JD Lee.
JD Lee.
JD Lee.
FOURTH EDITION
Visit us at https://www.wileyindia.com/resources/
J.D. Lee
Concise
Inorganic Chemistry
for JEE (Main & Advanced)
@edubuzznotes
@edubuzznotes
J.D. Lee
Concise
Inorganic Chemistry
for JEE (Main & Advanced)
Adapted by
Sudarsan Guha
@edubuzznotes
J.D. Lee
Concise
Inorganic Chemistry
for JEE (Main & Advanced)
Copyright © 2019 by Wiley India Pvt. Ltd., 4436/7, Ansari Road, Daryaganj, New Delhi-110002.
All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any
means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or scanning without the written permission of the publisher. This
book is an adaptation of Concise Inorganic Chemistry 5/e by J.D. Lee (ISBN: 978-81-265-1554-7). All rights remain with
respective holders.
Limits of Liability: While the publisher and the author have used their best efforts in preparing this book, Wiley and the
author make no representation or warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this book, and
specifically disclaim any implied warranties of merchantability or fitness for any particular purpose. There are no warranties
which extend beyond the descriptions contained in this paragraph. No warranty may be created or extended by sales
representatives or written sales materials. The accuracy and completeness of the information provided herein and the
opinions stated herein are not guaranteed or warranted to produce any particular results, and the advice and strategies
contained herein may not be suitable for every individual. Neither Wiley India nor the author shall be liable for any loss of
profit or any other commercial damages, including but not limited to special, incidental, consequential, or other damages.
Disclaimer: The contents of this book have been checked for accuracy. Since deviations cannot be precluded entirely, Wiley
or its author cannot guarantee full agreement. As the book is intended for educational purpose, Wiley or its author shall not
be responsible for any errors, omissions or damages arising out of the use of the information contained in the book. This
publication is designed to provide accurate and authoritative information with regard to the subject matter covered. It is sold
on the understanding that the Publisher is not engaged in rendering professional services.
Trademarks: All brand names and product names used in this book are trademarks, registered trademarks, or trade names
of their respective holders. Wiley is not associated with any product or vendor mentioned in this book.
Preface
Concise Inorganic Chemistry by J.D. Lee is a book widely used by students reparing for
JEE as the most comprehensive and authentic text for understanding Inorganic Chemistry.
The purpose of adaptation of this book is to provide a complete textbook of Inorganic
Chemistry that covers the entire syllabus of JEE (Main and Advanced)in proper sequence
of topics and provides in-depth explanation of topics. The use of book should give confidence
to the students to apply their knowledge to problem-solving and attempting JEE.
In this new (fourth) edition, major changes have been made in the Chapter 8: Hydrogen,
where the concept of hydrogen bonding is now explained with specific examples relevant
to JEE. Chapter 9: The s-Block Elements has been made more concise with more focus on
topics required from JEE perspective. Major changes have been made in Chapter 10: The
p-Block Elements. It is now divided into six separate parts as Group 13, Group 14, Group
15, Group 16, Group 17 and Group 18 Elements. Each part is followed by a separate set
of exercises for that particular group. Miscellaneous questions based on multiple concepts
have been placed at the end of the chapter. Apart from this new questions have been
included in the exercises at the end of most of the chapters.
For the future also, any suggestions for the improvement of this book are welcome by
the author.
Sudarsan Guha
M. Tech. (IIT-Kanpur)
_
@edubuzznotes
_
@edubuzznotes
Concise Inorganic Chemistry by J.D. Lee has been the definitive text for learning
Inorganic Chemistry since its first edition appeared about 45 years ago. The book captures
the fundamentals of the subject in a simple and logical framework of factual knowledge.
The description is long enough to cover the essentials, yet short enough to be interesting. Its
unparalleled approach to teaching Inorganic Chemistry is the reason why it is probably the
most favoured resource for an IIT aspirant like you today.
In collaboration with experts in JEE (Main & Advanced) coaching, the fifth edition of
the original book has now been adapted to give you the best book available in Inorganic
Chemistry for preparing for the toughest engineering entrance exam in India. This adaptation
offers the dual advantage of unmatched explanation of concepts as developed by “Master
teacher” and appropriate applications of the concepts to problem solving as developed by
an expert in this area.
Let’s walk through some of the special book features that will help you in your efforts
to take the JEE (Main & Advanced) with confidence.
B. PEDAGOGY
CHAPTER OPENER
Each chapter starts with an
opening vignette related to the
topic, and listing of contents of
that chapter. This gives you an
overview of the chapter and
helps to identify the extent of
coverage.
CONCEPT EXPLANATION
Concepts are explained in a man-
ner easy to read and understand.
They are descriptive to the extent
required and provide reasons for
the structure, properties and reac-
tions of compounds. Many fasci-
nating applications of inorganic
compounds are also explained.
_
@edubuzznotes
FIGURES
The text is sprinkled with
multiple figures which pre-
sent two-dimensional rep-
resentation of compounds
and their structures. This
visual representation en-
hances understanding and
helps the student visualize
what a molecule may look
like.
TABLES
A large number of tables
capture data on structure,
properties and other such
parameters. The tabular repre-
sentation supports compara-
tive study of properties and
draws out changing trends in
them. The trends of various
properties of elements along
the periodic table are also
amply illustrated.
Application of concepts to problem solving is the core of JEE (Main & Advanced),
so it is important to test our understanding of concepts. For the test to be effective,
the assessment technique should be comprehensive and in the context of this
book, also in resonance with the JEE Main and JEE Advanced paper pattern.
Each part of the assessment should be modeled on the actual paper pattern
because unless the student practices the JEE way, he/she will not be sufficiently
equipped to take the examination. Keeping this in mind, the assessment has been
divided into:
_
@edubuzznotes
D. USE OF SI UNITS
SI units for energy are used throughout this edition, thus making a comparison of thermo-
dynamic properties easier. Ionization energies are quoted in kJ mol–1, rather than ionization
potentials in eV. Older data from other sources use eV and may be converted into SI units
(1 kcal = 4.184 kJ, and 1 eV = 23.06 × 4.184 kJ mol–1).
Meters are strictly the SI units for distance, and bond lengths are sometimes quoted in
nanometers (1 mm = 10–9 m). However Ångström units Å (10–10 m) are a permitted unit of
length, and are widely used by crystallographers because they give a convenient range of
numbers for bond lengths. Most bonds are between 1 and 2 Å (0.1 to 0.2 nm). Ångström
units are used throughout for bond lengths.
The positions of absorption peaks in spectra are quoted in wave numbers cm–1, because
instruments are calibrated in these units. It must be remembered that these are not SI units,
and should be multiplied by 100 to give SI units of m–1, or multiplied by 11.96 to give J mol–1.
The SI units of density are kg m–3, making the density of water 1000 kg m–3. This conven-
tion is not widely accepted, so the older units of g cm–3 are retained so water has a density
of 1 g cm–3.
In the section on magnetism both SI units and Debye units are given, and the relation
between the two is explained. For inorganic chemists who simply want to find the number
of unpaired electron spins in a transition metal ion, Debye units are much more convenient.
I II III IV V VI VII 0
IA IIA IIIB IVB VB VIB VIIB <…VIIIB…> IB IIB IIIA IVA VA VIA VIIA VIIIA
H He
Li Be B C N O F Ne
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
F. APPENDICES
Contents
Preface v
Note to the Student vii
1. Structure of an Atom 1
1.1 Atoms 1
1.2 Some Important Defnitions 2
1.3 Electronic Confguration of an Atom 3
Quantum numbers 4
Aufbau principle 6
Pauli exclusion principle 8
Hund’s rule 9
Stability of half•flled and fully•flled shells 13
Electronic confguration of ions 13
Nodal planes of different orbitals 15
Slater’s rule 15
Single Correct Choice Type Questions 17
Multiple Correct Choice Type Questions 20
Comprehension Type Questions 21
Assertion•Reasoning Type Questions 23
Integer Answer Type Questions 23
Matrix•Match Type Questions 24
Answers 25
3. Chemical Bonding 59
3.1 Attainment of a Stable Confguration 60
3.2 Types of Bonds 60
3.3 Transitions Between the Main Types of Bonding 61
Ionic bonds 61
Covalent bonds 62
Oxidation numbers 63
Coordinate bonds 63
Double and triple bonds 64
Metallic bonds and metallic structures 64
3.4 The Covalent Bond 64
The Lewis theory 64
Sidgwick–Powell theory 66
3.5 Valence Bond Theory 66
What is the essence of hybridization? 66
Features of hybrid orbitals 67
Calculation of steric number 68
3.6 Valence Shell Electron Pair Repulsion (VSEPR) Theory 69
Effect of lone pair 69
Effect of double bond 73
Effect of electronegativity 73
Back bonding 75
3.7 The Extent of d Orbital Participation in Molecular Bonding 79
3.8 Types of Covalent Bonds (Sigma (s ) and Pi (p ) Bonds) 80
Bridge bonding 83
3.9 Molecular Orbital Method 85
3.10 LCAO Method 85
s–s combinations of orbitals 86
s–p combinations of orbitals 87
p–p combinations of orbitals 88
p–d combinations of orbitals 89
d–d combinations of orbitals 89
Non•bonding combinations of orbitals 89
3.11 Rules for Linear Combination of Atomic Orbitals 90
3.12 Examples of Molecular Orbital Treatment for Homonuclear Diatomic Molecules 92
H+2 molecule ion 93
H2 molecule 93
+
He2 molecule ion 93
He2 molecule 94
Li2 molecule 94
Be2 molecule 94
B2 molecule 94
C2 molecule 94
N2 molecule 95
O2 molecule 95
O-2 ion 95
F2 molecule 96
3.13 Examples of Molecular Orbital Treatment for Heteronuclear Diatomic Molecules 96
NO molecule 97
CO molecule 97
3.14 Dipole Moment 98
Application of dipole moment 100
Some special cases 102
_
@edubuzznotes
Contents xvii
4. Hydrolysis 157
4.1 Introduction 157
4.2 Hydrolysis Through SN1 Mechanism 157
4.3 Hydrolysis Through SN2 Mechanism 158
4.4 Hydrolysis Through Addition–Elimination Mechanism 162
4.5 Hydrolysis Through Addition Mechanism 163
4.6 Hydrolysis Through Redox Reaction 163
4.7 Hydrolysis Through Push–Pull Mechanism 163
4.8 Hydrolysis Through Mixed Mechanism 164
Single Correct Choice Type Questions 166
Multiple Correct Choice Type Questions 167
Comprehension Type Questions 167
Assertion–Reasoning Type Questions 168
Integer Answer Type Questions 169
Matrix–Match Type Questions 169
Answers 170
5. Coordination Compounds 171
5.1 Double Salts and Coordination Compounds 171
5.2 Werner’s Work 172
5.3 More Recent Methods of Studying Complexes 173
5.4 Classifcation of Ligands 175
5.5 Effective Atomic Number (EAN) 178
Sidgwick EAN rule 179
5.6 Shapes of d Orbitals 180
5.7 Bonding in Transition Metal Complexes 181
Valence bond theory 181
Crystal feld theory 181
Molecular orbital theory 181
5.8 Valence Bond Theory 181
5.9 Crystal Field Theory 182
Octahedral complexes 183
5.10 Effects of Crystal Field Splitting 188
5.11 Tetragonal Distortion of Octahedral Complexes (Jahn•Teller Distortion) 189
5.12 Square Planar Arrangements 191
5.13 Tetrahedral Complexes 193
5.14 Magnetism 195
5.15 Extension of the Crystal Field Theory to Allow for Some Covalency 196
5.16 Nomenclature of Coordination Compounds 196
5.17 Isomerism 199
Polymerization isomerism 199
Ionization isomerism 199
Hydrate isomerism 199
Linkage isomerism 200
Coordination isomerism 200
Coordination position isomerism 201
Geometrical isomerism and optical isomerism 201
Single Correct Choice Type Questions 206
Multiple Correct Choice Type Questions 209
Comprehension Type Questions 210
Assertion–Reasoning Type Questions 211
Integer Answer Type Questions 212
Matrix–Match Type Questions 212
Answers 214
_
@edubuzznotes
Contents xix
6. Metallurgy 217
6.1 Types of Ores 218
6.2 Principal Steps in the Recovery of a Metal from its Ore 219
6.3 Concentration or Dressing of Ore 219
Gravity separation or levigation 220
Magnetic separation 220
Froth foatation or oil foatation 220
Chemical method of separation: leaching 222
6.4 Conversion of Concentrated Ore into its Oxide 222
Calcination 222
Roasting 222
6.5 Different Reduction Processes 223
Carbon reduction 223
Self reduction 224
Thermite reduction (or Goldschmidt•Thermite process) 224
Metal replacement method (Hydrometallurgy) 225
Electrolytic reduction 225
Thermal decomposition method 226
6.6 Purifcation or Refning of Metal 226
Thermal refning 226
Electrorefning 228
6.7 Thermodynamics of Reduction Process 229
6.8 Alloys and Amalgams 231
Classifcation of alloys 231
Characteristics of alloys 232
Preparation of alloys 232
Amalgam 233
6.9 Different Types of Furnaces Used in Metallurgy 233
6.10 Extraction of Silver 234
Refning of Ag 235
6.11 Extraction of Gold by Cyanide Process 235
Refning of Au 235
6.12 Extraction of Tin 236
Refning of Sn 237
6.13 Extraction of Magnesium 237
Electrolytic reduction 237
Carbon reduction process 239
Other processes 239
6.14 Extraction of Aluminium 239
Benefciation of bauxite 240
Electrolytic reduction of pure Al2O3 242
Electrorefning of aluminium 243
6.15 Extraction of Lead 244
Carbon reduction 244
Self reduction process 246
Refning of lead 246
6.16 Extraction of Copper 246
Refning of blister copper 248
6.17 Extraction of Zinc 248
6.18 Extraction of Iron 250
Purifcation of iron or preparation of wrought iron 251
Steel making 252
Single Correct Choice Type Questions 253
Multiple Correct Choice Type Questions 255
_
@edubuzznotes
xx Contents
Appendices 593–612
Appendix A Abundance of the Elements in the Earth’s Crust 593
Appendix B Melting Points of the Elements 595
Appendix C Boiling Points of the Elements 596
Appendix D Densities of the Solid and Liquid Elements 597
Appendix E Electronic Structures of the Elements 598
Appendix F Some Average Single Bond Energies and Some Double and
Triple Bond Energies 602
Appendix G Solubilities of Main Group Compounds in Water 603
Appendix H Atomic Weights Based on 12 C = 12.000 605
Appendix I Values of Some Fundamental Physical Constants 607
Appendix J Electrical Resistivity of the Elements at the Stated Temperature 608
Appendix K Hardness of Minerals – Mohs’ Scale 610
Index I1
_
@edubuzznotes
1
Structure of an
Shells Possible subshells
n=1 1s
n=2 2s 2p
Atom n=3
n=4
3s
4s
3p
4p
3d
4d 4f
n=5 5s 5p 5d 5f 5g
n=6 6s 6p 6d 6f 6g
n=7 7s 7p
n=8 8s 8p
5. Isoelectronic species: The species having the same number of electrons are known as isoelectronic spe•
cies. (It may be an atom, ion or a molecule.) For example,
a. C 4- , N 3- , O2- , F- , Ne, Na + , Mg 2+ , Al 3+
b. Si 4− , P 3 − , S 2 − , Cl − , Ar, K + , Ca 2 + , Sc 3+
c. H 2 S, HCl, Ar, SH −
d. NH 2− , NH 3 , CH 4 , H 2 O, OH − , NH +4 , OH − , NH 2 −
− 2−
e. Ni (CO)4 ], [ Co (CO)4 , Fe (CO)4 , Fe (CO)2 ( NO)2
f. CO23 − , NO−3 , BO33−
g. SiO44 − , PO34− , SO24 − , ClO4−
Now•a•days the defnition of isoelectronic species is also observed to extend to include the species
having the same number of valence shell electrons (described later in the section on Classifcation of
elements as s, p, d and f•block elements). For example, the following species can also be considered
isoelectronic because they have the same number of valence shell electrons:
6. Isosters: Species that are isoelectronic as well as consist of the same number of atoms are known as
isosters. For example,
a. CH 4 , NH +4
b. CO23 − , NO−3 , BO33−
c. NH −2 , H 2 O
d. SiO44 − , PO34− , SO24 − , ClO4−
Quantum numbers
The characteristic features of the four quantum numbers are described as follows:
1. Principal quantum number (n): This quantum number indicates the distance of an electron from the
nucleus. It can have values of 1, 2, 3, 4 … up to ∞. As the value of n increases, the distance of the electron/
orbital from the nucleus increases as well as the energy of the electron increases.
Principal quantum numbers having different values of n are also considered as different energy
shells which are represented as follows:
n 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 …∞
Energy shells K L M N O P Q
2. Azimuthal quantum number (l): This quantum number indicates the shape of an orbital (not of elec•
tron) and can have values from 0 to (n–1) for a particular value of n. For example, for n = 5, the value
of l are 0, 1, 2, 3, 4.
Each value of l indicates the sub•energy level or subshell within the particular shell or energy level,
which are denoted as follows:
l 0 1 2 3 4
Subshell or sub•energy level s p d f g
Note: The notations for the sub•energy levels come from the spectroscopic terms that were used to
describe the atomic spectra and have the following full form:
s → sharp f → fundamental
p → principal g → generalized
d → diffused
These subshells have different shapes which are depicted in Table 1.2.
or
(Continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
1.3 Electronic Configuration of an Atom 5
Note:
(i) f and g subshells are of complicated shape and beyond the scope of syllabus.
(ii) These shapes of subshells are not experimentally observed as these are the 3D – plots of solution
of Schrödinger wave equation which is not part of the syllabus for JEE.
3. Magnetic quantum number (m or ml): This quantum number indicates the possible orientations of
an orbital in space. The value of m for a particular value of l varies from +l to –l including zero. For
example,
The different values of m for a particular value of l gives the possible orientations of the corresponding
orbital in space. Each possible orientation is considered as a particular orbital.
z z z
x x x
y y y
px py
pz
c. d•subshell consists of fve orbitals that are known as dxy dyz, dxz, dx2 − y2 and dz2 which are shown in
Figure 1.3.
y z z
x x y
y
x x
dx 2 −y2 dz2
Note:
(i) dxy, dyz, dxz orbitals are known as non•axial d•orbitals because the lobes of the orbitals are not
available along the axis.
(ii) dx −y and dz are known as axial d•orbitals because the lobes of oribtals are along the axis.
2 2 2
4. Spin Quantum Number (s or ms): It is the quantum number which is required to describe an electron
only (not the orbital) and it characterizes the spin of an electron. An electron is not only moving
around the nucleus but also spinning about its own axis. It may spin either clockwise or anticlockwise.
a. The possible values of spin quantum number are +1/2 and −1/2, but it is not fxed, that is, if the value
of s is +1/2 for clockwise spinning, then the value of s is −1/2 for anticlockwise and vice•versa. Also,
the electrons present in parallel spin must have the same spin value, for example,
or
s = −1 2 −1 2 −1 2
or
s = +1/2 +1/2 +1/2
or
Aufbau principle
The electrons are flled up in the empty orbitals of an atom from the lowest energy orbital to the higher
energy orbital. The energy sequence of empty orbitals is given in Figure 1.4, in which the energy of the
subshells increases along the directions of arrow.
_
@edubuzznotes
1.3 Electronic Configuration of an Atom 7
n=1 1s
n=2 2s 2p
n=3 3s 3p 3d
n=4 4s 4p 4d 4f
n=5 5s 5p 5d 5f 5g
n=6 6s 6p 6d 6f 6g
n=7 7s 7p
n=8 8s 8p
Alternatively, the above energy sequence or the energy comparison between any two subshells can be
established very easily on the basis of (n + l) rule which is stated as follows:
1. Smaller the value of (n + l) for a particular subshell smaller will be its energy.
2. If for two subshell, the (n + l) value is the same then the subshell having higher value of n will have
higher energy. For example,
for 3d ⇒ n + l = 3 + 2 = 5
same
and for 4 p ⇒ n + l = 4 + 1 = 5
Between the two, 4p has higher energy as compared to that of 3d.
Let us compare the energy of the following subshells according to (n + l) rule:
5p, 4s, 4d, 3d, 4f, 6s
Based on the (n + l) rule, we have
Subshell (n + l )
5p 5+1=6
4s 4+0=4
4d 4+2=6
3d 3+2=5
4f 4+3=7
6s 6+0=6
Hence the energy order will be: 4 f > 6 s > 5 p > 4d > 3d
_
@edubuzznotes
8 Chapter 1 Structure of an Atom
(Continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
1.3 Electronic Configuration of an Atom 9
–1
–2
–3
So on…
Note:
(i) The number of orbitals present in a subshell is (2l + 1).
(ii) The total number of electrons present in a subshell is 2(2l + 1).
(iii) Total number of orbitals present in a shell is n2.
(iv) Total number of electron present in a shell is 2n2.
Based on the above rules, let us fnd the number of subshell, orbitals and maximum number of electrons
that can be accommodated in R shell.
Shell K L M N O P Q R
n= 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Hund’s rule
According to this rule, the degenerate orbitals (i.e. orbitals having same energy) will be flled by one electron
each having same spin and then only pairing of electrons will take place. Alternatively, the flling up of
electron in the degenerate orbitals will take place in such a way that the multiplicity (M) value will be maximum
where M is defned as follows:
M = 2 | S | +1
where S = total spin value of all electrons in degenerate orbitals.
For example, consider the nitrogen atom; the electronic distribution is shown as follows:
7 N : 1s2 2s2 2p3 M = 2|S| + 1
Using all the above discussed rules, that is, Aufbau principle, Pauli’s exclusion principle and Hund’s
rule, the electronic confguration of different elements can be written. For example,
12 Mg : 1s 2 2s2 2 p6 3s 2
31 Ga : 1s 2 2s2 2 p6 3s 2 3 p6 4s2 3d 10 4 p1
The electronic confguration of all the known elements is given in Table 1.4.
Table 1.4 Electronic configurations of elements
Element Atomic Subshells
number (Z ) Is 2s 2p 3s 3p 3d 4s 4p 4d 4f 5s 5p 5d 5f 6s 6p 6d 7s
H 1 1
He 2 2
Li 3 2 1
Be 4 2 2
B 5 2 2 1
C 6 2 2 2
N 7 2 2 3
O 8 2 2 4
F 9 2 2 5
Ne 10 2 2 6
Na 11 2 2 6 1
Mg 12 2 2 6 2
A1 13 2 2 6 2 1
Si 14 2 2 6 2 2
P 15 2 2 6 2 3
S 16 2 2 6 2 4
Cl 17 2 2 6 2 5
Ar 18 2 2 6 2 6
K 19 2 2 6 2 6 1
Ca 20 2 2 6 2 6 2
Sc 21 2 2 6 2 6 1 2
Ti 22 2 2 6 2 6 2 2
V 23 2 2 6 2 6 3 2
Cr* 24 2 2 6 2 6 5 1
Mn 25 2 2 6 2 6 5 2
Fe 26 2 2 6 2 6 6 2
Co 27 2 2 6 2 6 7 2
Ni 28 2 2 6 2 6 8 2
Cu* 29 2 2 6 2 6 10 1
Zn 30 2 2 6 2 6 10 2
Ga 31 2 2 6 2 6 10 2 1
Ge 32 2 2 6 2 6 10 2 2
As 33 2 2 6 2 6 10 2 3
Se 34 2 2 6 2 6 10 2 4
(Continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
1.3 Electronic Configuration of an Atom 11
The (*) marked elements are those for which the Aufbau principle is not strictly followed.
Elements beyond the (**) marked element are also known. The elements with atomic numbers 112,
114 and 116 have been discovered and assigned offcial IUPAC names copernicium, feuorium and
livermorium, respectively. The elements with atomic numbers 113, 115, 117 and 118 are yet to be
discovered.
_
@edubuzznotes
1.3 Electronic Configuration of an Atom 13
44 Ru : [Kr] 5s1 4d 7
29 Cu : [Ar] 4 s1 3d 10 45 Rh : [Kr] 5s1 4d 8
47 Ag : [Kr] 5s1 4d 10 46Pd : [Kr] 5s 0 4d 10
79 Au : [X e] 4 f 14 6s1 5d 10 78 Pt : [Xe] 6s1 4 f 14 5d 9
Several above violations of Aufbau principle can be explained on the basis of achieving either half•
flled or fully•flled confgurations of a subshell which are relatively more stable. The extra stability of half•
flled and fully•flled confgurations can be attributed to the following reasons:
1. The symmetry leads the stability (as the rule of nature).
2. The exchange energy is more for half•flled and fully•flled electronic confguration. For example, con•
sider the electronic confguration shown in Figure 1.5, in which the possible exchange of positions of
electrons is depicted.
4 + 3 + 2 + 1 = 10
After exchanging the position between any two electrons, it gives the same confguration. During this
exchange of position of electrons, some amount of energy is released which is known as exchange energy.
More number of exchanges causes release of more energy.
For the above case (i.e. d5 confguration), the total number of possible exchanges is ten. Similarly for d10
confguration, the total number of possible exchanges will be (10 + 10) = 20, (only two electron of same spin
are allowed to exchange their position). Hence, ten exchanges are possible for 5 electrons having +1/2 spin
and another ten exchanges are possible for fve electrons having −1/2 spin. Hence fully•flled confguration
is more stable as compared to half•flled confguration.
If the atomic number of an atom A is Z, then total number of electrons in A– is (Z+ 1) and in A2− is
(Z + 2). Hence, to arrive at the electronic confguration, count the total number of electrons in the
anion and fll them in the empty orbital available in that element. For example, consider N 3− :
Total number of electrons = 7 + 3 = 10.
The electronic confguration is: 1s2 2s2 2p6.
_
@edubuzznotes
14 Chapter 1 Structure of an Atom
2. For cation:
e e
M − → M + − → M 2+
xe
M − →M x+
Hence, the total number of electrons in Mx+ is = Z− x where Z is the atomic number of M.
Then write the electronic confguration as usual if M is an element of s•block or p•block.
But if M is an element of d•block or f•block, then write the electronic confguration of the respective
element M frst and then remove the x number of electrons from ns, then from (n – 1)d and then from
(n – 2)f orbital gradually. For example, consider Fe and Cu ions for d•block elements.
(i)
Fe : [Ar]3d 6 4s 2
26
(ii)
Cu : [Ar] 3d 10 4 s1
29
Cu+ : [Ar] 3d 10 4 s 0
Cu 2+ : [Ar] 3d 9
64 Gd : [Xe]4f 7 5d 1 6s 2
Gd 2+ : [Xe]4f 7 5d 1 6s 0
Gd 3+ : [Xe]4f 7 5d 0 6s 0
Gd 4+ : [Xe]4 f 6 5d 0 6 s 0
Following the Hund’s rule, after obtaining the electronic confguration, the number of unpaired electrons
(if any) can be calculated for any element or ion. From the number of unpaired electrons, it can further
be predicted if the species is paramagnetic or diamagnetic. If we assume that the magnetic moment arises
entirely from unpaired electron spins, then the spin only magnetic moment value can be calculated using
the following formula:
where n is the number of unpaired electrons present in the species. Spin only magnetic moment is also
referred to as magnetic momentm for convenience sake.
1. Paramagnetic: The substance consisting of unpaired electron(s) (either one or more) is known as para•
magnetic and it is attracted by the magnetic feld. Paramagnetic substances are coloured in general.
2. Diamagnetic: The substance consisting of no unpaired electron is known as diamagnetic and it is
repelled by the magnetic feld. Diamagnetic substances are generally colourless.
Let us predict the magnetic behaviour of ions based on their electronic confgurations. For example, con•
sider Mn2+, the electronic confguration is:
Mn : [Ar] 3d 5 4s2
Mn 2+ : [Ar] 3d 5 or
The electronic confguration shows the presence of fve unpaired electrons, hence it is paramagnetic and
the magnetic moment (mS) is
mS = 5 ( 5 + 2 ) BM
= 35 B.M = 5.92 BM
_
@edubuzznotes
1.3 Electronic Configuration of an Atom 15
Slater’s rule
In 1930, it was suggested by J. C. Slater that any one electron in an atom is attracted by all protons in the
nucleus and repelled by other electrons present in the same shell or inner shell (Figure 1.6). He established
a simple relation for determining the net attraction on an electron, which is given by:
Zeff = Z −s
where Zeff is the effective nuclear change on that specifed electron; Z is the atomic number and s is the
shielding constant or screening constant which is the measure of net repulsion on that electron caused by
other electrons in the same shell and inner shells.
K L M
The value of the screening constant (s) can be calculated by the following rules:
1. Write the electronic confguration of an atom as follows:
(1s) (2s, 2p) (3s, 3p) (3d) (4s, 4p) (4d) (4f )…
Note that only the presentation will be in the above format but the number of electrons in a subshell
will be as in the electronic confguration obtained in accordance with Aufbau principle, Hund’s rule
and Pauli exclusion principle.
2. For electrons present in s or p•subshell:
a. The electrons present on the right side of the group made by ( ) of the electron for which s is to be
calculated, have no contribution to the value of s.
_
@edubuzznotes
16 Chapter 1 Structure of an Atom
b. Other electrons present in the same shell number will have the contribution of 0.35 each (except for
the electrons in 1s subshell, that contribute 0.3).
c. Electrons present in the (n – 1)th shell will have the contribution of 0.85 each.
d. Electrons present in the (n – 2)th shell onward will have the contribution of 1.0 each.
3. For electrons present in the d or f subshell.
a. Same as for electron present in s or p•subshell.
b. The other electrons present in the same group [i.e. within ()],will have the contribution of 0.35
each.
c. Rest of the electrons left of this group will have the contribution of 1.0 each.
Based on the above rules, we can now calculate the Zeff for an electron in various subshells. Some examples
are as follows:
1. Zeff for electrons in 4s and 3d subshells of Fe. The electron confguration is
Fe : [Ar] 4 s 2 3d 6
For 3d•electron,
s = 18 × 1.0 + 5 × 0.35 = 19.75
(Note that two electrons in 4s•subshell have no contribution as per the rule.) Substituting, we get,
Zeff = 26 − 19.75 = 6.25
Using Slater’s rule, it can be understood that the 3d electrons are more strongly attracted by its nucleus
as compared to 4s electrons. Hence, though the electrons are flled frst in the 4s•subshell, yet removal
of electron takes place from 4s subshell frst followed by the removal of electron of 3d subshell for frst
transition series element, and it can be generalized for all transition element, that is, the removal of
electron will take place ns subshell frst and then from (n – 1)d subshell.
2. Zeff for electrons in 4s and 3d subshells of Sc.
The electronic confguration as per Slater’s rule can be written as Sc: (1s2) (2s2 2p6) (3s2 3p6) (3d1)
(4s24p) …
For 4s electron,
s = 10 × 1.0 + 9 × 0.85 + 1 × 0.35 = 18
⇒ Zeff = 21 − 18 = 3.0
For 3d electron,
s = 18 × 1.0 = 18
⇒ Zeff = 21 − 18 = 3.0
Here, Zeff for both 4s and 3d subshells are the same and it does not conclude that the removal of
electron will take place from 4s subshell frst. More accurate method is developed by Clementi and
Raimondi which suggests that Zeff of 4s subshell is less than that of 3d subshell. (But this method
involves some more rigorous calculations that are out of syllabus of JEE.)
3. Zeff for electrons in 3s and 3p subshells of P atom.
Electronic confguration according to Slater’s rule is
P: (1s2) (2s2 2p6) (3s2 3p3)
_
@edubuzznotes
Single Correct Choice Type Questions 17
Li Be B C N O F Ne
1.3 1.95 2.60 3.25 3.90 4.55 5.20 5.85
2. In a group:In the Zeff values calculated using Slater’s rule, there is slight increase observed in a group.
However, when calculated according to Clementi and Raimondi method, a more accurate steady
increase in Zeff values was observed down a group for all groups. For example,
H Li Na K Rb Cs
Zeff (by Slater) : 1.0 1.3 2.2 2.2 2.2 2.2
Zeff (by Clementi and Raimondi) : 1.0 1.279 2.507 3.495
1. The electrons, identifed by quantum number n (C) Similar value of (n + l) with that of 2s orbital.
and l: (D) Accommodation in either 2px , 2py or 2pz orbital.
(I) n = 3; l = 0 (II) n = 5; l = 2
4. Given that Zeff value of an element N (Z = 7) is Y.
(III) n = 2; l = 1 (IV) n = 4; l = 3
Then which of the following statements is correct?
can be placed in order of increasing energy from the
(A) s value for N will be 7 + Y.
lowest to highest as:
(B) s value for oxygen will be 7.35 − Y.
(A) III < I < IV < II
(C) s value for oxygen will be 7 − Y.
(B) I < III < IV < II
(D) Given information is not suffcient.
(C) II < III < IV < I
(D) II < IV < I < III 5. The orbital diagram in which the Aufbau principle
is violated
2. An electron has a spin quantum number +1/2 and mag•
(A)
netic quantum number −1. It cannot be present in:
(A) d•orbital 2s 2p 2p 2p
(B) f•orbital
(B)
(C) p•orbital
(D) s•orbital
2s 2p 2p 2p
3. Consider the following electronic confguration (C)
2s 2p 2p 2p
2s 2px 2py 2pz (D)
If one electron is added into the given electronic
2s 2p 2p 2p
arrangement, then upcoming electron will have:
(A) Similar spin with that of electron of 2pz. 6. For which of the following orbitals, the electron
(B) Similar value of magnetic quantum number with fnding probability is zero, if we move along the
that of 2px. z•axis?
_
@edubuzznotes
18 Chapter 1 Structure of an Atom
20. Which of the following may have same set of quan• (A) 5s, 5d
tum numbers? (B) 4d, 6s
(A) Last electron of Sc and last electron of Fe. (C) 4d, 4f
(B) Unpaired electron of C and entered electron in C −. (D) 6s, 4f
(C) Last electron of Sc and last electron of Y.
(D) Unpaired electron in 2p orbital of N and 28. Which of following species has the magnetic moment
unpaired electron in 2p orbital of B. value of 3.87 BM?
(A) Fe3+
21. Which out of Co (II) salts and Cd (II) salts, is attracted (B) Cr 2+
or repelled by the magnetic feld? (C) Co 2+
(A) Co (II) salts are attracted and Cd (II) salts are (D) Au
3+
repelled.
(B) Co (II) salts are repelled and Cd (II) salts are 29. Give the correct order of initials True (T) or False (F)
attracted. for following statements.
(C) Co (II) salts are attracted, while Cd (II) salts are (I) Number of electrons having l = 0 is 10 in Pd.
not affected by the magnetic feld. (II) The value of Zeff for 3d electron of Cr and 3d
(D) Both Co (II) and Cd (II) salts are repelled. electron of Mn is same as number of electron in
22. An electron present in which of the following orbitals d sub shell of Cr and Mn are the same.
2+
has the minimum value for (n + l + m + s)? Consider (III) Multiplicity of Fe is equal to that of Ni .
the minimum possible value for m and s (where ever (IV) Value of l / n for last electron of element
applicable). having atomic number 57 is 0.4,
23. Choose the correct statement among the following: 30. According to Slater rule, the set of elements that
(A) Number of orbitals in nth shell is n2. show incorrect order of Zeff are:
(B) Number of orbitals in a subshell is (2l − 1). (A) Al > Mg
(C) Number of subshells in nth shell is (n − 1). (B) Na > Li
(D) Number of electrons in an orbital of a subshell is (C) K > Na
2(2l + 1). (D) None of these
24. In boron atom shielding of the last electron is due to 31. The magnetic moment and nature for isolated gaseous
(A) electrons of K shell only. 3+
ion Au is
(B) all the electrons of K and L shells.
(A) zero and diamagnetic.
(C) two electrons of 1s and 2s each.
(B) 2.82 BM and diamagnetic.
(D) all the electrons of L shell only.
(C) 2.82 BM and paramagnetic.
25. Which of the following statements is correct? (D) None of these.
(A) Total number of electrons in a subshell is 2l + 1. 32. The correct set of quantum numbers for the last
(B) pz, dx2 − y2 and dz2 orbitals are non•axial. electron of Na + is
(C) Only s orbital has directional orientation while pz, 1
d and f orbitals have non•directional properties. (A) 3, 0, 0, −
2
(D) Spin multiplicity of nitrogen atom is 4.
1
(B) 3, 1, 0, +
26. Imagine a Universe in which the four quantum 2
numbers can have the same possible value as in our 1
Universe except that the magnetic quantum number (C) 3, 1, 1, +
2
(m) can have integral values from 0 to ± (l + 1). Find 1
the electronic confguration of atomic number 20. (D) 2, 1, 0, −
2
(A) 1s6 2s6 2p8
(B) 1s2 2s2 2p6 3s2 3p6 4s2 33. Select the correct statement for Ne.
(C) 1s4 2s4 2p6 3s4 3p2 (A) It is not isoelectronic wih H2O
(D) 1s2 1p6 2s2 1d10 (B) Its last electron enters in S orbital
27. The subshells which are flled just before and just (C) The value of m must be zero for the last electron.
after the flling of 5p subshell are respectively: (D) The value of l must be 1 for the last electron.
_
@edubuzznotes
20 Chapter 1 Structure of an Atom
(B) 4 px
(C)
(C) 4dxy
dxy dyz dxz dx − y
2 2 dz 2
(D) 4dx2 − y2
(D)
8. Which of the following electronic confgurations are
dxy dyz dxz dx − y
2 2 dz 2 6
incorrect for a d system for an isolated gaseous ion?
2. Which of the following set(s) consist of only isoelec•
tronic species? (A)
(A) N3−, O3−, Ne, Na+
(B) NO−3, SiO4− 2−
4 , CO 3 (B)
2+ 4+
(C) Hg , Pb
(D) H, He+, Li2+, Be3+
(C)
3. If two subshells have equal value of (n + l) and one of
them has n = 4, l = 3, while second subshell has dumb•
bell shape. Then which of the following statement is/ (D)
are correct?
(A) Second subshell has value of n = 6. 9. Using the Slater’s rule, choose the correct statements
(B) Second subshell has one nodal plane. among the following.
(C) Second subshell is d•subshell. (A) Value of s (shielding constant) for d•electrons
(D) First subshell is f•subshell. of penultimate shell of Sc, Y, La are equal.
4. Select the correct statement(s) among the following. (B) Zeff for d•electrons of penultimate shell of Sc, Y,
(A) The maximum value of principal quantum La are equal.
number is 7. (C) Value of s increases by a factor of 0.3 in the frst
(B) For n = 2, there may be four subshells and these period from left to right.
may contain a maximum of 8 electrons. (D) Value of Zeff increases by a factor of 0.35 in the
(C) M shell can accommodate a maximum of 18 electrons. second period from left to right.
(D) The energy of 5p•orbitals is more than that of
4d•orbitals. 10. Which of the following quantum numbers may
be the same for an electron present in 3p and 5p
5. Which of the following statements are not true for orbitals?
dxy orbital?
(A) Principal quantum number
(A) It is double dumbbell shaped. (B) Azimuthal quantum number
(B) The lobes lie in between x•and z•axes. (C) Magnetic quantum number
(C) pz orbital is perpendicular to dxy orbital.
(D) Spin quantum number
(D) The lobes of px orbital are collinear with those
of dxy orbital. 11. Choose the correct options from the following:
6. Which are the orbitals represented in Figure 1.7? (A) Cr and S have the same number of valence shell
electrons.
(B) Cr and S have different number of unpaired
electrons in their ground state.
(C) Cr and S are the elements of the same period.
(D) In the long form of the periodic table, the Group
number of Cr and S is 6 and 16, respectively.
12. Which of the following set of quantum numbers are
dxz valid for electrons of ground state electronic confgu•
Figure 1.7 Multiple correct choice type question 2. ration of elements having atomic number upto 25.
_
@edubuzznotes
Comprehension Type Questions 21
n l m s
16. Choose the correct option regarding energy of empty
(C) 1 orbitals.
4 1 0 −
2 n l m s
n l m s 1
(I) 4 0 0 +
(D) 1 2
2 2 +1 +
2 1
(II) 3 2 0 −
13. Select the incorrect statements among the following. 2
The effective nuclear charge (Zeff) takes into account the (B) Ni
+
interelectronic repulsion in multielectron atoms. Slater’s
(C) Cu 2+
rule helps us in evaluating Zeff for various species. Apply
(D) All of these.
Slater’s rules to answer the following questions.
12. The number of unpaired electrons in the divalent
5. Zeff for 3d electron of Zn = x
cation of the element in isolated gaseous state is
Zeff for 3d electron of Zn2+ = y
Zeff for 4s electron Zn = z (A) 0
Choose the correct option(s) (B) 3
(A) x > z (B) y > z (C) 4
(C) x = y (D) All of these (D) 1
Passage 4: For Questions 7–9 13. Which of the following statement is correct?
(A) The quantum numbers of the electron in H atom
Consider a hypothetical atom where, px , py , pz and
are exactly identical with that of one electron of
dxy , dxz , dyz , dx2 − y2 orbitals are present for principal
He atom.
quantum number n = 3.
(B) The maxima of the radial distribution of s orbital
7. In the nodal plane of px orbital, the number of other decreases as the principal quantum number
orbital lobes that are fully present is increases.
(A) 2 (C) According to Pauli’s exclusion principle, the
(B) 3 lower energetic orbital will be flled frst.
(C) 4 (D) The N atom has the electronic confguration of
(D) 5 1s 2 2 s 2 2 p3 which is represented as
8. In the nodal plane of pz orbital, the number of other
orbital lobes that are fully present is
(A) 2 14. (n + l) is maximum and minimum for which of the
(B) 3 following orbitals: 6s, 5p, 6d, 4d, 2p, 3s, 2s?
(C) 4 (A) 6f and 1s
(D) 5 (B) 6d and 2s
9. Which of the following orbital’s lobe is not present (C) 5p and 3s
at all either in the nodal plane of px orbital or in the (D) 6s and 2p
nodal plane of py orbital? 15. Which of the following statements is correct for H
(A) dxy atom?
(B) dx 2 − y 2 (A) H atom can be placed both in Group 1 and
(C) dyz Group 18.
(D) pz (B) H atom can be placed both in Group 1 and
Group 17.
(C) H atom produces smallest anion in reality.
Passage 5: For Questions 10–12 (D) 2s, 2p, 3s orbitals are not available in H atom.
The general electronic confguration of outer most and
penultimate shell is given as (n − 1)s2 (n − 1)p6(n - 1)d x ns 2 .
Then for an element with n = 4 and x = 7.
Passage 7: For Questions 16–18
10. The number of protons present in the divalent cation The electronic confguration of an element is written as
of the element of above confguration is follows: 1s 2 2 s 2 2 p6 3s 2 3 p6 3d 8 4 s 2
_
@edubuzznotes
Integer Answer Type Questions 23
16. On removal of one electron, the electronic confgura• 18. Which of the following statements is incorrect?
tion will become (A) In calculation of s value (shielding constant)
(A) 1s 2 2 s 2 2 p6 3s 2 3 p6 3d 7 4 s 2 for an electron in 4s orbital, the contribution of
1s electron is 0.3.
(B) 1s 2 2 s 2 2 p6 3s 2 3 p6 3d 8 4 s1 (B) In calculation of s value for of an electron in 3d
(C) 1s 2 2 s 2 2 p6 3s 2 3 p6 3d 9 4 s orbital, the contribution of 4s electron is zero.
(C) In calculation of s value for an electron in 3d
(D) None of these.
orbital, the contribution of electron present in
17. The screening constant value for an electron in 3s is 3p orbital is 1.0.
identical with that of an electron present in (D) In calculation of s value for an electron in 4s
(A) 3p orbital. orbital, the contribution of electron present in
(B) 3d orbital. 3p orbital is 0.85.
(C) 4s orbital.
(D) 4p orbital.
7. If Zeff of Mg is 2.85, then what will be the value of y 18. The total value of m for all electrons in N atom is
(s + 0.85) ___________.
for magnesium, where y = ?
2 19. Find maximum number of electrons in Al for which
8. How many elements amongst the following have at
least 4 electrons in p•subshells? l×m
= 0. (Atomic number of Al =13).
B, N, Al, Si, P, Cl n
9. If Aufbau’s rule is not followed and electron flling is 20. Find total number of orbitals in S atom, for which
done shell after shell, then number of unpaired elec• m ≤ 1 and which contains at least one electron.
trons present in copper will be ____________. (Atomic number of S = 16).
10. The frst excited state of Cl− ion will have degeneracy 21. Find total number of orbitals in which electron den•
of ___________. sity is observed along any of the axis (x, y or z).
11. Maximum number of degenerate orbitals in M shell s, px , py , pz , dxy , dxz , dyz , dz2 , dx2 − y2
of Li2+ is ___________.
12. Number of groups incorrectly mentioned according 22. Calculate maximum number of electrons in Mn
25
3. Match the electronic confguration with the nature/ 4. Match the ion with the property.
property of the element. Column-I Column-II
Column-I Column-II (A) Fe2+
(P) Set of quantum number for the last
10 2 6 1 (P) p•block element. electron
(A) [ Ar] 3d 4 s 4 p 5s
1
2 6 2 6 (Q) Zero group n = 2, l = 1, m = 1, s = +
(B) [Ne] 3s 3 p 4 s 3d 2
element.
(R) d•block element. (B) Mn4+ (Q) Magnetic moment (μ) = Zero.
(C) 1s 2 2 s 2 2 p6 3s 2 3 p6
2+
(C) Zn (R) Spin multiplicity(SM) = 4
14 10 2 3 (S) 4th period element.
(D) [Xe] 4 f 5d 6 s 6 p
(D) Na +
(S) Paramagnetic
(T) Paramagnetic
element.
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (A) 8. (C) 15. (D) 22. (A) 29. (D)
2. (D) 9. (C) 16. (D) 23. (A) 30. (C)
3. (D) 10. (C) 17. (B) 24. (C) 31. (C)
4. (B) 11. (C) 18. (B) 25. (D) 32. (D)
5. (B) 12. (C) 19. (B) 26. (A) 33. (D)
6. (C) 13. (A) 20. (D) 27. (B)
7. (A) 14. (A) 21. (A) 28. (C)
1. 4 3. 7 5. 4 7. 5 9. 1
2. 9 4. 1 6. 6 8. 4 10. 5
_
@edubuzznotes
26 Chapter 1 Structure of an Atom
2
Periodic Table 80
Cs
and Periodic 60 Rb
Properties
40 Ba
Na Cl Ca Sr V I
VI
III Sb Te
IV Br
20 I P S In La
II Mg
Li As Se Zr Sn
Si Mo
Al V Fe Nb Cd Nd
Be Zn Ru Rh
C Co Cu
0
10 30 50 70 90 110 130 150
Dobereiner’s triad
In 1829, German chemist Dobereiner was able to identify
several groups of three elements that showed similarity in
physical and chemical properties. He observed that in the set
of three elements having similar properties (called triads), the
atomic weight of the middle element is the arithmetic mean of
the atomic weights of other two elements. Some examples of
Dobereiner’s triads are as follows:
_
@edubuzznotes
28 Chapter 2 Periodic Table and Periodic Properties
Only few such triads were available at that time and day by day as many more elements were discovered,
the rule could no longer be generalized.
Sa Re Ga Ma Pa Dha Ni Sa
Li Be B C N O F Na
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl K
K Ca
The curve obtained is referred to as Lother Meyer’s curve and is shown in Figure 2.1.
_
@edubuzznotes
2.1 Periodic Table 29
80
Cs
60 Rb
40 Ba
Na Cl Ca Sr V I
VI
III Sb Te
S IV Br
20 I P In La
II Mg
Li As Se Zr Sn
Si Mo
Al V Fe Nb Cd Nd
Be Zn Ru Rh
C Co Cu
0
10 30 50 70 90 110 130 150
In the periodic table, so constructed, the elements in the same families (e.g., lithium, sodium, potassium)
were arranged in vertical columns designated as Groups I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, VIII. The horizontal rows
were referred to as series.
Mendeleev’s periodic table was later modified after the discovery of inert gases and several
other elements. The inert gases were placed in new Group 0. Each long period was divided into two
series, named as odd and even depending on the serial number. The first seven elements formed the
even series and the last seven elements formed the odd series (not including the inert gases). The
vertical Groups I to VII were further divided into two subgroups A and B to accommodate ele•
ments with difference in properties. The elements of even series in the long periods were placed in
subgroup A while the elements of odd series were placed in the B subgroup. The Group 0 was not
split further and in Group VIII three sets containing three elements each were placed.
*Lanthanide series Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
(6th period) 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
**Actinide series Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
(7th period) 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
The designation of the subgroups A and B given here is quite arbitrary and the new designation is given in the long
form Periodic table as per the latest Convention.
Important characteristics of modern version of Mendeleev’s short periodic table are listed as follows:
Second period: Li Be B
Third period: Mg Al Si
But no suitable position was found for Be according to its calculated atomic weight. But actually the
valency of Be is 2 according to group number and its atomic weight is rectifed (4.5 × 2 = 9).
3. Similarly the atomic weight rectifcation is also done for indium.
The demerits of Mendeleev’s periodic table are given as follows:
1. Some of the elements are wrongly placed though their atomic weights are larger compared to the
next one. For example,
2. Though the isotopes have different mass yet they don’t have any different (signifcant) position in the
periodic table.
3. Subgroup elements do not have suffcient similarities in their properties yet they are placed in the
same group.
4. The position of hydrogen is uncertain (either in Group I A or VII B).
5. The rare earth elements (4f and 5f series) are all placed in Group III A and they do not have any sepa•
rate position in the table.
6. The classifcation of metals and non•metals is not done in this table.
7. In Group VIII, three elements are placed together.
Moseley’s work
In 1913, Moseley performed an experiment in which he bombarded high speed electrons on different
metal surfaces and obtained X•rays. He observed that there existed a systematic mathematical relationship
between the wavelengths of the X•rays produced and the atomic numbers of the elements. This came to be
known as Moseley’s law and is expressed as:
n ∝Z
where v is the frequency of X•rays and Z is the atomic number of elements. The plot of n vs. Z is a straight
line (Figure 2.2)
20 20
u ´ 10–8 s–1
15 15
u ´ 10–8s–1
10 10
5 5
20 40 60 80 160 10 20 30 40 50
Relative Atomic Mass (A) Atomic Number (Z)
(a) (b)
Moseley’s experiment showed that the proper sequence criterion for the periodic arrangement of atoms
was not atomic weight but atomic number. The cause of similarity of properties was the repetition of the
outer shell electronic confguration at regular intervals. This observation formed the basis of the modern
periodic table.
Group
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Period IA IIA IIIB IVB VB VIB VIIB VIIIB IB IIB IIIA IVA VA VIA VIIA VIIIA
2 Li Be B C N O F Ne
(2s, 2p) 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
3 Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
(3s, 3p) 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
4 K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
(4s, 3d, 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
4p)
5 Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
(5s, 4d, 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
5p)
6 Cs Ba La* Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
(6s, 4f, 55 56 57 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
5d, 6p)
7 Fr Ra Ac** Unq Unq Unq Unq Unq Unq Unq Unq Unq
(7s, 5f, 87 88 89 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112
6d, 7p) (Rf ) (Db) (Sg) (Bh) (Hs) (Mt)
New convention
Post transition metals
Earlier convention
The Rate Earths, (n–2)f
*Lanthanides Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
series(4f) 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
f - block
Period :6
**Actinide Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
series(5f) 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
Period :7
Figure 2.3 The long form of modern periodic table and its segments.
Note: In some of the books, just to read easily, the groups are arranged as I A to VII A and then I B to VIII B from left
to right. The naming of groups as A and B is of no signifcance as such and it is only the group number that is important,
which is identical in both the arrangements.
c. The total number of valence shell electrons is equal to its group number according to A and B
convention.
d. He†(ns2) is excluded from p•block in terms of electronic confguration and it is better to consider it
as s•block element. But according to its chemical behavior it is justifed to place it in the Group 0,
that is, Group 18.
3. d-block elements: If the last electron enters into d orbital, the elements are called as d•block elements
(except Thorium). The general valence shell electronic confguration is:
ns 0 − 2 (n − 1)d 1− 10
or ns1− 2 (n − 1)d 1− 10 (except for pallad
dium)
Total valence shell electrons of d•block elements = Total number of electrons in the outermost shell
(ns orbital) and penultimate shell [(n – 1) d orbitals]. For example,
In Co : [Ar] 4s2 3d7 : 2 + 7 = 9, the maximum number of electrons that can be lost is 9 though it is not
yet observed.
In Fe : [Ar] 4s2 3d6 : 2 + 6 = 8, the maximum number of electrons that can be lost is 8. It is also not yet
observed but in case of Ru and Os this situation is observed in compounds RuO4 and OsO4
4. f-block elements: If the last electron of the elements enters into f•orbital, they are considered as f•block
elements. The general valence shell electronic confguration is:
ns 2 (n - 1)d 0- 1 (n - 2)f 1- 14
Total valence shell electrons = Electrons present in ns, (n – 1) d and (n–2) f orbitals or subshells.
Then successive roots are put together and the name is ended with ium. When some letters are repeated,
then the following precedence is to be adopted:
Atomic radius
The radius of the atom is the distance from the nucleus to the outermost electron or up to point at which
the probability of fnding of electron is the maximum. Since the atoms are not available in the atomic state
in most of the cases, three kinds of atomic radii are measured for any atom and these are covalent radius,
van der Waals radius and metallic radius. The three types of radii are discussed as follows.
Covalent radius
The covalent radius of an element represents the contribution of that element to the length of a bond that
is predominantly covalent. For example, the covalent radius of any element A is taken to be one half of the
internuclear distance in the homonuclear diatomic molecule A2 as shown in Figure 2.4.
A A
dA–A
rC = dA–A
2
A B
dA–B
dA − B = rA + rB − 9∆c
° °
where 1 A = 10 −10 m and 1picometer = 10 −12 m ⇒ 1 A = 102 picometer.
In the later stage, the above equation was modifed by Pauling and Stevenson as
dA − B = rA + rB − | CA c A − CB c B |
CA and CB are constants for two different atoms and cA and cB are the electronegativities of A and B.
Metallic radius
For metals the metallic radius is defned as half of the internuclear distance separating two adjacent metal
atoms in a metallic lattice (Figure 2.6).
dM–M
dA–A
Ne > Li>Be>B>C>N>O>F
van der Covalent radius
Waals
radius
For d•block elements, the variation of atomic radii in a period is depicted in Figure 2.8. The atomic
radius initially decreases, then remains constant and fnally increase again. The values of the radii of
d•block elements and trends in the sizes are discussed further in chapter 11.
Third series
Atomic Radius
Second series
First series
Atomic Number
2. Variation in a group: For representative (s• and p• block) elements, the atomic radii increases down the
group. This is due to successive use of orbitals with principal quantum number (n) one higher than the
last. Some exceptions to this are:
a. The radius of gallium is expected to be greater than that of aluminium but rAl ≈ rGa . This behavior
can be explained on the basis of electronic confguration for the two elements and the poor shield•
ing effect of d•electrons.
Al: [Ne]3s23p1
Ga: [Ar]4s23d104p1
b. Similarly, the radius of thallium is expected to be greater than that of indium but rTl ≈ rIn. The is
explained on the basis of electronic confguration and poor shielding of is d and f electrons
In: [Kr]5s24d105p1
La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
Atomic Number
Figure 2.9 Variation in atomic radii with increase in atomic number for lanthanoids.
Ionic radius
When a positive ion is formed, the number of positive charges on the nucleus exceeds the number of elec•
trons and effective nuclear charge is increased, resulting in the remaining electrons being attracted more
strongly by the nucleus. Thus a positive ion is always smaller than the corresponding atom and more the
electrons removed smaller is the ion.
When a negative ion is formed, one or more electrons are added to an atom and the effective nuclear
charge is reduced. The electron cloud expands and the size of negative ion is more than that of the atom
(Figure 2.10).
_
@edubuzznotes
2.3 Periodic Trends in Properties 39
A+(Cation)
-e
+e A–(Anion)
3. For isoelectronic species, as the number of protons increases the radius of ion decreases.
C 4 − > N 3 − > O2 − > F − > Na + > Mg 2+ > Al 3+
Note: The smallest anion is F - and not H-(ionic radius 208 pm). The radius order of anions is
F - < Cl - < Br - < H - < I - . The exception in the size of H- is because this is the only anion with e/p ratio = 2.
Ionization energy
Ionization energy (IE) is the energy required to remove an electron from an isolated gaseous atom in it
ground state.
A(g) IE→ A + (g) ∆H1 = + ve
It is measured in eV atom-1 or kJ mol-1.
Some characteristic features of ionization energy are listed as follows:
1. The ionization energy for an atom is always positive and for an ion may be negative.
−e
Be − −
ve IE
→ Be
2. Successive ionization energy always increases for any species because the e/p ratio gradually decreases.
Thus,
−e
A IE
1
−e
→ A + IE
2
→ A 2 + IE
−e
3
→ A 3+ IE
−e
4
−e
→ ... IE
n
→ An+
IE1 < IE 2 < IE 3 < IE 4 < ... < IE n
Note that:
IIE1 of A + = IE 2 of A, IE1 of A 2 + = IE 2 of A+ = IE 3of A
_
@edubuzznotes
40 Chapter 2 Periodic Table and Periodic Properties
3. Observing the sudden jump of successive IE values we can predict the number of valence shell
electrons of the corresponding atom. For example,
Sodium achieves stable confguration of neon after losing one electron. Germanium achieves stable
confguration of [Ar]3d10 after losing four electrons and aluminium loses three electrons to achieve
stable confguration of neon. Hence, they do not show tendency to lose any more electrons and sudden
jump in the values of IE are observed.
Ionization energy depends upon the following factors:
1. It decreases when shell number or the radius increases.
2. It increases when Zeff increases.
3. It decreases when σ (shielding constant) increases.
4. It is more for half•flled and fully•flled electronic confgurations.
5. It also depends upon the orbitals from which the electron is removed. If the principal quantum
number is the same, then the energy required for removal of electrons from different orbitals shows
the following order: s > p > d > f.
Electron affinity
Electron affnity is the energy released when one mole of electron is added to one mole of an element in its
isolated gaseous state (ground state).
-1
A(g) ¾+e
¾® A - DH = - x kJ mol
It is represented as EA and its unit is eV atom-1 or kJ mol-1 or kcal mol-1. It is also known as electron
gain enthalpy and represented as by∆ H eg .
According to the old convention, for an element A
A + e ® A- DH eg = (-) x kJ mol -1
The negative sign indicates that energy is released. For those cases in which energy is absorbed the EA
value considered as zero.
According to the new convention, ΔHeg may be negative or positive depending upon the circumstance and
EA = −∆H eg (At absolute zero temperature)
While at any other temperature T,
5
∆H eg = − EA − RT ∆H −
2
Hence, ∆it is better to−consider
T ∆H eg ≈ − EA.
Note:
(i) EA1 > EA2, that is for an element, the electron affnity for the frst electron is greater than that of the
second electron.
A + e
→ A − +
e
→ A2−
n n n+1 n+2
;
p n n n
_
@edubuzznotes
42 Chapter 2 Periodic Table and Periodic Properties
It is clear that
EA of A = IE of A −
Accordingly,
EA of A+ = IE of A
EA of A2+ = IE of A+
... and so on
ns1 +
e
→ ns 2 ns 2 +
e
→ ns 2 np1
Fully•flled electronic confguration is achieved Fully•flled electronic confguration is disturbed
∆H eg is (–)ve ∆H eg is (+)ve
On addition of an electron, the elements C, Si, Ge and Sn achieve half•flled electronic confguration
while in case of N, P, As and Sb do not have the tendency to gain electron and thus lose their half•flled
confguration.
Electron affnity depends upon a number of factors, that include:
1. It decreases when radius increases.
2. It increases when Zeff increases.
3. It decreases when s increases.
4. EA of half•flled and full•flled electronic confguration is less.
5. EA order for addition of electron in different orbitals having the same principal quantum number
is s > p > d > f
Electronegativity
In 1931, Pauling defned electronegativity of an atom as the tendency of the atom to attract electrons (bond
pair) towards itself when combined in a compound. It is a unitless and dimensionless quantity.
Electronegativity depends upon the following factors:
1. It decreases when radius increases.
2. It increases when Zeff increases.
3. It decreases when s (shielding constant) increases.
4. It increases when the oxidation state of an element increases.
5. It increases as much the percentage of s character in hybrid orbital increases. For example,
\ / sp2 2.75
C=C
/ \
−C ≡ C − sp 3.25
If two atoms have similar electronegativities, that is similar tendencies to attract electrons, the
bond between them is largely covalent. But when the difference between the electronegativites is large,
the bond has high degree of polar character. Some important approaches for obtaining values of
electronegativity are discussed as follows:
1. Pauling scale: This scale is based upon energy calculation and the expression is
F O Cl N Br I S C P H B Si
4 3.5 3.16 3.04 2.85 2.55 2.58 2.5 2.18 2.1 2.04 1.8
2. Mulliken scale: Mulliken suggested an alternate approach to electronegativity based on the ionization
energy and electron affnity of the element. In this scale, the electronegativity is given by the relation
IE + EA
cM =
2
where IE and EA are expressed in eV atom . Thus electronegativity is the average of ionization energy
-1
and electron affnity. The values of electronegativity are about 2.8 times larger than the Pauling values.
Thus the relationship more in use is
c
cP = M
2.8
More accurately
c P = 0.336 c M − 0.2
3. Allred Rochow scale: Allred defned electronegativity as the attractive force between nucleus and an
electron at a distance equal to covalent radius, In this scale, the electronegativity is given by
0.359 Zeff
c AR =
r2
where r is the covalent radius in Å and Zeff is the effective nuclear charge on the incoming electron or
peripheral electron. The following equation gives the correlation of cAR with cP
c P = c AR + 0.744
Applications of Electronegativity
Some applications of electronegativity are listed as follows:
1. Percentage ionic character in a bond can be calculated using Haney•Smith equation:
% ionic character = 16 ∆c + 3.5( ∆c )2
where ∆c is the difference in electronegativity between the two atoms.
2. The acidic and basic properties of metal oxides can be predicted. As ∆c increases, the acidic strength
of oxides of different elements decreases. For example,
_
@edubuzznotes
2.3 Periodic Trends in Properties 45
In aqueous medium , the acidic oxides lead to formation of acids HNO2 and HNO3.
+2 +4
(iv) CO < CO2 acidic
+4 +6
(v) SO2 < SO3 nature
+4 + order
(vi) CO2 > SiO2
Note: Some important points to note are as follows:
a. Most of the metallic oxides are basic in nature except ZnO, Al2O3, PbO, PbO2, SnO, SnO2, BeO,
which are amphoteric in nature.
b. In general alkali metal and alkaline earth metal oxides are more basic compared to oxides of
d-block elements.
c. For those oxides which are basic or acidic or amphoteric, the corresponding hydroxides are also
of similar nature.
Basic oxide Basic Acidic Acidic Amphoteric Amphoteric
hydroxide oxide hydroxide oxide hydroxide
Na2O NaOH SiO2 Si(OH)4 Al2O3 Al(OH)3
MgO Mg(OH)2 B2O3 B(OH)3 ZnO Zn(OH)2
MnO Mn(OH)2 N2O5 HNO3 BeO Be(OH)2
CuO Cu(OH)2
d. Amphoteric substance is one which reacts with both acid as well as base. Neutral substance
does not react with acid as well as base and when passed through water keeps it neutral.
3. The strength of oxyacids can be predicted easily, provided the number of OH group attached to central
atom remains the same. Some examples are:
+1 +3 +5 +7
a. H − O − Cl < H − O − ClO < H − O − ClO2 < H − O − ClO3
HOCl HClO2 HClO3 HClO4
+3 +5
b. HNO2 < HNO3
+4 +6
c. H 2 SO3 < H 2 SO4
+5 +5
d. H 3 PO4 > H 3 AsO4
+1 +3 +5
e. H 3 PO2 < H 3 PO3 < H 3 PO4 ( Exceptionally incorrect order )
H 3 PO3 >H 3 PO2 >H 3 PO4 (Correct order )
Note: The oxidation state is the formal charge developed by a particular atom by shifting the bond pair
towards more electronegative atom completely. For example
−1
H1+
+ −4
H : Cl and +1
H C H1+
H1+
_
@edubuzznotes
46 Chapter 2 Periodic Table and Periodic Properties
4. M–O–H like compound will act as acid or as base can be predicted very easily.
a.
b. Acts as a base when
M - O - H ⇌ M + + OH -
cO - cM > cO - cH
b.
a. Acts as an acid when
M - O - H ⇌ MO - +H +
cO - cH > cO - cM
b. Acts as a base when
Some example are:
Lattice Energy
Lattice energy is the characteristic of ionic compounds. It is the energy released to form one mole of ionic
compound (in solid form) from their respective isolated gaseous ions.
-U
M n+ (g)+ X n - (g) ⇌
+U MX(s)
Hydration Energy
Hydration energy is the energy released when an isolated gaseous ion gets hydrated and it is measured in
terms of kJ mol-1 or kJ ion-1.The hydration process can be depicted as follows:
_
@edubuzznotes
2.3 Periodic Trends in Properties 47
Na + (g) ¾taken
¾¾¾
Water
in
® Na + (aq)
DH hydration (cation) = (-)ve
Cl - (g) ¾taken
¾¾¾
water
in
® Cl - (aq)
DH hydration (anion) = (-)ve
Total hydration energy = DH hydration (cation) + DH hydration (anion)
Hydrated radius: It is the distance from the nucleus of a particular ion to that particular point up to which
the associated water molecules are immobile due to its attraction (Figure 2.12).
+
+ +
− − +
−
+
+ − +
+
−
+
− − −
− +
− −
−
−
+
+
+
+
−
+
− −
− +
+
+
Represents polar ends of water moleule
+
Hydration number: It is the number of water molecules associated to a particular ion when it is hydrated.
For example,
→ Na ( H 2 O)x
+
Na + x
H2 O
−
Cl − yH2 O
→ Cl ( H 2 O)y
x : Hydration number for Na +
y : Hydration number for Cl −
Hydration energy, hydrated radius and hydration number of a particular ion depends upon the charge
per unit area. Hence their order is the same for the following cations in the given examples:
Ionic Mobility
Ionic mobility is defned as the ability of an ion to move in an aqueous solution. Larger the hydrated radius,
lesser is the ionic mobility, that is,
1
Ionic mobity ∝
Hydrated radius of ion
_
@edubuzznotes
48 Chapter 2 Periodic Table and Periodic Properties
Thus, the order of ionic mobility is in the reverse order of the hydrated radius order, for example
(i ) Li + (aq ) < Na + (aq ) < K + (aq ) < Rb+ (aq ) < Cs + (aq )
(ii ) Be2+ (aq ) < Mg 2+ (aq ) < Ca 2+ (aq ) < Sr 2+ (aq ) < Ba 2+ (aq )
(iii ) F− (aq ) < Cl− (aq ) < Br − (aq ) < I− (aq )
(iv) Na + (aq ) > Mg 2+ (aq ) > Al3+ (aq )
1. From the given information of element M (C) Element X is not a transition element.
M → M3+ + 3e- ΔH = x kJ/mole (D) Atomic size of element Y is equal to the atomic
IE1 (M) = y kJ/mole size of element X.
IE1 (M2+) = z kJ/mole 4. Which of the following elements have electron
The value of IE2 (M) will be affnity greater than S?
(A) (x + y + z) kJ/mole (A) O
(B) (x – y – z) kJ/mole (B) Se
(C) (x – y + z) kJ/mole (C) Te
(D) z – (x + y) kJ/mole (D) None of these
2. In the given cycle, if P and Q are the magnitude
5. Among O, O+, O2+ and O2-, the species having most
of hydration energies (ΔHhydration) per mole for A3+
positive and most negative value of DHeg
(g) and B2- (g) ions, respectively. Then the value of
are, respectively
3 (A) O+ and O
P + Q will be,
2 (B) O2+ and O2-
(Consider only magnitude of ΔHhydration and LE is the (C) O and O2-
lattice energy of ionic compound.) (D) O2- and O2+
(III) For Zr2+ ion, mm = 8 BM 13. Match the electronic confguration with their
(IV) General valence shell electronic confguration respective DHeg (kJ/mole)/value.
for f•block elements is Column-I Column-II
(n - 2) f 1−14 (n - 1)d10 ns2. 2 2 6
(P) 1s , 2s , 2p (1) −328
(A) TTFT
(B) TFFT (Q) 1s2, 2s2, 2p4 (2) −122
(C) FFTF 2 2
(R) 1s , 2s , 2p 2
(3) −141
(D) FTTF 2 2 5
(S) 1s , 2s , 2p (4) +116
10. Match the elements with their corresponding IE1.
Code:
Column-I Column-II
P Q R S
(P) N (1) +800 (A) 3 1 2 4
(Q) O (2) +900 (B) 2 4 1 2
(R) Be (3) +1300 (C) 2 4 3 1
(S) B (4) +1400 (D) 4 3 2 1
Code: 14. Match the atoms/ions with their corresponding
P Q R S electron affnity. (eV/atom).
(A) 2 3 1 4 Column-I Column-II
(B) 1 2 3 4 (P) F (1) 3.4
(C) 4 3 2 1 (Q) F +
(2) 17.4
(D) 1 4 2 3 (R) Cl (3) 13
11. Match the elements of given atomic number with (S) Cl +
(4) 3.6
their properties.
Code:
Column-I Column-II
P Q R S
(P) (11) (1) IE is maximum
(A) 1 3 4 2
(Q) (19) (2) Zeff = 2.2 (on last electron)
(B) 2 1 3 4
(R) (37) (3) Size largest
(C) 1 2 4 3
(S) (55) (4) Position is next to Kr
(D) 3 1 2 4
Code:
15. Which of the following species has the highest
P Q R S
electronegativity?
(A) 1 1, 2 1, 2 3, 4 (A) C (sp hybridized)
(B) 1, 2 2, 4 2, 4 2, 3 (B) N (sp2 hybridized)
(C) 1, 2 2 2, 4 2, 3 (C) N (sp hybridized)
(D) C (sp3 hybridized)
(D) 2, 3 2 2, 4 2, 3
12. Match the species with their respective ionic size. 16. Choose the correct order of ionic radius for the fol•
lowing species.
Column-I Column-II (A) Cl − > I − > Te2 − > Ar +
(P) Mg 2+
(1) 1.19 Å
(B) Te2 − > I − > Cl − > Ar +
(Q) O 2-
(2) 0.72 Å
(C) I − > Te2 − > Cl − > Ar +
(R) Na+ (3) 1.16 Å
(D) I − > Cl − > Ar + > Te2 −
(S) F- (4) 1.26 Å
17. Choose the correct order of radius for the following
Code: species.
P Q R S (A) Na + < Na < Na −
(A) 3 1 2 4 (B) Na − > Na + > Na
(B) 2 4 1 3
(C) Na < Na − < Na +
(C) 2 4 3 1
(D) 4 2 3 1 (D) Na > Na + > Na −
_
@edubuzznotes
50 Chapter 2 Periodic Table and Periodic Properties
18. Choose the correct order of ionization energy for the 25. The atomic numbers of two elements A and B
following species. are 17 and 20 respectively. The formula of an ionic
(A) Sc > La > Y compound made by A and B is (where the cation is
(B) Sc > Y ≈ La conventionally written frst)
(A) AB
(C) Sc > Y > La
(B) A 2 B
(D) Sc < Y > La (C) AB2
19. The electronegativities of two elements A and B are (D) BA 2
cA and cB respectively and the relationship between
26. The successive ionization energies (IE) for an
them is given by
element A are as follows
| χ A − χ B | = 0.102 ∆ A − B
A IE
1
→ A + IE
2
→ A 2 + IE
3
→ A 3+ → ...
where ∆ A − B is the resonance energy expressed in
kJ mol−1. If ∆ A − B is zero, then which of the following If the IE1 and IE 3 values are 27 kJ mol−1 and
statements is true? 51 kJ mol−1 respectively, then the value of IE 2 is
(A) χ A > χ B ___________ kJ mol−1.
(A) 21
(B) χ A < χ B
(B) 33
(C) χ A = χ B (C) 59
(D) Cannot be predicted. (D) 63
20. Choose the incorrect order for acidic strength. 27. Consider three hypothetical ionic compounds
(A) CO2 > CO AB, A 2 B and A 2 B3 where in all the compounds B
is in -2 oxidation state and A has a variable oxida•
(B) SO2 < SO3 tion state. What is the correct order of lattice energy
(C) HClO2 > HOCl of these compounds?
(D) SiO2 > CO2 (A) A 2 B > AB > A 2 B3
(B) A 2 B3 > AB > A 2 B
21. Which of the following processes is endothermic?
(C) AB > A 2 B > A 2 B3
(A) S → S −
(B) S − → S 2 − (D) A 2 B3 > A 2 B > AB
(C) Na → Na − 28. Choose the correct order of the property given below:
(D) P → P − (A) N 3 − < O2 − : Ionic radius
(B) N > O: First ionization energy
22. Which of the following processes is exothermic? (C) N > O: Second ionization energy
-
(A) N ® N (D) N > O: Electron affnity order
(B) N ® N+ 29. The ionization energies for B, Tl and In are x, y and z
kcal mol–1 respectively. Choose the correct relation•
(C) N ® N -
ship between them.
(D) N+ ® N 2+ (A) z > x ≈ y
23. Which of the following statements is incorrect? (B) x > y > z
(A) With the decrease in electronegativity in a group (C) x > y> ≈ z
the metallic character increases. (D) x < y > z
(B) Smaller ionization energy value indicates that 30. The smallest size cation and anion that can exist are
electropositive character is more. respectively
(C) Electronegativity does not depend upon Zeffective. (A) H+ and H−
(D) Successive ionization energies always increase (B) H+ and F−
for an element. (C) Li+ and F−
24. Write the period number, group number and block of (D) Li+ and H−
the element having atomic number 42. 31. If the atomic number of an inert gas element is Z,
(A) 5, 5, d then an element with which of the following atomic
(B) 5, 6, d numbers will have the highest electronegativity
(C) 5, 2, d according to Pauling scale?
(D) 5, 15, p
_
@edubuzznotes
Multiple Correct Choice Type Questions 51
8. Which of the following elements have electron affn• (D) Electron present in p orbital is in need of less
ity greater than O? energy for its removal as compared to electron
(A) F (B) S present in d orbital having the same principal
(C) Se (D) Cl quantum number.
9. An element with atomic number 48 (Z = 48) of the 15. Among the elements with the following atomic num•
periodic table will bers, which are d•block elements?
(A) belong to p•block. (A) 29 (B) 81
(B) be placed in group number 12. (C) 46 (D) 58
(C) be called a transition element. 16. In which of the following processes the energy is
(D) have twenty electrons with l = 2. being absorbed?
10. Identify the correct statements among the following. (A) Na(g) → Na-(g)
(A) IEZn (Z = 30) < IEGa (Z = 31). (B) Na+ → Na+(aq)
(B) The Mulliken’s scale of electronegativity = (EA + (C) A+(g) + B-(g) → AB(s)
IE)/2, where EA and IE can be expressed in any (D) N(g) → N+(g)
energy unit.
(C) On Pauling’s scale, electronegativity of F is 17. The formation of the oxide ion O2-(g) requires frst
maximum. an exothermic and then an endothermic step as
(D) cCs < cK (where c is the electronegativity). shown below:
11. In which period or group of periodic table (long O(g) + e − → O− (g); ∆H ° = −142 kJ mol −1
form) transition elements are not present? O− (g) + e − → O2 − (g); ∆H ° = +844 kJ mol −1
(A) Third group (B) Third period
(C) Twelfth group (D) Thirteenth group Which is not the cause of the above fact?
(A) Oxygen is more electronegative.
12. Choose the correct ionization energy order for the
(B) Oxygen has high electron affnity.
given species:
(C) O- ion has comparatively larger size than oxygen
(A) O > S > S − > O−
atom.
(B) F > F − > Cl − > Cl
(D) O- ion will tend to resist the addition of electron.
(C) O > O− > S − > S
(D) F > Cl > Cl − > F − 18. IE1 of an element is lower than that of IE2 because
(A) it is diffcult to remove an electron from cation
13. Which of the following statements are correct?
compared to from the same element.
(A) The electron affnity of Si is greater than that of C.
(B) BeO is amphoteric while B2O3 is acidic. (B) the ionisation process is endothermic.
(C) The ionization energy of Tl is less than that of Al. (C) the size of cation is smaller than its atom.
(D) The ionization energy of elements of Cu•group is (D) all of the above.
less than that of the respective elements of Zn•group. 19. In which of the following statements is the correct
14. Choose the incorrect statements from the following: order with respect to the given property?:
(A) Ionization energy of atom may be negative. (A) Fe3+ (aq) > Fe2+(aq) : Ionic mobility order.
(B) Ionization energy of an ion may be negative. (B) Br– (aq) < Cl – (aq) < F – (aq): Hydrated radius order.
(C) Ionization energy is inversely proportional to (C) SbH3 > AsH3 > PH3 : M – H bond polarity order.
radius. (D) S > C >H > B: Electronegativity order.
16. Which of the following is an incorrect statement? (C) Successive electron affnity of An+ is gradually
(A) The frst ionization energy of A− is equal to the decreasing.
electron affnity of A. (D) None of these is correct.
(B) The second electron affnity is always greater
21. If A has the electronic confguration of 1s22s22p3,
than the frst electron affnity for an element.
then which of the following statement is correct?
(C) The process O → O2 − is endothermic (A) IE1 of A• is negative.
(D) The process Li → Li + is endothermic. (B) IE1 of A is less than that of A−.
(C) IE2 = IE3 for above element.
17. Which of the following reactions would not proceed (D) All of the above statements are correct.
in the forward direction spontaneously?
(A) Xe + He+ → Xe+ + He
(B) Si + Cl + → Si + + Cl
Passage 10: for Questions 22 –24
(C) F − + I → F + I − Ionization energy is always positive for an element and
successive ionization energies always gradually increase.
(D) Be − + B → B− + Be
22. The successive ionization energy for an element is
given below in mJ/mole.
Passage 8: For Questions 18–19 0.7865, 1.5771, 3.2316, 4.3555, 16.091, 19.785,
23.786, 29252
Ionization potential is the minimum amount of energy Predict the number of valence shell electrons in the
needed to remove the outermost electron from the gas•
given element.
eous isolated atom. Its unit is eV atom−1 or kJ mol−1.
Successive ionization energy is the amount of energy (A) 1
needed to remove electron successively from a gase• (B) 2
ous ion, it may be termed as IE2, IE3,…. The difference (C) 3
in the values of IE1, IE2,… helps to determine electronic (D) 4
confguration of the elements. 23. For an element having only one valence shell elec•
tron, which of the following difference will have the
Element IE1 IE2 IE3 (kcal/mol) maximum value.
P 497 947 1500 (A) IE2 – IE1
Q 98 735 1100 (B) IE3 – IE2
R 176 347 1850 (C) IE3 – IE1
(D) cannot be predicted
S 296 530 2050
24. Choose the incorrect ionization energy order
(A) Al > Ga
18. Which of the element (X) can make MX type com• (B) TI > In
pound (where X is the halogen and M is alkali (C) Pb > Sn
metal)? (D) Y < Sc
(A) P (B) Q
(C) R (D) S
Passage 11: For Questions 25–27
19. The order of ionic mobility in aqueous solution of the
following ions will be Given the following information
(A) R (2aq+ ) > S(2aq+ ) A − (g) → A 2 + (g) + 3e − ∆H1 = 1400 kJ mol–1
20. Which of the following statement is correct? (A) +450 (B) +350 (C) +600 (D) +250
(A) In some of the elements IE2 values may be 2+
27. The ∆H hydration of A (g ) in kJ mol–1 is
negative.
(A) +250 (B) – 350 (C) – 250 (D) – 300
(B) IE1 of A3+ = IE2 of A+.
_
@edubuzznotes
Integer Answer Type Qestions 55
8 The frst four successive ionization energies for an 13. The number of pairs, in which electron affnity of the
element are 6.113, 11.871, 50.908 and 67.01 (in eV) second element is more than that of the f irst element
respectively. The number of valence shell electrons is is ___________.
___________ . (F, Cl) (C, N) (O, N) (F, Ne) (B, C), (O, S)
9. The number of species among the following, having 14. The number of species having higher frst ionization
inert gas confguration is ___________ . energy than Ca from the following is ___________.
Ga, Ge, Br, Se, Kr, As, K
K 2 + , Ca 2 + , S − , S 2 − , Br − , Se2 − , H + , H − , Mn 2 +
10. The number of elements among the following atomic
numbers that are p block elements is ___________ .
83, 79, 42, 64, 37, 54, 34
2. Match the properties with the parameters that they are Column I Column II
dependent on. (A) K (P) One electron in the s orbital of
valence shell
Column I Column II
(B) Cu (Q) Transition element
(A) Electron affnity (P) Radius (C) La (R) One unpaired electron
(B) Ionization potential (Q) Zeff (D) Au (S) Member of the 4th period
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (B) 3. (D) 5. (D) 7. (D) 9. (C)
2. (A) 4. (D) 6. (B) 8. (D) 10. (C)
_
@edubuzznotes
Answers 57
11. (C) 17. (A) 23. (C) 29. (B) 35. (D)
12. (C) 18. (C) 24. (B) 30. (B) 36. (B)
13. (D) 19. (C) 25. (D) 31. (B) 37. (C)
14. (C) 20. (D) 26. (B) 32. (A) 38. (A)
15. (C) 21. (B) 27. (B) 33. (C)
16. (B) 22. (A) 28. (B) 34. (C)
3 Ionic
NaCl
Bonding Na3Bi
Na3P
MnO
BeO
MnO2
LiCl
BCl3
Na Sn Si Se l2 Cl2
Contents
nt
M
le
et
va
al
Co
lic
3.1 Attainment of a Stable Configuration
3.2 Types of Bonds The three types of chemical
3.3 Transitions between the Main Types of bonds—ionic, covalent, and
Bonding
3.4 The Covalent Bond metallic—form a 2D plane.
3.5 Valence Bond Theory
3.6 Valence Shell Electron Pair Repulsion (VSEPR) 3.19 Layer Structures (CdI2, CdCI2, [NiAs])
Theory 3.20 Lattice Energy
3.7 The Extent of d Orbital Participation in 3.21 Stoichiometric Defects
Molecular Bonding 3.22 Nonstoichiometric Defects
3.8 Types of Covalent Bonds (Sigma (s) and Pi (p) 3.23 Born–Haber Cycle
Bonds) 3.24 Polarizing Power and Polarizability – Fajans’
3.9 Molecular Orbital Method Rules
3.10 LCAO Method 3.25 Melting Point of Ionic Compounds
3.11 Rules for Linear Combination of Atomic 3.26 Solubility of Ionic Compounds
Orbitals 3.27 Electrical Conductivity and Colour
3.12 Examples of Molecular Orbital Treatment for 3.28 Acidic Nature of Oxides
Homonuclear Diatomic Molecules 3.29 Thermal Stability of Ionic Compounds
3.13 Examples of Molecular Orbital Treatment for 3.30 Weak Forces
Heteronuclear Diatomic Molecules 3.31 Interactions between Ions and Covalent
3.14 Dipole Moment Molecules
3.15 The Ionic Bond 3.32 The Metallic Bond
3.16 Close Packing 3.33 Theories of Bonding in Metals
3.17 Ionic Compounds of the type AX 3.34 Conductors, Insulators and Semiconductors
(ZnS, NaCl, CsCl)
3.18 Ionic Compounds of the Type AX2
(CaF2, TiO2, SiO2)
_
@edubuzznotes
60 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
Electropositive element
+ Ionic bond
Electronegative element
Electronegative element
+ Covalent bond
Electronegative element
Electropositive element
+ Metallic bond
Electropositive element
Ionic bonding involves the complete transfer of one or more electrons from one atom to another. Covalent
bonding involves the sharing of a pair of electrons between two atoms, and in metallic bonding the valency
electrons are free to move throughout the whole crystal.
These types of bonds are idealized or extreme representations, and though one type generally
predominates, in most substances the bond type is somewhere between these extreme forms. For example,
lithium chloride is considered to be an ionic compound, but it is soluble in alcohol, which suggests that
it also possesses a small amount of covalent character. If the three extreme bond types are placed at the
corners of a triangle, then compounds with bonds predominantly of one type will be represented as points
near the corners. Compounds with bonds intermediate between two types will occur along an edge of the
triangle, whilst compounds with bonds showing some characteristics of all three types are shown as points
inside the triangle (Figure 3.1).
_
@edubuzznotes
3.3 Transitions between the Main Types of Bonding 61
Metallic
Li
Ag Na3Bi
Sn Na3Sb
As Na3As
Te Na3P
S Na3N
I2−CIF−OF2−NF3−CCl4−BF3−BeF2−Na2O
Figure 3.1 Triangle illustrating the transitions between ionic, covalent and metallic bonding.
(Reproduced from Chemical Constitution, by J.A.A. Ketelaar, Elsevier.)
Ionic bonds
Ionic bonds are formed when electropositive elements react with electronegative elements. Consider the ionic
compound sodium chloride. A sodium atom has the electronic confguration 1s2 2s2 2p6 3s1. The frst and second
shells of electrons are full, but the third shell contains only one electron. When this atom reacts it will do so in
such a way that it attains a stable electron confguration. The noble gases have a stable electron arrangement
and the nearest noble gas to sodium is neon, whose confguration is 1s2 2s2 2p6. If the sodium atom can lose one
electron from its outer shell, it will attain this confguration and in doing so the sodium acquires a net charge
of +1 and is called a sodium ion Na+. The positive charge arises because the nucleus contains 11 protons, each
with a positive charge, but there are now only 10 electrons. Sodium atoms tend to lose an electron in this way
when they are supplied with energy, and so sodium is an electropositive element:
Na → Na+ + electron
sodium sodium
atom ion
Chlorine atoms have the electronic confguration 1s2 2s2 2p6 3s2 3p5. They are only one electron short of
the stable noble gas confguration of argon 1s2 2s2 2p6 3s2 3p6, and when chlorine atoms react, they gain an
electron. Thus chlorine is an electronegative element.
Cl + electron → Cl −
chlorine chlorine
atom ion
Through gaining an electron, an electrically neutral chlorine atom becomes a chloride ion with a net
charge of –1.
When sodium and chlorine react together, the outer electron of the sodium atoms is transferred to
the chlorine atoms to produce sodium ions Na+ and chloride ions Cl- Electrostatic attraction between the
positive and negative ions holds the ions together in a crystal lattice. The process is energetically favour•
able as both sorts of atoms attain the stable noble gas confguration, and sodium chloride Na+ Cl − is formed
readily. This may be illustrated diagrammatically in a Lewis diagram showing the outer electrons as dots:
.. .. ù
é :Cl
-
Na . + . .. ®
:Cl [Na]+ + êë . .: úû
sodium chlorine sodium chlorine
atom atom ion ion
_
@edubuzznotes
62 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
The formation of calcium chloride CaCl2 may be considered in a similar way. Ca atoms have two electrons
in their outer shell. Ca is an electropositive element, so each Ca atom loses two electrons to two Cl atoms,
forming a calcium ion Ca2+ and two chloride ions Cl −. Showing the outer electrons only, this may be
represented as follows:
.. é . . ù-
:C
. .l: :C l :
ëê . . úû
C a: + ®
.. [Ca]2- +
:C é . . ù-
. .l: :C l :
ëê . . úû
calcium chlorine calcium chloride
atom atoms ion ions
Covalent bonds
When two electronegative atoms react together, both atoms have a tendency to gain electrons, but neither
atom has any tendency to lose electrons. In such cases the atoms share electrons so as to attain a noble gas
confguration.
First consider diagrammatically how two chlorine atoms Cl react to form a chlorine molecule Cl2 (only
the outer electrons are shown in the following diagrams):
.. .. .. ..
:C
.. l : + : C
.. l : ⇒ : . .l: :C. .l:
C
chlorine atoms chlorine molecule
Each chlorine atom gives a share of one of its electrons to the other atom. A pair of electrons is shared
equally between both atoms, and each atom now has eight electrons in its outer shell (a stable octet) – the
noble gas structure of argon. In this electron dot picture (Lewis structure), the shared electron pair is shown
as two dots between the atoms Cl : Cl. In the valence bond representation, these dots are replaced by a line,
which represents a bond Cl—Cl.
In a similar way a molecule of tetrachloromethane CCl4 is made up of one carbon and four chlorine
atoms:
Cl
. .. ..
. C . + 4 é .Cl : ù ® Cl : C : C l
. ëê . . ûú ..
Cl
The carbon atom is four electrons short of the noble gas structure, so it forms four bonds, and the chlorine
atoms are one electron short, so they each form one bond. By sharing electrons in this way, both the carbon
and all four chlorine atoms attain a noble gas structure. It must be emphasized that although it is possible to
build up molecules in this way in order to understand their electronic structures, it does not follow that the
atoms will react together directly. In this case, carbon and chlorine do not react directly, and tetrachloromethane
is made by indirect reactions.
A molecule of ammonia NH3 is made up of one nitrogen and three hydrogen atoms:
..
N . + 3 [ H .] → .. :H
H :N
H
_
@edubuzznotes
3.3 Transitions between the Main Types of Bonding 63
The nitrogen atom is three electrons short of a noble gas structure, and the hydrogen atoms are one
electron short of a noble gas structure. Nitrogen forms three bonds, and the hydrogen atoms one bond
each, so all four atoms attain a stable confguration. One pair of electrons on the N atom is not involved
in bond formation, and this is called a lone pair of electrons.
Other examples of covalent bonds include water (with two covalent bonds and two lone pairs of
electrons), and hydrogen fuoride (one covalent bond and three lone pairs):
.. ..
H :O
..
: H :F
..
:
H
Oxidation numbers
The oxidation number of an element in a covalent compound is calculated by assigning shared electrons
to the more electronegative element, and then counting the theoretical charge left on each atom.
(Electronegativity is described in Chapter 2.) An alternative approach is to break up (theoretically) the
molecule by removing all the atoms as ions, and counting the charge left on the central atom. It must be
emphasized that molecules are not really broken, nor electrons really moved. For example, in H2O, removal
of two H+ leaves a charge of –2 on the oxygen atom, so the oxidation state of Ο in H2O is ( –II). Similarly
in H2S the oxidation state of S is (–II); in F2O the oxidation state of Ο is (+II); in SF4 the oxidation state of
S is (+IV); whilst in SF6 the oxidation state of S is (+VI). The concept of oxidation numbers works equally
well with ionic compounds, and in CrCl3 the Cr atom has an oxidation state of (+III) and it forms Cr3+ ions.
Similarly in CrCl2, Cr has the oxidation state (+II), and exists as Cr2+ ions.
Coordinate bonds
A covalent bond results from the sharing of a pair of electrons between two atoms, where each atom
contributes one electron to the bond. It is also possible to have an electron pair bond where both
electrons originate from one atom and none from the other. Such bonds are called coordinate bonds
or dative bonds. Since, in coordinate bonds, two electrons are shared by two atoms, they differ from
normal covalent bonds only in the way they are formed, and once formed they are identical to normal
covalent bonds.
Even though the ammonia molecule has a stable electron confguration, it can react with a hydrogen
ion H+ by donating a share in the lone pair of electrons, forming the ammonium ion NH +4 :
+ +
H
H H
⋅⋅ ⋅⋅ |
+
H : N : + [ H] → H :N : H or H N → H
⋅⋅ ⋅⋅
H H |
H
Covalent bonds are usually shown as straight lines joining the two atoms, and coordinate bonds as
arrows indicating which atom is donating the electrons. Similarly ammonia may donate its lone pair to
boron trifuoride, and by this means the boron atom attains a share in eight electrons:
H F
H F
•• •• | |
H : N: + B : F → H N → B F
•• ••
| |
H F
H F
In a similar way, a molecule of BF3 can form a coordinate bond by accepting a share in a lone pair from
a F − ion.
_
@edubuzznotes
64 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
F F −
⋅⋅ − ⋅⋅ |
F : +
: ⋅⋅ B : F → F → B F
⋅⋅
F |
F
PCl 5 + Cl − → [PCl 6 ]−
SbF5 + F − → [SbF6 ]−
of electrons. This is called the ‘octet rule’. The octet rule explains the observed valencies in a large
number of cases. There are exceptions to the octet rule; for example, hydrogen is stable with only two
electrons. Other exceptions are discussed later. A chlorine atom has seven electrons in its outer shell,
so by sharing one electron with another chlorine atom both atoms attain an octet and form a chlorine
molecule Cl2.
.. .. .. ..
: Cl . + . Cl : : Cl : Cl
.. :
→
.. .. ..
A carbon atom has four electrons in its outer shell, and by sharing all four electrons and forming four
bonds it attains octet status in CCl4.
Cl
..
. ..
. C . + 4 . Cl
.. : → Cl : C
.. : Cl
. Cl
In a similar way, a nitrogen atom has fve outer electrons, and in NH3 it shares three of these, forming
three bonds and thus attaining an octet. Hydrogen has only one electron, and by sharing it attains a stable
arrangement of two electrons.
.. ..
. N . + 3 [ H .] → H : N : H
. ..
H
In a similar way an atom of oxygen attains an octet by sharing two electrons in H2O and an atom of fuorine
attains an octet by sharing one electron in HF.
.. ..
H :O : H : F:
.. ..
H
Double bonds are explained by sharing four electrons between two atoms, and triple bonds by sharing
six electrons.
⋅ ⋅⋅
⋅ C ⋅ + 2 . O : → : O :: C :: O :
⋅ ⋅ ⋅⋅ ⋅⋅
⋅⋅ ⋅⋅ ⋅⋅
⋅ Be ⋅ + 2 ⋅ F : → : F : Be : F :
⋅⋅ ⋅⋅ ⋅⋅
⋅⋅
: F :
⋅ ⋅⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅⋅ ⋅⋅
⋅ B ⋅ + 3 ⋅ F : → : F : B : F :
⋅⋅ ⋅⋅ ⋅⋅
2. The octet rule is also broken where atoms have an extra energy level which is close in energy to the
p level, and may accept electrons and be used for bonding. PF3 obeys the octet rule, but PF5 does not.
PF5 has ten outer electrons, and uses one 3s, three 3p and one 3d orbitals. Any compound with more
than four covalent bonds must break the octet rule, and these violations become increasingly common
in elements after the frst two periods of eight elements in the periodic table.
3. The octet rule does not work in molecules which have an odd number of electrons, such as NO and
ClO2, nor does it explain why O2 is paramagnetic and has two unpaired electrons.
_
@edubuzznotes
66 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
Despite these exceptions, the octet rule is surprisingly reliable and did a great deal to explain the number
of bonds formed in simple cases. However, it gives no indication of the shape adopted by the molecule.
Sidgwick–Powell theory
In 1940 Sidgwick and Powell reviewed the structures of molecules then known. They suggested that for
molecules and ions that contain only single bonds, the approximate shape can be predicted from the number
of electron pairs in the outer or valence shell of the central atom (Table 3.1). The outer shell contains one
or more bond pairs of electrons, but it may also contain unshared pairs of electrons (lone pairs). Bond pairs
and lone pairs were taken as equivalent, since all electron pairs take up some space, and they repel each
other. Repulsion is minimized if the electron pairs are orientated in space as far apart as possible. Based on
this theory, the following molecular shapes were suggested depending on number of electron/lone pairs in
the valence shell.
1. If there are two pairs of electrons in the valence shell of the central atom, the orbitals containing them
will be oriented at 180° to each other. It follows that if these orbitals overlap with orbitals from other
atoms to form bonds, then the molecule formed will be linear.
2. If there are three electron pairs on the central atom, they will be at 120° to each other, giving a plane
triangular structure.
3. For four electron pairs the angle is 109°28′, and the shape is tetrahedral.
4. For fve pairs, the shape is a trigonal bipyramid.
5. For six pairs the angles are 90° and the shape is octahedral.
4 tetrahedron 109°28′
6 octahedron 90°
2s 2p 2s 2p
Be Be∗
B B∗
C C∗
Hence Be, B, C can show covalency of 2, 3 and 4 respectively. Apart from this, the existence of PF5, SF6,
IF7, XeF2, XeF4, XeF6 can also be well explained by this theory.
If purely atomic orbitals were involved in bonding, then in the formation of methane molecule the three
C–H bonds will be formed by the p–s overlap and the fourth C–H bond will be formed by the s–s overlap.
Since the s–s overlap may take place from any direction, there is no certainty of the location of the fourth
H atom. Hence, the following two observations are expected
angles are not certain.
1. All HCH
2. Three C–H bonds formed by the p–s overlap are stronger than the one C–H bond formed by the s–s
overlap (see Section 3.8).
But in reality, this is not observed, instead we observe that
bond angles are identical with a value of 109°28′.
1. All HCH
2. All C–H bond lengths and strengths are identical.
So to explain the above observations, the theory of hybridization was introduced. Hybridization can be
defned as the mixing of pure atomic orbitals of comparable energy.
sp : s + any p orbital.
sp
sp2 : s + any two p orbitals.
sp3 : s + px + py + pz
sp3d: s + px + py + pz + dz2 [Trigonal bipyramid geometry] %p sp2 %s↑
sp3d : s + px + py + pz + dx2 − y2 [Square pyramidal geometry]
dsp2: (n – 1) dx2 − y2 + ns + npx + npy
sp3d2 : ns + npx + npy + npz + ndx2 − y2 + ndz2 sp3
d2sp3 : (n − 1) dx2 − y2 + (n − 1) dz2 + ns + npx + npy + npz
sp3d3: ns + npx + npy + ndx2 − y2 + ndxy + npz + ndz2 Figure 3.3 Shape of hybrid orbitals
3
d s : (n − 1) dxy + (n − 1) dxz + (n − 1) dyz + ns [Tetrahedral with increasing p character.
geometry]
Table 3.3 Relation between steric number, hybridization and geometry of molecules
Steric number Hybridization Orientation of the hybrid orbital in space or Angles between hybrid
electronic geometry around the central atom orbitals
2 sp Linear 180°
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
3.6 Valence Shell Electron Pair Repulsion (VSEPR) Theory 69
a
3 2
6 sp d Octahedral (Oh) Between two
adjacent orbitals : 90°
Between two
opposite orbitals : 180°
2. If the lone pair(s) is (are) present, the bond angles get distorted and the shape of the molecule can be
visualized from the three•dimensional fgure obtained after placing the bond pairs and lone pair(s) in
a manner such that the repulsion between them is minimised. (The location of the lone pair will not be
considered in the shape determination because electrons are not visible.)
Shapes of the species undergoing different hybridizations:
1. For sp hybridization
The steric number is 2.
R
The possible values of Q + are
2
2 + 0 Þ Linear geometry, e.g. BeH2, BeCl2, BH 2+ , NO2+ .
or 1 + 1 Þ Linear geometry, e.g. CO.
2. For sp2 hybridization
The steric number is 3.
R
The possible values of Q + are
2
3 + 0 Þ Trigonal planar geometry, e.g. BX3, AlCl3, AlBr3, CH 3+ , CO32 − , NO3− , etc.
or 2 + 1 Þ Bent / V•shaped / Angular geometry, e.g. NO2− , SnCl 2 , SO2 , etc.
3
3. For sp hybridization
The steric number is 4.
R
The possible values of Q + are
2
4 + 0 Þ Tetrahedral geometry, e.g. BH 4− , NF4+ , NH +4 , SiF4 , PH +4 , etc.
or 3 + 1 Þ Pyramidal geometry, e.g. NH3, SnCl 3− , SO23 − , SeO23 − , etc.
or 2 + 2 Þ Angular / V•shaped / Bent geometry, e.g. H2O, Cl2O, NH 2− , etc.
Note: More the number of lone pairs, lesser will be the bond angle. Hence the bond angles of CH4,
NH3 and H2O are 109°28′, 107 and 104°5′ respectively.
4. For sp3d hybridization
The steric number is 5.
R
The possible values of Q + are
2
5 + 0 Þ TBP geometry, e.g. PCl5, PF5, SbF5, PCl2F3, PCl3F2, XeO3F2, etc.
or 4 + 1 Þ See•saw geometry, e.g. SF4, SF2Cl2, XeO2F2.
or 3 + 2 Þ T• shaped geometry, e.g. ClF3, XeF3+, BrF3, XeOF2, etc.
or 2 + 3 Þ Linear geometry, e.g. XeF2, ICl 2− ,[I(CN)2 ]− , etc.
The relative location of the bond pair and the lone pair is decided by Bent’s rule, which states that
the more electronegative atom prefers to stay in the orbital having less s character, while the lone pair
prefers to stay in the orbital having more s character. Alternatively, it may be stated as follows. For
TBP geometry, the more electronegative atom prefers to stay in the axial position, while the lone pair
prefers to stay in the equatorial position.
The above statement is explained through the following concepts:
a. It is suggested that sp3d = sp2 + pd, i.e. all fve hybrid orbitals in sp3d hybridization are not equal,
and the concept of unequal hybridization (kind of failure of hybridization theory) starts here. So
the equatorial set of orbitals is made of sp2 hybrid orbitals, while the axial set is made of pd hybrid
orbitals. It is also supported by the fact that in PCl5, dP – Cl(a) is greater than dP – Cl (e).
b. The order of energy required to remove an electron from a particular orbital having the same
principal quantum number is s > p > d > f . This follows the order of proximity of orbitals to the
nucleus.We know that the more electronegative atom attracts the bond pair towards itself, and this
_
@edubuzznotes
3.6 Valence Shell Electron Pair Repulsion (VSEPR) Theory 71
kind of withdrawing of electrons will be easiest when the attached orbital of it from the central
atom consists of minimum or nil s character. Hence, the more electronegative atom prefers the
orbitals having less s character or axial position in the TBP geometry.
Again, the bond pair is attracted by two atoms, while the lone pair is attracted by only one atom.
Hence, the lone pair will try to come closer to the nucleus and only the s orbital can do so easily. Hence,
the lone pair prefers the orbital having more s character or the equatorial position in TBP geometry.
Based on the above explanation, the structures of some molecules with sp3d hybridization are shown
in Figure 3.4.
Note: The effect of the lone pair on bond angles makes them bent, see–saw and T–shaped.
F F CF3
Cl Cl H3C
P Cl P P CF3
F
Cl Cl
CH3
F F CF3
PCl3F2 PCl2F3 P(CF3)3(CH3)2
179°
F F F F F
F Cl Cl 87.5°
103° S S S Cl F +Xe F
F Cl F
F F F F F
SF4 SF2Cl2 SF3Cl ClF3 XeF3+
F F Cl C
O
Xe Xe I− I
O F F Cl C
XeO2F2 XeF2 [ICl2]− [I(CN)2]−
N
F F O
.9°
91° F
81
F F F F F F F Cl Cl
I Xe+ Xe Xe I−
F F F F F F F F Cl Cl
In case of IF5 and [XeF5]+, distortion is observed in the shape because the lone pair–bond pair repulsion is
greater than the bond pair–bond pair repulsion. But in case of XeOF4, the lone pair–bond pair repulsion
is almost equal to the double bond–single bond pair repulsion. Hence, the distortion is very less and the
double bond repels slightly more here as compared to the lone pair, and the OXeF angle is 91°.
_
@edubuzznotes
72 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
Table 3.4 Axial and equatorial radii for compounds with sp3d hybridization
Compound re (pm) ra (pm)
PF5 153.4 157.7
PCl5 202 214
SbCl5 231 243
SF4 154 164
ClF3 159.8 169.8
BrF3 172.1 181.0
However, this generalization does not hold true when the atoms surrounding the central atom are
different. For example, the bond lengths observed in PCl3F2 and PCl2F3 are as follows:
It can be concluded that in such cases the orbital length (axial) is always greater than orbital length
(equatorial) but not the bond length.
Similarly for PBP geometry, one axial orbital is having fve neighbouring orbitals and all are at 90°,
while one equatorial orbital is having four neighbouring orbitals, out of which two are at 90° and other
two are at 72°. Hence the axial orbital occupies more space as compared to the equatorial orbital
and the axial orbital has more s character. Thus the two lone pairs in PBP geometry occupy the axial
position and this clearly explains the structure of [XeF5]−.
F
F
F
Xe
F F
F
(c) (a) (b)
Again according to this theory, the position of the lone pair in XeF6 molecule should be in axial
position and the shape should be pentagonal pyramidal. But this is not observed and the actual shape
of molecule is octahedral. This implies that the lone pair is placed at the equatorial position, and this
explains the structure of XeF6 shown in Figures 3.7 a, b and c.
According to Figure 3.7 mexpected for XeF6 is not equal to zero. But mreal (XeF6) ~ zero. To explain
the above facts, it is considered that the actual molecule is in dynamic equilibrium of all the three
structures shown in Figure 3.7. Here it is considered that the lone pair is present in the
−
stereochemically
−
active s orbital and similar structure is observed in IF6−. But anions like [SbX6]3 , [TeX6]2 (X = Cl,
Br, I), [BrF6]−, [ICl6]− have been assigned perfectly octahedral structure on the basis of X•ray crystal•
lography and the lone pair is present in stereochemically inactive s orbital.
It is a common misconception that hybridization is the cause of a particular molecular shape. This is
not so. The reason why any particular shape is adopted is its energy. It is also important to remember that
the hybridized state is a theoretical step in going from an atom to a molecule, and the hybridized state
never actually exists. It cannot be detected even spectroscopically, so the energy of hybrid orbitals cannot
be measured and can only be estimated theoretically.
O O O
2−
S
S
−O
O− Resonance hybrid
O O
Resonating O
structure
(d)
Figure 3.8 Bond angles in the presence of double bond: (a) trigonal geometry and (b) & (c) tetrahedral
geometry.
O O − O l1 l1 O
O O
S S S l
2
H H H O H
O O O H O l2 O H
+
The double bond – double bond repulsion is more as compared to double bond – single bond and single bond–
angles are not identical, also there are two kinds of S–O bond lengths.
single bond repulsion. Hence OSO
Note: Similar explanation is also applicable for HCO2– and HCO2H, NO3– and HNO3, NO2– and HNO2, PO43–
and H3PO4, etc.
Effect of electronegativity
The effect of electronegativity can be explained by considering the following cases.
_
@edubuzznotes
74 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
1. When the central atom having lone pair is the same with different surrounding atoms.
NF3 and NH3 both have structures based on a tetrahedron with one corner occupied by a lone pair. The high
electronegativity of F pulls the bonding electrons further away from N than in NH3. Thus repulsion between
bond pairs is less in NF3 than in NH3. Hence the lone pair in NF3 causes a greater distortion from tetrahe•
dral than NH3. The same effect is found in H2O and F2O.
The following examples highlight the signifcance of ‘having lone pair’ on the central atom. In absence of
lone pair, the effect of electronegativity is not observed.
CH4 and CF4 SiH4 and SiF4 BH4− and BF4−
109°28′ and 109° 28′ 109° 28′ and 109°28′ 109° 28′ and 109° 28′.
In the following case bond angles are distorted but, the decrease in bond angle is due to decrease in steric
crowding.
H C
a. Application on the bond angle: The different bond angles in CHF3 C Cl and Cl
and CH2F2 can be explained on the basis of (Figure 3.10a). Cl 111°3′ Cl
Cl
But it is not applicable for CHCl3 and CH2Cl2 where the cor• 111°8′
responding bond angles increase due to larger size of Cl atoms Figure 3.10: The increase in
(Figure 3.10b). electronegativity of surrounding
b. Application on bond length: With increase in p character in an atoms affects the bond angle.
orbital, bond length will increase while with increase in s character
in an orbital, bond length will decrease. For example, dC–Cl in CH3Cl (1.78Å) > dC–Cl in CF3Cl (1.75 Å).
Similarly,
dN – N in N2H4 > dN – N in N2F4
dC – C in C2H6 > dC – C in C2F6
dO – O in O2H2 > dO – O in O2F2
2. When the surrounding atom is the same with different central atom having lone pair.
The effect of electronegativity as postulated in VSEPR theory explains the order of the angle for the above
molecules but cannot rationalize very small angles (~90°) in PH3, AsH3…, H2S, H2Se… etc. with respect to
NH3 and H2O respectively.
To explain this, Drago suggested an empirical rule which is compatible with the energetics of
hybridization. It states that if the central atom is in the third row or below in the periodic table, the lone
_
@edubuzznotes
3.6 Valence Shell Electron Pair Repulsion (VSEPR) Theory 75
pair will occupy a stereochemically inactive s orbital, and the bonding will be through p orbitals, and bond
angles will be nearly 90° if the electronegativity of the surrounding atom is £ 2.5.
The above rule is based upon the relation between hybridization and bond angle for two or more
equivalent s–p hybrid orbitals, where the fraction of s character (S) or fraction of p character (P) is given
by the relationship:
S P −1
cos q = = (for 90° < q < 180°)
S −1 P
For example, for AsH , H As H angle is 91.8°, and from calculation it can be shown that each As–H bond
3
consists of almost 97% p character and 3% s character. Hence, it can be concluded that there is no hybrid•
ization or the extent of hybridization is very less for PH3, AsH3, SbH3, H2S, H2Se and H2Te molecules.
The cause for no hybridization in these molecules can be explained as follows. In case of P, the energy
required for hybridization is about 600 kJ mol–1 which is not compensated by the energy released from the
bond formation using hybrid orbitals. From the energy point of view alone, the most stable arrangement
would be utilizing pure p orbitals in bonding with the lone pair ‘sinking’ into a pure s orbital.
Based upon the above discussion, we can explain the following facts.
a. PH3 has much lower solubility in water as compared to that of NH3.
b. The formation of PH4+ is diffcult as compared to that of NH4+ which is supported by the fact that
NH 3 + H 2 O ⇌ NH 4 + + OH −
whereas,
→ PH 4+ + OH −
PH 3 + H 2 O ×
The reason for the above observation is that the amount of [H+] is quantitatively less to protonate the lone
pair that resides at almost pure s orbital in case of PH3. When [H+] increases in the presence of strong acids
like HX (X = Cl, Br and I), PH4+ is formed more readily.
PH 3 + HX ® PH 4+ + X-
3. The complexing ability of NH3 is much higher as compared to that of PH3.
These three observations can be explained on the basis that the lone pair donating ability for P in case of
PH3 is much less because the lone pair resides at almost pure s orbital. In case of NH3, the lone pair is pres•
ent in one sp3 hybrid orbital and can be donated easily.
Back bonding
The phenomenon of back bonding involves transfer of lone pair from flled shell of an atom to the unflled
shell of the adjacent bonded atom.
It is a kind of coordinate p bonding which may be partial or full, depending on the relative donating
and accepting ability of the donor and accepter atoms. In general, the donor atoms are the second period
elements carrying lone pairs, such as F, O, N, C; sometimes Cl, Br, I, P, S can also act as donor atoms depend•
ing on circumstance.
1. Back bonding with F as donor atom
a. Considering the electronegativity of the surrounding atoms, the expected bond angle order for PH3
and PF3 is PH3 > PF3. But in reality, it is PH3 < PF3. This is due to back bonding in PF3 which is shown
in Figure 3.11.
− − − −
P P P P
F F F F+
+F F
F +F F F F
F
Resonance hybrid
Figure 3.11 Back bonding in PF3
Hence, due to back bonding the partial double bond character develops in a bond causing a decrease
in the bond length; the bond angle may or may not increase, but it never decreases.
Hence, the following bond angles observed are well explained.
b. In case of BF3, the extent of back bonding is more than that observed in PF3 F
δ+
because of the 2 pπ − 2 pπ overlap in case of BF3, while that in P–F bond is
3dπ − 2 pπ . However, there is no change in the bond angle due to absence of the 120° 120°
lone pair on the central atom. B−
δ+ δ+
Hence, it is also clear that dB – F in BF3 is less than that in BF4– because back bonding F F
– 3
is not possible in BF4 due the non•availability of vacant orbital in B atom under sp 120°
hybridization.
2. Back bonding with O as donor atom
a. The expected bond angle order for H2O, Cl2O and +
+ O
+
O δ−
F2O is H2O > Cl2O > F2O based on the electro• O Cl − δ− Cl
−Cl Cl
negativities of the surrounding atoms. But in real• Cl
Cl 110°8°
ity, the order is Cl2O (110°8′) > H2O (104°5′) > F2O Resonance
hybrid
(103°2′). This is also explained on the basis of back
bonding in Cl2O (Figure 3.12), which is not pos• Figure 3.12 Back bonding in Cl2O
sible in H2O and F2O.
For the analogous compound SCl2, the bond angle is 102° since the lone pair of S or Cl atoms need not
be delocalised due to the availability of vacant d orbitals of their own.
b. The dB–O in B(OH)3 < dB–O in [B(OH)4]–. This is because back bonding is possible in case of B(OH)3
from O atom to vacant p orbital of B atom, which is not available in case of [B(OH)4]– and hence no
back bonding is possible.
c. (CH3)2O forms a complex with BF3 easily, while (SiH3)2O O O
cannot do so because the availability of the lone pair on O atom H3C 110° CH3 H 3Si 144° SiH3
decreases due to back bonding from O atom to vacant 3d orbital (a)
of Si atom. C atom has no such vacant orbital for back bonding. Ο Ο
and
In case of (CH3)2O, the positive deviation of the bond angle Cl 110°8′ Cl H3Si 144° SiH3
(b)
with respect to hybridization can be explained on the basis of
steric crowding of two methyl groups. In case of (SiH3)2O, the Figure 3.13 Bond angle devia-
huge bond angle increase is mainly due to back bonding and tion in (a) (CH ) O and (SiH ) O.
3 2 3 2
partly due to steric repulsion (Figure 3.13a). (b) Cl2O and (SiH3)2O.
If we consider the bond angles of Cl2O and (SiH3)2O, in both
the cases 3dp-2pp type of back bonding takes place but the huge angle change in case of (SiH3)2O is due to
the much higher extent of back bonding as compared to Cl2O. This is because of the presence of three lone
pairs on each Cl atom which retard the fow of electrons
from O atom. This phenomenon is not observed in case of O− O−
(SiH3)2O due to absence of lone pairs. (Figure 3.13b). B B
−
d. The boroxine (B3O6) ring is planar due to back bonding O O O+ +O
and it is aromatic in nature (Figure 3.14). Here the back
bond is considered as a full coordinate p bond in a par• B B B
−
−B O−
+
ticular resonating structure according to the bond order O O O −
O− O
−
observed. Similarly B3N3H6 is also planar and aromatic -
due to back bonding. Figure 3.14 Structure of [B3O6]3 ion.
+
e. In C ≡ O molecule also, the coordinate p bond may be considered as back bond from O atom to C
atom. The structure before back bonding may be written as : C = O: ɺɺ In this arrangement the lone pair
from O atom is donated to the vacant orbital of electron ɺɺ
F C O CF3
defcient C atom. 3
Al Al
f. In (F3C)2 Al – O – Al(CF3)2, the AlOAl angle is almost 180° CF3
CF3
(i.e. 178°) so the Al – O – Al skeleton is almost linear, and oxygen 178°
atom may be considered as sp hybridized (Figure 3.15).
Here the extent of back bonding is enhanced by the Figure 3.15 Structure of
inductive effect of strongly electronegative CF3 group which (F 3C)2 Al – O – Al(CF3)2.
increases the electron defciency of Al atom that is already electron defcient due to incomplete octet.
Another example of the compound where the O atom is sp hybridized is Ph3Si–O–SiPh3 in which
angle is 180°.
the SiOSi
_
@edubuzznotes
3.6 Valence Shell Electron Pair Repulsion (VSEPR) Theory 77
g. R3Si – O – H is more acidic than R3C – O – H. This is also due to back bonding from O atom to Si
atom which increases the polarity of O – H bond and stabilizes the conjugate base R 3 Si − O.
−
R3Si Ο Η or R3Si Ο
(3d) (2p) (3d) (2p)
> COH
This also explains the bond angle order of SiOH in the above compounds.
h. R3NO has a higher dipole moment as compared to R3PO due to back bonding from O atom to
P atom though the electronegativity difference between P and O is much larger as compared to that
between N and O.
+ + .. ..
R3 N ¾ O ; R3 P ¾ O : « ¾¾
R3P ¬ ¾
®O:
¾
.. ..
Here the contribution of structure (I) is very less. The hybrid structure is contributed largely by struc•
tures (II) and (III). Hence the bond angle is in between 109° 28′ and 120°, i.e. 112°.
e. The bond length order of the B–N bond in the following compounds is
and the order of energy required for the rotation of the B – N bond is just reverse, i.e.
Here back bonding from N to B is most restricted in case of B(NR2)3 due to steric crowding and most
relaxed in case of H2B – NR2. Hence, the above orders are well explained.
4. Back bonding with C as donor atom
a. CHCl3 is more acidic than CHF3 which is explained as follows:
−
CHCl 3 ⇌ H + + C Cl 3
−
CHF3 ⇌ H + + C F3
C C
Cl Cl F
F
Cl F
The lone pair on C atom gets delocalized through 2pp – 3dp bonding in Cl 3C − , which is not possible in
case of F3 C − .
− −
b. R 3C is pyramidal while (CN )3C is planar due to the back bonding from the lone pair of C atom into
the p * orbital of the C ≡ N group.
5. Back bonding with halogens (Cl, Br, I) as donor atom
a. The Lewis acidity order of BX3 molecules is explained in terms of back donation from X atom
(X = F, Cl, Br, I) to B atom. The back donation ability order for halogens towards B atom is
F >> Cl > Br > I. This is because
(i) the size increases and mismatch of the over•
lapping orbital increases down the group, i.e. Cl
from F (2pp – 2pp) to I (2pp – 5pp).
O S B
(ii) F atom is a good donor due to its flled shell,
Cl 110°8′ Cl Cl 102° Cl Cl Cl
while in general Cl, Br, I do not like to act as
donor atoms; only act as donor atom when 2pp – 3dp No such 2pp – 3pp
the adjacent atom is electrons defcient due 'back bonding'
to incomplete octet like B atom as shown in
Figure 3.18 Effect of back bonding of halogen
Figure 3.18.
on Lewis acidity.
Finally the Lewis acidity order is:
BF3 < BCl 3 < BBr3 < BI 3 .
b. The relative stability order for the diradicals is
: CH 2 < : CCl 2 < : CF2
_
@edubuzznotes
3.7 The Extent of d Orbital Participation in Molecular Bonding 79
Phosphorus atom –
excited state
Phosphorus having gained five
electrons from chlorine atoms
in PCl5 molecule
sp3d hybridization, trigonal bipyramid
However, d orbitals are in general too large and too high in energy to mix completely with s and
p orbitals. The difference in size is illustrated by the mean values for the radial distance for different
phosphorus orbitals: 3s = 0.47 Å, 3p = 0.55 Å and 3d = 2.4 Å. The energy of an orbital is proportional
to its mean radial distance, and since the 3d orbital is much larger it is much higher in energy than the
3s and 3p orbitals. It would at frst seem unlikely that hybridization involving s, p and d orbitals could
possibly occur.
Several factors affect the size of orbitals. The most important is the charge on the atom. If the atom
carries a formal positive charge then all the electrons will be pulled in towards the nucleus. The effect is
greatest for the outer electrons. If the central Ρ atom is bonded to a highly electronegative element such as
F, Ο or Cl, then the electronegative element attracts more than its share of the bonding electrons and the
F or Cl atom attains a d– charge. This leaves a d+ charge on Ρ, which makes the orbitals contract. Since the
3d orbital contracts in size very much more than the 3s and 3p orbitals, the energies of the 3s, 3p and 3d
orbitals may become close enough to allow hybridization to occur in PCl5. Hydrogen does not cause this
large contraction, so PH5 does not exist.
In a similar way the structure of SF6 can be described by mixing the 3s, three 3p and two 3d orbitals,
that is sp3d2 hybridization.
3s 3p 3d
Electronic structure of full
sulphur atom – ground inner
state shell
Electronic structure of
sulphur atom – excited
state
The presence of six highly electronegative F atoms causes a large contraction of the d orbitals, and lowers
their energy, so mixing may be possible.
_
@edubuzznotes
80 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
A second factor affecting the size of d orbitals is the number of d orbitals occupied by electrons. If only
one 3d orbital is occupied on an S atom, the average radial distance is 2.46 Å, but when two 3d orbitals are
occupied the distance drops to 1.60 Å. The effect of changing the charge can be seen in Table 3.5.
3s 3p 3d
A further small contraction of d orbitals may arise by coupling of the spins of electrons occupying different
orbitals.
It seems probable that d orbitals do participate in bonding in cases where d orbital contraction
occurs.
(c)
(a) (b)
Figure 3.20 Different types of overlaps in s bond: (a) s – s overlap; (b) s – p overlap;
and (c) p – p overlap
s–s<s–p <p–p
The order of bond strength can be explained on the basis of the fact
that more the area of overlap, higher will be the strength. Since the
p orbital has directional property, p – p overlap provides more area
for overlap for the same internuculear distance which is explained
in Figure 3.21.
2. p bond: It is formed by sideways overlap of orbitals and it merely
shortens the bond length.
Different types of overlap for p bonds (Figure 3.22): Figure 3.21 Area of overlap in
p – p overlap.
_
@edubuzznotes
3.8 Types of Covalent Bonds (Sigma (s) and Pi (p) Bonds) 81
pp – pp : or or
(a)
pp – dp
(or) dp – pp
(b)
dp – dp (4 lobes interaction):
it is also called as d bonds 2pp – 3dp
(c)
The relative strength of the p bonds increases when the intermolecular distance decreases and the order is:
2pp - 2pp > 2pp - 3dp >2pp - 3pp >3pp - 3pp
Due to the inclined nature of the d orbital, it is more close in case of 2pp – 3dp overlap and strength of bond
is more as compared to 2pp - 3pp as shown in Figure 3.23.
The shape of the molecule is determined by the s bonds (and lone pairs) but not by the p bonds.
Consider the structure of the carbon dioxide molecule. Since C has typically four valency and Ο has
typically two valency, the bonding can be simply represented as
O=C=O
Triatomic molecules must be either linear or angular. In CO2, the C atom must be excited to provide four
unpaired electrons to form the four bonds required.
Electronic structure of 1s 2s 2p
carbon atom – ground
state
Electronic structure of
carbon atom – excited
state
with p orbitals on the O atoms at either side (Figure 3.24b). This p overlap shortens the C—O distances, but
does not affect the shape.
The sulphur dioxide molecule SO2 may be considered in a similar way. S shows oxidation states of
(+II), (+IV) and (+VI), whilst O has two valency. The structure may be represented as
O=S=O
Triatomic molecules are either linear or bent. The S atom must be excited to provide four unpaired electrons.
The two electron pairs which form the p bonds do not affect the shape of the molecule. The remaining three
orbitals point to the corners of a triangle, and result in a planar triangular structure for the molecule with
two corners occupied by O atoms and one corner occupied by a lone pair. The SO2 molecule is thus angular
or V–shaped (Figure 3.25).
3s 3p 3d
Electronic structure of
sulphur atom – excited
state O
3s 3p 3d
Sulphur atom having gained
four electrons from bonds
to oxygen atoms in SO2 molecule S
two s bonds two p bonds
and one lone pair O
S
O O
The central S atom must be excited to provide six unpaired electrons to form six bonds.
3s 3p 3d
Electronic structure of
sulphur atom – excited
state
The three p bonds are ignored in determining the shape of the molecule. The three s orbitals are directed
towards the corners of an equilateral triangle, and the SO3 molecule is a completely regular plane triangle
(Figure 3.26). The p bonds shorten the bond lengths, but do not affect the shape. This approach explains the
s bonding and shape of the molecule, but the explanation of p bonding is unsatisfactory. It presumes that:
_
@edubuzznotes
3.8 Types of Covalent Bonds (Sigma (s) and Pi (p) Bonds) 83
2 BH 3 ⇌ B2 H 6
The driving force for this kind of dimerization is to
achieve momentarily octet for B atoms in B2H6. The
B2H6 can be considered a hybrid structure of the H H H H H H
B
following resonating structures (I) and (II), where B B B
−
the B atom in [ BH 4 ] unit has a complete octet, H H H H
+ H H
while the B atom in [ BH 2 ] has an incomplete
octet. Figure 3.27 Dimerization of BH3 molecules.
+ − − +
[BH
2 ] [ BH 4 ] ↔ [ BH 4 ] [ BH 2 ]
I II
Hence the momentarily octet is achieved and B2H6 molecule is still electron defcient. This is further sup•
ported by the experimental fact that B2H6 readily reacts with tetrahydrofuran (THF) as shown below.
H
H H
B−
B2H6 + 2 2
O O+
THF
For the above reaction, the driving force is to complete the octet of B atom permanently.
a. Hybridization of the B atoms in B2H6: Observing the tetrahedral arrangement of four H atoms
around the B atom, it is concluded that the hybridization of both B atoms is sp3 and overall the
molecule is non•planar.
H H
H
B B
H
H H
sp3 sp3
The electronic distribution of the bridge bond (B – H – B) has a banana•like appearance and is also
called banana bond. This bridge bond is also called three centre–two electron (3c–2e) bond because
only two electrons are responsible for attracting three positive centres or nucleus.
b. Bond lengths and bond strength in B2H6:
(i) dB − H (terminal bonds) < dB − H (bridge bonds)
(ii) The energy required to replace H atoms from the bridged position is more than that needed
for the terminal position. This is supported by the fact that on reaction with methyl chloride,
terminal hydrogen atoms are replaced by methyl group in preference to bridged hydrogen
atoms.
Me Me
H
B2H6 + 4 MeCl B B
H
Me Me
_
@edubuzznotes
84 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
The reason for this could be to the fact that to break the H
bridge bond, the overlapping zone should be broken H H
from both sides and the overall energy required is more B B
as compared to do so for terminal bonds (Figure 3.28). H H H
This kind of overlap is s type and considered as
sp3 – s – sp3 overlap. Figure 3.28 Terminal and bridge-bond
2. Bridge bonding in BeH2 and BeCl2: The structures of cleavage in B2H6.
BeH2 , Be2H4 and (BeH2)n can be explained in the light
of bridge bonding as shown in Figure 3.29.
H
H H
Be2H4 : Be H Be Be H
BeH2 : H Be H Be H
H H
sp sp2 sp2
Linear Planar
(BeH2)n : H H H H H H H H H
Polymeric Be Be Be Be Be Be Be Be
solid H H H H H
H H
H sp3 sp3 sp3 sp3 H
Non-planar
2ICl 3 ⇌ I 2 Cl 6
3 2
In I 2 Cl 6 both I atoms are sp d hybridized and overall molecule is planar to minimize the repulsion
between the lone pairs of I atoms (Figure 3.32).
Cl Cl
Cl Cl Cl Cl
I
I I I
Cl
Cl Cl Cl Cl Cl
The nature and planarity of bonds in some molecules that show bridge bonding is given in Table 3.6.
Table 3.6 Molecules which show bridge-bonding
Molecules Nature of bonds (3c – 2e / 3c – 4e ) Planar (P) and Non-planar (NP)
Al 2Cl 6 3c – 4e NP
Al 2 Br6 3c – 4e NP
(AlH 3 )n 3c – 2e NP
Al 2 I 6 3c – 4e NP
Al 2 (CH 3 )6 3c – 2e NP
I 2Cl 6 3c – 4e P
Note: The bridge bonding between two different atoms is also possible which is found in Al(BH4)3
and Be(BH4)2. (See Chapter 10, page 368 for further discussion.)
where N is a normalizing constant chosen to ensure that the probability of fnding an electron in the whole
of the space is unity, and c1 and c2 are constants chosen to give a minimum energy for y(AB). If atoms
A and B are similar, then c1 and c2 will have similar values. If atoms A and B are the same, then c1 and c2
are equal.
The probability of fnding an electron in a volume of space dv is y 2dn, so the probability density for the
combination of two atoms as above is related to the wave function squared:
2
ψ (AB) 2
= (c12 ψ (A) 2
+ 2c1c2 ψ (A) ψ (B) + c22 ψ (B) )
If we examine the three terms on the right of the equation, the frst term c 21 ψ (2A ) is related to the probability
of fnding an electron on atom A if A is an isolated atom. The third term c22 ψ (2B) is related to the probability
_
@edubuzznotes
86 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
of fnding an electron on atom B if B is an isolated atom. The middle term becomes increasingly important
as the overlap between the two atomic orbitals increases, and this term is called the overlap integral. This
term represents the main difference between the electron clouds in individual atoms and in the molecule.
The larger this term the stronger the bond.
The latter equation should be regarded as the summation of the wave functions and not as the mathematical
difference between them.
When a pair of atomic orbitals y(A) and y(B) combine, they give rise to a pair of molecular orbitals y(g)
and y(u). The number of molecular orbitals produced must always be equal to the number of atomic orbitals
involved. The function y(g) leads to increased electron density in between the nuclei, and is therefore a
bonding molecular orbital. It is lower in energy than the original atomic orbitals. Conversely y(u) results in
two lobes of opposite sign cancelling and hence giving zero electron density in between the nuclei. This is
an antibonding molecular orbital which is higher in energy (Figure 3.34).
+ + + Bonding orbital
s(g)
s s
Ψ(g)
s s Ψ(u)
The molecular orbital wave functions are designated y(g) and y(u); g stands for gerade (even) and u
for ungerade (odd), g and u refer to the symmetry of the orbital about its centre. If the sign of the wave
function is unchanged when the orbital is refected about its centre (i.e. x, y and z are replaced by –x,
–y and –z) the orbital is gerade. An alternative method for determining the symmetry of the molecular
orbital is to rotate the orbital about the line joining the two nuclei and then about a line perpendicular
to this. If the sign of the lobes remains the same, the orbital is gerade, and if the sign changes, the orbital
is ungerade.
_
@edubuzznotes
3.10 LCAO Method 87
Energy
The energy of the bonding molecular orbital is lower than 0
Ψ(g)
that of the atomic orbital by an amount Δ. This is known as the
stabilization energy.
Similarly the energy of the antibonding molecular orbital
is increased by Δ. Atomic orbitals may hold up to two electrons Distance between atoms
(provided that they have opposite spins) and the same applies
to molecular orbitals. In the case of two hydrogen atoms Figure 3.34 Energy of y(g) and y(u)
combining, there are two electrons to be considered: one from molecular orbitals.
the 1s orbital of atom A and one from the 1s orbital of atom B.
When combined, these two electrons both occupy the bond• Atomic Molecular Atomic
ing molecular orbital y(g). This results in a saving of energy of orbitals orbitals orbitals
2Δ, which corresponds to the bond energy: It is only because Ψ(u)
the system is stabilized in this way that a bond is formed.
Energy
Ψ(A) Ψ(B)
Consider the hypothetical case of two He atoms combining.
The 1s orbitals on each He contain two electrons, making a atom (A) atom (B)
1s orbital 1s orbital
total of four electrons to put into molecular orbitals. Two of Ψ(g)
the electrons occupy the bonding MO, and two occupy the
antibonding MO. The stabilization energy 2Δ derived from
flling the bonding MO is offset by the 2Δ destabilization Figure 3.35 Energy levels of s–s atomic
energy from using the antibonding MO. Since overall there and molecular orbitals.
is no saving of energy, He2 does not exist, and this situation
corresponds to non•bonding.
Some further symbols are necessary to describe the way in which the atomic orbitals overlap. Overlap
of the orbitals along the axis joining the nuclei produces s molecular orbitals, whilst lateral overlap of
atomic orbitals forms p molecular orbitals.
Atomic Molecular
orbitals orbitals
− + + − + s overlap
bonding orbital
px s Ψ(g)
node
+ − + + − + s ∗ overlap
antibonding orbital
px s Ψ(u)
− + + − − + − s overlap
bonding orbital
px px
Ψ(g)
s ∗ overlap
+ − + − + − + − antibonding orbital
px px
Ψ(u)
Next consider the combination of two p orbitals which both have lobes perpendicular to the axis
joining the nuclei. Lateral overlap of orbitals will occur, resulting in p bonding and p* antibonding MOs
being produced (Figure 3.38).
+ + +
p overlap
nodal plane
bonding orbital
− − −
px px Ψ(u)
nodal plane
+ − + −
p overlap
nodal plane
antibonding orbital
− + − +
px px Ψ(g)
There are three points of differences between these molecular orbitals and the s orbitals described
previously:
1. For p overlap, the lobes of the atomic orbitals are perpendicular to the line joining the nuclei, whilst
for s overlap the lobes point along the line joining the two nuclei.
2. For p molecular orbitals, y is zero along the internuclear line and consequently the electron density y 2
is also zero. This is in contrast to s orbitals.
3. The symmetry of p molecular orbitals is different from that shown by s orbitals. If the bonding p MO
is rotated about the internuclear line a change in the sign of the lobe occurs. The p bonding orbitals
are therefore ungerade, whereas all s bonding MOs are gerade. Conversely, the antibonding p MO is
gerade whilst all s antibonding MOs are ungerade.
p bonding is important in many organic compounds such as ethene (where there is one s bond and one
p bond between the two carbon atoms), ethyne (one s and two p), and benzene, and also in a number of
inorganic compounds such as CO2 and CN − .
Ethene contains a localized double bond, which involves only the two carbon atoms. Experimental
measurements show that the two C atoms and the four H atoms are coplanar, and the bond angles are close
to 120°. Each C atom uses its 2s and two 2p orbitals to form three sp2 hybrid orbitals that form s bonds
to the other C atom and two H atoms. The remaining p orbital on each C atom is at right angles to the s
_
@edubuzznotes
3.10 LCAO Method 89
bonds so far formed. In the valence bond theory these two p orbitals overlap sideways to give a p bond. This
sideways overlap is not as great as the end to end overlap in s bonds so a C = C, though stronger than a
C—C bond, is not twice as strong (C—C in ethane 346 kJ mol–1, C=C in ethene 598kJ mol–1). The mol•
ecule can be twisted about the C—C bond in ethane, but it cannot be twisted in ethene since this would
reduce the amount of p overlap. In the molecular orbital theory the explanation of the p bonding is slightly
different. The two p orbitals involved in p bonding combine to form two p molecular orbitals, one bonding
and one antibonding. Since there are only two electrons involved, these occupy the p bonding MO since
this has the lower energy. The molecular orbital explanation becomes more important in cases where there
is non•localized p bonding, that is where p bonding covers several atoms as in benzene, NO3− and CO2− 3 .
In ethyne each C atom uses sp hybrid orbitals to form s bonds to the other C atom and a H atom.
These four atoms form a linear molecule. Each C atom has two p orbitals at right angles to one another, and
these overlap sideways with the equivalent p orbitals on the other C atom, thus forming two p bonds. Thus
a C ≡ C triple bond is formed, which is stronger than a C=C double bond ( C ≡ C in ethyne 813 kJ mol–1).
The majority of strong p bonds occur between elements of the frst short period in the periodic table,
for example C ≡ C , C ≡ N, C ≡ O, C=C and C=O. This is mainly because the atoms are smaller and hence
the orbitals involved are reasonably compact, so it is possible to get substantial overlap of orbitals. There
are a smaller number of cases where p bonding occurs between different types of orbitals, for example the
2p and 3d orbitals. Though these orbitals are much larger, the presence of nodes may concentrate electron
density in certain parts of the orbitals.
+ + − + −
p overlap
+ bonding orbital
− − + −
py dxy Ψ(u)
+ − + + − +
p ∗ overlap
− + − − + − antibonding orbital
py dxy Ψ(g)
density in between the nuclei, the signs (symmetry) of the lobes which overlap must be the same. Similarly
for antibonding MOs the signs of the overlapping lobes must be different. In the combinations shown in
Figure 3.41 any stabilization which occurs from overlapping + with + is destabilized by an equal amount
of overlap of + with –. There is no overall change in energy, and this situation is termed non•bonding.
It should be noted that in all of these non•bonding cases the symmetry of the two atomic orbitals is different,
i.e. rotation about the axis changes the sign of one.
+ −
+
+ − +
− +
−
s py px dyz
When l = 0, the orbitals are symmetrical around the axis and are called s orbitals. When l = ±1 they
are called p orbitals and when l = ±2 they are called d orbitals.
4. The spin quantum number is the same as for atomic orbitals and may have values of ± 1 .
2
The Pauli exclusion principle states that in a given atom no two electrons can have all four quantum
numbers the same. The Pauli principle also applies to molecular orbitals: No two electrons in the same
molecule can have all four quantum numbers the same.
The order of energy of molecular orbitals has been determined mainly from spectroscopic data.
In simple homonuclear diatomic molecules, the order is:
_
@edubuzznotes
3.11 Rules for Linear Combination of Atomic Orbitals 91
π2 p y , π*2 p y , σ*2 px
σ1s, σ*1s, σ 2s, σ*2s, σ 2 px ,
π 2 pz , π*2 pz
increasing energy
→
The molecular orbital diagram representing this order of energy levels is shown in Figure 3.42.
Energy Energy
σ*2px
p*2py = p*2pz
2p 2p
p 2py = p 2pz
σ2px
σ*2s
2s 2s
σ2s
σ*1s
1s 1s
σ1s
Figure 3.42 Electronic configuration, atomic orbital and molecular orbitals for simple
homonuclear diatomic molecules.
Note that the 2py atomic orbital gives p bonding and p* antibonding MOs and the 2pz atomic orbital
gives p bonding and p* antibonding MOs. The bonding p2py and p2pz MOs have exactly the same energy
and are said to be double degenerate. In a similar way the antibonding p*2py and p*2pz MOs have the same
energy and are also doubly degenerate.
A similar arrangement of MOs exists from s3s to s*3px, but the energies are known with less
certainty.
The energies of the s 2p and s 2p MOs are very close together. The order of MOs shown above is
correct for oxygen and heavier elements, but for the lighter elements boron, carbon and nitrogen the p 2py
and p 2pz are probably lower than s 2px. For these atoms the order is:
p 2p y p *2p y
s 1s, s *1s, s 2s, s *2s, , s 2px , , s *2px
p 2pz p *2pz
increasing energy
→
The molecular orbital diagram representing this order of energy levels is shown in Figure 3.43.
_
@edubuzznotes
92 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
Energy Energy
σ*2px
p*2py = p*2pz
2p 2p
σ2px
p 2py = p2pz
σ*2s
2s 2s
σ2s
σ*1s
1s 1s
σ1s
Figure 3.43 Electronic configuration, atomic and molecular orbitals for heavier
homonuclear diatomic molecules.
This kind of energy reversal is due to mixing of 2s and 2p orbitals where the energy difference is very
close, i.e for B, C, N atoms. According to the symmetry interactions (non•crossing rule), the two orbit•
als of the same symmetry repel each other; and the lower energy orbital lowers down more while the
higher energy orbital is energized more. Accordingly, s 2 s and s 2 p x have same symmetry and similarly for
s 2*s and s 2 p*x , the energy of s2s is lowered and that of the s 2px becomes higher. Similarily the energy of s 2*s
is lowered while that of s 2p*x becomes higher. Finally, the energy of the s 2px becomes higher than p 2 py , p 2 pz
which remain unchanged in the symmetry interaction. This kind of mixing of orbitals or symmetry interac•
tion is not applicable for O2 and F2 molecule formation because of larger energy gap between 2s and 2p
orbitals for these atoms.
Atoms Li Be B C N O F Ne
∆E(2 p − 2 s) 1.8 2.8 4.5 5.3 6.0 15.0 20.5 26.7
in (eV)
Hund’s rule states that when several orbitals have the same energy (that is they are degenerate),
electrons will be arranged so as to give the maximum number of unpaired spins.
In the molecular orbital method, we consider the whole molecule rather than the constituent atoms,
and use molecular orbitals rather than atomic orbitals. In the build•up of the molecule, the total number
of electrons from all the atoms in the molecule is fed into molecular orbitals. The Aufbau principle and
Hund’s rule are used as before.
For simplicity homonuclear diatomic molecules will be examined frst. Homonuclear means that there
is only one type of nucleus, that is one element present, and diatomic means that the molecule is composed
of two atoms.
H2 molecule
There is one electron from each atom, and hence there are two electrons in the molecule. These occupy the
lowest energy MO:
s1s2
This is shown in Figure 3.44. The bonding s1s MO is full, so the stabilization energy is 2Δ. A s bond is
formed, and the H2 molecule exists and is well known.
s*1s
1s 1s
s1s
H H2 H
atom molecule atom
+
He2 molecule ion
This may be considered as a combination of a He atom and a He+ ion. There are three electrons in the
molecular ion, which are arranged in MOs:
s1s2, s*1s1
The flled s1s bonding MO gives 2Δ stabilization, whilst the half•flled s1s* gives Δ destabilization. Overall
there is Δ stabilization. Thus the helium molecule ion can exist. It is not very stable, but it has been observed
spectroscopically.
_
@edubuzznotes
94 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
He2 molecule
There are two electrons from each atom, and the four electrons are arranged in MOs:
s1s2, s *ls2
The 2Δ stabilization energy from flling the s 2s MO is cancelled by the 2Δ destabilization energy from
flling the s *1s MO. Thus a bond is not formed, and the molecule does not exist.
Li2 molecule
Each Li atom has two electrons in its inner shell, and one in its outer shell, giving three electrons. Thus there
is a total of six electrons in the molecule, and these are arranged in MOs:
s1s2, s *1s2, s 2s2
The inner shell of flled s1s and s *1s MOs do not contribute to the bonding in much the same way
as in He2. They are essentially the same as the atomic orbitals from which they were formed, and are
sometimes written:
KK, s 2s2
However, bonding occurs from the flling of the s 2s level, and Li2 molecules do exist in the vapour state.
However, in the solid it is energetically more favourable for lithium to form a metallic structure. Other
Group 1 metals such as sodium behave in an analogous way:
Na2 KK, LL, s 3s2
Be2 molecule
A beryllium atom has two electrons in the frst shell plus two electrons in the second shell. Thus in the Be2
molecule there are eight electrons. These are arranged in MOs:
s 1s2, s *1s2, s 2s2, s *2s2
or
KK, s 2s2, s *2s2
Ignoring the inner shell as before, it is apparent that the effects of the bonding s2s and antibonding s*2s
levels cancel, so there is no stabilization and the molecule would not be expected to exist.
B2 molecule
Each boron atom has 2 + 3 electrons. The B2 molecule thus contains a total of ten electrons, which are
arranged in MOs:
p 2 py1
s 1s 2 , s *1s 2 , s 2 s 2 , s *2 s 2 , 1
p 2 pz
Note that B is a light atom and the order of energies of MOs is different from the ‘usual’ arrangement.
Thus the p 2p orbitals are lower in energy than the s 2px. Since the p 2py and p 2pz orbitals are degenerate
(identical in energy), Hund’s rule applies, and each is singly occupied. The inner shell does not participate in
bonding. The effects of bonding and antibonding s 2s orbitals cancel but stabilization occurs from the flling
of the p 2p orbitals, and hence a bond is formed and B2 exists.
C2 molecule
A carbon atom has 2 + 4 electrons. A C2 molecule would contain a total of 12 electrons, and these would
be arranged in MOs:
The molecule should be stable, since the two p 2p bonding orbitals provide 4Δ of stabilization energy,
giving two bonds. In fact carbon exists as a macromolecule in graphite and diamond, since these are an even
more stable arrangement (where each carbon forms four bonds): hence diamond and graphite are formed
in preference to C2.
_
@edubuzznotes
3.12 Examples of Molecular Orbital Treatment 95
N2 molecule
A nitrogen atom has 2 + 5 = 7 electrons. Thus the N2 molecule contains 14 electrons. These are arranged in MOs:
p 2 py2
s 1s 2 , s * 1s 2 , s 2 s 2 , s * 2 s 2 , 2
s 2 px2 ,
p 2 pz
Assuming that the inner shell does not participate in bonding, and that the bonding and antibonding 2s
levels cancel, one s and two p bonding pairs remain, giving a total of three bonds. This is in agreement with
the valence bond formulation as N ≡ N.
O2 molecule
Each oxygen atom has 2 + 6 = 8 electrons. Thus the O2 molecule contains a total of 16 electrons. These are
arranged in MOs:
p 2 py2 , p *2 py1
s 1s 2 , s *1s 2 , s 2 s 2 , s *2 s 2 , s 2 px2 , 2 1
p 2 pz , p * 2 pz
The antibonding p*2py and p*2pz orbitals are singly occupied in accordance with Hund’s rule. Unpaired
electrons give rise to paramagnetism. Since there are two unpaired electrons with parallel spins, this
explains why dioxygen is paramagnetic. If this treatment is compared with the Lewis electron pair theory
or the valence bond theory, these do not predict unpaired electrons or paramagnetism.
•• ••
:
: O •+ • O :→ :O O :
• • •• : ••
This was the frst success of the molecular orbital theory in successfully predicting the paramagnetism of
O2, a fact not even thought of with a valence bond representation of O=O.
As in the previous examples, the inner shell does not participate in bonding and the bonding and
antibonding 2s orbitals cancel each other. A s bond results from the flling of s 2 px2 . Since p*2 py1 is half
flled and therefore cancels half the effect of the completely flled p 2 py2 orbital, half of a p bond results.
Similarly another half of a p bond arises from p 2 pz2 and p*2 pz1 , giving a total of 1 + 21 + 21 = 2 bonds. The
bond order is thus two.
Instead of working out the bond order by cancelling the effects of flled bonding and antibonding MOs,
the bond order may be calculated as half the difference between the number of bonding and antibonding
electrons:
æ number of electrons ö æ number of electrons ö
ç ÷- ç ÷
è occupying bonding orbitalsø è in antibonding orbitalsø
Bond order =
2
In the case of O2 the bond order calculates as (10 — 6)/2 = 2, which corresponds to a double bond.
O-2 ion
The compound potassium superoxide KO2 contains the superoxide ion O2− . The O2− ion has 17 electrons, and
has one more electron than the O2 molecule. This extra electron occupies either the p *2py or p *2pz orbital.
It does not matter which it occupies since they are the same energy.
p 2 py2 , p * 2 py2
s 1s 2 , s ∗1s 2 , s 2 s 2 , s ∗2 s 2 , s 2 px2 , 2
p 2 pz , p ∗ 2 pz
1
The inner shell takes no part in bonding. The bonding and antibonding 2s orbitals completely cancel each
other. The s 2 px2 orbital bond is flled and forms a s bond. The effects of the bonding p 2 p2y and antibond•
ing p 2 py2 orbitals cancel, and the completely flled bonding p 2 pz2 is half cancelled by half antibonding, thus
giving half a p bond. The bond order is thus. 1+ 12 = 1 12 This corresponds to a bond that is intermediate in
length between a single and a double bond. Alternatively the bond order may be calculated as (bonding –
antibonding)/2, that is (10 - 7) / 2 = 1 12
_
@edubuzznotes
96 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
F2 molecule
Fluorine atoms have 2 + 7 electrons, so an F2 molecule contains 18 electrons. These are arranged:
p 2 py2 , p *2 py2
s 1s 2 , s *1s 2 , s 2 s 2 , s *2 s 2 , s 2 px2 , 2 2
p 2 pz , p *2 pz
The inner shell is non•bonding, and the flled bonding 2s, 2py and 2pz are cancelled by the equivalent anti•
bonding orbitals. This leaves a s bond from the flled s 2 px2 orbital, and thus a bond order of one. Alternatively
the bond order may be calculated as (bonding – antibonding)/2, that is (10 – 8)/2 = 1.
It should be noted that Cl2 and Br2 have structures analogous to F2, except that additional inner shells
of electrons are full.
The F—F bond is rather weak and this is attributed to the small size of fuorine and repulsion between
lone pairs of electrons on adjacent atoms.
F -2 and F -3
The formation of both F-2 and F-3 can be explained on the basis of MO theory. In case of F-2, the extra elec•
tron enters into s *2px orbital while in case of F-3 the donation from F- is accepted in the s *2px orbital.
In an argon matrix at 15 K, F-2 can be prepared according to the following reaction
M + F2 → M + + F2−
where M = K, Rb, Cs
The F -3 ion is prepared at 15 K on freezing argon gas which contains F2 as well as gaseous MF (where
M = Rb, Cs) in small amounts.
F2 + MF → M + + F3−
s∗2px
2p
p∗2py = p∗2pz
2p
s∗2px
p 2py = p 2pz
s∗2s
2s
2s
AO AO of
of X s 2s
MO Y
Figure 3.45 Electronic configuration, atomic and molecular orbitals for a heteronuclear molecule XY.
_
@edubuzznotes
3.13 Examples of Molecular Orbital Treatment for Heteronuclear Diatomic Molecules 97
The problem is that in many cases the order of MO energy levels is not known with certainty. Thus
we will consider frst some examples where the two different atoms are close to each other in the periodic
table, and consequently it is reasonable to assume that the order of energies for the MOs are the same as
for homonuclear molecules.
NO molecule
There are total 15 electrons in the molecule and the order of energy levels of the various MOs is
p 2 py2 , p ∗ 2 py1
σ 1s 2 , σ ∗ 1s 2 , σ 2 s 2 , σ ∗ 2 s 2 , σ 2 px2 ,
p ∗ 2 pz
2 0
p 2 pz ,
An unpaired electron is present in the p*orbital and is delocalized over the whole molecule, hence NO
molecules is paramagnetic. Since the highest occupied molecular orbital (HOMO) is p* and the energy of
which is higher than the atomic orbitals of N atom and O atom, the ionization energy of NO is less than
that of both N and O atoms.
On ionization, the bond order 2.5 of NO is increased to 3.0 in NO+ as a result of which bond length decreases
from 113 pm in NO to 106 pm in NO+.
CO molecule
Some special features are introduced in the MO diagram of CO because the electronegativity difference
between C and O atom is large. Since the ∆E(2 p − 2 s) for C atom (5.3 eV) is much less compared to ∆E(2 p − 2 s)
for O atom (15.0 eV), the participation of s – p hybrid orbitals are considered for the formation of MO
diagram of CO, which is shown in Figure 3.46.
Energy Energy
s*sp
(LUMO)
(HOMO)
p*
2p nb(C)
sp 2p
sp
sp p
2s
ssp
sp
nb(O)
2s
AO MO of AO of
of C atom CO O atom
Figure 3.46 Electronic configuration, atomic orbital and molecular orbital for carbon monoxide.
In ionization of CO, i.e. CO → CO+ , the removal of electron takes place from the non•bonding orbital of C
atom (HOMO). Hence the interelectronic repulsion decreases and fnally the bond length decreases from
112.8 pm to 111.5 pm.
_
@edubuzznotes
98 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
m = q×d (3.1)
where µ = dipole moment of the bond A–B, q = charge accumulated on either A or B without sign, d = bond
length of A–B bond.
It measures the polarity of the bond which is caused by the electronegativity difference between two
atoms involved in that bond. It is a vector quantity because it has both direction as well as magnitude and
the direction is shown by an arrow (→) from low electronegative atom to high electronegative atom. For
example, if B is more electronegative than A, then the direction is shown in A–B bond is as follows
A B
Dipole moment is measured in Debye unit (symbol D)
where 1 D = 10−18 esu cm = 3.33 × 10−30 coulomb metre.
Bond moment: It is the dipole moment of a particular bond. The dipole moment of a molecule is
determined by the bond moments of the bonds.
For diatomic heteroatomic molecules, the bond moment is equal to the dipole moment and for diatomic
homoatomic molecule it is zero because there is no shifting of bond pair towards any atom. Hence q is zero
in Eq. (3.1).
For polyatomic molecule (molecule having more than two atoms), the dipole moment is equal to the vector
sum of all bond moments and lone pair moments.
Lone pair moment: The lone pair has no contribution to the dipole moment of the molecule, if the
lone pair is present in the pure s or p orbital.This is because s orbital is spherically symmetrical and two
lobes of a pure p orbital are projected equally in the opposite direction. However, when the lone pair is
present in a hybrid orbital, the electronic density is not equal in two lobes of the hybrid orbital.
So, the direction of lone pair moment is from smaller lobe to larger lobe as shown above. Because of pres•
ence of lone pair in hybrid orbital it is also referred to as hybrid lone pair moment.
The value of lone pair moment depends upon the %s character of the hybrid orbital and as the %s
character increases, the lone pair moment increases upto 50% and then falls down as it becomes more and
more spherical. The lone pair moment order for different hybrid orbitals (consisting of s or p orbitals) is
given as follows:
sp > sp2 > sp3
In general, the lone pair moments have larger magnitude compared to bond pair moment. For example, in
case of the hybrid orbitals of carbon, it varies from 4.4 D (sp hybrid) to 3.7 D (sp3 hybrid) while the largest
value of some bond moments are
P → B : 4.4 D
N → O : 4.28 D
O → B : 3.6 D
Most of the other bond moments are less or much less than these values.
The contribution of lone pair moment to the dipole moment of the molecule can be understood with
the help of the following examples.
_
@edubuzznotes
3.14 Dipole Moment 99
1. The dipole moment of NH3 is much higher compared to that of NF3 though there is very small difference
in ∆χ (electronegativity difference) values of N–H bond (∆χ = 0.94) and N–F bond (∆χ = 0.96).
mL mL
N N
H H F F
H F
mR mR
where μL= lone pair moment and μR = resultant vector of bond moments.
In case of NH3, m NH3 = ( m R + m L ) and it is much higher than m NF3 = ( m R − m L ) .The overall direction
of dipole moment in these molecules is shown in the Figure 3.47 and it can be predicted only when all
individual data of lone pair moment and bond moment is available.
2. Similarly, in case of H2O and F2O, m F2 O is much less than m H2 O as shown in Figure 3.48.
mRL mRL
O O
F F H H
mR mR
F F F
N N N N
F
m=0 m ≈ 0 (0.16 D)
4. For SO2 molecule, the overall direction of dipole moment is upwards as shown in Figure 3.50.
S
O O
2. Prediction of the shape of the molecule can be done based on dipole moment measurements.
a. For AX2 type of molecule
If μ = 0; it must be linear. For example, BeCl2, XeF2, ICl2–, I3−, etc.
If μ ≠ 0 ; it must be angular. For example, H2O, SCl2, SO2, etc.
b. For AX3 type of molecule
If μ = 0; it must be trigonal planar. For example, BH3, BF3, AlCl3, CH3+etc.
If μ ≠ 0; it must be pyramidal or T•shaped. For example, NH3, CH3– are pyramidal and ClF3, XeF3+ are
T•shaped.
c. For AX4 type of molecule
If μ = 0; it must be tetrahedral or square planar. For example, CH4, SiF4 are tetrahedral and XeF4, ICl4
are square planar.
If μ ≠ 0; it must be see•saw. For example, SF4.
d. For AX5 type of molecule
If μ = 0; it must be trigonal bipyramidal. For example, PF5, SbF5, etc. Only XeF5− has pentagonal
planar structure.
If μ ≠ 0; it must be square pyramidal. For example, XeF5+.
e. For AX6 type of molecule
If μ = 0; it must be regular octahedral. For example, SX6, TeCl6.
If μ ≠ 0; it must be distorted octahedral (known) or any other shape (but unknown). For example,
XeH6.
f. For AX7 type of molecule
If μ = 0; it must be pentagonal bipyramidal. For example, IF7.
If μ ≠ 0; [Not known yet].
3. Prediction of cis – trans isomerism. For example, as shown for C2H2Cl2 in Figure 3.51.
H H H Cl
C=C and C=C
Cl Cl Cl H
But another structural isomer is possible from this formula which has non•zero dipole moment value as
shown in Figure 3.52.
H Cl
C=C
H Cl
(III)
X
X
m = 2.0 m = 1.5 m=0
ortho meta para
Figure 3.53 Dipole moment order of ortho, meta and para disubstituted
benzene when both halogen atoms are same.
Note: If two halogen atoms are the same, then the above order is always obtained.
b. For molecules like C6H4XY, where X is electron withdrawing in nature and Y is electron donating in
nature, the order of dipole moment is observed as ortho < meta < para as shown in Figure 3.54.
CH3 CH3 CH3
NO2
NO2
NO2
ortho meta para
Figure 3.54 Dipole moment order of ortho, meta and para disubstituted
benzene when both the atoms are different.
c. Again consider molecules of the type C6H4 XY when X ≠ Y but X and Y are both electron withdrawing
in nature, the dipole moment order is ortho > meta > para.
Some observed data is given for molecules of the type C6H4 XY in Table 3.7.
{
< <
Electron donating type
CH3 NO2 3.76 < 4.17 < 4.40
NH2 NO2 3.64 < 4.85 < 6.2
Electron withdrawing
type { Cl
Cl
NO2
CN 4.75
4.6 >
>
3.69
3.4
>
>
2.70
2.5
_
@edubuzznotes
102 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
Cl PΕt3 Εt3P Cl
Pt Pt
Cl PΕt3 Cl PΕt3
The equilibrium is temperature dependent and if at a particular temperature the observed dipole
moment is 4 D, then the percentage of cis isomer is 40 and that of trans isomer is 60 and
60
Keq = = 1.5
40
b. The stability of a particular conformation can be understood from dipolar repulsion. For example,
consider two different forms of butane•2,3•dione.
O O
C CH3 C O
H3C C H3C C
O CH3
trans form cis form
m=0 m≠0
(more stable) (less stable)
H H H H
Cl H
1. The molecule HO OH is expected to have zero dipole moment value but it has the dipole
moment value of 1.64 D. This is due to the presence of lone pair on O atom which is not involved in reso•
nance with benzene ring.
_
@edubuzznotes
3.14 Dipole Moment 103
2. Sometimes the value of dipole moment is lessened by the mesomeric effect and becomes reversed in
direction also. For example,
a. CH3 CH2 Cl
− +
CH2 CH Cl CH2 CH Cl
N O
H
m = 1.8 D m = 0.7 D.
c. The dipole moment of Ph–F in less than that of Ph–Cl and it is due to more effective mesomeric
effect in case of F (2pp – 2pp) as compared to that of Cl (3pp – 2pp).
F Cl
m = 1.63 D m = 1.75 D.
3. The dipole moment of p•nitroaniline and o• nitroaniline are extra•ordinarily large compared to the
expected value. This is because +R effect of −NH2 group and –R effect of −NO2 group are coupled
together and the overall effect enhances dipole moment value.
O O O−
+ − +
H2N N H2N N H2N N +
+ +
O
− O
− O
−
4. CO molecule has very low dipole moment of 0.112 D due to the following reasons:
a. In CO lone pair moments due to presence of two lone pairs can be considered as cancelled by each
other as shown below.
CO
5. trans (Et3P)2 PtCl2 has zero dipole moment value while trans (Et2S)2 PtCl2 has signifcant value of dipole
moment (μ = 2.4 D).
Εt
Εt3P: Cl Εt S: Cl
Pt while Pt
Εt
Cl :PΕt3 Cl :S Εt
m=0 m = 2.4 D
The lone pairs on S atom (not used in coordinate bonding) are not oriented in a manner that their lone
pair moments are cancelled by each other.
6. O3 molecule is also polar due to its lone pair moments and resultant lone pair moment is not zero as
shown in Figure 3.55.
O
+
O O
7. For halogenated derivatives, the observed dipole moment order is observed as follows
a. HF>HCl>HBr>HI
b. CH3Cl> CH3F > CH3Br> CH3I
c. CH3Cl > CH2Cl2> CHCl3>CCl4
X− X− X−
A+
X− X− X− X− X− X−
<0.155 2 Linear
0.155 → 0.225 3 Planar triangle
0.225 → 0.414 4 Tetrahedral
0.414 → 0.732 4 Square planar
0.414 → 0.732 6 Octahedral
0.732 → 0.999 8 Body•centred cubic
with one another. By simple geometry this gives the ratio (radius A+/radius X − ) = 0.155. This is the lower
limit for a coordination number of 3. If the radius ratio is less than 0.155 then the positive ion is not in
contact with the negative ions, and it ‘rattles’ in the hole, and the structure is unstable (Figure 3.56c).
If the radius ratio is greater than 0.155 then it is possible to ft three X − ions round each A+ ion. As the
difference in the size of the two ions increases, the radius ratio also increases, and at some point (when
the ratio exceeds 0.225), it becomes possible to ft four ions around one, and so on for six ions around
one, and eight ions around one. Coordination numbers of 3, 4, 6 and 8 are common, and the appropriate
limiting radius ratios can be worked out by simple geometry, and are shown in Table 3.8.
If the ionic radii are known, the radius ratio can be calculated and hence the coordination number and
shape may be predicted. This simple concept predicts the correct structure in many cases.
BE
cos 30o =
BD
BE
BD =
cos 30o
r− r−
r+ + r − = o = = r − × 1.155
cos 30 0.866
+
r = (1.155r − ) − r − = 0.155r −
Hence r+
= 0.155
r−
Taking reciprocals r+ + r− 1
−
= + 1.225
r 0.8164
_
@edubuzznotes
106 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
D
B
B C C
E
A
(a) (b)
B
A
A C B C
D D
(c) (d)
Figure 3.57 Limiting radius ratios for coordination numbers 3, 4 and 6. (a) Cross-section through a
planar triangle site; (b) tetrahedron inscribed in a cube; (c) diagram for tetrahedral case; (d) cross–
section through an octahedral site.
Rearranging r+
+ 1 = 1.225
r−
Hence r+
= 0.225
r−
3. Coordination number 6 (octahedral): A cross•section through an octahedral site is shown in Figure 3.48d,
and the smaller positive ion (of radius r +) touches six larger negative ions (of radius r −). (Note that only
four negative ions are shown in this section, and one is above and another below the plane of the paper.)
It is obvious that AB = r + + r − and BD = r − . The angle ABC is 45°. In the triangle ABD
BD r−
cos ABD = 0.7071 = = + −
AB r + r
Taking reciprocals r+ + r− 1
= = 1.414
r− 0.7071
Rearranging r+
+ 1 = 1.414
r−
Hence r+
= 0.414
r−
An ionic structure is composed of oppositely charged ions. If the larger ions are close packed, then
the smaller ions may occupy either the octahedral holes or the tetrahedral holes depending on their size.
Normally the type of hole occupied can be determined from the radius ratio. An ion occupying a tetrahedral
hole has a coordination number of 4, whilst one occupying an octahedral hole has a coordination number
of 6. In some compounds the relative sizes of the ions are such that the smaller ions are too large to ft
in the holes, and they force the larger ions out of contact with each other so that they are no longer close
packed. Despite this, the relative positions of the ions remain unchanged, and it is convenient to retain the
description in terms of close packing.
Figure 3.58 Tetrahedral and octahedral holes: (a) Tetrahedral and octahedral sires in a close-packed
lattice; (b) tetrahedral site; and (c) octahedral
_
@edubuzznotes
108 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
S2− Zn2+
(a) (b)
Figure 3.59 Structures of ZnS: (a) zinc blende and (b) wurtzite. (Reproduced with permission from
Wells, A.F., Structural Inorganic Chemistry, 5th ed., Oxford University Press, Oxford, 1984.)
Ca2+ F−
Figure 3.62 Fluorite (CaF2) structure. (Reproduced by permission of Wells, A.F., Structural Inorganic
Chemistry, 5th ed., Oxford University Press, Oxford, 1984.)
O2−
Ti4+ Oxygen
Silica
Rutile structure
TiO2 exists in three forms called anatase, brookite and rutile. The rutile structure is found in many crystals
where the radius ratio is between 0.41 and 0.73. This suggests a coordination number of 6 for one ion, and
from the formula it follows that the coordination number of the other ion must be 3. This is a 6:3 structure.
Each Ti4+ is octahedrally surrounded by six O2– ions and each O2– ion has three Ti4+ ions round it in a plane
triangular arrangement (Figure 3.63).
The rutile structure is not close packed. The unit cell, i.e. the repeating unit of this structure, is not a
cube, since one of the axes is 30% shorter than the other two. It is convenient to describe it as a considerably
distorted cube (though the distortion is rather large). The structure may then be described as a consider•
ably distorted body•centred cubic lattice of Ti4+ ions. Each Ti4+ ion is surrounded octahedrally by six Ο2–
ions, and the Ο2– are in positions of threefold coordination, that is each O2– is surrounded by three Ti4+ ions
at the corners of an equilateral triangle. Three•coordination is not common in solids. There are no examples
of three•coordination in compounds of the type AX, but there is another example in the compounds of
_
@edubuzznotes
110 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
type AX2, that is CdI2, though in this case the shape is not an equilateral triangle. The structure of CaCl2 is
also a 6:3 structure, and is similar to CdI2. These are described later (Section 3.19).
There are only a few cases where the radius ratio is below 0.41. Examples include silica SiO2 and beryl•
lium fuoride BeF2. These have coordination numbers of 4 and 2, but radius ratio predictions are uncertain
since they are appreciably covalent.
The Cd2+ ions occupy half of the octahedral sites. Rather than half flling the octahedral sites in a regular
way throughout the whole structure, all of the octahedral sites are flled between two I − layers, and none
of the octahedral sites is flled between the next two layers of I − ions. All of the octahedral holes are flled
between the next two layers of I − ions, none between the next pair, and so on (Figure 3.65).
I−
Cd2+
Lattice energies cannot be measured directly, but experimental values are obtained from thermodynamic
data using the Born−Haber cycle.
Theoretical values for lattice energy may be calculated. The ions are treated as point charges, and the
electrostatic (coulombic) energy E between two ions of opposite charge is calculated:
z + z − e2
E =−
r
where z and z are the charges on the positive and negative ions, e is the charge on an electron, r is the
+ −
inter•ionic distance
For more than two ions, the electrostatic energy depends on the number of ions, and also on A their
arrangement in space. For one mole, the attractive energy is:
No Az + z − e 2
E =−
r
where No is the Avogadro constant – the number of molecules in a mole – which has the value 6.023 ´ 1023
mol–1. A is the Madelung constant, which depends on the geometry of the crystal.
Values for the Madelung constant have been calculated for all common crystal structures, by summing
the contributions of all the ions in the crystal lattice. Some values are given in Table 3.10.
_
@edubuzznotes
112 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
The equation for the attractive forces between the ions gives a negative value for energy, that is
energy is given out when a crystal is formed. The inter•ionic distance r occurs in the denominator of the
equation. Thus the smaller the value of r, the greater the amount of energy evolved when the crystal
lattice is formed, and hence the more stable the crystal will be.
Mathematically, the equation suggests that an infnite amount of
energy should be evolved if the distance r is zero. Plainly this is Table 3.10 Madelung constants
not so. When the inter•ionic distance becomes small enough for
Type of structure A
the ions to touch, they begin to repel each other. This repulsion
originates from the mutual repulsion of the electron clouds on Zinc blende ZnS 1.63806
the two atoms or ions. The repulsive forces increase rapidly as Wurtzite ZnS 1.64132
r decreases. The repulsive force is given by B / r n, where B is a Sodium chloride NaCl 1.74756
constant that depends on the structure, and n is a constant called
Caesium chloride CsCl 1.76267
the Born exponent. For one gram molecule the total repulsive
force is ( N o B) / r . The Born exponent may be determined from
n Rutile TiO 2 2.408
compressibility measurements. Often chemists use a value of 9, Fluorite CaF2 2.51939
but it is better to use values for the particular ions in the crystal Corundum Al2O3 4.17186
as given in Table 3.11.
The total energy holding the crystal together is U the lattice
energy. This is the sum of the attractive and the repulsive forces.
N o Az+ z- e 2 N B
U=- + on
r r
attractive repulsive (3.2)
force force
(A is the Madelung constant and B is a repulsion coeffcient, which is a constant which is approximately
proportional to the number of nearest neighbours.)
The equilibrium distance between ions is determined by the balance between the attractive and repul•
sion terms. At equilibrium, dU/dr = 0 and the equilibrium distance r = r0
dU N o A z + z − e 2 nN o B (3.3)
= − n+1 = 0
dr r 2o ro
Az + z − e 2 r no− 1
B= (3.4)
n
_
@edubuzznotes
3.20 Lattice Energy 113
N A z + z − e 2 1
U=− 1 −
ro n
This equation is called the Born–Landé equation. It allows the lattice energy to be calculated from a knowl•
edge of the geometry of the crystal, and hence the Madelung constant, the charges z and z , and the inter•
+ −
ionic distance. When using SI units, the equation takes the form:
No A z + z − e 2 1
U=− 1 − (3.5)
4pε o r o n
2. The lattice energy depends on the product of the ionic charges, and U is proportional to (z ⋅ z ).
+ −
3. The close agreement between the experimental lattice energies and those calculated by the Born–
Landé equation for the alkali metal halides does not of itself prove that the equation itself, or the
assumptions on which it is based, are correct. The equation is remarkably self•compensating, and
tends to hide errors. There are two opposing factors in the equation. Increasing the inter•ionic distance
r reduces the lattice energy. It is almost impossible to change r without changing the structure, and
therefore changing the Madelung constant A. Increasing A increases the lattice energy: hence the
effects of changing r and A may largely cancel each other.
This may be illustrated by choosing a constant value for n in the Born–Landé equation. Then changes
in inter•ionic distance can be calculated for either changes in the coordination number, or in crystal
structure. Taking a constant value of n = 9, we may compare the inter•ionic distances with those for
six•coordination:
Coordination number 12 8 6 4
Ratio of inter•ionic distance 1.091 1.037 1.000 0.951
For a change of coordination number from 6 (NaCl structure) to 8 (CsCl structure) the inter•ionic
distance increases by 3.7%, and the Madelung constants (NaCl A = 1.74756, and CsCl A = 1.76267)
change by only 0.9%. Thus a change in coordination number from 6 to 8 would result in a reduction in
_
@edubuzznotes
114 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
lattice energy, and in theory the NaCl structure should always be more stable than the CsCl structure.
In a similar way reducing the coordination number from 6 to 4 decreases r by 4.9%. The decrease in
A is 6.1% or 6.3% (depending on whether a zinc blende or wurtzite structure is formed), but in either
case it more than compensates for the change in r, and in theory coordination number 6 is more
stable than 4.
This suggests that neither four•nor eight•coordinate structures should exist, since the six•coordi•
nate NaCl structure is more stable. Since ZnS is known (coordination number 4), and CsCl, CsBr and
CsI have a coordination number of 8, this suggestion is plainly incorrect. We must therefore look for a
mistake in the theoretical assumptions made. First the value of n was assumed to be 9, when it may vary
from 5 to 12. Second, the calculation of electrostatic attraction assumes that the ions are point charges.
Third, the assumption is made that there is no reduction in charge because of the interaction (i.e. the
bonds are 100% ionic).
4. Crystals with a high lattice energy usually melt at high temperatures, and are very hard. Hardness is
measured on Mohs’ scale. (See Appendix K.) High lattice energy is favoured by a small inter•ionic
distance, and a high charge on the ions (Table 3.12).
It has been seen that a number of salts which might be expected from radius ratio considerations
to have a CsCl structure in fact adopt a NaCl structure. The Madelung constant for CsCl is larger
than for NaCl, and would give an increased lattice energy. However, the inter•ionic distance r will
be larger in a CsCl type of structure than in a NaCl type of structure, and this would decrease the
lattice energy. These two factors work in opposite directions and partly cancel each other. This makes
the lattice energy more favourable for a NaCl type of lattice in some cases where a CsCl structure is
geometrically possible. Consider a case such as RbBr, where the radius ratio is close to borderline
between six•coordination (NaCl structure) and eight•coordination (CsCl structure). If the CsCl structure
is adopted, the Madelung constant is larger than for NaCl. and this increases the lattice energy by 0.86%.
Table 3.12 Inter-ionic distances and ionic charges related to m.p. and hardness
r(Å) (z+ ⋅ z-) m.p. (oC) Hardness (Mohs’ scale)
NaF 2.310 1 990 3.2
BeO 1.65 4 2530 9.0
MgO 2.106 4 2800 6.5
CaO 2.405 4 2580 4.5
SrO 2.580 4 2430 3.5
BaO 2.762 4 1923 3.3
TiC 2.159 16 3140 8–9
At the same time the inter•ionic distance in a CsCl structure increases by 3%, and this decreases the
lattice energy by 3%. Clearly the NaCl structure is preferred.
Two types of defects may be observed in stoichiometric compounds, called Schottky and Frenkel defects
respectively. At absolute zero, crystals tend to have a perfectly ordered arrangement. As the temperature
increases, the amount of thermal vibration of ions in their lattice sites increases, and if the vibration of a
particular ion becomes large enough, it may jump out of its lattice site. This constitutes a point defect. The
higher the temperature, the greater the chance that lattice sites may be unoccupied. Since the number of
defects depends on the temperature, they are sometimes called thermodynamic defects.
Schottky defects
A+ B− A+ B− A+
A Schottky defect consists of a pair of ‘holes’ in the crystal lattice.
One positive ion and one negative ion are absent (see Figure 3.67).
This sort of defect occurs mainly in highly ionic compounds where B− B− A+ B−
the positive and negative ions are of a similar size, and hence the
coordination number is high (usually 8 or 6), for example NaCl, CsCl, A+ B− A+ A+
KCl and KBr.
The number of Schottky defects formed per cm3 (ns) is given by
B− A+ B− A+ B−
W
ns = N exp − s
2kT Figure 3.67 Schottky defect.
3
where N is the number of sites per cm that could be left vacant, Ws is the work necessary to form a
Schottky defect, k is the gas constant and T the absolute temperature.
Frenkel defects
A Frenkel defect consists of a vacant lattice site (a ‘hole’), and the ion
which ideally should have occupied the site now occupies an intersti•
A+ B− A+ B− A+
tial position (see Figure 3.68).
Metal ions are generally smaller than the anions. Thus it is easier A+
to squeeze A+ into alternative interstitial positions, and consequently B −
B −
A+ B−
it is more common to fnd the positive ions occupying interstitial
positions. This type of defect is favoured by a large difference in size A+ B− A+ B− A+
between the positive and negative ions, and consequently the coor•
dination number is usually low (4 or 6). Since small positive ions are
highly polarizing and large negative ions are readily polarized, these B− A+ B− A+ B−
compounds have some covalent character. This distortion of ions,
and the proximity of like charges, leads to a high dielectric constant. Figure 3.68 Frenkel defect.
Examples of this type of defect are ZnS, AgCl, AgBr and AgI.
The number of Frenkel defects formed per cm3 (n f ) is given by
æ Wf ö
nf = NN ¢ expç - ÷
è 2kT ø
where N is the number of sites per cm3 that could be left vacant, N ′ is the number of alternative interstitial
positions per cm3, Wf is the work necessary to form a Frenkel defect, k is the gas constant and T the absolute
temperature.
The energy needed to form either a Schottky defect or a Frenkel defect depends on the work needed
to form the defect, and on the temperature. In a given compound one type generally predominates.
In NaCl, the energy to form a Schottky defect is about 200 kJ mol–1 compared with a lattice energy of
approximately 750 kJ mol–1. It is therefore much easier to form a defect than to break the lattice.
The number of defects formed is relatively small, and at room temperature NaCl has only one defect in 1015
lattice sites, this value rising to one in 106 sites at 500 °C and one in 104 sites at 800 °C.
A consequence of these defects is that a crystalline solid that has defects may conduct electricity to a
small extent. Electrical conductivity in a chemically pure, stoichiometric semiconductor is called ‘intrinsic
semiconduction’. In the above cases, intrinsic semiconduction occurs by an ionic mechanism. If an ion moves
from its lattice site to occupy a ‘hole’, it creates a new ‘hole’. If the process is repeated many times, a ‘hole’
_
@edubuzznotes
116 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
may migrate across a crystal, which is equivalent to moving a charge in the opposite direction. (This type of
semiconduction is responsible for the unwanted background noise produced by transistors.)
Crystals with Frenkel defects have only one type of hole, but crystals containing Schottky defects have
holes from both positive and negative ions, and conduction may arise by using either one type of hole or
both types. Migration of the smaller ion (usually the positive ion) into the appropriate holes is favoured at
low temperatures, since moving a small ion requires less energy. However, migration of both types of ions in
opposite directions (using both types of holes) occurs at high temperatures. For example, at temperatures
below 500 °C the alkali halides conduct by migration of the cations, but at higher temperatures both anions
and cations migrate. Further, the amount of anionic conduction increases with temperature, as shown in
Table 3.13.
The density of a defect lattice should be different from that of a perfect lattice. The presence of ‘holes’
should lower the density, but if there are too many ‘holes’ there may be a partial collapse or distortion of
the lattice – in which case the change in density is unpredictable. The presence of ions in interstitial posi•
tions may distort (expand) the lattice and increase the unit cell dimensions.
Metal excess
This may occur in two different ways.
F-centres
A negative ion may be absent from its lattice site, leaving a ‘hole’ which is occupied by an electron, thereby
maintaining the electrical balance (see Figure 3.69). This is rather
similar to a Schottky defect in that there are ‘holes’ and not inter•
stitial ions, but only one ‘hole’ is formed rather than a pair. This A+ B− A+ B−
type of defect is formed by crystals which would be expected to
form Schottky defects. When compounds such as NaCl, KCl, B− A+ B− A+
LiH or d•TiO are heated with excess of their constituent metal
vapours, or treated with high energy radiation, they become def•
A+ e− A+ B−
cient in the negative ions, and their formulae may be represented
by AX1− ·, where d is a small fraction. The nonstoichiometric
form of NaCl is yellow, and the nonstoichiometric form of KCl is B− A+ B− A+
blue – lilac in colour. Note the similarity with the fame colorations
for Na and K. Figure 3.69 Metal excess defect
because of absent anion.
_
@edubuzznotes
3.22 Nonstoichiometric Defects 117
The crystal lattice has vacant anion sites, which are occupied by electrons. Anion sites occupied by
electrons in this way are called F•centres. (F is an abbreviation for Farbe, the German word for colour.)
These F•centres are associated with the colour of the compound and the more F•centres present, the
greater the intensity of the coloration. Solids containing F•centres are paramagnetic, because the electrons
occupying the. vacant sites are unpaired. When materials with F•centres are irradiated with light they
become photoconductors. When electrons in the F•centres absorb suffcient light (or heat) energy, the
electron is promoted into a conduction band, rather similar to the conduction bands present in metals.
Since conduction is by electrons it is n•type semiconduction.
Metal deficiency
Metal•defcient compounds may be represented by the general formula A1–δΧ. In principle metal defciency
can occur in two ways. Both require variable valency of the metal, and might therefore be expected with
the transition metals.
movement of A2+. With a series of similar ‘hops’, an electron may be transferred in one direction across
the structure, and at the same time the positive hole migrates in the opposite direction across the struc•
ture. This is called positive hole, or p•type semiconduction.
If a defect oxide of this type is heated in dioxygen, its room
temperature conductivity increases, because the dioxygen oxidizes
some of the metal ions, and this increases the number of positive A+ B− A+ B−
centres. B −
B− A+ B+ A+
Extra interstitial negative ions
In principle it might be possible to have an extra negative ion in A+ B− A 2+ B−
an interstitial position and to balance the charges by means of an
extra charge on an adjacent metal ion (see Figure 3.72). However,
B− A+ B− A+
since negative ions are usually large, it would be diffcult to ft them
into interstitial positions. No examples of crystals containing such
Figure 3.72 Metal deficiency
negative interstitial ions are known at present.
caused by interstitial negative ions.
Electron
+ 12 Enthalphy of affinity (EA)
Energy dissociation
+ −
(kJ mol−1) ∆Hd Na(g) + Cl(g)
Na+(g) + 12 Cl2(g)
+400
Ionization energy
(IE)
1
Na(g) + 2 Cl2(g)
1
0 Na(s) + 2 Cl2(g)
Enthalpy of
formation
(∆Hf)
NaCl(crystal)
−400
DH f = DH s + IE + 21 DH d + EA + U
All the terms except the lattice energy and electron affnity can be measured. Originally the cycle was used
to calculate electron affnities. By using known crystal structures, it was possible to calculate the lattice
energy, and hence values were obtained for the electron affnity.
DHf = + DHs + IE + 21 DH d + EA + U
Now that some electron affnity values are known, the cycle is used to calculate the lattice energy for
unknown crystal structures.
It is useful to know the lattice energy, as a guide to the solubility of the crystal. When a solid dissolves,
the crystal lattice must be broken up (which requires that energy is put in). the ions so formed are sol•
vated (with the evolution of energy). When the lattice energy is high a large amount of energy is required
to break the lattice. It is unlikely that the enthalpy of solvation will be big enough (and evolve suffcient
energy to offset this), so the substance will probably be insoluble.
the ‘noble behaviour’ of many transition metals, that is their resistance to chemical attack, is related
to a similar series of energy changes. Noble character is favoured by a high heat of sublimation, high
ionization energy and low enthalpy of solvation of the ions.
Lattice energies may also provide some information about the ionic/covalent nature of the bonding.
If the lattice energy is calculated theoretically assuming ionic bonding then the value can be compared
with the experimental value for the lattice energy obtained from the experimentally measured quantities
in the Born–Haber cycle. Close agreement indicates that the assumption that bonding is ionic is in fact
true, whilst poor agreement may indicate that the bonding is not ionic. A number of lattice energies are
compared in table 3.14. the agreement is good for all the compounds listed except for CdI2, confrming
that these are ionic. the large discrepancy for CdI2 indicates that the structure is not ionic, and in fact it
forms a layer structure which is appreciably covalent.
electrons are drawn from the negative ion towards the positive ion, resulting in a high concentration of
electrons between the two nuclei, and a large degree of covalent character results.
The extent to which ion distortion occurs depends on the power of an ion to distort the other
ion (that is on its polarizing power) and also on how susceptible the ion is to distortion (that is on its
polarizability). Generally the polarizing power increases as ions become smaller and more highly charged.
The polarizability of a negative ion is greater than that of a positive ion since the electrons are less frmly
bound because of the differences in effective nuclear charge. Large negative ions are more polarizable
than small ones.
Fajans put forward four rules which summarize the factors favouring polarization and hence covalency.
1. A small positive ion favours covalency.
In small ions the positive charge is concentrated over a small area. This makes the ion highly polarizing,
and very good at distorting the negative ion.
2. A large negative ion favours covalency.
Large ions are highly polarizable, that is easily distorted by the positive ion, because the outermost
electrons are shielded from the charge on the nucleus by flled shells of electrons.
3. Large charges on either ion, or on both ions, favour covalency.
This is because a high charge increases the amount of polarization.
4. Polarization, and hence covalency, is favoured if the positive ion does not have a noble gas confguration.
Examples of ions which do not have a noble gas confguration include a few main group elements
such as Tl+, Pb2+ and Bi3+, many transition metal ions such as Ti 3+, V3+, Cr 2+, Mn 2+ and Cu+, and some
lanthanide metal ions such as Ce3+ and Eu2+. A noble gas confguration is the most effective at shielding
the nuclear charge, so ions without the noble gas confguration will have high charges at their surfaces,
and thus be highly polarizing.
Exceptions of ‘smaller size cation causes higher polarization’ are as follows.
Cd 2+ 0.78 Å
Hg 2+ 0.96 Å
The radius increases down the group and it is expected that the polarizing power should also decrease. But it
actually increases, and this is because Zeffective increases down the group as much as the number of low shield•
ing electron increases. The above observation is supported by the fact that the covalent character order is
ZnCl 2 < CdCl 2 < HgCl 2
and the dissociation observed is
in
ZnCl 2 water
→ Zn 2 + + 2Cl − ; 100% dissociation
HgCl 2 in
water
→ Hg 2 + + 2Cl − ; only 2% dissociation
Similarly the colour for the sulphides of these metals is also intensifed.
ZnS (white) → CdS (yellow) → HgS (black)
Lattice energy = ∫ 2
=−
∞
r r
when two opposite charges q1 and q2 are brought to the internuclear distance of r from infnity and k
is the proportionality constant. Here, q1 = z+e and q2 = z-e and z+ and z- are the charges in positive and
negative ions and e is the charge on an electron.
Hence
Lattice energy ∝ q1 q2
1
and Lattice energy ∝
r
The variations in the lattice energy with change in the charge and distance factor, in different situa•
tions, are discussed as follows:
a. When the internuclear distance factor is kept same and the charge factor (q1q2) is varied. For example,
+2 −2 +3 −3 +4 −4
Compounds +1 −1
Na F Mg O Sc N Ti C
q1 q2 1 4 9 16
Hence,
Lattice energy order: NaF < MgO < ScN < TiC
Melting point order: NaF < MgO < ScN < TiC
Hardness order: NaF < MgO < ScN < TiC
b. When charge factor (q1 q2) is fxed and the internuclear distance factor is varied, then with the
increase in the value of r, the lattice energy and melting point decreases. For example,
(i) For the series BeO, MgO, CaO, SrO and BaO
Melting point order: MgO > CaO > BeO > SrO > BaO
Lattice energy order: BeO > MgO > CaO > SrO > BaO
_
@edubuzznotes
122 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
2. When the polarization is dominating factor: When P increases and melting point decreases. Again
polarization will vary with the following factors.
a. When the charge on the cation increases and the radius decreases.
Covalent character order: NaX < MgX2 < AlX3
Melting point order: NaX > MgX2 > AlX3
where X = Cl, Br, I
_
@edubuzznotes
3.26 Solubility of Ionic Compounds 123
b. When the charge on the cation remains the same but the size of the cation increases, the polariza•
tion decreases and melting point increases. For example,
(i) For the series BeX2, MgX2, CaX2, SrX2, BaX2
Covalent character order: BeX2 > MgX2 > CaX2 > SrX2 > BaX2
Melting point order: BeX2 < MgX2 < CaX2 < SrX2 < BaX2
(ii) For the series LiX, NaX, KX, RbX, CsX
Covalent character order: LiX > NaX > KX > RbX > CsX
where X = Cl, Br, I
But the melting point order is not decided accordingly, since the extent of polarization is low
enough due to lower charges of cation.
c. When the size of the anion increases, polarization increases and melting point decreases. For example,
(i) For the series where M+ is Li+ to Cs+.
Covalent character order: MF < MCl < MBr < MI
Melting point order: MF >MCl > MBr > MI
(ii) For the series where M2+ is Be2+ to Ba2+.
Covalent character order: MF2 < MCl2 < MBr2 < MI2
Melting point order: MF2 >MCl2 >MBr2 > MI2
(iii) For the series AlX3, where X = F, Cl, Br, I
Covalent character order: AlF3 < AlCl3 < AlBr3 < AlI3
Melting point order: AlF3 > AlCl3 > AlI3 > AlBr3
Here another parameter works to decide the melting point order, i.e. for the covalently bonded
molecule, higher the molecule weight, higher will be the melting point. Hence the expected order is
AlCl3 < AlBr3 < AlI3
and the overall order is as above.
more the covalent character, higher will be the solubility in relatively non•polar solvent.
this information helps us choose the correct solvent for a reaction. for example, in finkelstein
reaction,
in water
CH 3Cl + KI ↽ CH 3 I + KCl
⇀
and in acetone
in acetone
CH 3Cl + KI
→ CH 3 I + KCl ↓
In water the reaction is reversible and the yield of CH3I is not good. However, in acetone the per•
centage yield is very good in acetone because KCl is insoluble in acetone and makes the reaction
unidirectional.
2. When the lattice energy and hydration energy are the dominating factors: the mechanism for dissolu•
tion process of an ionic compound is shown below.
MX(s)
+U Mn+(g) + Xn (g)
−∆Hc −∆Ha
∆HS
Mn+(aq) + Xn−(aq)
∆HS = U + ∆H h
(i) If ∆HS > T ∆SS , then ∆G is positive and the compound is insoluble at the temperature T. for
example, PbCl2 and CH3CO2Ag are sparingly soluble in cold water while completely soluble in
hot water because with the increase in temperature, the situation reverses and ∆HS < T ∆SS
and ∆GS becomes negative.
(ii) If ∆HS < T ∆SS , then ∆GS is negative and the compound is soluble and this solubility is
governed by huge the entropy change only. for example, solubility of NaNO3 and KNO3, etc.
k1 k2
∆H c = and ∆Ha = (where ∆H h = ∆H c + ∆Ha )
rc ra
1
Also, lattice energy U∝
rc + ra
k3
U=
rc + ra
or
where rc and ra are the radii of cation and anion respectively. therefore
∆HS = ∆H h + U
= ∆H c + ∆Ha + U
k1 k2 k
∆HS = + + 3 (3.6)
rc ra rc + ra
k1 k2 k3
∆HS = + + (3.7)
rc ra ra
for the compounds having the same anion (k2 ra ) + (k3 ra ) remains constant, therefore
1
∆HS ∝
rc
thus with increase in radius of the cation down the group, ∆HS becomes less and less negative and so
does ∆GS. Hence the solubility decreases down the group. for example,
a. LiClO4 > NaClO4 > KClO4 > RbClO4> CsClO4
b. LiNO3 > NaNO3 > KNO3 > RbNO3.> CsNO3
c. NaI > LiI > KI > RbI > CsI
Lithium iodide is the alkali metal halide which has maximum polarization, and this high polariza•
tion causes lower solubility in polar solvent. Hence it is not at the expected position in the order.
d. LiBr > NaBr > KBr > RbBr > CsBr
e. CaCrO4 > SrCrO4 > BaCrO4
f. Be(NO3)2 > Mg(NO3)2 > Ca(NO3)2 > Sr(NO3)2 > Ba(NO3)2
g. BeCO3 > MgCO3 > CaCO3 > SrCO3 > BaCO3
h. BeSO4 > MgSO4 > CaSO4 > SrSO4 > BaSO4
i. CaSO3 > SrSO3 >BaSO3
j. CaS2O3 > Sr S2O3 > BaS2O3
k. BeX2 > MgX2 > CaX2 > SrX2 > BaX2 (where X = Cl, Br, I)
Exceptions where rc << ra but solubility increases down the group, are given as follows:
a. CaC2O4 < SrC2O4 < BaC2O4 < BeC2O4
BeC2O4 is the exception of this trend.
b. Li2CO3 < Na2CO3 < K2CO3 < Rb2CO3 < Cs2CO3
c. NaHCO3 < KHCO3 < RbHCO3 < CsHCO3
_
@edubuzznotes
126 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
LiHCO3 is absent in the trend because it does not exist in the solid form.
In case of NaHCO3 it is observed that HCO3– ions are attracted to each other by very strong
hydrogen bonds which are formed by ion–dipole interaction.
O O
O O− O O−
H C H C H C H C
O O− O O
−
O O
The voids generated by the HCO3– ions in the lattice are best ftted with Na+ ion. As the size of cation
increases down the group, HCO3– ions become far apart from each other to accommodate the cation,
and the hydrogen bonds become weaker. Hence the energy required to break the crystal becomes
less and less, and the solubility increases down the group.
2. When rc » ra, then the lattice energy parameter is the deciding factor for solubility order. For the
compounds having same (q1 q2) factor, as the inter•ionic distance (rc + ra) increases, the lattice energy
decreases and solubility increases down the group. This can be explained as follows.
k1 k2 k
∆HS = + + 3
rc ra rc +ra
k1 k2 k3
∆HS = + +
rc ra 2rc
(as rc » ra)
For the compounds having the same anion like LiF to CsF, the k2 ra term is constant. It is observed
that the variation of lattice energy term k3 2rc is more prominent as compared to the hydration energy
term k1 rc for the variation of rc from Li+ to Cs+. Hence the solubility increases down the group. For
example,
a. LiF < NaF < KF < RbF < CsF
b. LiOH < NaOH < KOH < RbOH < CsOH
c. Be(OH)2 < Mg(OH)2 < Ca(OH)2 < Sr(OH)2 < Ba(OH)2
d. MgF2 < CaF2 < SrF2 < BaF2 < BeF2.
BeF2 is the exception to the trend
The solubility of alkali metals halides at a glance:
the intensity of colour in ionic compounds increases with the increase in polarization. for example,
Some important points related to the colour of halides are listed as follows:
1. It is not mandatory that all iodides will be coloured, e.g. NaI, KI, CuI are colourless.
2. for a particular metal ion, if the iodide is colourless, other halides must be colourless.
3. for a particular metal ion, if the bromide is colourless, then its iodide may be coloured but fuoride and
chloride must be colourless.
long as the shorter axis. Both the arrangements may exist together only when the molecule is having
higher attractive forces than the thermal energy, and it is true for both solids and liquids. With increase
in temperature, these orientations become more random. The hydrogen bonding is a special case of
this type of interaction due to its high energy release.
2. Dipole–induced dipole interaction (or Debye forces): When the
dipolar end of a polar molecule is introduced in the environment of − + d− d+
a non•polar molecule, it can induce a dipole moment in the adjacent
non•polar molecule (Figure 3.75). Then this induced dipole can inter•
act electrostatically with the polarizing dipole. Figure 3.75 Induced dipole.
This kind of interaction explains the solubility of noble gases in water, and formation of noble
gas hydrates like Ar⋅6H2O, Kr⋅6H2O, and Xe⋅6H2O. The solubility order for noble gases in water is:
He < Ne < Ar < Kr < Xe. This is due to the increased polarizability of the larger inert gas molecules.
Similarly, other derivatives of inert gases, Kr(phenol)2, Xe(phenol)2, and Rn(phenol)2 result from
this kind of interaction.
Note: He and Ne do not form clathrate compounds due to their small size.
3. Instantaneous dipole–induced dipole interaction (London forces): Molecules or atoms which have no
permanent dipole are also attracted to each other and this is evident from the formation of liquid X2
(where X = H, F, O, N, Cl, etc.) and liquid He. In such a molecule, at any point of time an instantaneous
dipole is developed which induces dipole in the other nearby non•polar molecule, thereby producing
dipole•induced dipole interactions. These interactions are known as London forces.
London forces can be used to explain the formation of the following:
a. Formation of liquid H2: The electronic distribution
in H2 molecules can be represented as shown in H− H+ H H H+ H−
Figure 3.76.
On the time average these molecules are non•polar
but at a particular moment, the molecule may
become polar and the actual molecules may be a Figure 3.76 Electronic distribution in
combination of all the three structure shown in H 2 molecule.
Figure 3.76.
The development of induced dipole and its inter• d+ d−
d+ d− + −
action in H2 molecule is shown in Figure 3.77.
b. Formation of liquid He: It is observed that two
electrons in 1s orbital of He are not diametri•
cally opposite always. Hence an instantaneous Figure 3.77 Instantaneous dipole-induced
dipole is developed that induces dipole in adja• dipole interaction in H2 molecule.
cent atoms (Figure 3.78).
London forces work in polar and non•polar d−
molecules and are dependent on the fol•
dd + dd −
lowing factors and increases rapidly with
d+
increase in: He He
(expected) (sometimes)
(i) Number of polarizable electrons.
(ii) Molecular weight.
Figure 3.78 Instantaneous dipole-induced
(iii) Molecular volume and surface area dipole interaction in He molecule.
available for interaction.
Based on these, the effects of London forces on melting and boiling points of compounds are
described as follows:
_
@edubuzznotes
130 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
b. When molecular weight is the same, molecular surface area is the responsible factor. For example,
in isomeric alkanes as branching increases the surface area available for interaction decreases,
resulting in the following melting/boiling point order in general:
n•butane > isobutane
n•pentane > iso•pentane > neo•pentane (for boiling point)
But the melting point order is neo•pentane > iso•pentane > n•pentane.
c. When the number of electrons is the same but molecular weight varies, boiling/melting point
increases with increase in molecular weight. For example,
H2 < D2 < T2
Boiling point: 20 K 23 K 25 K
d. When polarizability of the attached groups is dominating over molecular weight, boiling point
increases with increase in polarizability. For example, since methyl group is more polarizable than
F atom, the boiling point order is
BF3 < BMe3
NF3 < NMe3
e. The boiling point of H2 (20 K) is more as compared to that of He (4.2 K). The extent of induction
is more prominent in case of H2 (which is caused by full positive or negative charge) as compared
to that in He (which is caused by partial positive or negative charge).
f. The molecular weight of fuorocarbons are signifcantly higher than those of corresponding hydro•
carbons, yet their melting points and boiling points are less, particularly for higher members. The
boiling points of some fuorocarbons and corresponding hydrocarbons are given in Table 3.15.
Since fuorine is more electronegative as compared to carbon, a negative charge cloud density is devel•
oped at the periphery of the molecule which repels other molecules. This kind of repulsive force reduces
the attraction among the molecules and is responsible for the observed order of boiling points.
g. The boiling point order for SiCl4 and CCl4 is CCl4 > SiCl4 though the molecular weight of SiCl4 is more
than that of CCl4. The reason is the same as discussed above for hydrocarbons and furorcarbons.
The partial negative cloud density in case of SiCl4 is more as compared to that in CCl4 because the ΔEN
(Cl - Si) = 3.16 – 1.8 = 1.36 while ΔEN (Cl – C) = 3.16 – 2.5 = 0.66. The increase in ΔEN value is suf•
fcient to overcome the percentage increase in molecular weight which is only 10–11%.
Note: The van der Waals forces denoted by Eattractive and the net Eattractive = EK + ED + EL
where EK : Keesom forces
ED : Debye forces
EL : London forces
_
@edubuzznotes
3.31 Interactions between Ions and Covalent Molecules 131
Lennard–Jones potential
r
The net interaction energy (also called as Lennard– O
Jones potential) is expressed by ET.
ET = Eattractive + Erepulsive
−A/r 6
A B (−)ve
= +
r6 rn
The plot of ET with r is shown in Figure 3.79. Figure 3.79 Plot of Lennard–Jones potential
with internuclear distance.
+ −
−
−
+
+ +
− +
−
−
+
+
Xn−
+
Mn+
+
+
−
−
+ +
−
− +
−
+
−
−
+
Figure 3.80 Ion–dipole interactions between ionic compounds and polar solvents.
d+ d−
X X X X X X
Non-polar
Ion After induction
molecules
Figure 3.81 Ion-induced dipole interactions between ionic compounds and polar or non-polar molecules.
_
@edubuzznotes
132 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
All the above interactions depend on the internuclear distance, and decrease with increase in this distance.
Their energy–distance relation is given in Table 3.16.
Conductivity
All metals are exceptionally good conductors of heat and electricity. Electrical conduction arises by the
movement of electrons. This is in contrast to the movement of ions which is responsible for conduction in
aqueous solution or fused melts of ionic compounds like sodium chloride, where sodium ions migrate to
the cathode, and chloride ions migrate to the anode. In the solid state, ionic compounds may conduct to a
very small extent (semiconduction) if defects are present in the crystal. There is an enormous difference in
the conductivity between metals and any other type of solid (Table 3.17).
Most of the elements to the left of carbon in the periodic table are metals. A carbon atom has four
outer electrons. If these are all used to form four bonds, the outer shell is complete and there are no
electrons free to conduct electricity.
2s 2p
half-full
Carbon atom excited stale inner
shell
Elements to the left of carbon have fewer electrons, and so they must have vacant orbitals. Both the number
of electrons present in the outer shell, and the presence of vacant orbitals in the valence shell, are important
features in explaining the conductivity and bonding of metals.
The conductivity of metals decreases with increasing temperature. Metals show some degree of para•
magnetism, which indicates that they possess unpaired electrons.
Lustre
Smooth surfaces of metals typically have a lustrous shiny appearance. All metals except copper and gold
are silvery in colour. (Note that when fnely divided most metals appear dull grey or black.) The shininess
is rather special, and is observed at all viewing angles, in contrast to the shininess of a few non•metallic
elements such as sulphur and iodine which appear shiny when viewed at low angles. Metals are used as mir•
rors because they refect light at all angles. This is because of the ‘free’ electrons in the metal, which absorb
energy from light and re•emit it when the electron drops back from its excited state to its original energy
level. Since light of all wavelengths (colours) is absorbed, and is immediately re•emitted, practically all the
light is refected back – hence the lustre. The reddish and golden colours of copper and gold occur because
they absorb some colours more readily than others.
Many metals emit electrons when exposed to light – the photoelectric effect. Some emit electrons
when irradiated with short•wave radiation, and others emit electrons on heating (thermionic emission).
The cohesive force may be measured as the heat of atomization. Some numerical values of ΔH°, the
heats of atomization at 25 °C, are given in Table 3.17. The heats of atomization (cohesive energy) decrease
on descending a group in the periodic table Li–Na–K–Rb–Cs, showing that they are inversely proportional
to the internuclear distance.
The cohesion energy increases across the periodic table from Group 1 to Group 2 to Group 13. This
suggests that the strength of metallic bonding is related to the number of valency electrons. The cohesive
energy increases at frst on crossing the transition series Sc–Ti–V as the number of unpaired d electrons
increases. Continuing across the transition series the number of electrons per atom involved in metallic
bonding eventually falls, as the d electrons become paired, reaching a minimum at Zn.
The melting points and to an even greater extent the boiling points of the metals follow the trends in
the cohesive energies. The cohesive energies vary over an appreciable range, and they approach the mag•
nitude of the lattice energy which holds ionic crystals together. The cohesive energies are much larger than
the weak van der Waals forces which hold discrete covalent molecules together in the solid state.
There are two rules about the cohesive energy and structure of metals (or alloys), and these are
examined as follows:
Rule 1. The bonding energy of a metal depends on the average number of unpaired electrons available
for bonding on each atom.
Rule 2. The crystal structure adopted depends on the number of s and p orbitals on each atom that are
involved with bonding.
_
@edubuzznotes
134 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
Consider the frst rule – Group 1 metals have the outer electronic confguration ns1, and so have one
electron for bonding. In the ground state (lowest energy), Group 2 elements have the electronic confg•
uration ns2, but if the atom is excited, an outer electron is promoted, giving the confguration ns1, np1,
with two unpaired electrons, which can form two bonds. Similarly Group 13 elements in the ground
state have the confguration ns2, np1, but when excited to ns1, np2, they can use three electrons for metallic
bonding.
Table 3.18 Enthalpies of atomization ΔH° (kJ mol–1) (Measured at 25 °C except for Hg)
Metal ΔH° Melting point Boiling point
(°C) (°C)
Li 162 181 1331
Na 108 98 890
K 90 64 766
Rb 82 39 701
Cs 78 29 685
The second rule attempts to relate the number of s and p electrons available for bonding to the crystal
structure adopted (Table 3.19). Apart from Group 1 metals, the atoms need to be excited, and the structures
adopted are shown in Table 3.20.
Group 1 elements have a body•centred cubic structure, and follow the rule. In Group 2, only Be and
Mg have a hexagonal close•packed structure and strictly follow the rule. In Group 13, Al has a cubic close•
packed structure as expected. However, not all the predictions are correct. There is no obvious reason why
Ca and Sr form cubic close•packed structures. However, the high temperature forms of Ca and Sr, and the
room temperature form of Ba, form body•centred cubic structures (like Group 1), instead of the expected
hexagonal close•packed structure. The explanation is probably that the paired s electron is excited to a
d level instead of a p level, and hence there is only one s or p electron per atom participat•
ing in metallic bonding. This also explains why the frst half of the transition metals also form
_
@edubuzznotes
3.32 The Metallic Bond 135
Table 3.20 Type of structure adopted by metals in the periodic table (The room tempera-
ture structure is shown at the bottom. Other structures which occur at higher temperatures
are listed above this in order of temperature stability)
Li Be B C N
bcc hcp
Na Mg Al Si P S
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se
bcc
ccp bcc
bcc bcc β ccp ccp
bcc ccp hcp hcp bcc bcc X bcc hcp ccp ccp hcp d a
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te
bcc
hcp bcc bcc
bcc ccp hcp hcp bcc bcc hcp hcp ccp ccp ccp hcp ccp∗ d α
Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po
bcc
ccp bcc bcc
bcc bcc hcp hcp bcc bcc hcp hcp hcp ccp ccp hep ccp a
body•centred cubic structures. In the second half of the transition series, the extra electrons may be put in the
p level, to avoid pairing d electrons, and so allow the maximum participation of d orbitals in metallic bond•
ing. This increases the number of s and p electrons involved in metallic bonding, and for example in Cu, Ag
and Au the excited electronic state involved in bonding is probably d 8, s1, p2, giving a cubic close•packed
structure and fve bonds per atom (two d, one s and two p electrons). At Zn the d orbitals are full, and the
excited state used for bonding is 3d10, 4s1, 4p1, giving two bonds per atom and a body•centred cubic struc•
ture. The enthalpies of atomization are in general agreement with these ideas on bonding.
six next•nearest neighbours about 15% further away. If this small difference in distance between nearest and
next•nearest neighbours is disregarded, the coordination number for a body•centred cubic structure may
be regarded loosely as 14. The mechanical properties of malleability and ductility depend on the ease with
which adjacent planes of atoms can glide over each other, to give an equivalent arrangement of spheres.
These properties are also affected by physical imperfections such as grain boundaries and dislocations, by
point defects in the crystal lattice and by the presence of traces of impurity in the lattice. The possibility of
planes gliding is greatest in cubic close•packed structures, which are highly symmetrical and have possible
slip planes of close•packed layers in four directions (along the body diagonals), compared with only one
direction in the hexagonal close•packed structure. This explains why cubic close•packed structures are gener•
ally softer and more easily deformed than hexagonal or body•centred cubic structures. Impurities may cause
dislocations in the normal metal lattice, and the localized bonding increases the hardness. Some soft metals
like Cu become work hardened – it is harder to bend the metal a second time. This is because dislocations are
caused by the frst bending, and these disrupt the slip planes. Other metals such as Sb and Bi are brittle. This
is because they have directional bonds, which pucker layers, preventing one layer from slipping over another.
The type of packing varies with the position of the element in the periodic table (Table 3.20), which
is related to the number of s and p electrons on each atom that can take part in metallic bonding. This has
been described earlier.
Metallic elements commonly react with other metallic elements, often over a wide range of composition,
forming a variety of alloys which look like metals, and have the properties of metals.
Bond lengths
If the valence electrons in a metal are spread over a large number of bonds, each bond should be weaker
and hence longer. The alkali metals exist as diatomic molecules in the vapour state, and the interatomic
distances in the metal crystal are longer than in the diatomic molecule (Table 3.21).
Though the bonds in the metal are longer and weaker, there are many more of them than in the
M2 molecule, so the total bonding energy is greater in the metal crystal. This can be seen by comparing
the enthalpy of sublimation of the metal crystal with the enthalpy of dissociation of the M2 molecules
(Table 3.22).
1s 2s 2p
Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li
Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li Li* Li Li Li Li Li Li Li*
(a) (b) (c) (d)
The Li2 molecule exists in the vapour state, and bonding occurs using the 2s atomic orbital. There are
three empty 2p orbitals in the valence shell, and the presence of empty AOs is a prerequisite for metallic
properties. (Carbon in its excited state, nitrogen, oxygen, fuorine, and neon all lack empty AOs in the
valence shell and are all non•metals.)
_
@edubuzznotes
138 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
The valence shell has more AOs than electrons, so even if the electrons are all used to form normal
two•electron bonds, the atom cannot attain a noble gas structure. Compounds of this type are termed
‘electron defcient’.
Empty AOs may be utilized to form additional bonds in two different ways:
1. Empty AOs may accept lone pairs of electrons from other atoms or ligands, forming coordinate bonds.
2. Cluster compounds may be formed, where each atom shares its few electrons with several of its neigh•
bours, and obtains a share in their electrons. Clustering occurs in the boron hydrides and carboranes,
and is a major feature of metals.
The molecular orbital description of an Li2 molecule has been discussed earlier in Section 3.12, in the
examples of MO treatment. There are six electrons arranged in molecular orbitals:
s 1s2, s *1s2, s 2s2
Bonding occurs because the s 2s bonding MO is full and the corresponding antibonding orbital is
empty. Ignoring any inner electrons, the 2s AOs on each of the two Li atoms combine to give two MOs –
one bonding and one antibonding. The valency electrons occupy the bonding MO (Figure 3.83a).
Suppose three Li atoms joined to form Li3. Three 2s AOs would combine to form three MOs – one
bonding, one non•bonding and one antibonding. The energy of the non•bonding MO is between that for
the bonding and antibonding orbitals. The three valency electrons from the three atoms would occupy the
bonding MO (two electrons) and the non•bonding MO (one electron) (Figure 3.83b).
In Li4, the four AOs would form four MOs – two bonding, and two antibonding. The presence of two
non•bonding MOs between the bonding and antibonding orbitals reduces the energy gap between the
orbitals. The four valency electrons would occupy the two lowest energy MOs, which are both bonding
orbitals, as shown in Figure 3.83c.
Antibonding
(a) Li2
2s 2s
Atom Atom
1 2
Bonding
Antibonding
(b) Li3
2s 2s 2s
Non-bonding
Atom Atom Atom
1 2 3
Bonding
(b) Li4
2s 2s 2s 2s
As the number of electrons in the cluster increases, the spacing between the energy levels of the various
orbitals decreases further, and when there are a large number of atoms, the energy levels of the orbitals are
so close together that they almost form a continuum (Figure 3.83d).
The number of MOs must by defnition be equal to the number of constituent AOs. Since there is only
one valence electron per atom in lithium, and a MO can hold two electrons, it follows that only half the
MOs in the 2s valence band are flled –i.e. the bonding MOs. It requires only a minute amount of energy to
perturb an electron to an unoccupied MO.
The MOs extend in three dimensions over all the atoms in the crystal, so electrons have a high degree
of mobility. The mobile electrons account for the high thermal and electrical conduction of metals.
If one end of a piece of metal is heated, electrons at that end gain energy and move to an unoccu•
pied MO where they can travel rapidly to any other part of the metal, which in turn becomes hot. In an
analogous manner, electrical conduction takes place through a minor perturbation in energy promoting an
electron to an unflled level, where it can move readily. In the absence of an electric feld, equal numbers
of electrons will move in all directions. If a positive electrode is placed at one end, and a negative electrode
at the other, then electrons will move towards the anode much more readily than in the opposite direction;
hence an electric current fows.
Conduction occurs because the MOs extend over the whole crystal, and because there is effectively no
energy gap between the flled and unflled MOs. The absence of an energy gap in lithium is because only
half the MOs in the valence band are flled with electrons (Figure 3.84a).
In beryllium there are two valence electrons, so the valence electrons would just fll the 2s valence
band of MOs. In an isolated beryllium atom, the 2s and 2p atomic orbitals differ in energy by 160 kJ mol–1.
In much the same way as the 2s AOs form a band of MOs, the 2p AOs form a 2p band of MOs. The upper
part of the 2s band overlaps with the lower part of the 2p band (Figure 3.84b). Because of this overlap of
the bands some of the 2p band is occupied and some of the 2s band is empty. It is both possible and easy
to perturb electrons to an unoccupied level in the conduction band, where they can move throughout the
crystal. Beryllium therefore behaves as a metal. It is only because the bands overlap that there is no energy
gap, so perturbation from the flled valence band to the empty conduction band can occur.
Atomic Molecular
orbitals orbitals
Atomic Molecular
orbitals orbitals
Empty
2p 2p band levels
Empty
levels
2s 2s band
Occupied
levels 2s 2s band Occupied
levels
(a) (b)
Figure 3.84 Two methods by which conduction can occur: (a) metallic molecular orbitals for lithium
showing half-filled band; (b) metallic molecular orbitals for beryllium showing overlapping bands.
Intrinsic semiconductors are basically insulators, where the energy gap between adjacent bands is
suffciently small for thermal energy to be able to promote a small number of electrons from the full
valence band to the empty conduction band. Both the promoted electron in the conduction band and the
unpaired electron left in the valence band can conduct electricity. The conductivity of semiconductors
increases with temperature, because the number of electrons promoted to the conduction band increases
as the temperature increases. Both n•type and p•type semiconductors are produced by doping an insulator
with a suitable impurity. The band from the impurity lies in between the valence and conduction bands in
the insulator, and acts as a bridge, so that electrons may be excited from the insulator bands to the impurity
bands, or vice versa (Figure 3.85).
Energy Energy
Partially
filled
Conductor Conductor
Small gap
Large gap Impurity
band
Filled
Filled Filled
Impurity
Insulator Intrinsic semiconductor
semiconductor
3. What is the shape of the cationic part of solid Cl2O6? 12. Which of the following interactions is responsible for
(A) Distorted octahedral the formation of clathrate compounds?
(B) Square pyramidal (A) Instantaneous dipole•induced dipole interaction
(C) Square planar (B) Ion•dipole interaction
(D) None of these
(C) Dipole•dipole interaction
4. Which of the following orders of boiling point is (D) Dipole•induced dipole interaction
incorrect?
(A) CH4 < CF4 (B) BF3 < BMe3 13. Which of the following orders is correct?
(C) I2 < Br2 < Cl2 < F2 (D) Br2 < I – Cl (A) CH3F > CH3Cl (dipole moment)
bond angle in CH NCS is: (B) HF > H2O (extent of hydrogen bonding)
5. The CNC 3
(C) C5H12 > C5F12 (boiling point)
(A) < 109°28′ (B) < 120°
(D) KCl > NaCl (solubility in water)
(C) > 120° (D) 112°
14. Which of the following statements is correct for
6. Which of the following orders is incorrect? (X = F/Cl)
(A) CH2F2 < CHF3 < (FCF)
(B) CH2F2 < CH2 Cl2 (XCX)
(C) CHF3 < CHCl3 (XCX)
(D) CF4 < CCl4 (XCX) (A) It contains pp − pp and pp − dp
(B) It has regular tetrahedral geometry.
7. Which of the following statements is correct? (C) q 1 > q 3
(A) C−F both length: CH3F < CHF3
(D) Plane which contains maximum number of atom
(B) O−F bond length: O2F2 < OF2
bond angle: OCF < OCCl is 4.
(C) (XCX) 2 2
bond angle in OCCl > HCH
(D) (CICCI) 2
bond 15. In which of the following processes electron is not
angle in O = CH2 added to molecular orbital having gerade symmetry?
(A) O+2 → O2− (B) N +2 → N 2−
8. Which of the following statements is/are correct for
H2C = SF4? (C) B2 → B2− (D) C 2 → N 22 −
(I) Double bond lies in equatorial position. 16. If Hund’s rule and sp intermixing is/are not consid•
(II) It is a non•planar and polar molecule. ered, then which of the following characteristics is
(III) Maximum number of atoms in a plane is 6. changed in C2?
(A) I, II (B) II, III (A) Number of electrons in gerade molecular orbital
(C) I, III (D) I, II, III (B) Bond order
9. Which of the following molecules is polar as well as (C) Magnetic behaviour
non•planar? (D) Magnetic moment
(A) P(CH3)3 (CF3)2 (B) POF3 17. A silicate mineral has chemical formula Ca2Mgx
(C) OF2 (D) SO2 Si8O22(OH)2 and is known as tremolite. Predict the
value of x.
10. Consider the following statements:
(I) In OSF4, Feq − Sɵ − Feq > Feq − Sɵ = O (A) 3 (B) 4
(II) The bond angle of PF3 is greater than PH3 but (C) 2 (D) 5
the bond angle of NF3 is lesser than NH3. 18. In which of the following N–N bond length is the
(III) The % s•character in the orbital containing shortest?
lone pair of H2O molecule is 30%. (A) N2O (B) N 3−
= 104°5 and cos(104.5) = −0.25]
[(HOH) (C) N2O4 (D) N2O3 (unsymmetrical)
Which of the following statements is/are correct? 19. Select the correct order of H – M – H bond angle.
(A) I, II (B) II, III (A) PH3 > PH+4 (B) P2H4 > PH+4
(C) I, III (D) I, II, III (C) PH3 > NH+4 (D) PH+4 > NH3
11. Choose the correct order of boiling point. 20. Compare bond angle x and y in the following
(A) H2 < He molecules.
(B) B(OH)3 < B(OMe)3
(C) NF3 < NMe3
(D) CCl4 < SiCl4
_
@edubuzznotes
142 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
(A) x > y (B) y > x 29. Which of the following molecules is non•
(C) x = y (D) None of these planar?
21. Choose the correct statement from the following (A) CFH
ɺ
2 (B) CF
ɺ H
2
36. Calculate the percentage of p character in the orbital (A) All C-F bond lengths are identical.
occupied by the lone pair of electrons in water (B) Two C-F bonds attached to middle carbon atom
is 104.5° and cos (104.5°)
molecule. [Given HOH are longer as compared to the other C-F bond at
= -0.25] the terminal carbon.
(A) 80% (B) 20% (C) 70% (D) 75% (C) Two C-F bonds attached to the middle carbon
atom are shorter as compared to the other C-F
37. Give the correct order of initials True (T) or False (F) bond at the terminal carbon.
for the following statements. (D) None of these.
(I) sp3 hybrid orbitals are at 90° to one another.
(II) Adjacent sp3d2 hybrid orbitals are at 90° to one 46. Which of the following statements is not correct
another. regarding NO2 molecule?
(III) sp2 hybrid orbitals are at 120° to one another. (A) Paramagnetic behaviour decreases when it
undergoes in dimerization.
(IV) Bond order of N – O bond in NO3- is 1 1 .
3 (B) It is coloured in its dimeric form.
(A) T F T F (B) T T F F (C) F T T T (D) F T F T (C) The colour is due to the presence of unpaired
electron.
38. Which among the following species is not perfectly (D) The free electron is present in one of the sp2
planar? hybrid orbital.
ɺ
(A) CH ɺ
(B) CHF (C) : CF2 ɺ
(D) NO 47. PClxF5–x molecule will be polar and non•polar for
3 2 2
what values of x respectively?
39. Which of the following molecules has the maximum Polar Non•polar Polar Non•polar
number of A–X bonds of identical length, where ‘A’ (A) 2, 3, 5 and 0, 4, 1 (B) 0, 2, 5 and 3, 1, 4
is the central atom and ‘X’ is the surrounding atom? (C) 4, 3, 0 and 2, 0, 4 (D) 2, 1, 4 and 3, 0, 5
(A) SF6 (B) IF7
48. Which of the following molecules/species has the
(C) PF5 (D) ClO4−.
minimum number of lone pairs?
40. Which of the following sequences shows the correct (A) ICl3 (B) BF4– (C) SnCl2 (D) XeF4
bond angle order for isoelectronic species O3, NO2– 49. Find the pair of species having the same shape but
and NOF? different hybridization of the central atom.
(A) NO2− > NOF > O3 (B) O3 > NO2– > NOF (A) SO3, CO32
–
(B) NO2–, ClO2–
(C) O3 < NO2– < NOF (D) Cannot be predicted (C) BeCl2, HCN (D) XeF2, SnCl2
41. The shape of [ClF4]– and [ClF2]– ions is respectively 50. Which of the following statements is incorrect
(A) See–saw and linear. regarding Cl2O molecule?
(B) See–saw and bent. (A) The molecule is planar.
(C) Tetrahedral and linear. (B) The shape of the molecule is bent.
(D) Square planar and linear. (C) The hybridization of the central atom is sp3.
(D) The molecule is non•planar.
42. Which of the following d orbitals is not involved in
d3s hybridization? 51. The hybridization of all carbon atoms in benzene is
(A) sp2 (B) sp3
(A) dx 2 − y2 (B) dxy (C) dyz (D) dxz (C) sp2 and sp3 (D) sp2 and sp
43. Which among the following statements is incorrect? 52. The ratio of s bond and p bond in naphthalene
(A) Half•flled confguration is less stable as is ________.
compared to fully flled confguration. (A) 11 : 5 (B) 2 : 1 (C) 19 : 5 (D) 10 : 4
(B) SbF5 is a hypervalent species.
53. The strongest p bond is present in which of the
(C) SbF5 can act as a Lewis acid.
following species?
(D) All are incorrect.
(A) HC ≡ CH (B) H−C ≡ P
44. Which of the following orders is correct with respect (C) SO42– (D) H2C = CH2
to the given property?
54. Which of the following pairs is iso•structural?
(A) SiF4 > SiCl4 : B.P. order.
(A) BO33– and SO32– (B) NO2+ and CO2
(B) MgCO3 > SrCO3 > BaCO3: pCO2 order when kept
(C) HNC and SnCl2 (D) SnCl3– and SO3
at fxed temperature in a closed container.
(C) XeF2 > XeF4 : Dipole moment order. 55. The dz2 orbital is involved in which of the following
(D) XeF2 > XeF4 : Fluoride•accepting tendency order. hybridizations?
(A) sp3d (square pyramidal) (B) sp3
45. Which of the following statements is correct for 3 2
(C) sp d (D) None of these
F3C-CF2-CF3?
_
@edubuzznotes
144 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
56. Which of the following species has incomplete octet? 60. Which of the following statements is not correct?
− −
(A) Sif4 (B) N3 (C) PBr5 (D) B3 (A) (s + py) produces sp hybrid orbitals which are
lying in the yz plane.
57. Which of the following statements is correct for the (B) (s + py) produces sp hybrid orbitals which are
two molecules, C6H6 and B3 N 3 H 6 ? lying in the xz plane.
(C) (s + px + pz) produces sp2 hybrid orbitals which
(A) C–H bond length is identical with N–H and are lying in the xz plane.
B–H bond lengths. (D) (s + py) produces sp hybrid orbitals which are
(B) the nature of double bond is perfectly identical lying along the y axis.
in both.
(C) Both the molecules are planar. 61. Which is the correct order of the bond angle?
(D) C6H6 is non•polar while B3N3H6 is polar. (A) NH3 < Nf3 (B) H2O > Cl2O
(C) PH3 < SbH3 (D) H2te < H2S
58. Which of the following species has the same number
of X – O – X linkages, where X = S or P? 62. the electronic confgurations of three elements are
(I) S4O62– (II) S3O9 (III) S2O53– (IV) P3O93– as follows:
(A) II & IV (B) II & III L:1s22s22p63s1, M: 1s22s22p4, N: 1s22s22p63s23p1
(C) I & III (D) I & IV Choose the correct formula of the ionic compounds
59. In which of the following processes, the value of formed by the above given elements where the cat•
magnetic moment does not change? ions are written frst as usual.
(A) N 2 → N 2 − (B) N 2 → N 2 + (A) N3M2, LM (B) ML2, M3N2
+ (C) LN, M2L (D) N2M3, L2M
(C) O2 → O2 (D) O2 + → O2 −
(B) Bond length dXe − f ( XeO3 f2 ) < dXe − f ( XeOf4 ) (A) Bef2 + 2 f − → Bef42 −
(C) Shapes are trigonal bipyramidal and square pyra• − −
(B) Bf3 + f → Bf4
midal, respectively. + +
(D) the nature of p•bond is of 5dp – 2pp type. (C) NH 3 + H → NH 4
10. Which of the following statements is/are correct for 17. If polarizing power is in the order of M a+ > M b+ > M c+
XefOSO2f? and polarizability is in the order of X − > Y − > Z − ,
F Xe O F
then select which of the following compounds have
+ −
more covalent character as compared to M b Y ?
S + −
(A) M a+ Y − (B) M b X
O O
(C) M c+ Y − (D) M +b Z −
3
(A) the number of sp hybridized central atom is 3.
18. Which of the following compounds are thermally
(B) the number of identical S–O bond is 2.
more stable than compound CaO2?
(C) Maximum number of atoms that may lie in one
(A) BeO2 (B) BaO2
plane is 5.
(C) SrO2 (D) MgO2
(D) All atoms are lying in the same plane.
19. IE1, IE2 and IE3 of an atom X are 170 kcal/mole, 340
11. Select the correct statement(s) about the following
kcal/mole and 1280 kcal/mole, respectively. If this
chemical species:
atom X forms compounds with O, Cl and N, then
+
O2, O2 , N2, NO, H 2 and H 2−
+ which of following compounds has the least chance
to exist?
(A) Magnetic moment of NO is greater than that (A) X2O3 (B) XCl
of O2. (C) XCl2 (D) X3N2
(B) the bond length of O+2 is shorter than that of O2
20. In which of following processes, do(es) the value of
due to removal of electron from p *.
magnetic moment change?
(C) the ionization energy of N2 is greater than that
(A) CO → CO+ (B) N 2 − → N 2 +
of N.
(D) H +2 is more stable than H 2− although both have (C) Zn → Zn 2 + (D) O2 → O2 −
the same bond order.
21. Choose the correct statement(s) among the following
12. Which of the following orders is/are incorrect, against for HPO32• ions.
the indicated properties? (A) All three HPO angles are identical due to
(A) Agf > AgCl > AgI: Covalent character resonance.
(B) NaHCO3 > KHCO3 < RbHCO3 : Solubility in (B) All bond lengths are identical due to resonance.
water (C) the bond order of all P – O bond is 1.33.
(C) Naf < Mgf2 < Alf3: Melting point (D) None of these.
(D) MgC2O4 > CaC2O4 > BaC2O4: Solubility in water
22. London force works in
13. Select the correct statement(s) among the following. (A) gaseous state. (B) solid state.
(A) When lone pair of surrounding atom is involved (C) liquid state. (D) none of these.
in back bonding, the bond angle does not change
23. Which of the following d orbitals may participate in
anywhere.
sp3d hybridization?
(B) When lone pair of central atom is involved in
(A) dz2 (B) dxy (C) dyz (D) dx 2 − y2
back bonding, the bond angle does not change.
(C) In B3N3H6, all B – N bond lengths are equal and 24. Which of the following options represent incorrect
these are shorter than the single B – N covalent hybridization of its central atom for the respective
bonds due to delocalization of p electrons. species?
(D) Bf3, BCl3 are gaseous, BBr3 is liquid and BI3 is (A) SeCl4 : sp3d (B) Brf4− : sp3d2
solid because when size increases, instantaneous 3
(C) Sif2Cl2 : sp d (D) XeO64−: sp3d3
dipole•induced dipole interaction increases.
25. Which of the following compounds have the same
14. Which of the following molecule have 3c – 2e bond?
shape?
(A) Al2Cl6 (B) Al2(CH3)6
(A) Sf4 (B) Xef4
(C) [Be(OMe)2]n (D) [Be(CH3)2]n
(C) [Asf4]– (D)[SnCl3]–
15. types of bonds in B2H6:
(A) B – B (2c – 2e) (B) B B B (3c – 2e) 26. Which of the following Lewis acid – base interac•
(C) B – H (2c – 2e) (D) B H B (3c – 2e) tions are associated with the further involvement of
d-orbitals?
16. Be(OH)2 forms bridge bonding structure in their
polymeric form of the compounds as given below. (A) Sbf5 + Hf → H + Sbf6 [ ]−
(I) [Be3(OH)8]2− (II) [Be4(OH)10]2− + −
Which types of bonds are present in the above (B) NH 3 + Bf3 → H 3 N − Bf3
compounds? (C) AlCl 3 + Cl − → [ AlCl 4 ]
−
27. Which of the following diagrams indicate the forma• (A) Square pyramidal (B) Linear
tion of p bonds? (C) Square planar (D) Bent
(A) 34. Which of the following species has the maximum
number of lone pairs on the central atom?
(A) BrF4 (B) SO2−
−
4
2−
(C) CO3 (D) XeF3+
(B) 35. Which of following energy terms are associated with
the Born–Haber cycle of dissolution of BaCl2 in
water?
(A) Hydration energy of Ba2+.
(B) Lattice energy of BaCl2.
(C) Sublimation energy of Ba.
(C) (D) Electron affnity of Cl–.
36. The formal charges on different atoms in the Lewis
structure of N3– are:
(A) –1, +1, –1 (B) –1, +1, 0
(C) –2, +1, 0 (D) 0, +1, –2
(D)
37. Choose the correct angle order.
in PH − = HCH
(A) HPH in CH .
4 4
in NH < HPH
(B) HNH in PH
3 3
(C) HNH
in NH < HPH
3
in PH +
4
28. Which of the following can be calculated from the in SO 2− < ONO
(D) OSO in NO −
Born–Haber cycle of formation of Al2O3? 3 3
10. The total number of oxygen atoms shared per unit of boranes have had a fundamental impact on all of chemis•
SiO44 − in beryl [Be2Al2Si6O18] is try, organic as well as inorganic.
(A) 4 (B) 3 There are two series of boranes.
(C) 2 (D) 1 (1) BnHn+4 (called nidoboranes)
(2) BnHn+6 (called Arachno•boranes)
15. Select correct statements about B2H6 (diborane).
Passage 6: For Questions 11–12 (I) It is isoelectronic with ethane.
In the following structures of two compounds (II) It is isostructural with ethane.
(III) Hybridization of each boron is sp3.
(IV) All B•H bonds are identical.
(V) It is a nidoborane.
(A) I, II, III (B) II, III, V
(C) II, IV, V (D) I, III, V
16. Find the maximum number of atoms present in one
plane which is perpendicular to that plane which con•
tains all 2c – 2e bonds of B2H6.
11. Find the ratio of 90° angles in (I) and (II). (A) Two (B) Four
(A) 6 : 5 (B) 5 : 2 (C) Six (D) Eight
(C) 8 : 10 (D) 4 : 5 17. In which of the following compounds at least one
12. Choose the correct statement from the following valance shell orbital of underlined atom remains
options. unhybridized?
(A) The number of identical bonds in (I) is equal to (A) B2H6 (B) BH 4−
that in (II). (C) BCl3 (D) None of these
(B) The number of identical bonds in (I) is equal to
that in S 2O27 − .
(C) All bond lengths in (II) are identical. Passage 9: For Questions 18–19
(D) Smallest bond angle value is available in (I)
among these two structures. Different kind of molecules are available in chemistry,
like molecules having single central atom, molecules
having more than one central atom, molecules having odd
Passage 7: For Questions 13–14 number of electrons and even if some molecules do not
exist with theoretical support.
There are some cases in which the number of available
18. The reason for non•existence of which molecule is
valence electrons is not suffcient to displace normal elec•
not the same with the molecules in other options?
tron pair bond (i.e., 2 centre – 2 electron, 2c – 2e) among
(A) XeH6 (B) HFO4
all the constituent atoms.
(C) SH6 (D) IH7
13. Find the maximum number of atom(s) that is/are
19. Which of the following statements is incorrect?
present in one plane in the given complex.
(A) The free electron of ClO3 molecule is not present
in the d•orbital of Cl atom.
(B) The hybridization of central atom of ClCO2 is sp2.
(C) The dC•H in CH3 is smaller than dC•F in CF3.
(D) The hybridization of N•atom(s) in NO2 and its
(A) 1 (B) 5 dimer is different.
(C) 11 (D) 7
14. Select the correct order of bond angle in B2H6. (Here Passage 10: For Questions 20–22
Ht and Hb are terminal and bonding hydrogens,
respectively.) Molecular orbital theory is completely based upon the
wave mechanical approach. The MO diagram gives the
(A) H −B−H > H −B−H
t t b b energy comparison between different orbitals.
(B) H
20. Choose the correct ionization energy order from the
t − B − Ht < Hb − B − Hb
(C) H
following options.
−B−H = H
t t −B−H
b b (A) F2 > F (B) B > B2
(D) None of these (C) N2 < N (D) B2 > B
21. Which of the following orbital is having maximum
Passage 8: For Questions 15–17 number of nodal planes?
(A) s *p − p (B) p d − d (2 lobes interaction)
The binary boron•hydrogen compounds are called *
boranes. Experimental and theoretical studies of the (C) p p − p (D) p d − p
_
@edubuzznotes
Comprehension Type Questions 149
22. In the process of N 2− → N 2 , the electron is removed (C) length of the orbital increases.
from ____________ provided the x•axis is the bond (D) thinness of the orbital increases.
formation axis. 29. For which of the following sets of geometry, both
* *
(A) p 2 py orbital (B) p 2 px orbital axial and equatorial positions are present?
(C) s 2 px orbital (D) s orbital (A) Octahedral and trigonal bipyramidal.
2s
(B) Tetrahedral and octahedral.
(C) Trigonal bipyramidal and pentagonal
Passage 11: For Questions 23–24 bipyramidal.
(D) Tetrahedral and pentagonal bipyramidal.
According to Molecular orbital theory, electrons in a mol•
ecule are present in molecular orbitals. Molecular orbital
is defned as the region or space around two or more
Passage 14: For Questions 30–32
nuclei where electron fnding probability is the maximum. Bent’s rule explains the relative position of atoms and
23. There is largest difference of energy between the lone pairs in trigonal bipyramidal and pentagonal bipy•
molecular orbital of dioxygen in ramidal geometries mainly. However, the bond lengths
(A) s 2 px and p 2 py
*
(B) s 2 py and p 2 py and bond angles are also well explained in several places.
(C) s 2 and s 2* s (D) s 2* and s 2 s 30. Which of the following species does not have perfect
px px
geometrical shape?
24. B2 molecule will be diamagnetic when (A) [ BeF4 ]2 − (B) CF3 Cl
(I) s•p mixing is NOT operative. 2−
(II) s•p mixing is operative and Hund’s rule is (C) SiF6
[ ] (D) SO3
violated.
(III) s•p mixing is operative and Hund’s rule is NOT 31. Which of the following statements is not correct?
violated. (A) In PF2Br3, dP–F> dP–Br.
(A) (I), (II) (B) (I), (III) angles are of 90° in PF2Br3.
(B) All FPBr
(C) (II), (III) (D) (I), (II) and (III) angles are of 120° in PF2Br3.
(C) All BrPBr
(D) Fluorine atom occupies axial position.
32. Which of the following options are correct statements?
Passage 12: For Questions 25–26 (I) dO – F (O2F2) > dO – F (OF2)
Dipole moment gives an idea of the polar character of a (II) The %s character in the orbital containing lone
covalent molecule. It is a vector quantity as it has a direc• pair of H2O molecule is 30% [where cos(104.5°)
tion as well as magnitude. A molecule with µ = 0 is non• = –0.25].
polar and with µ ≠ 0 is polar. angle in CH − C ≡ CH is exactly equal
(III) HCH 3
−30
25. If the dipole moment of NF3 is 0.80 × 10 Cm, then to 109°28′.
the dipole moment of NH3 is (IV) The FNF in [NF ]– is less than HNH
in [NH ]–.
2 2
(A) 0.80 × 10−30 Cm (B) 1.2 × 10−31 Cm (A) I, II, III (B) II, IV
−30
(C) 4.90 × 10 Cm (D) 0.7 × 10−30 Cm
(C) I, II, IV (D) II, III, IV
26. Which of the following dipole moment order is
correct? Passage 15: For Questions 33–36
(A) XeF2 < XeF4 (B) SiH4 < CF4
(C) H2O < OF2 (D) PCl5 < PCl3 IF7 is a molecule in which I atom is in the maximum
oxidation state, and the hybridization for I atom is sp3d3.
adjacent angles in IF7 molecule is
33. The number of FIF
Passage 13: For Questions 27–29 (A) 10 (B) 15
The hybrid orbital is obtained by mixing of atomic orbitals (C) 20 (D) 14
of comparable energy. angles less than 90° and equal to
34. The number of FIF
27. Which of the following shapes of molecule is not 90° are respectively
obtained from the trigonal bipyramidal electron (A) 5 and 5 (B) 10 and 5
geometry of the central atom? (C) 5 and 10 (D) 10 and 15
(A) Linear (B) Tetrahedral 35. The number of I – F bonds having the longest and
(C) See–saw (D) Trigonal bipyramidal shortest lengths are respectively
28. Choose the correct option to complete the statement: (A) 5 and 2 (B) 2 and 5
As much the percentage s character increases in a (C) 5 and 5 (D) 2 and 2
particular hybrid orbital, ___________ . 36. The number of planes of symmetry in IF7 is
(A) bulkiness of the orbital decreases. (A) 5 (B) 7 (C) 4 (D) 6
(B) length of the orbital decreases.
_
@edubuzznotes
150 Chapter 3 Chemical Bonding
Passage 16: For Questions 37–39 (A) Instantaneous dipole–induced dipole interaction.
(B) Dipole–dipole interaction.
One more electron or atom can change the system a lot (C) Dipole–induced dipole interaction.
in several aspects. (D) Ion–dipole interaction.
37. Choose the correct bond angle order: 44. Choose the correct order for boiling point.
+
(A) C H 3 > C H 3 > CH
ɺ
− +
(B) C H 3 = CH
ɺ
−
(A) GeH4 > SiH4 < CH4 (B) Xe > Ne > He
3 > C H3
3
(C) He >H2 (D) CH4 > CD4
+ − + −
(C) CH
ɺ
3 > C H3 > C H3 (D) C H 3 > C H 3 = CH
ɺ
3
38. Choose the correct bond angle order. Passage 19: For Questions 45–47
− + − +
(A) CH 4 > C H 3 > C H 3 (B) C H 3 > CH 4 > C H 3 ‘No ionic compound is 100% ionic as well as no covalent
+ − − + compound is 100% covalent.’
(C) C H 3 > CH 4 > C H 3 (D) CH 4 > C H 3 > C H 3
45. Correct solubility order is
39. Choose the correct order for C – H bond length. (A) CaCrO4 > BaCrO4 (B) BeCO3 < BaCO3
(C) LiNO3 < CsNO3 (D) NaClO4 < KClO4
(A) CH > CH 4 > CH
−
3
+
3
− 46. Choose the incorrect order of the given properties.
(B) CH 4 = C H 3 > CH 3 + (A) BeCl2 < LiCl : Electrical conductivity
+
ɺ
(C) CH 4 = C H 3 = CH 3
(B) NaF < MgF2 < AlF3 : Covalent character order
ɺ
− (C) BeSO4 < MgSO4 < CaSO4 : Thermal stability order
(D) CH 3 > CH 4 > C H 3
(D) HgCl2 < HgBr2 < HgI2: Solubility order in water
47. Which of the following options give incorrect melting
Passage 17: For Questions 40–42 point order?
(A) H2 < T2 (B) He > T2 (C) D2 > He (D) T2 > D2
The structures of P(CH3)2F3 and P(CH3)F4 are shown
below:
F F
Passage 20: for Questions 48–50
F CH3
and P
H3C P F Valence shell electron repulsion theory (VSEPR) can
y°
x° be used to predict the approximate shape of a molecule.
H3C F
F Electrons in bonds and in lone pairs can be thought of
F
as “charge cloud” that repel one another and stay as far
40. Which of the following are correct values for x and y apart possible, thus causing molecules to assume specifc
in the above fgure? shapes.
(A) x >120°, y >120° (B) x >120°, y < 120° The repulsive interactions of electron pairs decrease in
(C) x = y = 120° (D) x < 120°, y < 120° the order:
41. Which of the following statements is true regarding Lone pair–lone pair > Lone pair–bond pair > Bond pair–
the above two structures? bond pair.
(A) dP – C > dP – F (axial) in both.
(B) dP – C > dP – F (equatorial) in both. These repulsions result in deviations from idealized shapes
(C) dP – F (axial) > dP – F (equatorial) in both. and alteration in bond angles in molecules.
(D) All are correct.
48. Molecular shape of XeF3+ , SF3 and CF3+ are
+
50. Which of the following statements is incorrect? Passage *22: For Questions 54–56
(A) In ClF3, the axial Cl–F bond length is larger than
equatorial Cl–F bond length. The Lewis structure drawing is the frst step to draw the
(B) In SF4, F–S–F equatorial bond angle is not 120° structure of a compound. This method has a lot of limi•
and 104° due to lone pair–bond pair repulsions. tations which are overcome by the theory of hybridiza•
-
(C) In ICl 4 , bond angles is 90°. tion to explain many properties of molecules/ species.
(D) In OBr2, the bond angle is less than OCl2. 54. Which of the following species have a p bond as well
as coordinate s bond in their Lewis structure?
(A) SiF4 (B) CO2 (C) SO3 (D) NO3−
Passage 21: For Questions 51–53 55. What are the different kinds of bonds and interac•
tions present within CuSO4. 5H2O?
HCN and HNC molecules are formed by the same (I) s bond (II) p bond (III) Coordinate bond
atoms. (IV) Electrostatic forces of attraction
51. Which of the following properties are identical for (V) Hydrogen bond (dipole – dipole)
HCN and HNC molecules? (VI) Hydrogen bond (ion – dipole)
(A) The number of s bonds. (A) I, II, III only (B) II, III, and IV only
(B) The number of p bonds. (C) II, VI, and VI only (D) All six kinds of
(C) The number of lone pairs. forces of attraction
(D) All of these. are present.
52. The correct set of formal charges for HNC is 56. Which of the following statements is/are incorrect
(A) 0, 0, 0 (B) 0, –1, +1 regarding the real structure and Lewis structure of
(C) 0, +1, –1 (D) +1, 0, –1 phosphate ion?
(A) The number of s bonds is same in both the structures.
53. Which of the following statements is incorrect (B) The number of lone pairs is same in both the
regarding the HCN and HNC molecules? structures.
(A) The hybridization of the central atom is same for (C) The number of p bonds is same in both the
both. structures.
(B) They produce different ions in solution. (D) The shape remains unchanged in both the
(C) They produce the same ions in solution. structures.
(D) They produce the same number of ions in
solution. *One or more than one correct answers.
8. Statement I: Allene molecule is non•polar. 16. Statement I: In TlI3, the oxidation state of Tl is +1.
Statement II: Allene molecule is non•planar. Statement II: TlI3 is isomorphous with NH4I3 and CsI3.
9. Statement I: On addition of two electrons to NO2+, 17. Statement I: The dC − O in CH3CO2H are different
the N–O bond length increases by ∼9 pm while on while that in CH3CO2Na are identical.
adding only one electron to NO+, the N–O bond
length increases by ∼9 pm. Statement II: Resonance takes place in CH3CO2Na
but does not take place in CH3CO2H.
Statement II: In both the above processes, the bond −
order of N–O bond is decreased by 0.5. 18. Statement I: The direction of back bonding in C Cl 3
and : CCl 2 is the same.
10. Statement I: When BF3 and BCl3 are mixed together, it −
produces BF2Cl and BFCl2 through halogen exchange. Statement II: In C Cl 3, 2pp–3dp bonding and in
Statement II: Figure below is the intermediate for the : CCl 2 , 2pp – 3pp bonding takes place.
above process. 19. Statement I: dP–F is greater than dP–Cl in PF2Cl3.
F F Cl
B B Statement II: The axial orbital has no s character
while equatorial orbital has 33.33% s character in
F Cl Cl trigonal bipyramidal geometry.
11. Statement I: The delocalization energy for B3N3H6 is
less as compared to C6H6. 20. Statement I: Be2Cl4 molecule has an incomplete octet.
Statement II: B3N3H6 is polar while C6H6 is non•polar. Statement II: In Be2Cl4 each Be atom is sp2 hybridized.
12. Statement I: [AlBr4]– exists while the existence of 21. Statement I: The nodal planes of p bonds of
[BBr4]– is questionable. 1,3 – butadiene lie in the same plane.
Statement II: Al is larger in size as compared to B atom. Statement II: p bonds are also lying in the same plane
13. Statement I: SiH4 is highly reactive towards water in 1,3 – butadiene.
while CH4 is non•reactive.
22. Statement I: dMn − O in MnO4− is less than that in
Statement II: Polarity of Si – H bond is just reverse of MnO2− 4 .
that of C – H bond.
Statement II: The higher oxidation state of an ele•
14. Statement I: HgF2 is colourless while HgI2 is coloured. ment causes higher extent of d orbital contraction
Statement II: I– is more polarizable than F–. and forms more effective p bond with O atoms.
F
15. Statement I: S2F2 has the structure S = S , but S2Cl2 23. Statement I: Mercurous ion is always diamagnetic.
has no such analogous structure. F
Statement II: The 79th electron of each Hg atom gets
Statement II: F being more electronegative than Cl paired up to form a bond between two Hg atoms.
causes better d orbital contraction as compared to Cl.
3. Among the following, fnd the number of processes in 6. Find the total number of compounds whose bond
which ion•dipole interaction is not observed. order is unaffected whether the s•p mixing is consid•
I− in I2, KCl in water, CO2 in water, Xe in ice CHCl3 in ered or not.
water. B2, C2, N2, O2
4. Find the total number specie(s) among the following, 7. Calculate the value of n in
containing 3c−2e bond. ZnnCa2 (Si3O10)·2H2O.
Be2H4, (BeH2)n, Be2Cl4, Al2(CH3)6, Al2Cl6, I2Cl6, B2H6,
8. Find the maximum number of hydrogen atoms that
B2H2 (CH3)4
may lie in one plane in BH2(CH3)4 molecules.
_
@edubuzznotes
Matrix–Match Type Questions 153
9. Find the number of chemical species which are iso• 22. In Me4C molecule, the maximum number of atoms
electronic and have the same bond order as of CO. that may lie in the same plane and the number of such
CN-, NO+, N2, C 22 − , O22 + planes are respectively ___________ and ___________.
10. Find the number of chemical species which are 23. The maximum number of atoms that may lie in the
planar and dxy orbital of central atom participates in same plane of eclipsed form of C2H6 and the number
the hybridization. of such planes are respectively ___________ and
___________.
XeF5− , XeF5+ , XeF6, XeF4, SF4, ICl-4
24. The maximum number of atoms that may lie in the
11. Find the total number of compound(s), which is/are same plane in P(CH3)3 (CF3)2 is ___________ and the
repelled by magnetic feld. number of such planes is ___________.
v
K2O2, KO2, O2 [P tF6 ] , NO[BF4], KCN, Na2C2 25. The maximum number of equal angles in CH2F2 is
12. In the compound PClk F5•k, possible values of k are 0 ___________.
to 5. Then sum of all possible value of k for the com• 26. The number of lone pairs in BF4– is___________.
pounds having zero dipole moment is______.
27. The maximum number of atoms that may lie in the
13. Find the number of 90° angles in XeF5− molecules. same plane in (CH3)2C = SF2(CH3)2 is ___________.
14. The sum of oxidation states of N atom in the follow• 28. The maximum number of atoms that may lie in the
ing compounds of nitrogen is ___________. same plane in N(SiH3)3 and the number of atoms are
out of that plane are respectively ___________ and
NH3, N2H4, NH2OH, N2, N2O, NO, N2O3, NO2, N2O5
___________.
15. The maximum number of atoms lying in the same 29. The number of nodal planes when two dxy orbitals
plane in B2H6 is ___________. from two atoms produce antibonding δ bonds is
16. In a molecule of CH3Cl, the number of planes con• ___________.
sisting of maximum number of atoms where at least 30. The maximum number of atoms that may lie in
two atoms are same is___________. the same plane of staggered form of C2H6 and the
17. The number of planes of symmetry in TeCl6 is number of such planes are respectively ___________
___________. and ___________.
18. The number of planes which divide TeCl6 molecule 31. The sum of the number of d•orbitals whose lobes
into two equal halves is ___________. are available along the axis and are involved in the
hybridization of central atoms of XeF5− and XeF5+ is
19. The number of planes of symmetry in SbF5 is ___________.
___________.
32. The number of triatomic molecules, which are non•
20. The number of planes of symmetry in SiH4 is planar is ___________.
___________. SnCl2, BF3, BeF2, OCl2
21. The maximum number of atoms lying in the same 33. The sum of oxidation states of all P atoms in the fol•
plane in [AlCl4]– and the number of such planes are lowing compound of phosphorus is ___________.
respectively ___________and ___________.
P4, PH3, H3PO2, P2O5, H3PO3, H3PO4
3. Match the compounds with their properties. 8. Match the molecules/species with their properties.
Column I Column II Column I Column II
(A) XeO3 (P) Pyramidal geometry. (A) If7 (P) the axial bond length is
(B) XeO2f4 (Q) Non•planar molecule. larger than the equatorial
bond length.
(C) XeO2f2 (R) One lone pair is present
(B) [Sif6]2− (Q) the axial bond length
on Xe. is shorter than the
(S) dz2 orbital is involved in equatorial bond length.
hybridization of central (C) Brf3 (R) dx − y orbitals are involved
2 2
atom. in bonding.
+
(D) [PI4] (S) All possible bond angles are
4. Match the compounds with their properties. not identical.
Column I Column II (t) All possible bond angles are
identical.
(A) BH3 (P) All atoms are central atom.
(B) Sif4 (Q) It has no lone pair. 9. Match the molecules/species with their properties.
(C) B3N3H6 (R) It has only s•bond.
(D) SiC (S) It is non•planar. Column I Column II
(A) Brf5 (P) It has atleast one angle less
5. Match the compounds with their Lewis structures.
than 90°.
Column I Column II (B) ICl3 (Q) the central atom is sp3d
(A) SO 3
2−
(P) the central atom does not hybridized.
have lone pair. (C) H3O+ (R) It is non•planar.
(B) HNC (Q) All atoms of the species (S) the central atom is having
have lone pair(s). only one lone pair.
(C) Sif4 (R) It has co•ordinate bond. 10. Match the molecules with their properties.
(D) NO3− (S) It has s • bond and
p • bond as well as Column I Column II
coordinate bond.
(A) O3 (P) p bond is present in the
(t) Species having only
molecule.
s bond.
(B) Xef2 (Q) s bonds are only present.
6. Match the type of hybridization with the orbital involved. (C) BeH2 (R) It is hyperoctet.
Column I Column II (D) CO (S) It is hypovalent.
(A) sp3d (tBP) (P) pz (t) It is linear.
(B) sp2 (orbitals lying in xz plane) (Q) px
(C) sp3d2 (R) dx − y2 2
11. Match the molecules/species with correct statement
(S) dz2
related to their property.
Column I Column II
7. Match the molecules/species with their properties. −
(A) [BH4] (P) All atoms are p•block elements.
Column I Column II
(B) [Bef4]2− (Q) the central atom is a s•block
(A) AlBr3 (P) It has zero dipole moment. element.
(B) Clf3 (Q) It is planar. (C) SiC (R) the central atom(s) is(are) sp3
(C) ICl4− (R) the central atom of the hybridized.
molecule is sp3d hybridized. (D) [Bf4]− (S) All atoms are s•block elements.
(D) PCl2f3 (S) It is non•planar. (t) the central atom is p•block
(t) Maximum four atoms are element but the surrounding
lying in the same plane. atoms are s•block elements.
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (D) 6. (D) 11. (C) 16. (A) 21. (D) 26. (B)
2. (C) 7. (C) 12. (D) 17. (D) 22. (D) 27. (D)
3. (D) 8. (D) 13. (C) 18. (A) 23. (C) 28. (C)
4. (C) 9. (B) 14. (C) 19. (D) 24. (C) 29. (D)
5. (C) 10. (B) 15. (C) 20. (A) 25. (D) 30. (D)
_
@edubuzznotes
Answers 155
31. (A) 37. (C) 43. (D) 49. (B) 55. (C) 61. (D)
32. (A) 38. (B) 44. (B) 50. (D) 56. (D) 62. (D)
33. (B) 39. (A) 45. (B) 51. (A) 57. (C)
34. (D) 40. (B) 46. (B) 52. (C) 58. (A)
35. (B) 41. (D) 47. (D) 53. (A) 59. (D)
36. (C) 42. (A) 48. (C) 54. (B) 60. (B)
4
Hydrolysis + H
O
H
+ O
H
H
Water
Schematic representation
of hydrolysis.
4.1 | INTRODUCTION
When a substance undergoes nucleophilic substitution reaction Contents
and the nucleophile is the solvent itself, then the reaction is 4.1 Introduction
known as solvolysis. In solvolysis reaction, if the solvent used 4.2 Hydrolysis Through SN1
is water then the reaction is called as hydrolysis.
Mechanism
Hydrolysis can occur through several mechanisms. Some
4.3 Hydrolysis Through SN2
of these mechanisms are
Mechanism
1. Unimolecular nucleophillic substitution (SN1 ) 4.4 Hydrolysis Through
2. Bimolecular nucleophilic substitution (SN 2 ) Addition–Elimination
3. Addition–elimination mechanism Mechanism
4. Addition mechanism 4.5 Hydrolysis Through
Addition Mechanism
5. Redox reaction
4.6 Hydrolysis Through Redox
6. Push–pull mechanism Reaction
These mechanisms are discussed in the following sections. 4.7 Hydrolysis Through Push–
Pull Mechanism
4.8 Hydrolysis Through Mixed
4.2 | HYDROLYSIS THROUGH SN1 Mechanism
MECHANISM
This mechanism is explained by the following examples.
1. Hydrolysis of NF3: When hydrolysis of NF3 is carried out
at ordinary conditions, no reaction is observed by SN 2
mechanism.
under
NF3 + H 2 O ordinary
conditions → No reaction
However, NF3 undergoes hydrolysis under drastic conditions to give N 2O3 and HF through SN1
mechanism as shown in Figure 4.1 which is fnally decomposed into NO2 and NO.
Step 1
SN1 − +
N F + NF2
F
F ⇓
F
F H2O +
N + F2N O H
F H
vacant −H+
pz orbital
F2N OH
Step 2 O
2H2O −H2O
F2 N OH N(OH)3 H O N
−2HF
Step 3
2. Hydrolysis of CCl 4 : CCl 4 is inert towards hydrolysis under ordinary conditions through SN 2 mecha•
nism due to the following reasons:
a. The non•availability of vacant low•lying d orbitals.
b. Steric crowding due to presence of four Cl atoms around C atom which do not allow water
molecule to approach antibonding orbitals of C–Cl bonds.
c. The nucleophile also cannot attack the vacant 3d orbital of Cl atom because of polarity of the
bond. The negative charge (d −) developed on Cl atoms repels the incoming nucleophile.
However, CCl 4 undergoes partial hydrolysis under drastic conditions, using superheated steam,
through SN1 mechanism.
CCl 4 + H 2 O → COCl 2 + 2 HCl
superheated
steam
Out of the four leaving groups (Cl), only two groups leave while two are left on the parent molecule.
Hence the reaction is referred to as partial hydrolysis.
O H O
Cl
+ H2O + H −H+ −HCl
Cl3 C O C C
C Cl Cl− + CCl3
Cl H Cl Cl Cl Cl
Cl
Cl
Cl OH
Cl
H2O H2O Si Cl −HCl
Si Cl Si
Cl SN2 Cl Cl
Cl
Cl Cl Cl
Transition state (sp 3d hybridized) + 3 H2O
(TBP geometry)
3 HCl + Si(OH)4
2
Figure 4.2 Hydrolysis of SiCl4 by SN mechanism.
Some important observations related to hydrolysis of SiCl4 by SN2 mechanism are listed below:
a. When R 1R 2 R 3SiCl undergoes hydrolysis, it is associated with an inversion of confguration.
b. If we compare the rate of hydrolysis for SiX 4 (where X = F, Cl, Br, I), it is in the same order as that
of their Lewis acid strength order, i.e.
This is because the effect of p back bonding is less dominant over the negative inductive effect.
c. For SnCl 4 and SnCl 2 , the hydrolysis rate is SnCl 4 > SnCl 2 due to higher charges on the former.
While for SnCl 4 and SnMe4 , the hydrolysis rate is SnCl 4 > SnMe4 because the positive inductive
effect of the methyl group reduces the Lewis acidity of Sn 4+ ion, which leads to reduction in the rate
of nucleophilic attack.
2. Hydrolysis of SiF4 and BF3 : Both these molecules show partial hydrolysis.
For SiF4:
SiF4 + 4 H 2O → Si(OH)4 + 4 HF
2SiF4 + 4 HF → 2 H 2 [SiF6 ]
3SiF4 + 4 H 2O → Si(OH)4 + 2 H 2 [SiF6 ]
The complexation reaction is so fast that unless all HF molecules are consumed by SiF4, the H2O
molecule cannot attack the next molecule of SiF4. Out of three moles of SiF4, only one mole of SiF4
gives the hydrolyzed product, hence it is called partial hydrolysis.
Similarly for BF3:
Alternatively,
4 BF3 + 12 H 2O → 4 B(OH)3 + 12 HF
12 HF + 3B(OH)3 → 3H + + 3BF4− + 9 H 2O
4 BF3 + 3H 2O → B(OH)3 + 3[H + BF4− ]
Again out of four moles of BF3 , only one mole of BF3 gives the hydrolysed product. Hence it is called
partial hydrolysis.
_
@edubuzznotes
160 Chapter 4 Hydrolysis
3. Hydrolysis of BCl 3 and BeCl 2 : Both these molecules undergo complete hydrolysis.
For BCl3:
SN2
BCl3 + 3H2O B(OH)3 + 3HCl
on alkaline −
B(OH)4
hydrolysis
Final product
The rate of hydrolysis for BX 3 (X = F, Cl, Br, I) is BF3 < BCl 3 < BBr3 < BI 3 .
Similarly, for BeCl2:
SN2
BeCl2 + H2O Be (OH)2 + 2HCl
polymerization
on alkaline
hydrolysis Be(OH)2 n (solid)
4. Hydrolysis of NCl 3 , PCl 3 , AsCl 3 , SbCl 3 and BiCl 3 : The hydrolysis of these compounds is discussed
as follows:
a. NCl 3 produces NH 3 and HOCl on hydrolysis as shown in Figure 4.3.
H2O − + H −H+ H+
N Cl2N + Cl O Cl2 NH + HOCl
H
Cl Cl
Cl 2H2O
NH3 + 2HOCl
2
Figure 4.3 Hydrolysis of NCl3 by SN mechanism.
Here the nucleophilic attack on N atom cannot take place due to the non•availability of vacant orbital.
The attack on Cl atom is favoured because the N−Cl bond is almost non•polar, and the attack takes
place through electromeric effect.
b. PCl3 produces H 3 PO3 and HCl as shown in Figure 4.4.
I II
2
Figure 4.4 Hydrolysis of PCl3 by SN mechanism.
The driving force for the tautomerization reaction is the larger bond energy of II as compared to that of I.
_
@edubuzznotes
4.4 Hydrolysis Through Addition-Elimination Mechanism 161
Transition state
Similarly,
AX 3 + 2 H 2O → HAO2 + 3HX
AX 5 + 3H 2 O → HAO3 + 5HX
AX 7 + 4 H 2 O → HAO4 + 7 HX
These are the products generally formed and sometimes other side products are also formed, but they
are specifc to the case.
O− O O O O
H2O O H
O O −Cl− S −H+ S
S O+
S H + H
Cl Cl O Cl OH
Cl Cl I Cl II H III H2O/−HCl
O O
S
HO OH
H
O− + O
O O H
H2O H − +
−H+/H+
S − OOH S O
H O O S O H O O HO H2SO4 + H2O2
O H
O H O
O H
Hence,
H 2SO5 + H 2O → H 2SO4 + H 2O2
O
O
H S O −H+/H+ H2O
O O S O H + H2O H2SO5 + H2SO4 H2SO4 + H2O2
O O
O O O O
O S S
H2O −H+/H+
S −O O+ H HO OH
O
O H
In the hydrolysis of SO3, only the nucleophile, i.e. water, is added to the molecule without any elimination
of the leaving group. Hence the process is called as addition mechanism.
Similarly for SO2 and CO2
SO2 + H 2O → H 2SO3
CO2 + H 2O → H 2CO3
XeF2 + H 2 O → Xe + 2 HF + 21 O2
3XeF4 + 6 H 2 O → 2Xe + XeO3 + 12HF + 23 O2
XeF6 + 3H 2O → XeO3 + 6 HF
_
@edubuzznotes
4.7 Hydrolysis Through Push–Pull Mechanism 163
Push
H2O H
SiH4 + 2OH− SiH4(OH)2 2− H3(OH)2 Si O
d −H
H d+
Pull
3H2O
Si(OH)6 2− + 3H2 H3Si(OH)3 2− + H2
on dehydration
Hence, traces
SiH 4 + H 2 O of
OH −
→ SiO2 ⋅ nH 2 O + 4 H 2
traces
Si 2 H 6 + H 2 O of
OH −
→ 2SiO2 ⋅ nH 2 O + 6 H 2
Be2C + 2 H 2O → Be(OH)2 + CH 4
Al 4C 3 + 12 H 2O → 4 Al(OH)3 + 3CH 4
CaC 2 + 2 H 2O → Ca(OH)2 + C 2 H 2
Mg 2C 3 + 4 H 2O → 2Mg(OH)2 + CH 3 − C ≡ CH
Mg 3 N 2 + 6 H 2O → 3Mg(OH)2 + 2 NH 3 ↑
Ca 3 P2 + 6 H 2O → 3Ca(OH)2 + 2 PH 3 ↑
_
@edubuzznotes
164 Chapter 4 Hydrolysis
OH2
Cl Cl Cl Cl3P O H
H2O −HCl
P
P Cl SN2 Cl
Cl
Cl Cl Cl Cl Addition–elimination
Cl
Transition state
O
O
P
2H2O H2O Cl Cl
H3PO4 HCl + P
–2HCl Cl OH Addition– Cl
Cl elimination
2. Hydrolysis of SF4 versus SF6: SF4 undergoes hydrolysis very easily to produce H 2SO3 and HF through
SN 2 mechanism as shown in Figure 4.9.
OH2 O
F F
F −HF −HF S
S S F3S OH
F F
F F F F
F H2O
Transition state (sp 3d 2 hybridized)
(Octahedral geometry) Addition
elimination
O−
O O −HF +
H2O/−HF S OH2
S Addition S
F F
HO OH elimination F OH
Figure 4.9 Hydrolysis of SF4 by SN2 mechanism followed by addition elimination mechanism.
Unlike SF4, SF6 is inert towards hydrolysis even though it has vacant d orbitals available with the
central atom S. This is due to steric crowding around sulphur atom; and this reason is supported by
the fact that the order for rate of hydrolysis of SF6 , SeF6 and TeF6 is SF6 < SeF6 < TeF6 . As the size of
the central atom increases, this steric crowding decreases; and the surface of the central atom becomes
more exposed for the nucleophilic attack.
Though SeF6 is inert like SF6 , it undergoes hydrolysis to a very little extent, on the other hand TeF6
hydrolyzes readily and completely.
SeF6 + 4 H 2O → H 2SeO4 + 6 HF
TeF6 + 6 H 2O → Te(OH)6 + 6 HF
Here also, the nature of products formed is different due to steric crowding. The expected product
from SeF6 hydrolysis is Se(OH)6 but to avoid steric crowding it condenses into H 2SeO4 .
_
@edubuzznotes
4.8 Hydrolysis Through Mixed Mechanism 165
3. Hydrolysis of P4 O10 : This hydrolysis also proceeds through addition and addition–elimination
mechanism as shown in Figure 4.10.
O
O
P O
O O OH
H2O P
O O O H2O O P
O P P O
−H+/H+ O O O
P
O O P O −H+/H+
P O P
O O I II P
HO
O O O P O OH O O OH
Addition of P
nucleophile H O O OH
only
III H O/−H+/H+
2
O O O O O O O
P H2O
H2O P P P P P P
+ H3PO4 O OH
HO O O OH −H+/H+ HO O O
HO HO OH OH OH OH OH
V −H+/H+ IV Tetrapolyphosphoric
acid
O O
H3PO4 + P H2O
P
HO O 2H3PO4
OH −H+/H+
HO OH
VI
In the frst three steps (I, II and III) of hydrolysis of P4 O10, there is no elimination. Hence these three
steps follow addition mechanism for the nucleophile. However, in the last three steps (IV, V and
VI) one PO–4 unit is left which acts as the leaving group. So the overall mechanism is addition and
addition–elimination.
Similarly for P4S10,
P4S10 + 16 H 2O → 4 H 3 PO4 + 10 H 2S
4. Hydrolysis of P4: Disproportionation of P4 in alkaline medium can be easily explained through addition
and addition–elimination mechanisms as shown in Figure 4.11.
OH
P − OH2
+ 3OH P
PH3 + + 3OH−
− P P
HO − + 3H2O
OH P P
Addition HO
P OH Addition–
H2O OH2 elimination
− + 3H2O/−H+/H+
HO
H H
3 H P 3 P
O O H
HO
O
H
1. Which of the following orders is incorrect for the rate (C) PF3 > PCl3
of hydrolysis? (D) SeF6 > SF6
(A) SnCl2 > SnCl4
9. The chain controlling unit for silicone is
(B) SnCl4 > SnMe4
(A) R 3SiCl
(C) AlCl3 < CCl4
( B) R 2SiCl 2
(D) BF3 < BCl3
(C) RSiCl 3
2. Which of the following statements is incorrect? (D) SiCl 4
(A) Disproportionation reaction takes place for the
10. The products of hydrolysis of Br–Cl are
hydrolysis of XeF4.
(B) In the hydrolysis of PCl3, tautomers of P(OH)3 (A) HBr + HCl + 1 O2
2
are formed as fnal product. (B) HOBr + HCl
(C) In the hydrolysis of NCl3, HOCl is not formed. (C) HOCl + HBr
(D) CH4 is inert towards the hydrolysis at normal (D) HOBr + HOCl
conditions.
11. The hydrolysis of Na 2SO3 makes the solution
3. Which of the following reaction is correct? (A) alkaline.
1
(A) PCl3 + 4H2O ® H3PO3 + 5HCl + 2 O2 (B) acidic.
(B) XeF6 + 3H2O ® XeO3 + 6HF (C) neutral.
(C) 2BCl3 + 6HOH (excess) ® B2H6 + 6HOCl (D) None of these.
(D) B2H6 + 2N(CH3)3 ® [BH2[N(CH3)3]2]+ [BH4]−
12. Which of the following compounds produces only
4. In which of the following all the chlorine atoms are basic product(s) on hydrolysis?
substituted, as given, on hydrolysis? (A) Mg 3 N 2
room (B) NCl 3
MCl n + nH 2O temperature
→ M(OH)n + nHCl
(C) BBr3
(A) NCl3 (D) LiH
(B) BCl3
(C) CCl4 13. When CH 3Cl undergoes alkaline hydrolysis to
(D) None of these produce CH 3OH, the state of hybridization of C
atom in the transition state is
5. Which of the following statements is correct? (A) sp
(A) On hydrolysis of SeF6 and TeF6 four water mol•
(B) sp3d
ecules are consumed.
(C) sp3
(B) On hydrolysis of PCl3 the product obtained has
(D) sp2
basicity 3.
(C) On hydrolysis of SF4, hybridization of S in tran• 14. When SiCl 4 undergoes hydrolysis to produce
sition state is sp3d. Si(OH)4 , the state of hybridization of Si atom in the
(D) All molecules of BF3 are not hydrolyzed in water. transition state is
(A) sp
6. Which of the following compounds produce acid
(B) sp3d
having basicity of two on hydrolysis?
(C) sp3
(A) NCl3
(D) sp2
(B) Al2(CH3)6
(C) SO2Cl2 15. The basicity of the acid produced from the central
(D) Mg3N2 atom in the hydrolysis of AsCl 3 is
7. In which of the following reactions oxidation number (A) 1
of underlined atom will be +6 in atleast one of the (B) 2
products? (C) 3
(D) 4
Hydrolysis
(A) SO2 F2 ¾¾¾¾¾
®
16. Which of the following statements is incorrect?
Hydrolysis
(B) XeF4 ¾¾¾¾¾
® (A) PCl 5 produces POCl 3 as intermediate product
Hydrolysis
(C) XeF6 ¾¾¾¾¾
® on hydrolysis.
(B) BCl 3 produces B(OH)3 on alkaline hydrolysis.
(D) All of the these
(C) SiH 4 gives rise to H 2 gas on hydrolysis.
8. Select the incorrect trend for extent of hydrolysis.
(D) N 2O5 produces two molecules of HNO3 on
(A) SF4 > SF6
hydrolysis.
(B) NCl3 > NF3
_
@edubuzznotes
Comprehension Type Questions 167
17. Which of the following statements is correct? (C) d orbital participates in the hydrolysis of SF6 .
(A) BiCl 3 produces Bi(OH)3 (white ppt.) on (D) d orbital participates in the hydrolysis of PCl 5 .
hydrolysis.
(B) d orbital participates in the alkaline hydrolysis
of CH 3Cl.
(B) If both Statement I and Statement II are true but Statement II: Sn–H bond has insuffcient polarity
Statement II is not the correct explanation for compared to Si–H bond.
Statement I. 4. Statement I: TeF6 produces H 2 TeO4 as hydrolyzed
(C) If Statement I is true but Statement II is false. product.
(D) If Statement I is false but Statement II is true.
Statement II: Te(OH)6 exists and there is no steric
1. Statement I: Mg 2C 3 and Al 4C 3 both produce the crowding to accommodate six OH– groups around it.
same gaseous products on their hydrolysis.
5. Statement I: P4S10 produces H 3 PO4 and H 2S, not
Statement II: The nature of hydrocarbon produced H 2SO4 and PH 3, on hydrolysis.
from a particular carbide depends upon the anionic
part present in it. Statement II: S atom being more electronegative, the
nucleophilic attack takes place on P atom and proto•
2. Statement I: Hydrolysis of Al 2 (CH 3 )6 is highly nation takes place on S atom.
spontaneous.
6. Statement I: Silicones are resistant towards hydrolysis.
Statement II: Al 2 (CH 3 )6 gives Al(OH)3 (white ppt.)
and CH 4 (gaseous product) on hydrolysis. Statement II: +I effect of CH 3 groups reduces the d (+)
character of Si atoms.
3. Statement I: SiH 4 is prone towards hydrolysis while
SnH 4 is inert.
The answer to each of the following questions is a non• 5. When SF4 is hydrolysed, the change in oxidation state
negative integer. of S atom during the process is ___________.
1. Find the total number of molecules which give hydro 6. Among the following orders, the number of incorrect
acid as one of the products when they undergo com• orders with respect to rate of hydrolysis is ___________.
plete hydrolysis.
(i) SnCl 2 > SnCl 4
NCl3, POCl3, PCl3, SF4, SiCl4, N2O5, P4O10 (ii) BBr3 > BI 3
2. Find the number of molecules which produce Na2SO4 (iii) SeF6 > TeF6
on hydrolysis followed by the treatment of resulting (iv) SiCl 4 < SiBr4
solution with excess NaOH. (v) SiH 4 > GeH 4
SOCl2, SO2Cl2, H2S2O7, SF4, SOF4, SeF6. (vi) SF6 < SeF6
3. The number of compounds among the following, 7. When SnCl 4 is converted into [SnCl 6 ]2− by the nucle•
forming oxyacids from the central atom on hydrolysis ophilic additon of Cl − , the coordination number is
is ___________. increased by___________.
AsCl 3 , NCl 3 , PCl 3 , SbCl 3 , PCl 5 , SiF4 8. The number of HCl molecules formed from the hydrol•
ysis of one molecule of NCl3 is ___________.
4. The number of compounds among the following that do
not produce only acidic product(s) on their hydrolysis is
___________.
SO2 , SO2Cl 2 , NCl 3 , SeCl 4 , TeF6 , XeF4 .
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (C) 4. (B) 7. (D) 10. (B) 13. (D) 16. (B)
2. (C) 5. (D) 8. (C) 11. (A) 14. (B) 17. (D)
3. (B) 6. (C) 9. (A) 12. (A) 15. (C)
x
5
x y
Coordination
y z z
Compounds
dxy dxz z dyz
x
dx 2−y2 dz 2
Shapes of d orbitals.
5.1 | DOUBLE SALTS AND Contents
COORDINATION COMPOUNDS
5.1 Double Salts and
Addition compounds are formed when stoichiometric Coordination Compounds
amounts of two or more stable compounds join together. 5.2 Werner’s Work
For example: 5.3 More Recent Methods of
Studying Complexes
KCl + MgCl 2 + 6H 2 O → KCl MgCl 2 6H 2 O
• •
ferrocyanide ion [Fe(CN)6]4− exist as distinct entities both in the solid and in solution. Complex ions are
shown by the use of square brackets. Compounds containing these ions are called coordination com•
pounds. The chemistry of metal ions in solution is essentially the chemistry of their complexes. Transition
metal ions, in particular, form many stable complexes. In solution ‘free’ metal ions are coordinated either to
water or to other ligands. Thus Cu2+ exists as the pale blue complex ion [Cu(H2O)6]2+ in aqueous solution
(and also in hydrated crystalline salts). If aqueous ammonia is added to this solution, the familiar deep
blue cuproammonium ion is formed:
form, but a square planar complex can exist Figure 5.2 Isomers in octahedral complexes.
in two isomeric forms. This proved these com•
plexes are square planar rather than tetrahe• Cl NH3
dral (Figure 5.4).
Pt
Cl NH3
M(en)3
cis
Cl NH3
Pt
conductivity with that of known simple ionic materials (Table 5.2). These conductivities suggest the same
structures for the cobalt/ammonia/chlorine complexes mentioned earlier, as do the results from Werner’s
AgCl experiments, shown in Table 5.3.
The freezing point of a liquid is lowered when a chemical substance is dissolved in it. Cryoscopic mea•
surements involve measuring how much the freezing point is lowered. The depression of freezing point
obtained depends on the number of particles present. Cryoscopic measurements can be used to fnd if a
molecule dissociates, and how many ions are formed. If a molecule dissociates into two ions it will give
twice the expected depression for a single particle. If three ions are formed this will give three times the
expected depression. Thus:
The number of particles formed from a complex molecule determines the size of the depression of
freezing point. Note that the number of particles formed may be different from the total number of charges
which can be obtained from conductivity measurements. These two types of information can be used
together to establish the structure (Table 5.4).
The magnetic moment can be measured and this provides information about the number of unpaired
electron spins present in a complex. From this it is possible to decide how the electrons are arranged and
which orbitals are occupied. Sometimes the structure of the complex can be deduced from this. For exam•
ple, the compound NiII(NH3)4(NO3)2 ∙ 2H2O might contain four ammonia molecules coordinated to Ni in
a square planar [Ni(NH3)4]2+ ion and two molecules of water of crystallization and have no unpaired elec•
trons. Alternatively the water might be coordinated to the metal, giving an octahedral [Ni(H2O)2(NH3)4]2+
complex with two unpaired electrons. Both these complex ions exist and their structures can be deduced
from magnetic measurements.
Dipole moments may also yield structural information but only for non•ionic complexes. For example,
the complex [Pt(NH3)2Cl2] is square planar, and can exist as cis or trans forms. The dipole moments from
the various metal–ligand bonds cancel out in the trans confguration. However, a fnite dipole moment is
given by the cis arrangement (Figure 5.4).
Electronic spectra (UV and visible) also provide valuable information on the energy of the orbitals, and
on the shape of the complex. By this means it is possible to distinguish between tetrahedral and octahedral
complexes, and whether the shape is distorted or regular.
The most powerful method, however, is the X•ray determination of the crystal structure. This provides
details of the exact shape and the bond lengths and angles of the atoms in the structure.
C C C
O O H3C CH CH3
−
_
@edubuzznotes
176 Chapter 5 Coordination Compounds
N N N N
S O−
As(CH3)2
N
O−
As(CH3)2
c. Tridentate: Three donations are accepted from the ligand. For example,
(i) dien: diethylenetriamine (ii) imda 2−: iminodiacetate
NH
CH2 CH2 CH2 CH2
H2C NH CH2 C C O
O
H2N NH2 O− O−
d. Tetradentate: Four donations are accepted from the ligand. For example,
(i) trien: triethylenetetraamine (ii) NTA 3− : nitrilotriacetate
CH2 CH2 O CH2
CH2
CH2 NH CH2 C N C O
CH2
H2N NH O− O−
CH2 C
H2N
CH2 O O
−
e. Pentadenate: Five donations are accepted from the ligand. For example,
EDTA 3−: ethylenediamine triacetate
CH2 CH2 CH2
CH2
N N C O
O C
CH2 H
O− O−
C
O O−
_
@edubuzznotes
5.4 Classification of Ligands 177
f. Hexadentate: Six donations are accepted from the ligand. For example,
EDTA 4− : ethylenediamine tetracetate
CH2 CH2 CH2
CH2
N N C O
O C
CH2 CH2
O O−
−
C
C
O O− O
O−
Note:
1. Flexidentate : A ligand which shows variable denticity is called a fexidentate ligand.
For example,
(i)
O O O O
S and S
O O O O
Bidentate ion Monodentate ion
CO2−
3 is bidentate CO2−3 is monodentate
may also act as fexidentate
ligand
2. Chelating : A ligand that can form a ring structure with the central atom is called a chelating ligand.
All polydentate ligands are the example of chelating ligands.
Chelated complexes are more stable than similar complexes with monodentate ligands as dissociation
of the complex involves breaking two bonds rather than one.
However, it must be noted that NH 2 NH 2 and N ( CH 2 − CH 2 ) 3 N cannot act as chelating ligands due
to the formation of three membered ring and locked structure, respectively.
3. Ambidentate ligand : A ligand that may have more than one kind of donor sites but at a time only one
kind of donor site is utilized for donation is called as ambidentate ligand. Ambidentate ligand may be
of two types.
a. Monodentate and ambidentate:
C N O C N S C N O
or or
:
or .N
C N S C N
:
O:
O C N
or
O
O O .
O S :N
:
N or N N O O:
S or
S− S
or O O N O
− or
O
O S +
N :C O:
S or
S
+
O O :C O:
3. Based upon bonding interaction between the ligand and the central atom
a. Classical or simple donor ligand: These ligands only donate the lone pair of electrons to the central
atom. For example, O2 − , OH − , F − , NH 2− , NH 3 , N 3−, etc.
b. Non-classical or p - acid or p - acceptor ligand: These ligands not only donate the lone pair of elec•
trons to the central atom but also accept the electron cloud from the central atom in their low•lying
vacant orbitals. This kind of back donation is known as ‘synergic effect’ or ‘synergic bonding’. For
− +
example, CO, C N, NO, PF3 , PR 3 (R = H, Et, Ph…), C 2 H 4 , C 2 H 2 , CO2, etc.
(i) In case of CO, the back donation to the p * orbital of central atom may be depicted as:
p∗
M C O M C O
p∗
By valence bond or molecular orbital theory, it is well understood that the bond order of C − O
bond decreases but the C − O bond length must increase due to synergic effect. Similarly, as
− +
C N and NO are isoelectronic with CO, so back donation takes place in these species also in
the p * orbitals and the same conclusion can be drawn for the bond order and bond lengths.
(ii) In case of PR3, the back donation may be depicted as:
vacant 3d orbital
accepts the back
donation
M P R3
(iii) In case of C 2 H 4 , the back donation may be depicted using the example of Zeise’s salt.
H
Cl Cl p∗
H
Pt C
Cl
C H
p∗
Here the back donation is accepted in the p * orbital of C − C bond. Hence, the bond order of
C − C bond decreases and the bond length increases as compared to free C 2 H 4 molecule. Due
to backbonding, C2H4 molecule loses its planarity. Similarly, C2H2 molecule loses its linearity
not the planarity.
−
is a 6•electron donor.
− is a 4•electron donor.
is a 2•electron donor.
−
CH 2 = CH − C H 2 is a 2•electron donor.
3. For the compounds having d bond, for example, Mn 2 (Co)10, the EAN of each Mn atom is calculated as:
1
EAN of Mn = [2 × 25 − 0 + 10 × 2 + 2* ] = 36
2
*These two electrons are considered for d •bond.
The EAN of some metal atoms in different complexes are given in Table 5.5.
Metal carbonyls exhibit a strong tendency to achieve Sidgwick EAN values and as a result of this:
1. The number of CO molecule attached in mononuclear carbonyls can be predicted. For example, in
2. [Mn(CO)6 ]0 can act as a reducing agent. The complex loses an electron to attain the noble gas confgu•
ration and hence obey Sidgwick EAN rule.
e
[Mn(CO)6 ] − → [Mn(CO)6 ]+
EAN = 37 EAN = 36
3. [V(CO)6 ]0 can act as oxidizing agent. The complex gains an electron to attain the noble gas confgura•
tion and hence obey Sidgwick EAN rule.
e
[V(CO)6 ]0 + → [V(CO)6 ] − .
EAN = 35 EAN = 36
4. [Mn(CO)5 ]0 undergoes dimerization to attain the noble gas confguration and hence obey Sidgwick
EAN rule.
2[Mn(CO)5 ]0
→ [Mn 2 (CO)10 ]
EAN = 35 EAN = 36
x x y
t2g
orbitals y z z
(de)
eg
orbitals y
(dg)
dx 2−y2 dz2
If this ion forms a complex with six ligands, then six empty atomic orbitals are required on the metal ion
to receive the coordinated lone pairs of electrons. The orbitals used are the 4s, three 4p and two 4d. These
are hybridized to give a set of six equivalent sp3d2 hybrid orbitals. A ligand orbital containing a lone pair
of electrons forms a coordinate bond by overlapping with an empty hybrid orbital on the metal ion. In this
way a s bond is formed with each ligand. The d orbitals used are the 4dx2 − y2 and 4dz2 . In the diagrams below,
electron pairs from the ligands are shown as .
_
@edubuzznotes
182 Chapter 5 Coordination Compounds
3d 4p 4d
full
inner
shell
(sp3d 2 hybridization)
octahedral shape
outer orbital complex
high-spin complex
Since the outer 4d orbitals are used for bonding this is called an outer orbital complex. The energy of these
orbitals is quite high, so that the complex will be reactive or labile. The magnetic moment depends on the
number of unpaired electrons. The 3d level contains the maximum number of unpaired electrons for a
d6 arrangement, so this is sometimes called a high•spin or a spin•free complex. An alternative octahedral
arrangement is possible when the electrons on the metal ion are rearranged as shown below. As before,
lone pairs from the ligands are shown as .
Since low energy inner d orbitals are used this is called an inner orbital complex. Such complexes are more
stable than the outer orbital complexes. The unpaired electrons in the metal ion have been forced to pair
up, and so this is now a low•spin complex. In this particular case all the electrons are paired, so the complex
will be diamagnetic.
The metal ion could also form four•coordinate complexes, and two different arrangements are possible.
It must be remembered that hybrid orbitals do not actually exist. Hybridization is a mathematical manipula•
tion of the wave equations for the atomic orbitals involved.
3d 4s 4p 4d
full
inner
shell
(sp 3 hybridization)
tetrahedral shape
3d 4s 4p 4d
full
inner
shell
(dsp 2 hybridization)
square planar shape
The theory does not explain the colour and spectra of complexes. The theory shows the number of
unpaired electrons and from this the magnetic moment can be calculated. However, it does not explain why
the magnetic moment varies with temperature.
on the ligands. Thus the electrons occupy the d orbitals furthest away from the direction of approach of
ligands. In the crystal feld theory the following assumptions are made.
1. Ligands are treated as point charges.
2. There is no interaction between metal orbitals and ligand orbitals.
3. The d orbitals on the metal all have the same energy (that is degenerate) in the free atom. However,
when a complex is formed the ligands destroy the degeneracy of these orbitals, i.e. the orbitals now
have different energies. In an isolated gaseous metal ion, the fve d orbitals do all have the same energy,
and are termed degenerate. If a spherically symmetrical feld of negative charges surrounds the metal
ion, the d orbitals remain degenerate. However, the energy of the orbitals is raised because of repul•
sion between the feld and the electrons on the metal. In most transition metal complexes, either six
or four ligands surround the metal, giving octahedral or tetrahedral structures. In both of these cases
the feld produced by the ligands is not spherically symmetrical. Thus the d orbitals are not all affected
equally by the ligand feld.
Octahedral complexes
In an octahedral complex, the metal is at the centre of the octahedron, and the ligands are at the six corners.
The directions x, y and z point to three adjacent corners of the octahedron as shown in Figure 5.6.
The lobes of the eg orbitals (dx2 − y2 and dz2 ) point along the axes x, y and z. The lobes of the t2g orbitals
(dxy, dxz and dyz) point in between the axes. It follows that the approach of six ligands along the x, y, z,
−x, −y and −z directions will increase the energy of the dx2 − y2 and dz2 orbitals (which point along the axes)
much more than it increases the energy of the dxy, dxz and dyz orbitals (which point between the axes).
Thus under the infuence of an octahedral ligand feld the d orbitals split into two groups of different
energies (Figure 5.7).
eg
d orbitals are
split into two
groups
Energy
z
t2g
Figure 5.6 The directions in an Figure 5.7 Crystal field splitting of energy
octahedral complex. levels in an octahedral field.
Rather than referring to the energy level of an isolated metal atom, the weighted mean of these two
sets of perturbed orbitals is taken as the zero: this is sometimes called the Bari centre. The difference in
energy between the two d levels is given either of the symbols Δо or 10 Dq. It follows that the eg orbitals are
+0.6Δо above the average level, and the t2g orbitals are −0.4Δо below the average (Figure 5.8).
The size of the energy gap Δо between the t2g and eg levels can be measured easily by recording the
UV–visible spectrum of the complex. Consider a complex like [Ti(H2O)6]3+. The Ti3+ ion has one d electron.
_
@edubuzznotes
184 Chapter 5 Coordination Compounds
eg
+0.6∆o
Energy
∆o
Average energy level
(Bari centre)
−0.4∆o
t2g
Average energy Metal ion
of metal ion in octahedral
in spherical field
field
In the complex this will occupy the orbital with the lowest energy, that is one of the t2g orbitals (Figure 5.9a).
The complex absorbs light of the correct wavelength (energy) to promote the electron from the t2g level to
the eg level (Figure 5.9b).
eg
t2g
(a) (b)
1
Figure 5.9 d configuration: (a) ground state, (b) excited state.
Ligands which cause only a small degree of crystal feld splitting are termed weak feld ligands. Ligands
which cause a large splitting are called strong feld ligands. Most Δ values are in the range 7,000 cm−1 to
30,000 cm−1. The common ligands can be arranged in ascending order of crystal feld splitting Δ. The order
remains practically constant for different metals, and this series is called the spectrochemical series.
Spectrochemical series
weak feld ligands
I − < Br − < S 2 < Cl − < NO3− < F − < OH − < EtOH < oxalate < H2O
< EDTA < (NH3 and pyridine) < ethylenediamine < dipyridyl
< o•phenanthroline < NO2− < CN −< CO
orbital into a vacant orbital on the ligand. In a similar way, many unsaturated N donors and C donors may
also act as p acceptors.
The magnitude of Δо increases as the charge on the metal ion increases.
Table 5.8 Crystal field splittings for hexa-aqua complexes of M2+ and M3+
Oxidation state Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu
Electronic d2 d3 d4 d5 d6 d7 d8 d9
(+II)
confguration
Δo in cm−1 − 12 600 13 900 7 800 10 400 9 300 8500 12 600
Δo in kJ mol −1
− 151 (166) 93 124 111 102 (151)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Electronic d d d d d d d d8
(+ III)
confguration
Δo in cm−1 20 300 18 900 17 830 21 000 13 700 18 600 − −
Δo in kJ mol −1
243 226 213 (251) 164 222 − −
Note: Values in paranthesis for d4 and d9 are approximate because of tetragonal distortion.
For frst row transition metal ions, the values of Δо for M3+ complexes are roughly 50% larger than the values
for M2+ complexes (Table 5.8).
The value of Δо also increases by about 30% between adjacent members down a group of transition
elements (Table 5.9). The crystal feld stabilization energy in [Ti(H2O)6]3+, which has a d1 confguration,
has previously been shown to be −0.4Δо. In a similar way, complexes containing a metal ion with a d2
confguration will have a CFSE of 2 × −0.4Δо = −0.8Δо, by singly flling two of the t2g orbitals. (This is in
agreement with Hund’s rule that the arrangement with the maximum number of unpaired electrons is the
most stable.) Complexes of d3 metal ions have a CFSE of 3 × −0.4Δо = −1.2Δо.
Complexes with a metal ion with a d4 confguration would be expected to have an electronic arrange•
ment in accordance with Hund’s rule (Figure 5.11a) with four unpaired electrons, and the CFSE will
be (3 × −0.4Δо) + (0.6Δо) = −0.6Δо. An alternative arrangement of electrons which does not comply with
Hund’s rule is shown in Figure 5.11b. This arrangement has two unpaired electrons, and the CFSE is
eg
eg
Energy
Small ∆o Large ∆o
value value
t2g
t2g
(a) (b)
4
Figure 5.11 High- and low-spin complexes: (a) d high-spin arrangement
(weak ligand field); (b) d 4 low-spin arrangement (strong ligand field).
_
@edubuzznotes
5.9 Crystal Field Theory 187
(4 × −0.4∆о) = −1.6∆о. The CFSE is larger than in the previous case. However, the energy P used to pair
the electrons must be allowed for, so the total stabilization energy is −1.6∆о + P. These two arrangements
differ in the number of unpaired electrons. The one with the most unpaired electrons is called ‘high•
spin’ or ‘spin•free’, and the other one the ‘low•spin’ or ‘spin•paired’ arrangement. Both arrangements
have been found to exist. Which arrangement occurs for any particular complex depends on whether
the energy to promote an electron to the upper eg level (that is the crystal feld splitting ∆о) is greater
than the energy to pair electrons (that is P) in the lower t2g level. For a given metal ion P is constant.
Thus the amount of crystal feld splitting is determined by the strength of the ligand feld. A weak feld
ligand such as Cl− will only cause a small splitting of energy levels ∆о Thus it will be more favourable
energetically for electrons to occupy the upper eg level and have a high•spin complex, rather than to
pair electrons. In a similar way, strong feld ligands such as CN− cause a large splitting ∆о. In this case it
requires less energy to pair the electrons and form a low•spin complex. (see Table 5.10.).
Similar arguments apply to high• and low•spin complexes of metal ions with d5, d6 and d7 confgura•
tions. These are summarized in Table 5.11.
Table 5.11 CFSE and electronic arrangements in octahedral complexes
Number Arrangement in weak ligand field Arrangement in strong ligand field
of d
t2g eg CFSE Spin only t2g eg CFSE Spin only
electrons
∆о magnetic ∆о magnetic
moment ms(D) moment ms(D)
− 1.2
d4 + 0.6 4.90 − 1.6 2.83
= − 0.6
− 1.2
d5 + 1.2 5.92 − 2.0 1.73
= − 0.0
− 1.6
d6 + 1.2 4.90 − 2.4 0.00
= − 0.4
− 2.0 − 2.4
d7 + 1.2 3.87 + 0.6 1.73
= − 0.8 = − 1.8
− 2.4 − 2.4
d8 + 1.2 2.83 + 1.2 2.83
= − 1.2 = − 1.2
− 2.4 − 2.4
d9 + 1.8 1.73 + 1.8 1.73
= − 0.6 = − 0.6
− 2.4 − 2.4
d 10 + 2.4 0.00 + 2.4 0.00
= − 0.0 = − 0.0
_
@edubuzznotes
188 Chapter 5 Coordination Compounds
where n( t2 g ) and n( eg ) are the number of electrons occupying the t2g and eg orbitals respectively. The CFSE
is zero for ions with d0 and d10 confgurations in both strong and weak ligand felds. The CFSE is also zero
for d5 confgurations in a weak feld. All the other arrangements have some CFSE, which increases the
thermodynamic stability of the complexes. Thus many transition metal compounds have a higher mea•
sured lattice energy (obtained by calculations using the terms in the Born–Haber cycle) than is calculated
using the Born–Landé, Born–Meyer or Kapustinskii equations. In contrast, the measured (Born–Haber)
and calculated values for compounds of the main groups (which have no CFSE) are in close agreement
(Table 5.12). There is also close agreement in MnF2 which has a d5 confguration and a weak feld ligand:
hence there is no CFSE.
A plot of the lattice energies of the halides of the frst row transition elements in the divalent state is
given in Figure 5.12. In the solid, the coordination number of these metals is 6, and so the structures are
analogous to octahedral complexes. The graphs for each halide show a minimum at Mn2+, which has a
d5confguration. In a weak feld this has a high•spin arrangement with zero CFSE. The confgurations d 0
and d10 also have zero CFSE. The broken line through Ca2+, Mn2+ and Zn2+ represents zero stabilization. The
heights of other points above this line are the crystal feld stabilization energies.
The hydration energies of the M2+ ions of the frst row transition elements are plotted in Figure 5.13a.
2+
M (g) + excess H 2 O → [M(H 2 O)6 ]2 +
The ions Ca2+, Mn2+ and Zn2+ have d 0, d5 and d10 confgurations, and have zero CFSE. An almost straight
line can be drawn through these points. The distance of the other points above this line corresponds to the
CFSE. Values obtained in this way agree with those obtained spectroscopically. A similar graph of the M3+
ions is shown in Figure 5.13b: here the d 0, d5 and d10 species are Sc3+, Fe3+ and Ga3+.
The ionic radii for M2+ ions might be expected to decrease smoothly from Ca2+ to Zn2+ because of the
increasing nuclear charge, and the poor shielding by d electrons. A plot of these radii is given in Figure 5.14.
The change in size is not regular.
A smooth (broken) line is drawn through Ca2+, Mn2+ and Zn2+. These have d 0, d5 and d10 confgurations
as the d orbitals are empty, half full or full. These arrangements constitute an almost spherical feld round
the nucleus. In Ti2+ the d electrons occupy orbitals away from the ligands, providing little or no shielding
of the nuclear charge. Thus the ligands are drawn closer to the nucleus. The increased nuclear charge has
an even greater effect in the case of V2+. At Cr2+ the eg level contains one electron. This is concentrated
_
@edubuzznotes
5.11 Tetragonal Distortion of Octahedral Complexes (Jahn-Teller Distortion) 189
kJmol−1
3000 F
2200
2900
2000
2800
1800
Cl
2700
Br 1600
Lattice energy
2600 I Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga
(a) M2+
2500 4800
2400 4600
2300 4400
4200
2200
4000
2100
Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga
Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn (b) M3+
Figure 5.12 CFSE of dihalides of the first transition Figure 5.13 Enthalpies of hydration
series. (After T.C. Waddington. Lattice energies and for M2+ and M3+, in kJ mol−1.
their significance in inorganic chemistry. Advances in
Inorganic Chemistry and Radiochemistry, 1,
Academic Press, New York, 1959.)
1.0
0.9
in the direction of the ligands, thus providing very good
A°
shielding. Thus the ligands can no longer approach so 0.8
closely and the ionic radius increases. This increase in
size is continued with the flling of the second eg orbital 0.7
at Mn2+. The screening by the eg orbitals is so good that
the radius of Mn2+ is slightly smaller than it would be if 0.6
it were in a truly spherical feld. The same sequence of Ca2+ Sc2+ Ti2+ V2+ Cr2+ Mn2+ Fe2+ Co2+ Ni2+ Cu2+ Zn2+
size changes is repeated in the second half of the series.
Figure 5.14 Octahedral ionic radii of M2+
for first row transition elements.
Ti IVO2 .[Ti IV F6 ]2 −
d0 Strong or weak
[Ti IVCI 6 ]2 −
[Mn II F6 ]4 −
d5 Weak
[FeIII F6 ]3−
[FeII (CN)6 ]4 −
d6 Strong
[CoIII (NH 3 )6 ]3+
[Ni II F6 ]4 −
d8 Weak
[Ni II (H 2O)6 ]2 +
[Zn II (NH 6 )6 ]2 +
d10 Strong or weak
[Zn II (H 2O)6 ]2 +
All other arrangements have an asymmetrical arrangement of d electrons. If the d electrons are asym•
metrically arranged, they will repel some ligands in the complex more than others. Thus the structure is dis•
torted because some ligands are prevented from approaching the metal as closely as others. The eg orbitals
point directly at the ligands. Thus asymmetric flling of the eg orbitals results in some ligands being repelled
more than others. This causes a signifcant distortion of the octahedral shape. In contrast the t2g orbitals do
not point directly at the ligands, but point in between the ligand directions. Thus asymmetric flling of the t2g
orbitals has only a very small effect on the stereochemistry. Distortion caused by asymmetric flling of the
t2g orbitals is usually too small to measure. The electronic arrangements which will produce a large distortion
are shown in Table 5.14.
The two eg orbitals dx2 − y2 and dz2 are normally degenerate. However, if they are asymmetrically flled
then this degeneracy is destroyed, and the two orbitals are no longer equal in energy. If the dz2 orbital con•
tains one more electron than the dx2 − y2 orbital then the ligands approaching along +z and −z will encounter
greater repulsion than the other four ligands. The repulsion and distortion result in elongation of the octa•
hedron along the z axis. This is called tetragonal distortion. Strictly it should be called tetragonal elonga•
tion. This form of distortion is commonly observed.
If the dx2 − y2 orbital contains the extra electron, then elongation will occur along the x and y axes. This
means that the ligands approach more closely along the z axis. Thus there will be four long bonds and two
short bonds. This is equivalent to compressing the octahedron along the z axis and is called tetragonal com•
pression. Tetragonal elongation is much more common than tetragonal compression, and it is not possible
to predict which will occur.
For example, the crystal structure of CrF2 is a distorted rutile (TiO2) structure. Cr2+ is octahedrally sur•
rounded by six F−, and there are four Cr—F bonds of length 1.98−2.01 Å, and two longer bonds of length
_
@edubuzznotes
5.12 Square Planar Arrangements 191
2.43 Å. The octahedron is said to be tetragonally distorted. The electronic arrangement in Cr2+ is d4. F− is
a weak feld ligand, and so the t2g level contains three electrons and the eg level contains one electron. The
dx2 − y2 orbital has four lobes whilst the dz2 orbital has only two lobes pointing at the ligands. To minimize
repulsion with the ligands, the single eg electron will occupy the dz2 orbital. This is equivalent to splitting
the degeneracy of the eg level so that dz2 is of lower energy, i.e. more stable, and dx2 − y2 is of higher energy, i.e.
less stable. Thus the two ligands approaching along the +z and −z directions are subjected to greater repul•
sion than the four ligands along +x, −x, +y and −y. This causes tetragonal distortion with four short bonds
and two long bonds. In the same way MnF3 contains Mn3+ with a d4 confguration, and forms a tetragonally
distorted octahedral structure.
Many Cu(+II) salts and complexes also show tetragonally distorted octahedral structures. Cu2+ has a
9
d confguration:
t 2g eg
To minimize repulsion with the ligands, two electrons occupy the dz2 orbital and one electron occupies
the dx2 − y2 orbital. Thus the two ligands along −z and −z are repelled more strongly than are the other four
ligands.
The examples above show that whenever the dz2 and dx2 − y2 orbitals are unequally occupied, distor•
tion occurs. This is known as Jahn–Teller distortion. The Jahn–Teller theorem states that ‘Any non•linear
molecular system in a degenerate electronic state will be unstable, and will undergo some sort of distortion
to lower its symmetry and remove the degeneracy.’ More simply, molecules or complexes (of any shape
except linear), which have an unequally flled set of orbitals (either t2g or eg), will be distorted. In octahedral
complexes distortions from the t2g level are too small to be detected. However, distortions resulting from
uneven flling of the eg orbitals are very important.
[NiII(NH3)6]2+.
The single electron in the dx2 − y2 orbital is being repelled by
four ligands, whilst the electron in the dz2 orbital is only being
repelled by two ligands. Thus the energy of the dx2 − y2 increases
t2g
relative to that of dz2 . If the ligand feld is suffciently strong,
the difference in energy between these two orbitals becomes
larger than the energy needed to pair the electrons. Under these Figure 5.15 d 8 arrangement in weak
conditions, a more stable arrangement arises when both the eg elec• octahedral field.
trons pair up and occupy the lower energy dz2 orbital. This leaves
the dx2 − y2 orbital empty (Figure 5.16). Thus four ligands can now
approach along the +x, −x, +y and −y directions without any diffculty, as the dx2 − y2 orbital is empty. However,
ligands approaching along the +z and −z directions meet very strong repulsive forces from the flled dz2
orbital (Figure 5.17). Thus only four ligands succeed in bonding to the metal. A square planar complex is
formed, the attempt to form an octahedral complex being unsuccessful.
The amount of tetragonal distortion that occurs depends on the particular metal ion and ligands.
Sometimes the tetragonal distortion may become so large that the dz2 orbital is lower in energy than
the dxy orbital as shown in Figure 5.18. In square planar complexes of CoII, NiII and CuII the dz2 orbital has
nearly the same energy as the dxz and dyz orbitals. In [PtCl4]2− the dz2 orbital is lower in energy than the dxz
and dyz orbitals.
_
@edubuzznotes
192 Chapter 5 Coordination Compounds
dx 2−y2 dx 2−y 2
dz2 dz2
Energy
dxy
t2g
(a) (b)
8
Figure 5.16 d arrangement in very strong octahedral field. Tetragonal distortion splits (a) the eg level;
and (b) also splits the t2g level. The dxy orbital is higher in energy than the dxz or dyz. (For simplicity this
is sometimes ignored.)
dx 2−y 2
eg
z dxy
y
Energy
dz2
t2g
Square planar complexes are formed by d8 ions with strong feld ligands, for example [NiII(CN)4]2−.
The crystal feld splitting Δо is larger for second and third row transition elements, and for more highly
charged species. All the complexes of Pt(+II) and Au(+III) are square planar – including those with weak
feld ligands such as halide ions.
Square planar structures can also arise from d4 ions in a weak ligand feld. In this case the dz2 orbital
only contains one electron. Some ions that form square planar complexes are given in Table 5.15.
d4 Cr(+II) Weak 4
6
d Fe(+II) (Haem) 2
d7 Co(+II) Strong 1
8
d Ni(+II), Rh(+I), Ir(+I) Strong 0
Pd(+II), Pt(+II), Au(+III) Strong and weak 0
9
d Cu(+II), Ag(+II)) Strong and weak 1
_
@edubuzznotes
5.13 Tetrahedral Complexes 193
dx 2−y 2 dz 2
x
y
The direction of approach of the ligands does not coincide exactly with either the eg or the t2g orbit•
als. The angle between an eg orbital, the central metal and the ligand is half the tetrahedral angle =
109°28 ′ / 2 = 54°44 ′. The angle between a t2g orbital, the central metal and the ligand is 35°16′. Thus the t2g
orbitals are nearer to the direction of the ligands than the eg orbitals. (Alternatively the t2g orbitals are half
the side of the cube away from the approach of the ligands, whilst the eg orbitals are half the diagonal of
the cube away.) The approach of the ligands raises the energy of both sets of orbitals. The energy of the t2g
orbitals is raised most because they are closest to the ligands. This crystal feld splitting is the opposite way
round to that in octahedral complexes (Figure 5.21).
The t2g orbitals are 0.4Δt above the weighted average energy of the two groups (the Bari centre) and the
eg orbitals are 0.6Δt below the average (Figure 5.22).
t 2g
t2g
d orbitals are
split into two +0.4 Dt
groups Average
energy level
Energy
Dt (Bari centre
Energy
eg
−0.6 Dt
eg
Average energy Metal ion
Free metal ion Metal ion of metal ion in tetrahedral
(five degenerate in tetrahedral in spherical field
d orbitals) field field
Figure 5.21 Crystal field splitting of energy Figure 5.22 Energy levels for d orbitals in
levels in a tetrahedral field. a tetrahedral field.
_
@edubuzznotes
194 Chapter 5 Coordination Compounds
The magnitude of the crystal feld splitting Δt in tetrahedral complexes is considerably less than in octa•
hedral felds. There are two reasons for this:
1. There are only four ligands instead of six, so the ligand feld is only two thirds the size: hence the ligand
feld splitting is also two thirds the size
2. The direction of the orbitals does not coincide with the direction of the ligands. This reduces the crystal
feld splitting by roughly a further two thirds.
Thus the tetrahedral crystal feld splitting Δt roughly 2/3 × 2/3 = 4/9 of the octahedral crystal feld splitting
Δo. Strong feld ligands cause a bigger energy difference between t2g and eg than weak feld ligands.
However, the tetrahedral splitting Δt is always much smaller than the octahedral splitting Δ0. Thus it is
never energetically favourable to pair electrons, and all tetrahedral complexes are high•spin.
The CFSE in both octahedral and tetrahedral environments is given in Table 5.16. This shows that for
d0, d5 and d10 arrangements the CFSE is zero in both octahedral and tetrahedral complexes. For all other
electronic arrangements there is some CFSE, and the octahedral CFSE is greater than the tetrahedral
CFSE. It follows that octahedral complexes are generally more stable and more common than tetrahedral
complexes. This is partly because there are six bond energy terms rather than four, and partly because there
is a larger CFSE term. Despite this some tetrahedral complexes are formed, and are stable. Tetrahedral
complexes are favoured:
1. Where the ligands are large and bulky and could cause crowding in an octahedral complex.
2. Where attainment of a regular shape is important. For tetrahedral structures d 0, d2, d5, d7 and d10
IV 0 0 VII 0
confgurations are regular. Some tetrahedral complexes which are regular are: Ti Cl 4 (eg , t2 g ),[Mn O4 ] (
− −
0
]− (eg0 , t20g ),[FeVI O4 ]2 − (eg2 , t20g ),[FeIII Cl 4 ]− (eg2 , t23g ),[CoII Cl 4 ]2 − (eg4 , t23g ) and [Zn II Cl 4 ]2− (eg4 , t26g ).
3. When the ligands are weak feld, and the loss in CFSE is thus less important.
4. Where the central metal has a low oxidation state. This reduces the magnitude of Δ.
_
@edubuzznotes
5.14 Magnetism 195
5.14 | MAGNETISM
The magnetic moment can be measured using a Gouy balance. If we assume that the magnetic moment
arises entirely from unpaired electron spins then the ‘spin only’ formula can be used to estimate n, the
number of unpaired electrons. This gives reasonable agreement for complexes of the frst row of transition
metals.
m s = n(n + 2)
Once the number of unpaired electrons is known, either the valence bond or the crystal feld theory
can be used to work out the shape of the complex, the oxidation state of the metal, and, for octahedral
complexes, whether inner or outer d orbitals are used. For example, Co (+III) forms many complexes, all
of which are octahedral. Most of them are diamagnetic, but [CoF6]3− is paramagnetic with an observed
magnetic moment of 5.3 BM. Crystal feld theory explains this (Figure 5.23).
Co(+II) forms both tetrahedral and square planar four•coordinate complexes.These can be distinguished
by magnetic measurements (Figure 5.24).
However, orbital angular momentum also contributes to a greater or lesser degree to the magnetic
moment. For the second and third row transition elements not only is this contribution signifcant, but
spin orbit coupling may occur. Because of this, the ‘spin only’ approximation is no longer valid, and there
is extensive temperature•dependent paramagnetism. Thus the simple interpretation of magnetic moments
in terms of the number of unpaired electrons cannot be extended from the frst row of transition elements
to the second and third rows. The temperature dependence is explained by the spin orbit coupling.
This removes the degeneracy from the lowest energy level in the ground state. Thermal energy then allows
a variety of levels to be populated.
t2g
Co3+ octahedral complex with strong field ligands
Energy
eg
eg
Energy
dxy
dz2
Energy
−
(iv) ←: SCN : thiocyanato or thiocyanato − S
−
←: NC S : isothiocyanato or thiocyanato − N
O S
C
C
(v) O S : dithiooxalato (O, O′)
S O
C
C
(iv) S O : dithiooxalato (S, S′)
9. For anionic complexes, metal names are ended with ‘ate’, i.e. ‘ate’ is to replace ‘ium’, ‘um’, or ‘enum’
in the metal’s name. For example,
(i) Aluminium : Aluminate
(ii) Platinum : Platinate
(iii) Molybdenum : Molybdate
(iv) Zinc : Zincate
(v) Nickel : Nickelate
(vi) Cobalt : Cobaltate
(vii) Iron : Ferrate
(viii) Manganese : Manganate
10. The oxidation number of the central atom is written in Roman numerals within brackets, after the
name of the central atom. For example, as. (II), (−I), (0), etc.
Alternatively, the charge on a coordination entity may be indicated. The net charge is written in Arabic
numerals, with the number preceding the charge sign and enclosed in parenthesis. It follows the name
of the central atom (including the ending ‘ate’ if applicable) without the intervention of a space.
For example,
(i) K 4 [ Fe(CN)6 ]: potassium hexacyanidoferrate (II)
or potassium hexacyanidoferrate (4−)
or tetrapotassium hexacyanidoferrate
(ii) K 2 [OsCl 5 N]: potassium pentachloridonitridoosmate (2−)
or potassium pentachloridonitridoosmate (VI)
(iii) [CuCl 2 {O = C(NH 2 )2 }2 ]0 : dichloridobis (urea) copper (II)
(iv) [CoCl(NH 3 )5 ]Cl 2 : pentamminechloridocobalt (III) chloride
or pentaamminechloridocobalt (2+) chloride
11. If there is any water of crystallization, it is to included in the name. For example,
[Cr(H 2O)4 Cl 2 ]Cl ⋅ 2 H 2O: tetraaquadichlorido chromium (III) chloride • 2 • water or
tetraaquadichlorido chromium (III) chloride dihydrate
These rules are illustrated by the following examples:
5.17 | ISOMERISM
Compounds that have the same chemical formula but different structural arrangements are called isomers.
Because of the complicated formulae of many coordination compounds, the variety of bond types and the
number of shapes possible, many different types of isomerism occur. Werner’s classifcation into polymer•
ization, ionization, hydrate linkage, coordination, coordination position, and geometric and optical isomerism
is still generally accepted.
Polymerization isomerism
This is not true isomerism because it occurs between compounds having the same empirical formula,but different
molecular weights. Thus [Pt(NH3)2Cl2], [Pt(NH3)4][PtCl4], [Pt(NH3)4][Pt(NH3)Cl3]2 and [Pt(NH3)3Cl]2[PtCl4]
3+ 6+
OH OH
(NH3)3 Co OH Co(NH3)3 and Co Co(NH3)4
OH OH
3
all have the same empirical formula. Polymerization isomerism may be due to a different number of nuclei in
the complex, as shown in Figure 5.25.
Ionization isomerism
This type of isomerism is due to the exchange of groups between the complex ion and the ions outside it.
[Co(NH3)5Br]SO4 is red–violet. An aqueous solution gives a white precipitate of BaSO4 with BaCl2 solution,
thus confrming the presence of free SO2− 4 ions. In contrast [Co(NH3)5SO4]Br is red. A solution of this complex
does not give a positive sulphate test with BaCl2. It does give a cream•coloured precipitate of AgBr with AgNO3,
thus confrming the presence of free Br − ions. Note that the sulphate ion occupies only one coordination posi•
tion even though it has two negative charges. Other examples of ionization isomerism are [Pt(NH3)4Cl2]Br2
and [Pt(NH3)4Br2]Cl2, and [Co(en)2NO2 ∙ Cl]SCN, [Co(en)2NO2 ∙ SCN]Cl and [Co(en)2Cl ∙ SCN]NO2.
Hydrate isomerism
This type of isomerism is shown by compounds having the same formula but differing only in the number
of water molecules of crystallization. More broadly, it can also be called solvent isomerism to include
other solvents also (like NH 3 or other ligands) present in a similar manner. Some examples of hydrate
isomerism are as follows
1. CrCl 3 ⋅ 6 H 2 O can exist in following forms:
[Cr(H 2 O)6 ]Cl 3: violet (three chloride ions)
_
@edubuzznotes
200 Chapter 5 Coordination Compounds
Linkage isomerism
Certain ligands contain more than one atom which could donate an electron pair. Thus this type of isom•
erism is shown by ambidentate ligands. For example, in the NO2− ion, either N or O atoms can act as the
electron pair donor. Thus there is the possibility of isomerism. Two different complexes [Co(NH3)5NO2]Cl2
have been prepared, each containing the NO2− group in the complex ion. One is red and is easily decom•
posed by acids to give nitrous acid. It contains Co—ONO and is a nitrito complex. The other complex is
yellow and is stable to acids. It contains the Co—NO2 group and is a nitro compound. The two materials
are represented in Figure 5.26.
NH3 2+ NH3 2+
H3N ONO H3N NO2
Co and Co
H3N NH3 H3N NH3
NH3 NH3
Red Yellow
Nitritopentamminecobalt(III) Nitropentamminecobalt(III)
ion ion
This type of isomerism also occurs with other ligands such as SCN− , OCN−, S2O32−, CN−, NOS−, NO and
C2O2S22− (dithiooxalate ion). For example,
CH2 CH2
Me2N CH2
C
N
2− 2−
S O O S O S S O
C C C C
Pd2+ and Pd2+
C C C C
S O O S O S S O
Coordination isomerism
When both the positive and negative ions are complex ions, isomerism may be caused by the interchange
of ligands between the anion and cation, for example [Co(NH3)6][Cr(CN)6] and [Cr(NH3)6][Co(CN)6].
Intermediate types between these extremes are also possible. For example,
_
@edubuzznotes
5.17 Isomerism 201
NH2
(NH3)4Co Co(NH3)2Cl2 Cl2 Cl Cl Cl
Pd Pd
O2
Ph3P Cl PPh3
and and
Ph3P Cl Cl
NH2
Pd Pd
Cl(NH3)3Co Co(NH3)3Cl Cl2 Ph3P Cl Cl
O2
(Continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
202 Chapter 5 Coordination Compounds
(Continued)
b. When ligands are bidentate symmetrical and monodentate type, having no chiral centre: The various
structures possible are listed below. Here M is the metal ion, AA is a bidentate symmetrical ligand
and a, b, c, and d represent monodentate ligands.
c. When ligands are bidentate unsymmetrical and monodentate type having no chiral centre: The vari•
ous structures possible are listed below. Here M is the metal ion, AB is a bidentate unsymmetrical
ligand and a, b, c, and d represent monodentate ligands.
M M M M M
c b b c b c a c a b
b a a b c
Optically active Optically inactive Optically inactive Optically inactive Optically inactive
(cis w.r.t. all) (trans w.r.t all) (trans w.r.t a) (trans w.r.t b) (trans w.r.t c)
Figure 5.28 Possible structures for octahedral complexes of the type [Ma2b2c2]n±.
(ii) For [M(AA)a 2 bc]n± : The various structures possible are shown in Figure 5.29.
a a a b
A b A a A a A a
M M M M
A c A b A c A a
a c b c
Optically inactive Optically active Optically active Optically inactive
Figure 5.29 Possible structures for octahedral complexes of the type [M(AA)a2bc]n± .
(iii) For [M(AB)a 2 b 2 ]n± : The various structures possible are shown in Figure 5.30.
a a a b
A b A a A b A a
M M M M
B b B b B a B a
a b b b
Optically inactive Optically active Optically active Optically inactive
Figure 5.30 Possible structures for octahedral complexes of the type [M(AB)a2b2]n± .
(iv) For Ma 3 b 3: The various structures possible are shown in Figure 5.31.
a a
a a b a
M and M
b b a b
b b
Facial (Fac) Meridional (Mer)
Figure 5.31 Possible structures for octahedral complexes of the type Ma3b3.
M a M
a a a a
Trigonal bipyramidal Square pyramidal
b. The formula Ma 2 b 3 can exist in six possible geometries as shown in Figure 5.33.
a b b
b a b a b b b a b a
a b
M b M a M a M M M
b a b b a b b b a b a b
(a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f)
Figure 5.33 Possible structures for complexes of the type Ma2b3. Here (a), (b), (c) are geometrical
isomers of each other but any one of (a), (b), (c) and any one of (d), (e), (f) are allogon isomers
of each other.
3. For coordination number 4
The complexes with coordination number four (e.g. Ma 4 ) can have two possible geometries, i.e. tetra•
hedral or square planar (Figure 5.34).
a
a a
M M
a
a a
a a
Tetrahedral Square planar
Figure 5.34 Possible structures for complexes with coordination number four.
a. For tetrahedral geometry:
(i) If the ligands are different, then no geometrical isomerism is observed in tetrahedral geometry,
i.e. complexes of the type Mabcd exist as two optical isomers only (Figure 5.35).
a a
M d M
d
b c c b
dl - pair
(ii) If symmetrical bidentate ligands having no chiral center are present, then the complexes are
optically inactive. For example, the following compounds are optically inactive: [Zn(acac)2 ]0 ,
o -
[Be(C 2O4 )2 ]2− and B C6H4 2
o
(iii) If unsymmetrical bidentate ligands are present, then the compound will be optically active. For
example, the following compounds are optically active:
o -
B C
C6H4 2 and [Zn(gly)2 ]0
o
O
b. For square planar geometry:
(i) The complexes with formula [Ma 4 ]n ± , [Ma 3 b]n ± , [M(AA)2 ]n ± , [M(AA)a 2 ]n ± and [M(AB)a 2 ]n ±
do not show geometrical isomerism since possible geometry is only one. Here, a, b are simple
monodentate ligands; AA is a symmetrical bidentate ligand and AB is an unsymmetrical
bidentate ligand, all having no chiral centre.
(ii) The complexes with formulae [Ma 2 b 2 ]n± and [Ma 2 bc] can have two geometrical isomers, as
shown in Figure 5.36 a and 5.36 b respectively.
_
@edubuzznotes
5.17 Isomerism 205
a b a a
M M
c/b a b b/c
trans cis
(a) (b)
Figure 5.36 Geometrical isomers for complexes of the type [Ma2b2]n± and [Ma2bc] .
(iii) The complexes with formula [Mabcd]n± can have three geometrical isomers (Figure 5.37).
For these isomers, cis and trans terminology is not applicable or it is to be mentioned with
respect to a, b or b, c, etc.
a b a c a c
M M M
d c d b b d
M M
B B B A
M M
B b B a
Pt2+ Pt2+
Me N N Me Me N N Me
Optically inactive Optically inactive
Me N N Me Me N N Me
Pt2+ Pt2+
Me N N Me Me N N Me
Optically active Optically active
Me N N Me
Pt2+
Me N N Me
Optically inactive
(vii) The complexes of the type [M(AB)2 ]n± can show geometrical as well as∗optical isomerism if the
ligand AB has a chiral centre. For example, the compound [Pd(NH 2 − C H(CH 3 ) − CO2− )2 ]0 can
have four geometrical isomers (Figure 5.41).
Me Me H H2N O
H2N NH2 O
C C C C
H H Me H
Pd2+ Pd2+
C C C C
O O O NH2 Me
O O O
Optically inactive (Plane of symmetry) Optically active
(cis-cis) (trans-cis)
H Me Me
H2N NH2 H2N O O
C C C C
H H H
Me Pd2+ Pd2+
C C C C
O O Me
O O O O NH2
Optically active Optically inactive (Centre of symmetry)
(cis-trans) (trans-trans)
(viii) Geometrical isomers are possible for square planar binuclear complexes of the type,
[Pd 2Cl 4 (PPh 3 )2 ] (Figure 5.42)
Cl Cl Cl Cl Cl PPh3
Pd Pd Pd Pd
8. Which of the following complex has low spin? 17. Select correct statement about this complex [Pt(ox)
(A) K2 [Fe(CN)6] (py)2(O2)(H2O)]
(B) K3 [Fe(CN)6] (A) Oxidation state of O2 is −1.
(C) K3 [Co(OX)3] (B) EAN of Pt is 86.
(D) All of these (C) Complex will show geometrical as well as optical
9. Which of the following complex is optically inactive isomerism.
but its other geometrical isomer is optically active? (D) Both (B) and (C).
(A) trans•tetraaquadichloridocobalt (III) nitrate 18. Select the incorrect statement about metal carbonyl
(B) mer•triaquatrifuoridocobalt (III) complex compounds.
(C) trans•diamminebis (ethane 1, 2 diamine) cobalt (A) Metal•carbon bonds in metal carbonyls possess
(III) chloride both s and p character.
(D) trans•diamminedichloridoplatinum (II) (B) Due to synergic, bonding metal•carbon bond
10. Which of the following complexes is colourless? becomes weak.
(A) MnO4− (C) Due to synergic bonding carbon•oxygen bond
(B) [Ni(H2O)6]2+ strength decreases.
(C) [Cu(CH3CN)4]+ (D) In metal carbonyls the extent of synergic bond•
(D) [Cr(H2O)6]3+ ing will increase with increase in negative charge
on central metal ion.
11. The correct statement is
(A) [NiCl4]2− is sp3 hybridized and paramagnetic in 19. In which of the following complexes, spin only mag•
nature. netic moment is independent of the nature of ligand?
(B) [PtCl4]2− is dsp2 hybridized and paramagnetic in (L = monodentate ligand)
nature. II II
(C) [Ni(CO)4] is dsp2 hybridized and diamagnetic in (A) [NiL4] (B) [CoL6]
nature.
(D) [Co(H2O)6]3+ is sp3d2 hybridized and diamagnetic III III
in nature. (C) [FeL6] (D) [CrL6]
12. Which of the following complex is most stable? 20. Match the complexes with their characteristics.
(A) [Co(H2O)6]Cl3
(B) K3[Co(CN)6] Column-I Column-II
2−
(C) K3 [Co(OX)3] (P) [Ni(CN)2] (1) Spin magnetic moment
(D) K3 [CoF6] = 8 BM
13. The geometries of [Co(CO)4]− and [Cd (CN)4]2− are (Q) Fe(CO)5 (2) sp3 hybridized state of
(A) both square planar. central metal
(B) both tetrahedral. (R) [MnBr4]2− (3) dsp2 hybridized state
(C) tetrahedral and square planar, respectively. of central metal
(D) square planar and tetrahedral, respectively.
(S) [Ni(NH3)6]2+ (4) Trigonal bipyramidal
14. Which of the following species exists as optically complex
inactive form?
(A) [Fe(en)3]Cl3 Code:
(B) [RhCl(PPh3)(CO)(H2O)] P Q R S
(C) [Pd(en)2Cl2] (A) 3 4 1 2
(D) O (B) 3 4 2 1
=
C (C) 1 4 3 2
O (D) 2 4 3 1
Na B 21. Which of the following statements is correct for the
complex [ Fe(H 2O)5 NO] SO4 ?
O 2
(A) The EAN value of Fe in this complex depends on
15. Which of the following ligands can act as chelating the charge of NO ligand.
agent but does not have a chiral centre? (B) The EAN value of Fe in this complex does not
(A) nta3− (B) bn depend on the charge of NO ligand.
(C) pn (D) None of these (C) The hybridization of the central atom is d 2 sp3.
16. Which type of isomerism may be shown by the com• (D) It is paramagnetic with µ = 1.73 B.M.
plex [Ru(NH3)4 )(H2O)(S2O3)]NO3? 22. The EAN value of [Ti(σ − C 5 H 5 )2 (π − C 5 H 5 )2 ]0 is
(A) Ionization isomerism (A) 32
(B) Linkage isomerism (B) 33
(C) Geometrical isomersim (C) 34
(D) All of these (D) 35
_
@edubuzznotes
208 Chapter 5 Coordination Compounds
(I) fac•Mo(CO)3 (PF3 )3 (II) fac•Mo(CO)3 (PCl 3 )3 13. Which of the following has higher multiple bond
(III) fac•Mo(CO)3 (PMe3 )3 character in M−C bond?
(A) I < II < III. (B) I >II >III. (A) [Ni(CO)4]
(C) I = II = III. (D) II >I >III. (B) [Co(CO)4]–
(C) [Fe(CO)4]2–
8. In which of the following complexes is the bond
(D) (B) and (C) both have equal bond character in
order of C – O bond minimum?
(A) [Mn(CO)6 ]+ (B) [Cr(CO)6 ] M−C bond.
Passage 5: For Questions 12-13 16. Due to the presence of ambidentate ligands coor•
dination compounds show isomerism, palladium
Synergic bond is a type of back bonding. complexes of the type [Pd(C6H5)2(SCN)2] and
12. Which of the following has higher stretching fre• [Pd(C6H5)2(NCS)2] are
(A) linkage isomers.
quency for C−O bond?
(B) coordination isomers.
(A) [Ni(CO)3PF3]
(C) ionisation isomers.
(B) [Ni(CO)3(PMe3)]
(D) geometrical isomers.
(C) Both have equal stretching frequency.
(D) None of these.
6. Statement I: SnCl 2 does not act as ligand but SnCl 3− Statement II: t26g eg1 is the electronic confguration for
acts as good ligand. both cases.
Statement II: On addition of Cl − to SnCl 2, the orbital 9. Statement I: CdS is yellow coloured.
containing the lone pair acquires less s•character. Statement II: The d − d transition does not take place
7. Statement I: [Cr(H 2O)6 ] 3+
is more acidic compared in this compound.
to [ Fe(H 2O)6 ]3+ . 10. Statement I: [Co(en)2(NH3)Br]SO4 has lower electri•
Statement II: Both are inner orbital complexes. cal conductivity as compared to [Co(en)2(NH3)SO4]
8. Statement I: Under the infuence of a strong feld Br.
ligand, d7•system will have only one unpaired elec• Statement II: Both the ions produce the same
tron either in coordination number six or four. number of ions in solution.
In each of the following questions, statements are given while those in Column II are labelled as (P), (Q), (R), (S)
in two columns, which have to be matched. The state• and (T). Any given statement in Column I can have cor•
ments in Column I are labelled as (A), (B), (C) and (D), rect matching with one or more statements in Column II.
_
@edubuzznotes
Matrix–Match Type Questions 213
Column I Column II
n± −a / +b
(A) [M(AB)a 3 b] →[M(AB)a 2 b 2 ] n± (P) The number of pairs of enantiomers is increased by one.
n± −c / +b
(B) [M(AB)a 2 bc] →[M(AB)a 2 b 2 ] n± (Q) The number of geometrical isomers in the final
product is four.
b / +d
(C) [Ma 3 b 2 c]n ± − →[Ma 3 bcd]n ± (R) The number of stereoisomers is increased to double of
the original or decreased to half of the original.
a /+b
(D) [M(AA)a 3 b]n ± − →[M(AA)a 2 b 2 ]n ±
5. Match the complex compounds with the properties 7. Match the pair of complex compounds with the
not depicted by them. properties that are same in them.
(A) [ Fe(CO)4 ]2− (P) Hybridization is dsp2. (A) [Ti(H 2O)6 ]3+ (P) Hybridization.
and [Mn(NH 3 )6 ]2+
(B) [Pt(NH 3 )2 Cl 2 ] (Q) Hybridization is sp3.
(C) [Pt(bn)2 ]2+ (R) Exhibits geometrical (B) [AuCl 4 ]− (Q) Magnetic moment value.
isomerism. and [PdCl 4 ]2−
(D) [Zn(gly)2 ]0 (S) Low spin complex. (C) [ Fe(DMG)2 ]0 (R) EAN value.
(T) Exhibits optical
and Ni(DMG)2 ]0
isomerism.
6. Match the pair of complex compounds with the proper• (D) [ Fe(CO)5 ]0 and (S) Shape.
ties that are different in them. [Ni(CO)4 ]0
8. Match the coordination complex with the number of 9. Match the complex with its property.
isomers formed.
Column I Column II
Column I Column II 3–
(A) [Co(C2O4)3] (P) High•spin complex.
(A) [M(AB)3]n± (P) Complex having two (B) [CoF6] 3–
(Q) Low•spin complex.
optically active isomers.
(C) [Ni(NH3)6]2+ (R) Zero electron in eg set of
(B) [Ma2b2c2]n± (Q) Complex having four orbital.
stereoisomers.
(D) [Cr(CN)6]3– (S) Paramagnetic behaviour.
(C) [M(AA)a2b2]n± (R) Complex having odd number
(T) d2sp3 hybridization.
of geometrical isomers.
(D) [Ma3bcd]n± (S) Complex having even
number of geometrical
isomers.
(T) All geometrical isomerism
are not optically active.
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (A) 8. (D) 15. (A) 22. (C) 29. (B)
2. (B) 9. (C) 16. (D) 23. (A) 30. (B)
3. (D) 10. (C) 17. (D) 24. (A) 31. (C)
4. (A) 11. (A) 18. (B) 25. (A) 32. (B)
5. (A) 12. (B) 19. (D) 26. (B) 33. (A)
6. (D) 13. (B) 20. (B) 27. (C) 34. (B)
7. (A) 14. (B) 21. (B) 28. (C) 35. (C)
1. (B), (C) 5. (A), (B), (C), (D) 9. (A), (C), (D) 13. (A), (D) 17. (A), (D)
2. (A), (D) 6. (B), (D) 10. (C), (D) 14. (A), (B), (D)
3. (A), (C), (D) 7. (A), (B) 11. (A), (C), (D) 15. (A), (B), (C), (D)
4. (A), (B), (C), (D) 8. (A), (B), (C) 12. (A), (C), (D) 16. (A), (D)
6 Metallurgy
Metallurgy Physical
methods
Chemical
methods
Calcination Roasting Liquation
Magnetic Reduction of
Leaching Electrolysis
separation oxide to metal
Hydraulic Using
washing Distillation
1. Heat
2. Carbon
3. Carbon monoxide
Froth 4.Aluminium
floatation 5. Electrolysis
Metallurgical processes.
Metallurgy is the subject which deals with the science and Contents
technology applied for the extraction of metals economically
on a large scale from their respective ores. Another aspect 6.1 Types of Ores
of metallurgy deals with making of alloys which are metallic 6.2 Principal Steps in the
solutions composed of two or more elements. Recovery of a Metal
To begin with we must understand the difference between from its Ore
a mineral and an ore. 6.3 Concentration or
1. Mineral: The compounds of a metal which are naturally Dressing of Ore
available in the earth’s crust and can be obtained by mining are 6.4 Conversion of
called minerals. A mineral may consist of one or more metallic Concentrated Ore into
compounds, having almost fxed chemical composition. its Oxide
2. Ore: The minerals from which a metal can be extracted 6.5 Different Reduction
economically and conveniently are called ores. Processes
6.6 Purification or Refining
Hence all ores are minerals but all minerals are not ores. For of Metal
example, FeS2 (iron pyrite) is abundantly available in the
6.7 Theromodynamics of
Earth’s crust but cannot be used as ore of iron. The chemical
Reduction Process
reactions involved in conversion of iron pyrite to iron are:
6.8 Alloys and Amalgams
2 FeS 2 + 11
O2 ® Fe2 O3 + 4SO2 6.9 Different types of
2
Furnaces used in
Fe2 O3 + 3C → 2 Fe + 3CO Metallurgy
6.10 Extraction of Silver
The removal of S from FeS2 to obtain iron involves high 6.11 Extraction of Gold by
cost of production and presence of high percentage of sulphur Cyanide Process
in iron makes it brittle and thus of no use. 6.12 Extraction of Tin
The impurities present in the ore are known as gangue. 6.13 Extraction of Magnesium
For example, silica (SiO2) is a common impurity present in 6.14 Extraction of Aluminium
most of the ores.
6.15 Extraction of Lead
6.16 Extraction of Copper
6.17 Extraction of Zinc
6.18 Extraction of Iron
_
@edubuzznotes
218 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
Ore
Na3AlF6 Cryolite
AgCl Horn silver
KCl⋅MgCl2⋅6H2O Carnalite
Cu2Cl(OH)3 Atacamite
4. Oxy salt ores
a. Carbonate ores
CaCO3 Limestone
MgCO3 Magnesite
CaCO3⋅MgCO3 Dolomite
FeCO3 Siderite
ZnCO3 Calamine
Cu(OH)2⋅CuCO3/Cu2(OH)2CO3 Malachite or Basic copper carbonate
Cu(OH)2⋅2CuCO3 Azurite
PbCO3 Cerrusite
b. Sulphate ores
CaSO4⋅2H2O Gypsum K2SO4 · MgSO4 · MgCl2 · 6H2O Kainite
MgSO4⋅7H2O Epsom salt MgSO4 · H2O Kieserite
PbSO4 Anglesite K2SO4 · Al2(SO4)3 · 4Al(OH)3 Alunite
BaSO4 Baryte PbO · PbSO4 Lanarkite
Na2SO4⋅10H2O Glauber Salt
CuSO4⋅5H2O Chalcanthite
c. Nitrate ores
KNO3 Indian saltpeter
NaNO3 Chile saltpeter
Air
Finely
divided ore
+
Pine oil Sulphide ore
+ +
Sodium ethyl xanthate Froth
+
Water
required to create a bubble of radius r is 2 × 4pr 2 × E, where E is the energy required to create unit
surface area and, is directly proportional to surface tension.
The froth foatation process is usually applied for sulphide ores and the schematic representation is
shown in Figure 6.4. Sodium ethyl xanthate acts as a collector of sulphide ore.
S
CH3 CH2 O C
S Na+
Hydrophobic Hydrophilic end
end
Particle
Coating of CuS
Accordingly using suitable activators, the froth fotation process can also be applied for non•sulphide ore.
For example, Na2S is suitable activator for malachite (CuCO3 ·Cu(OH)2) and anglesite (PbSO4) in which
the coatings of CuS and PbS are formed by the activator, respectively.
Depressant is a substance that is added to suppress the foating characteristic of the ore particles. For
example, galena (PbS) is associated with another sulphide impurity ZnS which also rises to the surface
with the froth. The reagent NaCN/KCN is used to suppress the foating characteristics of ZnS by forming
a soluble complex with KCN.
PbS(s) + NaCN / KCN → No reaction
ZnS(s) + 4[NaCN / KCN] → [Zn(CN)4 ]2 − + 4[Na + / K + ] + S 2 −
_
@edubuzznotes
222 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
2. Ag2S is dissolved out from silver glance (Ag2S + impurity) by using NaCN solution in the presence of air.
Ag 2 S + 4 NaCN → 2[Ag(CN)2 ]− + 4 Na + + S 2 −
3. In Sn extraction, the removal of impurities like FeS2 and Cu2S also involves application of the leaching
process. These two sulphides are roasted carefully to produce soluble sulphates that are washed out
with hot water.
Calcination
It is the process in which the concentrated ore is heated to a high temperature (just below its fusion
temperature) in the absence of air (or limited supply of air).
1. This process is mainly used for a carbonate ore to get its oxide
3. Impurities like S, As and Sb are removed in the form of their elemental vapours by calcination.
4. The products formed by calcination are always porous.
Roasting
It is the process in which the concentrated ore is heated to a high temperature (just below its fusion
temperature) in presence of excess of air.
1. This process is mainly applicable for sulphide ores to get the corresponding metal oxides.
2. Sometimes the lower oxidation state oxide gets converted into higher oxidation state oxide. For
example,
2 FeO + 1 O2 → Fe2 O3
2
Note: The chief reducing agent for carbon reduction process is CO(g) and not C(s) because the interaction
between solid oxide ore and gaseous CO is much higher as compared to that between the solid oxide ore
and solid C.
Self reduction
This method is applicable to some of the sulphides, e.g. PbS, Cu2S and HgS. It does not involve use of
reducing agent from an external source. Here the sulphide ore is partially roasted into its oxide, which in
turn reacts with unreacted sulphide to produce molten metal. For example,
2 PbS + 3O2 → 2 PbO + 2SO2
PbS + 2 PbO → 3Pb + SO2 ↑
Mg tape
Ignition mixture
Mg powder + KClO3/BaO2
Thermite mixture
Fe2O3 : Al powder
(3 : 1)
the activation energy required for the reaction (Figure 6.6). KClO3 or BaO2 provides O2 from each and
every part of mixture and helps the ignition mixture to burn together.
2 [ Au(CN)2 ] + Zn → [ Zn(CN)4 ] + 2 Au ↓
− 2−
CuSO4 + Fe → FeSO4 + Cu ↓
Electrolytic reduction
The oxides of strong electropositive metals such as K, Ca, Na, Al and Mg are very stable. It is diffcult to
reduce them into metallic state by carbon reduction process because of the following reasons.
1. The temperature requirement is very high so the fuel cost is high.
2. The collection of metals is to be done very carefully under inert environment, otherwise the metals
react with air to form their respective oxides again.
3. At high temperatures, the metals being extracted may also form carbides in the presence of excess
carbon taken for carbon reduction.
Such metals are extracted by passing electricity through their fused chlorides or oxides or hydroxides. For
example,
1. Na is extracted from molten NaCl or molten NaOH.
NaCl → Na + + Cl − NaOH → Na + + OH −
At the cathode: Na + e → Na At cathode: Na + + e → Na
+
2. Al is extracted from molten Al2O3 (details will be discussed in the individual extraction).
Note: Aqueous solution cannot be used as electrolyte here because then these electropositive metals
will react again with H2O to liberate H2 at the cathode.
3. The metals which come below Al in the electrochemical series can be extracted by the electrolysis
of the aqueous solutions of their salts. This process is applicable for Cu, Zn, Sn, Pb, etc. For example,
ZnSO4 solution can be used to get Zn
ZnSO4 → Zn 2 + + SO42 −
The electrode used is Zn or Al (as cathode) and the reaction at the cathode is
Zn 2 + + 2e → Zn
Similarly, CuSO4 and SnSO4 solutions are used to get Cu and Sn respectively.
_
@edubuzznotes
226 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
300 °C
Ag 2 O → 2 Ag + 21 O2
Thermal refining
Oxidation by air and poling
This process is applicable for refning of Cu and Sn. In this process, the crude metal is melted and air is
blasted through the melt. After air is blown, the melt is stirred with a raw wooden pole and its unburnt
condition produces suffcient amount of carbon and CO to reduce the metallic oxide formed and yield
refned metal. A coke powder layer is maintained at the top of the surface to prevent reoxidation of
the metal formed (Figure 6.7). A small amount of metal to be refned, however, may get oxidized in this
process.
Raw wooden
pole is used
as stirrer
Coke powder layer
at the top surface
Air
The more basic metallic impurities are preferably oxidized by oxygen of air forming volatile or
nonvolatile oxides (i.e. scum). The less basic impurities (if any) are not removed by oxidation, because
under this situation metal to be refned will be oxidized in preference.
Fractional distillation
This refning process utilizes the boiling point difference between the metal and that of the impurity. Using
this process, crude zinc containing Cd, Fe and Pb as impurities can be refned as follows:
Zn (vap)
Cd : b.p. = 767 °C
Crude T > 767 °C Pb T > 920 °C
Fe : Zn
Zn b.p. > 1500 °C –Cd (vap) Fe
Pb :
Fe and Pb
b.p. = 920 ° C
_
@edubuzznotes
6.6 Purification or Refining of Metal 227
Liquation or Sweating
This method is applicable for metals, such as
Sn, Pb and Bi, which have low melting points
as compared to their impurities. In this method,
the block of crude metal is kept at the top of the Fuel
+ air
sloping furnace and heated just above the melt•
ing point of the metal to be refned. The pure
metal melts and fows down the sloping hearth Molten
and gets collected in a receiver at the bottom of metal
the slope (Figure 6.8). The perforated block of Figure 6.8 Diagrammatic representation
impurity is thrown later. for liquation.
The impurity content has to be high enough
in the crude metal, otherwise the impurities also
fow down with the molten metal.
Ring furnace
Zone refining
Metallic rod
Metals like Si, Ge and Ga of high purity (which are to be purified
used in semiconductors) are purifed by this method.
This process is known as ultrapurifcation because it
results in impurity level decreasing to ppm level. Melted zone
Zone refning is based upon fractional crystal•
lization as the impurity prefers to stay in the melt
and on solidifcation only the pure metal solidifes
on the top surface of the melt. In this process, a ring d
furnace is heated to a suitable temperature for melt•
ing the metal rod (Figure 6.9) and producing a thin Figure 6.9 Metal rod heated by ring furnace.
zone throughout the cross•sectional area as shown in
Figure 6.10.
It is desirable that the diameter of the rod, d is small
enough to give a uniform melt.
When the melted zone in the metal rod is ready, the fur•
nace is allowed to move downwards very slowly together Correct Incorrect
with the melted zone (Figure 6.11). The furnace is then
switched off, cooled down and taken to the top again for rep• Figure 6.10 Cross-sectional
etition of the process. Almost all impurity sweeps out to the view of the metal rod.
bottom after several repetitions of the process.
The two essential criteria for the vapour phase refning pro• Ultrapure
metal
cess are listed as follows:
1. The intermediate compound formed has to be volatile.
2. The intermediate compound formed has to be rela•
tively unstable, i.e. it should decompose on heating at
practically achievable temperature. Ring furnace
This refning technique is used in the following purif•
cation processes. Figure 6.11 Ring furnace moving down
the metal rod.
_
@edubuzznotes
228 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
If Ni(CO)4 is not volatile, it cannot be separated from impurities, so its volatile nature helps to
free it from impurities. Also Ni(CO)4 needs to undergo thermal decomposition easily, otherwise it
cannot produce pure metal.
b. Van–Arkel–de Boer process for purifcation of zirconium, boron and titanium
I2 ( vap) 1400 °C
Zr or
Ti → ZrI 4 or TiI 4 on
tungsten filament
→ Zr(s) or Ti (s) + 2I 2 (g)
250 °C
impure volatile pure recycled
Electrorefining
This method is applicable for purifcation of Cu, Zn, Sn, Ag, Au, Ni, Pb and Al. The cathode is made of thin
strip of pure metal (same as that to be refned) and the anode is made of large slab of impure metal (to be
refned).The electrolyte is the aqueous solution of suitable salt of the metal (to be refned) or the melt of
oxide/salt sometimes (Figure 6.12).
−
+
Cathode of pure
metal (M)
Anode
of impure
Electrolyte
metal (M)
(MX)
Anode mud
There are two reactions competing at the anode. So the anionic part of the electrolyte is to be chosen
in such way that the reaction (ii) does not take place at the anode.
Hence at a particular moment, the number of moles of metal dissolved in the electrolyte is equal to the
number of moles of metal ions deposited at the cathode. The concentration of metal ion in the electrolyte
remains the same at a particular time.
The metallic impurities having lower oxidation potential than that of the metal to be refned are sepa•
rated in the form of anode mud at the bottom.
_
@edubuzznotes
6.7 Thermodynamics of Reduction Process 229
ΔG = ΔH – TΔS
ΔH is the enthalpy change during the reaction, T is the absolute temperature, and ΔS is the change in
entropy during the reaction. Consider a reaction such as the formation of an oxide:
M + Ο2 → MO
Dioxygen is used up in the course of this reaction. Gases have a more random structure (less ordered)
than liquids or solids. Consequently, gases have a higher entropy than liquids or solids. In this reaction S
the entropy or randomness decreases, and hence ΔS is negative. Thus if the temperature is raised then TΔS
becomes more negative. Since TΔS is subtracted in the equation, then ΔG becomes less negative. Thus the
free energy change increases with an increase of temperature.
The free energy changes that occur when one gram molecule of a common reactant (in this case dioxygen)
is used may be plotted graphically against temperature for a number of reactions of metals to their oxides.
This graph is shown in Figure 6.13 and is called an Ellingham diagram (for oxides). Similar diagrams can
be produced for one gram molecule of sulphur, giving an Ellingham diagram for sulphides, and similarly
for halides.
_
@edubuzznotes
230 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
200
Ag
0
Hg
−200
−600 Cr
Ti
−800
Al
−1000 Mg
Ca
−1200
Figure 6.13 Ellingham diagram showing the change in free energy ΔG with
temperature for oxides (based on 1 g mol of dioxygen in each case).
The Ellingham diagram for oxides shows several important features:
1. The graphs for metal to metal oxide all slope upwards, because the free energy change increases with
an increase of temperature as discussed above.
2. All the free energy changes follow a straight line unless the materials melt or vaporize, when there is
a large change in entropy associated with the change of state, which changes the slope of the line (for
example, the Hg–HgO line changes slope at 356 °C when Hg boils, and similarly Mg–MgO changes at
1120 °C when Mg boils).
3. When the temperature is raised, a point will be reached where the graph crosses the ΔG = 0 line. Below
this temperature the free energy of formation of the oxide is negative, so the oxide is stable. Above
this temperature the free energy of formation of the oxide is positive, the oxide becomes unstable, and
should decompose into the metal and dioxygen.
Theoretically all oxides can be decomposed to give the metal and dioxygen if a suffciently high
temperature can be attained. In practice the oxides of Ag, Au and Hg are the only oxides which can be
decomposed at temperatures which are easily attainable, and these metals can therefore be extracted
by thermal decomposition of their oxides.
4. In a number of processes, one metal is used to reduce the oxide of another metal. Any metal will reduce
the oxide of other metals which lie above it in the Ellingham diagram because the free energy will
become more negative by an amount equal to the difference between the two graphs at that particular
temperature. Thus Al reduces oxides of Fe, Cr, Ti in the well known thermite reaction, but Al will not
reduce MgO at temperatures below 1500 °C.
In the case of carbon reacting with dioxygen, two reactions are possible:
C + O2 → CO2
1
C+ 2 O2 → CO
_
@edubuzznotes
6.8 Alloys and Amalgams 231
Classification of alloys
Alloys are classifed as
1. Ferrous alloys: If the alloy has iron as one of its constituents, it is called a ferrous alloy, e.g. stainless
steel (Cr + Fe + Ni), ferrosilicon (Fe + Si), etc.
2. Non•ferrous alloys: The alloy which does not contain iron is called a non•ferrous alloy, e.g. brass
(Cu + Zn), bell metal (Cu + Sn), solder (Sn + Pb), etc.
_
@edubuzznotes
232 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
Characteristics of alloys
Alloys are prepared to develop some specifc properties which are not found in the constituent elements.
Both physical and chemical properties of an alloy differ considerably from those of its constituents.
Some properties of metals that can be improved by preparing alloys are as follows:
1. Superior casting: Formation of alloys increases the casting property of the metal. For example, Type
metal (Pb•80% + Sb•16% + Sn•4%) contains Sb which expands on solidifcation and consequently it
takes a sharp impression of the mould. Hence it improves the casting property of lead.
2. Hardness: Alloys are harder than non•metals and metals from which they are made. For example, steel
is harder than cast iron.
3. Resistance to corrosion: Alloys are more resistant towards corrosion, e.g. stainless steel is more
resistant towards corrosion than iron.
4. Melting point: Alloys have low melting points as compared to their constituent elements.
5. Tenacity: The tenacity of copper is doubled on addition of 5% silicon to it.
Preparation of alloys
The methods utilized for preparation of alloys are described as follows:
1. By fusion: Brass (90% Cu + 10% Zn) and bronze (90% Cu + 10% Sn) are prepared by this method.
2. By reduction: Aluminium bronze is prepared by heating aluminium oxide and carbon in presence of
the required amount of Cu.
Al2O3 + 3C + Cu → (Al + Cu) + CO↑
3. By compression: The required metals are frst converted into thin sheets and then rolled together and
hammered under high pressure to give the alloy. Alloys like solder (50% Pb + 50% Sn) are prepared by
this method.
4. By simultaneous electrodepositon: An aqueous solution of the salts of the component metals is taken
in an electrolytic cell and electric current is passed. The desired metals are deposited simultaneously
on the cathode to give the desired alloy. For example, brass is obtained by electrolysis of a solution
containing Cu and Zn cyanides in KCN solution.
Some important alloys with their compositions and uses are listed in Table 6.2.
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
6.9 Different Types of Furnaces Used in Metallurgy 233
Amalgam
Treating different metals like Sn, Zn, Au, Na, Ag, etc. with mercury produces amalgams. Some uses of amal•
gam are
1. Ag–Hg or Au–Hg amalgams are used in flling dental cavities.
2. Tin amalgam is used for silvering mirrors.
3. Na–Hg amalgam is utilized to have decreased reactivity of Na.
Concentrated ore
Residue:
Froth solid impurity
Finely Concentrated
floatation Digested with (thrown)
divided ore with
ore Removes silica little 5% NaCN solution
(Ag2S) or other SiO2 in the presence of
silicious air and filtered Filtrate:
matter
Na[Ag(CN)2]
Zn powder is
added in slight
excess and
filtered again
Residue: Filtrate:
crude Ag Na2[Zn(CN)4]
soluble complex
Figure 6.16 Flow chart for Mc-Arthur Forest process for extraction of silver.
Reactions taking place at the different stages in the cyanide process are as follows:
1. Ag 2S + 4 NaCN(excess) ⇌ 2[Ag(CN)2 ]− + Na 2S + 2 Na +
4 Na 2 S + 5O2 (air) + 2 H 2 O → 2 Na 2 SO4 + 4NaOH + 2S
Since the above reaction is reversible, the conversion ratio is not good. Hence the process is carried
out in the presence of air which converts the Na2S produced into Na2SO4 and S and the overall reac•
tion becomes unidirectional.
_
@edubuzznotes
6.11 Extraction of Gold by Cyanide Process 235
2. In the step involving precipitation of Ag, a little excess of Zn powder is added by which Na[Ag(CN)2]
becomes the limiting reagent, otherwise the loss of Ag will be more. Here Zn is chosen because it is
more electropositive as compared to Ag and the replacement reaction occurs very easily.
2 Na[Ag(CN)2 ] + Zn → Na 2 [Zn(CN)4 ] + 2 Ag ↓
Refining of Ag
Refning of silver is carried by electrolytic process.
electrolytic refining
Crude Ag
( Mobius process) → Pure Ag
Figure 6.17 Flow chart for cyanide process for extraction of gold.
Here oxidation of Au is not possible without the presence of air and NaCN acts as a complexing agent.
2. In step 2:
2 Na[Au(CN)2 ] + Zn → Na 2 [Zn(CN)4 ] + 2 Au ↓
Refining of Au
The steps involved in the refning of Au are given in Figure 6.18. In the third step, on heating with borax,
the soluble metaborate of Cu, i.e. Cu(BO2)2, is formed and washed out with water. Similarly, in the fourth
step also Ag dissolves out as Ag2SO4 leaving behind pure Au.
Note: 1. The removal of Ag can also be carried out using chlorine or by electrolysis.
2. Cupellation is a process, where crude gold is taken in a small bowl called cupell and melted in the
presence of air. Due to high oxygen affnity of Pb, it is converted into PbO (volatile) and escapes
from the system.
_
@edubuzznotes
236 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
Crude Au
Zn, Pb, Cu (1) Add dil. H2SO4 (2) Cupellation
Au {Pb, Cu, Ag} Au {Cu, Ag}
and Ag are Removes ZnSO4 + H2 Removes Pb
impurities as volatile PbO (3)
Heated with
borax and
washed with
hot water
(4) Parting
Pure
Au {Ag}
Au heated with conc.
H2SO4 and washed
with hot water
SnO2
Gravity Concentrated ore
Finely Roasting is CuSO4, CuO
separation containing
divided FeSO4, FeO
Removes SiO2 SiO2 performed in
ore (FeWO4 +...)
and other (small amount) a controlled SiO2
silicious matter way so that (small amount)
formation of
soluble sulphate is Washed with
favoured. hot water,
Removes SO2 removes CuSO4
and AS2O3 and FeSO4
Metallic SnO2
Sn
Black CuO + FeO
(1) Carbon
reduction tin Magnetic (FeWO4 +...)
anthracite SnO2 separation
Slag coke + limestone 75% −(FeWO4 +...) SiO2 (small amount)
Temp. = 1200 °C
(2) Smelted with 10−20%
Sn to 1300 °C
coke + CaCO3
FeSiO3
+ SnSiO3
Metallic
Sn
2. In step 2:
SnSiO3 + CaO + C → Sn + CaSiO3 + CO ↑
_
@edubuzznotes
6.13 Extraction of Magnesium 237
Refining of Sn
The steps involved in the refning of Sn are shown in Figure 6.20.
Electrolytic reduction
The process for extraction of magnesium consists of the following three steps.
1. Preparation of hydrated MgCl2
a. From carnalite (KCl ⋅ MgCl2 ⋅ 6H2O): The steps involved in the preparation of hydrated MgCl2
from carnalite are depicted in Figure 6.21.
Residue:
Solution KCl crystals
KCl . MgCl2 . 6H2O
concentrated by Residue:
Crystals are evaporation. Cooled Filtrate: Concentrated MgCl2 . 6H2O
dissloved in and allowed MgCl2 solution cooled and crystals
water to crystallize
allowed to Filtrate:
and filtered
crystallize, MgCl2
filtered saturated
Recycled solution
Figure 6.21 Flow chart for preparation of hydrated MgCl2 from carnalite.
The principle behind this process is that KCl is less soluble as compared to MgCl2 and crystallizes frst.
b. From sea water: Sea water consists of a lot of MgCl2. The process for extraction of MgCl2 from
sea water is known as Dow sea water process. The steps involved in the process are depicted in
Figure 6.22.
The principle behind this process is that Ca(OH)2 is soluble in water while Mg(OH)2 is sparingly
soluble in water.
_
@edubuzznotes
238 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
Filtrate: Remaining
Concentrated Lime water is water (thrown)
sea water added and
filtered Residue: Add dil
MgCl2
Mg(OH)2 HCl solution
solution
Concentrated,
cooled and allowed
to crystallize
Filtrate: Residue:
saturated MgCl2 . 6H2O
solution of crystals
MgCl2
(recycled)
Figure 6.22 Flow chart for preparation of hydrated MgCl2 from sea water.
2. Conversion of hydrated MgCl2 to anhydrous MgCl2
On direct heating of MgCl2⋅6H2O, anhydrous MgCl2 cannot be obtained due to its hydrolysis.
∆
MgCl2 . 6H2O Mg(OH)Cl + HCl↑ + 5H2O↑
∆
MgO + HCl↑
Also, MgO formed is an unwanted substance in the electrolytic reduction step due its very high melt•
ing point (i.e. 2850 °C).
Hence hydrated MgCl2 is heated to 175 °C in vacuum in a current of dry HCl gas and MgCl2
(anhydrous) is formed.
MgCl .6 H O ∆2 → MgCl + 6 H O
2 2 2
+ Graphite rods
act as anode
−
Steel container
itself acts as
cathode
At cathode : Mg 2 + + 2e → Mg
At anode : 2Cl − − 2e → Cl 2
The container for electrolytic cell has to be covered and the air present inside is removed by passing
the coal gas through an opening (not shown in the diagram) to prevent the oxidation of Mg formed which
is foating on the top surface of the molten electrolyte.
The electrolyte in the molten state consists of four parts anhydrous MgCl2 and one part anhydrous
NaCl. One part of NaCl is added to reduce the melting temperature of the electrolyte from 1200 °C (m.p.
of pure MgCl2) to 700 °C and at the same time electrical conductivity of the melt is also increased.
Fused carnalite may also be used as electrolyte because both Na and K are more electropositive as
compared to Mg and hence Mg2+ is preferably discharged at the cathode.
MgO + C → Mg ↑ + CO ↑
Mg thus obtained comes out in the vapour form and cooled suddenly to about 200 °C by dilution with
a large volume of H2 gas to prevent reoxidation of Mg.
Note: b.p. of Mg is ∼1100 °C.
Other processes
Some other processes used for extraction of magnesium are:
1. Thermal reduction of MgCl2 : The mixture of anhydrous MgCl2 and CaC2 is heated at 1500 °C and the
vapours of Mg are collected in the same way as in carbon reduction process.
MgCl 2 + CaC 2 → CaCl 2 + Mg + 2C
2. Pidgeon process : Here the calcined mixture of dolomite and powder of ferro•silicon (80% Si) is heated
to 1200 °C in a closed container. Mg is vaporized and collected in a condenser.
CaCO3 ⋅ MgCO3 → CaO ⋅ MgO + 2CO2
Beneficiation of bauxite
Different processes adopted for benefciation of red and white bauxite are described below.
Bayer’s process
This is used for benefciation of red bauxite. Various stages of the process are depicted in the fow chart
(Figure 6.24).
Filtrate:
NaOH (2) (i) Diluted with
huge water
Filtrate: Residue:
together with
NaAlO2 + Na2SiO3 Fe2O3, TiO2
freshly prepared
Residue: + other insoluble
Al(OH)3 as
Si[OH]4 + Al[OH]3 impurities
seeding agent
Figure 6.24 Flow chart for Bayer’s process for beneficiation of bauxite.
2. In step 2:
+
3H
[Al(OH)4 ] − ↽
OH −
Al(OH)3 ↓ ↽
⇀
⇀ 3+
Al + 3H 2 O
white
_
@edubuzznotes
6.14 Extraction of Aluminium 241
Since Al(OH)3 is amphoteric in nature, it gets dissolved in alkali as well as in acid as shown in
−
reactions above. Hence to get Al(OH)3 from [Al(OH)4] , the pH of the medium is to be reduced but it
is to be taken care that the pH is not low enough to dissolve it further in the form of Al3+. The decrease
in pH can be done by
1. adding large amount of water which increases the volume and decreases the pH. But without the
seeding agent (which provides the nucleus of the precipitate) the precipitation is delayed.
2. acidifcation which reduces the pH of the medium. But here a strong acid is not recommended to avoid
any further dissolution of Al(OH)3 in the form of Al3+. Hence weak acid like CO2 gas is passed which
reacts as follows:
CO2 + 2OH − → CO3 2 − + H 2 O
OH − ions are consumed in the above reaction and the formation of Al(OH)3 is favoured.
Note: The Bayer’s process cannot be adopted for white bauxite because the major impurity SiO2 is also
separated out along with Al2O3 and fnally Al2O3 of inferior quality is formed.
Hall’s process
This process is adopted for benefciation of low grade red bauxite. Various stages of the process are depicted
in the fow diagram in Figure 6.25.
Residue:
(1) Fused at 1100 °C SiO2 + Fe2O3, etc
Finely divided
bauxite ore together with
Na2CO3 + little CaCO3 Filtrate: [Al(OH)4]−
and finally extracted
with water and filtered
(2) CO2 passed
and filtered
Figure 6.25 Flow chart for Hall’s process for beneficiation of low
grade red bauxite.
3. In step 3:
∆
2 Al(OH)3 −
3H O
→ Al 2 O3 + 3H 2 O
2
_
@edubuzznotes
242 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
Serpeck’s process
This process is used for benefciation of white bauxite. Various steps of this process are depicted in the fow
diagram in Figure 6.26.
CO↑+ Si↑
Finely powdered
(1) Heated
bauxite + Coke
to 1800 °C
powder
in a current AlN(s) residue + impurity (Fe2O3 + TiO2)
of N2 gas (2) Hot and dilute
NaOH solution
is added
and filtered
Figure 6.26 Flow chart for Serpeck’s process for beneficiation of white bauxite.
+ Graphite rod
acts as anode
Powdered −
coke layer
Iron tank
Lining of carbon
acts as cathode
Molten Al
On electrolysis molten Al is deposited at the cathode and since Al is heavier as compared to the electrolyte,
it gets deposited at the bottom, while oxygen gas is liberated at the anode.
1. Reactions: Al 2 O3 → 2 Al 3 + + 3O2 −
At the cathode: Al 3 + + 3e → Al
Since Na and Ca are more electropositive than to Al, only Al3+ gets deposited at the cathode.
At the anode: 2O2 − → O2 + 4e
2. Functions of fuorspar (CaF2)
a. It reduces the melting temperature of the mixture to 900 °C from 2050 °C (m.p. of pure Al2O3) and
saves on the fuel cost.
b. It also improves the electrical conductivity of the melt as compared to molten Al2O3.
3. Functions of cryolite
a. It also helps reduce the melting temperature of the mixture.
b. It acts as solvent and helps dissolve Al2O3.
Alternative theory for electrolytic reaction at the anode can explain the dissolution of Al2O3.
Since the [F−] >>>[O2–], F − ions gets discharged at the anode frst which in turn react with Al2O3 and
liberate O2 at the anode.
2F − → F2 + 2e
3F2 + Al 2 O3 → 2AlF3 + 23 O2
−
Electrorefining of aluminium
Impure aluminium mixed with copper melt Graphite rod
is taken in an iron tank with graphite lining.
Layer of pure Al
The layer of pure Al acts as the cathode. The
Impure Al (acts as cathode)
graphite rods at the top are essential for electri•
Electrolyte
cal connection (Figure 6.29).
Here the electrolyte is the molten mixture Graphite lining
of cryolite and BaF2 saturated with Al2O3. BaF2 Al (impure) + Cu melt
is added instead of CaF2 to adjust the density in
such way that it exists as a separate middle layer.
Similarly in impure Al, the Cu melt is deliber• +
ately added to increase the density in such a way
that it exists as a separate bottom layer. Figure 6.29 Electrorefining of aluminium.
_
@edubuzznotes
244 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
Al(NO3 )3 → Al 3 + + 3NO3−
H 2 O → H + + OH −
2e
At the cathode: 2 H + + → H 2 (Al3+ does not discharge)
At the anode: 4OH − → 2 H 2 O + O2 ↑ + 4e
3. Molten AlCl3 is not chosen as electrolyte because being covalent in nature, it is a poor conductor of
electricity. It also sublimes easily.
Carbon reduction
The various stages involved in the carbon reduction process for extraction of lead are depicted in the fow
diagram in Figure 6.30.
_
@edubuzznotes
6.15 Extraction of Lead 245
Function of lime: Since lime is more basic compared to PbO, the CaO reacts preferably with SiO2 and
its presence acts as negative catalyst towards the formation of PbSiO3 and PbSO4. It also helps to keep
the mass porous and helps to complete reaction.
3. In the smelting step: Initially coke is burnt in a blast of air to produce CO and CO2
C + O2 → CO2
C + CO2 → 2CO
Pb formation reactions:
PbO + C → Pb(l) + CO ↑
PbO + CO → Pb(l) + CO2 ↑
PbSO4 + 4C → PbS + 4CO
PbS (unreacted) + 2 PbO → 3Pb(l) + SO2 ↑
PbS + PbSO4 (if any) → 2 Pb(l) + 2SO2 ↑
Refining of lead
The steps for refning of lead are given in the fow chart in Figure 6.32.
Pure Pb
*Electrolyte: PbSiF6 + H 2SiF6 + gelatine
Gelatine is added to electrolyte to adjust the viscosity of electrolyte.
Anode: Impure Pb.
Cathode: Pure Pb strip.
In Bessemer
converter
Figure 6.33 Flow chart for extraction of copper from copper pyrite.
Cu 2S + 3 O2 → Cu 2O + SO2 ↑
2
Cu 2O + FeS → Cu 2S + FeO
2. In the smelting step: Coke is used here as fuel to maintain such temperature that keeps the mixture
remains in the molten state.
Cu 2 O + FeS → Cu 2 O + FeO
Slag being lighter foats as an immiscible layer on the top surface of Cu2S (matte) and is removed
through a separate hole.
3. In the Bessemer converter: The raw material for the Bessemer converter is matte, i.e. Cu2S + FeS (little).
Here air blasting is initially done for slag formation and SiO2 is added from external source.
During slag formation, the characteristic green fame is observed at the mouth of the Bessemer con•
verter which indicates the presence of iron in the form of FeO. Disappearance of this green fame
indicates that the slag formation is complete. Then air blasting is stopped and slag is removed.
Again air blasting is restarted for partial roasting before self reduction, until two•thirds of Cu2S is
converted into Cu2O. After this, only heating is continued for the self reduction process.
_
@edubuzznotes
248 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
Cu 2 S + 3 O2 → Cu 2 O + SO2 ↑
2
Cu 2 S + 2Cu 2 O → 6Cu(l) + SO2 ↑
and
Cu 2 S + 2O2 → Cu 2 SO4
Cu 2 S + Cu 2 SO4 → 4Cu + 2SO2 ↑
Thus the molten Cu obtained is poured into large container and allowed to cool and during cooling the
dissolved SO2 comes up to the surface and forms blisters. It is known as blister copper.
In the poling step, little Cu2O formed is reduced to metallic Cu by the reducing gases produced from
charring of green wooden pole. The powdered anthracite (coke) spread on the top surface of the molten
mass also helps produce a reducing environment.
In the electrorefning step, the impurities like Fe, Ni, Zn get dissolved in the solution while Au, Ag and
Pt are deposited as anode mud below the anode.
(4) Electrorefining
Electrolyte: ZnSO4 + H2SO4
Cathode: Al sheet (acts as cathode)
Anode: Impure Zn
Pure Zn
Figure 6.35 Flow chart for extraction and refining of zinc from zinc blende.
2. In the roasting step: During roasting, the temperature has to be above 850 °C and the air current must
be controlled because below 850 °C and in excess of air, ZnS is converted into ZnSO4 which converts
back to ZnS during carbon reduction of roasted ore.
ZnS + 3 O2 850
above
°C
→ ZnO + SO2 ↑
2
below
ZnS + 2O2 850
°C
→ ZnSO4
during
ZnSO4 + 4C carbon
reduction
→ ZnS + 4CO ↑
3. In the smelting step: During smelting, excess coke is used to stop the production of CO2. Otherwise, Zn
produced will be converted back to ZnO. Hence if any CO2 is produced, it is allowed to convert into
CO by the reaction with coke.
ZnO + C → Zn + CO
2ZnO + C 2Zn + CO2 (this reaction is reversible)
CO2 + C → 2CO
Temperature during smelting is kept above 1300 °C though the b.p. of Zn is 920 °C. The tempera•
ture is kept much higher as compared to that required for vapourizing zinc from the furnace. This is
done because the reaction of carbon dioxide with coke is highly endothermic and brings down the tem•
perature to below 920 °C and the evaporation of Zn is affected. Hence the temperature is maintained
at 1300 °C–1400 °C.
4. In the electrorefning step: For electrorefning of Zn (crude), Al sheet is used as cathode instead of
pure Zn strip. This is because the electrolyte used is ZnSO4 + H2SO4(dil.), and in dil. H2SO4, Zn gets
dissolved while Al does not.
Zn + H 2 SO4 (dil) → ZnSO4 + H 2 ↑
Al + H 2 SO4 (dil) → No reaction
2 Al + 6 H 2 SO4 (conc.) → Al 2 (SO4 )3 + 3SO2 + H 2 O
_
@edubuzznotes
250 Chapter 6 Metallurgy
Cast
Fe - Scrap + Coke Molten metal Slag
iron
(Air is blasted) (Pig iron 4% C) (CaSiO3)
(3% C)
At 600–900 °C:
S + O2 ® SO2 -; C + O2 ® CO2 -
3S + 2Fe2 O3 ® 4Fe + 3SO2 -
3Si + 2Fe2 O3 ® 4Fe + 3SiO2
3Mn + Fe2 O3 ® 2 Fe + 3MnO
MnO + SiO2 ® MnSiO3 (slag)
3C + 2Fe2 O3 ® 2 Fe + 3CO -
4P + 5O2 ® P2 O5 ; Fe2 O3 + P2 O5 ® 2 FePO4 (slag)
Steel making
Steel is made by removing most of the carbon and other impurities from pig iron. Composition of various
steels depending upon percentage of carbon is given as follows
%C Type of steel
0.15 – 0.3 Mild steel
0.3 – 0.6 Medium steel
0.6 – 0.8 High carbon steel
0.8 – 1.4 Tool steel
The steel making process involves melting and oxidizing C, Si, Mn, S and P present in the pig iron so
that these impurities are removed as gases or converted into slag. This is followed by addition of required
additives (i.e. different elements) to iron to impart desired properties to steel.
Different elements present in steel provide different properties as described below
The addition of mixture of C and Mn into produced steel is known as ‘spiegeleisen’. C and Mn act as
deoxidizers, remove any dissolved O2 and reduce FeO (if any). The excess carbon (if any) supplies the
desired quality. Mn makes the steel hard and improves its tensile strength also. Various processes used for
preparation of good quality steel are:
FeO + Mn → MnO + Fe; FeO + C → Fe + CO ↑
1. Puddling process: This process involves stirring of molten iron in reverberatory furnace by rods which
are consumed in the process.
2. Bessemer and Thomas process
3. Siemens open hearth process
4. Basic oxygen process (also called Linz•Donawitz (L.D.) process).
All these processes are developed to economize the production of steel from iron. In the Bessemer and
Thomas process or Siemens open hearth process, impurities are oxidized by air; while in the L.D. process,
pure O2 is used for the oxidation of impurities. This is because in the frst two processes the molten metal
takes up small amount of nitrogen from the air. In concentrations above 0.01%, nitrogen makes steel brittle
and nitriding the surface makes the metal more diffcult to weld. The use of O2 not only helps overcome
these problems but also has the following advantages:
1. There is faster conversion, so a given plant can produce more in a day i.e. larger quantities can be
handled in lesser time. For example, a 300 tonnes charge can be converted in 40 minutes compared to
6 tonnes in 20 minutes by the Bessemer process.
2. It gives a purer product and the surface is free from nitrides.
The lining of the furnace is designed based on the impurities present in the cast iron:
1. If the cast iron contains Mn, but not P, S, Si, then the lining used is silica brick and the process is known
as acid Bessemer process.
2. If the cast iron contains acidic impurities such as Si, S, P, a lining of calcined dolomite (CaO·MgO) or
magnesia (MgO) is used and the process is called basic Bessemer process. In this process, the P2O5
formed from P combines with lime and forms basic slag [Ca3(PO4)2.CaO] which is known as Thomas
slag. It is a valuable byproduct and sold as phosphate fertilizer.
_
@edubuzznotes
Single Correct Choice Type Questions 253
(A) very high temperature is associated. (B) Impurity content decreases from 4B to 4H.
(B) Fe is more electropositive than Al. (C) Impurities have no impact on hardness.
(C) Al has very high affnity towards oxygen. (D) All are incorrect.
(D) it is very expensive.
24. Which of the following substances is used for making
20. Which of the following ores can be considered as an mirrors?
ore of both Ca and Mg? (A) Pure Sn
(A) Dolomite (B) Pure Hg
(B) Calcite (C) Zinc amalgam
(C) Magnesite (D) Tin amalgam
(D) Magnetite
25. Choose the reaction which does not indicate slag
21. Identify M and N in the following reaction. formation?
controlled heating
Copper glance in presence of air (A) 3MgO + P2O5 → Mg 3 (PO4 )2
→ M + SO2
(B) SiO2 + PbO → PbSiO3
M N
→ Cu + SO2 ↑
(C) Fe2O3 + P2O5 → FePO4
(A) M = Cu 2O; N = Self reduction (D) None of these
(B) M = Cu 2O + Cu 2S ; N = only heating
26. In which of the following metal extraction processes,
(C) M = Cu 2O ; N = carbon reduction there is no reduction of respective ore of metal in the
(D) M = Cu 2O; N = Electrolytic reduction smelting step?
22. Which of the following reactions does not take place (A) Extraction of Fe.
during smelting step in carbon reduction process for (B) Extraction of Cu.
extraction of Pb? (C) Extraction of Pb.
(D) Extraction of Sn.
(A) PbO + CO → Pb + CO2
(B) PbO + C → Pb + CO 27. Which of the following characteristics of steel are
developed by the tempering process?
(C) 3PbO + 1 O2 ® Pb 3O4 (A) Steel becomes hard and brittle.
2
(B) Steel becomes soft.
(D) CaO + SiO2 → CaSiO3 (C) Steel remains hard but brittleness disappears.
23. There are different categories of lead pencil like 4B, (D) Only the surface layer becomes hard.
3B, 2B, HB, H, 2H, 3H and 4H (where B indicates 28. The purest variety of iron is called
softness and H indicates hardness). Which of the fol• (A) cementite.
lowing statements is correct if all these varieties of (B) wrought iron.
lead pencil are made of different kinds of lead? (C) pig iron.
(A) Impurity content increases from 4B to 4H. (D) steel.
2. Which of the following characteristics is/are not (C) Mg is not used for the reduction of alumina above
correctly matched at given temperature in the temperature X, although is thermodynamically
following options? feasible because the process is uneconomical.
(A) At temperature X, ΔG = 0 for (D) Below temperature X, Al can reduce MgO.
Al 2O3 + 3Mg ⇌ 3MgO + 2Al *One or more than one correct answers.
(B) Below temperature X, Mg can reduce Al2O3.
Slag
Only Gravity Smelting
Concentrated Roasting Roasted
haematite
separation ore ore with coke
ore Molten
+ flux
metal
Wrought
iron Puddling
eO
→F
Fe
0
O2
O 1 2
→C
CO+2
710 °C C → CO2
∆G° in kJ mol−1 Cr 2O
3
Cr → iO 2 TiO 2
S Ti →
Si → C→
CO
O 1500 °C
Al → Al 2 3
Zr → ZrO2
1105 °C
Mg → MgO
649 °C
Temperature in °C
Column-I Column-II
(A) Chalcocite (P) Bronze (Cu or Sn)
(B) Bauxite (Q) Solder (Pb, Sn)
(C) Cassiterite (R) Duralumin (Al, Cu, Mg, Mn)
(D) Carnalite (S) Magnelium (Mg, Al)
(T) German silver (Cu, Zn, Ni)
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (B) 8. (A) 15. (B) 22. (C)
2. (A) 9. (C) 16. (B) 23. (A)
3. (C) 10. (A) 17. (C) 24. (D)
4. (A) 11. (A) 18. (A) 25. (D)
5. (C) 12. (D) 19. (D) 26. (B)
6. (B) 13. (C) 20. (A) 27. (C)
7. (B) 14. (D) 21. (B) 28. (B)
Multiple Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (A), (C), (D) 5. (A), (C), (D) 9. (A), (B), (D) 13. (A), (B), (C), (D)
2. (A), (C), (D) 6. (A), (C), (D) 10. (B), (D) 14. (B), (C)
3. (B), (C) 7. (A), (B), (C), (D) 11. (B), (C), (D) 15. (B), (D)
4. (A), (B) 8. (A), (C) 12. (A), (B), (D)
7
Solution may contain: Hg2+, Ag+, Pb2+, Hg2+, Cd2+, Bi3+, Cu2+, Sn4+,
Co2+, Zn2+, Mn2+, Ni2+, Fe3+, Cr3+, Al3+, Ca2+, Ba2+, Mg2+, NH4+, Na+, K+
Add HCl (aq)
Qualitative Salt
Precipitate of Hg2Cl2,
AgCl, PbCl2 Solution
Add NH4OH
+
NH4Cl
Precipitate of Cr(OH)3,
Al(OH)3, Fe(OH)3
Solution
Precipitate of CoS,
ZnS, NiS, MnS
Solution
Add (NH4)2CO3
+
NH4Cl
Precipitate of Solution of
CaCO3, BaCO3, MgCO3 NH4+, Na+, K+
A salt consists of:
1. cationic part, known as the basic radical. The classic method for
2. anionic part, known as the acid radical. separation of common cations.
In qualitative analysis of salts, tests are carried out for both
acid and basic radicals. In general, the tests for acid radi• Contents
cals are done before tests for basic radicals. Acid radicals Tests for Acid Radicals
such as PO3−4 , F , borate, silicate and arsenate interfere in
−
the detection of metal ions during the group separation of 7.1 Action of Dilute Acids
basic radicals in an alkaline medium and are called interfer• 7.2 Tests for CO32-/HCO-3 and SO32-/
ing radicals. In the separation of Group 3 elements, as the HSO-3 Radicals
solution is made ammonical, metal ions of the subsequent 7.3 Tests for Sulphide (S2-) Radical
group may precipitate as phosphate, borate, etc. along with 7.4 Tests for Thiosulphate (S2O32-)
metal hydroxides of Group 3. Such precipitation may also Radical
occur in the absence of metal ions of Group 3. This will be 7.5 Tests for Nitrite (NO2-) Radical
misleading in the detection of metal ions. Hence, in the acid 7.6 Tests for Acetate, Formate and
radicals test, if these radicals are detected, they should be
Oxalate Radicals
frst removed according to the standard procedure (not in
7.7 Tests for Halide (Cl-, Br-, I-) Radicals
the syllabus) and then the group separation of basic radicals
should be carried out. 7.8 Tests for Nitrate (NO-3) Radical
Aqueous solutions of salts are generally used for tests 7.9 Tests for Sulphate (SO42 -) Radical
of acid and basic radicals. When the salt sample is insoluble 7.10 Tests for Borate (BO33-) Radical
in water, soda extract is used to prepare solution of the salt. 7.11 Tests for Phosphate (PO43 -) Radical
For preparation of soda extract, a mixture of 0.5 g of sample 7.12 Tests for Chromate (CrO42-)
and 1.5–2.0 g of Na 2CO3 powder are taken with 20 cm3 of and Dichromate (Cr2O72-) Radicals
distilled water in a 100 cm3 beaker. The mixture is heated 7.13 Tests for Permanganate (MnO4- )
strongly for 10–15 minutes, fltered and the fltrate is called and Manganate (MnO42-) Radicals
soda extract. The fow diagram depicting steps involved in
preparation of neutralized soda extract from soda extract Tests for Basic Radicals
are given in Figure 7.1. 7.14 Dry Tests for Basic Radicals
7.15 Wet Tests for Basic Radicals
7.16 Some General Tests for Cations
7.17 Specific Tests for Some Cations
Heating Effects
_
@edubuzznotes
264 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
Some important points regarding soda extract preparation are listed as follows:
1. Instead of Na 2CO3, no other carbonate can be used for this purpose because all sodium salts are
soluble in water and are passed into the fltrate.
MX + Na 2 CO3
→ M 2 CO3 ↓ + NaX
Water soluble
2. HNO3 is used for neutralization, because no nitrate salt is insoluble in water and the test of nitrate is
never done from soda extract.
3. In the above process, NH3 is used to make the solution alkaline because it is soluble in cold water but
not in hot water. Hence excess NH3 can be removed easily.
I B: Gases or acid vapours are evolved when radicals of this subgroup are treated with conc. H2SO4.
For example, all anions in I A + Cl-, Br-, I-, NO3− , borate, C 2O42−. However, test with conc. H2SO4 is not pre•
ferred for detection of radicals of subgroup IA.
Note: HCO2− evolves gas with both dilute as well as conc. H2SO4 and the latter is preferred for its test.
Class II: This consists of radicals that are dependent upon reactions in solutions for their identifcation.
This class is divided into two subgroups:
II A: Identifed on the basis of precipitation reactions. For example, SO2− 3− 2− 2−
4 , PO 4 , CrO 4 , Cr2 O 7 .
II B: Identifed on the basis of oxidation/reduction reactions. For example, MnO4 , MnO4 , CrO2−
2− − 2−
4 , Cr2 O 7 .
2− 2−
S 2O3 , S , CH 3CO2 , may be present.
−
Reactions involved
The addition of dilute acids to the salt solutions involves the following reactions with the acid radicals:
NO-2 + H + ¾¾ ® HNO2
1.
2 HNO2 ¾¾ ® H 2 O + 2 NO + 1 O2
2
NO + 1 O2 ¾¾ ® NO2 ↑ (brown fumes)
2
_
@edubuzznotes
7.2 Tests for CO23−/HCO3− and SO23−/HSO3− Radicals 265
2. CO23 − / HCO3− + H +
→ [H 2 CO3 ]
→ H 2 O + CO2 ↑
Observation: Colourless, odourless gas comes out with brisk effervescence.
3. SO23 − / HSO3− + H +
→ [H 2 SO3 ]
→ H 2 O + SO2 ↑
Observation: Colourless gas comes out with burning smell of sulphur.
4. S 2 − + 2 H +
→ H2S ↑
Observation: Colourless gas with rotten egg smell (offensive smell).
5. → S ↓ + [H 2 SO3 ] ∆
S 2 O23 − + H + → H 2 O + SO2 ↑
Observation: White turbidity is observed frst which fnally produces a white precipitate due to the
presence of free acid. H2SO3 formed is present in the solution and produces SO2 gas on warming.
6. CH 3CO2− + H + ∆
→ CH 3CO2 H ↑
Observation: Vinegar smell is observed on warming.
The gases evolved by addition of dilute acids to salt solutions containing radicals CO23 − / HCO3− and
SO23 − / HSO3− are CO2 and SO2 respectively. The two gases can be distinguished on the basis of following
two tests.
1. Smell of the evolved gas: If the evolved gas is odourless, it implies that the gas is CO2 and the radicals
responsible for its formation are CO23 − / HCO3− .
If the evolved gas has burning smell of sulphur, it implies that the gas is SO2 and the radicals respon•
sible for its formation are SO23 − / HSO3− .
2. Lime water test: The unknown colourless gas obtained on addition of dilute acid to the salt solution is
passed through lime water. If lime water turns milky, the gas is passed in excess to obtain a clear solu•
tion. These observations imply that the gas may be (i) CO2 or (ii) SO2 or (iii) CO2 + SO2
Reactions involved:
Ca(OH)2 + CO2 / SO2
→ CaCO3 ↓ + H 2 O
Lime water or
CaSO3 ↓
white turbidity
CaCO3 ↓ + CO2 + H 2 O
→ Ca(HCO3 )2
water soluble
CaSO3 ↓ + SO2 + H 2 O
→ Ca(HSO3 )2
water soluble
Note: (i) Instead of lime water Ca(OH)2, baryta water Ba(OH)2 can also be used.
(ii) In case of CaSO3, the turbidity dissolves slowly.
3. Test with oxidizing agents: The lime water test confrms the presence of CO2 and/or SO2 ruling out
presence of other colourless gases. Further test with oxidizing agents (O.A.) is carried out to confrm
the identity as SO2 or CO2.
CO2 + O. A.
→ No reaction
The oxidizing agents that can be used for detection of CO2 and/or SO2 and their relevant reactions
are as follows:
+
− H 2+ 2−
a. MnO4 + SO2 → Mn + SO4 + H 2O
purple colourless/
light pink
+
b. Cr2 O72 − + SO2 H→ Cr 3 + + SO24 − + H 2 O
orange green
+
c. IO3− + starch + SO2 H→ (I 2 + starch) + SO24 −
starch iodate deep blue
colourless solution
→ SO24 − + HCl
Cl 2 + SO2 + H 2O
→ SO24 − + 2 H +
H 2O2 + SO2
4. Test with alkaline Na-nitroprusside and alkaline Zn-nitroprusside:
Na-nitroprusside
CO2 + 2OH − → CO23 − + H 2 O or → No change
Zn-nitroprusside
Phenolphthalein is colourless in the pH range of 8 to 10 and above pH = 10, it changes its colour
to pink.
KH 1 K
CO23 − + H 2O ↽
HCO3 + OH ; K H 1 = w
⇀ − −
Ka 2
KH
2 Kw
HCO3− + H 2O ↽
−
H 2CO3 + OH ; K H 2 =
⇀
Ka 1
2. Using precipitating reagents: These selectively form coloured precipitates with CO2−
3 ions but not with
HCO3− ions.
Note: (i) Reagents in set I produce simple carbonates of their metals while reagents in set II produce the
basic carbonates of their metals.
(ii) The bicarbonates of all the metals listed above are soluble in water, hence no precipitates are
formed.
(iii) NaCl cannot be used as reagent here though NaHCO3 is sparingly soluble in water but its solubility
is relatively high. It gives ppt. of NaHCO3 from its concentrated solution only.
(i) ∆
(ii) Add NH3
Reprecipitation of
MCO3 confirms the
presence of HCO−3
Figure 7.2 Flow chart for detection of carbonate and bicarbonate present together, using MCl2.
2. Using AgNO3 in excess: The steps involved in the process are depicted in the fow diagram shown in
Figure 7.3.
Residue: Ag2CO3↓
CO32− solution
Excess of confirms presence of CO32− ion
+
AgNO3 solution
HCO3− solution is added Filtrate: HCO3− + Ag+ (unreacted)
and filtered
+ NO3−
Figure 7.3 Flow chart for detection of carbonate and bicarbonate when present together, using AgNO3.
Reactions involved:
(i) 2 HCO3− ∆
→ H 2 O + CO2 ↑ + CO32 −
2 Ag + + CO23 −
→ Ag 2CO3 [unstable under hot conditions]
Ag 2CO3
→ Ag 2O ↓ + CO2 ↑
brownish
black ppt.
Here the formation of Ag2CO3 is due to decomposition of HCO3− on heating and confrms the
presence of HCO3−.
(ii) In NH3 solution, Ag2CO3 as well as Ag2O are soluble and form [Ag(NH 3 )2 ]+ complex. Hence a
clear solution is obtained and no change is observed. Thus NH3 cannot be used for this purpose.
Residue: Hg2CO3↓ yellow ppt.
CO32− solution
Excess of confirms presence of CO32− ion
+
Hg2(NO3)2 solution
HCO3− solution is added and filtered Filtrate: HCO3− + Hg22+
Figure 7.4 Flow chart for detection of carbonate and bicarbonate present together, using Hg2(NO3)2.
_
@edubuzznotes
7.2 Tests for CO23−/HCO3− and SO23−/HSO3− Radicals 269
3. Using Hg2(NO3)2 in excess: The steps involved in the process are depicted in the fow diagram in
Figure 7.4.
Reactions involved:
−
(i) → H 2O + CO2 + CO23
2 HCO3− ∆
Hg 2 O ∆
→ Hg ↓ + HgO ↓
grey ppt.
(ii) In NH3 solution, black ppt. of the complex is obtained irrespective of the presence or absence
of HCO3− . Hence presence of HCO3− cannot be confrmed by this method.
Hg 22 + + NH 3
→ 2 Hg ↓ + HgO ⋅ Hg(NH 2 )X ↓
The following reagents cannot be used for distinction of HCO3− and CO2−
3 when present together.
1. HgCl2 in excess: The changes taking place when HgCl2 is used in excess are
Reaction involved:
4 Hg 2 + + CO23 − + 3H 2 O
→ HgCO3 ⋅ 3HgO ↓ + 6 H +
evolution of CO2 does not confrm the presence of HCO3− because CO2−
3 also can release CO2.
2. MgCl2, Pb(OAc)2, ZnCl2, CuCl2: In reactions with all these reagents, during the precipitation of basic
carbonates of the respective metals, some HCO3− ions are formed and passed into the fltrate. Hence it
cannot be confrmed whether HCO3− was present in the original sample or generated during the reac•
tion. For example,
Pb 2 + + 4CO23 − + 2 H 2 O
→ Pb(OH)2 ⋅ 2 PbCO 3 ↓+ 2 HCO3−
white ppt.
Cu 2 + + 3CO23 − + 2 H 2 O
→ Cu(OH)2 ⋅ CuCO3 ↓+ 2 HCO3−
green ppt.
Zn 2 + + 7CO23 − + 6 H 2 O
→ ZnCO3 ⋅ 3Zn(OH)2 ↓+ 6HCO3−
white ppt.
→ Mg(OH)2 ⋅ 4MgCO3 ⋅ 6 H 2 O ↓+ 2 HCO3−
Mg 2 + + 6CO23 − + 2H 2 O
white ppt.
_
@edubuzznotes
270 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
2. Using litmus paper: HSO3− solution is neutral towards litmus paper while SO2−
3 solution is alkaline
towards it.
SO23 − + H 2 O ⇌ HSO3− + OH −
The reaction produces suffcient amount of OH- ions to show alkaline behaviour towards litmus paper.
HSO3− + H 2 O ⇌ H 2 SO3 + OH −
The OH- ions formed are not suffcient to show alkaline nature with litmus paper and are considered
neutral.
3. Using oxidizing agents: Reagents such as H2O2 act as an oxidizing agent for both HSO3− and SO2−
3 ions.
However, on oxidation the behaviour towards litmus paper undergoes a change as depicted in the
following reactions.
HSO3− solution + H 2 O2
→ H + + SO42 − + H 2 O
neutral final solution beco omes acidic
SO23 - solution + H 2 O2 ¾¾
® SO24 - + H 2 O
alkaline final solution becomees neutral
Ag + + SO23 −
→ [Ag(SO3 )]−
soluble complex
(ii) When [Ag + ] > [SO23 − ]
[Ag(SO3 )]− + Ag +
→ Ag 2 SO3 ↓
white ppt.
On further addition of sulphite solution, the precipitate gets dissolved
Ag 2 SO3 + SO23 −
→ 2[AgSO3 ]−
(iii) On boiling
2 [ AgSO3 ] ∆
−
→ 2 Ag ↓ + SO24 − + SO2 ↑
→ 2 Ag ↓ + SO24 − + 2 H +
Ag 2 SO3 ↓ + H 2 O
grey ppt.
_
@edubuzznotes
7.2 Tests for CO23-/HCO3- and SO23-/HSO3- Radicals 271
Note: (i) All silver compounds, except AgI and Ag2S, are soluble in NH3, forming a complex [Ag(NH3)2]+.
(ii) Heating of aqueous suspension of Ag2SO3 and Ag2CO3 produces different types of products.
heated in
Ag 2 CO3 → Ag 2 O ↓ + CO 2 ↑ (T
Thermal decomposition)
water
brownish
black ppt.
Ag 2 SO3 + H 2 O ∆
→ 2Ag ↓ + H 2 SO4 (Redox reaction)
black metallic
deposit
Ag+ has mild oxidizing properties which can oxidize SO2 into H2SO4 while it cannot oxidize
SO2 anymore.
2−
2. SO3 can be easily oxidized either in solution or in solid state:
oxidizing precipitating reagent
SO23 − solution 2−
agent → SO4 solution
→ MSO4 ↓
white ppt.
precipitating reagent oxidizing
SO23 − solution → MSO3 ↓ → MSO 4 ↓
agent
white ppt. white ppt.
dissolves in dil.
mineral acid
The precipitate MSO4 formed does not dissolve in dilute mineral acids.
Various oxidizing agents that can be used for oxidizing SO32- are:
(i) Br2 - water
(ii) H2O2
(iii) boiling in presence of air
(iv) dil. HNO3
The precipitating reagents that can be used include:
(i) CaCl2
(ii) SrCl2
(iii) BaCl2
(iv) Pb(OAc)2
3. Test with dil. H2SO4 + Zn powder: On addition of dil. H2SO4 and zinc powder to SO2− 3 solution, a colourless
gas is evolved.
SO23 − + Zn + H + → H 2 S ↑ + Zn 2 + + H 2 O
The gas evolved can be identifed by the following properties:
a. It has rotten eggs smell.
b. It can turn the moist Pb(OAc)2 paper black due to the formation of PbS (black).
c. It can turn the moist Cd(OAc)2 paper yellow due to the formation of CdS (yellow).
Note: If the paper is not moist, the above observations are not noted because
H 2 S + 2 H 2 O ⇌ 2 H 3O + + S 2 −
Pb 2 + / Cd 2 + + S 2 −
→ PbS / CdS ↓
H2S may also be identifed by utilizing its reducing properties. For example,
MnO4− + H 2 S + H +
→ Mn 2 + + S ↓ + H 2 O
purple colourless
Cr2 O27 − + H 2 S + H +
→ Cr 3 + + S ↓ + H 2 O
orange green
I 3− → I−
+ H 2 S + H+ + S ↓
dark brown colourless
→ Br −
Br2 − water + H 2 S + H+ + S ↓
red colourless
_
@edubuzznotes
272 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
In all these reducing reaction, sulphur is precipitated and other oxidizing agents like Cl2–water (dilute),
H2O2, conc. H2SO4, conc. HNO3, H2SO3 may also be used to get sulphur precipitate. However, if Cl2–water
is concentrated, then fnally it will be again colourless.
Cl 2 + H 2 S
→ S↓ + 2 HCl
white ppt.
S ↓ + 4 H 2 O + 3Cl 2 → H 2 SO4 + 6 HCl
4Cl 2 + 4 H 2 O + H 2 S
→ H 2 SO4 + 8 HCl
SH − + H 2O ↽ H 2S + OH
⇀ −
b. Alkaline earth metal sulphides are sparingly soluble in water but pass into the solution with time
and hence do not give precipitates from their aqueous solution. For example,
BaS + 2 H 2 O ↽ Ba
⇀ (OH
)2
Ba(SH)2
+
both are water soluble
Observation: Colourless gas with rotten eggs smell is obtained. Other methods for its identifcation
have already been discussed in Section 7. 2.
This is a confrmative test for sulphides.
Note: Here dil. HNO3 cannot be used because S2- ions get oxidized to sulphur by dil. HNO3.
3. Test with sodium nitroprusside solution
S 2 − solution + Na 2 [ Fe(CN)5 NO]
→ Na 4 [ Fe(CN)5 NOS]
+
O O−
S2− + NO N N
S− S
Thionitrite ion
This is because H2S is a weak acid, therefore [S2-] formed is not suffcient to give the above observation.
However, on addition of alkali [OH-], concentration of S2- ions increases and gives this test.
_
@edubuzznotes
7.4 Tests for Thiosulphate (S2O23-) Radical 273
N
Methylene blue
This reaction is very sensitive and confrmative test for soluble sulphides as well as for H2S.
9. Iodine•azide test
NaN 3 + KI 3 → No reaction
colourless dark brown
But
traces of S2 −
2 N 3− + I 3− →
solution
3N 2 ↑ + 3I −
Observation: Colourless gas is evolved which is N2 and S2- ion acts as a catalyst here.
Note: This test has to be performed in the absence of SCN- or S 2O2− 3 because they also give similar
observation. Hence it is not a confrmative test of S2- ion.
Various tests carried out for identifcation of S 2O32− radical are listed as follows.
1. Solubility
a. Alkali metal thiosulphates are soluble in water.
b. MgS2O3 and CaS2O3 are soluble in water while BaS2O3 is sparingly soluble in water.
2. Test with CaCl2 and BaCl2
CaCl2
No ppt.
2−
S2O3 solution
White ppt. of BaS2O3 from moderately
conc. solution and on rubbing the wall
BaCl2 of the test tube, precipitation gets
accelerated
Observation: White turbidity appears and on warming burning smell of sulphur is obtained.
_
@edubuzznotes
274 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
The various precipitating reagents used, formulae of precipitate and clear solution formed are listed
below:
Reactions involved:
a. During precipitate formation
M n + + S 2 O23 −
→ M 2 (S 2 O3 )n ↓ (Except Cu 2 + )
2Cu 2 + + 2S 2 O23 −
→ 2Cu + + S 4 O62 −
2Cu + + S 2 O23 −
→ Cu 2 S 2 O3 ↓
white ppt..
b. During conversion of white ppt. into black ppt.
M 2 (S 2 O3 )n + nH 2 O
→ M 2 S n ↓ + nH 2 SO4
black ppt.
6. Test with FeCl3 solution
on standing
FeCl 3 + S 2 O23 −
→ Initially violet colouration
→ Light green solution
solution solution
Reactions involved:
Fe3 + + 2S 2 O23 −
→[ Fe (S 2 O3 )2 ]− ; [ Fe (S 2O3 )2 ]− + Fe3+
→ 2 Fe2 + + S 4O62 −
violet colouration light green
7. Test with KCN solution followed by FeCl3 solution: This test is a specifc test for S 2O32− radical and
involves the following reaction
S 2O23 − solution + CN −
→ SCN − + SO23 −
FeCl 3
→
Fe(SCN)3
Reactions involved:
2 NO2− + 2I − + 4 H +
→ I 2 + 2 NO ↑ + 2 H 2 O
I 2 + Starch
→ Deep blue colouratiion
Note: The observation depends upon co•reagent taken, for example
(i) I 2 + CCl 4 / CHCl 3 / CS 2
→ Violet layer is observed.
→ Dark brown colouration due to the formation of K+ I 3− .
(ii) I 2 + excess KI
7. Test with acidifed KMnO4: In this test NO2− acts as reducing agent and decolorizes the acidifed
KMnO4 solution and turns acidifed KMnO4 solution green.
NO2− + MnO4− + H + → NO3− + Mn 2 + + H 2 O
purple colourless
→ NO3− + Cr 3 + + H 2 O
NO2− + Cr2 O7− + H +
orange green
8. Test with NH4Cl solution: When NH4Cl solution is added in excess to nitrite solution and boiled,
colourless and odourless N2 gas is evolved.
NO2− + NH +4 ∆
→ N 2 + 2H 2 O
9. Test with urea [CO(NH2)2]: When nitrite solution acidifed with dil. HCl is added to solid urea, N2 + CO2
gases are evolved.
CO(NH 2 )2 + 2 HNO2 → 2 N 2 ↑ +CO2 ↑ + 3H 2 O
10. Test with thiourea [CS(NH2)2]: When nitrite solution acidifed with dil. AcOH is added to solid
thiourea, N2 gas is evolved and thiocyanic acid is formed, which is identifed by addition of FeCl3
solution acidifed with dil. HCl.
CS(NH 2 )2 + HNO2 → N 2 + H + SCN − + 2 H 2 O
3SCN − + Fe3 + → Fe(SCN)3
blood red
colour
11. Test with sulphamic acid (HO . SO2 . NH2): With this reagent, nitrite solution is completely decomposed.
→ N 2 ↑ +2 H + + SO24 − + H 2O
HO ⋅ SO2 ⋅ NH 2 + HNO2
It is the best method to destroy nitrite whenever it is required, because no nitrate is formed during the
reaction, whereas traces of nitrates are formed with NH4Cl, urea and thiourea used in reactions 8, 9
and 10 respectively.
NO2− radical can also be removed by use of NaN3 which however, is an expensive reagent.
NO2− + N 3− + 2 H +
→ N2 ↑ + N2O + H2O
N 3− + H +
→ HN 3 ↑
12. Gries–Ilosvay test: This test is based upon the diazo•coupling reaction of sulphanillic acid. This test is
specifc for nitrite radical.
+
NH2 N N CH3CO2−
SO3H SO3H
+
N N CH3CO2−
Note: (i) Fe3+ should not be present in the solution and if present, it must be masked by tartaric acid.
(ii) The test solution should be very dilute, otherwise the reaction will stop at the diazotization stage.
13. Test with indole reagent: The acidifed solution of nitrite reacts with indole to produce red coloured
nitroso indole.
4. Test with AgNO3 solution: Addition of AgNO3 cannot distinguish these three radicals, but addition of
AgNO3 followed by heating can distinguish one from the other.
Acetate
∆
CH 3CO2− + Ag +
→ CH 3CO2 Ag ↓ → Clear solution
white ppt. (aq. suspension)
Formate
∆
HCO2− + Ag +
→ HCO2 Ag ↓ → Black ppt.
white ppt. (aq. suspension)
2 HCO2 Ag ∆
→ HCO2 H + 2 Ag ↓ + CO2 ↑
Oxalate
∆
C 2 O24 − + 2 Ag +
→ Ag 2 C 2 O4 ↓ → No change
white ppt. (aq. suspension)
5. Esterifcation test: The reagent used for this test is C 2 H 5OH + conc. H 2SO4 .
Acetate
CH 3CO2− (s) + H 2 SO4 (conc.)
→ CH 3CO2 H + HSO4−
CH 3CO2 H + C 2 H 5OH
→ CH 3CO2 C 2 H 5 + H 2 O
(96%)
Observation: Pleasant, odour is obtained.
Note: In the second reaction, conc. H2SO4 acts as dehydrating agent and drives the reaction in the
forward direction.
Formate
→ HCO2 H + Na + + HSO4−
HCO2 Na + H 2 SO4
HCO2 H + C 2 H 5OH
→ HCO2 C 2 H 5 ↑ + H 2 O
Formate
2 HgCl 2 + 2 HCO−2
→ Hg 2 Cl 2 ↓ + 2Cl − + CO ↑ + CO2 ↑ + H 2 O
white ppt.
Hg 2 Cl 2 ↓ +2 HCO2−
→ 2 Hg ↓ + 2Cl − + CO ↑ + CO2 ↑ + H 2 O
black ppt.
7. Test with FeCl3 solution
CH 3CO2−
on
or → [Fe3 (OH)2 (CH 3CO2 )6 ]+ h
+ FeCl 3 eating → Fe(OH)2 (CH 3 CO2 ) ↓
HCO2− solution red ppt.
or or
[ Fe3 (HCO2 )6 ]3 + Fe(OH)2 (HCO2 ) ↓
red colouration red ppt.
C 2 O24 − + FeCl 3
→ No such observation
Reactions involved:
Acetate:
3Fe3 + + 6CH 3CO2− + 2 H 2 O
→ [ Fe3 (OH)2 (CH 3CO2 )6 ]+ + 2 H +
[ Fe3 (OH)2 (CH 3CO2 )6 ]+ + 4 H 2 O
→ 3[ Fe (OH)2 (CH 3CO2 )] ↓ + 3CH 3CO2 H + H +
red ppt.
Formate
3Fe3 + + 6 HCO2−
→[ Fe3 (HCO2 )6 ]3 +
[ Fe3 (HCO2 )6 ]3 + + H 2 O
→ 3 [ Fe(OH)2 (HCO2 )] ↓ + 3HCO2 H + 3H +
red ppt.
2 HCO2 Na + H 2 SO4 ¾¾
® 2 HCO2 H + Na 2 SO4
2 HCO2 H + HgO ¾¾
®(HCO2 )2 Hg + H 2 O
2(HCO2 )2 Hg ¾¾ ® (HCO2 )2 Hg ¯ + HCO2 H + CO2 ↑
white ppt.
® 2Hg ¯ + HCO2 H + CO2 ↑
(HCO2 )2 Hg 2 ¯ ¾¾
_
@edubuzznotes
280 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
Observation: White fumes of HCl are obtained which intensify on contact with the glass rod dipped in
NH3.
Bromide Br − + H +
→ HBr
2 HBr + H 2 SO4
→ Br2 ↑ + SO2 + 2 H 2 O
oxidizing
agent
2 X − + MnO2 + 4 H + ∆
→ Mn 2 + + X 2 ↑ + 2 H 2 O
Observation:
When X2 = Cl2, greenish yellow gas is evolved.
When X2 = Br2, reddish brown vapours are evolved.
_
@edubuzznotes
7.7 Tests for Halide (Cl−, Br−, l−) Radicals 281
Bromide Br − + Ag +
→ AgBr ↓ (pale yellow ppt.)
Iodide I − + Ag +
→ AgI ↓ (yellow ppt.)
→ Ag 3 AsO3 ↓ +3Na + + 3 Cl −
3AgCl + Na 3 AsO3
5. Test with Pb(OAc)2 solution: The three halide radicals can be distinguished by addition of Pb(OAc)2,
followed by heating and cooling.
Chloride
Bromide
on boiling
cooled
White ppt. reappears Clear solution
Iodide
2I − + Pb 2 +
→ PbI 2 ↓ ∆
→ Yellow solution
yellow ppt.
_
@edubuzznotes
282 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
Yellow solution is
observed which confirms
the presence of Cl− ion
where X2 = Br2 or I2
(ii) F− also produces volatile red•coloured CrO2 F2. Hence F− should also be absent.
(iii) NO2− , NO3− and ClO2− radicals also interfere with this test and so should be absent.
(iv) AgCl, HgCl2, Hg2Cl2, PbCl4, SnCl4 do not respond to this test due to their high covalent character
as a result of which suffcient free Cl− ions are not available.
Note: On addition of excess of Cl2–water, red layer of Br2 changes into pale yellow layer of BrCl in organic
solvent while the violet layer of I2 changes into colourless solution.
Br2 + Cl 2
→ 2 BrCl
→ Cl − + IO3− + H +
I 2 + Cl 2 + H 2 O
Br Br
HO O O HO O O
+ 4Br− + 4H+
+ 4Br2
C Br C Br
CO2H COOH
Note: (i) Chlorine bleaches the reagent and iodine forms red–violet coloured iodoeosin and hence these
radicals must be absent for the test. But if Br− radical is oxidized to free bromine by heating with
PbO2 and acetic acid, practically no chlorine is simultaneously evolved from chlorides and hence
the test may be performed in the presence of chlorides.
(ii) Only free Br2 converts the decolorized fuchsin into a blue or violet brominated dyestuff and the
reaction is not shown by free Cl2 or I2. Hence Br− can be detected in presence of Cl− and I−.
Reactions involved:
2Cu 2 + + 2I −
→ 2Cu + + I 2
2Cu + + 2I −
→ 2CuI ↓
white ppt.
I 2 + I −
→ I 3−
Note: The dark brown colour of I-3 is so dark that the white precipitate of CuI becomes invisible and
becomes visible only when Na2S2O3 converts the I 3− ion into iodide.
2S 2O23 − + I 3−
→ 3I − + S 4O62 −
colourless
2. Test with HgCl2 solution: Scarlet red precipitate of HgI2 is obtained which dissolves in excess of KI
solution forming soluble complex of [HgI 4 ]2− .
Reactions involved:
2I − + HgCl 2 → HgI 2 ↓ +2Cl −
HgI 2 + 2I −
→ [HgI 4 ]2 −
3. Test with oxidizing agents: Iodide solution is readily oxidized in acidic medium to free iodine by a
number of oxidizing agents like K 2Cr2O7, KNO2 and FeCl 3 solution.
6I − + Cr2O27 − + 4 H +
→ I 2 + 2Cr 3+ + 7 H 2O
2I − + 2 NO2− + 4 H +
→ I 2 + 2 NO ↑ + 2 H 2O
2I − + 2 Fe3+
→ I 2 + 2 Fe2 +
_
@edubuzznotes
284 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
The observations depend upon the other reagents associated. For example,
a. When starch is present, a deep blue solution is obtained.
b. When excess KI is present, a dark brown solution is obtained.
c. When CCl4/CHCl3/CS2 is present, a violet layer is observed.
4. Catalytic reduction of cerium (IV) salt test: The reduction of cerium (IV) salts in acid solution by
arsenites takes place very slowly:
2Ce4 + + AsO33 − + H 2O
→ 2Ce3+ + AsO34 − + 2 H +
2Ce4 + + 3I −
→ 2Ce3+ + I 3−
AsO33 − + I 3− + H 2 O
→ AsO34 − + 3I − + 2 H +
and
2 NO3− + 4 H 2SO4 + 3Cu
→ 3Cu 2 + + 2 NO ↑ + 4SO24 − + 4 H 2O
2 NO + O2
→ 2 NO2 ↑
4. Brown ring test: In this test, when conc. H2SO4 is poured slowly in a mixture of nitrate salt solution and
freshly prepared FeSO4 solution, a brown ring is observed at the junction of two liquids. This is the only
confrmatory test for nitrate radical.
Reactions involved:
2 NO3− + 4 H 2SO4 + 6 Fe2 +
→ 6 Fe3+ + 2 NO ↑ + 4SO24 − + 4 H 2O
[ Fe(H 2O)6 ]2 + + NO
→ [ Fe(H 2O)5 NO]2 + + H 2O
Note: (i) [ Fe(H 2O)5 NO]2+ is the compound responsible for the brown colour of the ring.
(ii) On shaking or warming, the brown colour disappears and NO gas is evolved.
(iii) Radicals such as Br−, I− and NO−2 must be absent because these produce coloured gases
with conc. H2SO4 like Br2, I2 and NO2 respectively and no ring is observed.
(iv) Ca(NO3 )2 , Ba(NO3 )2 , Pb(NO3 )2 do not respond to the test due to precipitation of their
corresponding metal sulphates.
5. Reduction of nitrate to NH3: When the nitrate salt solution is treated with metals like Zn or Al in the
presence of conc. NaOH, it gets reduced and ammonia gas is evolved.
Reactions involved:
NO3− + 4Zn + 7OH − + 6 H 2O
→ NH 3 ↑ + 4 [Zn(OH)4 ]2 −
3NO3− + 8 Al + 5OH − + 18 H 2O
→ 3NH 3 ↑ + 8 [Al(OH)4 ]−
_
@edubuzznotes
7.9 Tests for Sulphate (SO42- ) Radical 285
Devarda’s alloy (Cu + Al + Zn) can also be used in place of these metals and shows better performance.
Note: NO2− radical can also be reduced to ammonia by the same reagents and gives same
observations.
Ammonia gas evolved can be detected by the following methods:
a. It has a characteristic pungent smell.
b. It turns the moist litmus paper blue.
c. It produces white fumes when it comes in contact with a glass rod dipped in HCl.
d. It turns brown the flter paper dipped into Nessler’s reagent.
2[HgI 4 ]2 − + 3OH − + NH 3
→ HgO ⋅ Hg(NH 2 )I ↓ + 7I − + 2 H 2 O
brown ppt.
e. It turns black the flter paper dipped in (MnSO4 + H 2O2 ) solution.
Mn 2 + + H 2O2
→ No reaction
But
Mn 2 + + H 2 O2 + 2OH −
→ MnO(OH)2 ↓ + H 2 O
black ppt.
and this OH– comes from the reaction,
NH 3 + H 2 O → NH +4 + OH −
6. Reduction to nitrite test: In this test, the nitrate solution is reduced to nitrite radical in the presence of
Zn powder and acetic acid. The nitrite ion formed is further identifed using Gries–Ilosvay test.
Reaction involved:
→ NO−2 + Zn 2 + + 2AcO− + H 2O
NO−3 + Zn + 2 AcOH
Note: Nitrite radical interferes with this test and should best be removed by sulphanilic acid.
Various tests carried out for identifcation of sulphate radical are listed as follows.
1. Solubility
a. Alkali metal sulphates are soluble in water.
b. CaSO4, SrSO4 and BaSO4 are insoluble in water while BeSO4 and MgSO4 are soluble in water.
2. Test with MCl2 solution (where M 2+ : Ca 2+, Sr 2+, Ba 2+ )
→ MSO4 ↓ dil
SO24 − + M 2 + . mineral
acid → Insoluble
white ppt.
This is a confrmatory test for SO2− 4 ion.
SO24 − + Hg 2 + + 2 H 2 O
→ HgSO4 ⋅ 2 HgO ↓+ 4 H +
yellow ppt.
This precipitate is obtained even from the suspension of BaSO4 and PbSO4 and hence the test is very
sensitive. It is also confrmatory test for SO2-
4 .
_
@edubuzznotes
286 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
5. KMnO4 – BaSO4 test: In this test, when BaCl2 is added to a mixture of KMnO4 + sulphate salt solution,
the BaSO4 formed is pink coloured (violet) due to adsorption of KMnO4. The adsorbed permagnate
cannot be reduced by the common reducing agent (including H2O2).
H O
(KMnO4 + SO24 − ) solution + BaCl 2
→ BaSO4 ↓
2 2
→ BaSO4 ↓
pink ppt. still remains pink
3. Test with conc. H2SO4 and conc. HCl: In this test, when conc. H2SO4 is added to the solution of borate
in cold conditions, no visible change is observed. On heating, white fumes of H3BO3 are observed.
cold condition
No visible observation
Borate + conc. H2SO4
on heating
H3BO3↑; white fumes are observed
However, the addition of conc. HCl to borate ions in cold conditions leads to the formation of white
crystals of H3BO3, but conc.HCl in hot condition cannot be used because it fumes a lot (even at room
temperature).
cold condition
Borate + conc. HCl
→ H 3 BO3 ↓; white crystals
Reason: The B(OH)3 produced forms hydrogen bonds with conc. H2SO4 and does not aggregate
together to be precipitated out. In case of HCl, no hydrogen bonding takes place and B(OH)3 formed
aggregates to form white crystals.
4. Test with conc. H2SO4 and alcohol (green fame test): When conc. H2SO4 is added to solution of
borate ions in presence of methanol or ethanol, colourless fumes are evolved which burn with a green
fame.
Reaction involved:
3MeOH B(OMe)3 ↑+ 3H 2 O
conc. H2SO4
B(OH)3 + or → or
3EtOH B(OEt)3 ↑ + 3H 2 O
Note: (i) Use of methyl alcohol is preferred due to high volatility of the product formed, i.e.
B(OMe)3.
_
@edubuzznotes
7.11 Tests for Phosphate (PO34- ) Radical 287
(ii) Copper and barium salts also give similar green fame. To avoid their interference in the test,
the following modifcation to the test is helpful to identify borate radical in presence of Cu
and Ba salts. It is based upon the greater volatility of BF3.
Thoroughly mix the borate with powdered CaF2 and a little conc. H2SO4, and bring a little paste
formed with the help of glass rod very close to the edge of the base of Bunsen fame without actually
touching it. Volatile BF3 is formed and produces green fame.
Na 2 B4 O7 + 6CaF2 + 7H 2 SO4
→ 4 BF3 ↑ + 6CaSO4 + Na 2 SO4 + 7 H 2 O
5. Test with AgNO3 solution: White precipitate of AgBO2 is formed from fairly concentrated borax solu•
tion, and on boiling, it turns brownish black due to the formation of Ag2O.
Reactions involved:
B4 O27 − + 4 Ag + + H 2 O
→ 4 AgBO2 ↓ + 2 H +
2 AgBO2 ↓ + 3H 2 O ∆
→ Ag 2 O ↓ + 2 H 3 BO3
6. Test with BaCl2/CaCl2/SrCl2 solution: White precipitate of M(BO2)2 is obtained on addition of these
salts to borate radical.
B4 O27 − + 2M 2 + + H 2 O
→ 2M(BO2 )2 ↓ + 2 H +
white ppt.
7. Action of heat
Borax Initially swells up and
heated with
the
→ finally contracts into
powder help of Pt wire loop
transparent glassy bead
Reaction involved:
−10 H O
2
Na 2 B4 O7 ⋅ 10 H 2 O → 2 NaBO2 + B2 O3
transparent glassy bead
The glass possesses the property of dissolving many oxides on heating, forming metaborates, which
often have characteristic colours; and this is the basis of borax bead test for various metals.
8. Bromothymol blue test: Boric acid is a weak monobasic acid (Ka = 5.8 ´ 10- 10 ) but on addition of
certain organic polyhydroxy compounds, such as mannitol, glycerol, dextrose or invert sugar, it is trans•
formed into a relatively strong acid, as shown in the following reactions.
H 3 BO3 + H 2 O ⇌ [B(OH)4 ]− + H +
OH HO O − O
+ [B(OH)4]− + B + 4H2O
OH HO O
O
The formation of chelated complex in the second reaction helps shift the frst reaction more towards
right and boric acid becomes more strongly acidic.
Note: Ethylene glycol cannot give this test (reason is uncertain).
Various tests carried out for identifcation of phosphate radical are listed as follows.
1. Solubility
a. Alkali metal phosphates are soluble in water except Li3PO4 and primary phosphates of alkaline
earth metals are also soluble.
b. All the phosphates of other metals and also the secondary and tertiary phosphates of alkaline earth
metals are sparingly soluble in water.
_
@edubuzznotes
288 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
2. Test with AgNO3 solution: In this test, yellow precipitate of Ag3PO4 is obtained which is soluble in dil.
HNO3 and dil. NH3 solution.
Reactions involved:
HPO24 − + 3Ag + → Ag 3 PO4 ↓ + H +
yellow ppt.
Ag 3 PO4 ↓ + 2 H + → H 2 PO4− + 3Ag +
Ag 3 PO4 ↓ + 6 NH 3 → 3[Ag(NH 3 )2 ]+ + PO34 −
3. Test with BaCl2 solution: In this test, white precipitate of BaHPO4 is obtained from neutral solution
while tertiary phosphate Ba 3 (PO4 )2 is precipitated in the presence of NH3 solution.
Reactions involved:
HPO24 − + Ba 2 + → BaHPO4 ↓
white ppt.
2 HPO24 − + 3Ba 2 + + 2 NH 3 → Ba 3 (PO4 )2 ↓ +2 NH +4
4. Test with FeCl3 solution: In this test yellowish white precipitate of FePO4 is obtained.
Reaction involved:
HPO24 − + Fe3+ → FePO4 ↓ + H +
5. Test with magnesia mixture: In this test, white precipitate of Mg(NH 4 )PO4 is obtained.
Reaction involved:
MgCl 2 + NH 4 Cl + NH 4 OH + HPO24 - ® Mg(NH 4 )PO4 ¯+ H 2 O + NH 4 Cl + 2Cl -
white ppt.
Magnesia mixture
6. Canary yellow precipitate test: In this test, the reagent used is (NH 4 )2 MoO4 in the presence of
strongly acidic solution of HNO3 , which reacts with HPO2−
4 to produce a canary yellow precipitate.
Reaction involved:
HPO24 − + 3NH 4+ + 12MoO24 − + 23H + → (NH 4 )3 [P(Mo 3O10 )4 ] ↓ + 12 H 2 O
canary yellow w ppt.
Note: Arsenate gives similar observation only under boiling conditions.
The chromates of different metals are coloured in solids and produce yellow solutions when dissolved in water.
This yellow colour is due to charge transfer spectra. When pH of the solution is decreased by addition of acid,
this yellow colour changes into orange or orange–red or dark–red depending upon the pH of the medium.
O O O O O−
O O O− O O
2H+ H+ H+
Cr Cr Cr Cr Cr
OH− OH− OH −
O− O− O− O O− O O O O
Chromate Dichromate O O
yellow orange Cr Cr
O O O
O O
O
Cr Cr
O− O O O
O
Trichromate Cr
orange–red
O− O
Tetrachromate
dark–red
_
@edubuzznotes
7.12 Tests for Chromate (CrO42- ) and Dichromate (Cr2O72- ) Radicals 289
Various tests carried out for identifcation of chromate and dichromate radicals are listed as follows.
1. Solubility
a. Alkali metal chromates and dichromates are soluble in water.
b. (NH 4 )2 CrO4 and (NH 4 )2 Cr2 O7 are soluble in water.
c. MgCrO4 and CaCrO4 are soluble in water, whereas SrCrO4 and BaCrO4 are sparingly soluble in water.
d. PbCrO4 , Ag 2 CrO4 and Ag 2Cr2O7 are sparingly soluble in water.
2. Test with CaCl2, SrCl2, BaCl2 and Pb(OAc)2 solutions.
Chromate
CrO24 − solution + Ca 2 + → No ppt.
+ Sr 2 + → SrCrO4 ↓ AcOH
→ Soluble
yellow ppt.
+ Ba 2 + → BaCrO4 ↓
yellow ppt. AcOH
→ Insoluble
+ Pb 2 + → PbCrO4 ↓
yellow ppt.
In all these cases, the corresponding cation has no contribution to the colour, and the yellow colour
is due to charge transfer within CrO2−4 ion.
Note: (i) The addition of K 2CrO4 can distinguish between Ca 2+ and Sr 2+ or Ca 2+ and Ba 2+ .
(ii) The addition of K 2CrO4 followed by acetic acid can distinguish between these three cations.
However, the addition of (K 2CrO4 + AcOH) solution cannot distinguish between these three
cations.
Dichromate
Cr2O72− solution also produces the precipitate of BaCrO4 with BaCl 2 solution, but the precipitation
remains incomplete and becomes complete only on addition of NaOH or CH 3CO2 Na.
Cr2 O72 − + 2 Ba 2 + + H 2 O ⇌ 2 BaCrO4 + 2 H +
On addition of NaOH or CH 3CO2 Na, the H + ions produced are consumed to produce H 2O or
CH 3CO2 H by which the precipitation becomes complete.
3. Test with AgNO3 : The precipitates of Ag 2CrO4 (brick red) and Ag 2Cr2O7 (reddish brown) are
obtained from CrO2− 2−
4 and Cr2 O 7 solutions respectively. The precipitate from dichromate on heating in
water produces the brick red precipitate again.
Reactions involved:
CrO24 − + 2 Ag + → Ag 2 CrO4 ↓
brick red ppt.
Reaction involved:
CrO24 − + H 2O2 + 2 H + → CrO5 + 3H 2O
_
@edubuzznotes
290 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
The blue solution is due to CrO5 which undergoes decomposition on standing in acid solution.
4CrO5 + 12 H + → 4Cr 3+ + 7O2 ↑+ 6 H 2O
green
solution
In the presence of an organic solvent, CrO5 is stabilized by complex formation which has permanent
blue colour, as for example.
Et Et
O
O O
Cr
O O
O
5. Tests utilizing the oxidizing property of CrO24 - / Cr2 O72 - radicals: There are several tests in which the
colour of CrO2−4
or Cr2O72− is decolorized due to its oxidizing property. Some such tests are:
2− H +
CrO24 − + SO3 / SO2 → SO42 − + Cr 3 + + H 2 O
+
or + H 2 S / S 2 − H → S ↓ +Cr 3 + + H 2 O
7
2
Cr2 O27 − + Fe2 + H
+
→ Fe3 + + Cr 3 + + H 2 O
+ H+ + +
+
+ Br − / I − H
→ Br2 / I 2 + Cr 3 + + H 2 O
+
+ Cl − (salt) H
→ Cr2 O2 Cl 2 ↑ + H 2 O
+ HCl (conc.) → Cl 2 ↑ + Cr 3 + + H 2 O
+
+ C 2 H 5OH H
→ [CH 3CHO] → CH 3CO2 H + Cr 3 + + H 2 O
+
+ NO2− solution H
→ NO3− + Cr 3 + + H 2 O
+ H 2 SO4 (conc.) hot
→ O2 ↑ +Cr 3 + + H 2 O
+ H 2 SO4 (conc.) cold
→ CrO3 ↓ + H 2 O
dark
red crystals
+
MnO4− + S 2 − / H 2 S H
→ Mn 2 + + S ↓ + H 2 O
+
+ SO23 − / SO2 H
→ Mn 2 + + SO24 − + H 2 O
+
+ Fe2 + H
→ Mn 2 + + Fe3 + + H 2 O
+
+ I − H
→ Mn 2 + + I 2 + H 2 O
+
+ NO2− H
→ Mn 2 + + NO3− + H 2 O
+
+ C 2 O42 − H
→ Mn 2 + + CO2 ↑ + H 2 O
+
+ Cl − (salt) H
→ No reaction
+ conc. HCl → Mn 2 + + Cl 2 + H 2 O
+
+ H 2 O2 H
→ Mn 2 + + O2 ↑ + H 2 O
_
@edubuzznotes
7.14 Dry Tests for Basic Radicals 291
3. Test with hot conc. NaOH: In this test, permanganate radical gives green solution on treatment with
hot and concentrated NaOH. The purple colour of permanganate solution is restored by acidifcation
or by dilution with large amount of water.
Reactions involved:
2MnO4− + 2OH − → 2MnO24 − + 21 O2 + H 2 O
green
solution
3MnO24 − + 3H 2 O → 2MnO4− + MnO(OH)2 + 4OH −
purple colour
is restored
4. Heating effect of KMnO4 : Heating of dry crystals of KMnO4 (almost black in colour) gives a
black residue. Addition of little water to this residue, followed by filtration, gives green filtrate
and black residue.
Reaction involved:
2KMnO4 ∆ → K 2 MnO4 + MnO2 + O2 ↑
K 2 MnO4 is water soluble and so is leached out as green fltrate. MnO2 is insoluble in water and gives
rise to black residue.
Residue
If no residue is obtained, then the cation present in the salt is not a metal ion. In general, salts of non•
metallic cations such as NH +4 or PH +4 may be present.
Colour change
Most of the colour changes on heating are associated with the removal of water of crystallization or with
the formation of f•centres under hot conditions. For example,
heated, ∆
1. ZnO (white) ↽
ZnO (yellow)
⇀
cooled
cold hot
_
@edubuzznotes
292 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
∆
2. CuSO4 ⋅ 5H 2O −
5 H 2O
→ CuSO4
blue white
∆
3. CoCl 2 ⋅ 6 H 2 O → CoCl 2
−6H 2 O
pink blue
Sublimation
1. White sublimates are given by HgCl 2 , Hg 2Cl 2 , As2O3 , Sb 2O3 and NH 4 X (where X = Cl, Br, I). These
white sublimates are distinguished by the following procedure. Dilute HCl is added to the white sub•
limate and H2S gas is passed through the solution to obtain a precipitate. The different colours of the
precipitates obtained correspond to different basic radicals which are described below.
Salt Colour of the precipitate Formula of the precipitate
HgCl 2 Black HgS
Hg 2Cl 2 Black Hg + HgS
As2O3 Yellow As2S 3
Sb 2O3 Orange Sb 2S 3
NH 4 X No reaction
Reactions involved:
HgCl 2 + S 2 − → HgS ↓ +2Cl −
black ppt.
H S
Hg 22 + → Hg ↓ + Hg 2 +
2
→ Hg ↓ + HgS ↓ + 2 H +
black ppt.
For M = As, Sb
M 2O3 + 6 HCl → 2MCl 3 + 3H 2O
2M 3 + + 3S 2 − → M 2 S 3 ↓
The above two black precipitates are also well distinguished when they are treated with Na 2S
solution.
HgS + Na 2S → [HgS 2 ]2 − + 2 Na +
colourless
soluble complex
(Hg + HgS) + Na 2S → Hg ↓ + [HgS 2 ]2 − + 2Na +
black ppt. colourless
soluble
compleex
2. Coloured sublimates are indicative of the nature of basic radical described as follows.
a. If black: HgS (known as vermillion) or Hg 2S.
b. If yellow: HgI 2 and As2S 3 .
We can further distinguish between HgI 2 and As2S 3 by the following procedure. On application of
mechanical stress:
(i) If the yellow sublimate turns red, it indicates the presence of HgI2.
(ii) No change in the sublimate shows the presence of As2S3.
This behaviour can be explained on the basis of changes shown in Figure 7.6.
HgI2 heated to on cooling HgI2
HgI2
scarlet red 127 °C to room temp. yellow
yellow
on application of
mechanical stress only
Figure 7.6 Changes during application of mechanical stress on the yellow sublimate.
_
@edubuzznotes
7.14 Dry Tests for Basic Radicals 293
Gas evolved
The evolved gas can be recognized based on its characteristic properties and is indicative of the nature of
the acid radical present in the salt.
1. CO2 ⇒ Certain carbonates or organic materials are present.
2. SO2 ⇒ Sulphite, thiosulphates or sulphides may be present.
3. Cl 2 ⇒ Certain chlorides may undergo thermal decomposition.
4. Br2 ⇒ Certain bromides may undergo thermal decomposition.
5. I 2 ⇒ Certain iodides may undergo thermal decomposition.
6. NO2 ⇒ Decomposition of nitrates.
7. CO ⇒ Decomposition of formates or oxalates.
Flame test
In the fame test, a platinum wire or glass rod is frst dipped into concentrated HCl and then into a little of
substance to be tested. It is then introduced into the lower oxidizing zone of the fame, and the imparted
colour to the fame is observed. The different colours of the fame corresponding to different basic radicals
are described below.
When Na+ and K+ are present together, the yellow colouration of sodium fame masks that of potassium.
To confrm the presence of potassium under this condition, repeat the test through double blue glass and
observe the fame colour again. The colours observed are described below.
Metal Colour of the flame with naked eye Colour of the flame through double blue
(cobalt) glass
Note: Be2+ and Mg2+ do not impart any colour to the fame due to their high ionization energy.
The different colours observed with different metals are given in Table 7.1
Table 7.1 Colour of borax beads for different metals
Oxidizing flame Reducing flame
Metal
Hot Cold Hot Cold
Cr Yellow Green Green Green
Mn Violet Violet Colourless Colourless
Fe Yellowish brown Yellow Green Green
Co Blue Blue Blue Blue
Ni Violet Reddish brown Grey Grey
Cu Green Blue Colourless Opaque*
* This opacity is due to red colour metallic copper deposition.
Note: (i) Borax bead test is performed only for coloured salt samples.
(ii) The swelling characteristic is due to the loss of water of crystallization, but it is not mandatory
that all compounds having water of crystallization will show swelling characteristic.
(iii) Alums also show swelling characteristic, but on strong heating they are converted into
amorphous powder unlike the glassy bead in case of borax.
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
7.15 Wet Tests for Basic Radicals 295
‘Zero’ group ⇒ NH +4 : The test for NH +4 is done from the original sample separately.
Some important points regarding group analysis:
1. Among the cations in Table 7. 2, only the chlorides of Ag + , Hg 22 + and Pb 2+ are sparingly soluble in water.
2. Pb 2+ appears in two groups, Group I and Group II. This is because PbCl 2 is sparingly soluble in water
and the concentration of Pb 2+ ions passed into the fltrate is suffcient to give the precipitate of PbS
with Group II reagents.
3. Dilute HCl and NH 4OH act as auxiliary reagents with Group II and Group IV reagents respectively.
This is because we want to achieve the separation of cations in maximum possible groups. To do so, we
take the help of the fact that ‘Ksp of Group II sulphides is less than the Ksp of Group IV sulphides’. Hence
Group II sulphides will be precipitated out even under low concentration of sulphides, while Group IV
sulphides require higher concentration of sulphides. To fulfll this reaction condition, dil. HCl is chosen in
Group II reagents and NH 4OH is chosen in Group IV reagents.
In Group II
H 2 S ⇌ 2H + + S2 −
HCl → H + + Cl −
Due to common ion effect of H + , the frst reaction shifts to left and [S 2− ] decreases.
In Group IV
H 2 S ⇌ 2H + + S2 −
NH 4 OH ⇌ NH +4 + OH −
NH 4OH consumes H + from frst reaction, so the frst reaction shifts to right and [S 2− ] increases.
4. The function of NH 4Cl in Group III reagent is as follows:
NH 4 OH ⇌ NH +4 + OH −
NH 4 Cl → NH 4+ + Cl −
_
@edubuzznotes
296 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
Due to the common ion effect of NH +4 , the concentration of OH − ions decreases. If NH 4Cl is not added,
then the following precipitates could be obtained together:
a. All M(OH)3 from Group III.
b. All M(OH)2 from Group IV.
c. Mg(OH)2 only from Group VI.
But when NH 4Cl is added, the [OH − ] decreases to such an extent that only M(OH)3 from Group III
are precipitated due to their very low Ksp (in the range of ∼ 10 −38) as compared to that of others.
5. The function of NH 4Cl in the GroupV reagent is discussed as follows
NH 4+ + CO32 − → NH 3 ↑ + HCO3−
6. Before adding the Group III reagent into the Group II fltrate, the following steps need to be taken
care of:
a. The dissolved H 2S is to be boiled off. If not done, then the dissolved H 2S reacts with NH 4OH of
the Group III reagent and the produced [S 2− ] is suffcient to cause precipitation of some of the
Group IV cations which is unwanted.
H 2S + 2 NH 4OH → 2 NH +4 + S 2 − + 2 H 2O
b. Then add 2–3 drops of dil. HNO3 and boil again to convert all Fe2+ (if any) into Fe3+ . If this is not
done, then Fe2+ does not give precipitate with the Group I, Group II and Group III reagents and
gives black precipitate of sulphide only with the Group IV reagent, which is diffcult to separate
from rest of the precipitates of the group.
Hence all Fe2+ ions (Fe2+ and Fe3+ in the original sample) are precipitated in the form of Fe(OH)3
and observing this reddish•brown precipitate of Fe(OH)3 , we cannot predict the oxidation state of
iron in the original sample.
2. Reaction with NaOH: Different coloured precipitates are obtained with different cations and the
behaviour of these precipitates in excess NaOH are listed below.
a. White precipitates obtained from reaction between Mn+ and OH– are shown in Figure 7.7
Colourless
soluble complex
Soluble
Pb(OH)2 Pb(OH)2 [Pb(OH)4]2−
Sn(OH)2 Sn(OH)2 [Sn(OH)4]2−
Sn(OH)4 Sn(OH)4 [Sn(OH)6]2−
Cd(OH)2 Sb2O3 [SbO2]−
Sb2O3 Al(OH)3 [Al(OH)4]−
Excess
Bi(OH)3 Zn(OH)2 [Zn(OH)4]2−
NaOH
Al(OH)3
*Fe(OH)2
Zn(OH)2
**Mn(OH)2
Cd(OH)2
Mg(OH)2
Insoluble Bi(OH)3
Fe(OH)2
*Fe(OH)2 : Greenish white or dirty green ppt. Mn(OH)2
**Mn(OH)2 : Pinkish white ppt. Mg(OH)2
These two colours are very light and hence are listed with white precipitates.
Hg 2O excess
NaOH
→ Insoluble
c. Yellow precipitate:
HgO excess
NaOH
→ Insoluble
d. Blue precipitate:
Cu(OH)2 excess
NaOH
→ Insoluble
e. Green precipitate:
Cr(OH)3 excess
NaOH
→ [Cr(OH)4 ]−
green
solution
Ni(OH)2 excess
NaOH
→ Insoluble
f. Reddish–brown precipitate:
Fe(OH)3 excess
NaOH
→ Insoluble
Note: (i) Cations like As3+ , As5+ , Sb 5+ produce soluble species like AsO33− , AsO34− and SbO3− 4 , respec•
tively, hence no precipitation is observed.
(ii) Hydroxides of Na + , K + , Ca 2 + , Sr 2 + , Ba 2 + are soluble in water and hence no precipitation is
observed.
_
@edubuzznotes
298 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
3. Reaction with NH4OH: In this test also different coloured precipitates are obtained from different
cations and the behaviour of these precipitates in excess NaOH are listed below.
a. White precipitates obtained from reaction between Mn+ and OH− are shown in Figure 7.8.
Soluble
Pb(OH)2 Zn(OH)2 [Zn(NH3)4]2+
Sn(OH)2 Cd(OH)2 [Cd(NH3)4]2+
Sn(OH)4
Al(OH)3 is partially soluble in NH3.
Cd(OH)2
Sb2O3
Excess
Bi(OH)3
NH4OH
Al(OH)3
*Fe(OH)2
Zn(OH)2
**Mn(OH)2
Rest are insoluble
Mg(OH)2
Insoluble in NH4OH
HgO . Hg(NH2)X.
b. Brownish•black precipitate:
4 NH OH 4 excess NH OH
Ag + → Ag 2 O → [Ag(NH 3 )2 ]+ ; soluble complex
NH OH excess NH OH
Hg 22 +
4
→ 2 Hg ↓ + HgO ⋅ Hg(NH 2 )X ↓
4
→ Insoluble
c. Yellow precipitate: No such precipitate is obtained from Hg 2+ .
d. Blue precipitate:
excess
Cu(OH)2 → [Cu(NH 3 )4 ]2 + ; deep blue solution
NH OH 4
excess readily
Co(OH)X → [Co(NH 3 )6 ]2 + oxidizes
3+
to → [Co(NH 3 )6 ] + e
NH 4 OH
brownish − yellow pink solution
solution
e. Green precipitate: excess
Cr(OH)3 → Partially soluble
NH 4 OH
excess
Ni(OH)2 → [Ni(NH 3 )6 ]2 + ; deep blue solution
NH 4 OH
f. Reddish–brown precipitate:
excess
Fe(OH)3 → Insoluble
NH 4OH
Note: (i) Cations like As3+ , As5+ , Sb 5+ produce soluble species like AsO33− , AsO34− and SbO3− 4 respec•
tively, hence no precipitation is observed.
(ii) Hydroxides of Na + , K + , Ca 2 + , Sr 2 + , Ba 2 + are soluble in water and hence no precipitation is
observed.
Some specifc behaviour:
3+
(i) Bi (solution) + Na 2SnO2 (solution) → Bi ↓ + [Sn(OH)6 ]2 − + 2 Na +
or or black
metallic
Bi(OH)3 Na2[Sn(OH)4 ] deposit
_
@edubuzznotes
7.16 Some General Tests for Cations 299
(ii) BiO ⋅ OH ↓
or + H 2 O2 → BiO−3 + H + + H 2O
yellowish brown solution due
Bi(OH)3 ↓
to bismuthate (BiO−3 ) ion.
4. Reaction with H2S/S2-: The reagents used for this reaction are as follows:
(i) dil. HCl + H 2S.
(ii) H 2S gas is directly passed through the sample solution.
(iii) (NH 4 )2 S or Na 2 S.
The concentration order of [S 2− ] is: (i) < (ii) < (iii).The precipitates formed by different cations are
their sulphides, that is, MS, M 2S, M 2S 3 ,… etc. depending on the charge of cation. The reagents used
and different cations forming precipitate with them are listed as below.
Reactions involved
a. Ag + dil
. HCl
→ AgCl ↓ (which does not convert into Ag 2 S at all)
+ H 2S
Filtrate H2S
PbS ↓
(Pb2+ + 2Cl−) in presence
black ppt.
Pb2+
dil. HCl of dil. HCl
b. and filtered
Residue H2S
PbS ↓
PbCl2(s) in presence
of dil. HCl black ppt.
H2S
Filtrate: No ppt.
in presence
d. Zn 2 + + H 2 S ZnS ↓ +2 H + + SO42 −
as ZnSO4 white ppt.
solution
Here the precipitation is partial because ZnS is soluble in acid below pH = 6 and the precipitation can
be made complete in the presence of CH 3CO2 Na
Zn 2 + + H 2S + 2CH 3CO2− → ZnS ↓ +2CH 3CO2 H
4a. Reactions of Group III cations with H2S/S 2-
For Fe 3+
Fe3 + + dil. HCl + H 2 S → white ppt. (A)
While
add
Fe3 + + (NH 4 )2 S / Na 2 S → Black ppt. (B) → white ppt. (A)
dil . H 2 SO4
dil . HCl
Fe2 + + H 2S
→ No ppt.
2 Fe2 + + 2S 2 − → 2 FeS ↓
black ppt.
FeS + H 2SO4 (dil.) → FeSO4 + H 2S ↑
Hence the black precipitate (B) is (2 FeS + S) and FeS dissolves in dilute mineral acid and the white
precipitate of S is obtained. The dissolution reaction of FeS with H 2SO4 is utilized for the preparation
of H 2S in the laboratory using Kipp’s apparatus.
For Al 3+ and Cr 3+
dil. HCl
No ppt.
+ H2S
Al3+ or Cr3+
(NH4)2 S or Al(OH)3 ; white ppt.
Na2S or
Cr (OH)3 ; green ppt.
On addition of S 2− reagent, we get the precipitates of the hydroxide of these two metal ions. This hap•
pens due to the hydrolysis of S 2− ion in water as follows:
S 2 − + H 2 O ⇌ SH − + OH −
This [OH − ] is suffcient to exceed the Ksp of Al(OH)3 and Cr(OH)3, and yield the above precipitates
because of their very low Ksp (∼10−38).
4b. Classifcation of sulphides based on their colours with different cations
The sulphides of various cations are classifed on the basis of their colour as follows:
Black: Ag 2S, PbS, (Hg + HgS), HgS, CuS, Bi 2S 3 (brownish black) NiS, CoS, FeS
Yellow: As2S 3 , As2S 5 , SnS 2 , CdS
Orange: Sb 2S 3 , Sb 2S 5
Buff : MnS
White: ZnS
Brown: SnS
4c. Classifcation of Group II sulphides based on their solubility in yellow ammonium sulphide (YAS)
(NH4)2S2: These are classifed as:
a. Group II A or ‘Cu•group’ which is insoluble in YAS: CuS, HgS, Bi 2S 3 , PbS, CdS.
b. Group II B or ‘As•group’ which is soluble in YAS: As2S 3 , As2S 5 , Sb 2S 3 , Sb 2S 5 , SnS, and SnS 2 .
Note: (i) CdS is the only yellow coloured sulphide precipitate which does not dissolve in YAS.
(ii) MnS is the only sulphide precipitate which dissolves in acetic acid.
(iii) Solubility of Group I, Group IIA and Group IV sulphides in different solvents are important
information for use and given below:
• In HNO3 (1 : 1), all are soluble except HgS and (Hg + HgS).
The generalized reaction is
MS / M 2S / M 2S 3 + HNO3 → M(NO3 )x + S ↓ + NO ↑ + H 2O
• In aqua regia (3HCl + HNO3 ), all are soluble and the reactions is:
M 2S n + (3HCl + HNO3 ) → MCl n + S ↓ + NO ↑ + H 2O
_
@edubuzznotes
7.16 Some General Tests for Cations 301
While
NH
Ag + + CrO24 − → Ag 2 CrO4 ↓ solution 3
→ [Ag(NH 3 )2 ]+ + CrO24 −
brick red ppt. (
colourless (yellow)
)
yellow solution
Here these two ions can be distinguished from each other using Na 2CrO4 solution.
The reactions for other cations like Ca 2 +, Sr 2 +, Ba 2 +, Pb 2 + have already been discussed in Section 7.12.
8. Reaction with KCN solution
(i) Ag + KCN
→ AgCN ↓ excess KCN
→ [Ag(CN)2 ]−
white ppt. colourless
so lub le complex
(ii) Pb 2 + KCN
→ Pb(CN)2 ↓ excess
KCN
→ Insoluble
white ppt.
(iii) Hg 2 2 + KCN
→
Hg ↓ + Hg(CN)2
black ppt.
Note: Using KCN, Group I cations can be distinguished easily.
(iv) Hg 2 + KCN
→ Hg(CN)2
No observational changes because the water soluble, colourless compound is formed.
quickly
(v) Cu 2 + KCN
→ Cu(CN)2 ↓ decomposes
→ Cu(CN) ↓ + (CN)2 ↑
yellow ppt. white ppt. cyanogen
excess KCN
H S 3−
No ppt. ←
passed [Cu(CN)4 ]
2
(vi) colourless
so lub le complex
Cd 2 + KCN
→ Cd(CN)2 ↓ excess
KCN
→ [ Cd(CN)4 ]2 −
white ppt. colourless
so lub le complex
H2S passed
CdS
yellow ppt.
Note: From the sequential reactions of Cu 2+ and Cd 2+ towards KCN it is clear that these two cations
can be distinguished from each other as well as separated from their mixture in the following way:
Residue
CdS↓
H2S
(Cu2+ + Cd2+)+ Excess KCN [Cu(CN)4]3−
passed and
+
filtered Filtrate
[Cd(CN)4]2−
[Cu(CN)4]3−
(vii) Fe2 + KCN
→ Fe(CN)2 ↓ excess
KCN
→ K 4 [ Fe(CN)6 ]
yellowish – brown ppt. pale yellow solution
(viii) Fe3 + KCN
→ Fe(CN)3 ↓ excess
KCN
→ K 3 [ Fe(CN)6 ]
reddish – brown ppt. yellow solution
However, from this solution the same precipitates can be obtained when the above reagents are added
with acetic acid.
K4[Fe(CN)6]
Cu2 [Fe(CN)6]↓
Cu + 4NH3
2+ + CH3CO2H chocolate brown ppt.
[Cu(NH3)4]2+ K3[Fe(CN)6]
Cu3 [Fe(CN)6]2↓
+ CH3CO2H green ppt.
With Zn2+ Zn 2 + + K 4 [ Fe(CN)6 ] → K 2 Zn 3 [ Fe(CN)6 ]2 ↓
white ppt.
Zn 2 + + K 3 [ Fe(CN)6 ] → No observation
With Fe2+
in absence of air
Fe2 + + K 4 [ Fe(CN)6 ] → K 2 Fe[ Fe(CN)6 ] ↓
white ppt.
Under ordinary atmospheric conditions, a pale blue precipitate is obtained due to the partial conver•
sion of Fe2+ into Fe3+ by aerial oxidation according to the following reaction.
Fe3+ + [Fe(CN)6]4− → [Fe4[Fe(CN)6]3 ↓
redox reaction Prussian blue ppt.
frst
Fe + [Fe(CN)6]3−
2+
[Fe3[Fe(CN)6]2 ↓
→ Turnbull’s blue ppt.
(detected earlier)
Initially it was suggested that Prussian blue and Turnbull’s blue are two different precipitates. But now with
a detailed study by Mössbauer spectroscopy it is proved that they are of identical compositon and structure.
Fe3+ +[Fe(CN)6]3− Fe[Fe(CN)6] ; brown colouration
reducing agent
SnCl2 H2O2
solution solution
Fe4[Fe(CN)6]3
Prussian blue ppt.
10. Reaction with Na2HPO4: There are two yellow precipitates formed by the following reactions:
HPO24 −
Ag + ← → Ag 3 PO4 ↓ + H +
NH 3
→ [Ag(NH 3 )2 ]+
solution
yellow ppt. soluble complex
2−
→ FePO4 ↓ + H +
HPO4
Fe3+ ←
NH 3
→ Insoluble
solution
yellow ppt.
Hence using Na 2 HPO4 followed by addition of ammonia these two cations can be well distinguished.
There are six cations that produce white precipitates which are shown in the following reactions.
HPO24 −
Pb 2 + ← → Pb 3 (PO4 )2 ↓ + H +
white ppt.
HPO2 −
Hg 22 + ←
4
→ Hg 2 HPO4 ↓
white ppt.
(This is the only case where no decrease in the pH of the medium is observed.)
HPO2 −
Al 3 + ←
4
→ AlPO4 ↓ + H +
white ppt.
HPO2 −
Zn 2 + ←
4
→ Zn 3 (PO4 )2 ↓+ H +
white ppt.
HPO2 −
Ba 2 + ←
4
→ Ba 3 (PO4 )2 ↓ + H +
white ppt.
2+ 2−
Mg + HPO4 + (NH 4 OH + NH 4 Cl) → Mg(NH 4 )PO4 ↓
white ppt.
_
@edubuzznotes
304 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
→
excess
KSCN
[Cu(SCN)4 ]3−
complex colourless
soluble
For Fe3+
This test is specifc for Fe3+ even in the presence of Fe2+ .
NaF
Reason: The solubility order is CaSO4 > SrSO4 > BaSO4 and the least soluble compound will be
precipitated frst.
6. Test with K4 [Fe(CN)6]: Among the three cations, only Ca2+ gives white precipitate with K4 [Fe(CN)6].
Ca 2 + + K 4 [ Fe (CN)6 ] → K 2 Ca [ Fe(CN)6 ] ↓
white ppt.
NaOH NH Cl
a. Mg 2 +
→ Mg(OH)2 ↓
4
→ clear solution
or NH 4 OH
white ppt. solution
Na 2 CO3 or NH Cl
b. Mg 2 +
→ Mg(OH)2 ⋅ 4MgCO3 ⋅ 6 H 2 O ↓
4
solution
→ clear solution
( NH 4 )2 CO3 solution
white ppt.
K+ K 3 [Co(NO2 )6 ] ↓
a. or
Na 3 [Co( NO2 )6 ] Both are yellow precipitates
yellow solution
→ or
NH 4+
or (NH 4 )3 [Co(NO2 )6 ] ↓
K+ K 2 [PtCl 6 ] ↓
H2 [ PtCl6 ]
b. or → or Both are yellow precipitates
or Na 2 [PtCl6 ]
NH 4+
(NH 4 )2 [PtCl 6 ] ↓
K+ KHC 4 H 4 O6 ↓
NaHC4 H4O6
c. or →
or H 2 C 4 H 4 O6
or Both are white precipitates
+
NH 4 tartaric acid (NH 4 )HC 4 H 4 O6 ↓
ü ¾or¾¾¾¾¾ ® KClO4 ¯
HClO4
K+ NaClO4 solution
d. or ï
ý white ppt..
+ï
NH 4 þ ¾¾¾¾¾¾® No ppt.
HClO4
or NaClO4 solution
The colourless gas NH3 evolved can be identifed by several methods discussed in Section 7.8.
No such gas is obtained with K +.
_
@edubuzznotes
306 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
3. For Fe 2 + : These tests are specifc to Fe2+ even in the presence of Fe3+
b. Fe2+ + [Fe(dipy)3]2+
N N red colouration
dipyridyl
(dipy)
c. Fe2 + + → [ Fe(C 12 H 8 N 2 )3 ] 2 +
N N red colouration
1,10 - phenanthroline
4. For Zn 2 +
a. Rinmann’s green test:
ignited
Zn 2 + solution + K 3 [Co(CN)6 ] → KZn[Co(CN)6 ] ↓
→ CoO ⋅ ZnO
yellow ppt. or
Co[ZnO2 ]
green residue
This green residue is known as Rinmann’s green.
b. Test with {CuSO4 + (NH 4 )2 [Hg(SCN)4 ]} solution:
Cu 2 + + [Hg(SCN)4 ]2 − → No reaction
While
Zn 2 + + [Hg(SCN)4 ]2 − → Zn[Hg(SCN)4 ] ↓
white ppt.
But in the presence of Zn 2 + , Cu 2 + also reacts through induced reaction giving rise to a violet
precipitate due to complex formation with both the ions.
Cu 2 + + Zn 2 + + [Hg (SCN)4 ]2 − → Cu [Hg (SCN)4 ] ↓ + Zn [Hg (SCN)4 ] ↓
viollet ppt.
5. For Cr 3+ : The presence of Cr 3+ is shown by chromate test where Cr 3+ is converted into CrO2− 4 using
different reagents. In all cases, the green colour due to Cr 3+ is changed into the yellow colour of CrO2−4 .
3+ 2−
Reagents used for conversion of Cr to CrO4 are listed as follows.
_
@edubuzznotes
Heating Effects 307
acidic
a. 2Cr 3 + + 3S 2 O82 − + 8 H 2 O → 2CrO24 − + 6SO24 − + 16 H +
medium
3+
b. Cr in alkaline medium exist as [Cr(OH)4 ]− .
Here another very good reagent sodium perborate (NaBO3) can be used instead of H 2O2. It
produces H 2O2 on hydrolysis in situ.
BO3− + 2OH − → BO33 − + H 2 O2
c. NaOBr solution also can be used for the same purpose.
Cr 3 + + 3 OBr − + 10 OH − → 2CrO24 − + 3Br − + 5H 2 O
6. For Mn 2++ : Similarly, the presence of Mn 2+ is confrmed by conversion to MnO4− and the observation is
changed from colourless to purple. The various methods for this conversion are listed as follows:
a. Using K 2S 2O8 or (NH 4 )2 S 2O8 solution in acidic medium.
HEATING EFFECTS
The effect of heating on various salts, oxides and acids can also be used for detection of radicals and identifca•
tion of unknown salts. The characteristic products obtained on heating of different salts are listed as follows.
1. Heating effect on carbonate and bicarbonate salts: All carbonates except (Na, K, Rb, Cs) decompose
on heating giving CO2. For example,
Li 2 CO3 ® Li 2 O + CO2
MCO3 ® MO + CO2 [M = Be, Mg, Ca, Sr, Ba]
Ag 2 CO3 ® 2 Ag + CO2 + 1 O2
2
yellow black
Cu(OH)2 .CuCO3 ¾D¾® 2CuO + CO2 + H 2 O
Basic Cu (II) carbonate
ZnCO3 ® ZnO + CO2
white yellow(hot)
white(colld)
PbCO 3 ® PbO + CO2 [2 PbCO3 .Pb(OH)2 ¾350 ¾¾ °C
® Pb 3O4 + CO2 + CO + H 2 O]
yellow white lead
HgCO3 ® Hg + 21 O2 - + CO2 -
2 NaHCO3 ∆
→ Na 2 CO3 + CO2 + H 2 O
300 °C
FeSO4 ⋅ 7 H 2 O → FeSO4 ∆
→ Fe2 O3 + SO2 + SO3
−7 H 2 O
green vitriol from 2 moles
D
MgSO4 .7 H2 O ¾¾¾¾ ® MgSO4 ¯ [Same as ZnSO4]
-7 H 2 O
Epsom salt
∆
Na2SO3 + SO2
2NaHSO3 Na2S2O5 + H2Ο ∆
Na2S + Na2SO4
2 NaHSO4 ∆
→ Na 2 SO4 + H 2 O + SO3
220 °C
Na2S2O3.5H2O Na2S2O3 + 5H2O
∆
from 4 moles
3Na2SO4 + Na2S5
1. Which of the following ions gives brown ring test 3. The sulphide ion gives purple colour with sodium
with dil. H2SO4? nitroprusside. The purple colour is due to the forma•
(A) NO2- (B) NO3- tion of
(C) Both (A) and (B) (D) None of these (A) Na 4 [ Fe(CN)3 (NOS)3 ] .
2. Which of the following cations gives red colour in (B) Na 4 [ Fe(CN)4 (NOS)2 ] .
fame?
(C) Na 4 [ Fe(CN)5 (NOS)] .
(A) Cs + (B) Ba 2 +
(C) Sr 2+
(D) K + (D) Na 4 [ Fe(NOS)6 ] .
_
@edubuzznotes
Single Correct Choice Type Questions 311
1. Na 2S 2O3 solution + X ¾¾
® White ppt. (C) AgNO2 (D) NH 4 NO3
excess
¾¾¾¾¾¾¾ ® Clear solution 9. Which of the following pairs of cations can be
Na 2 S2 O3 solution
separated from each other by adding hypo solution
Then X may be
followed by fltration?
(A) Pb(OAc)2 (B) CuSO4 (A) Ca 2 + , Ba 2 + (B) Ag + , Cu 2 +
(C) NaNO3 (D) AgNO3 2+
(C) Hg , Mg 2+
(D) Bi 3 + , Pb 2 +
2. Cr(OH)3 and Al(OH)3 cannot be separated using 10. Salt solution of M + NaN 3 + I 2 dissolved in KI soln
(A) dil. HCl . (B) NaOH (excess). → colourless gas is evolved.
(C) NH 3 solution. (D) Any of these. Then salt M may be
3. Which cations among the following do not give ppt. (A) KCl (B) Na 2S
of their sulphide with (NH 4 )2 S ? (C) N 2S 2O3 (D) NH 4SCN
(A) Al 3+ (B) Fe2+ 11. Which of the following acid radicals produce white
(C) Sr 2+ (D) Fe3+ precipitate on addition of AgNO3 ?
(A) C 2O42− (B) NO2−
4. Which of the following processes result in a Prussian
(C) Cl −
(D) HCO2−
blue ppt.?
(A) Fe2 + + [ Fe(CN)6 ]3 −
→ 12. To identify I 2 produced in a particular reaction, the
(B) Fe2 + + [ Fe(CN)6 ]4 − suitable reagents are
→
(A) excess NaOH solution.
(C ) Fe3+ + [ Fe(CN)6 ]3− →
SnCl (B) presence of CCl 4 .
(D) Fe3 + + [ Fe(CN)6 ]3 −
→ P 2 → (C) excess KI solution.
5. Which of the following acid radicals will produce (D) presence of starch.
H 2S gas on action of [Zn + dil. H 2SO4 ]? 13. The colour of acidic KMnO4 can be discharged by
(A) S 2− (B) SO2− 4 (A) Cl − ion. (B) NO2− .
2−
(C) SO3 (D) HSO4− (C) NO3 .
−
(D) FeCl 2 solution.
6. Which of the following pairs of cations can be sepa• 14. CO gas can be detected by which of the following
rated from each other by passing H 2S in dil. HCl methods?
medium? (A) It turns lime water milky.
(A) Sn 2 + , Hg 2 + (B) Pb 2 + , Mn 2 +
(B) It burns with a blue fame.
3+
(C) Sb , Cu 2+
(D) Zn 2 + , Cu 2 +
(C) It turns the PdCl 2 solution black.
7. Which of the following compounds will give yellow (D) It reduces Fe2O3 to Fe.
ppt. on addition of the (Na 2CrO4 + AcOH) solution?
15. Which of the following aqueous suspensions give
(A) BaCl 2 solution.
clear solution on heating?
(B) Aqueous suspension of PbCO3 .
(A) PbSO4 (B) PbCl 2
(C) Aqueous suspension of BaSO4 .
(C) CH 3CO2 Ag (D) None of these.
(D) Hot solution of PbCl 2 .
16. Sometimes turbidity appears in the Group II test
8. Salt A NaOH
→ Gas B + Solution C
of group analysis, even in the absence of Group II
Solution C + Zn + NaOH → Gas B cations. This is due to
Then solid A may be (A) the presence of Fe2+ cation.
(A) NaNO3 (B) NH 4 NO2
_
@edubuzznotes
314 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
(Step III)
ex
adding +
(C) Ag , Ba 2+
(D) Pb 2 + , Sr 2 +
N
SO2 is passed
again 9. Which of the following anions give precipitate with
Pale yellow
solution (B) MgCl2 solution only on boiling?
(A) CO2−
3 (B) HCO3−
Yellow solution comes
back again (C) Both (A) and (B) (D) None of these.
_
@edubuzznotes
Comprehension Type Questions 315
Passage 4: For Questions 10–12 the same gas in excess forming another compound (N).
But same observation is not obtained with boric acid.
2 2 4 H C O
A + FeCl 3
→ Deep blue ppt.(B) solution
→ 16. Purple colour of KMnO4 does not change because
Deep blue clearr solution used as writing ink (A) the gas has no oxidizing property since the cen•
→ Deep blue ppt. (B)
C + FeCl 2 tral atom has the minimum oxidation state.
(B) the gas has no reducing property since the cen•
2 2 H O
C + FeCl 3
→ Brown colouration → tral atom has the maximum oxidation state.
solution
Deep blue ppt. (B) (C) the gas has no precipitation characteristics.
(D) the gas precipitates CaCO3 from lime water.
10. Magnetic moments of compounds A and C in BM
17. The compounds M and N formed in the above
are respectively
sequence are respectively
(A) zero and zero (B) zero and 1.73
(A) water soluble CaCO3 and water soluble
(C) 4.89 and 1.73 (D) 4.89 and 5.92
Ca(HCO3 )2,
11. When C is added to CuSO4 solution, the colour and (B) water insoluble CaCO3 and water insoluble
formula of the precipitate formed is respectively Ca(HCO3 )2 .
(A) green and Cu 3 [ Fe(CN)6 ]2 (C) water insoluble CaCO3 and water soluble
(B) chocolate brown and Cu 2 [ Fe(CN)6 ] Ca(HCO3 )2 .
(C) green and Cu 2 [ Fe(CN)6 ] (D) water soluble CaCO3 and water insoluble
(D) chocolate brown and Cu 3 [ Fe(CN)6 ]2 Ca(HCO3 )2 .
12. When A is treated with conc. H 2SO4, the gas that 18. The correct order of increasing acidity is
comes out is _______ and this reaction is utilized as a (A) boric acid < acetic acid < carbonic acid
very good method for preparation of that gas. (B) acetic acid < boric acid < carbonic acid
(A) HCN (B) HNC (C) carbonic acid < acetic acid < boric acid
(C) CO (D) CO2 (D) boric acid < carbonic acid < acetic acid
(II) Bottle 1 + Bottle 3 white precipitate 28. White ppt. in test tube V is
(III) Bottle 1 + Bottle 4 white precipitate (A) Ag 2CO3 (B) Ag 2S 2O3
(IV) Bottle 2 + Bottle 3 colourless gas evolved (C) Ag 2SO4 (D) HCO2 Ag
(V) Bottle 2 + Bottle 4 no visible reaction
(VI) Bottle 3 + Bottle 4 blue precipitate 29. The solution initially present in test tube III + M followed
by addition of FeCl3 gives blood red colouration. Then
22. Chemical formula of the white precipitate formed in M is
observation (I) is
(A) NaOCN
(A) CuCl 2 (B) PbCl 2
(B) NaCN
(C) PbCO 3 (D) CuCO 3 ⋅ Cu(OH)2
(C) Na 2S 2O3
23. Colourless solution present in Bottle 1 is (D) HgCl 2
(A) CuSO4 (B) HCl
(C) Pb(NO3 )2 (D) Na 2CO3 Passage 10: For Questions 30–33
24. Nature of gas evolved in observation (IV) is (I) A hot metal M burns in acidic gas A and produces
(A) acidic. (B) neutral. B and C.
(C) basic. (D) amphoteric. (II) B reacts with KMnO4 giving rise to brown ppt.
25. Chemical formula of the white precipitate formed in (III) C reacts with dil. H 2SO4, giving the same gas A.
observation (III) is (IV) C on heating produces E and F.
(A) PbCl 2 (B) PbCO3 (V) E reacts with dil. H 2SO4 releasing rotten egg’s smell.
(C) CuCO 3 ⋅ Cu(OH)2 (D) PbSO4 (VI) F reacts with Pb(NO3 )2 giving rise to white ppt.
which does not dissolve in dil. mineral acid but is
Passage 9: For Questions 26–29 soluble in (NH 4 )2 C 2O4.
A great scientist ‘Tom Cat’ collected six sample solu• 30. When the gas A is passed through strongly acidic
tions in six test tubes for a new discovery and tried solution of light green compound FeCl 2 , it gives the
for Nobel Prize (Chemistry). But his very close friend ppt. of
‘Jerry Mouse’ all of a sudden appeared in the laboratory (A) FeS (B) S
and kicked off AgNO3 bottle on all these samples and (C) FeS 2 (D) FeS + S
spoiled the experiments, making all white precipitates.
But ‘Tom Cat’ did not lose his enthusiasm and made the 31. E reacts with FeCl 2 solution and the precipitate
following observations from all the white precipitates obtained is
formed. (A) FeS (B) S
(C) FeS + S (D) Fe2S 3
Test tube Observations
(I) The ppt. is soluble on heating. 32. Analogous sodium compound of B on heating
2−
(II) The anion present in test tube II does not produces a polysulphide having the unit of S x ion.
give the brown ring test for nitrate if it is The value of x is
present with nitrate ion. (A) 2 (B) 3 (C) 5 (D) 6
(III) The ppt. becomes soluble on addition of excess
of solution that was present in test tube III but 33. White precipitate obtained in observation (VI) is
on heating it produces a black ppt. which does (A) 2 PbCO 3 ⋅ Pb(OH)2 (B) Pb(OH)2
not dissolve in NH 3 . (C) PbSO3 (D) PbSO4
(IV) The ppt. gives a clear solution with excess of
solution that was present in test tube IV and Passage 11: For Questions 34–36
that clear solution gives black metallic ppt. on
heating together with evolution of acidic gas A white crystalline solid A on boiling with caustic soda
which turns acidic K2Cr2O7 solution green. solution gives a gas B which on passing through an
(V) The aqueous suspension of ppt. produces black alkaline solution of potassium tetraiodomercurate (II)
metallic residue and an acidic gas on heating. solution gives a brown ppt. The substance A on heating
This gas does not turn K 2Cr2O7 solution green. evolves a neutral gas C which is called laughing gas.
(VI) The ppt. is soluble in NH 3 but does not give 34. The gas B is
chromyl chloride test. (A) H 2S (B) NH 3
26. In which of the observations, black ppt. is Ag 2S. (C) HCl (D) CO2
(A) IV (B) III 35. The gas C is
(C) V (D) None of these.
(A) N 2O (B) O2
27. White ppts. in I, IV and II are respectively (C) NO (D) O3
(A) Ag 2SO3 , HCO2 Ag, AgBr
36. The substance A is
(B) AgNO2 , HCO2 Ag, AgCl
(C) CH 3CO2 Ag, Ag 2SO3 , AgNO2 (A) NH 4Cl (B) NH 4 NO3
(D) HCO2 Ag, Ag 2CO3 , AgNO2 (C) NH 4 NO2 (D) NaNO3
_
@edubuzznotes
Assertion–Reasoning Type Questions 317
3. Statement I: The colour of acidic K 2Cr2O7 solution is 14. Statement I: ZnO (white) on heating becomes yellow
discharged by Na 2S or Na 2SO4 solution. in colour.
Statement II: The maximum and minimum oxidation Statement II: The formation of f•centres is observed
states possible for S atom are +VI and -II respectively. in hot ZnO which is also called metal excess defect.
4. Statement I: The aqueous suspension of Ag 2CO3 on 15. Statement I: The chlorides of Be2+ and Mg 2+ do not
heating does not set free metallic Ag. impart any colour to the fame test.
Statement II: The decomposition temperature of Ag 2O Statement II: The hydration energy of Be2+ is higher
is 300 °C, which cannot be achieved in aqueous medium. than that of Mg 2+ .
5. Statement I: The aqueous suspensions of Ag 2CO3 16. Statement I: The NH 4OH in the Group IV reagents
and Ag 2SO3 , on heating produce Ag 2O and Ag decreases the S 2− ion concentration.
respectively as precipitate. Statement II: NH 4OH is an auxiliary reagent and
Statement II: Ag 2O is a mild oxidizing agent which not a precipitating reagent.
can oxidize SO2 into SO2− 4 and itself is reduced to 17. Statement I: The salt of NH +4 on reaction with any
metallic Ag while similar reaction cannot take place alkali produces NH 3 .
with CO2 .
Statement II: OH − is a very strong base as compared
6. Statement I: To prepare soda extract, any carbonate to NH 3 .
other than Na 2CO3 cannot be used.
18. Statement I: In the solution of [Zn(OH)4 ]2− , the
Statement II: All sodium salts are soluble in water. gradual addition of dil. HCl initially produces white
7. Statement I: On addition of dil. H 2SO4 , S 2O23 − ion gives precipitate of Zn(OH)2 and on further addition of
white turbidity. dil. HCl the white precipitate gets dissolved.
Statement II: S–S linkage is weak enough due to Statement II: Zn(OH)2 is amphoteric in nature.
3dp - 3 pp bonding in S2O32- ion. 19. Statement I: CuSO4 on reaction with NaCN (excess)
8. Statement I: Chlorides of Hg(I) and Hg(II) do not produces soluble complex of [Cu(CN)4 ]2− .
respond to chromyl chloride test. Statement II: NaCN solution is slightly alkaline in
Statement II: Chlorides of Hg(I) and Hg(II) are both nature.
diamagnetic in nature. 20. Statement I: Hg 2+ ion reacts with KI solution to pro•
9. Statement I: The layer test of Br can be performed
− duce yellow coloured HgI 2 precipitate.
in the presence of Cl- Statement II: HgI 2 (red) and HgI 2 (yellow) both on
Statement II: The use of organic layer intensifes the reaction with excess KI produce soluble complex of
observation. [HgI 4 ]2− solution.
_
@edubuzznotes
318 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
21. Statement I: In the brown ring test of NO2− or NO3− , Statement II: On addition of more acid, dichromate
the FeSO4 solution must be freshly prepared. undergoes further polymerization.
Statement II: On exposure to sunlight, Fe2+ is 24. Statement I: In the Group V reagents, the function of
converted into Fe3+ which does not give the brown NH 4Cl is to decrease the concentration of CO2−
3
ions.
ring test. Statement II: This decrease in the concentration of
22. Statement I: In the Gries–Ilosvay test of NO2− ion, CO2−3 is due to the common ion effect of NH 4 .
+
AcOH (pH = 3 to 4) is enough to cause diazotiza• 25. Statement I: B(OMe)3 is more volatile than B(OH)3,
tion of sulphanillic acid. though its molecular weight is higher than that of
Statement II: Sulphanillic acid exists in zwitter ion B(OH)3.
form. Statement II: Massive hydrogen bonding is possible in
23. Statement I: An orange solution of dichromate turns B(OH)3 .
yellow on addition of more acid.
1. Match the reaction with the type of change. (B) S 2O32− (Q) Reduces [Cu(C 4 H 4O6 )2 ]2 −
to red precipitate on heating
Column I Column II
(C) SO2−
3
(R) Light green colouration with
(A) (NH 4 )2 Cr2O7 ∆
→ ( P) Disproportionation reaction FeCl3 solution is observed
(B) MnO24 − + H 2O → (Q) Green colour is associated fnally
(excess) with reactant or product (S) Produces violet precipitate
(C) H 2S + SO2
→ (R) Comproportionation with [Ni(en)3 ](NO3 )2
reaction
(D) 2 Br − + Cl 2
→ (S) At least one product has
zero oxidation state of the
respective element
_
@edubuzznotes
Answers 319
3. Match the change observed during analysis of the 6. Match the radical with the change observed on
radical. qualitative analysis.
Column I Column II Column I Column II
(A) Colourless gas is (P) S 2O32− (A) SO 2−
(P) Canary yellow precipitate
4
evolved on addition with ammonium molybdate.
of dil. H 2SO4 (B) NO3− (Q) Brown ring test with acetic acid.
(B ) Black precipitate is obtained (Q) S 2−
when Hg(NO3 )2 is added (C) NO2− (R) Yellow precipitate with
in little amount. Hg(NO3 )2 solution.
( C ) The precipitate obtained on (R) Cl − (D) PO3−
4
(S) Evolves NH 3 gas with
addition of AgNO3 produces (Zn + conc. NaOH).
the colourless soluble complex 7. Match the compound with the change observed on
of [(AgNH 3 )2 ]+ with NH 3 (S) CH 3CO2− qualitative analysis.
solution
Column I Column II
4. Match the change observed during the analysis of the
cation. (A) (NH 4 )2 CO3 (P) Forms brown ring on reaction
with FeSO4 and conc. H 2SO4
Column I Column II (B) Ag 2C 2O4 (Q) Leaves no residue on heating.
(A) Forms precipitate with NaOH (P) Fe2+ (C) Pb(NO3 )2 (R) Colourless acidic gas is
and NH 4OH which is insoluble in evolved on heating.
excess of both the reagents (D) NH 4 NO3 (T) Residue is obtained on heating.
(B) Coloured precipitate is formed with (Q) Hg 2+ (E) (NH 4 )2 Cr2O7
KI which is soluble in excess of
the reagent. 8. Match the cations with their properties.
(C) Forms precipitate with KCN, (R) Pb 2+
which is soluble in excess of the Column I Column II
reagent (A) Cu 2+ (P) The chloride acts as very strong
(D) Forms black precipitate with H 2S (S) Ag + reducing agent in the laboratory
which is soluble in hot and (B) Mn 2+ (Q) The corresponding sulphide
dil. HNO3 is black in colour
(C) Zn 2+ (R) Gives precipitate with NaOH
5. Match the change observed with the reaction.
which is soluble in excess of
Column I Column II NaOH
(D) Sn 2+ (S) Does not give precipitate with
(A) No change is observed. (P) CuSO4 + excess KI
Group I reagent in the group
(B) Brown precipitate/ (Q) Pb 3O4 + conc. HNO3
analysis
appearance
(C) Pale green colouration (R) FeCl 3 + H 2S
(D) White turbidity/ (S) ZnCl 2 + H 2S
precipitate
(T) MgCl 2 + Na 2SO4
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (A) 8. (D) 15. (D) 22. (C) 29. (B) 36. (D)
2. (C) 9. (D) 16. (B) 23. (D) 30. (A) 37. (B)
3. (C) 10. (B) 17. (C) 24. (C) 31. (A) 38. (A)
4. (C) 11. (C) 18. (A) 25. (A) 32. (D)
5. (C) 12. (D) 19. (A) 26. (A) 33. (C)
6. (B) 13. (B) 20. (D) 27. (B) 34. (B)
7. (C) 14. (B) 21. (C) 28. (D) 35. (D)
_
@edubuzznotes
320 Chapter 7 Qualitative Salt Analysis
8
Hydrogen and
the Hydrides
methane are mixed with steam and passed over a nickel catalyst at 800–900 °C. These hydrocarbons
are present in natural gas, and are also produced at oil refneries when ‘cracking’ hydrocarbons.
CH4 + H2O → CO + 3H2
CH4 + 2H2O → CO2 + 4H2
The gas emerging from the reformer contains CO, CO2, H2 and excess steam. The gas mixture is mixed
with more steam, cooled to 400 °C and passed into a shift converter. This contains an iron/copper
catalyst and CO is converted into CO2.
CO + H2O → CO2 + H2
Finally the CO2 is absorbed in a solution of K2CO3 or ethanolamine HOCH2CH2NH2. The K2CO3 or
ethanolamines are regenerated by heating.
K2CO3 + CO2 + H2O → 2KHCO3
2HOCH2CH2NH2 + CO2 + H2O → (HOCH2CH2NH3)2CO3
3. In oil refneries, natural hydrocarbon mixtures of high molecular weight such as naphtha and fuel oil
are ‘cracked’ to produce lower molecular weight hydrocarbons which can be used as petrol. Hydrogen
is a valuable by•product.
4. Very pure hydrogen (99.9% pure) is made by electrolysis of water or solutions of NaOH or KOH.
This is the most expensive method. Water does not conduct electricity very well, so it is usual to elec•
trolyse aqueous solutions of NaOH or KOH in a cell with nickel anodes and iron cathodes. The gases
produced in the anode and cathode compartments must be kept separate.
Anode 2OH − → H2O + 21 O 2 + 2e −
Cathode 2H2O + 2e − → 2OH − + H2
Overall H2O → H2 + 21 O 2
5. A large amount of pure hydrogen is also formed as a by•product from the chlor•alkali industry, in
which aqueous NaCl is electrolysed to produce NaOH, Cl2 and H2.
6. The usual laboratory preparation is the reaction of dilute acids with metals, or of an alkali with aluminium.
Zn + H2SO4 → ZnSO4 + H2
2Al + 2NaOH + 6H2O → 2Na[Al(OH)4] + 3H2
7. Hydrogen can be prepared by the reaction of salt•like hydrides with water.
LiH + H2O → LiOH + H2
Chemical properties
Hydrogen is not very reactive under normal conditions. The lack of reactivity is due to kinetics rather than
thermodynamics, and relates to the strength of the H—H bond. An essential step in H2 reacting with another
element is the breaking of the H—H bond to produce atoms of hydrogen. This requires 435.9 kJ mol-1:
hence there is high activation energy to such reactions. Consequently many reactions are slow, or require
high temperatures, or catalysts (often transition metals). Many important reactions of hydrogen involve
heterogeneous catalysis, where the catalyst frst reacts with H2 and either breaks or weakens the H—H
bond, and thus lowers the activation energy. Examples include:
1. The Haber process for the manufacture of NH3 from N2 and H2 using a catalyst of activated Fe at
380–450 °C and 200 atmospheres pressure.
_
@edubuzznotes
324 Chapter 8 Hydrogen and the Hydrides
2. The hydrogenation of a variety of unsaturated organic compounds, (including the hardening of oils),
using fnely divided Ni, Pd or Pt as catalysts.
3. The production of methanol by reducing CO with H2 over a Cu/Zn catalyst at 300 °C.
Thus hydrogen will react directly with most elements under the appropriate conditions.
Hydrogen burns in air or dioxygen, forming water, and liberates a large amount of energy. This is used
in the oxy•hydrogen fame for welding and cutting metals. Temperatures of almost 3000 °C can be attained.
Care should be taken with these gases since mixtures of H2 and O2 close to a 2:1 ratio are often explosive.
2H2 + O2 → 2H2O ΔH = –485 kJ mol-1
Hydrogen reacts with the halogens. The reaction with fuorine is violent, even at low temperatures. The reac•
tion with chlorine is slow in the dark, but the reaction is catalysed by light (photocatalysis), and becomes
faster in daylight, and explosive in sunlight. Direct combination of the elements is used to produce HCl.
H2 + F2 → 2HF
H2 + Cl2 → 2HCl
A number of metals react with H2, forming hydrides. The reactions are not violent, and usually require a
high temperature. These are described in a later section.
Large quantities of H2 are used in the industrial production of ammonia by the Haber process. The
reaction is reversible, and the formation of NH3 is favoured by high pressure, the presence of a catalyst (Fe),
and a low temperature. In practice a high temperature of 380–450 °C and a pressure of 200 atmospheres are
used to get a reasonable conversion in a reasonable time.
N 2 + 3H 2 ⇌ 2NH 3 DG298K = -33.4 kJ mol -1
Large amounts of H2 are used for hydrogenation reactions, in which hydrogen is added to a double bond
in an organic compound. An important example is the hardening of fats and oils. Unsaturated fatty acids
are hydrogenated with H2 and a palladium catalyst, forming saturated fatty acids which have higher melt•
ing points. By removing double bonds in the carbon chain in this way, edible oils which are liquid at room
temperature may be converted into fats which are solid at room temperature. The reason for doing this is
that solid fats are more useful than oils, for example in the manufacture of margarine.
CH3 ∙ (CH2)n ∙ CH —— CH ∙ COOH + H2 → CH3 ∙ (CH2)n ∙ CH2 ∙ CH2 ∙ COOH
Hydrogen is also used to reduce nitrobenzene to aniline (dyestuffs industry), and in the catalytic reduction
of benzene (the frst step in the production of nylon•66). It also reacts with CO to form methyl alcohol.
catalyst
CO + 2H2 ¾¾¾¾
Cu Zn
® CH3OH
The hydrogen molecule is very stable, and has little tendency to dissociate at normal temperatures, since
the dissociation reaction is highly endothermic.
H2 → 2H ΔH = 435.9 kJ mol-1
However, at high temperatures, in an electric arc, or under ultraviolet light, H2 does dissociate. The atomic
hydrogen produced exists for less than half a second, after which it recombines to give molecular hydrogen and
a large amount of heat. This reaction has been used in welding metals. Atomic hydrogen is a strong reducing
agent, and is commonly prepared in solution by means of a zinc–copper couple or a mercury–aluminium couple.
series and the space shuttle in the US space programme. Car engines have been modifed to run on hydro•
gen. Note that the use of hydrogen involves the risk of an explosion, but so does the use of petrol.
Protium water H2O dissociates to about three times the extent that heavy water D2O does. The equi•
librium constant for the dissociation of H2O is 1.0 × 10−14 whilst for D2O it is 3.0 × 10−15.
H2O H+ + OH−
D2O D+ + OD−
Protium bonds are broken more readily than deuterium bonds (up to 18 times more readily in some cases).
Thus when water is electrolysed, H2 is liberated much faster than D2, and the remaining water thus becomes
enriched in heavy water D2O. If the process is continued until only a small volume remains, then almost
pure D2O is obtained. About 29 000 litres of water must be electrolysed to give 1 litre of D2O that is 99%
pure. This is the normal way of separating deuterium. Heavy water D2O undergoes all of the reactions of
ordinary water, and is useful in the preparation of other deuterium compounds. Because D2O has a lower
dielectric constant, ionic compounds are less soluble in it than in water. Some physical properties of H2O
and D2O are compared in Table 8 .2.
_
@edubuzznotes
326 Chapter 8 Hydrogen and the Hydrides
Deuterium compounds are commonly prepared by ‘exchange’ reactions where under suitable condi•
tions deuterium is exchanged for hydrogen in compounds. Thus D2 reacts with H2 at high temperatures,
forming HD, and it also exchanges with NH3 and CH4 to give NH2D, NHD2, ND3 and CH3D to CD4. It is
usually easier to prepare deuterated compounds using D2O rather than D2. The D2O may be used directly
in the preparation instead of H2O, or exchange reactions may be carried out using D2O.
Exchange reactions
NaOH + D2O → NaOD + HDO
NH4Cl + D2O → NH3DCl + HDO
Mg3N2 + 3D2O → 2ND3 + 3MgO
Direct reactions
SO3 + D2O → D2SO4
P4O10 + 6D2O → 4D3PO4
8.8 | HYDRIDES
Binary compounds of the elements with hydrogen are called hydrides. The type of hydride which an element
forms depends on its electronegativity, and hence on the type of bond formed. Whilst there is not a sharp division
between ionic, covalent and metallic bonding, it is convenient to consider hydrides in three classes (Figure 8.2):
s-block p-block
Group
1 2 Intermediate Hydrides 13 14 15 16 17 18
Period
1
2 3Li 4Be d-block 5B 6C 7N 8O 9F
4 19K 20Ca 21Sc 22Ti 23V 24Cr 28Ni 29Cu 30Zn 31Ga 32Ge 33As 34Se 35Br
5 37Rb 38Sr 39Y 40Zr 41Nb 46Pd 48Cd 49In 50Sn 54Sb 52Te 53I
6 55Cs 56Ba 57La 72Hf 73Ta 80Hg 81Ti 82Pb 83Bi 84Po 85At
Metallic Hydrides
They are powerful reducing agents, especially at high temperatures, though their reactivity towards water
limits their usefulness.
2CO + NaH → H ∙ COONa + C
SiCl4 + 4NaH → SiH4 + 4NaCl
PbSO4 + 2CaH2 → PbS + 2Ca(OH)2
NaH has a number of uses as a reducing agent in synthetic chemistry. It is used to produce other important
hydrides, particularly lithium aluminium hydride Li[AlH4] and sodium borohydride Na[BH4], which have
important uses as reducing agents in both organic and inorganic syntheses.
4LiH + AlCl3 → Li[AlH4] + 3LiCl
4NaH + B(OCH3)3 → Na[BH4] + 3NaOCH3
Covalent hydrides
Hydrides of the p•block elements are covalent. This would be expected since there is only a small differ•
ence in electronegativity between these atoms and hydrogen. The compounds usually consist of discrete
covalent molecules, with only weak van der Waals forces holding the molecules together, and so they are
usually volatile, and have low melting and boiling points. They do not conduct electricity. The formula of
these hydrides is XHn or XH(8 – n) where n is the group number (according to the A/B convention of the
periodic table) to which X belongs. These hydrides are produced by a variety of synthetic methods:
1. A few, as shown in Figure 8.3, may be made by direct action.
3H2 + N2 → 2NH3 (high temperature and pressure + catalyst, Haber process)
2H2 + O2 → 2H2O (spark – explosive)
H2 + Cl2 → 2HCl (burn – preparation of pure HCl)
B C N O F
Al Si P S Cl
Ga Ge As Se Br
In Sn Sb Te I
Pb Bi Po
hydride is polymeric (AlH3)n. In these structures, hydrogen appears to be bonded to two or more atoms,
and this is explained in terms of multi•centre bonding.
In addition to the simple hydrides, the rest of the lighter elements except the halogens form polynuclear
hydrides. The tendency to do this is strongest with the elements C, N and O, and two or more of the non•metal
atoms are directly bonded to each other. The tendency is greatest with C which catenates (forms chains) of
several hundreds of atoms. These are grouped into three homologous series of aliphatic hydrocarbons, and
aromatic hydrocarbons based on benzene.
CH4, C2H6, C3H8, C4H10, … CnH2n + 2 (alkanes)
…
C2H4, C3H6, C4H8, CnH2n (alkenes)
C2H2, C3H4, C4H6, … CnH2n – 2 (alkynes)
C6H6 (aromatic)
The alkanes are saturated, but alkenes have double bonds, and alkynes have triple bonds. Si and Ge only
form saturated compounds, and the maximum chain length is Si10H22. The longest hydride chains formed by
other elements are Sn2H6, N2H4 and HN3, P3H5, As3H5, H2O2 and H2O3, and H2S2, H2S3, H2S4, H2S5 and H2S6.
The melting point and boiling point of water stand out in Table 8.3 as being much higher than the
others, but on closer examination the values for NH3 and HF also seem higher than would be expected in
their respective groups. This is due to hydrogen bonding, which is discussed later in this chapter.
Table 8 . 3 Melting and boiling points of some covalent hydrides
Compound m.p. ( °C) b.p. ( °C)
In many cases the compounds are nonstoichiometric, for example LaHn, TiHn and PdHn, where the
chemical composition is variable. Typical formulae are LaH2.87, YbH2.55, TiH1.8, ZrH1.9, VH1.6, NbH0.7 and
PdH0.7 . Such compounds were originally called interstitial hydrides, and it was thought that a varying
number of interstitial positions in the metal lattice could be flled by hydrogen.
The nonstoichiometric compounds may be regarded as solid solutions. Metals which can ‘dissolve’ vary•
ing amounts of hydrogen in this way can act as catalysts for hydrogenation reactions. The catalysts are
thought to be effective through providing H atoms rather than H2 molecules. It is not certain whether the
hydrogen is present in the interstitial sites as atoms of hydrogen, or alternatively as H+ ions with delocalized
electrons, but they have strongly reducing properties.
Even small amounts of hydrogen dissolved in a metal adversely affect its strength and make it brittle.
Titanium is extracted by reducing TiCl4 with Mg or Na in an inert atmosphere. If an atmosphere of H2 is
used, the Ti dissolves H2, and is brittle. Titanium is used to make supersonic aircraft, and since strength is
important, it is produced in an atmosphere of argon.
Intermediate hydrides
A few hydrides do not ft easily into the above classifcation. Thus (BeH2)n is polymeric, and is thought to be a
chain polymer with hydrogen bridges. MgH2 has properties in between those of ionic and covalent hydrides.
CuH, ZnH2, CdH2 and HgH2 have properties intermediate between metallic and covalent hydrides.
They are probably electron defcient like (AlH3)n.
+
CH3 CH3
CH3 CH3
Strong evidence for hydrogen bonding comes from structural studies. Examples include ice, (determined
both by X•ray and neutron diffraction), the dimeric structure of formic acid (determined in the gas phase
by electron diffraction), X•ray structures of the solids like sodium hydrogen carbonate and boric acid
(Figure 8.5), and many others.
O O
H B H
O O
O
B H H B
O O O O
H H
H H
O O O O
H B H
H B H
O O O
O O
B H H B H H B
O O O O O O
(a) (b)
Figure 8.5 Hydrogen bonded structures. (a) Ice. (From Pauling, L., The Nature of the Chemical Bond,
3rd ed., pp. 449–504, Cornell University Press. Ithaca. 1960.) (b) A layer of crystalline H3BO3.
There are two types of hydrogen bonding, intermolecular and intramolecular and these are discussed as
follows along with their impact on properties of compounds.
H H H
R R R
Figure 8.6 Examples of intermolecular hydrogen bonding between
same molecules.
_
@edubuzznotes
332 Chapter 8 Hydrogen and the Hydrides
Dimerization of carboxylic acid is also an example of intermolecular hydrogen bonding (Figure 8.7).
d(+) d(-)
O H O
R C C R {R = H, CH3 ... etc.}
O H O
d(-) d(+)
Figure 8.7 Carboxylic acid dimer.
100 H 2O
100
50 50
HF
H2Te H2O
0 0
HI
NH3
H2Se SbH3
Melting points (°C)
Boiling points (°C)
H2Te
−50 Br SnH4 −50 H2Se HI
H
H2S AsH3 NH3
HCl HF SbH3
GeH4 H2S
PH3 HBr
−100 −100
SiH4
HCl AsH3
PH3
−150 −150 SnH4
CH4
GeH4
SiH4
CH4
−200 −200
−250 −250
2 3 4 5 2 3 4 5
Period Period
(a) (b)
Figure 8.8 (a) Boiling points of hydrides. (b) Melting points of hydrides.(c) Enthalpies of vaporization of
hydrides. (Adapted from Lagowski, J.J., Modern Inorganic Chemistry, Marcel Dekker, New York, p. 174.)
_
@edubuzznotes
8.10 Hydrogen Bonding 333
H2O
40
HF
NH3 H2Te
H2S H2Se
SbH3
AsH3 HI
20 HCl SnH4
PH3 HBr
GeH4
SiH4
10
CH4
0
2 3 4 5
Period
(c)
b. In much the same way the boiling point of NH3 is much higher than would be expected by com•
parison with PH3, AsH3 and SbH3, and similarly HF boils much higher than HCl, HBr and HI.
The reason for the higher than expected boiling points is hydrogen bonding. Note that the boiling
points of the Group 14 hydrides CH4, SiH4, GeH4 and SnH4 change smoothly, as they do not involve
hydrogen bonding. The hydrogen bonds in HF link the F atom of one molecule with the H atom
of another molecule, thus forming a zig•zag chain (HF)n in both the liquid and also in the solid
(Figure 8.9).
F F F F F
H H H H H H H H H H
H
F F F F F F
2. Replacement of hydrogen with alkyl groups in the compounds that undergo hydrogen bonding reduces
their boiling point. For example,
a. H2O : 100 °C; CH3OH: 63 °C ; CH3OCH3 :−5 °C
b. Me2NH : 7 °C ; Me3N : 4 °C
c. H2SO4 : 340 °C (decomposition); Me2SO4 : 188 °C
d. H3PO4 : 212 °C (decomposition); Me3PO4 : 193 °C
e. H3BO3 : 187 °C (decomposition); Me3BO3 : 65 °C
f. HF : 20 °C; CH3F : −78 °C
g. HN3 : 37 °C; CH3N3 : 20 °C
3. NH2CONH2 (urea) is a solid while CH3COCH3 (acetone) is liquid at room temperature due to more
effective intermolecular hydrogen bonding in the former.
4. According to the molecular weight comparison with BF3 (gas), B(OH)3 is expected to be gas but it is
solid due to massive intermolecular hydrogen bonding. In B(OH)3, on substitution with alkyl groups,
though molecular weight increases yet hydrogen bonding interaction dominates over van der Waal’s
forces of attraction.
5. The change in molar entropy of vapourization is more for liquids containing hydrogen bonding as
compared to the liquids that lacks hydrogen bonding. This is because hydrogen•bonded liquids under
go greater disorderliness on vapourization (Table 8.4).
*HF has very strong intermolecular hydrogen bonding but on vapourization, all hydrogen bonds do not break and exist
in the form of (HF)2 to (HF)6 . Hence the number of molecules produced in vapour is suffciently less as compared to
H2O or NH3 and therefore it has exceptionally low value of ΔSvap or randomness.
O
F Cl H
H H
N+ O-
O O
O
o-Fluorophenol o-Chlorophenol o-Nitrophenol
H
O O
Cl O
H H
Cl C C H
C O C O H
Cl O
H O
H
Salicylaldehyde Salicylic acid Chloral hydrate
Note: o•Chlorophenol and chloral hydrate are the examples in which chlorine atoms form hydrogern
bonding. It generally does not form H•bonding due to its low charge density.
Effect of intramolecular hydrogen bonding on physical and chemical properties
1. Acidity: The acidity of an acid depends upon the relative stabilities of the acid and its conjugate base. If
the intramolecular H•bonding stabilizes the conjugate acid through chelation, then acidity of the acid
decreases. For example
a. The formation of an intramolecular hydrogen bond in o•nitrophenol reduces its acidity compared
with m•nitrophenol and p•nitrophenol, where the formation of a hydrogen bond is not possible
(Figure 8.11).
O O
N
O O
O O N C
N H HC CH
C
C O HC CH HC CH
HC C C
HC C
HC CH C O O
C H
H H H
C H C C
H H H
C O Ka1 (-H+) C O- -Ka2 (-H ) + C O-
d(-) H H
⇀
↽ ⇀
↽
C O d(+) C O d(+) C O-
H C H C H C
O O O
More stable Does not form
Maleic acid due to ion-dipole easily to give up
interaction the acquired
stability
H O O
H C H H C H C
C O C O− C O−
Ka1 (−H+) Ka2 (−H+)
O C ⇀
↽ HO C ⇀
↽ O− C
H C H C H C H
O O O
Fumeric acid No such stability Forms easily
through H-bonding
2. Melting and boiling points: Intramolecular hydrogen bonding affects both the melting and boiling
points of ortho and para isomers of compounds. In case of ortho isomer, the interacting group is
close to each other and that leads to the formation of intramolecular hydrogen bonding preferably
and no intermolecular association occurs. Thus, the ortho isomer remains as monomer in the liquid
state and weak van der Waal’s forces act among the monomeric molecules. While the meta and para
isomers undergo intermolecular hydrogen bonding due to which the attraction between the molecules
becomes high and they have much higher melting point and boiling points compared to that of ortho
isomer (Figure 8.15). For example,
O H
a. O
O H
H
C O
C
H C
H O
H O
m. p. 7 °C 107 °C 116 °C
b. p. 196 °C 240 °C -
O H
O
b.
H
O
H
OH
m. p. 105 °C 171 °C
b. p. - -
c. H
O
HO OH
O H
OH
OH
m. p. 140 °C 219 °C
b. p. - -
3. Isomeric distribution: Intramolecular hydrogen bonding also affects the isomeric distribution in equi-
librium since it provides more stability through chelation (Figure 8.16).
a.
H H
N C N C
H N N H
O O
anti or trans syn or cis
b. CH3 H3C
C O C O
H2C
HC H
C O
H3C C O
CH3
4. Solubility: Intramolecular hydrogen bonding also affects the solubility which is less for ortho-isomer
due to less solvent-solute interaction. For example, ortho-nitrophenol is less soluble in water compared
to meta- and para-nitrophenol.
5. Viscosity: Isomeric compounds having intramolecular hydrogen bonding have lower value of surface
tension and viscosity in comparison to compounds having intermolecular hydrogen bonding. This is
because both of these two properties are directly proportional to the type of bonding. Viscosities of
some compounds are given in Table 8.5 which clearly indicate that larger the scope of intermolecular
association larger will be its viscosity.
H H H
29.5 kJ mol−1 25 kJ mol−1 15 kJ mol−1
The accumulated negative charge on oxygen atom in H2O is more as compared to that in H2O2.
_
@edubuzznotes
338 Chapter 8 Hydrogen and the Hydrides
a. The extent of hydrogen bonding in H2O2 is more than in H2O due to availability of greater number of
sites per molecule (Figure 8.17)
d(+)
H ..
.. H O
..
..
O
H
O d(+) H
..
..
Six sites are available per molecule Four sites are available per molecule
b. Ethanol is less viscous as compared to glycerol (or glycerine). This is because ethanol can form
maximum three hydrogen bonds per molecule while glycerol can form a maximum of nine hydrogen
bonds per molecule (Figure 8.18).
..
CH2 O
.. H
.. ..
CH O
..
CH3 CH2 O
.. H ,
CH2 H
b. H C N: H C N:
c. H CH2 C N: H CH2 C N
R
d. H C C H O C
R
2. Hydrogen atom can also be attracted by π•electron cloud in some compounds and this is known as
π•hydrogen bond. For example,
H O
a. H H b. H O
CH2
C C CH2
H CH2 CH2
CH2
_
@edubuzznotes
Single Correct Choice Type Questions 339
3. Hydrogen bonding may also be formed through ion•dipole interaction which is suffciently stronger as
compared to hydrogen bond formed by dipole•dipole interaction. For example,
a. In K + HF2-, hydrogen and fuoride ions are held through ion•dipole interaction.
d (+) d (-)
F⋯ H - F : 165 kJmol•1
b. In NaHCO3, HCO3- ions are attracted to each other by hydrogen bond through ion•dipole
interaction.
_
O O O O
C H C H C H : 154 kJ mol-1
_ _
O O O O O
Na+
1. Which of the following representation of hydrogen 3. Which of the following properties of hydrogen atom
bonding is(are) incorrect? are similar to those of halogens?
CH3 (A) Formation of H+ like X+.
(B) Formation of H− like X−.
_
(A) H3C N+ O H (C) Formation of H2 like X2.
(D) None of these.
CH3 CH3 4. Which of the following processes can be used for
preparation of H 2 gas?
H O
(A) Dissolving LiH in water.
B (B) Reaction of Al with NaOH solution.
(B)
O O (C) Reaction of Zn with dilute H 2SO4 .
H (D) Electrolysis of H 2O in the presence of KOH.
H
5. Which of the following properties of metallic hydrides
H are similar to those of their parent metal?
(C) CH3 C O H C CH2 OH
(A) Hardness
(B) Metallic lustre
H 3C H (C) Electrical conductivity
(D) Magnetic property
OH H
6. Which of the following statements is correct regarding
(D) HO P H O H the conversion of metal into metallic hydride?
(A) The density of metallic hydride is less than that of
O
parent metal.
2. Hydrogen atom may attain stability by (B) The crystal lattice expands through the inclusion
(A) forming an electron pair (covalent) bond with of hydride.
another atom. (C) A solid piece of a metal turns into powdered hydride.
(B) losing an electron to form H+. (D) None of these.
(C) gaining an electron to form H−.
(D) None of these.
(D) T2O > H 2O > D2O : Equilibrium constant for 6. Choose the incorrect statement.
dissociation (A) Ortho hydrogen has protons of parallel spin.
(B) Ortho hydrogen is adsorbed more readily than
Passage 2: For Questions 4–6 para hydrogen by metal surface.
(C) Both (A) and (B) are correct.
Ortho hydrogen (o•H2) and para hydrogen (p•H2) have
(D) Neither (A) nor (B) is correct.
different energy contents and are related by the equilib•
rium relation.
_
@edubuzznotes
Assertion–Reasoning Type Questions 341
Temperature (T )
Passage 3: For Questions 7–9
(B)
Water on cooling to 0 °C becomes ice. The main reason
for this conversion is the hydrogen bonding.
Density
7. Which of the following statements is correct?
(A) In ice, the hydrogen bonded H atoms are at equal rice/rwater
distance from the other two covalently bonded
H atoms around each O atom due to resonance.
(B) In ice, the hydrogen bonded H atoms are at longer
distance as compared to the other two covalently 0 °C 4 °C 100 °C
bonded H atoms around each O atom. Temperature (T )
(C) In ice, the hydrogen bonded H atoms are at
shorter distance as compared to the other two (C)
covalently bonded H atoms around each O atom.
(D) None of these.
Density
8. Two ice cubes when pressed against each other join rwater
together. This kind of joining phenomenon occurs rice
(A) just during pressing.
(B) after pressing when the pressure is released.
(C) during the whole process of pressing and releas•
0 °C 4 °C 100 °C
ing pressure.
Temperature (T )
(D) Cannot be predicted.
9. Which of the following curves is the correct represen• (D)
tation of the density vs. temperature plot for water? Density
(A) rwater
rice
Density
rwater
rice 0 °C 4 °C 100 °C
Temperature (T )
0 °C 4 °C 100 °C
Temperature (T )
Statement II: Van der Waal’s forces of attraction are Statement II: The polarity of O H bond is more than
more in D2 than in H2. that of the N H bond.
7. Statement I: Ti is prepared in an atmosphere of 10. Statement I: The heat of vapourization of HF is
Argon not H2. higher than that of H 2O.
Statement II: Ti dissolves H2 and becomes brittle.
Statement II: The hydrogen bond strength in HF is
8. Statement I: Trimethyl ammonium hydroxide higher than that in H 2O.
(compound A) is a weaker base compared to tetrame• 11. Statement I: Boric acid is slippery in nature.
thyl ammonium hydroxide (compound B).
Statement II: Boric acid is monobasic in water.
Statement II: The release of OH-from (compound B)
is faster than that from (compound A) due to presence 12. Statement I: CsCl (solid) can absorb HCl vapour
of hydrogen bonding in (compound A) and absence of while NaCl (solid) cannot do so.
such bonding in (compound B). Statement II: Absorbing HCl vapour, CsCl forms
Cs + [HCl 2 ]− through hydrogen bond.
9. Statement I: The correct presentation of exist•
H 13. Statement I: Glycerol is more viscous than ethanol.
Statement II: Intermolecular hydrogen bonding is
ence of NH 3 in water is H N H O not
present in glycerol molecule.
H H
H N H O H.
H H
The answer to each of the following questions is a non• 4. The number of protons that can be accepted by hydra•
negative integer. zine is___________.
1. The total number of neutrons present in D2O18 mol• 5. The number of moieties available for H•bonding in
ecule is ___________. one molecule of H 2SO4 is ___________.
2. The mass number of the element obtained when
tritium undergoes b•decay is ___________.
3. The number of compounds among the following,
which are monobasic in nature is ___________.
H 3 PO3 , H 3 PO2 , HClO4 , HNO2 , H 2CO3
In each of the following questions, statements are given in two columns, which have to be matched. The statements in
Column I are labelled as (A), (B), (C) and (D), while those in Column II are labelled as (P), (Q), (R), (S) and (T). Any
given statement in Column I can have correct matching with one or more statements in Column II.
1. Match the metal hydrides with their properties. 2. Match the compounds with type of hydrogen bond.
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (D) 4. (A) 7. (B) 10. (D)
2. (C) 5. (D) 8. (A) 11. (D)
3. (A) 6. (B) 9. (D) 12. (B)
9
The s-Block
Node
Elements and 1s 2s
Nodes
their Compounds
Contents
Group 1 – The Alkali Metals 3s
9.1 General Properties
9.2 Structures of the Metals, Hardness and
The s orbitals become larger
Cohesive Energy as the principal quantum
9.3 Flame Colours and Spectra number, n, becomes larger.
9.4 Colour of Compounds
9.5 Chemical Properties
9.6 Oxides, Hydroxides, Peroxides and Group 2 – The Alkaline Earth Elements
Superoxides 9.21 General Properties
9.7 Sulphides 9.22 Anomalous Behaviour of Beryllium
9.8 Oxosalts – Carbonates, Bicarbonates, 9.23 Chemical Properties
Nitrates, Nitrites and Sulphates 9.24 Hydroxides
9.9 Halides and Polyhalides 9.25 Hardness of Water
9.10 Hydrides 9.26 Reaction with Acids and Bases
9.11 Solubility and Hydration 9.27 Oxides and Peroxides
9.12 Solutions of Metals in Liquid Ammonia 9.28 Sulphates
9.13 Compounds with Carbon 9.29 Nitrates
9.14 Complexes, Crowns and Crypts 9.30 Hydrides
9.15 Biological Importance 9.31 Halides
9.16 Differences between Lithium and the Other 9.32 Nitrides
Group 1 Elements 9.33 Carbides
9.17 Preparation of Sodium Hydroxide 9.34 Complexes
9.18 Electrolytic Processes 9.35 Biological Role of Mg2+ and Ca2+
9.19 Preparation of Sodium Carbonate 9.36 Differences between Beryllium and the
9.20 The Solvay (or Ammonia – Soda) Process Other Group 2 Elements
_
@edubuzznotes
346 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
Density
The atoms are large, so Group 1 elements have remarkably low densities. Lithium metal is only about
half as dense as water, whilst sodium and potassium are slightly less dense than water (see Table 9.2).
_
@edubuzznotes
9.1 General Properties 347
Ionization energy
The frst ionization energies for the atoms in this group are appreciably lower than those for any other
group in the periodic table. The atoms are very large so the outer electrons are only held weakly by the
nucleus: hence the amount of energy needed to remove the outer electron is not very large. On descending
the group from Li to Na to K to Rb to Cs, the size of the atoms increases: the outermost electrons become
less strongly held, so the ionization energy decreases.
The second ionization energy – that is the energy to remove a second electron from the atoms – is
extremely high. The second ionization energy is always larger than the frst, often by a factor of two,
because it involves removing an electron from a smaller positive ion, rather than from a larger neutral
atom. The difference between frst and second ionization energies is much larger in this case since in addi•
tion it corresponds to removing an electron from a closed shell. A second electron is never removed under
normal conditions, as the energy required is greater than that needed to ionize the noble gases. The ele•
ments commonly form M+ ions. The frst and second ionization energies for Group elements is given in
Table 9.3.
Na electronegativity 0.9
Cl electronegativity 3.0
Electronegativity difference 2.1
An electronegativity difference of approximately 1.7–1.8 corresponds to 50% ionic character. The value
2.1 exceeds this, so the bonding in NaCl is predominantly ionic. Similar arguments apply to other com•
pounds: for example, the electronegativity difference in LiF is 3.0, and in KBr is 2.0, and both compounds
are ionic. The chemistry of the alkali metals is largely that of their ions.
_
@edubuzznotes
348 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
9.4 Colour of Compounds 349
For Group 1 metals, the energy emitted appears as visible light, thus giving the characteristic fame
colourations (Table 9.7).
The colour actually arises from electronic transitions in short•lived species which are formed
momentarily in the fame. The fame is rich in electrons, and in the case of sodium the ions are tempo•
rarily reduced to atoms.
Na+ + e → Na
The sodium D•line (which is actually a doublet at 589.0 nm and 589.6 nm) arises from the electronic transi•
tion 3s1 → 3p1 in sodium atoms formed in the fame. The colours from different elements do not all arise
from the same transition, or from the same species. Thus the red line for lithium arises from a short•lived
LiOH species formed in the fame.
high energy, will appear in the ultraviolet region rather than in the visible region, and will be invisible to the
human eye. Compounds of Group 1 metals are typically white, except those where the anion is coloured,
for example sodium chromate Na2[CrO4] (yellow), potassium dichromate K2[Cr2O7] (orange), and potas•
sium permanganate K[MnO4] (deep purple). In these cases the colour comes from the anions [CrO4]2−,
[Cr2O7]2− or [MnO4]− and not from the Group 1 metal ion.
When Group 1 elements form compounds (usually ionic, but there are a few covalent compounds), all
the electrons are paired. Because of this Group 1 compounds are diamagnetic. There is one notable exception
– the superoxides, which are discussed in Section 9.6.
The standard electrode potentials E° (in volts) are Li+|Li = −3.05 Na+|Na = −2.71, K+|K = −2.93, Rb+|Rb
= −2.92, Cs+|Cs = −2.92. Lithium has the most negative standard electrode potential of any element in the
periodic table, largely because of its high hydration energy. Standard electrode potentials E° and Gibbs free
energy ∆G are related by the equation:
_
@edubuzznotes
9.6 Oxides, Hydroxides, Peroxides and Superoxides 351
ΔG = −nFE°
where n is the number of electrons removed from the metal to produce the ion, and F is the Faraday constant.
The reaction Li+ + e → Li has the largest negative E° value, and hence the largest positive ∆G value.
Thus the reaction does not occur. However, the reverse reaction Li → Li+ + e has a large negative value
of ∆G, so lithium liberates more energy than the other metals when it reacts with water. In view of this it
is at frst sight rather surprising that lithium reacts gently with water, whereas potassium, which liberates
less energy, reacts violently and catches fre. The explanation lies in the kinetics (that is the rate at which
the reaction proceeds), rather than in the thermodynamics (that is the total amount of energy liberated).
Potassium has a low melting point, and the heat of reaction is suffcient to make it melt, or even vaporize.
The molten metal spreads out, and exposes a larger surface to the water, so it reacts even faster, gets even
hotter and catches fre.
Hydroxides
Sodium hydroxide NaOH is often called caustic soda, and potassium hydroxide is called caustic potash,
because of their corrosive properties (for example on glass or on skin). These caustic alkalis are the stron•
gest bases known in aqueous solution. The hydroxides of Na, K, Rb and Cs are very soluble in water, but
LiOH is much less soluble (see Table 9.9). At 25 °C a saturated solution of NaOH is about 27 molar, whilst
saturated LiOH is only about 5 molar.
_
@edubuzznotes
352 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
The bases react with acids to form salts and water, and are used for many neutralizations.
NaOH + HCl → NaCl + H2O
The bases also react with CO2, even traces in the air, forming the carbonate. LiOH is used to absorb carbon
dioxide in closed environments such as space capsules (where its light weight is an advantage in reducing
the launching weight).
2NaOH + CO2 → Na2CO3 + H2O
They also react with the amphoteric oxides, Al2O3 forming aluminates, SiO2 (or glass) forming silicates,
SnO2 forming stannates, PbO2 forming plumbates and ZnO forming zincates.
The bases liberate ammonia from both ammonium salts and coordination complexes where ammonia
is attached to a transition rnetal ion (ammine complexes).
NaOH + NH4Cl → NH3 + NaCl + H2O
6 NaOH + 2[Co(NH 3 )6 ]Cl 3 → 12 NH 3 + Co 2 O3 + 3NaCl + 3H 2 O
Hexammine•
cobalt (III) chloride
NaOH reacts with H2S to form sulphides S2−, and hydrogen sulphides SH−, and it is used to remove
mercaptans from petroleum products.
NaOH + H2S → NaSH → Na2S
The hydroxides react with alcohols, forming alkoxides.
NaOH + EtOH → NaOEt + H2O
sodium ethoxide
KOH resembles NaOH in all its reactions, but as KOH is much more expensive it is seldom used. However,
KOH is much more soluble in alcohol, thus producing OC 2 H 5− ions by the equilibrium
C 2 H 5OH + OH − ↽
OC 2 H 5 + H 2 O
⇀
−
This accounts for the use of alcoholic KOH in organic chemistry. Group 1 hydroxides are thermally stable,
illustrating the strong electropositive nature of the metals. On heating, many hydroxides decompose, losing
water and forming the oxide.
liquids. Because it reacts with CO2 in the air it has been used to purify the air in submarines and confned
spaces, as it both removes CO2 and produces O2. Potassium superoxide KO2 is even better for this purpose.
Some typical reactions are:
Na2O2 + Al → Al2O3
Na 2 O2 + Cr 3 + → CrO24
−
Na2O2 + CO → Na2CO3
2Na2O2 + 2CO2 → Na2CO3 + O2
The industrial process for forming sodium peroxide is a two•stage reaction in the presence of excess air:
2Na + 21 O2 → Na 2 O
Na 2 O + 21 O2 → Na 2 O2
The superoxides contain the ion [O2]−, which has an unpaired electron, and hence they are paramag•
netic and are all coloured (LiO2 and NaO2 yellow, KO2 orange, RbO2 brown and CsO2 orange).
Superoxides are even stronger oxidizing agents than peroxides, and give both H2O2 and O2 with either
water or acids.
KO2 + 2H2O → KOH + H2O2 + 21 O2
KO2 is used in space capsules, submarines, and breathing masks, because it both produces dioxygen and
removes carbon dioxide. Both functions are important in life support systems.
4KO2 +2CO2 → 2K2CO3 + 3O2
more CO
4KO2 + 2CO2 + 2H 2 O
2
→ 2KHCO3 + 3O2
Sodium superoxide cannot be prepared by burning the metal in dioxygen at atmospheric pressure, but
it is made commercially and in good yields by reacting sodium peroxide with dioxygen at a high tempera•
ture and pressure (450 °C and 300 atmospheres) in a stainless steel bomb.
Na2O2 + O2 → 2NaO2
9.7 | SULPHIDES
The metals all react with sulphur, forming sulphides such as Na2S, and polysulphides Na2Sn where n = 2, 3,
4, 5 or 6. The polysulphide ions are made from zig•zag chains of sulphur atoms.
S S S− S S S S S−
−S S− −S S −S S S− −S S S
Sodium sulphide can also be made by heating sodium sulphate with carbon, or by passing H2S into NaOH
solution.
Na2SO4 + 4C → Na2S + 4CO
NaOH + H2S → NaHS + H2O
NaOH + NaHS → Na2S + H2O
Group 1 sulphides hydrolyse appreciably in water, giving strongly alkaline solutions:
Na2S + H2O → NaSH + NaOH
Na2S is used to make organic sulphur dyestuffs, and in the leather industry to remove hair from hides.
Na2S is readily oxidized by air to form sodium thiosulphate, which is used in photography to dissolve silver
halides, and as a laboratory reagent for iodine titrations.
2Na2S + 2O2 + H2O → Na2S2O3 + 2NaOH
2Na2S2O3 + I2 → Na2S4O6 + 2NaI
_
@edubuzznotes
354 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
C H C H C H
−O O O− O
O
Infinite anion chain in NaHCO3
2−
O H O
O C C O
O H O
Lithium is exceptional in that it does not form solid bicarbonate, though LiHCO3 can exist in solution. All
the carbonates and bicarbonates are soluble in water except NaHCO3 and Li2CO3.
Commercially Li2CO3 is added as an impurity to Al2O3 to lower its melting point in the extraction of
aluminium by electrolysis. Na2CO3 is used as washing soda to soften water in hard water areas. NaHCO3 is
used in baking powder and in fre extinguishers. NaHCO3 can be used on its own to make cakes or bread
‘rise’ since it decomposes between 50 °C and 100 °C, giving bubbles of CO2.
gentle heat
2NaHCO3
→ Na 2 CO3 + H 2 O + CO2
Baking powder is more commonly used, and contains NaHCO3, Ca(H2PO4)2 and starch. The Ca(H2PO4)2 is
acidic and when moistened it reacts with NaHCO3, giving CO2. The starch is a fller. An improved ‘combina•
tion baking powder’ contains about 40% starch, 30% NaHCO3, 20% NaAl(SO4)2 and 10% Ca(H2PO4)2. The
NaAl(SO4)2 slows the reaction down so the CO2 is given off more slowly.
The nitrates can all be prepared by the action of HNO3 on the corresponding carbonate or hydroxide,
and they are all very soluble in water. LiNO3 is used for freworks and red•coloured distress fares. Large
deposits of NaNO3 are found in Chile, and are used as a nitrogenous fertilizer. Solid LiNO3 and NaNO3
are deliquescent, and because of this KNO3 is used in preference to NaNO3 in gunpowder (gunpowder is
a mixture of KNO3, sulphur and charcoal). KNO3 is usually obtained from synthetic nitric acid and K2CO3,
but at one time it was made from NaNO3:
500 °C
2 NaNO3 ↽
2 NaNO2 + O2
⇀
800 °C
4 NaNO3 ↽
2 Na 2 O + 5O2 + 2N 2
⇀
Nitrites are important in the manufacture of organonitrogen compounds, the most important being the
azo dyes. Small amounts of NaNO2 are used in molten salt baths with NaNO3, and some is used as a food
preservative. Nitrites are easily recognized in the laboratory, because on treatment with dilute acids they
produce brown fumes of NO2.
2NaNO2 + 2HCl → 2NaCl2 + H2O + NO2 + NO
2NO + O2 → 2NO2
NaNO2 is manufactured by absorbing oxides of nitrogen in Na2CO3 solution.
Na2CO3 + NO2 + NO → 2NaNO2 + CO2
They can also be made by thermal decomposition of nitrates and the chemical reduction of nitrates:
2NaNO3 + C → 2NaNO2 + CO2
KNO3 + Zn → KNO2 + ZnO
or by reacting NO with a hydroxide.
2KOH + 4NO → 2KNO2 + N2O + H2O
4KOH + 6NO → 4KNO2 + N2 + 2H2O
About 55% of sodium sulphate is made synthetically, as a by•product from the manufacture of HCl, and
also from many neutralization processes that use H2SO4. About 45%, mainly Glauber’s salt Na2SO4 · 10H2O,
is mined.
The major use of Na2SO4 – some 70% – is in the paper industry, and about 10% is used in detergents,
and 10% in glass manufacture. In the Kraft paper making process, a strong alkaline solution of Na2SO4 is
used to dissolve the lignin that holds the cellulose fbres together in wood chips. The cellulose fbres are
then turned into corrugated cardboard and brown paper.
9.10 | HYDRIDES
Group 1 metals all react with hydrogen, forming ionic or salt•like hydrides M+H−. However, the ease with
which they do so decreases from lithium to caesium. These hydrides contain the H− ion (which is not
commonly found, since hydrogen usually forms H+ ions). It can be proved that H− ions exist because on
electrolysis hydrogen is liberated at the anode.
The hydrides react with water, liberating hydrogen, and lithium hydride is used as a source of hydrogen
for military purposes and for flling meteorological balloons.
LiH + H2O → LiOH + H2
Lithium also forms a complex hydride Li[AlH4], called lithium aluminium hydride, which is a useful reducing
agent. It is made from lithium hydride in dry ether solution.
4LiH + AlCl3 → Li[AlH4] + 3LiCl
_
@edubuzznotes
356 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
Lithium aluminium hydride is ionic, and the [AlH4]− ion is tetrahedral. Li[AlH4] is a powerful reducing
agent and is widely used in organic chemistry, as it reduces carbonyl compounds to alcohols. It reacts
violently with water, so it is necessary to use absolutely dry organic solvents, for example ether which has
been dried over sodium. Li[AlH4] will also reduce a number of inorganic compounds.
BCl3 + Li[AlH4] → B2H6 diborane
PCl3 + Li[AlH4] → PH3 phosphine
SiCl4 + Li[AlH4] → SiH4 silane
Sodium tetrahydridoborate (sodium borohydride) Na[BH4] is another hydride complex. It is ionic,
comprising tetrahedral [BH4]− ions. It is best obtained by heating sodium hydride with trimethyl borate:
230 − 270 °C
4 NaH + B(OCH 3 )3
→ Na[BH 4 ] + 3NaOCH 3
Other tetrahydridoborates of Group 1 and 2 metals can be made from sodium salts. These tetrahydridobo•
rates are used as reducing agents, and the alkali metal compounds (particularly those of Na and K) are
becoming increasingly used as they are much less sensitive to water than Li[AlH4]. Thus Na[BH4] can be
crystallized from cold water, and K[BH4] from hot water, so they have the advantage that they can be used
in aqueous solutions. The others react with water.
[ BH 4 ]− + 2H 2O → BO2− + 4H 2
9.11 | SOLUBILITY AND HYDRATION
All the simple salts dissolve in water, producing ions, and consequently the solutions conduct electricity.
Since Li+ ions are small, it might be expected that solutions of lithium salts would conduct electricity better
than solutions of the same concentration of sodium, potassium, rubidium or caesium salts. The small ions
should migrate more easily towards the cathode, and thus conduct more than the larger ions. However,
ionic mobility or conductivity measurements in aqueous solution (Table 9.10) give results in the opposite
order Cs+ > Rb+ > K+ > Na+ > Li+. The reason for this apparent anomaly is that the ions are hydrated in
solution. Since Li+ is very small, it is heavily hydrated. This makes the radius of the hydrated ion large, and
hence it moves only slowly. In contrast, Cs+ is the least hydrated, and the radius of the hydrated Cs+ ion is
smaller than the radius of hydrated Li+, and hence hydrated Cs+ moves faster, and conducts electricity more
readily.
The hydration number is the average number of water molecules associated with the metal ion. The values need not be whole numbers,
and are obtained by measuring the transference of water in a conductivity cell.
Some water molecules touch the metal ion and bond to it, forming a complex. These water molecules
constitute the primary shell of water. Thus Li+ is tetrahedrally surrounded by four water molecules. This may
be explained by the oxygen atoms of the four water molecules using a lone pair to form a coordinate bond
to the metal ion. With four electron pairs in the valence shell the VSEPR theory predicts a tetrahedral struc•
ture. Alternatively, using valence bond theory, the 2s orbital and the three 2p orbitals form four sp3 hybrid
orbitals which are flled by the lone pairs from the oxygen atoms.
_
@unacademyplusdiscounts
9.11 Solubility and Hydration 357
1s 2s 2p
Electronic structure of
lithium atom
1s 2s 2p
Electronic structure of
Li+ ion
1s 2s 2p
Electronic structure of
Li+ ion with four water
molecules bonded, using
a lone pair on oxygen four electron pairs – tetrahedral
to form a coordinate bond (sp3 hybridization)
With the heavier ions, particularly Rb+ and Cs+, the number of water molecules increases to six. VSEPR
theory predicts an octahedral structure. Valence bond theory also indicates an octahedral arrangement
using one s orbital, three p orbitals and two d orbitals for bonding.
full 3d 4s 4p
Electronic structure of
inner
potassium atom in the
shell
ground state
3d 4s 4p
Electronic structure of
K+ ion
3d 4s 4p
Electronic structure of
K+ bonded to six
molecules of water
six orbitals – octahedral
(d2sp3 hybridization)
Note that the d orbitals comprise a group of three (called t2g orbitals), and a group of two (called eg orbitals). Only the group of two is used
for bonding.
A secondary layer of water molecules further hydrates the ions, though these are only held by weak
ion – dipole attractive forces. The strength of such forces is inversely proportional to the distance, that is to
the size of the metal ion. Thus the secondary hydration decreases from lithium to caesium, and accounts for
Li+ being the most heavily hydrated.
The decrease in hydration from Li+ to Cs+ is also shown in the crystaline salts, for nearly all lithium salts
are hydrated, commonly as trihydrates. Many sodium salts are hydrated (e.g. Na2CO3 · 10H2O, Na2CO3 ·
7H2O and Na2CO3 · H2O). Few potassium salts and no rubidium or caesium salts are hydrated.
The solubility of most of the salts of Group 1 elements in water decreases on descending the group. For
a substance to dissolve the energy evolved when the ions are hydrated (hydration energy) must be larger
than the energy required to break the crystal lattice (lattice energy). Conversely, if the solid is insoluble, the
hydration energy is less than the lattice energy.
The reason why the solubility of most Group 1 metals decreases on descending the group is that the
lattice energy only changes slightly, but the free energy of hydration changes rather more. For example, the
difference in lattice energy between NaCl and KCl is 67 kJ mol−1, and yet the difference in ∆G(hydration) for
Na+ and K+ is 76 kJ mol−1 (Table 9.11). Thus KCl is less soluble than NaCl.
Table 9.11 Hydration and lattice energy values for Group 1 halides at 25 °C
Free energy Lattice energy (kJ
of hydration mol−1)
∆G°
MF MCl MBr MI
(kJ mol−1)
Li+ −506 −1035 −845 −800 −740
Na +
−406 −908 −770 −736 −690
K+ −330 −803 −703 −674 −636
Rb +
−310 −770 −674 −653 −515
Cs +
−276 −720 −644 −623 −590
_
@edubuzznotes
358 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
The Group 1 fuorides and carbonates are exceptional in that their solubilities increase rapidly on
descending the group (Table 9.12). The reason for this is that their lattice energies change more than the
hydration energies on descending the group.
Dilute solutions of alkali metals in liquid ammonia are dark blue in colour, and the main species pres•
ent are solvated metal ions and solvated electrons. If the blue solution is allowed to stand, the colour slowly
fades until it disappears owing to the formation of a metal amide. At concentrations above 3 M, solutions
are copper–bronze coloured and have a metallic lustre because metal ion clusters are formed.
These solutions of metals in liquid ammonia conduct electricity better than any salt in any liquid, and
the conductivity is similar to that of pure metals (specifc conductivity of Hg = 104 ohm−1; Na/NH3 = 0.5 × 104
ohm−l; K/NH3 = 0.45 × 104 ohm−1). Conduction is mainly due to the presence of solvated electrons.
These solutions of metals in liquid ammonia act as powerful reducing agents for the elements of
Groups 14, 15 and 16, for many compounds and coordination complexes, and they will even reduce an
aromatic ring.
These reductions can be carried out in liquid ammonia, but not in water, because the alkali metals are
stronger reducing agents than is hydrogen, and so will react with water and liberate hydrogen. The metals
can exist for some time in liquid ammonia.
_
@edubuzznotes
9.14 Complexes, Crowns and Crypts 359
OH O OH2 O O
+K+ K K
CHO OH2 OHC
CHO CHO
Salicaldehyde
O CHO H
CHO K O
O OHC
H
O O O O
O O O O
Dibenzo-18-crown-6 Dicyclohexyl-18-crown-6
CH2 CH2
O O
CH
Rb
O O CH2
CH2 CH2
N
C O
Benzo-12-crown-4
S C
RbNCS (dibenzo-18-crown-6)
complex
Li Be B C
Na Mg Al Si
The diagonal relationship arises because of the effects of both size and charge. On descending a group, the
atoms and ions increase in size. On moving from left to right in the periodic table, the size decreases. Thus
on moving diagonally, the size remains nearly the same. For example, lithium is smaller than sodium, and
magnesium is also smaller than sodium, and hence lithium and magnesium are similar in size. The sizes of
Li+ = 0.76 Å and Mg2+ = 0.72 Å are close, and so in situations where size is important their behaviour should
be similar.
Beryllium and aluminium also show a diagonal relationship. In this case the sizes are not so close
(Be2+ = 0.45 Å and Al3+ = 0.535 Å), but the charge per unit area is similar (Be2+ 2.36 and Al3+ 2.50) because
the charges are 2+ and 3+ respectively.
(ionic charge)
Charge per unit area =
4 π ⋅ (ionic radius)2
_
@edubuzznotes
9.18 Electrolytic Processes 363
It is sometimes suggested that the diagonal relationship arises because of a diagonal similarity in electro•
negativity values.
Li Be B C
1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5
Na Mg Al Si
0.9 1.2 1.5 1.8
Since ionic size and electronegativity are closely related, this is part of the same picture.
Anode: 2Cl − → Cl 2 + 2e
Na + + e → Na
Cathode:
2Na + 2H 2O → 2NaOH + H2
or 2OH − + Cl 2 → 2OCl − + H 2
hypochlorite
and also another reaction may occur to a small extent at the anode:
The electrolysis of brine is carried out on industrial scale using two types of cells—diaphragm and mercury
cathode that were frst developed in 1890’s.
4OH− → O2 + 2H2O + 4e
Diaphragm cell
In a diaphragm cell (Figure 9.4), brine is constantly added, and NaOH and Cl2 are produced continuously.
A porous diaphragm of asbestos is used to keep the H2 and Cl2 gases (produced at the electrodes) sepa•
rated from one another. If H2 and Cl2 gases mix they react, and the reaction may be explosive. In daylight
(and more so in sunlight) a photolytic reaction takes place which produces chlorine atoms. These lead to an
explosive chain reaction with hydrogen.
The diaphragm also separates the anode and cathode compartments. This reduces the chance that NaOH
produced in the cathode compartment can mix and react with Cl2 produced in the anode compartment. This
reduces the chance of the side reaction producing sodium hypochlorite, NaOCl. However, some sodium
_
@edubuzznotes
364 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
Carbon
anode
Carbon
Asbestos cathode
diaphragm
Sodium hydroxide out
hydroxide or OH− may diffuse into the other compartment, and this is inhibited by maintaining the level of
electrolyte higher in the anode compartment than in the cathode compartment, so there is a small positive fow
from the anode to the cathode compartment. Traces of dioxygen are produced in a side reaction. This reacts
with the carbon electrodes, gradually destroying them and forming CO2.
Less than half the NaCl is converted to NaOH, and a mixture of about 11% NaOH and 16% NaCl is
usually obtained. This solution is concentrated in a steam evaporator, when a considerable amount of NaCl
crystallizes out, giving a fnal solution containing 50% NaOH and 1% NaCl. It is important to note that
NaOH made in this way always contains some NaCl.
Na+ + e → Na(metal)
If the cathode is made of mercury, the Na atoms produced dissolve in the mercury and form an amalgam,
or loose alloy. The amalgam is pumped to a different compartment called the denuder, where water trickles
over lumps of graphite (here acting as an inert solid). The water and the Na in the amalgam react, and in
this way pure NaOH at 50% strength is obtained.
The clean mercury is recycled back to the electrolysis tank. Originally the anodes were made of graphite,
but because traces of dioxygen are produced in a side reaction they become pitted, owing to the formation
of CO2. The anodes are now made of steel coated with titanium. (See Figure 9.5.) Titanium is very resistant
to corrosion, and this not only overcomes the problem of pitting and forming CO2, but also lowers the
electrical resistance.
Water
Mercury Mercury in
cathode −
Denuder
graphite Caustic
Mercury soda out
Pump
Mercury
less basic than those of Group 1: hence their oxosalts (carbonates, sulphates, nitrates) are less stable to heat.
Magnesium is an important structural metal, and is used in large amounts. Several compounds are used in
vast quantities: limestone (CaCO3) is used to make quicklime CaO and cement, and large amounts of chalk
are also used. Other compounds used on a large scale include gypsum CaSO4 fuorite CaF2 (magnesite
MgCO3 and barytes BaSO4.
Mg2+ and Ca2+ are essential elements in the human body, and Mg2+ is an important constituent of
chlorophyll.
Group 2 metals are silvery white in colour. They have two valency electrons which may participate
in metallic bonding, compared with one electron for Group 1 metals. Consequently Group 2 metals are
harder, have higher cohesive energy, and have much higher melting points and boiling points than Group 1
elements (see Table 9.16). but the metals are relatively soft. The melting points do not vary regularly, mainly
because the metals adopt different crystal structures.
_
@edubuzznotes
9.21 General Properties 367
Ionization energy
The third ionization energy is so high that M3+ ions are never formed. The ionization energy for Be2+ is
high, and its compounds are typically covalent. Mg also forms some covalent compounds. However, the
compounds formed by Mg, Ca, Sr and Ba are predominantly divalent and ionic. Since the atoms are smaller
than those in Group 1, the electrons are more tightly held so that the energy needed to remove the frst
electron (frst ionization energy) is greater than for Group 1. Once one electron has been removed, the
ratio of charges on the nucleus to orbital electrons is increased, so that the remaining electrons are more
tightly held. Hence the energy needed to remove a second electron is nearly double that required for the
frst (Table 9.17). The total energy required to produce gaseous divalent ions for Group 2 elements (frst
ionization energy + second ionization energy) is over four times greater than the energy required to pro•
duce M+ from Group 1 metals. The fact that ionic compounds are formed shows that the energy given out
when a crystal lattice is formed more than offsets that used in producing ions.
Electronegativity
The electronegativity values of Group 2 elements are low, but are higher than the values for Group 1. When
Mg, Ca, Sr and Ba react with elements such as the halogens and dioxygen at the right hand side of the periodic
table, the electronegativity difference is large and the compounds are ionic.
The value for Be is higher than for the others. BeF2 has the biggest electronegativity difference for a
compound of Be and so is the most likely compound of Be to be ionic. BeF2 has a very low conductivity
when fused, and is regarded as covalent.
Hydration energies
The hydration energies of the Group 2 ions are four or fve times greater than for Group 1 ions. This is
largely due to their smaller size and increased charge, and ∆Hhydration decreases down the group as the size
of the ions increases (Table 9.18). In the case of Be a further factor is the very strong complex [Be(H2O)4]2+
_
@edubuzznotes
368 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
that is formed. The crystalline compounds of Group 2 contain more water of crystallization than the cor•
responding Group 1 compounds. Thus NaCl and KCl are anhydrous but MgCl2 · 6H2O, CaCl2 · 6H2O and
BaCl2 · 2H2O all have water of crystallization. Note that the number of molecules of water of crystallization
decreases as the ions become larger.
Since the divalent ions have a noble gas structure with no unpaired electrons, their compounds are
diamagnetic and colourless, unless the acid radical is coloured.
1s 2s 2p
Electronic structure of beryllium
atom in excited state
In fact linear molecules exist only in the gas phase, as this electronic arrangement has not flled the outer
shell of electrons. In the solid state fourfold coordination is always achieved. There are several ways by
which this can be achieved:
1. Two ligands that have a lone pair of electrons may form coordinate bonds using the two unflled orbitals
in the valence shell of Be. Thus two F− ions might coordinate to BeF2, forming [BeF4]2−. Similarly
diethyl ether can coordinate to Be(+II) in BeCl2, forming [BeCl2 (OEt2)2].
2. The BeX2 molecules may polymerize to form chains, containing bridging halogen groups, for example
(BeF2)n, (BeCl2)n. Each halogen forms one normal covalent bond, and uses a lone pair to form a coor•
dinate bond.
3. (BeMe2)n has essentially the same structure as (BeCl2)n but the bonding in the methyl compound is
best regarded as three•centre two•electron bonds covering one Me and two Be atoms.
4. A covalent lattice may be formed with a zinc blende or wurtzite structure (coordination number 4), for
example by BeO and BeS.
In water beryllium salts are extensively hydrolyzed to give a series of hydroxo complexes of unknown
structure. They may be polymeric and of the type:
2− 2−
HO OH OH HO OH OH OH
Be Be Be Be Be
HO OH OH HO OH OH OH
If alkali is added to these solutions the polymers break down to give the simple mononuclear beryllate ion
[Be(OH)4]2−, which is tetrahedral. Many beryllium salts contain the hydrated ion [Be(H2O)4]2+ rather than
Be2+, and the hydrated ion too is a tetrahedral complex ion. Note that the coordination number is 4. Forming
a hydrated complex increases the effective size of the beryllium ion, thus spreading the charge over a larger
area. Stable ionic salts such as [Be(H2O)4]SO4, [Be(H2O)4](NO3)2 and [Be(H2O)4]Cl2 are known.
_
@edubuzznotes
370 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
1s 2s 2p
Electronic structure of Be2+ ion
1s 2s 2p
Electronic structure of Be2+ ion
having gained four electron pairs
from four oxygen atoms in
water molecules four electron pairs – tetrahedral
(sp3 hybridization)
Beryllium salts are acidic when dissolved in pure water because the hydrated ion hydrolyses, producing
H3O+. This happens because the Be—O bond is very strong, and so in the hydrated ion this weakens the
O—H bonds, and hence there is a tendency to lose protons. The initial reaction is
H2O + [Be(H2O)4]2+ [Be(H2O)3(OH)]+ + H3O+
but this may be followed by further polymerization, involving hydroxobridged structures [Be2OH]3+,
[Be3(OH)4]3+. In alkaline solutions [Be(OH)4]2− is formed. The other Group 2 salts do not interact so
strongly with water, and do not hydrolyze appreciably.
Beryllium salts rarely have more than four molecules of water of crystallization associated with the
metal ion, because there are only four orbitals available in the second shell of electrons, whereas magnesium
can have a coordination number of 6 by using some 3d orbitals as well as 3s and 3p orbitals.
This indicates that beryllium is much less electropositive (less metallic) than the others, and beryllium does
not react with water. There is some doubt whether it reacts with steam to form the oxide BeO, or fails to
react at all.
Ca, Sr and Ba have reduction potentials similar to those of the corresponding Group 1 metals, and are
quite high in the electrochemical series. They react with cold water quite readily, liberating hydrogen and
forming metal hydroxides.
Ca + 2H2O → Ca(OH)2 + H2
Magnesium has an intermediate value, and it does not react with cold water but it decomposes hot water.
Mg + 2H2O → Mg(OH)2 + H2
or Mg + H2O → MgO + H2
Mg forms a protective layer of oxide, so despite its favourable reduction potential it does not react readily
unless the oxide layer is removed by amalgamating with mercury. In the formation of the oxide flm it
resembles aluminium.
9.24 | HYDROXIDES
Be(OH)2 is amphoteric, but the hydroxides of Mg, Ca, Sr and Ba are basic. The basic strength increases
from Mg to Ba, and Group 2 shows the usual trend that basic properties increase on descending a group.
Solutions of Ca(OH)2 and Ba(OH)2 are called lime water and baryta water respectively, and are used
to detect carbon dioxide. When CO2 is bubbled through these solutions, they become ‘turbid’ or ‘milky’ due
to the formation of a suspension of solid particles of CaCO3 or BaCO3. If excess CO2 is passed through
these ‘milky’ solutions then the turbidity disappears as soluble bicarbonates form with the excess CO2.
Baryta water is rather too sensitive as it gives a positive test for CO2 by exhaling breath on it, whereas with
lime water, breath (or other gas) must be blown through the solution as bubbles.
Excess
CO 2
Ca 2+ (OH − )2 + CO2 → CaCO3 → Ca 2 + (HCO3− )2
+ H 2 O
insoluble soluble
white precipitate
The bicarbonates of Group 2 metals are only stable in solution. Caves in limestone regions often
have stalactites growing down from the roof, and stalagmites growing up from the foor. Water percolat•
ing through the limestone contains some Ca2+(HCO 3− )2 in solution. The soluble bicarbonate decomposes
slowly into the insoluble carbonate, and this results in the slow growth of the stalactites and stalagmites.
Ca 2+ (HCO3− )2 → CaCO3 + CO2 + H2O
Thus the bicarbonates decompose into carbonates, and calcium carbonate is precipitated. If this is fltered
off, or allowed to settle, the water is free from hardness. Temporary hardness can also be removed by adding
slaked lime to precipitate calcium carbonate. This is called ‘lime softening’, and by operating at pH 10.5,
temporary hardness due to HCO3− can be almost completely removed.
Ca(HCO3)2 + Ca(OH)2 2CaCO3 + 2H2O
_
@edubuzznotes
372 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
‘Permanent hardness’ is not removed by boiling, and is due mainly to MgSO4 or CaSO4 in solution.
Small quantities of pure water are prepared in the laboratory either by distilling the water, or by passing
it through an ion•exchange resin, when the Ca2+ and Mg2+ ions are replaced by Na+. The sodium salts do
not affect the lathering power. Ion•exchange methods are widely used in industry. Water may also be soft•
ened by adding various phosphates, such as trisodium phosphate Na3PO4, sodium pyrophosphate Na4P2O7,
sodium tripolyphosphate Na5P3O10, or Grahams salt (Calgon) (NaPO3)n. These form a complex with the
calcium and magnesium ions and ‘sequester’ them, that is keep them in solution. At one time large quanti•
ties of sodium carbonate were used in the lime–soda process to soften water. The effect of adding Na2CO3
is to precipitate CaCO3.
CaSO4 + Na2CO3 → CaCO3 + Na2SO4
Mg(OH)2 is extremely insoluble in water (approx. 1 × 10−4 gl−1 at 20 °C) but the other hydroxides are soluble
and the solubility increases down the group (Ca(OH)2 approx. 2 gl−1; Sr(OH)2 approx. 8 gl−1; Ba(OH)2
approx. 39 gl−1). Be(OH)2 is soluble in solutions containing an excess of OH−, and is therefore amphoteric.
Mg(OH)2 is weakly basic, and is used to treat acid indigestion. The other hydroxides are strong bases.
Ca(OH)2 is called slaked lime.
BeO is covalent and has a 4:4 zinc sulphide (wurtzite) structure, but all the others are ionic and have a
6:6 sodium chloride structure.
As the atoms get larger, the ionization energy decreases and the elements also become more basic.
BeO is insoluble in water but dissolves in acids to give salts, and in alkalis to give beryllates, which on stand•
ing precipitate as the hydroxide. BeO is therefore amphoteric. MgO reacts with water, forming Mg(OH)2
which is weakly basic. CaO reacts very readily with water, evolving a lot of heat and forming Ca(OH)2
which is a moderately strong base. Sr(OH)2 and Ba(OH)2 are even stronger bases. The oxides are usually
prepared by thermal decomposition of the carbonates, nitrates or hydroxides. The increase in basic strength
is illustrated by the temperatures at which the carbonates decompose:
The carbonates are all ionic, but BeCO3 is unusual because it contains the hydrated ion [Be(H2O)4]2+
rather than Be2+.
CaCO3 occurs as two different crystalline forms, calcite and aragonite. Both forms occur naturally as
minerals. Calcite is the more stable: each Ca2+ is surrounded by six oxygen atoms from CO2−3 ions. Aragonite
is a metastable form, and its standard enthalpy of formation is about 5 kJ mol−1 higher than that of calcite.
In principle aragonite should decompose to calcite, but a high energy of activation prevents this happening.
Aragonite can be made in the laboratory by precipitating from a hot solution. Its crystal structure has Ca2+
surrounded by nine oxygen atoms. This is a rather unusual coordination number.
Calcium oxide (lime) is prepared on a large scale by heating CaCO3 in lime kilns.
CaCO3 → CaO + CO2
Lime is used:
1. In steel making to remove phosphates and silicates as slag.
2. By mixing with SiO2 and alumina or clay to make cement.
3. For making glass.
4. For softening water.
5. To make CaC2.
6. To make slaked lime Ca(OH)2 by treatment with water.
Bleaching powder is made by passing Cl2 into slaked lime. Though bleaching powder is often written as
Ca(OCl)2, it is really a mixture.
3Ca(OH)2 + 2Cl2 → Ca(OCl)2 · Ca(OH)2· CaCl2 · 2H2O
Soda lime is a mixture of NaOH and Ca(OH)2 and is made from quicklime (CaO) and aqueous sodium
hydroxide. It much easier to handle than NaOH.
Peroxides are formed with increasing ease and increasing stability as the metal ions become larger.
Barium peroxide BaO2 is formed by passing air over BaO at 500 °C. SrO2 can be formed in a similar way
but this requires a high pressure and temperature. CaO2 is not formed in this way, but can be made as the
hydrate by treating Ca(OH)2 with H2O2 and then dehydrating the product. Crude MgO2 has been made
using H2O2, but no peroxide of beryllium is known. The peroxides are white ionic solids containing the
[O—O]2− ion and can be regarded as salts of the very weak acid hydrogen peroxide. Treating peroxides with
acid liberates hydrogen peroxide.
BaO2 + 2HCl → BaCl2 + H2O2
_
@edubuzznotes
374 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
9.28 | SULPHATES
The solubility of the sulphates in water decreases down the group. Be > Mg >> Ca > Sr > Ba. Thus BeSO4
and MgSO4 are soluble, but CaSO4 is sparingly soluble, and the sulphates of Sr, Ba and Ra are virtually
insoluble. The signifcantly higher solubilities of BeSO4 and MgSO4 are due to the high enthalpy of solva•
tion of the smaller Be2+ and Mg2+ ions. Epsom salt MgSO4 · 7H2O is used as a mild laxative. Calcium sul•
phate can exist as a hemihydrate CaSO4 ⋅ 21 H 2O which is important in the building trade as plaster of Paris.
This is made by partially dehydrating gypsum.
CaSO4 ⋅ 2 H 2O 150
°C
→ CaSO4 ⋅ 21 H 2O 200
°C
→ CaSO4 1100
°C
→ CaO + SO3
gypsum plaster of Paris anhydritde
When powdered plaster of Paris CaSO4 ⋅ 21 H 2O is mixed with correct amount of water it sets into a solid
mass of CaSO4 · 2H2O (another crystallographic modifcation of gypsum). Plaster of Paris is used for plas•
tering walls, and also to make plaster casts (moulds) for a variety of purposes, industrial, sculptural, and
in hospitals to encase limbs so that broken bones are set straight. Alabaster is a fne grained form of
CaSO4 · 2H2O which is shiny like marble, and is used to make ornaments. CaSO4 is slightly soluble in water
(2g per litre), so objects made from alabaster or gypsum cannot be kept outdoors. BaSO4 is both insoluble
in water and opaque to X•rays and is used as a ‘barium meal’ to provide a shadow of the stomach or duo•
denum on an X•ray picture, which is useful in diagnosing stomach or duodenal ulcers. The sulphates all
decompose on heating, giving the oxides:
heat
MgSO4
→ MgO + SO3
In the same way as with the stability and thermal decomposition of the carbonates, the more basic the
metal is, the more stable the sulphate is. This is shown by the temperatures at which decomposition
occurs:
Heating the sulphates with carbon reduces them to sulphides. Most barium compounds are made from
barium sulphide.
BaSO4 + 4C → BaS + 4CO
9.29 | NITRATES
Nitrates of the metals can all be prepared in solution and can be crystallized as hydrated salts by the
reaction of HNO3 with carbonates, oxides or hydroxides. Heating the hydrated solids does not give the
anhydrous nitrate because the solid decomposes to the oxide. Anhydrous nitrates can be prepared using
liquid dinitrogen tetroxide and ethyl acetate. Beryllium is unusual in that it forms a basic nitrate in addition
to the normal salt.
N O warm to 50 ° C 125 °C
BeCl 2
2 4
→ Be(NO3 )2 ⋅ 2N 2 O4 under
→ Be(NO3 )2
vacuum → [ Be4 O(NO3 )6 ]
basic
beryllium
nitrate
Basic beryllium nitrate is covalent and has an unusual structure (Figure 9.6b). Four Be atoms are located
at the corners of a tetrahedron, with six NO3− groups along the six edges of the tetrahedron, and the (basic)
oxygen at the centre. The structure is of interest partly because berylliumis unique in forming a series
_
@edubuzznotes
9.31 Halides 375
NO 3
Thus, basic beryllium nitrate is one of a
NO
NO
series of similar molecules (cf. basic beryl• O O
3
O
lium acetate (Figure 9.7a)). The structure N
is also of interest because the NO3− groups Be
act as bidentate ligands in forming a bridge O− NO 3
NO
3
between two Be atoms (Figure 9.6a). (See Be Be
‘Chelates’ in Chapter 5 for a discussion of (a) (b)
multidentate groups.) −
Figure 9.6 (a) A bridging NO group. (b) Basic beryllium
3
nitrate.
9.30 | HYDRIDES
The elements Mg, Ca, Sr and Ba all react with hydrogen to form hydrides MH2. Beryllium hydride is diff•
cult to prepare, and less stable than the others. Impure BeH2 (contaminated with various amounts of ether)
was frst made by reducing BeCl2 with lithium aluminium hydride Li[AlH4]. Pure samples can be obtained
by reducing BeCl2 with lithium borohydride Li[BH4] to give BeB2H8, then heating BeB2H8 in a sealed tube
with triphenylphosphine PPh3.
2BeCl2 + LiAlH4 → 2BeH2 + LiCl + AlCl3.
Ca + H2 → CaH2
The hydrides are all reducing agents and are hydrolysed by water and dilute acids with the evolution of
hydrogen.
CaH2, SrH2 and BaH2 are ionic, and contain the hydride ion H−. Beryllium and magnesium hydrides
are covalent and polymeric. (BeH2)n presents an interesting structural problem. In the gas phase it seems
probable that several species may be present comprising polymeric chains and rings. The solid exists in
both amorphous and crystalline forms. Both are thought to be polymeric and to contain hydrogen bridges
between beryllium atoms.
9.31 | HALIDES
Halides MX2 can be made by heating the metals with the halogen, or by the action of halogen acid on either
the metal or the carbonate. The beryllium halides are covalent, hygroscopic and fume in air due to hydro•
lysis. They sublime, and they do not conduct electricity. Anhydrous beryllium halides cannot be obtained
from materials made in aqueous solutions because the hydrated ion [Be(H2O)4]2+ is formed, e.g. [Be(H2O)4]
Cl2 or [Be(H2O)4]F2. Attempts to dehydrate result in hydrolysis.
heat
[Be(H2O)4]Cl2
→ Be(OH)2 + 2HCl + 2H2O
The anhydrous halides are best prepared by the following reactions. Reaction with CCl4 is a standard
method for making anhydrous chlorides which cannot be obtained by dehydrating hydrates.
heat
BeO + 2NH3 + 4HF → (NH4)2[BeF4] → BeF2 + 2NH4F
700 °C
BeO + C + Cl2 ↽
⇀
BeCl2 + CO
800 °C
2BeO + CCl4
→ 2BeCl2 + CO2
_
@edubuzznotes
376 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
The anhydrous halides are polymeric. Beryllium chloride vapour contains BeCl2 and (BeCl2)2, but the solid
is polymerized.
Beryllium fuoride is very soluble in water, owing to the high solvation energy of Be in forming
[Be(H2O)4]2+. The other fuorides MF2 are all almost insoluble.
Fluorides of the other metals are ionic, have high melting points, and are insoluble in water. CaF2 is a white,
insoluble, high melting solid. It is very important industrially, and is the main source of both F2 and HF.
CaF2 + H2SO4 → 2HF + CaSO4
electrolysis
HF + KF → KHF2
→ F2
CaF2 is also used to make prisms and cell windows for spectrophotometers.
The chlorides, bromides and iodides of Mg, Ca, Sr and Ba are ionic, have much lower melting points
than the fuorides, and are readily soluble in water. The solubility decreases somewhat with increasing
atomic number. The halides all form hydrates, and they are hygroscopic (absorb water vapour from the air).
CaCl2 is widely used for treating ice on roads, particularly in very cold countries, because a 30% eutectic
mixture of CaCl2/H2O freezes at −55 °C, compared with NaCl/H2O at −18 °C. CaCl2 is also used to make
concrete set more quickly and to improve its strength, and as ‘brine’ in refrigeration plants. A minor use is
in laboratories as a desiccant (drying agent). Anhydrous MgCl2 is important in the electrolytic method for
extracting magnesium.
9.32 | NITRIDES
The alkaline earth elements all burn in dinitrogen and form ionic nitrides M3N2. This is in contrast to Group 1
where Li3N is the only nitride formed.
3Ca + N2 → Ca3N2
Because the N2 molecule is very stable, it requires a lot of energy to convert N2 into N3− nitride ions. The
large amount of energy required comes from the very large amount of lattice energy evolved when the
crystalline solid is formed. The lattice energy is particularly high because of the high charges on the ions
M2+ and N3−. Li is alone in Group I in forming a nitride, and here the very small size of Li+ results in a high
lattice energy.
Be3N2 is rather volatile in accord with the greater tendency of Be to covalency, but the other nitrides
are not volatile. All the nitrides are all crystalline solids which decompose on heating and react with water,
liberating ammonia and forming either the metal oxide or hydroxide, e.g.
Ca3N2 + 6H2O → 3Ca(OH)2 + 2NH3
9.33 | CARBIDES
When BeO is heated with C at 1900−2000 °C a brick red coloured ionic carbide of formula Be2C is formed.
It is unusual because it reacts with water, forming methane, and is thus called a methanide.
Be2C + 4H2O → 2Be(OH)2 + CH4
Group 2 metals typically form ionic carbides of formula MC2. The metals Mg, Ca, Sr and Ba form
carbides of formula MC2, either when the metal is heated with carbon in an electric furnace, or when their
oxides are heated with carbon. CaC2 made in this way is a grey coloured solid, but is colourless when pure.
BeC2 is made by heating Be with ethyne.
On heating, MgC2 changes into Mg2C3. This contains C 4− 3 , and it reacts with water to form propyne
CH3C ≡ CH (methyl acetylene).
1100 °C
Ca + 2C → CaC2
2000 °C
CaO + 3C → CaC2 + CO
_
@edubuzznotes
9.34 Complexes 377
Calcium carbide is the best known. It reacts with water, liberating ethyne (formerly called acetylene),
and is thus called an acetylide.
CaC2 + 2H2O → Ca(OH)2 + C2H2
At one time this reaction was the main source of ethyne for oxy•acetylene welding. Production of CaC2
has declined because ethyne is now obtained from processing oil.
CaC2 is an important chemical intermediate. When CaC2 is heated in an electric furnace with atmo•
spheric dinitrogen at 1100 °C, calcium cyanamide CaNCN is formed. This is an important reaction because
it is one method of fxing atmospheric dinitrogen. (The Haber process for NH3 is another method of fxing
dinitrogen.)
CaC2 + N2 → CaNCN + C
The cyanamide ion [N=C=N]2− is isoelectronic with CO2, and has the same linear structure. CaNCN is pro•
duced on a large scale, particularly in locations where there is cheap electricity Cyanamide is widely used
(particularly in SE Asia and the Far East) as a slow acting nitrogenous fertilizer, as it hydrolyses slowly over
a period of months. CaNCN has the advantage over more soluble nitrogenous fertilizers such as NH4NO3
or urea, in that it is not washed away with the frst rainstorm.
Other important industrial uses of CaNCN are the manufacture of cyanamide H2NCN which is used to
make urea and thiourea, and of melamine which forms hard plastics with formaldehyde.
CaNCN + H 2 SO4 → H 2 NCN + CaSO4
CaNCN + CO2 + H 2 O → H 2 NCN + CaCO3
cyanamide
H2N N NH2
C C
N N
C
pH 7 − 9 pyrolysis
H 2 NCN → NCNC(NH 2 )2
→ NH2
cyanamide dicyanamide
cyanide amide
(melamine)
It is interesting that BaC2 also reacts with N2, but it forms a cyanide Ba(CN)2, not a cyanamide (NCN)2-.
9.34 | COMPLEXES
Group 2 metals are not noted for their ability to form complexes. The factors favouring complex for•
mation are small highly charged ions with suitable empty orbitals of low energy which can be used for
bonding. All the elements in the group form divalent ions, and these are smaller than the correspond•
ing Group 1 ions: hence Group 2 elements are better at forming complexes than Group 1 elements.
Be is appreciably smaller than the others, and so Be forms many complexes. Of the others, only Mg
and Ca show much tendency to form complexes in solution, and these are usually with oxygen•donor
ligands.
_
@edubuzznotes
378 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
Beryllium fuoride BeF2 readily coordinates two extra F− ions, forming the [BeF4]2− complex. The tetra•
fuoroberyllates M2[BeF4] are well known complex ions, and resemble the sulphates in properties.
In a similar way complexes of the type BeCl2 · D2 are formed (where D is an ether, aldehyde or ketone
with an oxygen atom which has a lone pair of electrons that can be donated). These complexes, like
[Be(H2O)4]2+ are tetrahedral.
Many stable chelate complexes of Be are known, including beryllium oxalate [Be(ox)2]2−, with b •diketones
such as acetylacetone, and with catechol. In all of these the Be2+ ion is tetrahedrally coordinated (see
Figure 9.7b).
A complex with an unusual structure called basic beryllium acetate [Be4O(CH3COO)6] is formed if
Be(OH)2 is evaporated with acetic acid (see Figure 9.7a). Basic beryllium acetate is soluble in organic sol•
vents. It is covalent, and thus has a fairly low melting point (285 °C) and boiling point (330 °C). These are low
enough for it to be distilled, which is useful in the purifcation of beryllium.
O
2−
O C
Be
Ac C O
Ac
Be
O
Ac O
O Ac Be
Be
C
O
Ac O
C
Ac
Be O
(a) (b)
Figure 9.7 (a) Basic beryllium acetate Be4O(CH3COO)6. (b) Beryllium oxalate complex [Be(ox)2]2−.
Be compounds are said to taste sweet, but do not test this for yourself as they are extremely toxic.
This is due to their very high solubility and their ability to form complexes with enzymes in the body. Be
displaces Mg from some enzymes because it has a stronger complexing ability. Contact with the skin causes
dermatitis, and inhaling dust or smoke causes a disease called berylliosis which is rather like silicosis.
Magnesium forms a few halide complexes such as [NEt4]2[MgCl4], but Ca, Sr and Ba do not.
From the viewpoint of life on this planet the most important complex formed by magnesium is chloro•
phyll. The magnesium is at the centre of a fat heterocyclic organic ring system called a porphyrin, in which
four nitrogen atoms are bonded to the magnesium (see Figure 9.8a). Chlorophyll is the green pigment in
plants which absorbs light in the red region from sunlight, and makes the energy available for photosynthesis.
In this process CO2 is converted into sugars.
chlorophyll
6CO2 + 6H2O →
sunlight C6H12O6 + 6O2
glucose
Almost all life ultimately depends on chlorophyll and photosynthesis. The dioxygen in the atmosphere
is a by•product of photosynthesis, and foodstuffs are either parts of plants, or animals which feed
on plants.
Calcium and the rest of the group only form complexes with strong complexing agents. Examples
include acetylacetone, CH 3 ⋅ CO ⋅ CH 2 ⋅ CO ⋅ CH 3. (which has two donor oxygen atoms), and ethylenedi•
aminetetraacetic acid, EDTA, which has four donor oxygen atoms and two donor nitrogen atoms in each
molecule (Figure 9.8b). The free acid H4EDTA is insoluble, and the disodium salt Na2H2EDTA is the most
used reagent.
Ca2+ + [H2EDTA]2− → [Ca(EDTA)]2− + 2H+
EDTA will form six•coordinate complexes with most metal ions in solution provided that the pH
is suitably adjusted. Since Be is invariably four•coordinate it does not complex appreciably with EDTA.
In contrast. calcium and magnesium complex with EDTA, and titrations are performed using EDTA in
_
@edubuzznotes
9.36 Differences between Beryllium and the Other Group 2 Elements 379
CH CH2 CH3
H
C C C
C C
CH3 C C C2H6
C N N C
HC Mg CH
HC N C
N
H3C C C CH3
H C C
C C C
H
CH2 HC C O
*
CH2 CO2CH3 HOOC ⋅ CH2 CH2 ⋅ COOH
*N CH2 CH2 N*
∗
HOOC ⋅ CH2 CH2 ⋅ COOH
CO2C20H39
(∗ = donor atom)
(a) (b)
buffered solutions to estimate the amounts of Ca2+ and Mg2+ present to determine the ‘hardness’ of the
water. EDTA titrations of Ca2+ and Mg2+ are carried out at higher pH than those of many other metals (e.g.
Zn2+, Cd2+ and Pb2+) as their complexes are less stable, and at lower pH values the EDTA is protonated
instead of the Ca or Mg complex forming.
7. Which of the following hydrides are electron defcient? 9. Which of the following elements liberate H2 on reac•
(A) BeH2 tion with NaOH?
(B) CaH2 (A) Be
(C) AlH3 (B) Al
(D) KH (C) B
(D) None of these.
8. In which of the following cases, does N2 evolve as a
gaseous product? 10. Which of the following statements are correct regard•
ing the diagonal relationship between Al and Be?
(A) KNO3 reacts with K on heating.
(A) BeO and Al2O3 are amphoteric in nature.
(B) Na2O2 reacts with NH3.
(B) Carbides of both produce the same gas on
(C) NH3 reacts with bleaching powder.
hydrolysis.
(D) None of these.
(C) Both can form complexes.
(D) Hydrides of both the elements are covalent in
nature.
Statement II: Ethanol amine absorbs CO2 at 30 − 60 °C Statement II: The reaction is highly exothermic, as a
while it releases CO2 at 100 − 150 °C. result of which the remaining solid metal melts and
local heating is so high that the released H2 catches
3. Statement I: BeH2(s) and CaH2(s) have the same fre.
structure.
10. Statement I: NaOH + NH4+ − salt → NH3 ↑ +Na+ +H2O
Statement II: Be and Ca are both alkaline earth metal
elements. Statement II: H++ OH−→ H2O; it is the strong
acid–strong base reaction which releases more
4. Statement I: CaCl2 is formed as a by•product in the energy and shifts towards greater stability.
Solvay process for Na2CO3 preparation.
11. Statement I: Superoxides are stronger oxidizing
Statement II: During the recovery of NH3, CaCl2 is agents than peroxides.
obtained when Ca(OH)2 is used to react with NH4Cl.
Statement II: Superoxides accept electrons in the
5. Statement I: Na2CO3 solution is strongly alkaline in same energy level, i.e. p * orbital while peroxides
nature. *
accept electrons in the higher energy σ 2p orbital.
2. The total number of electrons in one molecule of 5. Cl2 gas is passed through a compound A and pro•
Mg2C3 is ___________. duces bleaching powder. The number of protons in
A is ___________.
3. Among the following the number of pairs of com•
pounds, for which the thermal stability order is correct 6. The ratio of the number of water of crystallization
is ___________. in gypsum and that in plaster of Paris is ___________.
(a) BeCO3 > SrCO3 7. Among the following elements, the number of ele•
(b) MgO >BaO ments that release H2 on reaction with NaOH is
(c) Li2CO3 < Cs2CO3 ___________.
(d) CaSO4 < BaSO4
Be, Al, B, Mg, Ca, Zn, Sn
(e) Li3N > Na3N
(f ) LiClO4 < KClO4
_
@edubuzznotes
384 Chapter 9 The s-Block Elements and their Compounds
8. The number of bicarbonates that do not exist in solid 10. What is the number of ions among the following for
form among the following is ___________. which hydrated ion has higher ionic mobility than
Be2+(aq)?
LiHCO3 , NaHCO3 , Ca(HCO3 )2 , KHCO3 , N 4
1. Match the chemical properties with the compounds. 3. Match the compounds with the properties.
(A) Ca (P) Produces H2 on reaction (A) CaSO4 ⋅ 2H2O (P) Stored under kerosene.
with H2O.
(B) LiI (Q) Most covalent alkali
(B) CaH2 (Q) Produces Ca(OH)2
metal halide.
on reaction with H2O.
(C) Na (R) Insoluble in water.
(C) CaO (R) The compound is ionic.
(D) CaC2 (S) Can absorb N2 under hot (D) KF (S) Soluble in water without
conditions. any reaction with water.
2. Match the compounds with their characteristics. 4. Match the compounds with their uses/properties.
(S) Produces basic oxides on thermal (D) NaCl (S) Dead burnt.
decomposition. (T) Soluble in water.
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (C) 5. (A) 9. (C) 13. (D) 17. (B)
2. (B) 6. (B) 10. (D) 14. (B) 18. (B)
3. (D) 7. (C) 11. (B) 15. (D) 19. (A)
4. (C) 8. (A) 12. (B) 16. (C)
10 z
The p-Block pz
Elements x
px
and their
py
the elements show lower valency states as well. There is an increasing tendency to form univalent
compounds on descending the group. Compounds with Ga(I), In(I) and Tl(I) are known. With Ga and In
the (+I) oxidation state is less stable than the (+III) state. However, the stability of the lower oxidation
state increases on descending the group. Tl(I) thallous compounds are more stable than Tl(III) thallic
compounds.
How and why does monovalency occur? The atoms in this group have an outer electronic confguration
of s2p1. Monovalency is explained by the s electrons in the outer shell remaining paired, and not participat•
ing in bonding. This is called the ‘inert pair effect’. If the energy required to unpair them exceeds the energy
evolved when they form bonds, then the s electrons will remain paired. The strength of the bonds in MX3
compounds decreases down the group. The mean bond energy for chlorides are GaCl3 = 242, InCl3 = 206
and TlCl3 = 153 kJ mol -1 . Thus the s electrons are most likely to be inert in thallium.
The inert pair effect is not the explanation of why monovalency occurs in Group 13. It merely describes
what happens, i.e. two electrons do not participate in bonding. The reason that they do not take part in bond•
ing is energy. The univalent ions are much larger than the trivalent ions, and (+I) compounds are ionic, and
are similar in many ways to Group 1 elements.
The inert pair effect is not restricted to Group 13, but also occurs among the heavier elements in other
groups in the p•block. Examples from Group 14 are Sn2+ and Pb2+, and examples from Group 15 are Sb3+
and Bi3+. The lower oxidation state becomes more stable on descending the group. Thus Sn2+ is a reducing
agent but Pb2+ is stable and Sb3+ is a reducing agent but Bi3+ is stable. When the s electrons remain paired,
the oxidation state is, always two lower than the usual oxidation state for the group.
Thus in the s•block, Groups 1 and 2 show only the group valency. Groups in the p•block show variable
valency, differing in steps of two. Variable valency also occurs with elements in the d•block. This arises from
using different numbers of d electrons for bonding, so in this case the valency can change in steps of one
(e.g. Cu+ and Cu2+, Fe2+ and Fe3+).
(a) (b)
The large difference in size between B and Al results in many differences in properties. Thus B is a
non•metal, has a very high melting point, always forms covalent bonds, and forms an acidic oxide. In
contrast, Al is a metal, has a much lower melting point, and its oxide is amphoteric. (It is safe to generalize
in this way, but unsafe to argue quantitatively that Al3+ is twice the size of B3+ or that the metallic radii differ
by a factor of 1.6, as B3+ does not exist, and B is not a metal.)
Electropositive character
The electropositive or metallic nature of the elements increases from B to Al, but then decreases from
Al to Tl.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.3 Preparation of Boron 391
The increase in metallic character from B to Al is the usual trend on descending a group associated
with increasing size. However, Ga, In and Tl do not continue the trend. The elements are less likely to
lose electrons (and are thus less electropositive), because of the poor shielding by d electrons described
previously.
The standard electrode potencial E° for M3+/M become less negative from Al to Ga to In and the
potential becomes positive for Tl (Table 10.4).
Table 10.4 Standard electrode potentials E °
M3+|M M+|M
(volts) (volts)
B (–0.87*)
Al −1.66 +0.55
Ga −0.56 −0.79†
In −0.34 −0.18
Tl +1.26 −0.34
* For H3BO3 + 3H+ + 3e → B + 3H2O
†
Value in acidic solution.
Ionization energy
The ionization energies increase as expected (frst ionization energy < second ionization energy < third
ionization energy). The sum of the frst three ionization energies for each of the elements is very high. Thus
boron has no tendency to form ions, and always forms covalent bonds. The other elements normally form
covalent compounds except in solution.
The ionization energy values do not decrease smoothly down the group (Table 10.5). The decrease
from B to Al is the usual trend on descending a group associated with increased size. The poor shielding by
d electrons and the resulting d•block contraction affect the values for the later elements.
Table 10.5 Ionization energies
Ionization energy
(kJ mol−1)
1st 2nd 3rd Sum of three
B 801 2427 3659 6887
Al 577 1816 2744 5137
Ga 579 1979 2962 5520
In 558 1820 2704 5082
Tl 589 1971 2877 5437
B2 O3 + Na / K / Mg / Al → B + Na 2 O / K 2 O / MgO / Al 2 O3
_
@edubuzznotes
392 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
(Continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
10.5 Reactions of the other Elements 393
Alums
Aluminium ions may crystallize from aqueous solutions, forming double salts. These are called aluminium
alums and have the general formula [MI(H2O)6][Al(H2O)6](SO4)2. MI is a singly charged cation such as Na+,
K+ or NH4+. The crystals are usually large octahedra, and are extremely pure. Purity is especially important
in some applications. Potash alum [K(H2O)6][Al(H2O)6](SO4)2 is used as a mordant in dyeing. In this appli•
cation Al3+ is precipitated as Al(OH)3 on cloth to help the dyes bind to the cloth as aluminium complexes. It
is essential that Fe3+ is absent in order to obtain the ‘true’ bright colours. Double salts break up in solution,
into their constituent ions. Crystals are made up of [M(H2O)6]+, [Al(H2O)6]3+ and two SO −4 ions. The ions
are simply the right size and charge to crystallize together. Apart from this, it is also used for (i) purifcation
of water; (ii) as coagulant and to stop bleeding; (iii) tanning of leather, etc.
Some M3+ ions other than Al3+ also form alums of formula [M1, (H2O)6][MIII(H2O)6](SO4)2. The most
common trivalent ions are Fe3+ and Cr3+, but others include Ti3+, V3+, Mn3+, Co3+, In3+, Rh3+, Ir3+ and Ga3+.
Note: Li+ cannot form alum due to its small size.
Cement
Aluminium compounds, particularly tricalcium aluminate Ca3Al2O6, are very important as constituents
of Portland and high alumina cements. The formula of tricalcium aluminate is better written Ca9[Al6O18],
because it contains 12•membered rings of Al—O—Al—O made by joining six AlO4 tetrahedra. Portland
cement is made by heating the correct mixture of limestone (CaCO3) with sand (SiO2) and clay (aluminosil•
icate) at a temperature of 1450−1600 °C in a rotary kiln. When mixed with sand and water Portland cement
sets to give concrete, a hard whitish insoluble solid, similar in appearance to Portland stone. (Portland stone
is limestone quarried on Portland Bill in Dorset, England.) Between 2% and 5% of gypsum CaSO4 ∙ 2H2O
is added to slow down the setting process, as slow setting greatly increases the strength. The composition
of cement is usually given in terms of the oxides. A typical composition for Portland cement is CaO 70%,
SiO2 20%, Al2O3 5%, Fe2O3 3%, CaSO4 ∙ 2H2O 2%.
High alumina cement is made by fusing limestone and bauxite with small amounts of SiO2 and TiO2
at 1400−1500 °C in either an open hearth furnace or a rotary kiln. High alumina cement is more expensive
than is Portland cement, but has one major advantage over Portland cement – it sets much quicker and
develops high strength within one day. It is used to make beams for bridges and buildings. High alumina
cement has good resistance to sea water and dilute mineral acids. It withstands temperatures up to 1500 °C
and so may be used with refractory bricks in furnaces. A typical analysis of high alumina cement is CaO
40%, Al2O3 40%, SiO2 10%, Fe2O3 10%. There has been much publicity over structural failures of beams
made of high alumina cement. Failure is due to prolonged exposure to hot wet conditions, or using too
much water when mixing the sand and cement. This latter results in it setting too quickly and thus not
having time to crystallize properly.
CoO + B2 O3 ® Co(BO2 )2
cobalt metaborate
(blue colour)
However, it is possible to force B2O3 to behave as a basic oxide by reacting with very strongly acidic
compounds. Thus with P2O5 or As2O5, boron phosphate or boron arsenate are formed.
B2O3 + P2O5 → 2BPO4
Orthoboric acid H3BO3 is soluble in water, and behaves as a weak monobasic acid. It does not donate
protons like most acids, but rather it accepts OH−. It is therefore a Lewis acid, and is better written as
B(OH)3. B(OH) + 2H O ↽ ⇀
+
H O + [ B(OH) ]
-
pK = 9.25
3 2 3 4
or
[H 3BO3 ]
OH HO OH −
B B
HO OH HO OH
Plane triangle Tetrahedral metaborate ion
−
HO
B O OH
O B
B O OH
HO
B(OH)3 + NaOH ↽
Na [ B(OH)4 ]
⇀
⇌
NaBO2 + 2H 2 O
sodium
metaborate
The added compound must be a cis•diol, to enhance the acidic properties in this way. (This means
that it has OH groups on adjacent carbon atoms in the cis confguration.) The cis•diol forms very stable
complexes with the [B(OH)4]− formed by the forward reaction above, thus effectively removing it from
solution. The reaction is reversible. Thus removal of one of the products at the right hand side of the equa•
tion upsets the balance, and the reaction proceeds completely to the right. Thus all the B(OH)3 reacts with
NaOH: in effect it acts as a strong acid in the presence of the cis•diol except ethylene glycol.
−
C OH HO OH
− C O OH OH C
−2H2O
+ B B +
C OH HO OH C O OH OH C
−
C O O C
−2H2O
B
C O O C
Structures of borates
In the simple borates, each B atom is bonded to three oxygen atoms, arranged at the corners of an equilateral
triangle. This would be predicted from the orbitals used for bonding.
1s 2s 2p
Electronic structure of
boron atom – ground state
Electronic structure of
boron atom – excited state
three singly occupied orbitals form
bonds with three oxygen atoms – shape
plane triaangle (sp2 hybridization)
H H
O O
H H B H H
O O
O
B H H B
H H
O O O O
H H H H
O O O O
H H H H
B B
O
O O
H H B H H
O O
H H
Three triangular units share corners and form a ring in sodium and potassium metaborates NaBO2 and
KBO2 (Figure 10.4a) which are better written as Na3[B3O6] and K3[B3O6].
Borax is usually written as Na2B4O7 ∙ 10H2O but is actually made from two tetrahedra and two triangu•
lar units joined as shown (Figure 10.4b) and should be written as Na2[B4O5(OH)4] ∙ 8H2O.
OH
O−
B−
O O
B
HO B O B OH
O O O
O
B−
B B
− O O O− OH
(a)
(b)
Figure 10.4 Structures of some borates, (a) Metaborate ring K3 [B3O6] made up of triangular BO3
units, (b) Borax (Na2 [B4O5(OH)4] ·8H2O) is made up of two triangular and two tetrahedral units.
This ion is [B4O5(OH)4]2−, and the other water molecules are associated with the metal ions.
Borax
The most common pyroborate is borax Na2[B4O5(OH)4]∙8H2O. It can be prepared by the following sequence
of reactions.
D
2CaO . 3B2O3 + 2Na2CO3 2CaCO3 ¯ + Na2B4O7 + 2NaBO2
Filtered
_ CaCO (as residue)
3
Concentrated
NaBO2 + Na2B4O7 . 10H2O and allowed to
Na2B4O7 + NaBO2
crystallize out
in filtrate as residue and filtered
in solution
Na2B4O7 . 10H2O ¯
_
@edubuzznotes
398 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
Sodium peroxoborate
Large amounts of sodium peroxoborate are produced, and there are two main preparative methods:
1. Electrolysis of a solution of sodium borate (containing some Na2CO3).
2. By oxidizing boric acid or sodium metaborate with hydrogen peroxide.
B B
HO O O OH
peroxoborate ion
Sodium peroxoborate is used as a brightener in washing powders. It is compatible with enzymes which
are added to some ‘biological’ powders. In very hot water (over 80 °C) the peroxide linkages O—O break
down to give H2O2.
An alternative test is to make the ester methyl borate B(OCH3)3. The suspected borate sample is mixed
with concentrated H2SO4 to form H3BO3, and warmed with methyl alcohol in a small evaporating basin.
The concentrated H2SO4 removes the water formed. The mixture is then set on fre. Methyl borate is
volatile, and colours the fame green.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.8 Tetrahydridoborates (borohydrides) 399
Fluoroboric acid
H3BO3 dissolves in aqueous HF, forming fuoroboric acid HBF4.
Fluoroboric acid is a strong acid, and commercial solutions contain 40% acid. The [BF4]− ion is
tetrahedral.
Preparation of Al2O3
It can be prepared by heating Al(OH)3, Al2(SO4)3 and ammonium alum.
→ Al 2 O3 + 3H 2 O ↑
2Al(OH)3 ∆
→ Al 2 O3 + 3SO3 ↑
Al 2 (SO4 )3 ∆
→ Al 2 O3 + 2NH 3 ↑ +4SO3 ↑ +25H 2 O ↑
(NH 4 )2 SO4 ⋅ Al 2 (SO4 )3 ⋅ 24 H 2 O ∆
Alumina is white, but it can be coloured by the addition of Cr2O3 or Fe2O3. White sapphires are gem
quality corundum. Synthetic rubies can be made by strongly heating a mixture of Al2O3 and Cr2O3, for
example in an oxy•hydrogen fame. Rubies are very hard, and are used for jewellery and to make bearings
in watches and instruments. Thus ruby is a mixed oxide. Blue sapphires are another mixed oxide containing
traces of Fe2+, Fe3+ and Ti4+.
Aluminium has a very strong affnity for oxygen. The enthalpy of formation of Al2O3 is −1670 kJ mol−1,
higher (more negative) than for practically all other metal oxides. Thus Al may be used in the thermite
reduction of less stable metal oxides.
3Mn3O4 + 8Al → 4Al2O3 + 9Mn
Al(OH)3 excess
NaOH
→ NaAl(OH)4
or
NaAlO2 ⋅ 2H 2 O is
CO2
passed
→ Al(OH)3 ↓
sodium aluminate white ppt.
The formula of aluminates is often written as NaAlO2 ⋅ 2H2O (which is equivalent to [Al(OH)4]−).
Other tetrahydridoborates are made by treating Na[BH4] with the appropriate metal chloride. The
alkali metal tetrahydridoborates are white ionic solids and react with water with varying ease. Thus Li[BH4]
reacts violently with water, but Na[BH4] may be recrystallized from cold water with only slight decomposi•
tion, and K[BH4] is quite stable.
Li[BH4] + 2H2O → LiBO2 + 4H2
The alkali metal tetrahydridoborates are valuable reducing agents in both inorganic and organic
chemistry. Na[BH4] is stable in alcoholic and aqueous solutions. This makes it a useful reagent for reducing
aldehydes to primary alcohols, and ketones to secondary alcohols. It is a nucleophilic reagent, and attacks
sites of low electron density. Thus other functional groups such as C=C, COOH and NO2 are not normally
attacked.
NaBH4
R . CHO R . CH2OH primary alcohol
R R
NaBH4
C O CHOH secondary alcohol
R′ R′
Not all tetrahydridoborates are ionic. The beryllium, aluminium borohydrides become increasingly
covalent and volatile. In these the [BH4]− group acts as a ligand and forms covalent compounds with
metal ions (Figure 10.5).
H H
B
H H
H H Be
H H
Al
H H
H
H H B B
H H
B B H H H
H H
Figure 10.5 Structures of Al(BH4)3 and Be(BH4)2. (After H.J. Eméleus and
A.G. Sharpe, Modern Aspects of Inorganic Chemistry, 4th ed., 1973,
Routledge and Kegan Paul.)
The other elements in the group also form electron•defcient hydrides. (AlH3)n is a white invola•
tile solid. It is a reducing agent and reacts violently with water. It is extensively polymerised by 3•centre
hydrogen bridges similar to those in diborane. Aluminium hydride is best made from Li[AlH4] and AlCl3.
It can be made from LiH and AlCl3 in either solution, but with excess LiH lithium aluminium hydride
Li[AlH4] is formed instead.
LiH + AlCl3 → (AlH3)n ¾excess
¾¾¾ LiH
® Li[AIH4]
Li[AlH4] is a most useful organic reducing agent because it will reduce functional groups, but in general it
does not attack double bonds. It is analogous to the borohydrides but cannot be used in aqueous solutions.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.9 Halides 401
10.9 | HALIDES
Trihalides
All the elements form trihalides. The boron halides are covalent. BF3 is gaseous, BCl3 and BBr3 are liquid and
BI3 is solid. BF3 is by far the most important. It is a colourless gas, boiling point −101 °C, and is made in large
quantities:
B2O3 + 3CaF2 + conc. 3H2SO4 ¾¾¾
heat
® 2BF3 + 3CaSO4 + 3H2O
B2O3 + 6NH4BF4 ¾heat
¾¾ ® 8BF3 + 6NH3 + 3H2O
Both BF3 gas and its complex with diethyl ether (C2H5)2O ® BF3 (a viscous liquid) are commercially available.
The shape of the BF3 molecule is a planar triangle with bond angles of 120°. This is predicted by
VSEPR theory as the most stable shape for three outer electron pairs round B. The valence bond theory
also predicts a planar triangle with hybridization of one s and two p orbitals used for bonding. However,
the B atom only has six electrons in its outer shell and this is termed electron defcient.
1s 2s 2p
Electronic structure of
boron atom – excited state
The bond lengths in BF3 are 1.30 Å, and are signifcantly shorter than the sum of the covalent radii (B = 0.80 Å,
F = 0.72 Å). The bond energy is very high: 646 kJ mol−1, which is higher than for any single bond. The
shortness and strength of the bonds is interpreted in terms of a pp•pp interaction, that is the bonds possess
some double bond character. The empty 2pz atomic orbital on B which is not involved in hybridization is
perpendicular to the triangle containing the sp2 hybrid orbitals. This pz orbital may accept an electron pair
from a full pz orbital on any one of the three fuorine atoms. Thus a dative p bond is formed, and the B atom
attains an octet of electrons. If one localized double bond existed, then there would be one short bond
and two longer ones. However, all measurements show that the three bond lengths are identical. The old
valence bond explanation of this was resonance between three structures with the double bond in different
positions (Figure 10.6). The modern explanation is that the double bond is delocalized. The four pz atomic
orbitals from B and the three F atoms form a four•centre p molecular orbital covering all four atoms which
contains two bonding electrons. Delocalized p bonding is described more fully in Chapter 3.
X F F F
B X B B B
X F F F F F F
B B B B
F F F F F F F F
_
@edubuzznotes
402 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
Once a tetrahedral complex has been formed, the possibility for p bonding no longer exists. In H3N →
BF3 the B—F distance is 1.38 Å, and in Me3N → BF3 the distance is 1.39 Å, much longer than the 1.30 Å in
BF3. Since the boron halides will accept electron pairs from numerous atoms and ions such as F−, O, N, P
and S, they are acting as strong Lewis acids.
BF3 is produced from B2O3 or borax:
B2O3 + 6HF + 3H2SO4 → 2BF3 + 3H2SO4 ∙ H2O
Al Al
Cl Cl Cl
AlCl3 is an important industrial chemical. Anhydrous AlCl3 (and to a lesser extent AlBr3) is used as the
‘catalyst’ in a variety of Friedel•Crafts type of reactions for alkylations and acylations.
AlCl3 is also used to catalyse the reaction to make ethyl bromide (which is used to make the petrol additive
PbEt4).
CH2 = CH2 + HBr → C2H5 Br
_
@edubuzznotes
10.11 Differences Between Boron and the Other Elements (Anomalous Behaviour of Boron) 403
AlCl3 is also used in the manufacture of anthraquinone (used in the dyestuffs industry), and dodecylben•
zene (used to make detergents), and in the isomerization of hydrocarbons (petroleum industry).
Dihalides
Boron forms halides of formula B2X4. These decompose slowly at room temperature. B2Cl4 can be made
as follows:
There is free rotation about the B—B bond, and in the gaseous and liquid states the molecule adopts a
non•eclipsed conformation. In the solid state the molecule is planar, because of crystal forces and ease of
packing.
Cl Cl Cl
Cl
B B B B
Cl
Cl Cl Cl
Non-eclipsed Planar
Boron dichloride
These are more properly written Ga+[GaCl4]− and In+[InCl4]− and contain M(I) and M(III) rather than
Ga(II) and In(II).
10.10 | COMPLEXES
Group 13 elements form complexes much more readily than the s•block elements, because of their smaller
size and increased charge. Tetrahedral hydride and halide complexes such as Li[AlH4] and H[BF4] have
already been mentioned. In addition many octahedral complexes are also known. The most important
octahedral complexes are those with chelate groups, for example b•diketones such as acetylacetone,
oxalate ions and also 8•hydroxyquinoline. (See Figure 10.8.) The latter complex has been used in the
gravimetric determination of aluminium.
3−
CH3
O C O O
O
C
Al CH Al Al
O C C N
CH3 O O
3 3 3
Acetyl acetone complex Oxalate complex 8-hydroxyquinoline complex
1. B2O3 is an acidic oxide; like SiO2. This is in contrast to Al2O3, which is amphoteric.
2. H3BO3, which may be written B(OH)3, is acidic, whilst Al(OH)3 is amphoteric.
3. Simple borates and silicate ions can polymerize, forming isopolyacids. Both are built on similar struc•
tural principles, namely by sharing oxygen atoms. Complicated chains, rings, sheets and other structures
are formed in this way. Aluminium forms no analogous compounds.
4. The hydrides of B are gaseous, readily hydrolysed and spontaneously infammable. In contrast
aluminium hydride is a polymeric solid (AlH3)n. SiH4 is gaseous, readily hydrolysed and infammable.
5. Apart from BF3, the halides of B and Si hydrolyze readily and vigorously. The aluminium halides are
only partly hydrolysed in water.
Preparation
Diborane is the simplest and most studied of the hydrides. It is used to prepare the higher boranes, and is
an important reagent in synthetic organic chemistry. For the latter purpose it is normally generated in situ.
Diborane may be prepared by a variety of methods. Boranes were frst prepared by Alfred Stock, who
pioneered this branch of chemistry between 1912 and 1936. He heated Mg and B to give magnesium boride
Mg3B2, and then treated this with orthophosphoric acid. The reaction gives a mixture of products.
2. Reacting Na[BH4] and iodine in the solvent diglyme. Diglyme is a polyether CH3OCH2
CH2OCH2CH2OCH3.
2Na[BH 4 ]+ I 2 ¾in¾¾¾¾¾
diglyme solution
® B2 H 6 + H 2 + 2NaI
Method (3) is particularly useful when diborane is required as a reaction intermediary. It is produced in
situ, and used without the need to isolate or purify it.
Diborane is a colourless gas, and must be handled with care as it is highly reactive. It catches fre
spontaneously in air and explodes with dioxygen. The heat of combustion is very high. In the laboratory
it is handled in a vacuum frame. Since it reacts with the grease used to lubricate taps, special taps must be
used. It is instantly hydrolysed by water, or aqueous alkali. At red heat the boranes decompose to boron
and hydrogen.
B2H6 + 3O2 → 2B2O3 + 3H2O ∆H = −2165 kJ mol-1
B2H6 + 6H2O → 2H3BO3 + 3H2
R R
H2CrO4
CH B C O
R′ 3 R′
ketone
_
@edubuzznotes
406 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
(CH 3 ⋅ CH 2 )3 − B H
2 CrO4
→ CH 2 COOH
carboxylic acid
Hydroboration is a simple and useful process for two main reasons:
1. The mild conditions required for the initial hydride addition.
2. The variety of products which can be produced using different reagents to break the B—C bond.
H.C. Brown won the Nobel Prize for Chemistry in 1979 for work on these organoboron compounds.
B2 H 6 + 2(Me)3 N → 2[Me3 N ⋅ BH 3 ]
excess
B2 H 6 + NH 3 low NH 3
temperature
→ B2 H 6 ⋅ 2NH 3
excess NH 3
higher
temperature
→ (BN)x boron nitride
ratio 2NH 3 :1B2 H 6
higher
temperature
→ B2 N 3 H 6 borazine
The products formed, i.e. boron nitride or borazine can be determined by fxing the temperature.
NH3, RNH2 and R2NH cleave amines asymmetrically also forming [L2BH2]+[BH4]− type of salts which
can be converted into cyclic compounds on heating. For example, the compound B2H6 ∙ 2NH3 is ionic, and
comprises [H3N → BH2 ← NH3]+ and [BH4]− ions. On heating, it forms borazine.
2L + B2H6 → [L2BH2]+ + [BH4]−
where L = NH3, RNH2, and R2NH.
While compounds like R3N, CO, Et2O, tetrahydrofuran, react with B2H6 forming the adduct associated
with symmetrical cleavage.
+ −
2 R3N + B2H6 2 R3N − B H3
+ − + −
2:O C: + B2H6 2O C − B H3
+ −
2 Et2O + B2H6 2 Et2O − B H3
+ −
2 O + B2H6 2 O − B H3
Boron nitride is a white slippery solid. One B atom and one N atom together have the same number of
valency electrons as two C atoms. Thus boron nitride has almost the same structure as graphite, with sheets
made up of hexagonal rings of alternate B and N atoms joined together. The sheets are stacked one on top
of the other, giving a layer structure (Figure 10.9).
B B B C C C
N N N N C C C C
B B B B C C C C
N N N C C C
B B B C C C
N N C C
Figure 10.9 Similarity in structure between (a) boron nitride and graphite, (b) borazine and
benzene.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.13 Reactions of the Boranes 407
H H H
H B H H + B- H H C H
N N N N+ C C
B B B- B- C C
H N H H N+ H H C H
H H H
Borazine Benzene
(b)
B3N3H3(Me)3
H H
Cl N
+ Cl Me N Me
+
B− B
− B− B
−
N+ +
N N+ +
N
H
−
H H
−
H
B B
Cl Me
B3N3H3Cl3 B3N3H3Me3
Borazine forms p complexes such as B3N3H6—Cr(CO)3 with transition metal compounds. Borazine is
considerably more reactive than benzene, and addition reactions occur quite readily:
B3N3H6 + 3HCl → B3N3H9Cl3
Here the protonation takes place at the N atom because the electron density on each atom in the ring is not
identical and is more on the N atom due to its higher electronegativity.
H
Cl H H H
H N
− + H +
B − −
B H B N H
3HCl + −
N B
N+ +N − +
H H B N Cl
H B−
Cl H H H
H
H H H H
B H B H
B H B
H
H H
H
H
Figure 10.11 Overlap of approximately sp3 hybrid orbitals from B with an s orbital from H to give a
'banana-shaped' three-centre two-electron bond.
AI AI
CH3 CH3 CH3
3. Limited LiH + AlCl3 → P Which of the following 7. Which of the following compounds can make boric
statements is/are correct regarding P? acid solution strongly acidic when added to the solu•
(A) It is an electron defcient molecule. tion of boric acid?
(B) It is a non •volatile solid (A) Ethylene glycol
(C) It acts as a strong reducing agent. (B) Glycerol
(D) There are 3c–2e bonds in P. (C) Salicylic acid
(D)Mannitol
4. The most common trivalent cations forming alum
is/are
(A) Fe3+ (B) Cr3+ (C) Al3+ (D) Ce3+
3. Which of the following statements is incorrect? 5. The purpose of addition of gypsum into the cement is
(A) Maximum number of atoms present in one plane (A) to slow down the setting process.
for borazine is 12. (B) to fasten the setting process.
(B) The protonation occurs on B•atom in the above (C) to increase its strength.
reaction with HCl. (D) Both (A) and (C).
(C) The product may exist either in the chair or boat 6. The highest percentage of which compound is present
form. in Portland cement?
(D) None of these. (A) CaO (B) Al2O3
4. Which of the product(s) is/are formed during the (C) SiO2 (D) CaSO2 ⋅ 2H2O
hydrolysis of B3N3H6? 7. Which of the following is/are the properties of high
(A) B(OH)3 alumina cement?
(B) NH3 (A) It has good sea•water resistance
(C) H2 (B) It can withstand very high temperature
(D) All of these (C) It has good resistance towards dilute mineral acid
(D) All of these.
Statement II: Li+ has the smallest size among alkali 5. Statement I: Alum may be used as an antiseptic.
metal ions. Statement II: Coagulation of colloidal particles in
2. Statement I: Borax solution is acidic in nature. blood is caused by ions present in alum.
8. When one mole of ammonium alum is heated, the 10. The tricalcium aluminate is better written as
number of moles of gaseous product is ________. Ca9[Al6O18]. The anionic part has very similar struc•
ture of beryl’s anion. The number of Al•O•Al linkage
9. The number of bridge (3c–2e) bonds present in
in this structure is ________.
Al(BH4)3 is ________.
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (C) 3. (D) 5. (A) 7. (B)
2. (A), (B), (C), (D) 4. (A), (B), (C), (D) 6. (A), (C)
Ionization energy
The ionization energies decreases from C to Si sharply, but then the decrease is less and fnally increases
for lead. This is because of the effects of flling of d and f shells and the electrons are low shielding in nature.
Melting points
C has an extremely high melting point. Si melts appreciably lower than C, but the values for Si and Ge are
still high. They all have the very stable diamond type of lattice. Melting involves breaking the strong covalent
bonds in this lattice, and so requires a lot of energy. The melting points decrease on descending the group
because the M—M bonds become weaker as the atoms increase in size (Table 10.12). Sn and Pb are metallic,
and have much lower melting points. They do not use all four outer electrons for metallic bonding.
Four-covalent compounds
The majority of the compounds are four•covalent. In this case all four outer electrons take part in bonding.
In the valence bond theory this is explained by promoting electrons from the ground state to an excited
state. The energy needed to unpair and promote the electron is more than repaid by the energy released
on forming two extra covalent bonds. The distribution of the four orbitals results in a tetrahedral structure,
consistent with sp3 hybridization.
Electronic structure of 1s 2s 2p
carbon atom-
ground state
two unpaired electrons, thus can only
from two covalent bonds
Carbon atom-
excited state
C is unaffected by alkalis. Si reacts slowly with cold aqueous solutions of NaOH. and readily with hot
solutions, giving solutions of silicates [SiO4]4−. Sn and Pb are slowly attacked by cold alkali, and rapidly by
hot alkali, giving stannates Na2[Sn(OH)6] and plumbates Na2[Pb(OH)6]. Thus Sn and Pb are amphoteric.
Diamond does not react with the halogens, but graphite reacts with F2 at 500 °C, forming intercalation
compounds or graphite fuoride (CF)n. Si and Ge react readily with all the halogens, forming volatile halides
SiX4 and GeX4. Sn and Pb are less reactive. Sn reacts with Cl2 and Br2 in the cold, and with F2 and I2 on warm•
ing, giving SnX4. Pb reacts with F2 in the cold, forming PbF2, and with Cl2 on heating, giving PbCl2.
10.20 | CARBIDES
Compounds of carbon and a less electronegative element are called carbides. This excludes compounds
with N, P, O, S and the halogens from this section. Carbides are of three main types:
1. ionic or salt•like
2. interstitial or metallic
3. covalent
The formulae of some of the compounds cannot be rationalized by the application of simple valency rules.
All three types are prepared by heating the metal or its oxide with carbon or a hydrocarbon at tempera•
tures of 2000 °C.
Salt-like carbides
It is convenient to group these depending on whether the structure contains C, C2 or C3 anions.
Beryllium carbide Be2C is a red solid and may be made by heating C and BeO at 2000 °C. Aluminium
carbide Al4C3 is a pale yellow solid formed by heating the elements in an electric furnace. Be2C contains
individual C atoms/ions, but the structure of Al4C3 is complex. It is misleading to formulate the structure
as 4Al3+ and 3C4− as such a high charge separation is unlikely. Both Be2C and Al4C3 are called methanides
because they react with H2O, yielding methane.
Carbides with a C2 unit are well known. They are formed mainly by the elements in Group 1 ( M I2 C 2 );
Group 2 ( M II C 2 ); the coinage metals (Cu, Ag, Au); Zn and Cd; and some of the lanthanides (LnC2 and
Ln4(C2)3). These are all colourless ionic compounds and contain the carbide ion (—C ≡ C—)2−. By far the
most important compound is CaC2. This is made commercially by strongly heating lime and coke:
CaO + 3C → CaC2 + CO ΔH = + 466 kJ mol−1
The reaction is endothermic, and a temperature of 2200 °C is required. These carbides react exothermically
with water, liberating ethyne (formerly called acetylene), so they are called acetylides.
CaC2 + 2H2O → Ca(OH)2 + HC ≡ CH
At one time calcium carbide was the major source of acetylene for oxy•acetylene welding, but ethyne is now
obtained mainly from oil. CaC2 is an important chemical intermediate and is used on an industrial scale to
produce calcium cyanamide. Cyanamide is used as a nitrogenous fertilizer, and to make urea and melamine.
1100 °C
CaC 2 + N 2
→ Ca(NCN) + C
One of the two carbides of magnesium Mg2C3 contains a C3 unit, and on hydrolysis with water it yields
propyne CH3—C≡CH.
_
@edubuzznotes
418 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
Interstitial carbides
These are formed mostly by transition elements, and some of the lanthanides and actinides. The Cr, Mn, Fe,
Co and Ni groups form a large number of carbides with a wide range of stoichiometries. They are typically
infusible or are very high melting, and are very hard. For example, TaC has a melting point of 3900 °C, and is
very hard (9–10 on Mohs’ scale of hardness), and WC is also very hard. Both are used to make cutting tools
for lathes. Interstitial carbides retain many of the properties of metals. They conduct electricity by metallic
conduction, and have a lustre like a metal.
In these compounds, C atoms occupy octahedral holes in the close•packed metal lattice, and so do not
affect the electrical conductivity of the metal. Provided that the size of the metal is greater than 1.35Å, the
octahedral holes are large enough to accommodate C atoms without distorting the metal lattice. (Since we
are considering a metal lattice, 12•coordinate radii must be used.) If all the octahedral holes are occupied
the formula is MC. Interstitial carbides are generally unreactive. They do not react with H2O like ionic
carbides. Most react slowly with concentrated HF or HNO3.
The hardness and density are increased for these carbides while malleability and ductility are decreased.
Covalent carbides
SiC and B4C are the most important. Silicon carbide is hard (9.5 on Mohs’ scale), infusible and chemically
inert. It is widely used as an abrasive called carborundum, and it is prepared by heating quartz or sand with
an excess of coke in an electric furnace at 2000–2500 °C.
SiO2 + 2C → Si + 2CO
Si + C → SiC
SiC is very unreactive. It is unaffected by acids (except H3PO4), but it does react with NaOH and air, and
with Cl2 at 100 °C.
SiC + 2NaOH + 2O2 → Na2SiO3 + CO2 + H2O
SiC + 2Cl2 → SiCl4 + C
SiC is often dark purple, black or dark green due to traces of Fe and other impurities, but pure samples are
pale yellow to colourless. SiC has a three•dimensional structure of Si and C atoms, each atom tetrahedrally
surrounded by four of the other kind. There are a large number of different crystal forms based on either
the diamond or wurtzite structures. Boron carbide is even harder than silicon carbide and is used both as
an abrasive and as a shield from radiation. Its formula is more correctly represented by B13C2 .
Carbon monoxide CO
CO is a colourless, odourless, poisonous gas. It is formed when C is burned in a limited amount of air. In
the laboratory it is prepared by dehydrating formic acid with concentrated H2SO4 or by reaction between
K4 [Fe(CN)6] and concentrated H2SO4 (while dilute H2SO4 evolves highly poisonous HCN gas).
H . COOH + H 2 SO4 → CO + H 2 O
K4[Fe(CN)6] + 6H2SO4 (conc)+ 6H2O → 2K2SO4 + FeSO4 + 3(NH4)2SO4 + 6CO
K4[Fe(CN)6] + 3H2SO4 (dil) → 2K2SO4 + FeSO4 + 6HCN ↑
CO can be detected because it burns with a blue fame. It also reduces an aqueous PdCl2 solution to metal•
lic Pd. CO can be absorded by aqueous suspension of CuCl
CuCl + 2H2O + CO → [CuCl(CO)(H2O)2]2
PdCl2 + CO + H2O → Pd + CO2 + 2HCl
_
@edubuzznotes
10.21 Oxygen Compounds of Carbon 419
When passed through a solution of I2O5 it liberates I2, i.e. it reduces I2O5 to I2. This reaction is used to esti•
mate CO quantitatively. The I2 is titrated with Na2S2O3.
5CO + I2O5 → 5CO2 + I2
CO is toxic because it forms a complex with haemoglobin in the blood, and this complex is 300 times more
stable than oxy•haemoglobin. This prevents the haemoglobin in the red blood corpuscles from carrying
oxygen round the body. This causes an oxygen defciency, leading to unconsciousness and then death. CO is
sparingly soluble in water and is a neutral oxide. CO is an important fuel, because it evolves a considerable
amount of heat when it burns in air.
C + H 2 O ¾red
¾¾ heat
¾ ® CO + H 2 DH ° = +131 kJ mol -1
water gas
DS° = +134 kJ mol -1
The water gas reaction is strongly endothermic (ΔG = ΔH – TΔS). Thus the coke cools down, and at inter•
vals the steam must be turned off and air blown through to reheat the coke. It is a particularly good fuel,
i.e. it has a high calorifc value, because both CO and H2 burn and evolve heat.
Producer gas is made by blowing air through red hot coke.
C + O2 + 4N2 CO2 + 4N2
air +C
2CO + 4N2
producer gas
The overall reaction is exothermic, so the coke does not cool down as with water gas.
2C + O2→ 2CO ΔH° = − 221 kJ mol−1 and ΔS° = + 179 kJ mol−1
Producer gas is a less effcient fuel than water gas, i.e. it has a lower calorifc value, as only part of the gas will
burn. The approximate composition of producer gas is 70% N2, 25% CO, 4% CO2 with traces of CH4, H2 and O2.
CO is a good reducing agent and can reduce many metal oxides to the metal.
Fe2O3 + 3CO blast
furnace
→ 2Fe + 3CO2
CuO + CO → Cu + CO2
CO is an important ligand. It can donate an electron pair to many transition metals, forming carbonyl
compounds. The number of CO molecules bonded to the metal in this way is generally in accordance with
the effective atomic number rule (see Chapter 5). However, the bonding is more complicated than this
implies. A number of different stoichiometries are formed (Table 10.13).
Table 10.13 Binary metal carbonyls formed by the first row transition elements
Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn
V(CO)6 Cr(CO)6 Mn2(CO)10 Fe(CO)5 Co2(CO)8 Ni(CO)4
Fe2(CO)9 Co4(CO)12
Fe3(CO)12 Co6(CO)16
_
@edubuzznotes
420 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
28 °C
→ Ni (CO)4
Ni + 4CO
200 °C under pressure
→ Fe(CO)5
Fe + 5CO
photolysis
2Fe(CO)5 → Fe2 (CO)9 + CO
CrCl 6 + 3Fe(CO)5 heat
→ Cr (CO)6 + 3FeCl 2 + 9CO
In the Mond process (now obsolete) for purifying nickel, nickel carbonyl Ni(CO)4 was made from Ni and
CO at 50 °C. (Water gas was used as the source of CO.) Ni(CO)4 is a gas and can be separated from other
metals and impurities. The Ni(CO)4 gas was then decomposed at 230 °C.
The bonding in CO may be represented as three electron pairs shared between the two atoms:
:
: C : O : or C O
:
It is better represented using the molecular orbital theory (see Chapter 3).
CO is the most studied organometallic ligand. Because of O
the back bonding it is sometimes called a p acceptor ligand. The
drift of p electron density from M to C makes the ligand more O C O
C
negative, which in turn enhances its σ donating power. Thus C
Fe
CO forms weak bonds to Lewis acids (electron pair acceptors)
such as BF3 as only σ bonding is involved. In contrast CO forms
O C C O C O
strong bonds to transition metals where both σ and p bond•
–
ing can occur. Other p acceptor ligands include CN , RNC, and
NO+. Comparing these ligands, the strengths of the σ bonds are Fe
– + C
in the order CN > RNC > CO > NO , whilst their p acceptor C
O C O
properties are in the reverse order.
CO is a very versatile ligand. It may act as a bridging group O
between the two metal atoms, for example in di•iron ennea car•
bonyl Fe2(CO)9 (Figure 10.16). CO may stabilize metal clusters Figure 10.16 Structure of Fe2(CO)9.
by the C forming a multi•centre bond with three metal atoms,
and the p* orbitals in CO may be involved in bonding to other
metal atoms.
Carbon monoxide is quite reactive, and combines readily with O, S and the halogens F, Cl and Br.
1
CO + O
2 2 → CO2
The carbonyl halides are readily hydrolyzed by water, and react with ammonia to form urea:
COCl2 + H2O 2HCl + CO2
Cl H 2N
C O + 2NH3 gas phase C O + 2HCl
Cl H2N urea
Carbonyl chloride is extremely toxic, and was used as a poisonous gas in World War I. Nowadays it is
produced in quite large quantities to make tolylene diisocyanate which is an intermediate in the manufacture
of polyurethane plastics.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.21 Oxygen Compounds of Carbon 421
CO + H 2 O ⇌ CO2 + H 2
CH 4 + 2H 2 O → CO2 + 4H 2
Preparation of CO2
CO2 is recovered from fermentation processes in breweries, from the gases evolved from calcining lime•
stone in lime kilns and from the fue gases from coal•burning electric power stations.
yeast under
C 6 H 12 O6 anaerobic
conditions
→ 2C 2 H 5OH + 2CO2
strong heat
CaCO3
→ CaO + CO2
It is obtained in small amounts by the action of dilute acids on carbonates. It can also be made by burn•
ing carbon in excess of air.
CaCO3 + 2HCl → CaCl2 + CO2 + H2O
C + O2 → CO2
Recovery of CO2
CO2 is recovered by absorbing it in either aqueous Na2CO3 or ethanolamine.
cool
Na 2 CO3 + CO2 + H 2 O ↽
2NaHCO3
⇀
hot
Girbotol process
30 − 60 °C
2HOCH 2CH 2 NH 2 + CO2 + H 2O ↽
(HOCH 2CH 2 NH 3 )2 CO3
⇀
100 −150 °C
ethanolamine
CO2 gas can be liquifed under pressure between −57 °C and +31 °C. About 80% is sold in liquid form,
and 20% as solid. The solid is produced as white snow by expanding the gas from cylinders. (Expansion
causes cooling.) This is compacted into blocks and sold. Solid CO2 sublimes directly to the vapour state
(without going through the liquid state) at −78 °C under atmospheric pressure. Over half the CO2 produced
is used as a refrigerant. Solid CO2 is called ‘dry ice’ or ‘cardice’, and is used to freeze meat, frozen foods
and ice cream, and in the laboratory as a coolant. Over a quarter is used to carbonate drinks (Coca•Cola,
lemonade, beer etc.). Other uses include the manufacture of urea, as an inert atmosphere, and for neutral•
izing alkalis.
180 ° C
CO2 + 2NH 3 → NH 4 CO2 NH 2 → CO(NH 2 )2 + H 2 O
pressure
ammonium urea
carbamate
Small scale uses of CO2 include use in fre extinguishers, blasting in coal mines, as an aerosol propellant,
and for infating life•rafts.
CO2 gas is detected by its action on lime water Ca(OH)2 or baryta water Ba(OH)2, as a white insoluble
precipitate of CaCO3 or BaCO3 is formed. If more CO2 is passed through the mixture, the cloudiness disap•
pears as the soluble bicarbonate is formed.
_
@edubuzznotes
422 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
Ca(OH) 2 + CO 2 ® CaCO3 ¯ + H 2 O
white
precipitate
CaCO3 + CO 2 + H 2 O ® Ca(HCO3 ) 2
soluble
CO2 is an acidic oxide, and reacts with bases, forming salts. It dissolves in water but it is only slightly
hydrated to carbonic acid H2CO3, and the solution contains few carbonate or bicarbonate ions. A hydrate
CO2 . 8H 2 O can be crystallized at 0 °C under a pressure of 50 atmospheres CO2.
CO2 + H 2 O ⇌ H 2 CO3
Carbonic acid gives rise to two series of salts, hydrogencarbonates (otherwise called bicarbonates), and
carbonates.
NaHCO3 sodium bicarbonate
(acid salt)
NaOH + (H2CO3)
Na2CO3 sodium carbonate
(normal salt)
The structure of CO2 is linear O—C—O. Both C—O bonds are the same length. In addition to σ bonds
between C and O. There is a three•centre four•electron p bond covering all three atoms. This adds two p
bonds to the structure in addition to the two p bonds. Thus the C—O bond order is two.
Biologically, carbon dioxide is important in the processes of photosynthesis, where the green parts of
plants manufacture glucose sugar. Ultimately all animal and plant life depends on this process.
6CO2 + 6H 2O sunlight
→ C 6 H 12O6 + 6O2
glucose
The reverse reaction occurs during the process of respiration, where animals and plants release energy.
C6H12O6 + 6O2 → 6CO2 + 6H2O + energy
Carbon suboxides
Carbon suboxide C3O2 is a foul•smelling gas, boiling point 6 °C. It is made by dehydrating malonic acid with
P4O10.
P4 O10
HOOC− CH 2 - COOH ¾¾¾ ® O=C=C=C=O + 2H2O
150 °C
malonic acid
It is stable at −78 °C and the molecule is linear. At room temperature the gas polymerizes to a yellow
solid, and at higher temperatures to red and purple solids. The oxide reacts with H2O, giving malonic acid,
and with HCl and NH3 as follows:
C3O2 + 2HCl → CH2(COCl)2 acid chloride
C3O2 + 2NH3 → CH2(CONH2)2 amide
There are disputed reports that C5O2 is formed by thermolysis of C3O2. The only other stable suboxide is
C12O9. This is a white solid, and is the anhydride of mellitic acid C6(COOH)6.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.23 Sulphides of Carbon 423
10.22 | CARBONATES
There are two series of salts from carbonic acid H2CO3, namely carbonates CO2− 3 and hydrogencarbonates
HCO3− . The CO2− 3 ion is fat. The CO 4−
4 ion does not exist, even though SiO 4 does. This is probably
4−
because C is too small, and the situation is analogous to the formation of NO3 and PO3−
−
4 in Group 15. The
structure of the CO2−
3
ion may be represented as follows:
Electronic structure of 1s 2s 2p One orbital
carbon having gained used to
four electrons by form a
forming four bonds in p bond
CO32- three orbitals form s bonds: hence
the shape of the ion is a plane triangle
(sp2 hybridization)
The p bonding in the CO2− 3 ion is best described using a delocalized p molecular orbital covering all four
atoms. (See Chapter 3.)
Carbonate ions are colourless and hence the carbonates of Group 1 and 2 metals are white. Though
Ag+ salts are typically white, Ag2CO3 is yellow due to the strong polarizing effect of Ag+. (NH4)2CO3 and
Group 1 carbonates are readily soluble in water, except Li2CO3 which is only slightly soluble.
Na2CO3 + 2HCl → 2NaCl + CO2 + H2O
Group 1 carbonates are stable to heat, and melt without decomposing. Group 2 carbonates all decom•
pose if heated suffciently strongly. Their stability increases as the size of the metal ion increases. Most other
carbonates decompose easily.
heat
CaCO3 → CaO + CO2
600 C
CH 4 + 4S ¾Al
¾¾¾O ® CS 2 + 2H 2 S
2 3
or
silica gel
_
@edubuzznotes
424 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
+SiO2
H 2 SO4 + CaF2 ® HF ¾¾¾
+H 2 O
® SiF 4 ¾¾¾
+ H2O
® HF + {
Si(OH)4 or
SiO2 × 2H 2 O
SiO2 is an acidic oxide. It dissolves slowly in aqueous alkali, and more rapidly in fused alkalis MOH or
fused carbonates M2CO3, forming silicates.
SiO2 + NaOH → (Na2SiO3)n + Na4SiO4
This reaction accounts for ground glass stoppers sticking in reagent bottles containing NaOH. Of the
halogens, only fuorine attacks SiO2.
SiO2 + 2F2 → SiF4 + O2
_
@edubuzznotes
10.25 Oxides of Tin and Lead 425
Silica gel is amorphous and very porous. It is obtained by dehydrating silicic acid, and contains about
4% water. It is widely used as a drying agent, a catalyst, and in chromatography.
Kieselguhr is another form of SiO2. It is a fne white powder, and is used in fltration plants, as an
abrasive, and as an inert fller. (Gelignite is a mixture of the explosive nitrobenzene (liquid) and inert kie•
selguhr (solid).
All monoxides are also available except SiO under ordinary conditions. Here also, the order of acidic
character is as follows:
CO > GeO > SnO > PbO
¬¾¾¾¾® ¬¾¾¾¾¾® ¬¾¾¾¾¾¾¾
®
neutral distinctly amphoteric
acidic
Oxides of Tin
There are two oxides of tin, SnO (grey) and SnO2 (white).
Preparation
When SnC2O4 is heated in the absence and in presence of air, SnO and SnO2 are formed, respectively.
absence of air→ SnO + CO2 + CO
∆
SnC 2 O4 in
For SnO2: ∆
Sn + O2 strongly
heated→ SnO2
heated→ 5SnO2 + 5H 2 O
∆
H 2 Sn 5O11 ⋅ 4 H 2 O strongly
Properties
SnO and SnO2 are both amphoteric in nature which is supported by the following reactions with:
Acids:
SnO + H 2 SO4 ® SnSO4 + H 2 O
SnO + 2HCl ® SnCl 2 + H 2 O
SnO2 only reacts with (or dissolves) in hot conc. H2SO4; though it does not dissolve in aqua regia.
SnO2 + 2 H 2 SO4 ∆
→ Sn(SO4 )2 + 2 H 2 O
Alkali:
SnO + 2 NaOH+H 2 O ¾cold
¾® Na 2 [Sn(OH)4 ]
But under hot conditions Sn(II) is oxidized into Sn(IV).
2SnO + 2 NaOH hot
→ Na 2 SnO3 + Sn + H 2 O
_
@edubuzznotes
426 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
Oxides of Lead
There are four oxides of lead:
1. PbO: It exists in two forms, yellow variety is massicot and red or reddish-yellow variety is litharge.
2. PbO2: It is dark brown in clour.
3. Pb2O3: It is a mixed oxide of PbO ⋅ PbO2 reddish-yellow in colour.
4. Pb3O4: It is red in colour and known as red lead. It is also a mixed oxide of 2PbO ⋅ PbO2.
Preparation of PbO
This oxide can be prepared by heating Pb(NO3)2 or any of the higher oxides as follows:
∆
PbO + 2NO2 + 21 O2
Pb(NO3 )2 →
The reaction is generally not used to prepare PbO as Pb(NO3)2 is explosive in nature. Other reactions
that give PbO are as follows.
T > 600°C
→ PbO + 21 O2
PbO2
T > 600°C
→ 3PbO + 21 O2
Pb 3O4
T > 600°C
→ 2PbO + 21 O2
Pb 2 O3
_
@edubuzznotes
10.25 Oxides of Tin and Lead 427
Properties of PbO
PbO is amphoteric in nature as is depicted by its reactions with the following reactions with:
Acids:
PbO + 2 HNO3 ® Pb(NO3 )2 + H 2 O
PbO + 2 HCl ® PbCl 2 + H 2 O
PbO + H 2 SO4 ® PbSO4 + H 2 O
Alkali:
PbO + 2 NaOH + H 2 O ® Na 2 [Pb(OH)4 ]
Preparation of PbO2
This oxide can be prepared by the following methods.
Pb 3O4 + 4 HNO3 ® 2 Pb(NO3 )2 + PbO2 ¯ +2H 2 O
red lead
Properties of PbO2
PbO2 is also amphoteric in nature, as shown by the following reactions with
PbO2 does not react with HNO3 and observed as brown precipitate in earlier reactions of preparation.
Alkali:
Preparation of Pb2O3
Pb2O3 can be prepared by the following reaction:
2PbO + NaOCl hot
solution
in alkaline
→ Pb 2 O3 + NaCl
limited medium
amount
Properties of Pb2O3
On reaction of Pb2O3 with HNO3, brown precipitate of PbO2 is obtained which validates that Pb2O3 is a
mixed oxide of PbO ⋅ PbO2.
Pb 2 O3 + 2 HNO3 ® Pb(NO3 )2 + H 2 O + PbO2 ↓
Preparation of Pb3O4
When PbO is heated in the presence of air, it gains weight due to addition of oxygen.
350 ° C
6PbO + O2 ↽
500° C
2 Pb 3O4
⇀
Properties of Pb3O4
Pb3O4 decomposes at 500°C producing O2 and PbO as shown above. It reacts with different acids as follows:
10.26 | SILICATES
Occurrence in the Earth’s crust
About 95% of the Earth’s crust is composed of silicate minerals, aluminosilicate clays, or silica. These make
up the bulk of all rocks, sands, and their breakdown products clays and soil. Many building materials are
silicates: granite, slates, bricks, and cement. Ceramics and glass are also silicates.
The three most abundant elements are O, Si and Al. Together they make up 81% of the earth’s crust,
that is four out of fve atoms are one of these. This is a much higher abundance than in the earth as a whole
or in the universe.
Soluble silicates
Silicates can be prepared by fusing an alkali metal carbonate with sand in an electric furnace at about
1400 °C.
1400 °C SiO
Na 2 CO3
→ CO2 + Na 2 O
2
→ Na 4 SiO4 , (Na 2 SiO3 )n and others
The product is a soluble glass of sodium or potassium silicate. It is dissolved in hot water under pressure,
and is fltered from any insoluble material. The composition of the product varies, but is approximately
Na 2 Si 2 O5 ⋅ 6H 2 O. They are used in liquid detergent preparations to keep the pH high, so that grease and
fat can be dissolved by forming a soap. Soluble silicates must not be used if the water is hard, or they will
_
@edubuzznotes
10.27 Classification of Silicates 429
react with Ca2+ to form insoluble calcium silicate. Sodium silicate is also used as an adhesive (for example
for pasting paper, bonding paper pulp and corrugated cardboard), in asbestos roof tiles, in freproof paint
and putty, and in making silica gel. The majority of silicate minerals are very insoluble, because they have an
infnite ionic structure and because of the great strength of the Si—O bond.
Orthosilicates (neso-silicates)
A wide variety of minerals contain discrete (SiO4)4− tetrahedra, that is they share no corners (see Figure 10.17).
They have the formula M II2 [SiO4], where M may be Be, Mg, Fe, Mn or Zn, or MIV[SiO4], for example
ZrSiO4. Different structures are formed depending on the coordination number adopted by the metal.
In willemite Zn2[SiO4], and phenacite Be2[SiO4], the Zn and Be atoms have a coordination number of 4,
and occupy tetrahedral holes. In forsterite Mg2[SiO4], the Mg has a coordination number of 6 and occupies
octahedral holes.
O−
SiO44 ion
−
O
Si Si
O−
O
−
O−
Si
− −
Si2O76
−
ion
Cyclic silicates
If two oxygen atoms per tetrahedron are shared, ring structures may be formed of general formula
(SiO3 )2nn − (Figure 10.19). Rings containing three, four, six and eight tetrahedral units are known, but those
with three and six are the most common. The cyclic ion Si 3O6− 9 occurs in wollastonite Ca3[Si3O9] and in
_
@edubuzznotes
430 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
−
− −
−
− −
−
and
− −
− −
− − − −
−
Si3O 96− ion
−
Si6O12−
18 ion
Figure 10.19 Structure of cyclic silicates Si3 O96- and Si6 O12-
18 . (After T. Moeller.)
Chain silicates
Simple chain silicates or pyroxenes are formed by the sharing of the O atoms on two corners of each
tetrahedron with other tetrahedra. This gives the formula (SiO3 )2nn − (see Figures 10.20 and 10.21). A large
number of important minerals form chains, but there are a variety of different structures formed because the
arrangement of the tetrahedra in space may vary and thus affect the repeat distance along the chain. The
most common arrangement repeats after every second tetrahedron, for example in spodumene LiAl[(SiO3)2]
(which is the main source of Li), enstatite Mg2[(SiO3)2], and diopsite CaMg[(SiO3)2]. Wollastonite Ca3[(SiO3)3]
has a repeat unit of three tetrahedra, and others are known with repeat units of 4, 5, 6, 7, 9 and 12.
Double chains can be formed when two simple chains are joined together by shared oxygens. These
minerals are called amphiboles, and they are well known. There are several ways of forming double chains,
giving formulae (Si 2 O5 )2nn − , (Si 4 O11 )6nn − , (Si 6 O17 )10n − and others. (See Figure 10.22.)
(SiO3)2n
n
chain
(Si4O11)6n
n
chain
(Si2O5)n2n sheet
Three-dimensional silicates
Sharing all four corners of a SiO4 tetrahedron results in a three•dimensional lattice of formula SiO2 (quartz,
tridymite, cristobalite etc.). These contain no metal ions, but three•dimensional structures can form the
basis of silicate structures if there is isomorphous replacement of some of the Si4+ by Al3+ plus an additional
metal ion. This gives an infnite three•dimensional lattice, and the additional cations occupy holes in the
lattice. Replacing one quarter of the Si4+ in SiO2 with Al3+ gives a framework ion AlSi 3O8− . The cations are
usually the larger metal ions such as K+, Na+, Ca2+ or Ba2+. The smaller ions Fe3+, Cr3+ and Mn2+ which were
common in the chain and sheet silicates do not occur in the three•dimensional silicates because the cavi•
ties in the lattice are too large. Replacements of one quarter or one half of the Si atoms are quite common,
giving structures M I [AlSi 3O8 ] and M II [Al 2 Si 2 O8 ]. Such replacements result in three groups of minerals:
1. Feldspars
2. Zeolites
3. Ultramarines.
The feldspars are the most important rock forming minerals and constitute two thirds of the igneous
rocks. For example, granite is made up of feldspars, with some micas and quartz. Feldspars are divided into
two classes:
The orthoclases are more symmetrical than are plagioclases as K+ and Ba2+ are just the right size to ft into
the lattice whilst Na+ and Ca2+, being smaller, allow distortion.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.28 Glass 433
Zeolites
Zeolites have a much more open structure than the feldspars. The anion skeleton is penetrated by chan•
nels, giving a honeycomb•like structure. These channels are large enough to allow them to exchange certain
ions. They can also absorb or lose water and other small molecules without the structure breaking down.
Zeolites are often used as ion•exchange materials, and as molecular sieves. Natrolite Na2[Al2Si3O10] ⋅ 2H2O
is a natural ion exchanger. Permutit water softeners use sodium zeolites. Zeolites take Ca2+ ions from
hard water and replace them by Na+, thereby softening the water. The sodium zeolite natrolite gradually
becomes a calcium zeolite, and eventually has to be regenerated by treatment with a strong solution of
NaCl, when the reverse process takes place. In addition to naturally occurring minerals, many synthetic
zeolites have been made. Zeolites also act as molecular sieves by absorbing molecules which are small
enough to enter the cavities, but not those which are too big to enter. They can absorb water, CO2, NH3 and
EtOH, and they are useful for separating straight chain hydrocarbons from branched chain compounds.
The mineral lapis lazuli is a splendid blue colour and was highly prized as a pigment for oil paintings
in the middle ages. It contains ultramarine Na8[(AlSiO4)6]S2, in which the colour is produced by the poly•
sulphide ion. The ultramarines are a group of related compounds, which contain no water, but do contain
anions such as Cl - SO42 - and S 22 - . Some examples of ultramarines are:
ultramarine Na8[(AlSiO4)6]S2
sodalite Na8[(AlSiO4)6]Cl2
nosean Na8[(AlSiO4)6]SO4
10.28 | GLASS
A small amount of glass is made of silica. This has excellent properties, but very high temperatures are
needed to produce it. Silica glass is too expensive for general use, but is used in scientifc instruments.
The temperature required for melting can be reduced by adding various oxides to the melt, thus obtain•
ing silicate glass. A number of oxides may be used including Na2O, K2O, MgO, CaO, BaO, B2O3, Al2O3, PbO
and ZnO. Glass is a solid solution, and so its composition may vary. The amount of oxide added is not very
large, and so the SiO4 tetrahedra have a signifcant role in the structure. If only Na2O or K2O were used,
the glass would be water soluble. Normal domestic glass for windows is a calcium•alkali silicate glass made
by fusing the alkali metal carbonate, CaCO3 and SiO2. (The carbonates decompose to oxides on heating.)
If Na2CO3 is used we obtain soda glass, which is also used for cheap laboratory glassware. Using K2CO3
gives potash glass. Most of the CaO may be replaced by PbO, giving lead glass, which has a higher refractive
index, and is used for making optical parts and glass ornaments. If Al2O3 is used, Al3+ may be present in
the structure as a free metal ion, or it may replace Si4+ in SiO4 tetrahedra. If B2O3 is used, B3+ replaces some
Si4+ in the tetrahedral skeleton. Borosilicate glasses containing B, and sometimes Al as well, are important.
They have a low coeffcient of expansion, and can withstand heat changes without cracking. They contain
less alkali and so are less prone to chemical attack. Such glasses are widely used for laboratory equipment
as in Pyrex glassware.
Additives for fning, for decolorizing and for colouring may be used when making glass. Fining agents
such as NaNO3 or As2O3 are added to remove bubbles. The fning agent decomposes and gives off large
bubbles of gases in the melt, which sweep out the small bubbles that are always formed. Decolorizing
agents may be added to eliminate impurities and to obtain colourless glass. Fe3+ gives a yellow–brown
colour, a mixture of Fe3+ and Fe2+ gives a green colour and Fe2+ gives a light blue colour. Other colouring
agents may be added –Co2+ gives a deep blue, and colloidal particles of Cu give ruby•red colours. CaF2 is
sometimes added as a clouding agent to make opal glass.
_
@edubuzznotes
434 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
This is the main industrial method for making methyl and phenyl chlorosilanes which are of consid•
erable commercial importance in the production of silicones. The yield is about 70%, with varying
amounts of other products: MeSiCl3 (10%) and Me3SiCl (5%), and smaller amounts of Me4Si and SiCl4
and others such as MeSiHCl2. Both Grignard and direct methods yield a mixture of products, and very
careful fractionation is important as the boiling points are close: Me3SiCl (57.7 °C), MeSiCl3 (66.4 °C)
and Me2SiCl2 (69.6 °C).
Except for Ph3SiCl, which is solid, the products are volatile liquids. They are highly reactive and fammable
and the reaction with water is strongly exothermic.
Silicones
The silicones are a group of organosilicon polymers. They have a wide variety of commercial uses as fuids,
oils, elastomers (rubbers) and resins.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.29 Organosilicon Compounds and the Silicones 435
The complete hydrolysis of SiCl4 yields SiO2, which has a very stable three•dimensional structure. The
fundamental research of F. S. Kipping on the hydrolysis of alkyl substituted chlorosilanes led, not to the
expected silicon compound analogous to a ketone but to long•chain polymers called silicones.
R Cl R OH R
+2H2O −H2O
Si Si ´ Si O
−2HCl
R Cl R OH R
R R R R
−H2O
HO Si OH + HO Si OH HO Si O Si OH
R R R R
R R R
HO Si OH + HO Si O Si OH
R R R
R R R
HO Si O Si O Si OH etc.
R R R
The starting materials for the manufacture of silicones are alkyl or aryl substituted chlorosilanes. Methyl
compounds are mainly used, though some phenyl derivatives are used as well. Hydrolysis of dimethyldi•
chlorosilane (CH3)2SiCl2 gives rise to straight chain polymers and, as an active OH group is left at each end
of the chain, polymerization continues and the chain increases in length. (CH3)2SiCl2 is therefore a chain
building unit. Normally, high polymers are obtained.
HO Si O Si O Si O Si O Si O Si O Si OH
Hydrolysis under carefully controlled conditions can produce cyclic structures, with rings containing three,
four, fve or six Si atoms:
Me O Me Me Me
Si Si Me Si O Si Me
Me O O Me O O
Si Me Si O Si Me
Me Me Me Me
tris cyclo-dimethylsiloxane tetrakis cyclo-dimethylsiloxane
Hydrolysis of trimethylmonochlorosilane (CH3)3SiCl yields (CH3)3 SiOH trimethylsilanol as a volatile
liquid, which can condense, giving hexamethyldisiloxane. Since this compound has no OH groups, it cannot
polymerize any further.
_
@edubuzznotes
436 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
HO Si O Si O Si O Si OH + HO Si CH3
HO Si O Si O Si O Si O Si CH3
The hydrolysis of methyl trichlorosilane RSiCl3 gives a very complex cross•linked polymer.
O R
R Si O Si O
O O R
O Si O Si O Si O
R R O
In a similar way addition of a small amount of CH3SiCl3 to the hydrolysis mixture produces a few cross•
links, or provides a site for attaching other molecules. By controlled mixing of the reactants, any given type
of polymer can be produced.
Silicones are fairly expensive but have many desirable properties. They were originally developed as
electrical insulators, because they are more stable to heat than are organic polymers, and if they do break
down do not produce conducting materials as carbon does. They are resistant to heat, oxidation and most
chemicals. They are strongly water repellent, are good electrical insulators, and have non•stick properties
and anti•foaming; properties. Their strength and inertness are related to two factors:
1. Their stable silica•like skeleton of Si—O—Si—O—Si. The Si—O bond energy is very high (502 kJ mol −1 ).
2. The high strength of the Si—C bond.
Uses of silicones
1. Their water repellency arises because a silicone chain is surrounded by organic side groups, and looks
like an alkane from the outside. Silicone may be liquids, oils, greases, elastomers (rubbers) or resins.
2. The boiling point and viscosity increase with chain length, giving compounds ranging from watery
liquids to viscous oils and greases. The fuids are used as water repellents for treating masonry and
building. Glassware and fabrics. They are also included in car polish and shoe polish.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.30 Hydrides of Silicon 437
3. Silicone fuids are non•toxic and have a low surface tension. Addition of a few parts per million of a
silicone greatly reduces foaming in sewage disposal, textile dyeing, beer making (fermentation) and
frothing of cooking oil in making potato crisps or chips.
4. Silicone oils are used as dielectric insulating material in high voltage transformers. They are also used
as hydraulic fuids.
5. Methyl silicones can be used as light duty lubricating oil, but are not suitable for heavy duty applications
like gearboxes, because the oil flm breaks down under high pressure. Silicones with some phenyl
groups are better lubricants. These oils can be mixed with lithium stearate soaps to give greases.
6. Silicone rubbers are made of long, straight chain polymers, (dimethyl•polysiloxanes) between 6000
and 600 000 Si units long, mixed with a fller – usually fnely divided SiO2 or occasionally graphite.
7. Silicone rubbers are useful because they retain their elasticity from –90 °C to +250 °C, which is a much
wider range than for natural rubber. They are also good electrical insulators.
More recently monosilane has been prepared by reducing SiCl4 with Li[AlH4], LiH or NaH in ether solution
at low temperatures. This is a much better method, as it gives one product rather than a mixture and it gives
a quantitative yield.
SiCl4 + Li[AlH4] → SiH4 + AlCl3 + LiCl
_
@edubuzznotes
438 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
Compounds with Si—H bonds undergo an important hydrosilation reaction with alkenes, in the presence
of a platinum catalyst. The reaction is similar to hydroboration, and the products may be used to make
silicones.
RCH=CH2 + SiHCl3 → RCH2CH2SiCl3
The difference in behaviour between alkanes and silanes is attributed to several factors:
1. Pauling’s electronegativity values are: C = 2.5, Si = 1.8. and H = 2.1. Thus the bonding electrons between
C and H or Si and H are not equally shared, leaving a d − charge on C and a d + charge on Si. Thus Si is
vulnerable to attack by nucleophilic reagents.
10.31 | COMPLEXES
The ability to form complexes is favoured by a high charge, small size and availability of empty orbitals of
the right energy. Carbon is in the second period and has a maximum of eight electrons in its outer shell. In
four•covalent compounds of carbon, the second shell contains the maximum of eight electrons. Because
this structure resembles that of a noble gas, these compounds are stable, and carbon does not form com•
plexes. Four•covalent compounds of the subsequent elements can form complexes due to the availability of
d orbitals, and they generally increase their coordination number from 4 to 6.
SiF4 + 2F − → [SiF6]2−
3s 3p 3d
Electronic structure full
of silicon atom in inner
ground state shells
Silicon atom in
excited state
The arguments over hybridizing d orbitals have been discussed in Chapter 3. The [SiF6 ]2− ion is usually
formed from SiO2 and aqueous HF. The [SiF6 ]2− complex is stable in water.
SiO2 + 6HF → 2H+ + [SiF6 ]2− + 2H2O
Lead tetraacetate Pb(CH3COO)4 can be obtained as a colourless, solid by treating Pb3O4 with glacial
acetic acid. It is water sensitive, and is widely used as a selective oxidizing agent in organic chemistry. Its
best known application is in the cleavage of 1, 2•diols (glycols), as present, for example, in carbohydrates.
C OH Pb(CH3COO)4
C O C O
Pb(CH3COO)2 + + Pb(CH3COO)2
C OH C O C O
H3Si SiH3
N
N
H3C CH3
CH3 SiH3
1s 2s 2p
Electronic structure of
nitrogen atom – ground state
In trisilylamine, three sp2 orbitals are used for σ bonding, giving a plane triangular structure. The lone pair
of electrons occupy a p orbital at right angles to the plane triangle. This overlaps with empty d orbitals
_
@edubuzznotes
440 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
on each of the three silicon atoms, and results in p bonding, more accurately described as pp−dp bonding,
because it is from a full p orbital to an empty d orbital. This shortens the bond lengths N—Si. Since the
nitrogen no longer has a lone pair of electrons, the molecule has no donor properties Similar pp–dp bond•
ing is impossible in (CH3)3N because C does not possess d orbitals and hence this molecule is pyramidal.
About 200 compounds are now thought to contain pp–dp bonds (Figure 10.26).
+
− + + Si
+
Si
− +
N
−
Si
+ − −
−
10.33 | HALIDES
Tetrahalides
+
All the tetrahalides are known except PbI4. They are typically covalent, + −
tetrahedral, and very volatile. The exceptions are SnF4 and PbF4, which
have three•dimensional structures and are high melting (SnF4 sublimes
+
at 705 °C, PbF4 melts at 600 °C). The elements after C have d orbitals −
−
available, and the Si–F, Si–Cl and Si–O bonds are stronger than the cor•
responding bonds with C. This is thought to be due to the donation of F Si
electrons from F, Cl or O to Si, giving rise to pp–dp bonding (see Figure
10.27). Figure 10.27 pp–dp overlap
in SiF4.
Carbon
Tetrafuoromethane (carbon tetrafuoride) CF4 is an exceptionally unreactive gas. It can be made as follows:
CO2 + SF4 → CF4 + SO2
SiC + 2F2 → SiF4 + CF4
CF2Cl2 + F2 → CF4 + Cl2 (industrial method)
Other fuorine compounds such as hexafuoroethane C2F6 and tetrafuoro•ethylene C2F4 are known. Under
pressure C2F4 polymerizes to (C2F4)n, giving polytetrafuoroethylene or PTFE. This is a hard, white solid plas•
tic with a greasy feel to the touch, and is much heavier (more dense) than one would expect. It is a good elec•
trical insulator, and is chemically inert. It is expensive, and is used in the laboratory because of its inertness.
It has a very low coeffcient of friction and is used for coating non•stick pans and razor blades. Fluorocarbons
are useful lubricants, solvents and insulators.
SbFCl catalyst
4
CHCl 3 + HF → CF2 ClH heat
→ C 2 F4
pressure
C 2 F4 → (C 2 F4 )n
_
@edubuzznotes
10.33 Halides 441
The carbon halides are not hydrolysed under normal conditions because they have no d orbitals, and cannot
form a fve•coordinate hydrolysis intermediate. In contrast the silicon halides hydrolyse readily. Silicon has
3d orbitals available, and these may be used to coordinate OH − ions or water as a frst step in hydrolysis.
In any atom there are always empty orbitals, but these are usually too high in energy to be used. If suffcient
energy is provided by using superheated steam then CCl4 will hydrolyse:
superheated
CCl 4 + H 2 O
steam → COCl 2 + 2HCl
carbonyl
chloride
(phosgene)
Phosgene is highly toxic, and was used as a poisonous gas in World War I. It is now made by combining CO
and Cl2 with a C catalyst in sunlight, and is used to make isocyanates for the manufacture of polyurethanes.
Freons
Mixed chlorofuorocarbons (sometimes called CFCs) such as CFCl3. CF2Cl2 and CF3Cl are known as Freons.
They are unreactive and non•toxic and are widely used as refrigeration fuids, as the propellant in aerosols,
and for washing computer boards.
Freons are very much more effective ‘greenhouse gases’ in the atmosphere than is CO2, though the
amount of Freons present is extremely small. Much more seriously, the Freons have penetrated the upper
atmosphere (5–20 miles high), and are causing damage to the ozone layer. The ozone layer is important as
it flters the radiation from the sun and prevents most of the harmful UV radiation from reaching the earth.
Excessive exposure to UV radiation should be avoided as it causes skin cancer (melanoma) in humans.
In the upper atmosphere Freons undergo a photolytic reaction and produce free chlorine atoms (which
are radicals). These react readily with ozone. The ClO radicals formed decompose slowly, re•forming chlo•
rine radicals, which react with more ozone and so on. The chlorine radicals do not recombine to form Cl2,
because they need a three•body collision to dissipate the energy, and such collisions are extremely rare in
the upper atmosphere. There is no effective sink for chlorine radicals. Once formed they are used again and
again, so a small number of radicals make a very effective scavenger for ozone.
CFCl3
photolysis
CF2Cl2 Cl
CF3Cl
rapid
Cl+ O3 O2 + ClO
ClO Cl + O
ClO + O Cl + O2
the soil. CO2 is an alternative propellant, but when cold it has a low vapour pressure and is therefore no use
for windscreen de•icers. Butane also gives diffculties, since it is fammable, and cannot be used with food.
Silicon
The silicon halides can be prepared by heating either Si or SiC with the appropriate halogen. In marked
contrast to the inertness of CF4, CCl4 and the Freons, SiF4 is readily hydrolysed by alkali.
The silicon halides are rapidly hydrolysed by water to give silicic acid.
SiCl4 + 4H2O → Si(OH)4 + 4HCl
In the case of the tetrafuoride, a secondary reaction occurs between the resultant HF and the unchanged
SiF4, forming the hexafuorosilicate ion [SiF6]2−
SiF4 + 2HF → 2H+ + [SiF6]2−
SiCl4 is commercially important. Small amounts are used to make ultra pure Si for transistors. Large
quantities of SiCl4 are hydrolysed at a high temperature (in an oxy•hydrogen fame) giving very fnely pow•
dered SiO2 rather than Si(OH)4. This ultrafne SiO2 is used as a thixotropic agent in polyester and epoxy
paints and resins, and as an inert fller in silicone rubber.
Other members of the series SinX2n+2 can be produced by pyrolysis (strong heating). These are either
volatile liquids or solids. The longest chains known are Si16F34, Si6Cl14 and Si4Br10. The chains are longer
than those formed in the hydrides. This is due to pp–dp bonding from full halogen p orbitals with d orbit•
als on Si.
SiCl4 + Si → Si2Cl6 + higher members of the series (Si6Cl14)
In the presence of excess acid, halides of Si, Sn and Pb increase their coordination number from 4 to 6,
and form complex ions, such as [SiF6]2–, [SnCl6]2– and [SnCl5]–. PbI4 is not known, probably because of the oxi•
dizing power of Pb(+ IV) and the reducing power of I − , which results in PbI2 always being formed.
Catenated halides
Carbon forms a number of catenated halides, perhaps the best known being Tefon or polytetrafuoroethylene,
which is described above. The polymers formed have chain lengths of several hundred carbon atoms.
Silicon forms polymers (SiF2)n and (SiCl2)n by passing the tetrahalide over heated silicon. These
polymers decompose on heating into low molecular weight polymers (or oligomers) of formula SinX2n+2.
The longest chains known are Si16F34, Si6Cl14 and Si4Br10. Sn and Pb do not form any catenated halides.
_
@edubuzznotes
Single Correct Choice Type Questions 443
Dihalides
There is a steady increase in the stability of dihalides:
CX2 << SiX2 < GeX2 < SnX2 < PbX2
SiF2 can be made by high temperature reactions, and can be trapped by cooling in liquid N2. When the
product warms up, polymerization occurs giving a range of compounds up to Si16F34.
SiF4 + Si ⇌ 2SiF2
SnF2 and SnCl2 are white solids, and are obtained by heating Sn or SnO with gaseous HF or HCl. SnCl2
partly hydrolyses in water, forming the basic chloride Sn(OH)Cl. SnF2 and SnCl2 both dissolve in solutions
containing halide ions.
SnF2 + F − → [SnF3 ] pK ~ 1
−
−
SnCl2 + Cl − → [SnCl 3 ] pK ~ 2
Sn2+ ions do occur in perchlorate solutions, but the stannous ion is readily oxidized by air to SnIV unless
precautions are taken. The compounds PbX2 are much more stable than PbX4. Pb is the only element in
the group with well defned cations. The salts PbX2 can all be made from a water soluble Pb2+ salt and the
corresponding halide ion or halogen acid.
1. When CO2 dissolves in water, the ions that are present Compound A can also be prepared by heating charcoal
in equilibrium are and sulphur vapour at about 850°C.
(A) CO32-
(B) HCO3- 4. Which of the following properties are correct for A?.
(C) H3O+ (A) It is highly infammable.
(D) All of these (B) It is very poisonous, affecting brain and central
nervous system.
2. A hydrate of CO2 can also be formed at 0°C under a (C) It is a colourless volatile liquid having very low
pressure of 50 atm of CO2. The formula of the hydrate fash point (30°C).
of CO2 is (D) All of these
(A) CO2 · 2H2O
(B) CO2 · 4H2O 5. For the following reaction, which of the following
(C) CO2 · 6H2O statements is incorrect regarding B and C?
(D) CO2 · 8H2O A + NaOH solution ® B + C + H 2O
3. Again H2O and CO2 are used by plants in a different
(A) Both B and C have planar anionic part.
manner during photosynthesis. The products of photo•
(B) B and C are isoelectronic (total number of
synthesis are
electrons).
(A) C6H12O6 + O2
(C) Both B and C are ionic compounds.
(B) C12H22O11 + O2
(D) None of these
(C) C12O22O11 + H2
(D) C6H12O6 + N2
_
@edubuzznotes
Integer Answer Type Questions 445
7. Find the number of planar species from the following. 9. Find the number of acidic oxides from the following.
CO , COCl2, SiO , C3O2, HCO , CS , C3S2
2- 2- - 2- CO, GeO, SnO, PbO2, SnO2, GeO2, SiO2
3 4 3 3
8. When SnC2O4 is heated in absence of air, fnd the dif• 10. Find the number of water of crystallization in mol•
ference in oxidation states of carbon atoms in gaseous ecule of butter of tin.
products.
Si O Si O Si O Si O
2. Match the chlorosilanes with the compounds they O
yield on hydrolysis. Me Me Me Me
Column I Column II 3. Match the reaction with the nature of the product
obtained.
(A) Me O Me (P) Only
Si Si Column I Column II
Me Me Me2SiCl2
O O
Si (A) Diamond (P) All atoms are sp2 hybridized.
Me Me (B) Graphite (Q) dC – C is maximum.
(B) Me Me (Q) Me2SiCl2 + (C) Fullerene (R) Does not exist as discrete
Me3SiCl molecules.
Me Si O Si Me
(S) Ring structure is existing.
Me Me
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (B) 3. (D) 5. (A) 7. (D) 9. (A)
2. (D) 4. (C) 6. (D) 8. (D)
The elements of this group all have fve electrons in their outer shell (Table 10.14). They exhibit a
maximum oxidation state of fve towards oxygen by using all fve outer electrons in forming bonds. The
tendency for the pair of s electrons to remain inert (the inert pair effect) increases with increasing atomic
weight. Thus, only the p electrons are used in bonding and trivalency results. Valencies of three and fve
are shown with the halogens and with sulphur. The hydrides are trivalent. Nitrogen exhibits a very wide
range of oxidation states: (–III) in ammonia NH3, (–II) in hydrazine N2H4, (–I) in hydroxylamine NH2OH,
(0) in dinitrogen N2, (+I) in nitrous oxide N2O, (+II) in nitric oxide NO, (+III) in nitrous acid HNO2, (+IV)
in nitrogen dioxide NO2 and (+V) in nitric acid HNO3. The negative oxidation states arise because the
electronegativity of H = 2.1 and that for N = 3.0.
Phosphorus
Phosphorus is solid at room temperature. White phosphorus is soft, waxy and reactive. It reacts with moist
air and gives out light (chemiluminescence). It ignites spontaneously in air at about 35 °C, and is stored
under water to prevent this. It is highly toxic. It exists as tetrahedral P4 molecules, and the tetrahedral
structure remains in the liquid and gaseous states. Above 800 °C P4 molecules in the gas begin to dissociate
into P2 molecules, which have a bond energy of 489.6 kJ mol −1. (This is only half the value for N2 because
the orbitals in the third shell are much larger and give relatively poor pπ–pπ overlap.) If white phosphorus
is heated to about 250 °C, or a lower temperature in the presence of sunlight, then red phosphorus is
formed. This is a polymeric solid, which is much less reactive than white phosphorus. It is stable in air and
does not ignite unless it is heated to 400 °C. It need not be stored under water. It is insoluble inorganic
solvents. Heating white phosphorus under high pressure results in a highly polymerized form of P called
black phosphorus. This is thermodynamically the most stable allotrope. It is inert and has a layer structure
(Figure 10.28). Other more doubtful allotropes have been reported.
Bond type
The majority of compounds formed by this group are covalent.
s p
Outer electronic structure
of group 15 element
Reactivity
Dinitrogen is relatively unreactive, which is why it has accumulated in such large amounts in the atmosphere.
White phosphorus catches fre when exposed to air, burning to form P4O10. It is stored under water to
prevent this. Red phosphorus is stable in air at room temperature, though it reacts on heating.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.36 Hydrides 451
10.36 | HYDRIDES
The elements all form volatile hydrides of formula MH3, which are all poisonous, foul smelling gases. On
descending the group from NH3 to BiH3:
1. The hydrides become increasingly diffcult to prepare.
2. Their stability decreases.
3. Their reducing power increases.
4. The ease of replacing the hydrogen atoms by other groups such as Cl or Me decreases.
5. Their ability to act as electron donors, using the lone pair of electrons for coordinate bond formation,
decreases.
Ammonia NH3
NH3 is a colourless gas with a pungent odour. The gas is quite poisonous. It dissolves very readily in water
with the evolution of heat. At 20 °C and one atmosphere pressure 53.1 g NH3 dissolves in 100 g water. This
corresponds to 702 volumes of NH3 dissolving in 1 volume of H2O. In solution ammonia forms ammonium
hydroxide NH4OH, and behaves as a weak base.
NH3 + H2O ⇌ NH 4+ + OH − K = 1.8 × 105 mol l −1
NH3 and NH4OH both react with acids, forming ammonium salts. These salts resemble potassium salts
in solubility and in their crystal structures. Like the Group 1 salts, ammonium salts are typically colourless.
There are some differences. Ammonium salts are usually slightly acidic if they have been formed with
strong acids such as HNO3, HCl and H2SO4, since NH4OH is only a weak base. Ammonium salts decompose
quite readily on heating. If the anion is not particularly oxidizing (e.g. Cl − , CO2−
3 or SO 4 ) then ammonia
2−
is evolved:
NH 4 Cl heat
→ NH 3 + HCl
(NH 4 )2 SO4 heat
→ 2NH 3 + H 2 SO4
If the anion is more oxidizing (e.g. NO 2− , NO 3− , ClO4− , Cr2 O72− then NH 4+ is oxidized to N2 or N2O.
- III +III 0
NH 4 NO2 ¾heat
¾¾ ® N 2 + 2H 2 O
- III +V +I
NH 4 NO3 ¾heat
¾¾ ® N 2 O + 2H 2 O
3. By forming dense white clouds of NH4Cl with the stopper from a bottle of HCl.
4. By forming a yellow–orange–brown precipitate with Nessler’s solution.
Most of ammonia is manufactured synthetically from H2 and N2 by the Haber–Bosch process (see later).
Ammonia can also be obtained from the hydrolysis of calcium cyanamide, CaNCN. Calcium cyanamide is
usually used as a fertilizer, and this reaction occurs slowly in the soil.
CaNCN + 3H2O → 2NH3 + CaCO3
Ammonium salts
Ammonium salts are all very soluble in water. They all react with NaOH, liberating NH3. The NH 4 ion is
+
Phosphine PH3
Phosphine PH3 is a colourless and extremely toxic gas, which smells slightly of garlic or bad fsh. It is highly
reactive. It can be formed either by hydrolysing metal phosphides such as Na3P or Ca3P2 with water, or by
hydrolysing white phosphorus with NaOH solution.
Ca3P2 + 6H2O → 2PH3 + 3Ca(OH)2
P4 + 3NaOH + 3H2O → PH3 + 3NaH2PO2
PH3, unlike NH3, is not very soluble in water: aqueous solutions are neutral. It is more soluble in CS2 and
other organic solvents. Phosphonium salts such as [PH4]+ Cl − can be formed, but require PH3 and anhydrous
HCl (in contrast to the ready formation of NH4X in aqueous solution). Pure PH3 is stable in air, but it
catches fre when heated to about 150 °C.
PH3 + 2O2 → H3PO4
PH3 frequently contains traces of diphosphine P2H4 which cause it to catch fre spontaneously. This is the
origin of the fickering light called will•o’•the•wisp, which is sometimes seen in marshes.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.36 Hydrides 453
c. PH 3 + 4 NO2 electric
spark
→ 4 N 2 + H 3 PO4
d. Formation of phosphides.
2PH 3 + 3CuSO4 → Cu 3 P2 + 3H 2 SO4
2PH 3 + 3HgCl 2 → Hg 3 P2 + 6 HCl
Electronic structure of 1s 2s 2p
nitrogen atom – ground
state
Nitrogen having gained a
share in three electrons
from three hydrogen
atoms in NH3 molecule
four orbitals in the outer shell
(three bond pairs and one lone pair)
tetrahedral arrangement with one
position occupied by a lone pair
_
@edubuzznotes
454 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
The hydrides PH3, AsH3 and SbH3 would be expected to be similar. However, the bond pairs of electrons
are much further away from the central atom than they are in NH3. Thus the lone pair causes even greater
distortion in PH3, AsH3 and SbH3. The bond angle decreases to 91°18′ (Table 10.17). These bond angles sug•
gest that in PH3, AsH3, SbH3 and BiH3 the orbitals used for bonding are close to pure p orbitals.
The melting and boiling points of the hydrides increase from PH3 through AsH3 to SbH3. The values
for NH3 seem out of line with this trend: one might have expected the boiling point of NH3 to be –110 °C or
–120 °C. The reason why NH3 has a higher boiling point and is much less volatile than expected is that it is
hydrogen bonded in the liquid state. The other hydrides do not form hydrogen bonds.
These hydrides are strong reducing agents and react with solutions of metal ions to give phosphides,
arsenides and stibnides. They are fammable and extremely poisonous.
Donor properties
NH3 can donate its lone pair of electrons quite strongly to form complexes. Thus ammonia forms ammo•
nium NH +4 salts, and also coordination complexes with metal ions from the Co, Ni, Cu and Zn groups, for
example the [Co(NH3)6]3+ ion, very readily.
PH3 acts as an electron donor and forms numerous complexes such as [F3B ← PH3], [Cl3Al ← PH3]
and [Cr(CO)3(PH3)3]. A variety of other trivalent phosphorus compounds such as PF3, PCl3, PEt3, P(OR)3
and PPh3 also form complexes, which in some ways resemble complexes with CO. Thus the lone pair on
P is used to form the coordinate bond to an empty orbital on the B or metal (a s bond). In the case of
metals, this original coordinate bond may be reinforced by back bonding from p overlap of a flled d orbital
on the metal with an empty d orbital on P.
The donor properties of the other hydrides are very weak, and they have little or no tendency to form
coordinate bonds.
In NH3 the lone pair occupies an sp3 hybrid orbital. In AsH3 and SbH3 the bond angles become close
to 90° which suggests that the orbitals used for M—H bonding are almost pure p orbitals. If the three
p orbitals are used for M—H bonding, the lone pair must occupy a spherical s orbital. This is larger, and
less directional, and hence less effective for forming a coordinate bond. This means that any s bond will be
very weak. In addition the 4d and 5d orbitals are too large for effective p back bonding. These two factors
account for the difference in complexing power between the hydrides.
Nitrogen forms several hydrides (see Table 10.18).
Table 10.18 Hydrides of nitrogen
Formula Name Oxidation state
NH3 Ammonia –III
N2H4 Hydrazine –II
NH2OH Hydroxylamine –I
Hydrazine N2H4
Hydrazine is a covalent liquid, which fumes in air, and smells similar to NH3. Pure hydrazine burns readily
in air with the evolution of a large amount of heat.
N2H4(l) + O2(g) → N2(g) + 2H2O ΔH = − 621 kJ mol−1
_
@edubuzznotes
10.36 Hydrides 455
The methyl derivatives MeNHNH2 and Me2NNH2 are mixed with N2O4 and used as a rocket fuel in the
space shuttle, in guided missiles, and (earlier) in the Apollo lunar modules.
N2H4 is a weak base and reacts with acids, forming two series of salts. The salts are white ionic crystal•
line solids, and are soluble in water.
N 2 H 4 + HX → N 2 H +5 + X −
N 2 H 4 + 2HX → N 2 H 62+ +2X −
When dissolved in water (in neutral or basic solutions) hydrazine or its salts are powerful reducing agents.
They are used to produce silver and copper mirrors and to precipitate the platinum metals. Hydrazine also
reduces I2 and O2.
N2H4 + 2I2 → 4HI + N2
N2H4 + 2O2 → 2H2O2 + N2
N2H4 + 2CuSO4 → Cu + N2 + 2H2SO4
In acidic solutions, hydrazine usually behaves as a mild reducing agent, though powerful reducing agents
can reduce N2H4 to NH3, thus causing N2H4 to be oxidized.
− II − III
N 2 H 4 +Zn + 2HCl → 2N H 3 + ZnCl 2
Hydrazine may act as an electron donor. The N atoms have a lone pair of electrons, which can form coor•
dinate bonds to metal ions such as Ni2+ and Co2+.
Most of hydrazine produced is used as rocket fuel. It is also used to treat the boiler feed water in
power stations to prevent oxidation of the boiler and pipes. In the laboratory phenylhydrazine is used
to characterize carbonyl compounds and sugars by forming crystalline derivatives called osazones.
CH 2 . OH CH 2 . OH
| |
(CH . OH)3 (CH . OH)3
| → |
CH . OH CH . OH
| |
CHO + H 2 N NHC 6 H 5 CH = N NHC 6 H 5 + H 2 O
glucose phenylhydrazine glucose phenylhydrazone
(an osazone)
Hydrazine is still manufactured by the Raschig process, in which ammonia is oxidized by sodium
hypochlorite in dilute aqueous solution.
NH3 + NaOCl → NH2Cl + NaOH (fast)
A side reaction between chloramine and hydrazine may destroy some or all of the product.
N2H4 + 2NH2Cl → N2 + 2NH4Cl
This reaction is catalyzed by heavy metal ions present in solution. For this reason distilled water is used
(rather than tap water), and glue or gelatin is added to mask (i.e. complex with) the remaining metal ions.
The use of excess of ammonia reduces the incidence of chloramine reacting with hydrazine. The use of a
dilute solution of the reactants is necessary to minimize another side reaction:
3NH2Cl + 2NH3 → N2 + 3NH4Cl
The hydrazine is concentrated by distillation yielding N 2 H 4 ⋅ H 2 O, or by adding H2SO4 to precipitate the
salt N 2 H 4 ⋅ H 2 SO4 .
_
@edubuzznotes
456 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
Electron diffraction and infrared data indicate that the structure of hydrazine is related to that of
ethane. Each N atom is tetrahedrally surrounded by one N, two H and a lone pair. The two halves of the
molecule are rotated 95° about the N—N bond and adopt a gauche (non•eclipsed) conformation. The
N—N bond length is 1.45 Å.
Phosphorus forms an unstable hydride P2H4, which has very little chemical similarity to N2H4.
H
:
: N N H
H H
Hydroxylamine NH2OH
Hydroxylamine forms colourless crystals that melt at 33 °C. It is thermally unstable and decomposes into
NH3, N2, HNO2 and N2O easily. It explodes if heated strongly. It is usually handled in aqueous solution, or
as one of its salts, since these are more stable than free NH2OH,
Hydroxylamine is a weaker base than is ammonia or hydrazine. Salts contain the hydroxylammonium
ion [NH3OH]+.
NH2OH + HCl → [NH3OH]+ Cl −
NH2OH + H2SO4 → [NH3OH]+ HSO4−
The appropriate reduction potentials suggest that hydroxylamine should disproportionate. It dispropor•
tionates slowly in acidic solutions:
−I +I − III
4[NH 2 OH ⋅ H]+ → N 2 O + 2NH +4 + 2H + + 3H 3 O
Both NH2OH and its salts are very poisonous, and they are also strong reducing agents.
Hydroxylamine is manufactured by reducing nitrites, or from nitromethane:
Hydroxylamine has donor properties (like NH3 and N2H4): the N atom can form coordinate bonds, and can
complex with metals. In addition it adds easily to double bonds in organic molecules, and thus provides an
easy way of introducing N atoms into molecules.
NH2OH is manufactured in large quantities to make cyclohexanone oxime, which is convserted to
caprolactam and then polymerized to give nylon•6 (Figure 10.30).
O
O NOH
C
NH2OH oleum
NH CO NH (CH2)5 CO NH
n
CH2 Nylon 6
Cyclohexanone Cyclohexanone
Caprolactam
oxime
2H 2 O ⇌ H 3O+ + OH −
2NH 3 ⇌ NH +4 + NH 2−
Thus, substances which produce H3O+ ions in water are acids, and ammonium salts are acids in liquid ammonia.
Similarly, substances producing OH − in water or NH 2− in liquid ammonia are bases in that solvent.
Thus acid – base neutralization reactions occur in both solvents, and phenolphthalein may be used to
detect the end point in either:
In a similar way, precipitation reactions occur in both solvents. However, the direction of the reaction is a
function of the solvent:
Liquid ammonia is an extremely good solvent for the alkali metals and the heavier Group 2 metals Ca, Sr
and Ba. The metals are very soluble and solutions in liquid ammonia have a conductivity comparable to that
of pure metals. The ammonia solvates the metal ions, but is resistant to reduction by the free electrons. These
solutions of metals in liquid ammonia are very good reducing agents because of the presence of free electrons.
Liq . NH
Na ¾¾¾¾
3
® [Na(NH 3 )n ]+ + e
Solutions of ammonium salts in liquid ammonia are used to clean the cooling systems in some nuclear
reactors. Liquid sodium is used to cool fast breeder nuclear reactors. Liquid ammonia is a good solvent for
metals, but the surfaces are left wet with NH3. When this evaporates it may leave a trace of fnely divided
sodium which is pyrophoric. Thus it is necessary to destroy the sodium by using an acid such as an ammo•
nium salt in liquid ammonia.
in NH
2 NH 4 Br + 2 Na
3
→ 2 NaBr + H 2 + 2 NH 3
Because liquid ammonia accepts protons readily, it enhances the ionization of so•called weak acids such as
acetic acid.
CH 3 ⋅ COOH ⇌ CH 3 ⋅ COO− + H+
_
@edubuzznotes
458 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
The NH3 removes H+ and thus causes the reaction to proceed in the forward direction. Thus acetic acid has
a pKa value of 5 in water but is almost completely ionized in liquid ammonia. Ammonia thus reduces the
difference between the strengths of acids. In this respect ammonia is called a levelling solvent.
Covalent azides are used as detonators and explosives. Ionic azides are
N3
usually much more stable, and some are used as organic intermediates and N3
N
dyestuffs. C C
The most important method of making azides is by passing nitrous oxide
gas into fused sodamide at 190 °C under anhydrous conditions. The water N N
vapour produced reacts with more sodamide. Alternatively nitrous oxide
C
can be passed into a solution of sodamide in liquid ammonia as a solvent.
N 2 O + NaNH 2 → NaN 3 + H 2 O
N3
H 2 O + NaNH 2 → NH 3 + NaOH
N 2 O + 2NaNH 2 → NaN 3 + NH 3 + NaOH Figure 10.31 Structure of
cyanuric triazide.
The sodium azide so obtained may be converted to hydrogen azide by
treatment with H2SO4 followed by distillation. Lead azide Pb(N3)2 can be precipitated from a solution
of sodium azide and a soluble lead salt such as Pb(NO3)2. Pb(N3)2 is sensitive to shock and is used as a
detonator to set off a high explosive charge. It is particularly reliable, and works even in damp conditions.
Numerous other metal azides are known. Cyanuric triazide is a powerful explosive (Figure 10.31).
The (N3)¯ ion is considered as a pseudohalide ion. It forms the extremely unstable and explosive
compounds fuorazide FN3 chlorazide ClN3, bromazide BrN3, and iodazide IN3, but the dimer N3—N3 is
unknown.
Analysis of N 3− is by reduction with H2S.
NaN3 + H2S + H2O → NH3 + N2 + S + NaOH
The N ion has 16 outer electrons and is isoelectronic with CO2. The N 3− ion is linear (N—N—N) as
−
3
is CO2. There is a total of two σ and two p bonds, giving N = N = N and s bond order of 2. Both N—N
bonds are the same length, 1.16 Å.
The hydrogen azide molecule has a bent structure. The addition of the extra electron from H means
that one electron must now occupy an antibonding MO, and hence the two N–N bond lengths are different:
112°
The bond angle H—N—N is 112°, and the two N—N bonds are of signifcantly different lengths, and the
bond orders are probably 1.5 and 2 respectively.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.39 Nitrogen Fixation 459
Chemical processes involving the fxation of atmospheric dinitrogen include the Haber–Bosch process
for ammonia, and the formation of calcium cyanamide, which both involve the use of high temperatures
and pressure. Bacteria can fx dinitrogen easily at room temperature and atmospheric pressure, yet man
requires expensive plant with high temperatures and pressures to do the same.
There is considerable research interest into fnding transition metal catalysed systems which will absorb
dinitrogen and produce ammonia for fertilizers cheaply and without the necessity for high temperatures or pres•
sure. The frst dinitrogen complex, the pentaammine(dinitrogen)ruthenium cation, was made in 1965 by reduc•
ing ruthenium trichloride with hydrazine. Other methods have now been found, e.g. replacement of a labile
ligand in a complex by N2. Dinitrogen complexes have now been made for almost all the transition elements.
2+ 2+
Ru ( NH 3 )5 H 2 O + N 2 → Ru ( NH 3 )5 N 2
aqueous solution
The formation of this stable dinitrogen complex led to studies with other metals. Complexes with
titanium(II) are the most promising, and reduction of titanium alkoxides yields either ammonia or
hydrazine. A complete cycle of reactions for fxing atmospheric dinitrogen to ammonia has been reported:
Ti IV (OR )4 Na
→ Ti II (OR )2 + 2NaOR
N2
Ti(OR)2 [Ti(OR)2 N2]
reduce
[Ti(OR)2N2] [Ti(OR)2 N2]6−
+6H+
[Ti(OR2)N2]6- 2NH3 + Ti(OR)2
or
+
[Ti(OR)2 N 2 ] ¾reduce
¾¾® [Ti(OR)2 N 2 ]4 - ¾+4H
¾¾ ® N 2 H 4 + Ti(OR)2
Cyanamide process
Calcium cyanamide is used in large amounts as a nitrogenous fertilizer, and as a source of organic chemicals
such as melamine.
1100 C
CaC 2 + N 2 → CaNCN + C
CaNCN + 5H 2 O → CaCO3 + 2NH 4 OH
_
@edubuzznotes
460 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
Haber–Bosch process
The most important commercial process is the Haber–Bosch process. Fritz Haber discovered how to make
N2 and H2 combine directly in the laboratory. He was awarded the Nobel Prize for Chemistry in 1918.
Carl Bosch was a chemical engineer who developed the plant to make ammonia using this reaction on an
industrial scale. He too was awarded the Nobel Prize for Chemistry in 1931 for his work on high pressure
reactions.
N 2 + 3H 2 ⇌ 2NH 3 + heat
4 volumes 2 volumes
The reaction is reversible, and Le Chatelier’s principle suggests that a high pressure and low temperature
are required to drive the reaction to the right, and thus form NH3. A low temperature gives a higher percentage
conversion to NH3, but the reaction is slow in reaching equilibrium, and a catalyst is required. In practice
the conditions used are 200 atmospheres pressure, a temperature of 380–450 °C and a catalyst of promoted
iron. It is more economic to use a higher temperature, so that equilibrium will be reached much faster,
even though this gives a lower percentage conversion. At a temperature of about 400 °C a 15% conversion
is obtained with a single pass over the catalyst. The gas mixture is cooled to condense liquid NH3, and the
unchanged mixture of N2 and H2 gases is recycled. The plant is made of steel alloyed with Ni and Cr.
The catalyst is made by fusing Fe3O4 with KOH and a refractory material such as MgO, SiO2 or A12O3.
This is broken into small lumps and put into the ammonia convertor, where the Fe3O4 is reduced to give
small crystals of iron in a refractory matrix. This is the active catalyst.
The actual plant is more complicated than this one•stage reaction implies, since the N2 and H2 must be
made before they can be converted to NH3. The cost of H2 is of great importance for the economy of the
process. Originally the H2 required was produced by electrolysis of water. This was expensive, and a cheaper
method using coke and water was then used (water gas, producer gas). Nowadays the H2 is produced from
carbons, either naptha or CH4, by reacting with steam at 750 °C with a Ni catalyst. All traces of S must be
removed since these poison the catalyst.
CH 4 + 2H 2 O ⇌ CO2 + 4H 2
CH 4 + H 2 O ⇌ CO + 3H 2
Some air is added. The O2 burns with some of the H2, thus leaving N2 to give the required reaction ratio
N2 : H2 of 1:3.
(4N 2 + O2 ) + 2H 2 ⇌ 4N 2 + 2H 2 O
air
The widespread use of nitrates as fertilizers greatly boosts crop yields. Since nitrates are soluble, the run•off
water into lakes and rivers also contains nitrates. This causes several problems.
1. It produces increased growth of algae and other aquatic plants, which may clog up rivers and lakes, and
may make mudbanks in estuaries turn green.
2. There is concern that nitrates are harmful in drinking water. They cause a disease in babies called
methaemoglobinaemia, which reduces the amount of oxygen in the baby’s blood. In extreme forms
this causes the ‘blue baby syndrome’. There is also concern that nitrates could be linked with stomach
cancer. Because of this, the EEC have set a safety limit of 25ppm for nitrates in drinking water.
3. There is some concern that denitrifcation to oxides of nitrogen, particularly N2O, may harm the ozone
layer.
Urea
Urea is widely used as a nitrogenous fertilizer. It is very soluble, and hence quick acting, but it is easily
washed away. It has a very high nitrogen content (46%). It is manufactured from NH3, and the reaction
proceeds in two stages.
180 - 200 C
2NH 3 + CO2 ¾¾¾¾¾¾ ® NH 2 COONH 4 ¾D¾® NH 2 × CO × NH 2 + H 2 O
high pressure
ammonium urea
carbonate
In the soil, urea slowly hydrolyses to ammonium carbonate.
NH2CONH2 + 2H2O → (NH4)2CO3
Phosphate fertilizers
Phosphate rocks such as fuoroapatite [3Ca3(PO4)2 CaF2] are very insoluble, and thus are of no use to plants.
Superphosphate is made by treating phosphate rock with concentrated H2SO4. The acid salt Ca(H2PO4)2 is
more soluble, and over a period of weeks the superphosphate will dissolve in the soil water.
The CaSO4 is an insoluble waste product, and is of no value to plants, but is not removed from the product
sold.
_
@edubuzznotes
462 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
‘Triple superphosphate’ is made in a similar way, using H3PO4 to avoid the formation of the waste product
CaSO4.
[3Ca 3 (PO4 )2 × CaF2 ] + 14 H 3 PO4 ¾¾
® 10Ca(H 2 PO4 )2 + 2HF
triple
superphospa
ahte
10.41 | HALIDES
Trihalides
All the possible trihalides of N, P, As, Sb and Bi are known. The nitrogen compounds are the least stable.
Though NF3 is stable, NCl3 is explosive. NBr3 and NI3 are known only as their unstable ammoniates NBr3·
6NH3 and NI3· 6NH3. The latter compound can be made by dissolving I2 in 0.880 NH4OH. It detonates
unless excess ammonia is present, and students are warned not to prepare this compound. The other
16 trihalides are stable.
The trihalides are predominantly covalent and, like NH3, have a tetrahedral structure with one position
occupied by a lone pair. The exceptions are BiF3 which is ionic and the other halides of Bi and SbF3 which
are intermediate in character.
The trihalides typically hydrolyse readily with water, but the products vary depending on the element:
NCl3 + 4H2O → NH4OH + 3HOCl
PCl3 + 3H2O → H3PO3 + 3HCl
AsCl3 + 3H2O → H3AsO3 + 3HCl
SbCl3 + H2O → SbO+ + 3Cl − + 2H+
BiCl3 + H2O → BiO+ + 3Cl - + 2H+
They also react with NH3. For example,
PCl3 + 6NH3 → P(NH2)3 + 3NH4Cl
NF3 behaves differently from the others. It is unreactive, rather like CF4, and does not hydrolyse with water,
dilute acids or alkali. It does react if sparked with water vapour.
PF3 is rather less reactive towards water and is more easily handled than the other halides. The
trihalides, particularly PF3, can act as donor molecules using their lone pair to form a coordinate bond,
for example in Ni(PF3)4. In addition to this s bond, there is p backbonding from a flled orbital on the
metal to an empty d orbital on P, similar to the way CO acts as a ligand. Ni(PF3)4 can be made from nickel
carbonyl Ni(CO)4.
Ni(CO)4 + 4PF3 → Ni(PF3)4 + 4CO
Many trifuorophosphine complexes of the transition metals are known. Though most of the trihalides are
made from the elements, PF3 is made by the action of CaF2 (or other fuoride) on PCl3. PF3 is a colourless,
odourless gas, which is very toxic because it forms a complex with haemoglobin in the blood, thus starving
the body of oxygen.
NF3 has little tendency to act as a donor molecule. The molecule is tetrahedral with one position occu•
pied by a lone pair, and the bond angle F—N—F is 102°30′. However, the dipole moment is very low
(0.23 Debye units) compared with 1.47D for NH3. The highly electronegative F atoms attract electrons, and
these moments partly cancel the moment from the lone pair, and this reduces both the dipole moment and
its donor power.
The trihalides also show acceptor properties, and can accept an electron pair from another ion such as
F − , forming complex ions such as [SbF5 ]2 − and [Sb 2 F7 ] − . They also react with a variety of organometallic
reagents, forming compounds MR3.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.41 Halides 463
PCl3 is the most important trihalide and some of it is used to make PCl5.
PCl3 + Cl2 (or S2Cl2) → PCl5
PCl3 is widely used in organic chemistry to convert carboxylic acids to acid chlorides, and alcohols to alkyl
halides.
PCl3 + 3RCOOH → 3RCOCl + H3PO3
PCl3 + 3ROH → 3RCl + H3PO3
PCl3 can be oxidized by O2 or P4O10 to give phosphorus oxochloride POCl3.
2PCl3 + O2 → 2POCl3
6PCl3 + P4O10 + 6Cl2 → 10POCl3
POCl3 is used in large amounts in the manufacture of trialkyl and triaryl phosphates (RO)3PO.
OEt
O PCl3 + 3EtOH O P OEt Triethyl phosphate
OEt
O . C6H4 . CH3
Tritolyl
O PCl3 + 3HO C6H4 CH3 O P O . C6H4 . CH3
phosphate
O . C6H4 . CH3
Pentahalides
Nitrogen is unable to form pentahalides because the second shell contains a maximum of eight electrons,
i.e. four bonds. The subsequent elements have suitable d orbitals, and form the following pentahalides:
AsCl5 is highly reactive and unstable, and has only a temporary existence. BiF5 is highly reactive,
and explodes with water, forming O3 and F2O. It oxidizes UF4 to UF6, and BrF3 to BrF5, and fuorinates
hydrocarbons. The pentahalides are prepared as follows:
3PCl5 + 5AsF3 → 3PF5 + 5AsCl3
PCl3 + Cl2 (in CCl4) → PCl5
2As2O3 + 10F2 → 4AsF5 + 3O2
2Sb2O3 + 10F2 → 4SbF5 + 3O2
2Bi + 5F2 → 2BiF5
These molecules have a trigonal bipyramid shape in the gas phase (see Figure 10.32), as expected from the
VSEPR theory for fve pairs of electrons.
_
@edubuzznotes
464 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
Cl
Cl
Cl
P
Cl
Cl
Electronic structure of 3s 3p 3d
phosphorus atom –
ground state
Excited state
The trigonal bipyramid is not a regular structure. Electron diffraction on PF5 gas shows that some
bond angles are 90° and others are 120°, and the axial P—F bond lengths are 1.58 Å whilst the equatorial
P—F lengths are 1.53 Å. In contrast NMR studies suggest that all fve F atoms are equivalent. This paradox
may be explained quite simply. Electron diffraction gives an instantaneous picture of the molecule, whilst
NMR gives the picture averaged over several milliseconds. The axial and equatorial F atoms are thought
to interchange their positions in less time than that needed to take the NMR. The interchange of axial and
equatorial positions is called ‘pseudorotation’.
PF5 remains covalent and keeps this structure in the solid state. However, PCl5 is close to the ionic–cova•
lent borderline, and it is covalent in the gas and liquid states, but is ionic in the solid state. PCl5 solid exists as
[PCl4]+ and [PCl 6 ] −: the ions have tetrahedral and octahedral structures respectively. In the solid, PBr5
exists as [PBr4]+ Br − , and PI5 appears to be [PI4]+ and I − in solution.
PCl5 is the most important pentahalide, and it is made by passing Cl2 into a solution of PCl3 in
CCl4. World production is about 20 000 tonnes/year. Complete hydrolysis of the pentahalides yields the
appropriate •ic acid. Thus PCl5 reacts violently with water:
PCl 5 + 4H 2 O →
H 3 PO4 + 5HCl
phosphoric
acid
If equimolar amounts are used, the reaction is more gentle and yields phosphorus oxochloride POCl3.
PCl5 + H2O → POCl3 + 2HCl
PCl5 is used in organic chemistry to convert carboxylic acids to acid chlorides, and alcohols to alkyl halides.
PCl5 + 4RCOOH → 4RCOCl + H3PO4 + HCl
PCl5 + 4ROH → 4RCl + H3PO4 + HCl
It reacts with P4O10, forming POCl3, and with SO2, forming thionyl chloride SOCl2.
6PCl5 + P4O10 → 10POCl3
PCl5 + SO2 → POCl3 + SOCl2
PCl5 also reacts with NH4Cl, forming a variety of phosphonitrilic chloride polymers (see later).
nPCl5 + nNH4Cl → (NPCl2)n + 4nHCl (ring compounds n = 3 to 8)
and
Cl4P . (NPCl2)n . NPCl3 (chain compounds)
_
@edubuzznotes
10.42 Oxides of Nitrogen 465
Despite the existence of pentahalides, no hydrides MH5 are known. To attain the fve•valent state, d orbitals
must be used. Hydrogen is not suffciently electronegative to make the d orbitals contract suffciently,
though PHF4 and PH2F3 have been isolated.
Nitric oxide NO
NO is a colourless gas and is an important intermediate in the manufacture of nitric acid by the catalytic
oxidation of ammonia (Ostwald process). It was also important in the obsolete Birkeland–Eyde process
_
@edubuzznotes
466 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
which involved sparking dinitrogen and dioxygen. NO is prepared in the laboratory by the reduction
of dilute HNO3 with Cu, or reduction of HNO2 with I − :
3Cu + 8HNO3 → 2NO + 3Cu(NO3)2 + 4H2O
2HNO2 + 2I − + 2H+ → 2NO + I2 + 2H2O
NO is a neutral oxide and is not an acid anhydride.
NO has 11 valency electrons. It is impossible for them all to be paired, and hence this is an odd electron
molecule and the gas is paramagnetic. It is diamagnetic in the liquid and solid states, because the molecule
dimerizes forming O—N—N—O. The asymmetrical dimer O—N—O—N has been observed to be formed
as a red solid in the presence of HCl or other Lewis acids.
The bond length N—O is 1.15 Å, which is intermediate between a double and a triple bond. Bonding
is best described using the molecular orbital theory (see Chapter 3). The bonding is similar to that in N2
and CO which both have 10 outer electrons. NO has 11 outer electrons, and the extra unpaired electron
occupies an antibonding p*2p orbital. This reduces the bond order from 3 in N2 to 2 21 in NO. If this electron
is removed by oxidizing NO, the nitrosonium ion NO+ is formed. In NO+ the bond order is 3, and the N—O
bond length contracts from 1.15 Å in NO to 1.06 Å in NO+.
Odd electron molecules are usually highly reactive and tend to dimerize, NO is unusually stable for an
odd electron molecule. Nevertheless it reacts instantly with dioxygen to give NO2, and with the halogens it
gives nitrosyl halides, e.g. NOCl.
2NO + O2 → 2NO2
2NO + Cl2 → 2NOCl
NO readily forms coordination complexes with transition metal ions. These complexes are called nitro•
syls. Fe2+ and NO form the complex [Fe(H2O)5NO]2+, which is responsible for the colour in the ‘brown•
ring test’ for nitrates. Most nitrosyl complexes are coloured. Another example is sodium nitroprusside
Na2[Fe(CN)5NO] . 2H2O.
NO often acts as a three•electron donor, in contrast to most ligands which donate two electrons. Thus
three CO groups may be replaced by two NO groups:
[Fe(CO)5] + 2NO → [Fe(CO)2(NO)2] + 3CO
[Cr(CO)6] + 4NO → [Cr(NO)4] + 6CO
In these complexes the M—N—O atoms are linear, or close to linear. However, in 1968 the M—N—O
angle in [Ir(CO)(Cl)(PPh3)(NO)]+ was found to be 123°, and since then a number of other complexes
have been found with bond angles in the range 120—130°. These bent bonds, which are weaker than straight
bonds, are of considerable theoretical interest. NO may also act as a bridging ligand between two or three
metal atoms in a similar way to CO.
The oxide exists in two different forms (Figure 10.33). These may be interconverted by irradiation with
light of the appropriate wavelength. The N—N bond length from microwave spectra is 1.864 Å in the
asymmetrical form. This is exceptionally long and thus the bond is exceptionally weak compared with the
N—N bond found in hydrazine (length of 1.45 Å). Solid N2O3 exists in the form [NO]+ [NO2]−.
O O
O N N O
N N
O
Symmetrical form colation O
(has a two fold axis) Asymmetrical form
(colourless) (blue)
(a) (b)
2NO2 ⇌ N 2 O4
paramagnetic diamagnetic
(brown) (colourless)
N2O4 is a mixed anhydride, because it reacts with water to give a mixture of nitric and nitrous acids:
N2O4 + H2O → HNO3 + HNO2
The HNO2 formed decomposes to give NO.
2HNO2 → NO2 + NO + H2O
2NO2 + H2O → HNO3 + HNO2
Thus moist NO2 or N2O4 gases are strongly acidic.
The NO2 molecule is angular with an O—N—O angle of 132°. The bond length O—N of 1.20 Å is
intermediate between a single and a double bond. X•ray diffraction on solid N2O4 shows the structure to
be planar.
O O
°
1.64 A
N N
O O
The N—N bond is very long (1.64 Å), and is therefore weak. It is much longer than the single bond
N–N distance of 1.47 Å in N2H4, but there is no satisfactory explanation of why it is long.
Liquid N2O4 is useful as a non•aqueous solvent. It self•ionizes:
N 2 O4 ⇌ NO+ + NO3−
acid base
The NO2–N2O4 system is a strong oxidizing agent. NO2 reacts with fuorine and chlorine, forming nitryl
fuoride NO2F and nitryl chloride NO2Cl. It oxidizes HCl to Cl2 and CO to CO2.
_
@edubuzznotes
468 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
2NO2 + F2 →2NO2F
2NO2 + Cl2 → 2NO2Cl
2NO2 + 4HCl → 2NOCl + Cl2 + 2H2O
NO2 + CO → CO2 + NO
In the gas phase N2O5 decomposes into NO2, NO and O2. Nitrogen trioxide NO3 may be formed by
treating N2O5 with O3.
X•ray diffraction shows that solid N2O5 is ionic NO2+ NO3− : it should in reality be called nitronium
nitrate. It is covalent in solution and in the gas phase, and probably has the structure:
O O
N O N
O O
NaNO3 + Pb heat
→ NaNO2 + PbO
Nitrous acid and nitrites are weak oxidizing agents and will oxidize Fe2+ to Fe3+, and I − to I2: they
themselves are reduced to N2O or NO. However, HNO2 and nitrites are oxidized by KMnO4 and Cl2,
forming nitrates NO3−.
Large amounts of nitrites are used to make diazo compounds, which are converted into azo dyes, and
also pharmaceutical products.
PhNH 2 + HNO2 → PhN 2 Cl + 2H 2 O
phenyldiazonium
chloride
Nitrites are important in the manufacture of hydroxylamine:
NH4NO2 + NH4HSO3 + SO2 + 2H2O→ [NH3OH]+ HSO4− + (NH4)2SO4
_
@edubuzznotes
10.43 Oxoacids Of Nitrogen 469
Sodium nitrite is used as a food additive in cured meat, sausages, hot dogs, bacon and tinned ham.
NO 2 ions inhibit the growth of bacteria, particularly Clostridium botulinum, which causes botulism (a
−
particularly unpleasant form of food poisoning). Reductive decomposition of NO2− gives NO, which forms
a red complex with haemoglobin, and improves the look of meat. There is concern that during the cook•
ing of meat, the nitrites may react with amines and be converted into nitrosamines R2N—N=O, which are
thought to cause cancer. Certainly secondary and tertiary aliphatic amines form nitrosamines with nitrites:
Et2NH + HNO2 → Et2NNO + H2O
Et3N + HNO2 → [Et3NH][NO2] heat
→ Et2NNO + EtOH
The nitrite ion is a good ligand and forms many coordination complexes. Since lone pairs of electrons are
present on both N and O atoms, either N or O can form a coordinate bond. This gives rise to isomerism
between nitro complexes M ← NO2 and nitrito complexes M ← ONO, for example [Co(NH5)5(NO2)]2+
and [Co(NH3)5(ONO)]2+. (This is discussed in Chapter 5, under ‘Isomerism’.) If a solution of Co2+ ions is
treated with NO2− ions, frst Co2+ ions are oxidized to Co3+, then NO2 ions form the complex [Co(NO2 )6 ]3− .
−
Precipitation of potassium cobaltinitrite K 3 [Co(NO2 )6 ]3− is used to detect K+ qualitatively. The NO2 ion
−
may act as a chelating ligand, and bond to the same metal twice, or it may act as a bridging ligand joining
two metal atoms.
The nitrite ion NO 2 has a plane triangular structure, with N at the centre, two corners occupied by
−
O atoms, and the third corner occupied by the lone pair. A three•centre bond covers the N and the two
O atoms and the bond order is 1.5 for the N—O bonds, which have bond lengths in between those for a
single and double bond. (More details are given in Chapter 3.)
It is a strong acid and is 100% dissociated in dilute aqueous solutions into H3O+ and NO 3 . It forms a
−
large number of salts callced nitrates, which are typically very soluble in water.
2−
The shape of the NO 3− ion is a planar triangle, like the CO 3 ion. The later elements in both groups
form tetrahedral oxoacid ions such as PO3− 4 and SiO4 . This difference in shape is probably due to the small
4−
size of the N and C atoms and their restriction to eight electrons in their outer shell.
HNO3 is an excellent oxidizing agent particularly when hot and concentrated. H+ ions are oxidizing,
but the NO3 ion is an even stronger oxidizing agent in acid solution. Thus metals like copper and silver
−
which are insoluble in HCl dissolve in HNO3. Some metals such as gold are insoluble even in HNO3, but
will dissolve in aqua regia, a mixture of 25% concentrated HNO3 and 75% concentrated HCl. The enhanced
ability to dissolve metals shown by aqua regia arises from the oxidizing power of HNO3 coupled with
the ability of Cl − to form complexes with the metal ions.
HNO3 was originally made from NaNO3 or KNO3 and concentrated H2SO4. The frst synthetic method
was the Birkeland–Eyde process. This sparked N2 and O2 together in an electric arc furnace, and passed the
gas into water. The process was started in Norway in 1903, but is now obsolete, because of the high cost of
electricity.
+O H O
N 2 + O2 ¾spark 2
¾¾® NO ¾¾¾ 2
® NO2 ¾¾¾® HNO3
The Ostwald process depends on the catalytic oxidation of ammonia to NO, followed by oxidation of
NO to NO2, and conversion of NO2 with water to HNO3. The frst plant was set up in Germany in 1908, and
Ostwald was awarded the Nobel Prize in 1909. The method is still in use. The overall process is:
platinum/rhodium catalyst
4NH 3( g ) + 5O2( g ) ¾¾¾¾¾¾¾¾¾
® 4NO( g ) + 6 H 2 O( g )
5 atm 850 °C
_
@edubuzznotes
470 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
Overall:
NH3 + 2O2 → HNO3 + H2O
This gives a HNO3 solution of concentration 60% by weight. Distillation only increases the concentration
to 68% since a constant boiling mixture is formed. ‘Concentrated’ HNO3 contains 98% acid and is produced
by dehydrating with concentrated sulphuric acid.
When nitric acid is mixed with concentrated sulphuric acid, the nitronium ion NO+2 is formed. This is
the active species in the nitration of aromatic organic compounds (Figure 10.34), this is an important step in
making explosives, or the nitro compounds may be reduced to aniline and used for making dyestuffs:
−H2O
HNO3 NO+2
NO+2
NO2 NH2
reduce
CH3 CH3
O2N NO2
NO+2
Toluene NO2
Trinitrotoluene
(used as an explosive)
NO2 NO2
Methyl-2,4,6-trinitrobenzene 2,4,6-trinitrophenol
(trinitrotoluene, TNT) (picric acid)
OH O COOH
HNO3
or (CH2)4 NH2 (CH2)6 NH2 CO[NH(CH2)6NH . CO(CH2)4. CO]n NH
Nylon - 66
COOH (Hexamethylene-
Cyclohexonal Cyclohexone
Adipic diamine)
acid
HNO3 is also used to oxidize p•xylene to terephthalic acid for the manufacture of terylene.
The structure of the nitrate ion is a planar triangle. All three oxygen atoms are equivalent. In addition to the
s bonds, four•centre p molecular orbitals cover the N and the three s atoms. Each of the N—O bonds has a bond
order of 1 13 , 1 from the s bond and 13 from the p bond. (This is described more fully in Chapter 3.)
2. Oxidation of metalloids: These are also oxidized to the corresponding oxyacids in their highest oxida•
tion states.
Sn + 2HNO3 ® H 2 SnO3 + 4NO2 +H 2 O
Meta-stannic
acid
H 2 S + 2 HNO3 → 2 NO2 + 2H 2 O + S
5. Oxidation of metals: Most metals, except noble metals (gold and platinum, which dissolve in aqua
regia) are oxidized by nitric acid and the nature of the product formed depends on the concentration
and temperature of the acid. Some metals, like Cr and Al do not dissolve in concentrated HNO3 due to
foamtion of passive flm on the surface.
4Zn + 10 HNO3 ® 4Zn(NO3 )2 + 5H 2 O + N 2 O
dil.
The reactions of metals with HNO3 can be summaized as follows in Table 10.20.
Trioxides
Phosphorus trioxide is dimeric and should be written P4O6, not P2O3. P4O6 is actually not a dimer of P2O3,
only formula•wise it is like a dimer because P2O3 does not exist structurally. P4O6 has four P atoms at the
corners of a tetrahedron, with six O atoms along the edges, each O being bonded to two P atoms. The struc•
ture of P4O6 is shown in Figure 10.36. Since the P—O—P angle is 127° the O atoms are strictly above the
edges, but it is more convenient to draw them on the edges.
P
O O
O
O
P P
P O
O
P4O6 is formed by burning phosphorus in a limited supply of air. It is a soft white solid (m.p. 24 °C, b.p. 175 °C).
It is removed from the reaction mixture and is purifed by distillation. (Higher oxides are formed in a
plentiful supply of air.) P4O6 will burn in air, forming P4O10.
P4O6 + 2O2 → P4O10
The basicity of oxides and hydroxides usually increases on descending a group. P4O6 is acidic and
hydrolyses in water, forming phosphorous acid.
P4O6 + 6H2O → 4H3PO3
Pentoxides
Phosphorus pentoxide is the most important oxide, and is quite common. It is dimeric and has the formula
P4O10, not P2O5. It is also not a true dimer because monomeric form P2O5 does not exist structurally. Its
structure is derived from that of P4O6. Each P atom in P4O6 forms three bonds to O atoms. There are fve
electrons in the outer shell of a P atom. Three electrons have been used in bonding, and the other two com•
prise a lone pair, which is situated on the outside of the tetrahedral unit. In P4O10 the lone pairs on each of
the four P atoms form a coordinate bond to an oxygen atom (Figure 10.37).
O
P
O
O P P O
(a) (b)
Figure 10.37 Structure of phosphorus pentoxide P4O10. (a) Formation of s bonds, (b) Orbitals
involved in back bonding.
Measurement of the P—O bond lengths shows that the bridging bonds on the edges are 1.60 Å but
the coordinate bonds on the corners are 1.43 Å. The bridging bonds compare with those in P4O6 (1.65 Å)
and are normal single bonds. The bonds on the corners are much shorter than a single bond, and are in
fact double bonds. These double bonds are different in origin from the ‘usual’ double bonds such as that
in ethene which arises from pp–pp overlap with one electron coming from each C atom. The second bond
in P=O is formed by pp–dp back bonding. A full p orbital on the O atom overlaps sideways with an empty
d orbital on the P atom. Thus it differs from the double bond in ethene in two respects:
1. A p orbital overlaps with a d orbital, rather than p with p.
2. Both electrons come from one atom, and hence the bond is a ‘dative bond’.
P4O10 is formed by burning P in an excess of air or dioxygen. It absorbs water from the air or from
other compounds, and becomes sticky. Because of this strong affnity for water, P4O10 is used as a drying
agent. Finely powdered P4O10 is sometimes spread over glass wool and used for drying purposes. This
provides a large drying surface, which is not easily covered by solid hydrolysis products. P4O10 hydrolyses
violently in water, forming phosphoric acid H3PO4. The manufacture of pure H3PO4 by this route is the
largest use of P4O10.
P4O10 + 6H2O → 4H3PO4
_
@edubuzznotes
474 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
P4O10 reacts with alcohols and ethers, forming phosphate esters. (The relation of these esters to phos•
phoric acid is shown by writing H3PO4 as O =P(OH)3.)
P4O10 + 6EtOH → 2O=P(OEt)(OH)2 + 2O=P(OEt)2(OH)
P4O10 + 6Et2O → 4O=P(OEt)3
P
HO OH
OH
Phosphates can be estimated quantitatively by adding a solution containing Mg2+ and NH4OH solution
to a solution of the phosphate. Magnesium ammonium phosphate is precipitated quantitatively, and this is
fltered, washed, ignited, and weighed as magnesium pyrophosphate Mg2P2O7.
Impure orthophosphoric acid H3PO4 is prepared in large amounts by treating phosphate rock with
H2SO4. This is called the ‘wet process’. The CaSO4 is hydrated to gypsum CaSO4 ∙ 2H2O, which is fltered off,
and the F − is converted to Na2[SiF6] and removed. The H3PO4 is concentrated by evaporation. Most of the
H3PO4 made in this way is used to make fertilizer.
Ca3(PO4)2 + 3H2SO4 → 2H3PO4 + 3CaSO4
[3(Ca3(PO4)2) · CaF2] + 10H2SO4 → 6H3PO4 + 10CaSO4 + 2HF
Pure H3PO4 is made by the ‘furnace process’. Molten P is burnt in a furnace with air and steam. First
P4O10 is formed by reaction between P and O, and then this is immediately hydrolysed.
P4 + 5O2 → P4O10
P4O10 + 6H2O → 4H3PO4
Phosphoric acid is hydrogen bonded in aqueous solution, and because of this the ‘concentrated acid’ is
syrupy and viscous. Concentrated acid is widely used and contains about 85% by weight of H3PO4 (100%
pure (anhydrous) H3PO4 is seldom used, but it can be prepared as colourless deliquescent crystals by
evaporation at low pressure). Most of the acid (solution) made in this way is used in the laboratory, and in
food (Kraft cheese Na2HPO4) and pharmaceutical preparations.
H3PO4 may also be made by the action of concentrated HNO3 on P.
P4 + 20HNO3 → 4H3PO4 + 20NO2 + 4H2O
Orthophosphonc acid loses water steadily on heating:
strong heat
H 3 PO4 ¾gentle
¾¾¾¾ heat
® H 4 P2 O7 ¾¾¾¾¾ ® (HPO3 )n
220 °C 320 °C
orthophosphoric pyrophosphoric metaphosphoric
acid acid acid
Polyphosphates
A very large number of polyphosphoric acids and their salts, the polyphosphates, arise by polymerizing
acidic [PO4] units forming isopolyacids. These consist of chains of tetrahedra, each sharing the O atoms
at one or two corners of the [PO4] tetrahedron, giving simple unbranched chains, in a similar way to the
formation of pyroxenes by the silicates.
The hydrolysis of P4O10 proceeds in stages, and an understanding of these stages leads to an
understanding of the wide range of phosphoric acids (Figure 10.39).
P4O10 + 6H2O → 4H3PO4 (overall reaction)
_
@edubuzznotes
476 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
O
O
P O
O O OH
H2 O P
O O O H2O O P
O P P O
−H+/H+ O O O
P
O O P O −H+/H+
P O P
O O II P
HO
O O O P O OH O O OH
Addition of P
nucleophile H O O OH
only I
III H O/−H+/H+
2
O O O O O O O
P H2O
H2O P P P P P P
+ H3PO4 O OH
HO O O OH −H+/H+ HO O O
HO HO OH OH OH OH OH
V −H+/H+ IV Tetrapolyphosphoric
acid
O O
H3PO4 + P H2O
P
HO O 2H3PO4
OH −H+/H+
HO OH
VI
P P
HO O OH
OH OH
H4P2O7
Pyrophosphoric acid
O O O
P P P
HO O O OH
OH OH OH
H5P3O10
Tripolyphosphoric acid
Some very long chain polymers called Graham’s salt, Kurrol salt and Maddrell’s salt are also known.
These are named after the person who frst reported them, and they are discussed later.
Disodium dihydrogenpyrophosphate Na2H2P2O7 is mixed with NaHCO3 and used in bread making to
leaven the bread, that is to make it rise. They react and evolve CO2 when heated together. This is an easier
way of making batches of bread than using yeast, and is used commercially.
Na2H2P2O7 + 2NaHCO3 → Na4P2O7 + 2CO2 + 2H2O
Graham's salt
Graham’s salt is the best known of these long chain polyphosphates, and is formed by quenching
molten NaPO3. It forms a glassy solid instead of crystallizing. In industry it is incorrectly called sodium
hexametaphosphate. Graham’s salt is soluble in water: These solutions give precipitates with metal ions
such as Pb2+ and Ag+ but not with Ca2+ and Mg2 +. Graham’s salt is sold commercially under the trade name
Calgon. It is widely used for softening water. It sequesters Ca2+ and Mg2+ in a similar way to Na5P3O10. Many
of these polyphosphates are used for water softening, and also for descaling boilers and pipes.
Metaphosphates – cyclophosphates
The metaphosphates form a family of ring compounds. The old name of metaphosphates is still widely used
even though according to IUPAC nomenclature cyclo• should be used to indicate the formation of rings.
They can be prepared by heating orthophosphates:
heat 316°C
nH 3 PO4
→ (HPO3 )n + nH 2 O
There is no evidence for the existence of free monometaphosphate ions PO3−, or of dimetaphosphate ions.
The latter would involve the sharing of two corners, that is an edge between two [PO4] tetrahedra, and would
impose a great deal of strain on the structure. In contrast, tri• and tetra•metaphosphates are well known
(Figure 10.41). A few larger rings have been isolated with up to eight [PO4] units, that is up to Na8[P8O24].
These are obtained as mixtures, and are conveniently separated by paper chromatography or thin layer
chromatography.
O O
O O O P O P O
O O P
O O O O O
P P O O
P O P O P O
O O P
O O O O O O
Di-metaphosphate ion Tri-metaphosphate ion Tetra-metaphosphate ion
(cyclo-diphosphate) (cyclo-triphosphate) (cyclo-tetraphosphate)
Note: H4P2O6 exists in two forms, that is, tetrabasic hypophosphoric acid (I) and tribasic isohypophosphoric
acid (II). The structures are as shown below.
O O O O
HO P P OH and P P
HO O OH
HO OH H OH
hypophosphoric acid isohypophosphoric acid
H H H
HO P O P OH HO P OH
O O O
pyrophosphorous orthophosphorous
acid acid
When white phosphorus reacts with NaOH, it produces a 9. With increase in temperature, following heating,
gaseous mixture by the following parallel reactions. acid (D) produces the following products in which
correct sequence?
P4 + 3NaOH + 3H 2O ® 3NaH 2 PO2 + PH 3 ↑ (A) Pyroacid, metaacid, anhydride.
3P4 + 8 NaOH + 8 H 2O ® 8 NaH 2 PO2 + 2 P2 H 4 ↑ (B) Metaacid, pyroacid, anhydride.
(C) Metaacid, anhydride, pyroacid.
4. The gas mixture comes out and catches fre immedi• (D) Pyroacid, anhydride, metaacid.
ately due the presence of
(A) PH 3
(B) P2 H 4
(C) P2 H 6
(D) H 2
In each of the following questions, statements are given in two columns, which have to be matched. The statements in
Column I are labeled as (A), (B), (C) and (D), while those in Column II are labeled as (P), (Q), (R), (S) and (T). Any
given statement in Column I can have correct matching with one or more statements in Column II.
1. Match the nitrogen oxides with their properties.
Column I Column II
Column I Column II (C) (NH4)2SO4 (R) It is deliquescent in nature.
(D) NH4ClO4 (S) Used as solid fuel in rocket
(A) N2O (P) Neutral towards water.
propellant.
(B) NO (Q) Acidic towards water.
(C) N2O3 (R) N–N linkage is (T) Used in dry batteries.
(unsymmetrical) present.
(D) N2O4 (S) Molecule having 3. Match the fertilizer with the compounds/reactions
highest bond order of they are obtained from.
N–O bond.
(E) N2O5 Column I Column II
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (B) 3. (B) 5. (B) 7. (C) 9. (A)
2. (D) 4. (B) 6. (A) 8. (C) 10. (A)
Uses of sulphur
S is an essential though minor constituent of certain proteins. It is present in the amino acids cystine,
cysteine and methionine.
Almost 90% of the World production of SO2 is converted to SO3 and fnally to H2SO4. Sixty per cent of
the H2SO4 produced is used to make fertilizers. The remainder is used to make a variety of other chemicals.
Sulphites SO2− 3 , hydrogen sulphites HSO 3 and SO2 are important for bleaching.
−
The 10% of S for non•acid purposes is used as elemental S. Some is used to make carbon disulphide
CS2. This is important in the vulcanizing of rubber. Other uses of sulphur are in the manufacture of fungi•
cides, insecticides and gunpowder. Gunpowder is an intimate mixture of saltpetre NaNO3 (75%), charcoal
(15%) and sulphur (10%).
Oxygen
Oxygen occurs as two non•metallic forms, dioxygen O2 and ozone O3. Dioxygen O2 is stable as a diatomic
molecule, which accounts for it being a gas. (S, Se, Te and Po have more complicated structures, e.g. S8, and
are solids at normal temperatures.) The bonding in the O2 molecule is not as simple as it might at frst
appear. If the molecule had two covalent bonds, then all the electrons would be paired and the molecule
should be diamagnetic.
⋅⋅ ⋅⋅
: O ⋅ + ⋅ O : → : O :: O : or O=O
⋅ ⋅ ⋅⋅ ⋅⋅
Dioxygen is paramagnetic and therefore contains two unpaired electrons. The explanation of this phenom•
enon was one of the early successes of the molecular orbital theory. The structure is described (see Chapter 3).
Liquid dioxygen is pale blue in colour, and the solid is also blue.
Ozone
Ozone O3 is the triatomic allotrope of oxygen. It is unstable, and decomposes to O2. The structure of
O3 is angular, with an O—O—O bond angle of 116°48´. Both O—O bond lengths are 1.28 Å, which is
intermediate between a single bond (1.48 Å in H2O2) and a double bond (1.21 Å in O2).
_
@edubuzznotes
10.47 Structure and Allotropy of the Elements 485
:
O 1.28 A
:
O O °
+
: :
+
: :
: :
O O: :O O: O O
116° 48¢
:
- -
Preparation of ozone
O3 is usually prepared by the action of a silent electric discharge upon dioxygen between two concentric
metallized tubes in an apparatus called an ozonizer. Concentrations of up to 10% of O3 are obtained in this
way. Higher concentrations or pure O3 can be obtained by fractional liquifaction of the mixture. The pure
liquid is dangerously explosive. Low concentrations of O3 can be made by UV irradiation of O2. This occurs
in the atmosphere when photochemical smog is formed over some cities, for example over Los Angeles or
Tokyo. The photochemical change is useful for producing low concentrations to sterilize food, particularly
for cold storage. O3 can also be made by heating O2 to over 2500 °C and quenching. In all of these prepara•
tions oxygen atoms are produced, and these react with O2 molecules to form O3.
Ozone can also be prepared by passing F2 gas in H2O. The following reactions take place:
2F2 + 2H2O → 4HF + O2
3F2 + 3H2O → 6HF + O3
The separation is done as usual by passing through a spiral tube kept at liquid air ( – 190°C) and the process
is called fractional liquefaction of the mixture.
Physical properties
O3 is an unstable, blue diamagnetic gas, b.p. – 112 °C. The colour is due to intense absorption of red light (l
557 and 602 nm). It is dark blue in liquid state and violet•black in solid stste. It also absorbs strongly in the
UV region (l 255 nm). This is particularly important since there is a layer of O3 in the upper atmosphere
which absorbs harmful UV radiation from the sun, thus protecting people on the earth. The use of chlo•
rofuorocarbons in aerosols and refrigerators, and their subsequent escape into the atmosphere, is blamed
for making holes in the ozone layer over the Antarctic and Arctic. It is feared that this will allow an exces•
sive amount of UV light to reach the earth which will cause skin cancer (melanoma) in humans. Oxides of
nitrogen (from car exhausts) and the halogens can also damage the O3 layer.
O3 has a characteristic fshy smell, often associated with sparking electrical equipment. The gas is toxic,
and continuous exposure to concentrations of 0.1 ppm must be avoided.
Chemical properties
O3 is thermodynamically unstable, and decomposes to O2. The decomposition is exothermic, and is catalysed
by many materials. The solid and liquid often decompose explosively. The gas decomposes slowly, even
when warmed, providing catalysts and UV light are absent. O3 is an extremely powerful oxidizing agent,
second only to F2 in oxidizing power, and reacts much more readily than dioxygen. It is one of the best
oxidizing agent in acid solution and can be dangerously explosive at high concentrations.
O3 + 2H+ + 2e ® O2 + H2O
It acts as a powerful oxidizing agent due to the ease with which it can liberate atoms of nascent oxygen
O3 → O2 + O. Some of the oxidation reactions of O3 in which O2 is liberated are listed as follows:
1. Oxidation of metal sulphides to metal sulphates
Na 2 SO3 + O3 ® Na 2 SO4 + O2
Na 2 AsO3 + O3 ® Na 2 AsO4 + O2
4. Reactions with sulphur, phosphorous and arsenic in presence of moisture
S + H 2 O + 3O3 ® H 2 SO4 + 3O2
2KI(neutral) + O3 + H 2 O ® I 2 + 2KOH + O2
KI + KOI
I 2 + 2S 2 O23 - ® S4 O62 - + 2I
8. Oxidation of metals
2 Hg + O3 ® Hg 2 O + O2
2 Ag + O3 ® Ag 2 O+ O2
brown
H 2 O2 + O3 ® H 2 O + 2O2
Na 2 O2 + O3 + H 2 O ® 2 NaOH + 2O2
_
@edubuzznotes
10.47 Structure and Allotropy of the Elements 487
Uses of ozone
O3 is also used as a disinfectant. For example, it is used to purify drinking water, since it destroys bacteria
and viruses. Its advantage over chlorine for this purpose is that it avoids the unpleasant smell and taste
of chlorine, since any excess O3 soon decomposes to O2. For similar reasons it is used to treat water in
swimming pools.
Estimation of ozone
The amount of O3 in a gas mixture may be determined by passing the gas into a KI solution buffered with
a borate buffer (pH 9.2). The iodine that is liberated is titrated with sodium thiosulphate.
Alternatively the gas may be decomposed catalytically, and the change in volume measured.
Sulphur
Sulphur has more allotropic forms than any other element. These different forms arise partly from the
extent to which S has polymerized, and partly from the crystal structures adopted. The two common
crystalline forms are a or rhombic sulphur which is stable at room temperature, and b or monoclinic
sulphur which is stable above 95.5 °C. These two forms change reversibly with slow heating or slow cooling.
Rhombic sulphur occurs naturally as large yellow crystals in volcanic areas. A third modifcation known as
g•monoclinic sulphur is nacreous (looks like mother•of•pearl) It can be made by chilling hot concentrated
solutions of S in solvents such as CS2, toluene or EtOH. All three forms contain puckered S8 rings with a
crown conformation (Figure 10.43a), and differ only in the overall packing of the rings in the crystal. This
affects their densities:
95.5° C
a - sulphur ↽
⇀ b - sulphur
Engel’s sulphur (ε•sulphur) is unstable and contains S6 rings arranged in the chair conformation
(Figure 10.43b). It is made by pouring Na2S2O3, solution into concentrated HCl and extracting the S with
toluene. It can also be made as follows:
H2S4 + S2Cl2 → S6 + 2HCl
(a) (b)
Figure 10.43 (a) Structure of S8 molecule (b) Structure of S6 molecule.
_
@edubuzznotes
488 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
In all of these ring compounds the S–S distance is 2.04 – 2.06 Å, and the bond angle S–S–S is in the
range 102–108°. They are all soluble in CS2.
Sulphur melts to form a mobile liquid. As the temperature is raised the colour darkens. At 160 °C
the S8 rings break, and the diradicals so formed polymerize, forming long chains of up to a million
atoms. This makes all the physical properties change discontinuously. The viscosity increases sharply,
and continues to rise up to 200 °C. At higher temperatures chains break, and shorter chains and
rings are formed, which makes the viscosity decrease up to 444 °C, the boiling point. The vapour
at 200°C consists mostly of S8 rings, but contains 1–2% of S2 molecules. At 600 °C the gas mainly
consists of S2 molecules.
The S2 molecule is paramagnetic and blue coloured like O2, and presumably has similar bonding. S2 gas
is stable up to 2200 °C.
s p d
S, Se or Te atom
ground state
Excited state
Further excited
state
six unpaired electrons, therfore can form six bonds
six electron pairs, hence octahedral structure
_
@edubuzznotes
10.50 General Properties of Oxides 489
Compounds of S, Se and Te with O are typically tetravalent. The (+IV) state shows both oxidizing and
reducing properties. Fluorine brings out the maximum oxidation state of (+VI). Compounds in the (+VI)
state show oxidizing properties. The higher oxidation states become less stable on descending the group.
These compounds are typically volatile because they are covalent.
S O
Normal oxides
In these, the oxidation number of M can be deduced from the empirical formula MxOy, taking the oxida•
tion number of oxygen as (–II). These oxides, for example H2O, MgO and Al2O3, contain only M–O bonds.
Peroxides
These contain more oxygen than would be expected from the oxidation number of M. Some are ionic and
contain the peroxide ion O2−
2 , for example those of Group 1 and 2 metals (Na2O2 and BaO2). Others are
covalently bound and contain —O—O—in the structure, for example H2O2 (H—O—O—H), peroxomono•
sulphuric acid and peroxodisulphuric acid.
2− 2−
O O O
2H O − S − O − O
+
2H + O − S − O − O − S − O
O O O
peroxomonosulphuric acid peroxodisulphuric acid
Peroxo compounds are strong oxidizing agents, and are hydrolysed by water to give H2O2.
H2SO5 + H2O → H2SO4 + H2O2
Superoxides, e.g. KO2, contain more oxygen than would be expected.
Suboxides
Here the formula contains less oxygen than would be expected from the oxidation number of M.
They involve M—M bonds in addition to M—O bonds, for example O=C=C=C=O.
Basic oxides
Metallic oxides are generally basic. Most metal oxides are ionic and contain the O2− ion. The oxides of the
more electropositive metals, Groups 1 and 2, and the lanthanides are typical. A large amount of energy
is required to form an ionic oxide. This is because the O2 molecule must frst be broken into atoms, and
then the energy (the electron affnity) required to add two electrons to form O2− is also large. Thus ionic
oxides are formed by compounds with high lattice energy to offset this. Thus ionic oxides typically have
high melting points (Na2O 1275 °C, MgO 2800 °C, La2O3 2315 °C). When they react with water the O2− ion
is converted into OH−.
Na2O + H2O → 2NaOH
However, many metal oxides with formulae M2O3 and MO2, though ionic, do not react with water.
Examples include Tl2O3, Bi2O3 and ThO2. These react with acids to form salts, and so are basic. Where a
metal can exist in more than one oxidation state, and thus form more than one oxide, e.g. CrO, Cr2O3, CrO3,
PbO, PbO2, and Sb4O6, Sb4O10, the lowest oxidation state is the most ionic and the most basic. Thus CrO is
basic, Cr2O3 amphoteric and CrO3 acidic.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.51 Oxides of Sulphur 491
Amphoteric oxides
Many metals yield oxides which are amphoteric, and react with both strong acids and strong bases. Examples
include BeO, Al2O3, Ga2O3, SnO, PbO and ZnO.
Al 2 O3 + 2OH − + 3H 2 O → 2[Al(OH)4 ]−
Acidic oxides
Non•metallic oxides are usually covalent. Many occur as discrete molecules (CO2, NO2, SO2, Cl2O) and
have low melting and boiling points, though some, such as B2O3 and SiO2, form infnite ‘giant molecules’
and have high melting points. They are all acidic. There are many are the anhydrides of acids.
B2O3 + 3H2O → 2H3BO3
N2O5 + H2O → 2HNO3
P4O10 + 6H2O → 4H3PO4
SO3 + H2O → H2SO4
Others which do not react with water such as SiO2 do react with NaOH, thus showing their acidic
properties. In cases where the element exists in more than one oxidation state, e.g. N2O3 and N2O5, SO2 and
SO3, the higher oxidation state is the most acidic.
N2O3 + H2O → 2HNO2
N2O5 + H2O → 2HNO3
N2O3 contains N(+III) and N2O5 contains N(+V). HNO3 is a stronger acid than HNO2. This may be
rationalized since the higher the oxidation state of the central atom the more it will attract electrons, thus
weakening any O—H bonds and facilitating the release of H+.
Neutral oxides
A few covalent oxides have no acidic or basic properties (N2O, NO, CO).
Dioxide SO2
SO2 is produced commercially on a vast scale:
1. By burning S in air.
S+O2 ® SO2
2. By burning H2S in air.
2H2S + 3O2 ® 2SO2 + 2H2O
_
@edubuzznotes
492 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
3. By roasting various metal sulphide ores with air in smelters (particularly FeS2, and to a smaller extent
CuS and ZnS).
4. Large amounts are produced as a waste product by burning coal and, to a lesser extent, other fossil
fuels, oil and gas. This undoubtedly harms the environment.
SO2 is a colourless gas (b.p. − 10 °C, m.p. −75.5 °C), which has a choking smell, and is very soluble in water
(39 cm−3 of SO2 gas will dissolve in 1 cm−3 of water). The SO2 in solution is almost completely present as
various hydrated species such as SO2∙ 6H2O and the solution contains only a minute amount of sulphurous
acid H2SO3. SO2 levels above 5 ppm are poisonous to man, but plants are harmed at appreciably lower
levels.
SO2 gas forms discrete V•shaped molecules, and this structure is retained in the solid state (Figure 10.45).
The bond angle is 119°30 ′. The bonding in SO2 is described in Chapter 3. It is a polar molecule and overall
direction of diapole is as shown in Fig. 10.45.
O
S
O
Chemical properties
SO2 can act as an oxidizing agent in some cases.
SO2 + 2 H 2 S ® 3S ¯ +2H 2 O
When SO2 is passed into FeCl2 and SnCl2 solutions at very low pH, it oxidizes them into Fe3+ and Sn4+ as
follows.
SO2 + 4 FeCl 2 + 4 HCl ® 4 FeCl 3 + S + 2 H 2 O
2SO2 + 6SnCl 2 + 8 HCl ® 5SnCl 4 + SnS 2 + 4 H 2 O
Estimation of SO2
Quantitative methods for measuring SO2 in the atmosphere are highly developed because of environmental
concern over ‘acid rain’. Methods include:
1. Oxidation to H2SO4, followed by determination of the H2SO4 by titration
SO2 + H2O2 → H2SO4
2. Reaction with K2[HgCl4] to give a mercury complex which reacts with the dye pararosaniline, and is
estimated colorimetrically.
K2[HgCl4] + 2SO2 + 2H2O → K2[Hg(SO3)2] + 4HCl
Detection of SO2
SO2 may be detected in the laboratory:
1. By its smell.
2. Because it turns a flter paper moistened with acidifed potassium dichromate solution green, due to
the formation of Cr3+.
K2Cr2O7 + 3SO2 + H2SO4 → Cr2(SO4)3 + K2SO4 + H2O
_
@edubuzznotes
10.51 Oxides of Sulphur 493
3. Because it turns starch iodate paper blue (due to starch and I2).
2KIO3 + 5SO2 + 4H2O → I2 + 2KHSO4 + 3H2SO4
Other methods for its detection based on its reducing property are already covered in Chapter 7.
Uses
1. SO2 is used to make other products such as sulphites, bisulphites and thiosulphates.
2SO2 + Na 2 CO3 + H 2 O → 2 NaHSO3 + CO2
sodium hydrogen
sulphite
(sodium bisulphite)
2 NaHSO3 + Na 2 CO3 → 2 Na 2 SO3 + H 2 O + CO2
sodium
sulphite
Na 2 SO3 + S heat
→ Na 2 S 2 O3
sodium
thiosulphate
2. SO2 has also been used as a non•aqueous solvent. A wide range of covalent compounds, both inorganic
and organic, are soluble in liquid SO2, and it is a useful reaction medium.
3. It is used bleaching wool and silk, as antichlor, disinfectant and preservative of food.
Trioxide SO3
SO3 is the only important trioxide. It is manufactured on a huge scale by the Contact process in which SO2
reacts with O2 in the presence of a catalyst (Pt or V2O5). Most of the SO2 produced is oxidized to SO3 by the
Contact process, and used to manufacture H2SO4.
2SO2(g) + O2(g) ⇌ 2SO3(g) ΔH = −98 kJ mol −1
The forward reaction is exothermic, and is favoured by a low temperature. Since there is a decrease in the
number of moles of gas, the process is favoured by a high pressure. In practice the reaction is carried out at
atmospheric pressure. The formation of SO3 is favoured by an excess of O2, and removing the SO3 from the
reaction mixture. A catalyst is used to obtain a reasonable conversion in a reasonable time. In the Contact
process a platinum gauze and platinized asbestos were both used at one time. Pt is an excellent catalyst,
and it works at moderately low temperatures. However, it is very expensive and is susceptible to poison•
ing, particularly by metals such as As. Nowadays a V2O5 catalyst activated with K2O is used instead, and is
supported on kieselguhr or silica. This is much cheaper, and is resistant to poisoning. The catalyst is inactive
below 400 °C and breaks down between 600 °C and 650 °C. Dust may clog the catalyst surface, and impair
its effciency. To prevent this the gases are passed through an electrostatic precipitator. The catalyst may
last for over 20 years.
The SO3 is not usually isolated, and practically all of it is converted to H2SO4. SO3 reacts vigorously
with water, evolving a large amount of heat and forming H2SO4. Commercially it is not possible just to
react SO3 with water. The SO3 reacts with water vapour and causes the formation of a dense mist of H2SO4
droplets, which are diffcult to condense and pass out of the absorber into the atmosphere. To avoid this, it
has been found best to dissolve SO3 in 98–99% H2SO4 in ceramic packed towers, to give oleum or fuming
sulphuric acid. This is mainly pyrosulphuric acid H2S2O7. Water is continuously added to keep the concen•
tration of H2SO4 constant.
H2S2O7 + H2O → 2H2SO4
In the gas phase SO3 has a plane triangular structure (Figure 10.46). The bonding is best described as sul•
phur forming three s •bonds, giving rise to a plane triangle, and three delocalized p bonds.
_
@edubuzznotes
494 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
O
S
O O
O O
S
O O
O O
S S
O O O
g-SO3 (solid)
Sulphamic acid is the only strong acid that exists as a solid at room temperature. It is used for cleaning the
plant at sugar refneries and breweries.
Sulphurous acid
Though SO2 is very soluble in water, most is present as hydrated SO2 (SO2 · H2O). Sulphurous acid H2SO3
may exist in the solution in minute amounts, or not at all, though the solution is acidic. Its salts, the sulphites
SO2−
3
, form stable crystalline solids. Many sulphites are insoluble or are sparingly soluble in water, e.g. CaSO3,
BaSO3 or Ag2SO3. However, those of the Group 1 metals and ammonium are soluble in water, and in dilute
solutions the hydrogen sulphite (bisulphite) ion HSO3− is the predominant species. Crystals of hydrogen
sulphites have only been formed with a few large metal ions, e.g. RbHSO3 and CsHSO3. Most attempts to isolate
hydrogen sulphites lead to internal dehydration with the formation of disulphites S 2 O52−:
2NaHSO3(aq) ⇌ Na2S2O5 + H2O
Na2SO3 is an important industrial chemical. It is made by passing SO2 into an aqueous solution of Na2CO3
to give aqueous NaHSO3, then treating the solution with more Na2CO3.
Na2CO3 + 2SO2 + H2O → 2NaHSO3 + CO2
2NaHSO3 + Na2CO3 → 2Na2SO3 + H2O + CO2
_
@edubuzznotes
496 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
The main use of Na2SO3 is as a bleach for wood pulp in the paper making industry. Some is used to treat
boiler feed water (it removes O2 and thus reduces corrosion of pipes and boilers). Small amounts are used
in photographic developer.
Sulphites and hydrogen sulphites liberate SO2 on treatment with dilute acids:
Na2SO3 + 2HCl → 2NaCl + SO2 + H2O
Sulphites and hydrogen sulphites both contain S in the oxidation state (+IV) and are moderately strong
reducing agents. Sulphites are determined by reaction with I2, and determination of the excess I2 with
sodium thiosulphate.
NaHSO3 + I2 + H2O → NaHSO4 + 2HI
2Na2S2O3 + I2 → Na2S4O6 + 2Na+ + 2I −
The sulphite ion exists in crystals and has a pyramidal structure (Figure 10.48), that is tetrahedral with one
position occupied by a lone pair. The bond angles O—S—O are slightly distorted (106°) due to the lone
pair, and the bond lengths are 1.51 Å. The p bond is delocalized, and hence the S—O bonds have a bond
order of 1.33.
S
O O−
O−
Physical properties
Pure sulphuric acid melts at 10.5 °C, forming a viscous liquid. It is strongly hydrogen bonded, and in the
absence of water it does not react with metals to produce H2. Many metals reduce H2SO4 (S + VI) to SO2
(S + IV), especially if heated. If pure H2SO4 is heated, a little SO3 is evolved, and an azeotropic mixture of
98.3% H2SO4 and 1.7% water is produced. This boils at 338 °C. Pure H2SO4 is used as a non•aqueous solvent
and as a sulphonating agent.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.52 Oxoacids of Sulphur 497
Chemical properties
Anhydrous H2SO4 and concentrated H2SO4 mix with water in all proportions, and evolve a great deal
of heat (880 kJ mol–1). If water is poured into concentrated acid, the heat evolved leads to boiling of the
drops of water and causes violent splashing. The safe way to dilute strong acids is to carefully pour the acid
into the water with stirring.
Concentrated H2SO4 has quite strong oxidizing properties. Thus when NaBr is dissolved in concentrated
H2SO4. HBr is formed but in addition some Br − ions are oxidized to Br2. Cu does not react with acids
because it is lower than H in the electrochemical series. However, several noble metals such as Cu dissolve
2+
in concentrated H2SO4 due to its oxidizing properties. The oxidizing properties of SO2−
4 convert Cu into Cu .
Dehydrating properties
Concentrated H2SO4 absorbs water avidly, and is an effective drying agent for gases. It is sometimes used as
a drying agent in desiccators. It dehydrates HNO3, forming the nitronium ion NO+2 , which is very important
in the nitration of organic compounds.
HNO3 + 2H2SO4 → NO2+ + H3O+ + 2 HSO4−
H2SO4 can also remove the elements of water, for example in the preparation of ethers.
2C2H5OH + H2SO4 → C2H5 ∙ O ∙ C2H5 + H2SO4 ∙ H2O
It removes water so strongly from some organic compounds that they char, and only the carbon remains.
Paper and cloth are completely destroyed.
C 12 H 22 O11 ¾conc
¾¾¾¾ . H 2 SO4
® 12C + 11H 2 O
C 6 H 12 O6 ¾conc
¾¾¾¾ . H 2 SO4
® 6C + 6 H 2 O
HOOC - COOH ¾conc
¾¾¾¾ . H 2 SO4
® CO + CO2 + H 2 O
HCOOH ¾conc
¾¾¾¾ . H 2 SO4
® CO + H 2 O
Na 2 SO3 + S ¾boiling
¾¾¾¾ water
® Na 2 S 2 O3 ¾evaporation
¾¾¾® Na 2 S 2 O3 × 5H 2 O
monoclinic crystals
Here, Na2SO3 is prepared by passing SO2 through a solution containing Na2CO3 in excess.
It is also prepared by oxidizing polysulphides with air.
1. Na 2 SO4 + 4C ¾roasting
¾¾® Na 2 S + 4CO
2Na 2 S + 3SO2 ® 2 Na 2 S 2 O3 + S
2. 2Na 2 S + Na 2 CO3 + 4SO2 ® 3Na 2 S 2 O3 + CO2
The thiosulphate ion is structurally similar to the sulphate ion (Figure 10.49).
2Na 2 S 2 O3 + I 2 → Na 2 S 4 O6 + 2NaI
sodium
tetrathionate
O
S
O O−
O−
S
S O−
O−
Hydrated sodium thiosulphate Na2S2O3∙ 5H2O is called ‘hypo’. It forms very large colourless hexagonal
crystals, m.p. 48 °C. It is readily soluble in water and solutions are used for iodine titrations in volumetric
analysis. Iodine very rapidly oxidizes thiosulphate ions S 2 O32− to tetrathionate ions S 4 O62−, and the I2 is
reduced to I − ions.
Na2S2O3 is used in the bleaching industry to destroy any excess Cl2 on fabrics after they have been
through a bleach bath. Similarly Na2S2O3 is sometimes used to remove the taste from heavily chlorinated
drinking water. Since Cl2 is a stronger oxidizing agent than I2, hydrogensulphate ions are formed rather
than tetrathionate ions.
Na2S2O3 + 4Cl2 + 5H2O → 2NaHSO4 + 8HCl
Hypo is used in photography for ‘fxing’ flms and prints. Photographic emulsions are made of AgNO3,
AgCl and AgBr. Parts of the flm exposed to light begin to decompose to Ag, thus forming a negative image.
The process is enhanced by the developer solution. After developing, the flm or print is put in a solution
of hypo (Na2S2O3). This forms a soluble complex with silver salts, thus dissolving any unchanged silver salts
in the photographic emulsion. When there is no photographic emulsion left, the flm or print can safely be
exposed to light.
+ 2Na S O
Na2S2O3 + AgBr →Ag2S2O3
2 2 3
→ Na3[Ag(S2O3)2]
Note: Other properties of S 2 O32- are already covered in Chapter 7.
Pyrosulphates
Pyrosulphates can be made by heating hydrogen sulphates strongly, or by dissolving SO3 in H2SO4. Some
trisulphuric acid H2S3O10 is also formed, but polysulphuric acids higher than this are not known.
2NaHSO4 → Na2S2O7 + H2O
H2SO4 + SO3 → H2S2O7
H2SO4 + 2SO3 → H2S3O10
The dithionate ion has a structure similar to that of ethane, but the two SO3 groups adopt an almost eclipsed
conformation. The S—S length is 2.15 Å and the S—O bonds are 1.43 Å – again rather short. The bond
angles S—S—O are close to tetrahedral (103°).
A range of polythionates have been known as salts since the early work of Wackenroder on the effect
of H2S on aqueous solutions of SO2. Ions such as trithionate S 3O62− , tetrathionate S 4 O62−, pentathìonate
S 5O62− and hexathionate S6 O62− are named according to the total number of S atoms present. It is only in
recent times that the parent acids have been made.
O O
HO S (S)n S OH
O O
polythionic acid
Peroxoacid series
The name peroxo indicates that the compound contains an —O—O— linkage. Two peroxoacids of
sulphur are known: peroxomonosulphuric acid H2SO5 and peroxodisulphuric acid H2S2O8. No peroxoacids
_
@edubuzznotes
500 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
of Se and Te are known. H2S2O8 is a colourless solid, m.p. 65 °C. It is obtained by electrolysis of sulphates at
high current density. It is soluble in water, and is a powerful and useful oxidizing agent. It will convert Mn2+
to permanganate and Cr3+ to chromate. The most important salts are (NH4)2S2O8 and K2S2O8.
Hydrolysis of peroxodisulphuric acid gives peroxomonosulphuric acid, H2SO5, which is often called
Caro’s acid.
O O O O
HO S O O S OH → HO S O OH + HO S OH
O O O O
10.53 | OXOHALIDES
Thionyl compounds
The following thionyl compounds are known
SOF2 SOCl2 SOBr2
Thionyl chloride SOCl2 is a colourless fuming liquid, b.p. 78 °C, and is usually prepared as follows:
PCl5 + SO2 → SOCl2 + POCl3
Most thionyl compounds are readily hydrolysed by water, though SOF2 only reacts slowly.
SOCl2 + H2O → SO2 + 2HCl
The structure of these oxohalides is tetrahedral with one position occupied by a lone pair.
:
S X
O X
Sulphuryl compounds
The following sulphuryl halides are known
Sulphuryl chloride SO2Cl2 is a colourless fuming liquid, b.p. 69 °C, and is made by direct reaction of SO2
and Cl2 in the presence of a catalyst. It is used as a chlorinating agent. Sulphuryl fuoride is a gas and is
not hydrolysed by water, but the chloride fumes in moist air and is hydrolysed by water. The sulphuryl
halides have a distorted tetrahedral structure. They may be regarded as derivatives of H2SO4, where both
OH groups have been replaced by halogens. If only one group is replaced, halosulphuric acids are obtained.
FSO3H ClSO3H BrSO3H
Fluorosulphuric acid forms many salts, but chlorosulphuric acid forms none and is used as a chlorinating
agent in organic chemistry.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.54 Hydrides 501
10.54 | HYDRIDES
The elements all form covalent hydrides. These are water H2O, hydrogen sulphide H2S, hydrogen selenide
H2Se, hydrogen telluride H2Te and hydrogen polonide H2Po. Water is liquid at room temperature, but the
others are all colourless, foul smelling toxic gases.
Our point of interest is H2S which can be prepared by the action of mineral acids on metal sulphides or
hydrolysis.
FeS + H 2 SO4 ® H 2 S ↑ + FeSO4
Al 2 S 3 + 6H 2 O ® 2Al(OH)3 + 3H 2 S
Cr2 S 3 + 6H 2 O ® 2Cr(OH)3 + 3H 2 S
This gas can be dried by anhydrous CaCl2 or P2O5. Concentrated sulphuric acid is also a very good drying
agent but cannot be used for this purpose because it oxidizes H2S to S.
H 2 SO4 + H 2 S ® S ¯ +SO2 ↑ +2H 2 O
H2S, is soluble in water and burns in air with a blue fame.
Water
Water is the most abundant chemical compound, and the oceans cover almost 71% of the earth’s surface.
For this reason we have no need to prepare water. However, sea water contains many dissolved salts, and
less than 3% of the earth’s water is fresh water, and most of that is present as polar ice. The preparation of
_
@edubuzznotes
502 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
pure water for drinking and laboratory use is a major industry. The human body is more tolerant of some
impurities than is industry.
Very pure water is required for laboratory and industrial use. The only way to remove all solid solutes
is distillation. This is expensive since water has a high boiling point and high latent heat of evaporation.
During distillation the water tends to dissolve appreciable amounts of CO2 from the atmosphere, which
make it acidic. A cheaper method is to produce deionized water. This is done by passing the water down two
different ion•exchange columns one after the other. (Alternatively a ‘mixed bed’ may be used, i.e. a single
column made up of two different ion•exchange materials.) Ion•exchange resins are insoluble polymeric
solids, containing a reactive group. They are manufactured in bead form, and are permeable to water.
The frst column contains a sulphonic acid resin, that is an organic resin with acidic groups — SO3H. This
removes all metal ions from solution and replaces them with H+:
Water produced in this way usually contains soluble silicates and CO2. When all the reactive sites on the
resin have been used, the resins can be regenerated by treating the frst one with dilute H2SO4, and the
second one with a Na2CO3 solution.
Drinking water is usually much less pure, and water with no dissolved salts does not taste very nice.
The World Health Organization recommends a maximum desirable content of not more than 0.5 grams of
dissolved solids per litre, though the maximum permissible level is three times this. If the fresh water source
contains silt, this is allowed to settle out. Light Suspended particles and colloidal particles which discolour
the water are removed by treating with Al(OH)3 or Fe(OH)3. These coagulate suspended particles, thus
clarifying the water. (Alum is the most widely used coagulating agent.) If necessary some water softening
may be performed by ion•exchange, or by mixing water from different sources. The water is then chlori•
nated, or treated with ozone to kill bacteria. These are present because of drainage from felds into rivers
and lakes, and also from the disposal of partly treated and untreated sewage. Failure to treat drinking water
is the major cause of enteritis. In some underdeveloped parts of the world up to half the children under the
age of fve die from this cause or other waterborne diseases.
Sea water has a high salt content. The production of drinking water and water for crops from sea water
is called desalination. It requires a large amount of energy, and is therefore expensive. It is only carried out
when the shortage of fresh water is severe, but it has become increasingly important in arid regions like the
Persian Gulf. Distillation, ion•exchange, electrodialysis, reverse osmosis and the freezing out of ice have all
been used.
Apart from water, the other hydrides are all poisonous and have unpleasant odours. The hydrides decrease
in stability from H2O to H2S to H2Se to H2Te. (This is shown by the decrease in their enthalpies of forma•
tion – Table 10.23.) They become less stable because the bonding orbitals become larger and more diffuse:
hence overlap with the hydrogen 1s orbital is less effective.
Table 10.23 Some properties of H2O, H2S, H2Se and H2Te
Enthalpies of formation (kJ mol−1) Bond angle Boiling point (°C)
The H—O—H bond angle in water is 104°28′, in accordance with the VSEPR prediction of slightly less
than tetrahedral due to the presence of lone pairs of electrons. Thus the orbitals used for bonding by O are
_
@edubuzznotes
10.54 Hydrides 503
close to sp3 hybrids. In H2S, H2Se and H2Te the bond angles become close to 90°. This suggests that almost
pure p orbitals on Se and Te are used for bonding to hydrogen.
In a series of similar compounds, the boiling points usually increase as the atoms become larger and
heavier. If the boiling points increase, then the volatility decreases. This trend is shown by the boiling points
of H2S, H2Se, H2Te and H2Po, but the boiling point of water is anomalous.
Water has an abnormally low volatility because its molecules are associated with each other by means
of hydrogen bonds in both the solid and liquid states. The structure of liquid water is not known for certain,
but probably consists of groups of two or three molecules hydrogen bonded together. The structure of
ordinary hexagonal ice is known. At high pressures other more dense structures are formed. A total of nine
different forms of ice are known. X•ray studies do not often reveal the positions of H atoms. In this case
the H positions were found by neutron diffraction on solid deuterium oxide D2O. The structure is similar
to wurtzite ZnS (see Chapter 3), with O atoms occupying both the Zn2+ and the S2− positions. The H atoms
are located just off the line joining two O atoms, and the O—H . . .O angle is 104°28′, The strength of a
hydrogen bond is about 20 kJ mol −1. This association is responsible for the abnormally high boiling point
and melting point of water.
The H bonding is the main reason why covalent compounds have a very low solubility in water. When
two substances mix there is an increase in entropy since the order decreases. Thus mixing is always favoured.
However, in the case of water, dissolving something means that hydrogen bonds must be broken. Unless
there is an interaction between the dissolved material and water greater than the energy lost through
breaking hydrogen bonds, then the material will not dissolve. Covalent materials have little interaction with
water, and so are insoluble. Ionic materials become hydrated, and polar materials take part in the hydrogen
bonding, so they are soluble.
A unique property of water is that the solid is less dense than the liquid. This is why lakes and the sea
freeze from the top downwards. The ice at the top makes it diffcult to cool the water underneath, so even
at the North Pole there is water underneath the ice. But for this the sea would freeze solid and the polar
ice•caps would cover much more of the earth’s surface. The maximum density of water occurs at 4 °C. On
melting, the hydrogen bonded network in the solid partly breaks down. Ice has a rather open structure,
with quite large cavities. On partial melting some ‘free’ water molecules occupy some of these cavities, and
hence the density increases. This effect outweighs the effect of thermal expansion up to 4 °C, but above this
temperature expansion is the larger effect so the density decreases.
Other hydrides
The hydrides dissociate to a varying degree, forming H+ ions. They are all very weak acids and there is
an increase in acidic strength from H2O to H2Te. In the compounds H2O, H2S, H2Se and H2Te the most
important factor is the enthalpy of formation, the values being –120, –10, +43 and +77 kJ mol−1. The
stability decreases (the last two are in fact thermodynamically unstable), thus accounting for the greater
dissociation of H2Te.
H 2 Te(hydrated) + H 2 O ⇌ H 3O+ + HTe-(hydrated)
The more acidic the hydrogen atom in the hydrides, the more stable will be the salts formed from them,
i.e. oxides, sulphides, selenides and tellurides.
H2S3 H—S—S—S—H
H2S4 H—S—S—S—S—H
_
@edubuzznotes
504 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
H2O2 and H2S2 have similar ‘skew’ structures. The dimensions of H2O2 gas are shown in Figure 10.50. H2O2
is the smallest molecule known to show restricted rotation, in this case about the O—O bond. A similar
structure is retained in the liquid and solid, but the bond lengths and angles are slightly changed because
of hydrogen bonding.
1.48Å
O
H
94°48′
94°48′
O
H
111°30′
Hydrogen peroxide
Preparation
Now•a•days instead of conc. H2SO4, H3PO4 is used because H2SO4 catalyzes the decomposition of
H2O2.
3BaO2 + 2 H 3 PO4 ® 3H 2 O2 + Ba 3 (PO4 )
Then H3PO4 is regenerated as follows, so indirectly H2SO4 is used.
2SO24 - ¾electrolysis
¾¾¾¾ ® S 2 O82 - + 2e
H 2 S 2 O8 + H 2 O ® H 2 SO5 + H 2SO 4
peroxodisulphuric peroxomonosulphuric
acid acid
H 2 SO5 + H 2 O ® H 2 SO4 + H 2 O2
3. H2O2 is now produced on an industrial scale by a cyclic process (Figure 10.51). 2•Ethyl anthroquinol
is oxidized by air to the corresponding quinone and H2O2. The anthraquinone is reduced back to
anthraquinol with hydrogen at a moderate temperature using platinum, palladium or Raney nickel as
catalyst. The cycle is then repeated. The reaction is carried out in a mixture of organic solvents (ester/
hydrocarbon or octanol/methylnaphthalene). The solvent must:
a. dissolve the quinol and quinone
b. resist oxidation
c. be immiscible with water.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.54 Hydrides 505
OH O OH
C2H5 C2H5 C2H5
O2 H2/Pd or Pt or
Raney Ni H2O2 +
OH O OH
The H2O2 is extracted with water as a 1% solution. This is concentrated by distillation under reduced
pressure, and sold as a 30% (by weight) solution which has a pH of about 4.0 (85% solutions are also
produced). H2O2 solutions are stored in plastic or wax coated glass vessels, often with negative catalysts
such as urea or sodium stannate added as stabilizers. Solutions keep quite well, but must be handled with
care since they may explode with traces of organic material or dust.
Physical properties
Pure H2O2 is a colourless liquid which resembles water quite closely. It is more hydrogen bonded than is
water and so has a higher boiling point (b.p. 152 °C, m.p. – 0.4 °C). It is more dense than water (density
1.4g cm–3), though it has a high dielectric constant.
Chemical properties
H2O2 is unstable, and the rate at which it decomposes (disproportionates) depends on the temperature and
concentration. Many impurities catalyse the decomposition, which may become very violent, especially
concentrated solutions. Catalysts include metal ions Fe2+, Fe3+, Co2+, Ni2+, metal surfaces such as Pt or Ag,
MnO2, charcoal or alkali –even the small amount leached from glass.
2 H 2 O2 ® 2 H 2 O + O2
H 2 O2 + 2 NaOH ® Na 2 O2 + H 2 O
H 2 O2 + Ba(OH)2 ® BaO2 + 2 H 2 O
H 2 O2 + Na 2 CO3 ® Na 2 O2 + CO2 + H 2 O
In most of its reactions H2O2 acts as a strong oxidizing agent. In acidic solutions these reactions are often
slow, but in basic solution they are usually fast. H2O2 will oxidize Fe2+ to Fe3+, [FeII(CN)6)]4– (ferrocyanide)
to [FeIII(CN)6]3– (ferricyanide), NH2OH to HNO3 and SO2− 3 to SO2−
4 .
Ionic peroxides such as Na2O2 give H2O2 with water or dilute acids. Na2O2 reacts with gaseous CO2.
2 Na 2 O2 + 2CO2 ® 2 Na 2 CO3 + O2
Heating Na2O2 with many organic compounds results in their oxidation to carbonates. Fusing Na2O2 with
Fe2+ salts gives sodium ferrate Na2[FeO4] which contains Fe(+VI).
Some important reactions of H2O2 as oxidizing agent are listed as follows.
1. PbS + 4 H 2 O2 ® PbSO4 + 4 H 2 O
2. NaNO2 + H 2 O2 ® NaNO3 + H 2 O
3. Na 2 SO3 + H 2 O2 ® Na 2 SO4 + H 2 O
4. Na 3 AsO3 + H 2 O2 ® Na 3 AsO4 + H 2 O
5. 2KI + H 2 O2 ® 2KOH + I 2
_
@edubuzznotes
506 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
6. H 2 S + H 2 O2 ® S ¯ + 2 H 2 O
7. H 2 SO4 + 2 FeSO4 + H 2 O2 ® Fe2 (SO4 )3 + 2 H 2 O
8. 2K 4 [Fe(CN)6 ] + H 2 O + H 2 SO4 ® 2K 3 [Fe(CN)6 ] + K 2 SO4 + 2H 2 O
9. 2[Cr(OH)4 ]- + 3H 2 O2 + 2OH - ® 2CrO24 - + 8 H 2 O
2- +
10. CrO4 + 2 H + 2 H 2 O2 ® CrO5 ¯ + 3H 2 O
blue
+ 3+
4CrO5 + 12 H ® 4Cr + 7O2 + 6H 2 O
2+ -
11. Mn + OH + H 2 O2 ® MnO2 + 2 H 2 O
With stronger oxidizing agents H2O2 is oxidized, that is H2O2 is forced to act as a reducing agent, and in
such cases O2 is always evolved. For example,
2KMnO4 + 5H 2 O2 + 3H 2 SO4 ® 2MnSO4 + K 2 SO4 + 5O2 + 8H 2 O
KIO4 + H 2 O2 ® KIO3 + O2 + H 2 O
2Ce(SO4 )2 + H 2 O2 ® Ce2 (SO4 )3 + 2H 2 SO4 + O2
Some important reactions of H2O2 as reducing agent are listed as follows.
1. Ag 2 O + H 2 O ® 2 Ag + H 2 O + O2
2. O3 + H 2 O2 ® H 2 O + 2O2
3. MnO3 + H 2 O2 + H 2 SO4 ® MnSO4 + 2 H 2 O + O2
4. PbO2 + H 2 O2 ® PbO + H 2 O + O2
5. Pb 3O4 + H 2 O2 + 6 HNO3 ® 3Pb(NO3 )2 + 4 H 2 O + O2
9. NaOCl + H 2 O2 ® NaCl + H 2 O + O2
Uses
Important uses of hydrogen peroxide are listed as follows.
1. H2O2 is a major industrial chemical, and is used extensively as a mild bleaching agent for textiles and
paper/wood pulp.
2. It is used for several environmental purposes: to restore aerobic conditions in sewage waters, and to
oxidize cyanides and sulphides.
3. It is an important rocket fuel. When it is mixed with N2H4 in 1:2 proportion, its reaction is highly exo•
thermic as well as associated with large increase in volume.
N 2 H 4 (l) + 2H 2 O(l) ® N 2 ↑ + 4 H 2 O ↑
Three mole liquid produces fve moles of gas, which causes huge volume expansion.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.55 Halides 507
4. It is also used for making other chemicals, particularly sodium peroxoborate Na2[B2(O2)2(OH)4]∙6H2O,
which is used as a brightener in washing powders.
H 3 BO3 + H 2 O2 → H 2 O + (OH)2 B − O − O − H
- O O -
2(HO)2 B O O H + 2NaOH + 4H2O Na2+ [(OH)2 B B(OH)2].6H2O
O O
Sodium peroxoborate
5. Smaller amounts of H2O2 are used to bleach hair, feathers, fats and waxes.
7. It is useful to counteract chlorine, and in this reaction H2O2 behaves as a reducing agent.
H 2 O2 + Cl 2 → 2HCl + O2
The H2O2 is extracted with water as a 1% solution. This is concentrated by distillation under reduced
pressure, and sold as a 30% (by weight) solution which has a pH of about 4.0 (85% solutions are also
produced). H2O2 solutions are stored in plastic or wax coated glass vessels, often with negative catalysts
such as urea or sodium stannate added as stabilizers. Solutions keep quite well, but must be handled with
care since they may explode with traces of organic material or specs of dust.
10.55 | HALIDES
Compounds with the halogens are listed in Table 10.24. Since F is more electronegative than O, binary
compounds are oxygen fuorides, whereas similar chlorine compounds are chlorine oxides. Some of
these compounds including the oxides of iodine, are therefore described in under ‘Halogen oxides’.
Table 10.24 Compounds with the halogens
MX6 MX4 MX2 M2X2 M2X Others
O OF2 O2F2 O3F2, O4F2
Cl2O ClO2 Cl2O6, Cl2O7
Br2O BrO2 BrO3
I2O4, I4O9, I2O5
S SF6 SF4 SF2 S2F2 SSF2, S2F4, S2F10
SCl4 SCl2 S2Cl2
S2Br2
Se SeF6 SeF4
SeCl4 Se2Cl2
SeBr4 Se2Br2
Te TeF6 TeF4
TeCl4 TeCl2
TeBr4 TeBr2
Tel4 TeI2
Po PoCl4 PoCl2
PoBr4 PoBr2
PoI4 (PoI2)
Compounds shown in parentheses are unstable.
Fluorine brings out the maximum valency of six with S, Se and Te; and SF6, SeF6 and TeF6 are all formed
by direct combination. They are all colourless gases and have an octahedral structure as predicted by the
VSEPR theory. The low boiling point indicates a high degree of covalency.
_
@edubuzznotes
508 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
3s 3p 3d
Electronic structure
of sulphur – excited
state
six unpaired electrons form bonds with six fluorine atoms,
hence octahedral shape
SF6 is a colourless, odourless, non•fammable gas, which is insoluble in water and extremely inert. SeF6 is
slightly more reactive and TeF6 is hydrolzed by water. This is possibly due to the larger size of Te which
permits the larger coordination number necessary in the frst stage of hydrolysis.
TeF6 + 6H2O → 6HF + H6TeO6
SF4 is highly reactive, but is more stable than the lower fuorides. In contrast to the relatively stable
hexafuorides, the tetrahalides are very sensitive to water.
Mustard gas is not a gas but a volatile liquid (m.p. 13 °C, b.p. 215 °C). It was sprayed as a mist that stayed
close to the ground, and was blown by gentle winds onto the enemy. It causes severe blistering of the skin
and death. In living cells it is converted into the divinyl compound (CH2CH)2S which reacts with and
disrupts proteins in the cell.
The dihalides form angular molecules, based on a tetrahedron with two positions occupied by lone
pairs. The lone pairs distort the tetrahedral angle of 109°28′ to 103° in SCl2, 101.5° in F2O and 98° in TeBr2.
3s 3p
Electronic structure of
sulphuric atom – ground
state
two unpaired electrons can form bonds with two chlorine atoms
four electron pairs, hence structure is tetrahedral with two lone pairs
Dimeric monohalides such as S2F2 and S2Cl2 are formed by direct action between S and the halogens. S2Cl2
is a toxic yellow liquid (m.p. −76 °C, b.p. 138 °C), with a revolting smell. The structure of S2Cl2 and the other
monohalides is similar to that of H2O2, with a bond angle of 104° which is due to distortion by two lone
pairs.
S2F2 is an unstable compound. It exists in two different isomeric forms, F—S—S—F (like Cl—S—S—Cl
and H—O—O—H), and thiothionyl fuoride S = SF2.
The compound S2F10 has an unusual structure, of two octahedra joined together.
F F F F
F S S F
F F F F
_
@edubuzznotes
Multiple Correct Choice Type Questions 509
(A) O3 (P) Very good fuorinating (C) Caro’s acid (R) Peroxy linkage is
agent. (H2SO5) present.
(B) H2O2 (Q) Used for preparing (D) Oleum (H2S2O7) (S) S–S linkage is present.
mustard gas.
(C) SF4 (R) Used as rocket fuel. (T) It is not a ring system.
(D) SCl2 (S) Used to purify drinking 3. Match the compounds with their properties.
water.
Column I Column II
2. Match the compounds with the correct statement
about them. (A) O3 (P) Acts as reducing agent.
(B) H2O2 (Q) Acts as oxidising agent.
Column I Column II
(C) SO2 (R) Molecule is polar.
(A) g–SO3 (P) Consists of S–O–S (D) H2S (S) Molecule is planar.
linkage.
(B) Na2S4O6 (Q) S is in the maximum
oxidation state.
_
@edubuzznotes
512 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (D) 3. (B) 5. (C) 7. (D)
2. (A) 4. (A) 6. (C)
The name halogen comes from the Greek, and means salt former. The elements all react directly with
metals to form salts, and they are also very reactive with non•metals. Fluorine is the most reactive element
known.
The elements all have seven electrons in their outer shell. The s2 p5 confguration is one p electron less
than that of the next noble gas. Thus atoms complete their octet either by acquiring an electron (i.e. through
forming an ionic bond, giving X −), or by sharing an electron with another atom (thus forming a covalent
bond). Compounds with metals are typically ionic, whilst those with non–metals are covalent.
The halogens show very close group similarities. Fluorine (the frst element in the group) differs in several
ways from the rest of the group. The frst element of each of the main groups all show differences from the
subsequent elements. The reasons for the difference are:
1. The frst element is smaller than the rest, and holds its electrons more frmly.
2. It has no low•lying d orbitals which may be used for bonding.
The properties of chlorine and bromine are closer than those between the other pairs of elements because
their sizes are closer. The ionic radius of Cl− is 38% larger than that of F −, but the radius of Br− is only 6.5%
larger than that of Cl−. The relatively small change in size occurs because Br− contains ten 3d electrons,
which shield the nuclear charge ineffectively. This also results in the electronegativity values being particu•
larly close for these two elements. Thus there is little difference in polarity of the bonds formed by Cl and
Br with other elements.
The oxidation states (±I) are by far the most common (Table 10.25). Whether it is (–I) or (+I) depends
on whether the halogen is the most electronegative element. Higher oxidation states exist for all of the
elements except F. The lack of low•lying empty d orbitals in the second shell prevents F from forming more
than one normal covalent bond.
Fluorine is a very strong oxidizing agent, and this together with its small size allows it to form compounds
that bring out the highest oxidation state of other elements. Examples include IF7, PtF6, SF6 and many other
hexafuorides, BiF5, SbF5, TbF4 and K[AgIIIF4].
The elements all exist as diatomic molecules, and they are all coloured. Gaseous F2 is light yellow, Cl2
gas is yellow–green. Br2 gas and liquid are dark red–brown, and I2 gas is violet. The colours arise from the
absorption of light on promoting an electron from the ground state to a higher state. On descending
the group the energy levels become closer, so the promotion energy becomes less and the wavelength of
the band becomes longer.
I2 solid crystallizes as black fakes, and has a slightly metallic lustre. Though the X•ray structure
shows discrete I2 molecules, the colour is reminiscent of charge transfer compounds, and the properties
are different from those of other molecular solids. The solid conducts electricity to a small extent, and
the conductivity increases when the temperature is raised. This behaviour is like that of an intrinsic
semiconductor, and different from metals. However, liquid I2 conducts very slightly. This is ascribed to
self•ionization:
3I 2 ⇌ I 3+ + I 3−
_
@edubuzznotes
514 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
HF F2 H2
(in) (out) (out)
Cooling impact
Carbon anode
Steel cathode
Electrolyte
7. The cathodes are made of steel, the anodes are carbon, and tefon is used for electrical insulation
(Figure 10.61). Graphite anodes must not be used, since graphite reacts with fuorine, forming graphite
compounds CF. In these, fuorine atoms progressively invade the space between the sheets of graphite,
forcing them apart, and buckling them. This gradually stops the graphite from conducting, the current
needed increases, more heat is produced, and eventually an explosion may occur. Ungraphitized
carbon is used to avoid this. It is made from powdered coke compacted and impregnated with copper.
Cylinders of F2 are now commercially available. However, for many purposes F2 is converted to ClF3
(b.p. 12 °C), which though very reactive is less unpleasant and easier to transport.
200 − 300 C
3F2 +Cl 2
→ 2ClF3
Production of fuorine frst became important for the manufacture of inorganic fuorides such as AlF3 and
synthetic Na3[AlF6]. Both are used in the extraction of aluminium.
The fuorocarbons are a very interesting and useful group of compounds, derived from hydrocarbons by
substituting F for H. Tetrafuoromethane CF4 is the fuorocarbon corresponding to methane. Completely
fuorinated compounds CnF2n+2 are called perfuoro compounds. Thus CF4 is perfuoromethane. Perfuoro
compounds have very low boiling points for their molecular weight: this is associated with very weak inter•
molecular forces. Fluorocarbons are extremely inert. Unlike methane, CF4 can be heated in air without
burning. Fluorocarbons are inert to concentrated HNO3 and H2SO4, to strong oxidizing agents such as
KMnO4 or O3, and to strong reducing agents such as Li[AlH4] or C at 1000 °C. They are attacked by molten
Na. When pyrolysed at very high temperatures the C—C bonds break rather than the C—F bonds.
Tetrafuoroethene F2C = CF2 (b.p. −76.6 °C) can be made:
2CHClF2 500
→ CF2 = CF2 + 2HCl
−1000 ° C
Fluoroalkenes of this type can be polymerized either thermally, or using a free radical initiator. Depending
on the degree of polymerization, that is on the molecular weight produced, the products may be oils, greases
or a solid of high molecular weight called polytetrafuoroethylene. This is similar to ethene (formerly called
ethylene) polymerizing to give polyethylene (polythene). Polytetrafuoroethylene is known commercially
as PTFE or Tefon. It is a very inert solid plastic material, and is useful because it is completely resistant to
chemical attack and is an electrical insulator. Though expensive, it is used in laboratories. It is also used as
a coating for non•stick pans.
Freons are mixed chlorofuorocarbons. Compounds such as CClF3, CCl2F2 and CCl3F are important
as non•toxic refrigerating fuids and aerosol propellants. They too are very inert, and are discussed later.
CF3CHBrCl is used as an anaesthetic called Fluothane.
Another use of F2 is to make SF6, which is a very inert gas used as a dielectric (insulating) medium for
high voltage equipment. F2 is also used to make other fuorinating agents ClF3, BrF3 and IF5 and SbF5. The
earlier use of liquid F2 as an oxidizing agent in rocket motors has now been discontinued. Anhydrous HF
has many uses.
Traces of fuoride ions F − in drinking water (about 1 ppm) greatly reduce the incidence of dental
caries (tooth decay). The F − ions make the enamel on teeth much harder, by converting hydroxyapatite
[3(Ca3(PO4)2 ∙ Ca(OH)2] (the enamel on the surface of teeth) into the much harder fuoroapatite
[3(Ca3(PO4)2 ∙ CaF2]. However, F − concentrations above 2 ppm cause discoloration, the brown mottling
of teeth, and higher concentrations are harmful. In some places NaF and H2[SiF6] are added to drinking
water, where the natural water is very soft and contains insuffcient naturally occurring F − ions. NaF is
now used in fuoride toothpaste. (The original fuoride toothpaste contained SnF2 and Sn2P2O7.)
Chlorine
Chlorine was frst prepared by Scheele by oxidizing HCl with MnO2. This method was used as a laboratory
preparation, but chlorine is now readily available in cylinders.
Gas prepared from MnO2 in this way must be purifed. First it is passed through water to remove HCl,
and then through concentrated H2SO4 to remove water. It may be further dried by passing it over CaO
and P4O10.
Chlorine is produced commercially on a vast scale by two main methods.
1. By the electrolysis of aqueous NaCl solutions in the manufacture of NaOH.
2. By electrolysis of fused NaCl in the manufacture of sodium.
Before 1960 chlorine was a by•product from these processes. Since then there has been a great increase in
the use of chlorine, mainly in the manufacture of plastics such as polyvinyl chloride. Thus chlorine is now
the major product.
electrolyze
2NaCl + 2H 2 O
→ 2NaOH + Cl 2 + 2H 2
electrolyze
→ 2Na + Cl 2
2NaCl
At one time chlorine was produced by oxidizing HCl with air, using the Deacon process. This process
became obsolete (and now a modifed Deacon process is now used to a small extent. It utilizes HCl obtained
as a by•product from the pyrolysis of 1,2•dichloroethane to vinyl chloride, and uses an improved catalyst
(CuCl2 with didymium oxide as promoter; didymium is an old name meaning ‘twin’, and it consists of two
lanthanide elements praseodymium and neodymium). This works at a slightly lower temperature than the
original process.
400 − 450 °C
CH 2 Cl − CH 2 Cl
→ CH 2 = CHCl + HCl
CuCl 2
2 HCl + 21 O2 (from air) ¾didymium
¾¾¾ ® H 2 O + Cl 2
oxide
Chlorine gas is toxic. It was used as a poison gas in World War I. The gas is detectable by smell at a
concentration of 3 ppm, and 15 ppm causes a sore throat and running eyes. Higher concentrations cause
coughing, lung damage, and death.
About two thirds of World production of chlorine is used to make organic chloro compounds, one ffth
for bleaching, and the rest for the manufacture of a variety of inorganic chemicals. The main two organic
compounds produced are:
1,2–dichloroethane
vinyl chloride monomer
Both are used in the plastics industry.
Large amounts of chlorine are used for bleaching textiles, wood, pulp and paper. Chlorine is widely used
throughout the developed world to purify drinking water, because it kills bacteria. It is also used to make a
wide variety of inorganic chemicals including:
bleaching powder
sodium hypochlorite NaOCl
chlorine dioxide ClO2
sodium chlorate NaClO3
many metal and non•metal chlorides
organic compounds like CCl4, CHCl3, DDT
It is also used to prepare poisonous gases like phosgene (COCl2), tear gas (Cl3CNO2) and mustard gas
(ClCH2 CH2S CH2 CH2Cl).
Bromine
Bromine is obtained from sea water and brine lakes. Sea water contains about 65 ppm Br−. Thus 15 tonnes
of sea water contain about 1 kg of bromine. Bromine is extracted from sea water, but it is more economic to
use more concentrated brine sources which contain 2000–5000 ppm of Br−. First H2SO4 is added to adjust
_
@edubuzznotes
10.57 General Properties 517
the pH to about 3.5. Then Cl2 gas is passed through the solution to oxidize the Br− to Br2. This is an example
of displacement of one element by another higher in the electrochemical series.
Cl2 + 2Br− → 2Cl− + Br2
The Br2 is removed by a stream of air, because Br2 is quite volatile. The gas is passed through a solution of
Na2CO3, when the Br2 is absorbed, forming a mixture of NaBr and NaBrO3. Finally the solution is acidifed
and distilled to give pure bromine.
3Br2 + 3Na2CO3 → 5NaBr + NaBrO3 + 3CO2
5NaBr + NaBrO3 + 3H2SO4 → 5HBr + HBrO3 + 3Na2SO4
5HBr + HBrO3 → 3Br2 + 3H2O
1,2•dibromoethane is added to petrol to act as a lead scavenger. Tetraethyl lead is added to petrol to
improve its octane rating, but when it burns it forms lead deposits. 1,2•dibromoethane is added to prevent
the build•up of lead deposits on the sparking plug and in the engine. The lead passes out with the exhaust
gases, mainly as PbClBr. The use of PbEt4 as an anti•knock additive to petrol has already declined, and will
decline further because of legislation against its use, and environmental concern over the toxic effects of
lead. Therefore the use of 1,2•dibromoethane has also declined.
Iodine
There are two different commercial methods of obtaining iodine. The method used depends on whether the
source is Chile saltpetre or natural brines.
Chile saltpetre is mainly NaNO3, but it contains traces of sodium iodate NaIO3 and sodium periodate
NaIO4. Pure NaNO3 is obtained by dissolving saltpetre in water and crystallizing NaNO3. The iodate
residues thus accumulate and concentrate in the mother liquor. Eventually, this concentrate is divided
into two parts. One part is reduced with NaHSO3 to give I−. This is mixed with the untreated part, giving
I2, which is fltered off as a solid and then purifed by sublimation.
There is no one dominant use. Half of the iodine produced is used to make a variety of organic
compounds including iodoform CHI3 (used as an antiseptic), and methyl iodide CH3I. Agl is used for
photographic flms, and for seeding clouds to produce rain. Small amounts of iodine are required in the
human diet, so traces (10 ppm) of NaI are added to table salt. KI is added to animal and poultry feeds.
The thyroid gland produces a growth regulating hormone called thyroxine which contains iodine. The
defciency of iodine causes disease goitre. Iodine has limited use as an antiseptic; tincture of iodine is an
aqueous solution of I2 in KI, and French iodine is a solution in alcohol. In the laboratory iodides and iodates
are used in volumetric analysis, and Nessler’s reagent K2[HgI4] is used to detect ammonia.
Ionization energy
The ionization energies of the halogens show the usual trend to smaller values as the atoms increase in size
(Table 10.27). The values are very high, and there is little tendency for the atoms to lose electrons and form
positiveions.
The ionization energy for F is appreciably higher than for the others, because of its small size. F always has
an oxidation state of (−I) except in F2. It forms compounds either by gaining an electron to form F−, or by
sharing an electron to form a covalent bond.
Hydrogen has an ionization energy of 1311 kJ mol−1, and it forms H+ ions. It is at frst surprising that
the halogens Cl, Br and I have lower ionization energies than H, yet they do not form simple X+ ions. The
ionization energy is the energy required to produce an ion from a single isolated gaseous atom. Usually
we have a crystalline solid, or a solution, so the lattice energy or hydration energy must also be considered.
Because H+ is very small, crystals containing H+ have a high lattice energy, and in solution the hydration
energy is also very high (1091 kJ mol−1). The negative ions also have a hydration energy. Thus H+ ions are
formed because the lattice energy, or the hydration energy, exceeds the ionization energy. In contrast the
halogen cation X+ would be large and thus have low hydration and lattice energies. Since the ionization
energy would be larger than the lattice energy or hydration energy, these ions are not normally formed.
However, a few compounds are known where I+ is stabilized by forming a complex with a Lewis base, for
example [I(pyridine)2] + NO3 .
−
The electron affnities for the halogens are all negative. This shows that energy is evolved when a
halogen atom gains an electron, and X → X−. Thus, the halogens all form halide ions.
(a)
Cl Cl Cl
Al Al
Cl Cl Cl
(b)
The halogens all have very high electronegativity values. When they react with metals there will be a
large electronegativity difference: hence they form ionic bonds.
When two halogen atoms form a molecule, they form a covalent bond. Most compounds between
the halogens and non•metals are also covalent. Fluorine is always univalent, and since it is the most
electronegative element it always has the oxidation number (−I). With Cl, Br and I, a covalence of one is
the most common. The oxidation state may be either (−I) or (+I) depending on which atom in the molecule
has the greater electronegativity.
Cl, Br and I also exhibit higher valencies, with oxidation numbers of (+III), (+V) and (+VII). These
higher valency states are covalent, and arise quite logically by promoting electrons from flled p and s
levels to empty d levels. The unpaired electrons then form three, fve or seven covalent bonds. There are
numerous examples of higher valency states in the interhalogens and halogen oxides.
ns np nd
Electronic structure of full
halogen atom – ground inner
state shell
(Only one unpaired electron, so can only form one covalent bond)
The oxidation states (+IV) and (+VI) occur in the oxides ClO2, BrO2, Cl2O6 and BrO3.
orbitals. Cl2, Br2 and I2 show the expected trend (Table 10.29), but the bond energy for F2 does not ft the
expected trend. Hence the order is Cl2 > Br2 > F2 > I2.
The bond energy in F2 is abnormally low (126 kJ mol−1), and this is largely responsible for its very high
reactivity. (Other elements in the frst row of the periodic table also have weaker bonds than the elements
which follow in their respective groups. For example in Group 15 the N—N bond in hydrazine is weaker
than P—P, and in Group 16 the O—O bond in peroxides is weaker than S—S.) Two different explanations
have been suggested for the low bond energy:
1. Mulliken postulated that in Cl2, Br2 and I2 some pd hybridization occurred, allowing some multiple
bonding. This would make the bonds stronger than in F2 in which there are no d orbitals available.
2. Coulson suggested that since fuorine atoms are small, the F—F distance is also small (1.48 Å), and
hence internuclear repulsion is appreciable. The large electron – electron repulsions between the lone
pairs of electrons on the two fuorine atoms weaken the bond.
It seems unnecessary to invoke multiple bonding to explain these facts, and the simpler Coulson explanation
is widely accepted.
Oxidizing power
Electron affnity is the tendency of the atoms to gain electrons. This reaches a maximum at chlorine.
(See Table 10.27) Oxidation may be regarded as the removal of electrons, so that an oxidizing agent gains
electrons. Thus the halogens act as oxidizing agents. The strength of an oxidizing agent (that is, its oxidation
potential) depends on several energy terms and is best represented by a Born–Haber type of energy cycle
(Figure 10.54).
The oxidation potential is the energy change between the element in its standard state, and in its
hydrated ions. Thus for iodine the change is from 21 I2(solid) to I(hydrated). Thus the oxidation potential is equal
−
to the sum of the energy put in as the enthalpies of fusion, vaporization and dissociation, less the energy
evolved as the electron affnity and enthalpy of hydration.
In a similar cycle the oxidation potential for bromine can be calculated for the change from 21 Br2(liquid)
to Brhydrated
−
. (Note that since in its standard state bromine is liquid, the enthalpy of fusion must be omitted.
Similarly in calculating the oxidation potential for chlorine and fuorine, since they are gases, both the
enthalpies of fusion and vaporization must be omitted.)
Chlorine has the highest electron affnity, so gaseous Cl atoms accept electrons most readily. However, Cl is
not the strongest oxidizing agent. Table 10.30 shows that, summing all the energy terms in the cycle, fuorine
has the most negative ΔH° value. Since the difference between ΔG° and ΔH° is not signifcant, it follows
that fuorine accepts electrons more readily than chlorine, so fuorine is the strongest oxidizing agent. There
are two main reasons for this change of order:
1. F2 has a low enthalpy of dissociation (arising from the weakness of the F—F bond).
−
2. F2 has a high free energy of hydration (arising from the smaller size of the F ion).
_
@edubuzznotes
10.58 Reaction with Water 521
X(gas)
Electron
1 affinity
2 Enthalpy of
Energy dissociation
X−(gas)
1
2 X2(gas)
1
2 Enthalpy of vaporization
1
2 X2(liquid)
1 Enthalpy
Enthalpy Oxidation of
2
of potential hydration
fusion for
1 Oxidation chlorine
X (solid)
2 2 potential
for
bromine
Oxidation
potential
for
iodine
X−(hydrated)
Figure 10.54 Energy cycle showing the oxidation potentials of the halogens. (Oxidation potential is
used here in preference to reduction potential to stress that the halogens are strong oxidizing agents.
Note ΔG° = −nFE°).
1
Table 10.30 Enthalpy (ΔH°) values for 2 X2 → X(hydrated) (all values in kJ mol−1)
1
Enthalpy of 1
Enthalpy of 1
Enthalpy of Enthalpy of
2 2 2 Electron affinity Sum of ΔH°
fusion vaporization dissociation hydration
F2 − − + 159/2 −333 −513 −836
Cl2 − − + 243/2 −349 −370 −597.5
Br2 − + 30/2 + 193/2 −325 −339 −552.5
I2 + 15/2 + 42/2 + 151/2 −296 −274 −466
Fluorine is a very strong oxidizing agent, and it will replace Cl− both in solution and also when dry.
Similarly, chlorine gas will displace Br− from solution. (This is the basis of the commercial extraction of
bromine from sea water.) In general any halogen of low atomic number will oxidize halide ions of higher
atomic number.
A similar reaction between chlorine and water is thermodynamically possible, but the reaction is very
slow because the energy of activation is high.
Cl2 + 3H2O → 2H3O+ + 2Cl−+ 21 O2
With chlorine an alternative disproportionation reaction occurs rapidly:
Cl 2 + H 2 O → HCl + HOCl
Oxidation state of chlorine (0) (− I) (+I)
A similar disproportionation reaction occurs to a very limited extent with Br2 and I2. Thus a saturated
aqueous solution of Cl2 at 25 °C contains about two thirds hydrated X2 and one third OCl−. Solutions of Br2
and I2 contain only a very small amount of OBr−, and a negligible amount of OI−, respectively (Table 10.31).
Table 10.31 Concentrations in saturated aqueous solutions at 25 °C
Solubility Concentration X2 (hydrated) Concentration HOX
(mol l−1) (mol l−1) (mol l−1)
Cl2 0.091 0.061 0.030
Br2 0.21 0.21 1.1 × 10−3
I2 0.0013 0.0013 6.4 × 10−6
Iodine is an even weaker oxidizing agent. The free energy change is positive, which shows that energy
must be supplied to make it oxidize water.
I2 + H2O → 2H+ + 2I−+ 21 O2 ΔG° = + 105 kJ mol−1
It follows that for the reverse reaction ΔG° would be − 105 kJ mol−1, so the reverse reaction should occur
spontaneously. This is the case. Atmospheric dioxygen oxidizes iodide ions to iodine. At the end point of
an iodine titration with sodium thiosulphate, the iodine originally present is all converted to iodide ions.
Thus the bluish colour produced by the starch indicator with iodine disappears, and the solution becomes
colourless.
−
I2 + 2S2O2−
3 → 2I + S4O6
2−
If the titration fask is allowed to stand for two or three minutes, the indicator turns blue again. This is
because some atmospheric oxidation has taken place, forming I2, which reacts with the starch to give the
blue colour again.
1
2I− + 2 O2 + 2H+ → I2 + H2O
The end point of the titration is usually taken as being when the colour disappears and the solution remains
colourless for half a minute.
Both of these properties arise from the small size of fuorine. The weak F—F bond arises because of
repulsion between the lone pairs of electron on the two atoms. Strong bonds arise because of the high
coordination number and high lattice energy.
Some bond energies are shown in Table 10.32. These explain why the halogens form very strong bonds.
Many are stronger than the C—C bond, which is itself regarded as a very strong bond. (The C—C bond
energy is 347 kJ mol−1.)
Table 10.32 Some bond energies of halogen compounds (all values in kJ mol−1)
HX BX3 AlX3 CX4 NX3 X2
F 566 645 582 439 272 126
Cl 431 444 427 347 201 210
Br 366 368 360 276 243 158
I 299 272 285 238 * 118
* Unstable and explosive.
HF
Industrially HF is made by heating CaF2 with strong H2SO4. The reaction is endothermic: hence the need
for heating. It is important that SiO2 impurities are removed from the CaF2, as otherwise they consume
much of the HF produced.
CaF2 + H2SO4 → CaSO4 + 2HF
SiO2 + 4HF → SiF4 + 2H2O
SiF4 + 2HF(aq) → H2[SiF6]
The HF is purifed by successive washing, cooling and fractional distillation, giving a product that is 99.95%
pure.
HF is used to prepare CFCs, AlF3 and artifcial cryolite (used in electrolytic extraction of aluminium).
Aqueous solution of HF is used for pickling steel and etching glass.
HCl
HCl is produced on a very large scale. There are several different preparative methods:
1. At one time HCl was made exclusively by the ‘salt cake’ method. In this method, concentrated H2SO4
was added to rock salt (NaCl). The reaction was endothermic, and was performed in two stages at
different temperatures. The frst of the reactions was carried out at about 150 °C. The solid NaCl
reacted with H2SO4 and became coated with insoluble NaHSO4. This prevented further reaction, and
accounts for the name ‘salt cake’. In the second stage, the mixture was heated to about 550 °C, when
further reaction with H2SO4 occurred and Na2SO4 was formed. This by•product was sold, mostly for
paper making (Kraft process).
150 C
NaCl + H2SO4
→ HCl(g) + NaHSO4
550 C
NaCl + NaHSO4
→ HCl(g) + Na2SO4
2. Large amounts of impure HCl have become available in recent years as a by•product from the
heavy organic chemical industry. For example, HCl is produced in the conversion of 1,2•dichloethane
CH2Cl—CH2Cl to vinyl chloride CH2 = CHCl, and in the manufacture of chlorinated ethanes and
chlorinated fuorocarbons. This is now the largest source of HCl.
3. High purity HCl is made by direct combination of the elements. A gaseous mixture of H2 and Cl2 is
explosive. However, the reaction proceeds quietly if the gases are burnt in a hydrogen–chlorine fame
in a special combustion chamber. The process is strongly exothermic.
4. HCl is conveniently made in the laboratory by treating NH4Cl with concentrated H2SO4. NH4Cl costs
more than NaCl (which was used in the ‘salt cake’ process). However, NH4Cl is preferred because
NH4HSO4 is soluble, and the reaction does not stop at the halfway stage.
Hydrogen chloride gas is very soluble in water. Aqueous solutions of HCl are sold as hydrochloric acid.
A saturated solution at 20 °C contains 42% HCl by weight, and ‘concentrated’ acid normally contains
about 38% HCl by weight (approx. 12M). Pure hydrochloric acid is colourless, but technical grades are
sometimes yellow because of contamination by Fe(III). The largest use is for ‘pickling’ metals, that is
removing oxide layers from the surface. It is also used to make metal chlorides, in the manufacture of
dyestuffs, and in the sugar industry.
Gaseous HCl is conveniently prepared in the laboratory from concentrated HCl and concentrated
H2SO4.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.60 Hydrogen Halides HX 525
HBr and HI
HBr and HI are made by the reaction of concentrated phosphoric acid H3PO4 on metal bromides or
iodides, in a similar reaction to the ‘salt cake’ process for HCl. Note that a non•oxidizing acid such as
phosphoric acid must be used. Concentrated H2SO4 is a strong oxidizing agent and would oxidize HBr to
Br2 and HI to I2.
The usual laboratory preparation involves reducing bromine or iodine with red phosphorus in water. Thus
HBr is made by adding bromine to a mixture of red phosphorus and water. For HI, water is added to a
mixture of phosphorus and iodine.
HF is only just liquid at room temperature (b.p. 19.9 °C), and HCl to HBr and Hl are gases. The boiling
points increase regularly from HCl, HBr to HI, but the value for HF is completely out of line with the
others (Table 10.34).
The unexpectedly high boiling point of HF arises because of the hydrogen bonds formed between the
F atom of one molecule and the H atom of another molecule. This links the molecules together as (HF)n,
and they form zig•zag chains in both the liquid and the solid (Figure 10.55). Some hydrogen bonding also
occurs in the gas, which consists of a mixture of cyclic (HF)6 polymers, dimeric (HF)2, and monomeric HF.
HCl, HBr and Hl are not hydrogen bonded in the gas and liquid, though HCl and HBr are weakly hydrogen
bonded in the solid.
F F F F F
H H H H H H H
H H H H
F F F F F F
Hydrogen bonds are generally weak (5−35 kJ mol−1) compared with normal covalent bonds (C—C
347 kJ mol–1), but their effect is highly signifcant. The most electronegative elements fuorine and oxygen
(and to a lesser extent chlorine) form the strongest hydrogen bonds. (The bond energy of the hydrogen
bond in F—H . . . F is 29 kJ mol−1 in HF(g)).
In the gaseous state the hydrides are essentially covalent. However, in aqueous solutions they ionize.
H+ are not produced since the proton is transferred from HCl to H2O, thus giving [H3O]+. HCl, HBr and Hl
ionize almost completely and are therefore strong acids. HF only ionizes slightly and is therefore a weak acid.
HCl + H2O → [H3O]+ + Cl−
_
@edubuzznotes
526 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
It is at frst paradoxical that HF is the weakest acid in water, since HF has a greater electronegativity
difference than the other hydrides, and therefore has more ionic character. However, acidic strength is the
tendency of hydrated molecules to form hydrogen ions:
This may be represented in stages: dissociation, ionization and hydration in an energy cycle.
The acid strength is equal to the sum of all the energy terms round the energy cycle in Figure 10.56.
acid strength = enthalpy of dehydration
+ enthalpy of dissociation
+ ionization energy of H+
+ electron affnity X−
+ enthalpy of hydration of H+ and X−
The factors which make HF the weakest halogen acid in water become apparent if the various thermo•
dynamic terms are examined in more detail. The dissociation constant k for the change is given by the
equation:
+ −
HX (hydrated) ⇌ H(hydrated) + X (hydrated)
ΔG° = −RT ln k
(where ΔG° is the Gibbs standard free energy, R the gas constant and T the absolute temperature). However,
ΔG depends on the change in enthalpy ΔH and the change in entropy ΔS
ΔG = ΔH − TΔS
Table 10.35 shows the enthalpy changes (ΔH) for the various stages in the above energy cycle.
Consider frst the total enthalpy change ΔH for the dissociation of HX (hydrated) into H(hydrated)
+ −
+ X (hydrated) . The
ΔH values for the various halogen acids are all negative which means that energy is evolved in the process,
H+(gas) + X(gas)
Electron
Ionization affinity
Energy energy
H+(gas) + X−(gas)
H(gas) + X(gas)
Enthalpy of
dissociation
HX(gas)
Enthalpy of Enthalpy
dehydratrion of
hydration
HX(hydrated)
Acid
strength
H+(hydrated) + X−(hydrated)
Figure 10.56 Energy cycle showing the acid strengths of the halogens.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.61 Halides 527
so the change is thermodynamically possible. However, the value for HF is small compared with the values
for HCl, HBr and Hl. Thus HF is only slightly exothermic in aqueous solution whereas the others evolve a
considerable amount of heat.
The low total ∆H value for HF is the result of several factors.
1. The enthalpies of dissociation show that the H—F bond is much stronger than the H—Cl. H—Br or
H—I bonds. Thus the dissociation energy of HF is nearly twice that required to dissociate HI. (The
strength of the HF bond is also shown by the short bond length of 1.0 Å compared with 1.7 Å in HI.)
2. The enthalpy of dehydration for the step HX(hydrated) → HX(gas) is much higher for HF than for the
others. This is because of the strong hydrogen bonding which occurs in aqueous HF solutions.
3. The unexpectedly low value for the electron affnity of F— also contributes, and though the enthalpy of
hydration of F— is very high, it is not enough to offset these other terms.
If allowance is made for the T∆S term, the ∆H values can be converted into corresponding ∆G values. From
these the dissociation constants are obtained: HF k = 10−3, HCl k = 108, HBr k = 10 10 and HI k = 10 11.
The dissociation constants show quite clearly that HF is only very slightly ionized in water, and is there•
fore a weak acid. In a similar way, the others are almost totally dissociated, and are therefore strong acids.
Liquid HF has been used as a non•aqueous solvent. It undergoes self•ionization:
2HF ⇌ [H 2 F]+ + F −
Acid−base reactions occur in this solvent system. However, the solvent itself has a very strong tendency
to donate protons. Thus when the familiar mineral acids HNO3, H2SO4 and HCl are dissolved in HF, the
mineral acids are forced to accept protons from the HF. Thus the so•called mineral acids are actually behav•
ing as bases in this solvent. The very strong proton donating powers of HF mean that very few substances
act as acids in HF. Perchloric acid is an exception, and it does behave as an acid. The only other known
acids in liquid HF are fuoride acceptors such as SbF5, NbF5, AsF5 and BF3. Many compounds react with
HF, thus limiting its usefulness as a solvent. It is a useful medium for preparing fuoro complexes such as
[SbF6] −, and fuorides.
10.61 | HALIDES
Ionic halides
Most halides where the metal has an oxidation state of (+I), (+II), or +(III) are ionic. This includes Group
1, Group 2 (except Be), the lanthanides, and some of the transition metals. Most ionic halides are soluble
in water, giving hydrated metal ions and halide ions. A few are insoluble: LiF, CaF2, SrF2, BaF2, and the
chlorides, bromides and iodides of Ag(+I), Cu(+I), Hg(+I) and Pb(+II).
Bridging halides
Halide bridges are sometimes formed between two atoms. (Less commonly they are formed between three
atoms.) Thus AlCl3 forms a dimeric structure whereas BeF2 and BeCl2 form infnite chains. The bridges are
depicted as the halogen forming one normal covalent bond, and donating a lone pair of electrons to form
a second (coordinate) bond. Both bonds are identical. The bridge may be described in molecular orbital
terms as a three•centre four•electron bond, which is already discussed in Chapter 3.
Table 10.36 Compounds of the halogens with oxygen (and their oxidation states)
Oxidation state (−I) (+I) (+IV) (+V) (+VI) (+VIII) Others
Fluorides OF2(−I) O4F2
O2F2(−I)
Oxides Cl2O(+I) ClO2 Cl2O6 Cl2O7 ClClO4
ClO3
Br2O(+I) BrO2 I2O5 I4O9 I2O4
Electronic structure of 1s 2s 2p
oxygen atom having gained
two electrons by forming
bonds to two halogen atoms
four electron pairs – tetrahedral
with two positions occupied by lone pairs
Repulsion between the lone pairs reduces the bond angle in F2O from the tetrahedral angle of 109°28′ to
103° (Figure 10.57). In Cl2O (and presumably Br2O) the bond angle is increased because of steric crowding
of the larger halogen atoms.
O O O
1.41 Å 1.71 Å
F F Cl Cl Br Br
103° 111° 112°
Bleaching powder
Most of the Cl2O produced is used to make hypochlorites. NaOCl is sold in aqueous solution. Ca(OCl)2 is a
solid. An impure form mixed with Ca(OH)2 and CaCl2 is sold as ‘bleaching powder’. The latter is also made
by passing Cl2 into Ca(OH)2. These are used to bleach wood pulp and fabrics, and as disinfectants.
When allowed to stand for long, bleaching powder undergoes the following reactions.
6Ca(OCl)Cl ® Ca(ClO3 )2 + 5CaCl 2 (auto-oxidation)
CoCl 2
2Ca(OCl)Cl ¾Catalyst
¾¾ ® 2CaCl 2 + O2
Ca(OCl)Cl + H 2 O ® Ca(OH)2 + Cl 2 ¯
Some important reactions depicting oxidizing property of bleaching powder are as follows.
1. Ca(OCl)Cl + H 2 S ® S + CaCl 2 + H 2 O
2. Ca(OCl)Cl + 2FeSO4 + H 2 SO4 ® Fe2 (SO4 )3 + CaCl 2 + H 2 O
3. Ca(OCl)Cl + KNO2 ® CaCl 2 + KNO3
4. 3Ca(OCl)Cl + 2NH 3 ® CaCl 2 + 3H 2 O + N 2
5. Ca(OCl)Cl+ 2KI + 2HCl ® CaCl 2 + KCl + H 2 O + I 2
_
@edubuzznotes
530 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
It is less stable than ClO2, and decomposes to O2, Cl2 and Cl2O6 at room temperature.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.63 Oxoacids 531
O O O O O
O Cl Cl O Cl Cl ClO+2 ClO4−
O O O O O
Cl2O6 is a strong oxidizing agent and explodes on contact with grease. Hydrolysis of Cl2O6 with water or
alkali gives chlorate and perchlorate. Reaction with anhydrous HF is reversible.
4 10 P O
2HClO4 ↽
⇀ Cl 2 O7
H O 2
10.63 | OXOACIDS
Table 10.37 The oxoacids of halogens
HOX HXO2 HXO3 HXO4
Oxidation states (+I) (+III) (+V) (+VII)
of the halogens
*HOF
HOCl HClO2 HClO3 HClO4
HOBr HBrO3 HBrO4
HOl HIO3 HIO4
*F is in (–I) oxidation state.
Four series of oxoacids are known (Table 10.37). The structures of the ions formed are shown in Figure 10.59.
All these structures are based on a tetrahedron. The sp3 hybrid orbitals used for bonding form only weak
σ bonds, because the s and p levels differ appreciably in energy. The ions are stabilized by strong pp – dp
bonding between full 2p orbitals on oxygen with empty d orbitals on the halogen atoms. Even so, many of
the oxoacids are known only in solution, or as their salts.
_
@edubuzznotes
532 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
− − − O
X X X X
O O O O O O
O O O
XO− XO2− XO3− XO4−
HOF is unstable, and decomposes on its own to HF and O2. It is a strong oxidizing agent and oxidizes H2O
to H2O2 quite readily. HOF should be a stronger acid than HOCl.
HOCl, HOBr and HOI are not very stable, and are known only in aqueous solutions. They are very
weak acids, but they are good oxidizing agents especially in acidic solutions. They can be prepared by
shaking the halogen with freshly precipitated HgO in water, for example:
Hypochlorous acid is the most stable. Sodium hypochlorite NaOCl is well known, and is used extensively
for bleaching cotton fabric, and as a domestic bleach. It is also used as a disinfectant and sterilizing agent.
The halogens Cl2, Br2 and I2 all dissolve to some extent in water, forming hydrated X2 molecules and
X− and OX− ions.
H2O + X2 → X2 (hydrated)
HX + HOX
In a saturated solution of chlorine, about two thirds exists as hydrated molecules, and the rest as hydrochloric
and hypochlorous acids. A much smaller amount of HOBr and a negligible amount of HOI are formed by
similar means.
Dissolving the halogens in NaOH can in principle be used to make all the hypohalite ions.
X2 + 2NaOH → NaX + NaOX + H2O
However, the hypohalite ions tend to disproportionate, particularly in basic solutions. The rate of the
disproportionation reaction increases with temperature. Thus when Cl2 dissolves in NaOH at or below room
temperature, a reasonably pure solution of NaOCl and NaCl is obtained. However, in hot solutions (80 °C)
the sodium hypochlorite disproportionates rapidly, and a good yield of sodium chlorate is obtained.
(+I) (− I) (+v)
3OX − hot
→ 2X − + XO3−
Hypobromites can only be made at about 0 °C: at temperatures above 50 °C quantitative yields of BrO 3
−
are obtained.
0 °C
Br2 + 2OH−
→ Br− + OBr− + H2O
All other perchlorates and perchloric acid HClO4 are made from NaClO4.
1. NH4ClO4 is a white solid and was formerly used as a blasting compound in mining. It is now used in the
booster rockets in the Challenger Space Shuttle to oxidize the fuel (Al powder). NH4ClO4 will absorb
suffcient ammonia to liquefy itself.
2. HClO4 is used mostly to make other perchlorates. HClO4 is a colourless liquid and can be made from
NH4ClO4 and dilute nitric acid, or from NaClO4 and concentrated hydrochloric acid.
NH4ClO4 + HNO3 → HClO4 + NH4NO3
In principle perchlorates could be made from the disproportionation of chlorates, but the reaction is
slow and of little use.
4ClO 3− → 3ClO 4− + Cl−
HClO4 is one of the strongest acids known. The anhydrous compound is a powerful oxidizing agent
which explodes on contact with organic material (wood, paper, cloth, grease, rubber or chemicals), and
sometimes on its own.
3. Magnesium perchlorate MgClO4 is used as the electrolyte in so•called ‘dry batteries’. It is very
hygroscopic, and is a very effective desiccant called ‘anhydrone’.
4. KClO4 is used in freworks and fares.
Virtually all metal perchlorates, except those with the larger Group 1 ions K+, Rb+ and Cs+, are soluble in
water. The sparing solubility of KClO4 is used to detect potassium in qualitative analysis. (A solution of
NaClO4 is added to the solution containing K+, and KClO4 is precipitated.)
Plainly the ClO4- ion is larger than the OCl− ion, so the hydration energy of ClO4- is less than that for OCl−.
This would suggest that HOCl should ionize more readily than HClO4. Since we know the reverse to be
true, the reason must be the energy required to break the O—H bond.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.64 Interhalogen Compounds 535
Oxygen is more electronegative than chlorine. In the series of oxoacids HOCl, HClO2, HClO3, HClO4,
an increasing number of oxygen atoms are bonded to the chlorine atom. The more oxygen atoms that are
bonded, the more the electrons will be pulled away from the O—H bond, and the more this bond will be
weakened. Thus HClO4 requires the least energy to break the O—H bond and form H+. Hence HClO4 is
the strongest acid.
In general, for any series of oxoacids, the acid with the most oxygen (that is the one with the highest
oxidation number) is the most dissociated. Thus the acid strengths decrease HClO4 >HClO3 >HClO2 >HOCl.
In exactly the same way, H2SO4 is a stronger acid than H2SO3, and HNO3 is a stronger acid than HNO2.
There are never more than two different halogens in a molecule. The bonds are essentially covalent because
of the small electronegativity difference and the melting and boiling points increase as the difference in
electronegativity increases.
The compounds formed in the AX and AX3 groups are those where the electronegativity difference is
not too great. The higher valencies AX5 and AX7 are shown by large atoms such as Br and I associated with
small atoms such as F. This is because it is possible to pack more small atoms round a large one.
The interhalogens are generally more reactive than the halogens (except F2). This is because the A—X
bond in interhalogens is weaker than the X—X bond in the halogens. The reactions of interhalogens are
similar to those of the halogens. Hydrolysis gives halide and oxohalide ions. Note that the oxohalide ion is
always formed from the larger halogen present.
ICl + H2O → HCl + HOI hypoiodous acid
BrF5 + 3H2O → 5HF + HBrO3 bromic acid
Interhalogen compounds will fuorinate many metal oxides, metal halides and metals.
3UO2 + 4BrF3 → 3UF4 + 2Br2 + 3O2
UF4 + ClF3 → UF6 + ClF
and when it is added to an unsaturated fat the colour disappears until all the double bonds have
reacted. The iodine number is simply the volume (ml) of a standard solution of ICl which reacts with a
fxed weight of fat.
CH CH + ICl CH CH
I Cl
2. When ICl reacts with organic compounds it often iodinates them, though chlorination may occur
depending on the conditions.
+ ICl vapour
chlorination
Salicylic acid
iodination
+ ICl in nitrobenzene
It is thought that the attacking species is I+, since the I atoms substitute in positions where there is an
excess of electrons. Both ICl and IBr are partially ionized in the fused state. Conductivity measure•
ments show that ICl ionizes to the extent of about 1%. Rather than form the simple ions I+ and Cl −, the
ions are solvated.
3ICl ⇌ [I2Cl]+ + [ICl2] −
ClF3 > BrF5 > IF7 > ClF > BrF3 > IF5 > BrF > IF3 > IF
4. ICl3 does not exist, but the dimer I2Cl6 is a bright yellow solid. Its structure (Figure 10.60) is planar. The
terminal I—Cl bonds are normal single bonds of length 2.38 Å and 2.39 Å. The bridging I—Cl bonds
are appreciably longer (2.68 Å and 2.72 Å), suggesting delocalized bonding rather than simple halogen
bridges formed by coordinate bonds from Cl to I. The liquid has an appreciable electrical conductivity,
due to self•ionization:
Cl Cl Cl
l l
Cl Cl Cl
+ −
I 2 Cl 6 ⇌ [ICl 2 ] + [ICl 4 ]
It has been less studied as an ionizing solvent than the others because the gas decomposes into ICl and
Cl2.
5. Liquid IF5 self•ionizes, and therefore conducts electricity.
2IF5 ⇌ IF +4 + IF 6−
10.65 | POLYHALIDES
Halide ions often react with molecules of halogens or interhalogens and form polyhalide ions. Iodine is
only slightly soluble in water (0.34 gl−1). Its solubility is greatly increased if some iodide ions are present in
the solution. The increase in solubility is due to the formation of a polyhalide ion, in this case the triiodide
ion I -3 . This is stable both in aqueous solution and in ionic crystals.
I2 + I− → I 3−
_
@edubuzznotes
10.66 Pseudohalogens and Pseudohalides 537
The I–I distances in [Me4N]+[I3] − are 2.92 Å. If the bond length of 2.66 Å in I2 is taken as a normal single
bond, the bonds in I3 are very weak.
−
More complex ions such as pentaiodide I 5 , heptaiodide I7 and enneaiodide I9 have also been prepared.
− − −
Crystalline compounds containing the larger polyiodide ions generally contain large metal ions such as Cs+
or large complex cations such as R4N+. This is because a large anion together with a large cation give a high
coordination number and hence a high lattice energy. Polyhalides such as KI3 ∙ H2O, RbI3, NH4I5, [(C2H5)4N]I7
and RbI9 ∙ 2C6H6 may be formed by the direct addition of I2 to I−, either with or without a solvent.
The Br 3 ion is much less stable and less common than I 3 . A few unstable Cl 3 compounds are known,
− − −
and the ion is formed in concentrated solution. F 3 compounds are also known now•a•days (see Molecular
−
Orbital Theory).
Many polyhalides are known which contain two or three different halogens, for example K[ICl2],
K[ICl4], Cs[IBrF] and K[IBrCl]. These are formed from interhalogens and metal halides.
The structures of the polyhalides are known. The trihalides K[I3], K[ICl2] and Cs[IBrF] all contain a linear
trihalide ion. Structure of I 5- , I 7- , I 9- , I 82- are given as follows.
− −
I I
I I
I I I I
I I
I I
I5−
I7−
2−
− I
I
I
I
: :
: :
:I: I I :I:
: :
I I :I: I I
I
I
I
I
I82−
I9−
N3
−
Azide ion HN3 Hydrogen azide
Some of the pseudohalide ions combine to form dimers comparable with the halogen molecules X2. These
include cyanogen (CN)2, thiocyanogen (SCN)2 and selenocyanogen (SeCN)2.
The best known pseudohalide is CN−. This resembles Cl−, Br− and I− in the following respects:
1. It forms an acid HCN.
2. It can be oxidized to form a molecule cyanogen (CN)2.
3. It forms insoluble salts with Ag+, Pb2+ and Hg+.
4. Interpseudohalogen compounds ClCN, BrCN and ICN can be formed.
5. AgCN is insoluble in water but soluble in ammonia, as is AgCl.
6. It forms a large number of complexes similar to halide complexes, e.g. [Cu(CN)4]2− and [CuCl4]2−, and
[Co(CN)6]3− and [CoCl6]3−
4. Which of the following processes is not feasible 8. In the following statements, which combination of
spontaneously? true (T) and false (F) options is correct?
(A) H 2O + F2 ® HF + HOF I. Ionic mobility is the highest for I– in water as
(B) H 2O + Cl 2 ® HCl + HOCl compared to other halides.
(C) H 2O + Br2 ® 2HBr + [O] II. Stability order is: Cl3– > Br3– > I3–
(D) H 2O + I 2 ® 2HI + [O] III. Reactivity order is: F < Cl< Br < I
IV. Oxidizing power order is: F2 < Cl2 < Br2 < I2
_
@edubuzznotes
Comprehension Type Questions 539
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (C) 3. (B) 5. (A) 7. (B) 9. (A)
2. (C) 4. (D) 6. (A) 8. (B) 10. (C)
Helium has two electrons which form a complete shell 1s2. The other noble gases have a closed octet of
electrons in their outer shell ns2 np6 (Table 10.40). This electronic confguration is very stable and is related
to their chemical inactivity. These atoms have an electron affnity of zero (or slightly negative), and have
very high ionization energies – higher than any other elements. Under normal conditions the noble gas
atoms have little tendency to gain or lose electrons. Thus they have little tendency to form bonds, and so
they exist as single atoms.
The noble gases are all able to diffuse through glass, rubber and plastic materials, and some metals. This
makes them diffcult to handle in the laboratory, particularly since glass Dewar fasks cannot be used for
low temperature work.
Clathrate compounds
Clathrate compounds of the noble gases are well known. Normal chemical compounds have ionic or
covalent bonds. However, in the clathrates atoms or molecules of the appropriate size are trapped in
cavities in the crystal lattice of other compounds. Though the gases are trapped, they do not form bonds.
If an aqueous solution of quinol (1, 4•dihydroxybenzene) is crystallized under a pressure of 10–40
atmospheres of Ar, Kr or Xe, the gas becomes trapped in cavities of about 4 Å diameter in the b•quinol
structure. When the clathrate is dissolved, the hydrogen bonded arrangement of b•quinol breaks down
and the noble gas escapes. Other small molecules such as O2, SO2, H2S, MeCN and CH3OH form clath•
rates as well as Ar, Kr and Xe. The smaller noble gases He and Ne do not form clathrate compounds
because the gas atoms are small enough to escape from the cavities. The composition of these clathrate
compounds corresponds to 3 quinol: 1 trapped molecule, though normally all the cavities are not filled.
The gases Ar, Kr and Xe may be trapped in cavities in a similar way when water is frozen under a high
pressure of the gas. These are clathrate compounds, but are more commonly called ‘the noble gas hydrates’.
They have formulae approximating to 6H2O: 1 gas atom. He and Ne are not trapped because they are
too small. The heavier noble gases can also be trapped in cavities in synthetic zeolites, and samples have
been obtained containing up to 20% of Ar by weight. Clathrates provide a convenient means of storing
radioactive isotopes of Kr and Xe produced in nuclear reactors.
The frst ionization energy for O2 → O +2 is 1165 kJ mol−1, which is almost the same as the value of 1170 kJ
mol−1 for Xe → Xe+. It was predicted that xenon should react with PtF6. Experiments showed that when
deep red PtF6 vapour was mixed with an equal volume of Xe, the gases combined immediately at room
temperature to produce a yellow solid. They (incorrectly) thought the product obtained was xenon
hexafuoroplatinate(V), Xe+ [PtF6]−. The reaction has since been shown to be more complicated, and the
−
product is really [XeF]+ [ Pt 2 F11 ] .
25 °C heat 60 °C
→ [XeF]+ [PtF6 ]− + PtF5
Xe[PtF6 ] + PtF6 → [XeF]+ [Pt 2 F11 ]−
Soon after this it was found that Xe and F2 reacted at 400 °C to give a colourless volatile solid XeF4. This
has the same number of valency electrons as, and is isostructural with, the polyhalide ion [ICl 4 ]−. Following
these discoveries there was a rapid extension of the chemistry of the noble gases, and in particular of xenon.
The ionization energies of He, Ne and Ar are much higher than for Xe, and are too high to allow the
formation of similar compounds. The ionization energy for Kr is a little lower than for Xe, and Kr does
form KrF2. The ionization energy of Rn is less than for Xe, and Rn might be expected to form compounds
similar to those of Xe. Rn is radioactive, has no stable isotopes, and all the isotopes have short half lives.
This has limited work on radon compounds, and only RnF2 and a few complexes are known.
Xe reacts directly only with F2. However, oxygen compounds can be obtained from the fuorides. There
is some evidence for the existence of XeCl2 and XeCl4, and one compound is known with a Xe—N bond.
Thus there is quite an extensive chemistry of Xe. The principal compounds are listed in Table 10.42.
_
@edubuzznotes
10.72 Chemistry of Xenon 545
Xenon reacts directly with fuorine when the gases are heated at 400 ˚C in a sealed nickel vessel, and
the products depend on the F2/Xe ratio.
2:1 Mixture XeF2
Xe + F2 1:5 Mixture XeF4
1 : 20 Mixture XeF6
The compounds XeF2, XeF4 and XeF6 are all white solids. They can be sublimed at room temperature, and
can be stored indefnitely in nickel or Monel containers. The lower fuorides form higher fuorides when
heated with F2 under pressure. The fuorides are all extremely strong oxidizing and fuorinating agents.
They react quantitatively with hydrogen follows:
XeF2 + H2 → 2HF + Xe
XeF4 + 2H2 → 4HF + Xe
XeF6 + 3H2 → 6HF + Xe
They oxidize Cl − to Cl2, I− to I2 and cerium(III) to cerium(IV):
If XeF2 is mixed with anhydrous HF its reactivity is greatly increased, possibly due to the formation of XeF +.
Pt + 3XeF2/HF → PtF6 + 3Xe
S8 + 24XeF2/HF → 8SF6 + 24Xe
The fuorides differ in their reactivity with water. XeF2 is soluble in water, but undergoes slow hydrolysis.
Hydrolysis is more rapid with alkali.
2XeF2 + 2H2O → 2Xe + 4HF + O2
XeF4 reacts violently with water, giving xenon trioxide XeO3.
3XeF4 + 6H 2 O → 2Xe + XeO3 + 12HF + 1 21 O2
XeF6 also reacts violently with water, but slow hydrolysis by atmospheric moisture gives the highly explosive
solid XeO3.
XeF6 + 6H2O → XeO3 + 6HF
With small quantities of water, partial hydrolysis occurs, giving a colourless liquid xenon oxofuoride
XeOF4. The same product is formed when XeF6, reacts with silica or glass:
Several perxenates of Group 1 and 2 metals have been isolated, and the crystal structures of Na4XeO6·
6H2O and Na4XeO6. · 8H2O have been determined by X•ray crystallography. The solubility of sodium
perxenate in 0.5 M NaOH is only 0.2 grams per litre, so precipitation of sodium perxenate could be used
as a gravimetric method of analysis for sodium. Perxenates are extremely powerful oxidizing agents, which
will oxidize HCl to Cl2, H2O to O2, and Mn2+ to MnO4− . With concentrated H2SO4 they give xenon tetroxide
XeO4, which is volatile and explosive.
-5 °C
Na4XeO6 + 2H2SO4 (conc.) ¾¾¾
® 2Na2SO4 + XeO4 + 2H2O
XeF ⋅ MF5
2
[XeF ]+ [MF6 ]−
The structures of some of the XeF2 complexes in the solid state are known. In the complex XeF2 2SbF5
(Figure 10.61), the two Xe−F distances differ greatly (1.84 Å and 2.35 Å). This suggests the formulation
[XeF]+ [Sb2F11]−. However, the Xe−F distance of 2.35 Å is much less than the van der Waals (non•bonded)
distance of 3.50 Å. This suggests that one fuorine atom forms a fuorine bridge between Xe and Sb. In fact
the structure is intermediate between that expected for the ionic structure, and that for the fully covalent
bridge structure.
F
F
F
F
Sb F
F
2.35Å Sb
F
F
1.84Å F
F
F
Figure 10.61 Structure of XeF2·2SbF5. (From Mackay and Mackay, Introduction to Modern Inorganic
Chemistry, 4th ed., Blackie, 1989.)
XeF4 forms only a few complexes, for example those with PF5, AsF5 and SbF5. XeF6 can act as a fuoride
donor, forming complexes such as:
XeF6 · BF3
XeF6 · GeF4
XeF6 · 2GeF4
XeF6 · 4SnF4
XeF6 · AsF5
XeF6 · SbF5
XeF6 may also act as a fuoride acceptor. With RbF and CsF it reacts as follows:
−
XeF6 + RbF → Rb + [ XeF7 ]
On heating, the [XeF7 ]− ion decomposes:
−
→ XeF6 + Cs2 [XeF8]
2Cs + [ XeF7 ] 50 °C
XeF2
XeF2 is a linear molecule with both Xe–F distances 2.00 Å. The bonding may be explained quite simply
by promoting an electron from the 5p level of Xe to the 5d level. The two unpaired electrons form bonds
with fuorine atoms. The fve electron pairs point to the corners of a trigonal bipyramid. Of these, three
are lone pairs and occupy the equatorial positions, and two are bond pairs and occupy the apical positions.
The atoms thus form a linear molecule (Figure 10.62).
Xe
5s 5p 5d
Electronic structure of Xe
atom – ground state
Xe excited
This explains the observed structure, but an objection is that the 5d orbitals of Xe appear to be too
large for effective overlap of orbitals. The maximum in the radial electron distribution function for a 5d
_
@edubuzznotes
10.73 Structure and Bonding in Xenon Compounds 549
orbital in a Xe atom occurs at a distance of 4.9 Å from the nucleus. It has been noted in Chapter 3 in the
section ‘The extent of d orbital participation in molecular bonding’ that highly electronegative atoms like
fuorine cause a large contraction in the size of d orbitals. If this contraction is big enough, the valence bond
explanation will suffce.
A second objection is over the mixing of orbitals (sp3d hybridization). Mixing is only effective
between orbitals of similar energy, and the Xe 5d orbitals would seem too high in energy to contrib•
ute to such a scheme of hybridization. (The difference in energy between a 5p and a 5d level is about
960 kJ mol−1.)
XeF4
The structure of XeF4 is square planar, with Xe–F distances of 1.95 Å (Figure 10.63). The valence bond
theory explains this by promoting two electrons as shown:
F F
Xe
F F
The problem of whether the size of the xenon 5d orbitals will allow effective overlap, or their energy will allow
mixing and hybridization, is the same as in XeF2. The molecular orbital explanation of XeF4 is similar to that
for XeF2. The Xe atom bonds to four F atoms.
XeF6
The structure of XeF6 is a distorted octahedron (Figure 10.64). The bonding in XeF6 has caused consider•
able controversy which is not completely resolved. The structure may be explained in valence bond terms
by promoting three electrons in Xe:
F
F
F Xe F
5s 5p 5d
Electronic structure of
xenon – excited state
The six unpaired electrons form bonds with fuorine atoms. The distribution of seven orbitals gives either
a capped octahedron or a pentagonal bipyramid (as in IF7). (A capped octahedron has a lone pair point•
ing through one of the faces of the octahedron.) Since there are six bonds and one lone pair, a capped
_
@edubuzznotes
550 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
octahedron would give a distorted octahedral molecule. The molecular orbital approach fails with XeF6,
since three three•centre molecular orbital systems mutually at right angles would give a regular octahedral
shape.
F F F F
Xe Xe
Xe
F F O O F F
F O Square pyramidal
Slightly disorted Pyramidal (octahedral with one
octahedron Xenon trioxide position unoccupied)
Xenon hexafluoride Xenon oxyfluoride
XeO3
XeOF4
XeF6
O
F
O
O O O
Xe Xe
Xe
O O O O
O
O O
F
Octahedral Tetrahedral
Perxenate ion Xenon tetroxide
XeO2F2
[XeO6]4− XeO4
(B) If both Statement I and Statement II are true but 3. Statement I: When Pt is fuorinated with XeF2, it is
Statement II is not the correct explanation for mixed with anhydrous HF.
Statement I
(C) If Statement I is true but Statement II is false. Statement II: Reactivity of XeF2 increases greatly due
(D) If Statement I is false and Statement II is true. to the formation of XeF+.
Statement II: Helium has lower solubility in blood as Statement II: Steric crowding is more for XeF8 than
compared to N2; thus minimising the risk of bend. in XeO4.
2. Statement I: In the adduct [XeF6⋅ ASF5], XeF6 acts as 5. Statement I: The variable oxidation state of Xe is
fuoride donor. observed by jump of two units.
Statement II: XeF6 acts as a Lewis base. Statement II: The valence shell electronic confgura•
tion is 5s25p6 and on excitation it always produces an
even number of unpaired electrons.
(A) XeO3 (P) Powerful explosive. (A) XeO64- (P) Central atom is sp3d2 hybridized.
(B) XeF2 (Q) Acts as fuoride donor. (B) XeF4 (Q) On treatment with conc. H2SO4
(C) XeO4 (R) Central atom carries at least one produces XeO4.
lone pair. (C) XeO3 (R) Only one lone pair is present on
(D) XeOF4 (S) It is formed by the reaction be• the central atom.
tween XeO3 and XeF6 (D) XeO2 F2 (S) Central atom of the molecule
has four surrounding atoms.
(T) It is formed by the reaction of
Na4 XeO6 with conc. H2SO4 at
−9°C
_
@edubuzznotes
Miscellaneous Questions 553
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (A) 2. (B) 3. (D) 4. (C) 5. (B)
Miscellaneous Questions
| SINGLE CORRECT CHOICE TYPE QUESTIONS
1. The fuoride which is soluble in water is 4. A + SbF5 → B
(A) CaF2 B + tert•butane → [tert•butyl]+ + X− + H2
Then A is
(B) BaF2 (A) HCl
( B ) HF
(C) SrF2
( C ) HBr
(D) BeF2 (D) HI
5. Which of the following represents the correct increas•
2. Which of the following pair of species is non•linear?
ing order of pKa values of the given acids?
(A) OCN− and Br3−
(A) HClO4 < HNO3 < H2CO3 < B(OH)3
(B) (SCN)2 and I5−
( B) HNO3 < HClO4 < B(OH)3 < H2CO3
(C) NCN2− and N3−
(C) HClO4 >HNO3 > H2CO3 > B(OH)3
(D) HN3 and (CN)2
(D) HClO4 < HNO3 < B(OH)3 < H2CO3.
3. Substance A
6. Which of the following options are incorrect?
I. reacts with H2S to produce white turbidity.
I. α • S ⇌ β • S; DH = (–) ve
II. changes light green solution of FeSO4 into yellow
II. α • S ⇌ β • S; DH = (+) ve
colour.
III. Red P ⇌ Black P; DH = (–) ve
III. reacts with moisture to give pungent smelling gas.
IV. Black P ⇌ White P; DH = (–) ve
Then A is
V. Graphite ⇌ Diamond; DH = (+)ve
(A) KMnO4
(A) II, IV and V
( B ) K2Cr2O7
(B) II, III and V
( C ) SO2
(C) I and IV
(D) Ca(OCl)Cl
(D) I and III
_
@edubuzznotes
554 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
7. SO2 is passed through a strongly acidic solution of 14. Which of the following compounds give NH3 on
SnCl2. The precipitate obtained consists of S and the heating?
oxidation state of S in the precipitate is I. NH4NO3
(A) −1 II. NH4NO2
(B) zero III. (NH4)2Cr2O7
(C) −2 IV. (NH4)2CO3
(D) the precipitate does not contain S. V. Mg(NH4)PO4
8. White compound A 3
→ B
2 HNO
→ C(used to I (A) I and IV
estimate CO). The compound A is (B) II and V
(A) P2O5 (C) IV only
(D) IV and V
(B) I2O5
(C) I4O9 15. Mg(NH4)PO4 and Na(NH4)HPO4 are heated
(d) S3O9 separately. Which of the following statements is/are
completely incorrect regarding the product obtained
9. Fe(CO)5 + NO → M (complex). M is in the above processes?
(A) Fe(NO)5 I. Same gas is eveolved.
(B) Fe(CO)3(NO)2 II. Same type of phosphate is formed.
(C) Fe(CO)2(NO)2 III. Different types of gases are formed.
(D) Fe(CO)2(NO)3 IV. Different types of phosphates are formed.
(A) I and II
10. OH (B) II and IV
Cu, 250 °C NH2OH (C) I and IV
A B
(D) II and III
16. A mixture of two gases, AsH3, and SbH3, is passed
through a tube heated at the middle position. Two
H2S2O7 ∆
C D mirror•like depositions are observed of which (I) is
Base before the hot position and (II) is after the hot
In the given reaction, compound C is position.
These depositions I and II are of
(A) nylon–6. (A) Sb and As
(B) caprolactum. (B) As and Sb
(C) nylon–66. (C) Both As
(D) lactone. (D) Both Sb
Et 17. Which of the following reagents does not produce
LiAlH4 any gaseous product on reaction with PbO2?
11. Si Cl
Me A (A) HCl (hot conc.)
Ph (B) HNO3 + (CO2H)2
q = + 30°
(C) NaOH
A will have the optical rotation of (D) H2SO4
(A) + 30°.
18. Which is of following options is correct for the given
(B) − 30°.
statement?
(C) zero. In the discharge reaction of lead storage cell, the
(D) Cannot be predicted. number of Faradays used is equal to
12. In the reaction I. twice the number of moles of PbO2 consumed.
II. half the number of moles of H2SO4 consumed.
burnt in Passed into
NH 3 → A ( gas) S →B III. the number of moles of H2SO4 produced.
air at 750 °C nCl solution
Pt catalyst and 6 atm
2
in presence of HCl IV. the number of moles of H2O produced.
(A) I and II
The compound B is:
(B) I and IV
(A) NH2OH
(C) II and IV
(B) NH3
(D) II and III
(C) N2O
(D) NH2–NH2 19. Reaction of PbO2 with hot conc. HCl and cold conc.
HCl (saturated with Cl2) separately produces
13. FeSO4 is a very good absorber for NO. The number
of unpaired electrons in the new compound formed (A) PbCl2 and PbCl4
by this process is (B) PbCl2 and H2PbCl6
(A) 4 (C) 3 (C) PbCl4 and PbCl2
(B) 5 (D) 6 (D) H2PbCl6 and PbCl2
_
@edubuzznotes
Comprehension Type Questions 555
20. Choose the incorrect statement from the following. (C) Piece of Sn kept with SnCl2 prevents its oxidation.
(A) Hydrolysis of SnCl4 is affected by the presence (D) SnCl2, SnCl4, and PbCl4 all form complex acid
of HCl vapours. with conc. HCl.
(B) Ammonolysis of SnCl4 is not affected by the
presence of NH4C1 vapours.
Passage 5: For Questions 14–16 16. The above resulting solution is added to AuCl3
solution resulting in a purple colour solution, which
Metallic Sn is reacted with NH4Cl and the resulting is called as ‘purple of cassius.’ It consists of
solution is treated with sulphur. (A) colloidal solution of gold.
14. The gaseous product(s) is/are (B) colloidal solution of Sn(OH)4 with fnely divided
(A) NH3 only. gold particles adsorbed on it.
(B) NH3 + H2. (C) colloidal solution of Sn(OH)4.
(C) H2 only. (D) mixture of precipitates of Au and Sn(OH)4 .
(D) No gaseous product.
15. The colour of the fnal precipitate obtained is
(A) dark brown. (C) yellow.
(B) white. (D) pink.
(B) If both Statement I and Statement II are true but Statement II: S(–I) is reduced to S(–II) easily in YAS.
Statement II is not the correct explanation for 4. Statement I: The bleaching action of SO2 is not
Statement I. permanent while that of H2O2 or Cl2 is permanent.
(C) If Statement I is true but Statement II is false. Statement II: Bleaching action by SO2 is due to
(D) If Statement I is false but Statement II is true. reduction of the substance which undergoes further
oxidation by air; while that of H2O2 or Cl2 is due to
1. Statement I: C 3 O2 and N +5 are isosteric yet they are oxidation of the substance.
not isostructural.
5. Statement I: P2O5 is a stronger dehydrating agent than
Statement II: C3O2 is linear while N +5 is bent. conc. H2SO4.
Statement II: P2O5 dehydrates conc. H2SO4 into SO3.
2. Among the following, the number of compounds/ions 6. When K2[Ni(CN)4] is reduced by K in liquid NH3,
having a linear structure is ________. the change in co•ordination number is __________.
C 5O2 , H 2O5 , N 3− , CN 22 − , N 5+ , H 2S 3 , [I(CN)2 ]− , ( 2 7. According to Drago’s rule, the P atom in PH3 is
+ − not hybridized and formation of PH4+ is diffcult.
N , (CN)2 , (SCN)2 .
2
The number of identical HPH angles in PH4+ ion is
_________.
3. The number of 90° angles (approximately) in PHF4 is
_________. 8. The ratio of number of lone pairs on the central atom
of ClF3 and XeF4 is ________.
_
@edubuzznotes
558 Chapter 10 The p-Block Elements and their Compounds
9. How many of the following are in the correct order 10. How many of the following compounds are matched
with respect to the given property? with the incorrect formula?
(i) H2 > He : Boiling point (i) Butter of tin : SnCl4 ⋅ 4H2O
order
(ii) Gypsum : CaSO4 ⋅ 2H2O
(ii) He > Ne > Ar > Kr > Xe : Boiling point
order (iii) Plaster of Paris : 2CaSO4 ⋅ 4H2O
(iii) S > O > Se > Te : Electron affnity (iv) Mustard gas : S(CH2CH2–Cl)2
order
(v) Thionyl chloride : COCl2
(iv) Diamond > graphite : Electrical conduc•
tivity order (vi) Sulphuryl chloride : SeCl2
(v) HCl < HBr < HF < HI : Melting point
order
In each of the following questions, statements are given in two columns, which have to be matched. The statements in
Column I are labelled as (A), (B), (C) and (D), while those in Column II are labelled as (P), (Q), (R), (S) and (T). Any
given statement in Column I can have correct matching with one or more statements in Column II.
1. Match the compounds with effects on heating 4. *Match the compounds with their common names
and uses.
Column I Column II
(A) NH4NO3 (P) Leaves no residue on heating. Column I Column II Column III
(B) NH4NO2 (Q) Leaves residue on heating. (A) SnCl4·5H2O (P) Mosaic (J ) Used as
(C) (NH4)2CO3 (R) Produces N2 on heating. gold fertilizer.
(D) (NH4)2Cr2O7 (S) Produces NH3 on heating. (B) (NH4)2SnCl6 (Q) Nitrolim (K) Used in
(E) Mg(NH4)PO4 calico
printing.
2. Match the oxides with their properties. (C) SnS2 (R) Butter of (L) Used in
tin gilding
Column I Column II
purpose.
(A) ClO2 (P) The free electron is present in a
(D) CaCN2 + C (S) Pink salt (M) Used as
hybrid orbital.
mordant in
(B) NO2 (Q) Produces the mixed acid on dye.
reaction with water.
(C) ClO3 (R) Molecule is planar. *Choose only one option from Column II and Column III
for each option of Column I.
(S) Molecule having the lowest
possible O–X–O angle. 5. Match the reagent/ characteristic with their use in the
detection of compounds.
3. Match the oxides with solutions in which they are
absorbed. Column I Column II
Column I Column II (A) Pb(OAC)2 (P) NH3
(A) CO (P) Absorbed by ethanol amine. (B) Nesslar’s reagent (Q) PH3
(B) CO2 (Q) Absorbed by FeSO4 solution. (C) Rotten fsh smell (R) H2S
(C) NO (R) Absorbed by aqueous (D)Violet layer (S) I2
suspension of Cu2Cl2.
(S) Absorbed by KOH solution.
_
@edubuzznotes
Answers 559
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (D) 5. (A) 9. (C) 13. (C) 17. (C)
2. (B) 6. (C) 10. (B) 14. (D) 18. (B)
3. (D) 7. (C) 11. (D) 15. (D) 19. (B)
4. (B) 8. (A) 12. (A) 16. (A) 20. (B)
11
The d-Block
Elements and Transition elements
Post transition
elements
some of their 3
Sc
4
Ti
5
V
6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn
Compounds Y
La Hf
Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd
Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg
Ac Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt
d-block elements.
Three series of elements are formed by flling the 3d, 4d and
5d shells of electrons. Together these comprise the d•block
elements. They are often called ‘transition elements’ because
their position in the periodic table is between the s•block and
p•block elements. Their properties are transitional between
the highly reactive metallic elements of the s•block, which typ•
ically form ionic compounds, and the elements of the p•block,
which are largely covalent. In the s• and p•blocks, electrons are
added to the outer shell of the atom. In the d•block, electrons Contents
are added to the penultimate shell, expanding it from 8 to 18
electrons. Typically, the transition elements have an incom• 11.1 Variable Oxidation State
pletely flled d level. The elements make up three complete 11.2 Complexes
rows of ten elements and an incomplete fourth row (Table 11.3 Size of Atoms and Ions
11.1). Group 12 (the zinc group) has a d10 confguration and 11.4 Density
since the d shell is complete, compounds of these elements 11.5 Melting and Boiling
(Zn, Cd, Hg,) are not typical and show some differences from Points
other elements of the series. In the present days, transition ele•
11.6 Reactivity of Metals
ments are only those with incompletely flled d orbitals. So Zn,
11.7 Ionization Energies
Cd and Hg are excluded from the transition series elements.
However, they are d•block elements. 11.8 Colour
In the d•block elements the penultimate shell of electrons 11.9 Magnetic Properties
is expanding. Thus they have many physical and chemical 11.10 Catalytic Properties
properties in common. Thus all the transition elements are 11.11 Nonstoichiometry
metals. They are therefore good conductors of electricity and 11.12 Abundance
heat, have a metallic lustre and are hard, strong and ductile. 11.13 Chromate and
They also form alloys with other metals. Dichromate
11.14 Manganate and
Permanganate
11.15 Silver and its Compounds
11.16 Zinc Compounds
11.17 Copper Compounds
11.18 Iron Compounds
_
@edubuzznotes
562 Chapter 11 The d-Block Elements and some of their Compounds
Thus Sc could have an oxidation number of (+II) if both s electrons are used for bonding and (+III)
when two s and one d electrons are involved. Ti has an oxidation state (+II) when both s electrons are used
for bonding, (+III) when two s and one d electrons are used and (+IV) when two s and two d electrons are
used. Similarly, V shows oxidation numbers (+II), (+III), (+IV) and (+V). In the case of Cr, by using the
single s electron for bonding, we get an oxidation number of (+I); hence by using varying numbers of d elec•
trons oxidation states of (+II), (+III), (+IV), (+V) and (+VI) are possible. Mn has oxidation states (+II),
(+III), (+IV), (+V), (+VI) and (+VII). Among these frst fve elements, the correlation between electronic
structure and minimum and maximum oxidation states in simple compounds is complete. In the highest
oxidation states of these frst fve elements, all of the s and d electrons are being used for bonding. Thus the
properties depend only on the size and valency, and consequently show some similarities with elements
of the main groups in similar oxidation states. For example, SO2− 4 (Group 16) and CrO 4
2−
(Group 6) are
isostructural, as are SiCl4 (Group 14) and TiCl4 (Group 4).
_
@edubuzznotes
11.2 Complexes 563
Once the d5 confguration is exceeded, i.e. in the last fve elements, the tendency for all the d electrons
to participate in bonding decreases. Thus Fe has a maximum oxidation state of (+VI). However, the second
and third elements in this group attain a maximum oxidation state of (+VIII) in RuO4 and OsO4. This dif•
ference between Fe and the other two elements Ru and Os is attributed to the increased size.
These facts may be conveniently memorized, because the oxidation states form a regular ‘pyramid’ as
shown in Table 11.2. Only Sc(+II) and Co(+V) are doubtful. The oxidation number of all elements in the
elemental state is zero. In addition, several of the elements have zero•valent and other low•valent states in
complexes. Low oxidation states occur particularly with p bonding ligands such as carbon monoxide and
dipyridyl. Similar but not identical pyramids of oxidation states are found in the second and third rows of
transition elements. The main differences are as follows:
1. In Group 8 (the iron group) the second and third row elements show a maximum oxidation state of
(+VIII) compared with (+VI) for Fe.
2. The electronic structures of the atoms in the second and third rows do not always follow the pattern of
the frst row. The structures of Group 10 elements (the nickel group) are:
Ni 3d8 4s2
Pd 4d10 5s0
Pt 5d9 6s1
Since a full shell of electrons is a stable arrangement, the place where this occurs is of importance. The
d levels are complete for copper, palladium and gold in their respective series.
Even though the ground state of the atom has a d10 confguration, Pd and the coinage metals Cu, Ag and
Au behave as typical transition elements. This is because in their most common oxidation states, Cu(II)
has a d 9 confguration and Pd(II) and Au(III) have d8 confgurations, i.e. they have an incompletely flled
d level. However, in zinc, cadmium and mercury the ions Zn2+, Cd2+ and Hg2+ have a d10 confguration.
Because of this, these elements do not show the properties characteristic of transition elements.
11.2 | COMPLEXES
The transition elements have an unparalleled tendency to form coordination compounds with Lewis bases,
i.e. with groups which are able to donate an electron pair. These groups are called ligands. A ligand may
be a neutral molecule such as NH3, or an ion such as Cl- or CN − . Cobalt forms more complexes than any
other element, and forms more compounds than any other element except carbon.
Co3+ + 6NH3 → [Co(NH3)6]3+
Fe2+ + 6CN– → [Fe(CN)6]4 –
_
@edubuzznotes
564 Chapter 11 The d-Block Elements and some of their Compounds
This ability to form complexes is in marked contrast to the s• and p•block elements which form only a
few complexes. The reason transition elements are so good at forming complexes is that they have small,
highly charged ions and have vacant low energy orbitals to accept lone pairs of electrons donated by other
groups or ligands. Complexes where the metal is in the (+III) oxidation state are generally more stable than
those where the metal is in the (+II) state.
The transition elements are divided into vertical groups of three (triads) or sometimes four elements,
which have similar electronic structures. On descending one of the main groups of elements in the s- and
p•blocks, the size of the atoms increases because extra shells of electrons are present. The elements in the
frst group in the d•block (Group 3) show the expected increase in size Sc → Y → La. However, in the sub•
sequent Groups (3–12) there is an increase in radius of 0.1 → 0.2 Å between the frst and second member,
but hardly any increase between the second and third elements. This trend is shown both in the covalent
radii (Table 11.3) and in the ionic radii (Table 11.4). Interposed between lanthanum and hafnium are the 14
lanthanide elements, in which the antepenultimate 4ƒ shell of electrons is flled.
14 Lanthanides
11.4 | DENSITY
The atomic volumes of the transition elements are low compared to elements in neighbouring Groups
1 and 2. This is because the increased nuclear charge is poorly screened and so attracts all the elec•
trons more strongly. In addition, the extra electrons added occupy inner orbitals. Consequently the
_
@edubuzznotes
11.7 Ionization Energies 565
densities of the transition metals are high. Practically all have a density greater than 5 g cm–3. (The only
exceptions are Sc 3.0 g cm–3 and Y and Ti 4.5 g cm–3.) The densities of the second row are high and third
row values are even higher. (See Appendix D.) The two elements with the highest densities are osmium
22.57 g cm–3 and iridium 22.61 g cm–3. To get some feel for how high this fgure really is, it is found that
a football made of osmium or iridium measuring 30 cm in diameter would weigh 320 kg or almost one
third of a tonne!
11.8 | COLOUR
Many ionic and covalent compounds of transition elements are coloured. In contrast, compounds of the
s- and p•block elements are almost always white. When light passes through a material, it is deprived of
those wavelengths that are absorbed. If absorption occurs in the visible region of the spectrum, the trans•
mitted light is coloured with the colour complementary to the colour of the light absorbed. Absorption in
the visible and UV regions of the spectrum is caused by changes in electronic energy. Thus the spectra are
sometimes called electronic spectra. (These changes are often accompanied by much smaller changes in
vibrational and rotational energies.) It is always possible to promote an electron from one energy level to
another. However, the energy jumps are usually so large that the absorption lies in the UV region. Special
circumstances can make it possible to obtain small jumps in electronic energy which appear as absorption
in the visible region.
Polarization
NaCl, NaBr and NaI are all ionic, and are all colourless; AgCl is also colourless. Thus the halide ions, Cl − ,
Br − and I − , and the metal ions Na+ and Ag+ are typically colourless. However, AgBr is pale yellow and
AgI is yellow. The colour arises because the Ag+ ion polarizes the halide ions. This means that it distorts
the electron cloud, and implies a greater covalent contribution. The polarizability of ions increases with
size, thus I − is the most polarized, and is the most coloured. For the same reason, Ag2CO3 and Ag3PO4 are
yellow, and Ag2O and Ag2S are black.
+ 2−
and MnO4 ⋅ VO2 is pale yellow, but CrO4 is strongly yellow coloured, and MnO4 has an intense purple
− −
colour in solution though the solid is almost black. The colour arises by charge transfer. In MnO4− an elec•
tron is momentarily transferred from O to the metal, thus momentarily changing O2– to O− and reducing
the oxidation state of the metal from Mn(VII) to Mn(VI). Charge transfer requires that the energy levels
on the two different atoms are fairly close. Charge transfer always produces intense colours since the
restrictions of the Laporte and spin selection rules do not apply to transitions between atoms. The colour
of aquated complexes of some transition metal ions are listed here.
_
@edubuzznotes
11.9 Magnetic Properties 567
Sc3+ → colourless
Ti4+ → colourless
Ti3+ → purple
V4+ → blue
V3+ → green
V2+ → violet
Cr2+ → blue
Cr3+ → green
Mn3+ → violet
Mn2+ → light pink
Fe2+ → light green
Fe3+ → yellow
Co2+ → pink
Ni2+ → green
Cu2+ → blue
Zn2+ → colourless
The s- and p•block elements do not have a partially flled d shell so there cannot be any d–d transition.
The energy to promote an s or p electron to a higher energy level is much greater and corresponds to ultra•
violet light being absorbed. Thus compounds of s• and p•block elements typically are not coloured.
In some cases, the transition metals with their variable valency may form unstable intermediate compounds.
In other cases the transition metal provides a suitable reaction surface.
11.11 | NONSTOICHIOMETRY
A further feature of the transition elements is that they sometimes form nonstoichiometric compounds.
These are compounds of indefnite structure and proportions. For example, iron(II) oxide FeO should be
written with a bar over the formula FeO to indicate that the ratio of Fe and O atoms is not exactly 1:1.
Analysis shows that the formula varies between Fe0.94O and Fe0.84O. Vanadium and selenium form a series
of compounds ranging from VSe0.98 to VSe2. These are given in the formulae:
11.12 | ABUNDANCE
Three of the transition metals are very abundant in the earth’s crust. Fe is the fourth most abundant element
by weight, Ti the ninth and Mn the twelfth (Table 11.6). The frst row of transition elements largely follow
Harkins’ rule that elements with an even atomic number are in general more abundant than their neigh•
bours with odd atomic numbers. Manganese is an exception. The second and third row elements are much
less abundant than the frst row. Tc does not occur in nature. Of the last six elements in the second and third
rows (Tc, Ru, Rh, Pd, Ag, Cd; Re, Os, Ir, Pt, Au, Hg) none occurs to an extent of more than 0.16 parts per
million (ppm) in the earth’s crust.
_
@edubuzznotes
11.13 Chromate and Dichromate 569
Table 11.6 Abundance of the transition elements in the earth’s crust, in ppm by weight
Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn
25 6320 136 122 1060 60 000 29 99 68 76
Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd
31 162 20 1.2 • 0.0001 0.0001 0.015 0.08 0.16
La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg
35 2.8 1.7 1.2 0.0007 0.005 0.001 0.01 0.004 0.08
Dissolve in
water and filter
Lime (CaO) is added with Na2CO3 which keeps the mass porous so that air becomes accessible to all
parts of reaction mixture and prevents fusion. Then, chromate is converted to dichromate using sulphuric
acid.
The solubility of Na2SO4 increases up to 32 °C and then decreases. Hence, a suitable temperature
is to be employed to crystallize out Na2SO4 frst. Then Na2Cr2O7 is crystallized out as Na2Cr2O7.2H2O
(red crystals) on evaporation.
Potassium dichromate is obtained by double decomposition reaction using hot concentrated Na2Cr2O7
solution and potassium chloride
double
Na 2 Cr2 O7 + KCl ¾decomposition
¾¾¾¾ ¾® K 2 Cr2 O7 + 2NaCl
K2Cr2O7 and NaCl both are water soluble and hence fractional crystallization is carried out. NaCl crys•
tallizes out frst and is fltered off. Then K2Cr2O7 is crystallized out further.
Properties
The important properties of CrO 2− 2−
4 and Cr2 O 7 such as solubility and chemical reactivity towards different
reagents have been discussed in Chapter 7 (Section 7.12).
Hexavalent chromium shows similarities in properties with hexavalent sulphur compounds because both
the elements have the same number of valence shell electrons. These similar properties are listed as follows:
1. SO3 and CrO3 are both acidic.
2. S forms SO24 − , S 2 O72 − and similarly Cr forms CrO24 − , Cr2 O72 − .
3. K 2 CrO 4 and K 2SO 4 are isomorphous.
- -
4. SO 2 Cl2 ¾OH
¾¾ ® SO 24 - and CrO 2 Cl2 ¾OH
¾¾ ® CrO 24 -
_
@edubuzznotes
570 Chapter 11 The d-Block Elements and some of their Compounds
-
5. SO3 Cl- and CrO3 Cl- ¾OH
¾¾ ® SO 24 - and CrO 2-
4
6. CrO3 and b (SO3 ) have the same structures
O O O O O O
|| || || || || ||
- Cr - O - Cr - O - Cr - O and - S- O - S- O - S- O -
|| || || || || ||
O O O O O O
1.
KOH − 2MnO2 + 4KOH + O2 2K2MnO4 + 2H2O
MnO2 MnO42 MnO42−
or NaOH, green MnO2 + 2KOH + KNO3 K2MnO4 + KNO2 + H2O
Pyrolusite heated in
formed from
melt the reactions
presence of air 3MnO2 + 6KOH + KClO3 3K2MnO4 + KCl + 3H2O
or KNO3 or KClO3
K2MnO4
if KOH
used (isomorphous
cold on with K2SO4)
Green solution
water evaporation
if NaOH
+ little
used Na2MnO4.10H2O
alkali
(isomorphous with
Na2SO4.10H2O)
This reaction is faster in the presence of KClO3 and KNO3 because these on decomposition provide
oxygen easily in all parts of the reaction mixture.
2. Manganate is also obtained when KMnO4 is boiled with conc. KOH.
4KMnO 4 + 4KOH ¾boiled
¾¾® 4K 2 MnO 4 + 2H 2 O + O 2
The above green solution is quite stable in alkali, but decomposes in pure water and in the presence of
acids, depositing MnO2 and giving a purple solution of permanganate.
Properties
1. Oxidizing properties of KMnO4 in acidic medium: The oxidizing properties of KMnO4 in acidic medium
have been discussed in Chapter 7 (Section 7.13). For use as an oxidizing agent, KMnO4 should be
stored in dark bottles and standardized just before use due to the following reasons:
_
@edubuzznotes
11.15 Silver and its Compounds 571
a. It is not a primary standard since it is diffcult to get it in a high degree of purity and free from
traces of MnO2.
b. It is slowly reduced to MnO2 especially in the presence of light or acid.
4MnO -4 + 4H + ® 4MnO 2 + 2H 2 O + 3O 2
2. Oxidizing properties of KMnO4 in alkaline medium: The reactions involved are
2MnO -4 + 2OH - ® 2MnO 24 - + H 2 O + O.
2MnO 24 - + 2H 2 O ® 2MnO 2 + 4OH - + 2O
Some examples,
a. 2KMnO4 + H 2 O + KI → 2MnO2 + 2KOH + KIO3
b. 2KMnO4 + 3HCO2 K → 2MnO2 + KHCO3 + 2K 2 CO3 + H 2 O
c. 2KMnO4 + 3H 2 O2 → 2KOH + 2MnO2 + 2 H 2 O + 3O2
3. Oxidizing properties of KMnO4 in neutral or weak acidic medium: The reaction in neutral medium is
KMnO−4 + Mn 2 + + 2 H 2O → 5MnO2 + 4 H +
For example,
in presence of
2KMnO4 + 3MnSO4 + 2 H 2 O
→ 5MnO2 + K 2 SO4 + H 2 SO4
Zn2+ or ZnO
2+ 2+
In absence of Zn ions, some of Mn ions may escape oxidation through the formation of insoluble
manganous permanganate MnII[MnIVO3].
The reaction in weak acidic medium is
8KMnO 4 + 3Na 2S2 O3 + H 2 O ® 8MnO 2 + 3Na 2SO 4 + 3S + 2KOH
4. Heating effect: The effect of heating on KMnO4 is discussed in Chapter 7 (Section 7. 13).
∆
2KMnO4 200 °C
→ K 2 MnO4 + MnO2 + O2
green black
K2MnO4 is soluble in water and obtained as green fltrate. MnO2 is insoluble in water and obtained as
black residue.
H2S
Black [4Ag + 2H2S + O2 2Ag2S + 2H2O]
Tarnishing of silver
Metallic Ag H2SO4
2Ag + 2H2SO4 Ag2SO4 + SO2 + H2O
HNO3
Ag + 2HNO3 AgNO3 + NO2 + H2O
hot conc.
HCl
Not affected by dil. HCl
E 0Ag/Ag+ < E 0 1 H2/H+
2
Properties
1. Thermal decomposition:
2 AgNO3 → 2 Ag + 2 NO2 + O2
CO32−
Ag2CO3 ↓ (yellowish white ppt.)
SO32−
Ag2SO3 ↓ (white ppt.)
S2−
Ag2S ↓ (black ppt.)
S2O2−
3
Ag2S2O3 ↓ (white ppt.)
−
CH3CO2
CH3CO2Ag ↓ (white ppt.)
−
HCO3
HCO2Ag ↓ (white ppt.)
C2O42−
Ag2C2O4 ↓ (white ppt.)
−
NO 2
AgNO3 AgNO2 ↓ (white ppt.)
− − −
Cl /Br /I
AgCl ↓ (white ppt.)
AgBr ↓ (pale yellow ppt.)
AgI ↓ (yellow ppt.)
PO43−
Ag3PO4 ↓ (yellow ppt.)
B4O72−
AgBO2 ↓ (white ppt.)
CrO42−
Ag2CrO4 ↓ (brick red ppt.)
2−
Cr2O 7
Ag2Cr2O7 ↓ (reddish brown ppt.)
Note: Preparation of AgCl, AgBr, AgI, Ag 2 S 2 O3 can be done very easily by the reaction of AgNO3
with KCl, KBr, Kl and Na 2 S 2 O3 solution (reactions are shown above). Properties of all these com•
pounds are also discussed at different places in Chapter 7.
_
@edubuzznotes
11.16 Zinc Compounds 573
4. aqua regia
insoluble
dil.HCl Zn/HCl
AgNO3 AgCl [H] Ag↓ + HCl
Na NaOH Na2CO3
OH Ag↓
(conc.) on fusion
K2S2O8
Ag2O
H 2O 2
Ag↓
AgO black
Ag
Ag 2 O + H 2 O2 → 2 Ag + H 2 O + O2
K 2 S 2 O8 + 2 AgNO3 + 2 H 2 O → 2 AgO + 2KHSO4 + 2 HNO3
5. AgO is expected to be paramagnetic due to d9 confguration. But actually it is diamagnetic and exists
as AgI [AgIIIO2].
Use
Preparation
1. 2Zn + O2 burnt in
air → 2ZnO
2. ZnCO3 ∆
→ ZnO + CO2
3. 2Zn(NO3 )2 ∆→ 2ZnO + 4 NO2 + O2
4. Zn(OH)2 ∆
→ ZnO + H 2 O
The purest form of ZnO is obtained by
4ZnSO4 + 4Na2CO3 + 3H2O ZnCO3.3Zn(OH)2 ↓ + 4Na2SO4 + 3CO2
white basic zinc
carbonate
ZnO (cold) ↽
ZnO (hot)
⇀
∆
white yellow
2. It is insoluble in water.
3. It sublimes at 400 °C.
4. It is an amphoteric oxide, as indicated by the following reactions:
ZnO + 2 HCl → ZnCl 2 + H 2 O
ZnO + H 2 SO4 → ZnSO4 + H 2 O
ZnO + 2 NaOH → Na 2 ZnO2 + H 2 O
5. ZnO can be reduced to metallic zinc using hydrogen gas or carbon.
400°C
ZnO + H 2 > → Zn + H 2 O
ZnO + C → Zn + CO
6. It forms Rinmann’s green with Co(NO3 )2
Uses
1. ZnO is used as a white pigment. It is superior to white lead because it does not turn black when it
comes in contact with air.
2. Rinmann’s green is used as a green pigment.
3. It is used as zinc ointment in medicine.
Other properties of ZnCl2 have already been discussed in Chapter 7 (Sections 7.16 and 7.17).
_
@edubuzznotes
11.17 Copper Compounds 575
Uses
1. For impregnating timber to prevent destruction by insects.
2. As dehydrating agent when anhydrous.
3. ZnO ⋅ ZnCl 2 is used in dental fllings.
1. Thermal decomposition:
39–70°C >70°C >280 °C
ZnSO4 . 7H2O ZnSO4 . 6H2O ZnSO4 . H2O ZnSO4
>800°C
1
O + SO2 + ZnO
2 2
Uses
1. In eye lotions.
2. Lithophone (ZnS + BaSO4 ) is used as white pigment and prepared as follows:
°− 60°C
ZnSO4 + BaS 50
→ BaSO4 ↓ + ZnS ↓
Properties
1. It is insoluble in water.
2. It readily dissolves in dilute acids by the following reactions:
CuO + H 2 SO4 → CuSO4 + H 2 O
CuO + 2 HCl → CuCl 2 + H 2 O
CuO + 2 HNO3 → Cu(NO3 )2 + H 2 O
CuO + C → Cu + CO ↑
CuO + H 2 → Cu + H 2 O ↑
Properties
1. It is crystallized as CuCl 2 ⋅ 2 H 2 O which is emerald green in colour.
2. Dilute solution of CuCl2 in water is blue in colour due to the formation of [Cu(H 2 O)4 ]2+ complex.
3. When conc. HCl or KCl is added to dilute solution of CuCl 2 , the colour changes into yellow owing to
the formation of [CuCl 4 ]2− .
4. The concentrated aqueous solution of CuCl2 is green in colour having the following two complex ions
in equilibrium:
2[Cu(H 2 O)4 ]Cl 2 ⇌ [Cu(H 2 O)4 ]2 + + [CuCl 4 ]2 − + 4 H 2 O
Properties
1. It is crystallized as CuSO4 ⋅ 5H2O and is called as blue vitriol.
on
exposure to 100°C
CuSO4 . 5H2O CuSO4 . 3H2O CuSO4 . H2O
sunlight
pale blue bluish white
blue effloresence
takes place
230°C
CuSO4 (anhyd.)
white
>800°C 750°C
2. The other properties of CuSO4 have already been discussed in Chapter 7 (Section 7.16).
Properties
1. It undergoes oxidation forming basic ferric sulphate.
4FeSO4 + H2O + O2 → 4Fe(OH)SO4
FeSO4 high
2. FeSO4 .7H 2 O ¾300
¾¾ °C
®anhy .white ¾temp
¾¾ .® Fe 2 O3 + SO2 + SO3
c. Au 3 + + Fe2 + → Au + Fe3 +
d. Fe2 + + HgCl 2 → Hg 2 Cl 2 ↓ + Fe3 +
white ppt.
On further addition of FeCl2, it does not turn Hg2Cl2 into metallic Hg as in case of addition of SnCl2.
_
@edubuzznotes
578 Chapter 11 The d-Block Elements and some of their Compounds
Properties
It is stable at high temperatures and on cooling slowly disproportionates into Fe3O4 and Fe.
4 FeO → Fe3O4 + Fe
2. 2 FeCl 3 + H 2 ∆
→ 2 FeCl 2 + 2 HCl
Properties
1. It is deliquescent in air.
2. It is soluble in water, alcohol and ether because it is suffciently covalent in nature.
3. It volatilizes at about 1000 °C and vapour density indicates the presence of Fe2 Cl 4 . Above 1300 °C
density becomes normal.
4. It is oxidized on heating in air.
12 FeCl 2 + 3O2 → 2 Fe2 O3 + 8 FeCl 3
Uses
1. It is used to prepare writing ink.
2. It is used as mordant in dying.
3. It is used as weed killer in agriculture.
4. It is used as a reducing agent.
_
@edubuzznotes
Single Correct Choice Type Questions 579
(C) Its tartarate complex reacts with NaOH and glu• Which of the following reactions will be spontaneous?
cose followed by heating to give Cu2O. (A) MnO24 − → MnO4−
(D) It gives CuO on strong heating in air.
(B) MnO4− → MnO2 + MnO24 −
2. ZnO shows yellow colour on heating due to
(A) d–d transition. (C) MnO24 − → MnO2 + MnO4−
(B) charge transfer spectra. (D) None of these.
(C) higher polarization caused by Zn2+ ion.
9. For the preparation of KMnO4 from K2MnO4 which
(D) presence of F•center.
of the following reagents is the best?
3. Malachite and azurite are used respectively as (A) Dil. H2SO4
(A) blue and green pigment. (B) SnCl2 (acidifed)
(B) red and green pigment. (C) CO2 is passed
(C) green and blue pigment. (D) Cl2 is passed
(D) green and red pigment.
10. When KMnO4 reacts with H2O2 in a slightly alkaline
4. Choose the correct options (true or false) for the fol• and acidic medium, the respective products obtained
lowing statements. are
(i) FeO is stable enough at room temperature. (A) K 2 MnO4 and Mn 2+ (B) MnO2 and MnO2
(ii) FeCl2 on heating in air and in steam produces the (C) MnO2 and Mn . 2+
(D) Mn 2+ and MnO2
same iron oxide.
(iii) The colour of FeCl2 depends upon the number of 11. AgO actually exists as Ag [AgO2], which is diamag•
water of crystallization. netic in nature. Then which of the following state•
(A) TTF ments is true regarding AgO?
(B) FTF (A) The arrangement of O2– ions around Ag+ ion is
(C) FFT square planar.
(D) TFT (B) The arrangement of O2– ions around Ag3+ ion is
tetrahedral.
5. The elements with maximum and minimum melting (C) The arrangement of O2– ions around Ag3+ ion is
points in the second transition series respectively square planar.
are (D) Both (B) and (C) are correct.
(A) Cr and Zn.
12. Total number of d-orbitals involved in the hybridiza•
(B) Cr and Cd.
tion of central metal ion in complex ion [MnO4]− is
(C) Cr and Hg.
(A) 6 (B) 4 (C) 2 (D) 3
(D) Mo and Cd.
13. Which of the following metal ions is expected to be
6. (i) BaCO3 + Na2CrO4 + AcOH→ M coloured?
aq. suspension ppt. (A) Zn2+ (B) Ti3+ (C) Sc3+ (D) Ti4+
(ii) BaCO3 + Na2CrO4 + HCN→ N 14. When Cu2+ solution reacts with excess KI, which of
aq. suspension ppt. the following statements is correct?
Which is the correct option regarding the above (A) White ppt. of Cu2I2 is obtained.
reactions? (B) A clear brown solution is obtained.
(A) M and N are the same and characterized as (C) A dark brown solution is obtained in which ppt.
BaCrO4. of Cu2I2 is invisible.
(B) M is BaCrO4 and N stands for no precipitate. (D) A blue solution is obtained.
(C) M is BaCrO4 and N is BaCO3. 15. When KMnO4 is heated with fused KOH, then the
(D) M stands for no precipitate and N is BaCrO4. product formed is
(A) KMnO4, purple
7. Which of the following statements is incorrect regard• (B) K2MnO4, green
ing the similarities between hexavalent Cr and S (C) MnO2, black
compounds? (D) Mn2O3, brown
(A) SO3 and CrO3 both are acidic.
(B) SO2C12 and CrO2Cl2 on alkaline hydrolysis pro•
duce similar type of products.
_
@edubuzznotes
580 Chapter 11 The d-Block Elements and some of their Compounds
15. The number of water of crystallization present in 16. The oxidation state of the metal present in A is the
compound E is same as that of the metal present in
(A) 4 (A) G and I
(B) 5 (B) G and E
(C) 2 (C) B and E
(D) 6 (D) B and G
Column I Column II
2. Match the compounds with their chemical properties.
3+
(A) Cr (P) 2
Column I Column II
3+
(B) Fe (Q) 3
(A) KMnO4 (P) Acts as oxidizing
2+
agent. (C) Ni (R) 4
(B) K2Cr2O7 (Q) All X–O bonds are 3+
(D) Mn (S) 5
equivalent.
(C) Na2SO4 (R) d3s hybridization
for the central
atom (s)
5. Match the ore with its formula and the use to which it is put.
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (B) 4. (C) 7. (C) 10. (C) 13. (B)
2. (D) 5. (D) 8. (C) 11. (C) 14. (C)
3. (C) 6. (C) 9. (D) 12. (D) 15. (B)
12
The f-Block Ln2O3
Burn
∆
S
with
O2
Ac
id
H2↑
C
Halogen
H2O
LnX3
at 2500°C
Important reactions of
lanthanoids.
The elements in which the additional electron enters
(n – 2) f orbital are called as f•block elements. They are also
called as inner transition elements. These are placed at the
bottom of the periodic table to make the table compact.
There are two series of f•block elements:
1. Lanthanoids (4f-series): These are 14 elements between
lanthanum(La) and Hf in which 4f orbitals are successively
flled; starting from Ce (At. no. 58) to Lu (At. no. 71).
Contents
2. Actinoids (5f-series): These are 14 elements, after actinium
(Ac), in which 5f orbitals are successively flled, starting Th 12.1 Lanthanoids
(At. no. 90) to Lr (At. no. 103). 12.2 Actinoids
12.3 Comparison between
Lanthanoids and Actinoids
12.1 | LANTHANOIDS
The 14 elements that fll up the antepenultimate 4f energy
levels are called lanthanoids. They are extremely similar to
each other in properties and until 1907, they were thought to
be a single element.
The names, atomic numbers, symbols of elements and
electronic confguration of atoms and M3+ ions are given in
Table 12.1.
Lanthanum(d•block element preceeding the 4f•series) has
electronic structure [Xe] 5d1 6s2. It is energetically favourable
to move single 5d eletron to 4f level in most of lanthanoids
except Ce, Gd and Lu. Gd has a 5d1 arrangement because it
leads to stable half•flled confguration and in case of Lu to a
stable flled f•shell confguration.
_
@edubuzznotes
586 Chapter 12 The f-Block Elements and their Properties
Table 12.2 Ionic radii of Sc3+, Y3+, La3+ and Ln3+ ions (pm)
Sc
74.5
Y
90
La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
103.2 102 99 98.3 97 95.8 94.7 93.8 92.3 91.2 90.1 89 88 86.8 86.1
_
@edubuzznotes
12.1 Lanthanoids 587
Oxidation states
The very common and stable oxidation state for lanthanoids is +3 which can also be explained easily from
their electronic confgurations, that is, two electrons from 6s orbital and one electron from 5d orbital are
lost easily from all elements except Eu and Yb. Hence, lanthanoids placed in Group 3 in the periodic table.
The stability of Eu2+ and Yb2+ can be explained based on their electronic confguration. Sometimes, +4
oxidation state is observed when this leads to
1. half•flled electronic confguration: For example, Tb4+ (f 7)
2. noble gas confguration: For example, Ce4+ (Xe)
Some higher oxidation states are also possible but not so important for discussion.
Color
1. Lanthanoid ions have unpaired electrons in f-orbitals and they exhibit color due to f–f transition.
2. The exhibited color generally depends upon the number of unpaired electrons but we cannot be pre•
dict the colour shown.
3. The ions having 4f n confguration and 4f 14–n confguration will have similar color (expected).
4. The ions having confguration f 0 and f 14 are colourless as they are diamagnetic; and if any colour is
present it is not due to f–f transition.
Magnetic properties
1. From Ce3+ to Gd3+, the paramagnetic behaviour increases, then decreases and fnally becomes diamag•
netic for Lu3+.
2. Ce4+, Yb2+ and Lu3+ are diamagnetic.
Ln2O3
Burn
Ln2S3 with
S O2 H2↑
∆ id
Ac
Halogen
N2 Ln LnX3
∆ H 2O
LnN
C
at 2500°C
Uses of lanthanoids
1. An unseparated mixture of La and the lanthanoids called Misch metal (50% Ce, 40% La, 7% Fe and
3% other metals) is added to steel to improve its strength and workability. It is pyrophoric and also
used in gas lighters.
2. CeO2 is used to polish glass. Again CeO2, La2O3, Nd2O3 and Pr2O3 are used as decolourizing agents for
glasses.
3. Cerium molybdate and cerium tungstate are used in paints and dyes.
4. CeS is used for making crucibles that can withstand temperatures up to 1950°C (as the melting point
is 2000°C).
12.2 | ACTINOIDS
The elements Th (At. no. 90) to Lr (At. no. 103) are together known as actinoids. Actinium, the d•block
element preceding 5f•series has outershell structure 6d17s2. For the frst four actinoids Th, Pa, U and Np, the
difference between the energy levels of 5f and 6d orbitals is small. Thus in these elements (or ions) elec•
trons may occupy either 5d or 6f orbitals. From Pu onwards, the energy of 5f orbitals becomes lower and
electrons fll the orbitals as in case of lanthanoids.
The electronic confgurations of the elements, their M3+ ions and other possible oxidation states are
given in the Table 12.3.
Oxidation states
1. The most stable oxidation state is +3.
2. Maximum oxidation state of +7 is shown by Np (At no. 93) and Pu (At no. 94).
3. Other available oxidation states are shown in Table 12.3.
Magnetic properties
Ions are paramagnetic or diamagnetic depending upon the number of unpaired 58 electrons, as can be
seen from their electronic confgurations.
Colour
In general, actinoid ions are coloured, unless they are diamagnetic.
Physical appearance
They are silvery white metals but get tarnished when exposed to alkaline solution.
Uses of actinoids
1. Thorium is used as fuel rods in nuclear reactors and in the treatment of cancer.
2. Uranium is used as nuclear fuel. Its salts are used to impart green colour to glass and are used in medicines.
_
@edubuzznotes
590 Chapter 12 The f-Block Elements and their Properties
Differences
The differences are tabulated in Table 12.5.
(A) 5f orbitals are more diffused as compared to 16. The magnetic moment of Am5+ (At. no. 95) is
4f-orbital from nucleus. (A) 24 BM (B) 35 BM
(B) 4f•orbitals are more diffused as compared to
(C) 15 BM (D) 3 BM
5f-orbitals.
(C) Shielding effect of electrons present in 4f- and 17. Which of the following elements is not an f•block
5f-orbitals is equal. element?
(D) The azimuthal quantum numbers of 4f- and 5f- (A) No (B) Nd (C) Nb (D) Np
orbitals are the same.
18. On moving from Ce3+ to Lu3+, the cation having max•
11. Which of the following cations has the strongest imum number of unpaired electrons is
tendency towards complex formation? (A) Ce3+ (B) Lu3+ (C) Eu3+ (D) Gd3+
(A) Sm3+ (B) Lu3+ (C) Gd3+ (D) Yb3+
19. Lanthanoid from series is
12. Which of the following elements has maximum
composition in Misch metal, which is used in gas (A) La to Lu
lighters? (B) Th to Lr
(A) La (B) Fe (C) Ce (D) Other metals (C) Ce to Lu
13. Which of the following Ce compound is used for (D) Ac to Lr
making crucibles? 20. Which of the following statements is true for
(A) CeO2 (B) CeS (C) ThO2 (D) Nd2O3 f-block elements?
14. The gradual decrease in radius for lanthanoid ele• (A) They can have electrons from f 0 to f 14.
ments is not obeyed by (B) Group number is 3 in the periodic table.
(A) Eu only (B) Yb only (C) With the increase in number of f-electrons, the
(C) Both Eu and Yb (D) None
15. The gradual decrease in radius of M3+ ion for lantha•
noids is not obeyed by (D) All of these.
(A) Eu only (B) Yb only
(C) Both Eu and Yb (D) None of these
| ANSWERS
Single Correct Choice Type Questions
1. (A) 6. (B) 11. (B) 16. (A)
2. (C) 7. (D) 12. (C) 17. (C)
3. (D) 8. (C) 13. (B) 18. (D)
4. (D) 9. (B) 14. (C) 19. (C)
5. (D) 10. (A) 15. (D) 20. (D)
_
@edubuzznotes
_
@edubuzznotes
APPENDIX
Abundance of
the Elements in
A
the Earth’s Crust
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
594 Appendix A Abundance of the Elements in the Earth’s Crust
Appendix A (continued)
Name Symbol Abundance* Name Symbol Abundance
23 Rubidium Rb 78 62 Iodine I 0.46
24 Zinc Zn 76 63 Indium In 0.24
25 Copper Cu 68 64 Antimony Sb 0.20
26 Cerium Ce 66 65 Cadmium Cd 0.16
27 Neodymium Nd 40 66 = Silver Ag 0.08
28 Lanthanum La 35 66 = Mercury Hg 0.08
29 Yttrium Y 31 68 Selenium Se 0.05
30 Cobalt Co 29 69 Palladium Pd 0.015
31 Scandium Sc 25 70 Platinum Pt 0.01
32 Niobium Nb 20 71 Bismuth Bi 0.008
33 Nitrogen N 19 72 Osmium Os 0.005
34 Gallium Ga 19 73 Gold Au 0.004
35 Lithium Li 18 74 = Iridium Ir 0.001
36 Lead Pb 13 74 = Tellurium Te 0.001
37 Praseodymium Pr 9.1 76 Rhenium Re 0.0007
38 Boron B 9.0 77 = Ruthenium Ru 0.0001
39 Thorium Th 8.1 77 = Rhodium Rh 0.0001
* Units are ppm of the earth’s crust, which is the same as g/tonne. Values mainly from Geochemistry by W.S. Fyfe, Oxford
University press. 1974, with some newer data.
_
@edubuzznotes
APPENDIX
Melting Points B
of the Elements
Group
1 2 13 14 15 16 17 18
Period
1 H H He
−259 −259 −
2 Li Be B C N O F Ne
181 1287 2180 4100 −210 −229 −219 −249
3 Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
Group
98 649 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 660 1420 44 114 −101 −189
4 K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
63 839 1539 1667 1915 1903 1244 1535 1495 1453 1083 419 30 945 816 221 −7 −157
5 Rb Sr Y Zr No Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
39 768 1523 1857 2468 2620 2172 2310 1966 1554 962 321 157 232 631 452 114 −112
6 Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
28.5 727 920 2227 3000 3410 3180 3045 2410 1772 1064 −38 303 327 271 254 302e −71e
7 Fr Ra Ac
APPENDIX
Boiling Points C
of the Elements
Group
1 2 13 14 15 16 17 18
Period.
1 H He
−253 −269
2 Li Be B C N O F Nc
766 1494 2748 3285 3350 2960 2060 2750 3100 2920 2570 907 2403 2850 615 685 60 −153.6
5 Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
688 1381 3264 4200 4758 4650 4567(4050)3760 2940 2155 765 2080 2623 1587 1087 185 −108.1
6 Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
705 (1850) 3420 4450 5534 5500 5650 (5025)(4550)4170 2808 357 1457 1751 1564 962 −62
7 Fr Ra Ac
(1700) 2470
Temperatures are in degrees Celsius. Large circles indicate high values and small circles low values.
Values given in parentheses are approximate, s indicates sublimation.
<0
1−1500
1501−3000
>3000
_
@edubuzznotes
APPENDIX
Densities of the
Solid and Liquid
D
Elements
Group
1 2 13 14 15 16 17 18
Period
1 H H He
2 Li Be B C N O F Ne
0.86 1.55 3.0 4.50 6.11 7.14 7.43 7.87 8.90 8.91 8.95 7.14 5.90 5.32 5.77 4.19 3.19
5 Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Te Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
1.53 2.63 4.5 6.51 8.57 10.28 11.5 12.41 12.39 11.99 10.49 8.65 7.31 7.27 6.70 6.25 4.94
6 Cs Ba La Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
1.90 3.62 6.17 13.28 16.65 19.3 21.0 22.57 22.61 21.41 19.32 13.53 11.85 11.34 9.81 9.14 —
7 Fr Ra Ac
_ 5.5 _
Densities are given in g cm−3 (which equals 10−3 kg m−3). The value for carbon is the value for graphite. Large
circles indicate large values and small circles small values.
_
@edubuzznotes
APPENDIX
Electronic
Structures of
E
the Elements
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
APPENDIX E Electronic Structures of the Elements 599
Appendix E (continued)
Z Element Symbol Structure
19 Potassium K [Ar] 4s1
20 Calcium Ca [Ar] 4s2
21 Scandium Sc [Ar]3d14s2
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
600 APPENDIX E Electronic Structures of the Elements
Appendix E (continued)
Z Element Symbol Structure
53 Iodine I [Kr] 4d10 5s25p5
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
APPENDIX E Electronic Structures of the Elements 601
Appendix E (continued)
Z Element Symbol Structure
87 Francium Fr [Rn] 7s1
88 Radium Ra [Rn] 7s2
89 Actinium Ac [Rn] 6d17s2
90 Thorium Th [Rn] 6d 27s2
91 Protactinium Pa [Rn] 5f 2 6d17s2
APPENDIX
Some Average
Single Bond F
Energies and
Some Double
and Triple Bond
Energies
APPENDIX
Solubilities of
Main Group G
Compounds in
Water
NH +4 vs 37 75 172 192 12 75
+ c
Li 0.27 83 177 165 12.8 70 1.33 35
+
Na 4.0 36 91 179 109 87 21 19.4 9.6
+
K 95 34.7 67 144 112 31.6 112 11.1 22.4
Rb+ 131 91 110 152 177 53 450 48
Cs2+ 370 186 108 79 330 23 vs 179
2+
Be vs vs s dec ss 107 39
Mg2+ 0.008 54.2 102 148 0.0009 70 ss 33
2+
Ca 0.0016 74.5 142 209 0.156 129 ss 0.21
2+
Sr 0.012 53.8 100 178 0.80 71 ss 0.013
2+
Be 0.12 36 104 205 3.9 8.7 ss 0.00024
Al3+ 0.55 70 dec dec dec ss 63 38
3+
Ga 0.002 vs s dec ss vs
3+
In 0.04 vs vs dec ss
+ b
Tl 78.6 0.33 0.05 0.0006 25.9a 9.55 4.0b s
3+
Tl Dec vs s s s 4.87
GeII S dec dec s
IV
Ge dec dec dec dec
II b
Sn S 270 dec s 0.98 ss dec 33d
IV
Sn vs Dec dec dec
II
Pb 0.064 0.99 0.844 0.063 0.016 55 0.00011 ss
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
604 APPENDIX G Solubilities of Main Group Compounds in Water
Appendix G (continued)
F− CI− Br− I− OH− NO3− CO32– SO42− HCO3−
PbIV dec
III
As dec dec dec 6.0d
v
As
SbIII dec dec dec dec dec ss
v
Sb dec
III
Bi ss dec dec ss 0.00014 dec dec
Solubilities in grams of solute per 100 grams of water at 20 °C unless otherwise indicated, vs = very soluble: s = soluble:
ss = slightly soluble: dec = decomposes. a = at 0 °C: b = at 15 °C: c = at 18 °C: d = at 25 °C.
_
@edubuzznotes
APPENDIX
Atomic Weights
Based on
H
12
C = 12.000
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
606 APPENDIX H Atomic Weights Based on 12
C = 12.000
Appendix H (continued)
Element Atomic weight Element Atomic weight
Dysprosium 162.50 Oxygen 15.9994
Einsteinium (254) Palladium 106.4
Erbium 167.26 Phosphorus 30.9738
Europium 151.96 Platinum 195.09
Fermium (253) Plutonium (242)
Fluorine 18.993 Polonium (210)
Francium (223) Potassium 39.102
Gadolinium 157.25 Praseodymium 140.91
Gallium 69.72 Promethium (147)
Germanium 72.59 Protactinium (231)
Gold 196.967 Radium (226)
Hafnium 178.49 Radon (222)
Helium 4.003 Rhenium 186.22
Rhodium 102.91 Terbium 153.92
Rubidium 85.47 Thallium 204.37
Ruthenium 101.07 Thorium 232.04
Samarium 150.35 Thulium 168.93
Scandium 44.96 Tin 118.69
Selenium 78.96 Titanium 47.90
Silicon 28.086 Tungsten 183.85
Silver 107.870 Uranium 238.03
Sodium 22.9898 Vanadium 50.942
Strontium 87.62 Xenon 131.30
Sulphur 32.064 Ytterbium 173.04
Tantalum 180.95 Yttrium 88.91
Technetium (99) Zinc 65.37
Tellurium 127.60 Zirconium 91.22
APPENDIX
Values of Some
Fundamental I
Physical
Constants
APPENDIX
Electrical
Resistivity of J
the Elements
at the Stated
Temperature
(continued)
_
@edubuzznotes
APPENDIX J Electrical Resistivity of the Elements at the Stated Temperature 609
Appendix J (continued)
Element Symbol Temp Resistivity Element Symbol Temp Resistivity
(°C) (µohm cm) (°C) (µohm cm)
Indium In 20 8.37 Samarium Sm 25 88
Lithium Li 20 8.55 Europium Eu 25 90
Osmium Os 20 9.5 Mercury Hg 20 95.8
Iron Fe 20 9.71 Erbium Er 25 107
Platinum Pt 20 10.6 Bismuth Bi 20 120
Palladium Pd 20 10.8 Gadolinium Gd 25 140.5
Tinβ Sn 0 11 Plutonium Pu 107 141.4
Tantalum Ta 25 12.45 Manganese Mn 23 185
Rubidium Rb 20 12.5 Tellurium Te 25 4.5 × 10 5
Niobium Nb 0 12.5 Germanium Ge 22 4.7 × 10 7
Chromium Cr 0 12.9 Silicon Si 20 4.8 × 10 7
Thorium Th 0 13 Boron B 20 6.7 × 1011
Thallium TI 0 18 Iodine I 20 1.3 × 1015
Rhenium Re 20 19.3 Selenium Se 20 1.2 × 1016
Caesium Cs 20 20 Phosphorus # P 11 1 × 1017
Lead Pb 20 20.648 Carbon C 20 ≅ 1 × 10 20
Strontium Sr 20 23 Sulphur S 20 2 × 10 24
* Resistivity of Ga is 8.2, 17.5 or 553 µohm cm depending on direction.
# White phosphorus.
_
@edubuzznotes
APPENDIX
Hardness of
Minerals – Mohs’
K
Scale
Sometimes rocks are called soft because individual particles, which may be quite hard in themselves, are
loosely held as an aggregate and fall apart fairly readily. The hardness of a mineral is something quite
different and refers to the resistance of the whole surface to be scratched.
More than a century ago a mineralogist called Friedrich Mohs devised a scale of hardness called after him
(Table K.1). He arbitrarily assigned talc (the softest known mineral) a hardness of 1, and diamond, (the
hardest known mineral) a value of 10. The scale is arbitrary and does not indicate any exact hardness. Thus
a mineral of hardness 6 can scratch those below it in the scale but it does not imply that it is twice as hard
as a mineral of hardness 3. Two minerals of the same hardness will both scratch each other. There is a very
large difference between 9 and 10 on the scale.
Common objects such as a fngernail, a copper coin, a knife blade or a metal fle can also be used as test
instruments. It may be convenient to use these to test samples for hardness quickly and easily when out in
the feld (Table K.2).
_
@edubuzznotes
APPENDIX K Hardness of Minerals – Mohs’ Scale 611
Minerals of hardness below 6.5 can be scratched by a nail•fle, those under 5.5 are scratched by a
penknife, those under 3.5 are scratched by a copper coin and those under 2.5 are scratched by a fngernail
and will leave a mark on paper. Conversely minerals over 5.5 will scratch glass.
_
@edubuzznotes
_
@edubuzznotes
SECTION 1
• This section contains SIX (06) questions.
• Each question has FOUR options for correct answer(s). ONE OR MORE THAN ONE of these four option(s) is (are)
correct option(s).
1. The compound(s) which generate(s) N2 gas upon thermal decomposition below 300°C is (are)
(A) NH4NO3 (B) (NH4)2Cr2O7 (C) Ba(N3)2 (D) Mg3N2
Solution
(B) (C) Ammonium salts decompose quite readily on heating. If the anion is more oxidizing (e.g. NO3− , Cr2 O27 −) then
NH +4 gets oxidized to N2 or N2O.
NH 4 NO3 Heat
→ N 2 O + 2H 2 O
(NH 4 )2 Cr2 O 7 Heat
→ N 2 + 4H 2 O + Cr2 O3
Ba (N 3 )2 Heat
→ Ba + 3N 2
2. The correct statement(s) regarding the binary transition metal carbonyl compounds is (are) (Atomic numbers: Fe = 26,
Ni = 28)
(A) Total number of valence shell electrons at metal centre in Fe(CO)5 or Ni(CO)4 is 16.
(B) These are predominantly low spin in nature.
(C) Metal–carbon bond strengthens when the oxidation state of the metal is lowered.
(D) The carbonyl C—O bond weakens when the oxidation state of the metal is increased.
Solution
(B) (C) Option (A): Incorrect. Total number of valence shell electrons in Fe(CO)5 [8 + 5 × 2 = 18] and Ni(CO)4
[10 + 4 × 2 = 18] is 18.
Option (B): Correct. CO being a strong field ligand cause pairing of electrons. Hence, both the complexes formed
are low spin in nature.
Option (C): Correct. CO ligand not only donates the lone pair of electrons to the central atom but also accept the elec-
tron cloud from the central atom in their low-lying vacant orbitals. This kind of back donation is known as ‘synergic
effect’ or ‘synergic bonding. In case of CO, the back donation to the p * orbital of central atom may be depicted as:
p∗
M C O M C O
p∗
Greater the electron density on the metal atom, that is, lower the oxidation state of the metal, greater will be the back
donation hence stronger will be the M—C bond.
Option (D): Incorrect. When the oxidation state of metal increases its tendency to accept the electrons from C of CO
increases but tendency to donate the electrons from M to C decreases consequently M—C bond strength decreases
and C—O bond strength increases.
_
@edubuzznotes I (Chemistry)
Solution
(A) (B) (C) Option (A): Correct. The basicity of oxides usually increases on descending a group. Therefore, Bi2O5
is more basic than N2O5.
Option (B): Correct. Covalent nature of a molecule depends on the electronegativity difference between bonded
atoms.
Option (C): Correct. Boiling point of NH3 is more than that of PH3 due to hydrogen bonding.
Option (D): Incorrect. P—P single bond is stronger than N—N single bond. This is due to the fact that N is small in
size, due to smaller size of atoms lone pair of repulsion will be more.
Me OH Me OH
Solution
(B)
Me OH Me Br Me I Me N3
NaN3,
PBr3 NaI HCONMe
Et2O CH3COCH3 (SN2)
(SN2) (SN2)
(X)
Ο
CHO
1. Br2, NaOH
2. H3O+
(C) (D)
3. Sodalime, ∆ Zn/Hg, HCl
OHC CHO
Ο Ο
_
@edubuzznotes JEE (Advanced) 2018 Paper I (Chemistry) P-3
Solution
(A) (B) (D)
CH3
O
Conc. H2SO4
3 CH3 C CH3 Heat
CH3 CH3
CH3
Heated iron
3H CH3 tube 873 K
CH3 CH3
O O− Na+
O
1. Br2/NaOH
+
(Haloform reaction) Na−O O− Na+
O O O O
2. H3O+
OH
O
3. Sodalime
∆
HO OH
(Decarboxylation)
O O
CHO CH3
Zn/Hg
HCl
6. A reversible cyclic process for an ideal gas is shown below. Here p, V, and T are pressure, volume and temperature,
respectively. The thermodynamic parameters q, w, H and U are heat, work, enthalpy and internal energy, respectively.
Temperature (T)
Solution
(B) (C) We know ∆U = q + w and w = − p ∆V
In the above figure, A-C is isochoric, A-B is isothermal and B-C is isobaric process. Therefore, for an isochoric
process AC, we have
q AC = ∆U AC = nCV , m (T 2 − T1 ) = ∆U BC
SECTION 2
• This section contains EIGHT (08) questions. The answer to each question is a NUMERICAL VALUE.
7. Among the species given below, the total number of diamagnetic species is .
H atom, NO2 monomer, O2− (superoxide), dimeric sulphur in vapor phase, Mn3O4, (NH4)2[FeCl4], (NH4)2[NiCl4],
K2MnO4, K2CrO4
Solution
(1) The paramagnetic species are H atom, NO2 monomer, O2− (superoxide), dimeric sulphur in vapor phase, Mn3O4,
(NH4)2[FeCl4], (NH4)2[NiCl4] and K2MnO4.
The diamagnetic species is K2CrO4.
8. The ammonia prepared by treating ammonium sulphate with calcium hydroxide is completely used by NiCl2·6H2O
to form a stable coordination compound. Assume that both the reactions are 100% complete. If 1584 g of ammo-
nium sulphate and 952 g of NiCl2·6H2O are used in the preparation, the combined weight (in grams) of gypsum and
the nickel−ammonia coordination compound thus produced is .
(Atomic weights in g mol−1: H = 1, N = 14, O = 16, S = 32, Cl = 35.5, Ca = 40, Ni = 59)
Solution
The reactions involved are as follows:
(NH 4 )2 SO 4 + Ca(OH)2 ® CaSO 4 × 2H 2 O + 2 NH 3
9. Consider an ionic solid MX with NaCl structure. Construct a new structure (Z) whose unit cell is constructed from
the unit cell of MX following the sequential instructions given below. Neglect the charge balance.
(i) Remove all the anions (X) except the central one
(ii) Replace all the face centered cations (M) by anions (X)
(iii) Remove all the corner cations (M)
(iv) Replace the central anion (X) with cation (M)
number of anions
The value of in Z is .
number of cations
Solution
(3) Given that MX is an ionic solid having NaCl type structure having ccp. So, the anion X− occupies all octahedral
voids. The changes (i)-(iv) cause the following effects:
(i) No. of anions left = 1
(ii) No. of anions added by replacing face centered cations M = 3; No. of cations left = 1
(iii) No. of cations left = 0
(iv) No. of cations added = 1; No. of anions left = 3
Finally, the unit cell contains 1 cation and 3 anions. So,
number of anions
The value of in Z is 3.
number of cations
the standard emf of the cell is 2.70 V at 300 K. When the concentration of Mg2+ is changed to x M, the cell potential
changes to 2.67 V at 300 K. The value of x is .
F
(Given, = 11500 K V−1, where F is the Faraday constant and R is the gas constant, ln (10) = 2.30)
R
Solution
(10) The cell reaction is
Mg(s) + Cu 2+ (aq, 1 M) → Mg 2+ (aq, x M) + Cu(s)
o RT [Mg 2+ ]
Ecell = Ecell − 2.303 × log
2F [Cu 2+ ]
300
2.67 = 2.70 − 2.303 × log( x )
2 × 11500
2.303 × 3
0.03 = log x ⇒ log x = 1 ⇒ x = 10
115 × 2
_
@edubuzznotes I (Chemistry)
11. A closed tank has two compartments A and B, both filled with oxygen (assumed to be ideal gas). The partition
separating the two compartments is fixed and is a perfect heat insulator (Figure 1). If the old partition is replaced by
a new partition which can slide and conduct heat but does NOT allow the gas to leak across (Figure 2), the volume
(in m3) of the compartment A after the system attains equilibrium is .
1 m3, 5 bar,
400 K 3 m3, 1 bar, 300 K
A B
Figure 1
A B
Figure 2
Solution
(2.22) Using pV = nRT, we have
In Figure 1,
pAVA 5 pV 1
nA = = and nB = B B =
RT 400 R RT 100 R
pA = pB and TA = TB = T , so
nA RT nB RT 5 1
= ⇒ =
VA VB 400 R ⋅ VA 100 R ⋅ VB
⇒ 4VA = 5VB
4 20
Now, VA + VB = 4 m 3 , so VA + VA = 4 ⇒ VA = = 2.22 m 3
5 9
12. Liquids A and B form ideal solution over the entire range of composition. At temperature T, equimolar binary
solution of liquids A and B has vapor pressure 45 torr. At the same temperature, a new solution of A and B
having mole fractions xA and xB, respectively, has vapor pressure of 22.5 torr. The value of xA/xB in the new
solution is
(Given that the vapor pressure of pure liquid A is 20 torr at temperature T)
Solution
(19) pAo xA + pBo xB = pT = 45
13. The solubility of a salt of weak acid (AB) at pH 3 is Y × 10−3 mol L−1. The value of Y is .
(Given that the value of solubility product of AB (Ksp) = 2 × 10−10 and the value of ionization constant of HB (Ka)
= 1 × 10−8)
_
@edubuzznotes JEE (Advanced) 2018 Paper I (Chemistry) P-7
Solution
(4.47) The reactions are
AB(s) ⇌ A + (aq ) + B- (aq )
S S-x
B (aq ) + H (aq ) ⇌ HB
- +
S-x 10-3
Now, for HB,
[H + ][ B− ] (s − x ) × 10 −3
Ka = ⇒ = 10 −8
[HB] x
⇒ s − x = x × 10 −5
[ A ][ B ] ( ) 2 10 10 K sp = [ A + ][ B− ] = S (S − x ) = 2 × 10 −10
sp
10
Putting
Putting Sx = 2 × 10 −5 in S 2 − Sx − 2 × 10 −10 = 0, we get 2 10 in 2 10 0, we get
S ≈ (2 × 10 −5 ) = 4.47 × 10 −3 M
Alternate solution
[H + ] 10 −3
S = K sp + 1 = 20 × 10 −10 −8 + 1 ≈ (2 × 10 −5 ) = 4.47 × 10 −3 M
Ka 10
14. The plot given below shows p – T curves (where p is the pressure and T is the temperature) for two solvents X and
Y and isomolal solutions of NaCl in these solvents. NaCl completely dissociates in both the solvents.
1 2 3 4
760
Pressure (mmHg)
1. solvent X
2. solution of NaCl in solvent X
3. solvent Y
4. solution of NaCl in solvent Y
360
367
368
362
Temperature (K)
On addition of equal number of moles of a non−volatile solute S in equal amount (in kg) of these solvents, the eleva-
tion of boiling point of solvent X is three times that of solvent Y. Solute S is known to undergo dimerization in these
solvents. If the degree of dimerization is 0.7 in solvent Y, the degree of dimerization in solvent X is
Solution
(0.05) For solvent X, ∆TbX = K bX m ⇒ 2 = 2 K bX m (1)
For solvent Y, ∆TbY = K bY m ⇒ 1 = 2 K bY m (2)
Dividing Eq. (1) by Eq. (2), we get
K bX
=2
K bY
_
@edubuzznotes I (Chemistry)
After adding solute S, molality is the same for both solutions. So, we have
a
For solvent X, van’t Hoff factor i = 1 −
2
a
∆TbX = iK bX m = 1 − K bX m (3)
2
0.7 1.3
For solvent Y, van’t Hoff factor i = 1 − =
2 2
1.3
∆TbY = iK bY m ⇒ K bY m (4)
2
a
∆TbX 1 − K bX m 1 2( 2 − a )
2
= ⇒ = ⇒ a = 0.05
∆TbY 1.3 3 1.3
K bY m
2
SECTION 3
• This section contains TWO (02) paragraphs. Based on each paragraph, there are TWO (02) questions.
• Each question has FOUR options. ONLY ONE of these four options corresponds to the correct answer.
PARAGRAPH “X”
Treatment of benzene with CO/HCl in the presence of anhydrous AlCl3/CuCl followed by reaction with Ac2O/NaOAc
gives compound X as the major product. Compound X upon reaction with Br2/Na2CO3, followed by heating at 473 K
with moist KOH furnishes Y as the major product. Reaction of X with H2/Pd-C, followed by H3PO4 treatment gives Z
as the major product.
(There are two questions based on PARAGRAPH “X”, the question given below is one of them)
Br COBr
COBr
(A) (B) (C) (D)
Br
HO O
Solution
(C)
CH
CHO COOH OH O
(X) (Y)
_
@edubuzznotes JEE (Advanced) 2018 Paper I (Chemistry) P-9
PARAGRAPH “X”
Treatment of benzene with CO/HCl in the presence of anhydrous AlCl3/CuCl followed by reaction with Ac2O/NaOAc
gives compound X as the major product. Compound X upon reaction with Br2/Na2CO3, followed by heating at 473 K
with moist KOH furnishes Y as the major product. Reaction of X with H2/Pd-C, followed by H3PO4 treatment gives Z
as the major product.
(There are two questions based on PARAGRAPH “X”, the question given below is one of them)
O O O
Solution
(A)
O
O
H2/Pd
CH2 CH2 C OH H3PO4/∆
CH CH C OH
(X)
O
(Z)
PARAGRAPH “A”
An organic acid P (C11H12O2) can easily be oxidized to a dibasic acid which reacts with ethylene glycol to produce a
polymer dacron. Upon ozonolysis, P gives an aliphatic ketone as one of the products. P undergoes the following reaction
sequences to furnish R via Q. The compound P also undergoes another set of reactions to produce S.
1. H2/Pd-C
2. NH3/∆ 1. H2/Pd-C 1. HCl
3. Br2/NaOH 2. SOCl2 2. Mg/Et2O
S P Q R
4. CHCl3, KOH, ∆ 3. MeMgBr, CdCl2 3. CO2 (dry ice)
5. H2/Pd-C 4. NaBH4 4. H3O+
(There are two questions based on PARAGRAPH “A”, the question given below is one of them)
Solution
(A)
O O
H OHCH3 H3C H Cl
COOH COOH C Cl C CH3
(Q)
(P)
Et2O Mg
CH3
CH3
CO2
H3O+
(R)
PARAGRAPH “A”
An organic acid P (C11H12O2) can easily be oxidized to a dibasic acid which reacts with ethylene glycol to produce a
polymer dacron. Upon ozonolysis, P gives an aliphatic ketone as one of the products. P undergoes the following reaction
sequences to furnish R via Q. The compound P also undergoes another set of reactions to produce S.
1. H2/Pd-C
2. NH3/∆ 1. H2/Pd-C 1. HCl
3. Br2/NaOH 2. SOCl2 2. Mg/Et2O
S P Q R
4. CHCl3, KOH, ∆ 3. MeMgBr, CdCl2 3. CO2 (dry ice)
5. H2/Pd-C 4. NaBH4 4. H3O+
(There are two questions based on PARAGRAPH “A”, the question given below is one of them)
H
N
(A) (B) NH2 (D)
(C)
HN
NH2
_
@unacademyplusdiscounts JEE (Advanced) 2018 Paper I (Chemistry) P-11
Solution
(B)
+ −
COOH COOH CONH2 NH2 N C NHCH3
(P) (S)
_
@edubuzznotes
_
@edubuzznotes
SECTION 1
• This section contains SIX (06) questions.
• Each question has FOUR options for correct answer(s). ONE OR MORE THAN ONE of these four option(s) is (are)
correct option(s).
Solution
(A) (B) (D) Option (A): Correct. The complex [Co(en)(NH3)3(H2O)]3+ has two following isomers:
NH3 NH3
NH3 NH3
en Co en Co
NH3
OH2
OH2 NH3
Option (B): Correct. When bidentate ‘en’ is replaced by two cyanide ligands complex [Co(CN)2(NH3)3(H2O)]+ will
have three following isomers:
+ + +
OH2 NH3 CN
NC NH3 NC OH2 H3N OH2
Co Co Co
NC NH3 NC NH3 H3N NH3
NH3 NH3 CN
Option (C): Incorrect. In complex [Co(en)(NH3)3(H2O)]3+, Co is in +3 oxidation, that is, [Ar]d6. In the presence
given ligands the complex will have low spin, hence, diamagnetic.
Option (D): Correct. In complex [Co(en)(NH3)4]3+ there is larger gap between t2g and eg than in complex [Co(en)
(NH3)3(H2O)]3+. Hence [Co(en)(NH3)3(H2O)]3+ will absorb light at longer wavelength as compared to [Co(en)(NH3)4]3+.
2. The correct option(s) to distinguish nitrate salts of Mn2+ and Cu2+ taken separately is (are)
(A) Mn2+ shows the characteristic green color in the flame test.
(B) Only Cu2+ shows the formation of precipitate by passing H2S in acidic medium.
(C) Only Mn2+ shows the formation of precipitate by passing H2S in faintly basic medium.
(D) Cu2+/Cu has higher reduction potential than Mn2+/Mn (measured under similar conditions).
Solution
(B) (D) Option (A): Incorrect. Mn2+ shows purple color in the flame test.
Option (B): Correct. When H2S gas is passed through a solution containing Cu2+ in the acidic medium, black ppt.
is obtained.
_
@edubuzznotes er II (Chemistry)
Cu 2+ HHCl
2S
→ CuS
( Black ppt. )
Option (C): Incorrect. Both Mn2+ and Cu2+can form precipitate by passing H2S in faintly basic medium.
Option (D): Correct. Higher reduction potential indicates higher tendency of Cu2+ to gain the electrons. Cu2+ ion on
accepting the electrons gain stability due to fully filled d-orbital.
Cu 2 + ® Cu Mn 2 + ® Mn
(d 9 s0 ) ( d 10 s1 ) ( d 5 s 0 ) (d 5 s2 )
3. Aniline reacts with mixed acid (conc. HNO3 and conc. H2SO4) at 288 K to give P (51%), Q (47%) and R (2%). The
major product(s) of the following reaction sequence is (are)
1. Ac2O, Pyridine 1. Sn/HCl
2. Br2, CH3COOH 2. Br2/H2O(excess)
R S 3. NaNO2, HCl/273–278 K
Major product(s)
3. H3O+
4. NaNO2, HCl/273–278 K 4. H3PO2
5. EtOH, ∆
Br Br Br Br
Br Br Br Br Br
Br
Br Br Br
Solution
(D)
NH2 NH2 NH2 NH2
NO2
Conc. HNO3
Conc. H2SO4
+ +
NO2
NO2
P Q R
(51%) (47%) (2%)
O O
(R)
Br
3. H3O+
+
N2Cl− NH2
NO2 NO2 NO2
5. EtOH 4. NaNO2
∆ HCl/273–
278 K
Br Br Br
(S)
_
@edubuzznotes JEE (Advanced) 2018 Paper II (Chemistry) P-15
(S)
Br
NO2 NH2 NH2
1. Sn/HCI 2. Br2
H2O(excess)
Br Br
Br Br Br
(S) 3. NaNO2, HCl
Br Br
N+2Cl–
4. H3PO2
Br Br Br
Br
Br Br
(Major product)
HO H
H OH
H OH
CH2OH
D-glucose
H H HO H H H H H HO OH HO H H H HO OH
OH H OH OH H H OH H
Solution
(D) The structure of b-L-glucopyranose is as follows:
OH
O
HO
OH
HO (equatorial)
HO
b − D−(+)− Glucopyranose
5. For a first order reaction A(g) → 2B(g) + C(g) at constant volume and 300 K, the total pressure at the beginning
(t = 0) and at time t are p0 and pt, respectively. Initially, only A is present with concentration [A]0, and t1/3 is the time
required for the partial pressure of A to reach 1/3rd of its initial value. The correct option(s) is (are)
(Assume that all these gases behave as ideal gases)
_
@edubuzznotes er II (Chemistry)
Rate constant
ln(p0 − pt )
t1/3
Time [A]0 Time [A]0
Solution
(A) (D) The reaction can be represented as
A( g ) ® 2 B(g ) + C(g )
At t = 0 p0 0 0
2 p0
At t = t1/ 3 p0 - 0 0
3
At t = t p0 - x 2x x
pt - p 0
Now, pt = p 0 - x + 2 x + x Þ x =
2
1 æ p0 ö
Substituting in the expression t = ln , we get
k çè p 0 - x ÷ø
æ ö
1 ç p0 ÷ 1 æ 2 p0 ö
t = ln ç = ln
k ç pt - p 0 ÷ k çè 3 p 0 - pt ÷ø
p - ÷
è 0 2 ø
which can be rearranged as
ln(3 p 0 - pt ) = - kt + ln 2 p 0
Thus, the graph of ln(3 p 0 - pt ) vs t is a straight line having negative slope –k and intercept ln 2 p 0 as shown in (A).
Also, as rate is independent of initial concentration, so the plot in option (D) is also correct.
6. For a reaction, A P, the plots of [A] and [P] with time at temperatures T1 and T2 are given below.
10 10
[A] / (mol L−1)
T1
[P] / (mol L−1)
T2
5 5
T2
T1
Time Time
Solution
(A) (C) As we increase the temperature, the concentration of the product reduces. This implies that the reaction is
exothermic, and ∆Hq < 0.
ln KT1
> 1 ⇒ ln KT1 > ln KT2 ⇒ KT1 > KT2
ln KT2
ln KT1 T2
But >
ln KT2 T1
SECTION 2
This section contains EIGHT (08) questions. The answer to each question is a NUMERICAL VALUE.
7. The total number of compounds having at least one bridging oxo group among the molecules given below is _____.
N2O3, N2O5, P4O6, P4O7, H4P2O5, H5P3O10, H2S2O3, H2S2O5
Solution
(5)
P P
O O O O
O O
O O O
O O O
N N N O N P P P P
O P O P O
O O O O O
O O
O O O S
O O
P P
HO O OH P P P HO S OH
O O OH HO S S OH
H H HO
OH OH OH O O
H4P2O5 H5P3O10 H2S2O3 H2S2O5
8. Galena (an ore) is partially oxidized by passing air through it at high temperature. After some time, the passage of
air is stopped, but the heating is continued in a closed furnace such that the contents undergo self-reduction. The
weight (in kg) of Pb produced per kg of O2 consumed is _______.
(Atomic weights in g mol–1: O = 16, S = 32, Pb = 207)
_
@edubuzznotes er II (Chemistry)
Solution
(6.47) The steps involved in the oxidation of galena (PbS) are as follows:
2 PbS+ 3O2 → 2 PbO + 2 SO2
2 PbO + PbS → 3 Pb + SO2
9. To measure the quantity of MnCl2 dissolved in an aqueous solution, it was completely converted to KMnO4 using
the reaction,
MnCl2 + K2S2O8 + H2O → KMnO4 + H2SO4 + HCl (equation not balanced).
Few drops of concentrated HCl were added to this solution and gently warmed. Further, oxalic acid (225 mg) was
added in portions till the color of the permanganate ion disappeared. The quantity of MnCl2 (in mg) present in the
initial solution is _______.
(Atomic weights in g mol–1: Mn = 55, Cl = 35.5)
Solution
(126) The balanced equation can be written as
10. For the given compound X, the total number of optically active stereoisomers is _______.
HO
HO
HO
X HO
This type of bond indicates that the configuration at the specific carbon and the geometry of the double bond
is fixed.
This type of bond indicates that the configuration at the specific carbon and the geometry of the double bond
is not fixed.
_
@edubuzznotes JEE (Advanced) 2018 Paper II (Chemistry) P-19
Solution
(7) There are total 7 optically active stereoisomers. Their structures are as follows:
OH
OH
OH
OH
OH OH
HO OH
OH
OH OH
OH
OH OH
HO OH
OH OH
OH OH
OH OH OH
HO
OH OH
OH OH
(optically active)
(optically active)
OH
OH OH
HO
11. In the following reaction sequence, the amount of D (in g) formed from 10 mol of acetophenone is _______.
(Atomic weights in g mol–1: H = 1, C = 12, N = 14, O = 16, Br = 80. The yield (%) corresponding to the product in
each step is given in the parenthesis)
O
Solution
(495) O COOH CONH2 NH2 NH2
Br Br
NaOBr NH3 Br2 /KOH Br2 (3 equiv)
H3O+ ∆ AcOH
Acetophenone A B C
(10 mol) (60%) (50%) (50%) Br
D
(100%)
_
@edubuzznotes er II (Chemistry)
60 50 50
The amount of D formed in mol is × × × 10 = 1.5 mol
100 100 100
Amount of D in grams is = 1.5 × 330 g = 495 g
12. The surface of copper gets tarnished by the formation of copper oxide. N2 gas was passed to prevent the oxide for-
mation during heating of copper at 1250 K. However, the N2 gas contains 1 mole % of water vapor as impurity. The
water vapor oxidizes copper as per the reaction given below:
pH2 is the minimum partial pressure of H2 (in bar) needed to prevent the oxidation at 1250 K. The value of ln(pH2)
is _______.
(Given: total pressure = 1 bar, R (universal gas constant) = 8 J K–1 mol–1, ln(10) = 2.3. Cu(s) and Cu2O(s) are mutu-
ally immiscible.
1
At 1250 K: 2Cu(s) + O2(g) → Cu2O(s); ∆G° = –78,000 J mol–1
2
1
H2(g) + O2(g) → H2O(g); ∆G° = – 1,78,000 J mol–1; G is the Gibbs energy)
2
Solution
(–14.6)
1
2Cu(s) + O 2 (g ) ® Cu 2 O(s); DG o = -78, 000 J mol -1 (1)
2
1
H 2 (g ) + O 2 (g ) ® H 2 O(g ); DG o = -1, 78, 000 J mol -1
2 (2)
The activation energy of the backward reaction exceeds that of the forward reaction by 2RT (in J mol–1). If the pre-
exponential factor of the forward reaction is 4 times that of the reverse reaction, the absolute value of ∆Gq (in J
mol–1) for the reaction at 300 K is _______.
(Given; ln(2) = 0.7, RT = 2500 J mol–1 at 300 K and G is the Gibbs energy)
Solution
(–8466 J mol–1) DG q = - RT ln K
− E / RT
Kf A e af
where K= = f − Ea / RT
K b Ab e b
Kf ( E − E )/ RT
K= = 4e a b af = 4e 2
Kb
14. Consider an electrochemical cell: A(s) | An+ (aq, 2 M) || B2n+ (aq, 1 M) | B(s). The value of ∆Hq for the cell reaction
is twice that of ∆Gq at 300 K. If the emf of the cell is zero, the ∆Sq (in J K–1 mol–1) of the cell reaction per mole of B
formed at 300 K is _______.
(Given: ln(2) = 0.7, R (universal gas constant) = 8.3 J K–1 mol–1. H, S and G are enthalpy, entropy and Gibbs energy,
respectively)
Solution
(–11.62 JK–1mol–1) The half-cell reactions are
A(s) → A n + (aq ) + ne − (1)
B2 n + (aq ) + 2 ne − → B(s) (2)
Adding Eq. (1) and Eq. (2), we get
2A(s) + B2 n + (aq ) → 2 A n + (aq ) + B(s)
DG q - RT ln K
DG q = DH q - T DS q Þ DS q = =
T T
[ A n + ]2
Þ DS q = - R ln = -8.3 ´ ln 4 = -11.5 J K -1 mol -1
[ B2 n + ]
_
@edubuzznotes er II (Chemistry)
SECTION 3
• This section contains FOUR (04) questions.
• Each question has TWO (02) matching lists: LIST-I and LIST-II.
• FOUR options are given representing matching of elements from LIST-I and LIST-II. ONLY ONE of these four
options corresponds to a correct matching.
15. Match each set of hybrid orbitals from LIST-I with complex(es) given in LIST-II.
LIST-I LIST-II
P. dsp 2
1. [FeF6]4–
Q. sp3 2. [Ti(H2O)3Cl3]
3 2
R. sp d 3. [Cr(NH3)6]3+
S. d2sp3 4. [FeCl4]2–
5. [Ni(CO)]4
6. [Ni(CN)4]2–
Solution
(C) [FeF6]4– : The arrangement of electrons in Fe2+ (3d6) will be
3d 4s 4p
Fe2+
[FeF6]4− ×× ×× ×× ×× ×× ××
sp 3d 2
hybridization
3d 4s 4p
3+
Ti
[Ti(H2O)3Cl3] ×× ×× ×× ×× ×× ××
d 2sp 3
hybridization
3d 4s 4p
3+
Cr
[Cr(NH3)6]3+ ×× ×× ×× ×× ×× ××
d 2sp 3
hybridization
_
@edubuzznotes JEE (Advanced) 2018 Paper II (Chemistry) P-23
[FeCl4]2− ×× ×× ×× ××
sp3
hybridization
[Ni(CO)4] ×× ×× ×× ××
sp3 hybridization
[Ni(CN)4]2− ×× ×× ×× ××
dsp2 hybridization
16. The desired product X can be prepared by reacting the major product of the reactions in LIST-I with one or more
appropriate reagents in LIST-II.
(Given, order of migratory aptitude: aryl > alkyl > hydrogen)
O
Ph
OH
Me Ph
LIST-I LIST-II
Ph
HO
P. Ph Me + H2SO4 1. I2, NaOH
OH
Me
Ph
H2N
Q. Ph H + HNO2 2. [Ag(NH3)2]OH
OH
Me
HO Ph
Ph
R. Me OH + H2SO4 3. Fehling solution
Me
Ph
Br
S. Ph H 4. HCHO, NaOH
OH + AgNO3
Me
5. NaOBr
_
@edubuzznotes er II (Chemistry)
Solution
(D) The reactions are as follows:
Ph Ph
HO Me O
Me
Ph + H2SO4 Ph
OH
Me Me
NaOBr I2/NaOH
Ph Ph
Me O Me O
Ph Ph
OH OH
Ph Ph
H2N Me O
H
Ph + HNO2 Ph
OH
Me H
Fehling [Ag(NH3)2]OH
Ph
Me O solution
Ph
Ph Me O
OH
Ph
OH
Ph Ph
HO Ph O
Ph
Me + H2SO4 Me
OH
Me Me
NaOBr I2/NaOH
Ph Ph
Me O Me O
Ph Ph
OH OH
Ph Ph
Br
H
Ph
OH + AgNO3 Ph CHO
Me
Me
Fehling [Ag(NH3)2]OH
solution
Ph Ph
Me O Me O
Ph Ph
OH OH
_
@edubuzznotes JEE (Advanced) 2018 Paper II (Chemistry) P-25
LIST-I LIST-II
P. ONa + Br 1. OH
Q. OMe + HBr 2. Br
R. Br + NaOMe 3. OMe
S. ONa + MeBr 4.
O
5.
Match each reaction in LIST-I with one or more products in LIST-II and choose the correct option.
(A) P → 1, 5; Q → 2; R → 3; S → 4 (B) P → 1, 4; Q → 2; R → 4; S → 3
(C) P → 1, 4; Q → 1, 2; R → 3, 4; S → 4 (D) P → 4, 5; Q → 4; R → 4; S → 3, 4
Solution
(B) With tertiary halides, steric hindrance in the substrate is severe, thus, elimination is highly favored, especially
when the reaction is carried out at higher temperatures.
OH
ONa + Br +
(Major) (Minor)
Br + NaOMe
18. Dilution processes of different aqueous solutions, with water, are given in LIST-I. The effects of dilution of the
solutions on [H+] are given in
(Note: Degree of dissociation (a) of weak acid and weak base is << 1; degree of hydrolysis of salt << 1; [H+] rep-
resents the concentration of H+ ions)
_
@edubuzznotes er II (Chemistry)
LIST-I LIST-II
P. (10 mL of 0.1 M NaOH + 20 mL of 0.1 M acetic acid) 1. the value of [H+] does not change on dilution
diluted to 60 mL
Q. (20 mL of 0.1 M NaOH + 20 mL of 0.1 M acetic acid) 2. the value of [H+] changes to half of its initial value
diluted to 80 mL on dilution
R. (20 mL of 0.1 M HCl + 20 mL of 0.1 M ammonia solution) 3. the value of [H+] changes to two times of its initial
diluted to 80 mL value on dilution
1
S. 10 mL saturated solution of Ni(OH)2 in equilibrium with 4. the value of [H+] changes to times of its initial
excess solid Ni(OH)2 is diluted to 20 mL (solid Ni(OH)2 is 2
value on dilution
still present after dilution). 5. the value of [H+] changes to 2 times of its initial
value on dilution
Match each process given in LIST-I with one or more effect(s) in LIST-II. The correct option is
(A) P → 4; Q → 2; R → 3; S → 1 (B) P → 4; Q → 3; R → 2; S → 3
(C) P → 1; Q → 4; R → 5; S → 3 (D) P → 1; Q → 5; R → 4; S → 1
Solution
(D) NaOH + CH 3 COOH ® CH 3 COONa + H 2 O
10 ´ 0.1 = 1 mmol 20 ´ 0.1 = 2 mmol
20 ´ 0.1 - 10 ´ 0.1 1
O - ùû =
éëCH 3 COO =
30 30
Since it is a buffer solution, with 1 mmol of CH3COOH and 1 mmol of CH3COONa in solution. So, (P) → (1).
NaOH + CH 3 COOH → CH 3 COONa + H 2 O
20 × 0.1 = 2 mmol 20 × 0.1 = 2 mmol
Since the solution contains 2 mmol of CH3COONa in 40 ml solution. So, for a salt of weak acid and strong base, we have
Kw Ka
[H + ]initial =
C
K w Ka
On dilution to 80 ml, C becomes C/2, so [H + ]new = = [H + ]initial × 2 . So, (Q) → (5)
C /2
HCl + NH 3 → NH 4 Cl
20 × 0.1 = 2 mmol 20 × 0.1 = 2 mmol
Since the solution contains 2 mmol of CH3COONa in 40 mL solution. So, for a salt of strong acid and weak base, we have
K wC
[H + ]initial =
Kb
K wC
On dilution to 80 mL, C becomes C/2, so [H + ]new = = [H + ]initial / 2 . So, (R) → (4)
2Kb
As it is a sparingly soluble salt, there is no change in [OH–] on dilution. So, (S) → (1)
_
@edubuzznotes
CHEMISTRY
4+ R 4− R
1. Two complexes [Cr(H2O)6]Cl3 (A) and [Cr(NH3)6]Cl3 (3) (4)
(B) are violet and yellow coloured, respectively. The 2R 2R
incorrect statement regarding them is:
6. The one that is extensively used as a piezoelectric
(1) Δo values of (A) and (B) are calculated from the material is:
energies of violet and yellow light, respectively.
(1) tridymite (2) amorphous silica
(2) both are paramagnetic with three unpaired electrons.
(3) quartz (4) mica
(3) both absorb energies corresponding to their
complementary colors. 7. Correct statements among a to d regarding silicones
(4) Δo values for (A) is less than that of (B). are:
(a) They are polymers with hydrophobic character.
2. The correct decreasing order for acid strength is:
(b) They are biocompatible.
(1) NO2CH2COOH > FCH2COOH > CNCH2COOH >
(c) In general, they have high thermal stability and low
ClCH2COOH
dielectric strength.
(2) FCH2COOH > NCCH2COOH > NO2CH2COOH >
(d) Usually, they are resistant to oxidation and used as
ClCH2COOH
greases.
(3) CNCH2COOH > O2NCH2COOH > FCH2COOH >
(1) (a), (b), (c) and (d)
ClCH2COOH
(2) (a), (b) and (c) only
(4) NO2CH2COOH > NCCH2COOH > FCH2COOH >
ClCH2COOH (3) (a) and (b) only
(4) (a), (b) and (d) only
3. The major product of following reaction is:
8. The major product of the following reaction is:
(i) AlH(i – Bu)
R – C ≡ N
(ii) H O
2
→?
2
(i) Br2
(1) RCOOH (2) RCONH2 (ii) EtOH
(4) OEt (3) The partial pressure of the gas in vapour phase is
OEt proportional to the mole fraction of the gas in the
solution.
(4) The value of KH increases with increase of
temperature and KH is function of the nature of the gas
9. In general, the properties that decrease and increase
down a group in the periodic table, respectively, 15. The following results were obtained during kinetic
are: studies of the reaction;
(1) atomic radius and electronegativity.
2A + B → Products
(2) electron gain enthalpy and electronegativity.
(3) electronegativity and atomic radius. Experiment [A] [B] Initial
(4) electronegativity and electron gain enthalpy. (in mol L−1) (in mol L−1) Rate of
Reaction
10. A solution of sodium sulfate contains 92 g of Na+ ions (in mol L−1
per kilogram of water. The molality of Na+ ions in that min−1)
solution in mol kg−1 is: I 0.10 0.20 6.93 × 10−3
(1) 12 (2) 4 II 0.10 0.25 6.93 × 10−3
(3) 8 (4) 16 III 0.20 0.30 1.386 ×
10−2
11. The correct match between Item-I and Item-II is:
Item-I (drug) Item-II (test) The time (in minutes) required to consume half of A is:
(A)Chloroxylenol (P) Carbylamine test (1) 5 (2) 10
(B) Norethindron (Q) Sodium hydrogen-carbonate (3) 1 (4) 100
test
(C) Sulphapyridine (R) Ferric chloride test 16. Major product of the following reaction is:
(D) Penicillin (S) Baeyer’s test Cl
Cl
(1) A → R; B → P; C → S; D → Q + H N
NH2 (i) Et3N
2 (ii) Free radical
(2) A → Q; B → S; C → P; D → R O O polymerisation
(3) A → R; B → S; C → P; D → Q Cl O
(4) A → Q; B → P; C → S; D → R
(1)
n O
12. A water sample has ppm level concentration of the
HN
following metals: Fe = 0.2; Mn = 5.0, Cu = 3.0; NH2
Zn = 5.0. The metal that makes the water sample
unsuitable for drinking is: O Cl
(1) Cu (2) Mn
(2) n
(3) Fe (4) Zn
HN
NH2
13. The anodic half-cell of lead-acid battery is recharged
O
using electricity of 0.05 Faraday. The amount of PbSO4
electrolyzed in g during the process is : (Molar mass of Cl
PbSO4 = 303 g mol−1)
n O
(1) 22.8 (2) 15.2 (3)
NH2
(3) 7.6 (4) 11.4 N
O
H
17. The alkaline earth metal nitrate that does not crystallise 24. According to molecular orbital theory, which of the
with water molecules, is: following is true with respect to Li2+ and Li2−?
(1) Mg(NO3)2 (2) Sr(NO3)2 (1) Li2+ is unstable and Li2− is stable
(3) Ca(NO3)2 (4) Ba(NO3)2 (2) Li2+ is stable and Li2− is unstable
(3) Both are stable
18. 20 mL of 0.1 M H2SO4 solution is added to 30 mL
of 0.2 M NH4OH solution. The pH of the resultant (4) Both are unstable
mixture is : [pKb of NH4OH = 4.7].
25. The major product of the following reaction is:
(1) 5.2 (2) 9.0
(3) 5.0 (4) 9.4
(1)
2 unit Br
Log x 4 unit
O
m
(2)
Log P Br
2 1/4
(1) p (2) p O
1/2
(3) p (4) p (3)
21. The ore that contains both iron and copper is: (4)
28. Consider the reversible isothermal expansion of 29. Arrange the following amines in the decreasing order
an ideal gas in a closed system at two different of basicity:
temperatures T1 and T2 (T1 < T2). The correct graphical
depiction of the dependence of work done (w) on the
final volume (V) is:
N N N
w T2 H H
I II III
T1
(1) (1) I > II > III
(2) III > I > II
0 In V
(3) III > II > I
(4) I > III > II
w T2
30. The compounds A and B in the following reaction are,
T1 respectively:
(2)
HCHO + HCl AgCN
A B
0 In V
0 In V
w T2
(4) T1
0 In V
_
@edubuzznotes
CHEMISTRY
2C57H110O6(s) + 163 O2(g) → 114 CO2(g) + 110 H2O(l) 5. The major product of the following reaction is:
O OH
(1) 490 g (2) 445 g CH3
(3) 495 g (4) 890 g O +
AlCl3, ∆
OH O
O
(1) H3C H
OH OH
(CH3CO)2O/pyridine (1 eqv.)
COCH3
12. The pH of rain water, is approximately:
OH (1) 5.6 (2) 7.5
(1) (2)
NHCOCH3 (3) 7.0 (4) 6.5
NH2
13. Consider the following reversible chemical reactions:
OCOCH3 OH
A 2 (g) + B2 (g)
1
K
2AB(g) ...(1)
(3) (4)
6AB(g)
K2
3A 2 (g) + 3B2 (g) ...(2)
NH2 NHCOCH3 The relation between K1 and K2 is:
1
(1) K1 K 2 = (2) K2 = K13
7. The major product of the following reaction is: 3
O (3) K2 = K1−3 (4) K1K2 = 3
C
(i) Br2/hn
14. The correct sequence of amino acids present in the
NH2
tripeptide given below is:
(ii) KOH (dil)
CH2CH3 Me Me Me OH
H O
N OH
O H2N N C
NH
O H
(1) (2) NH OH
O
(1) K (2) Li
(3) Rb (4) Cs O CH3
OH
21. Which of the following combination of statements is
OH true regarding the interpretation of the atomic orbitals?
(4)
and (a) An electron in an orbital of high angular momentum
H3C CH3
stays away from the nucleus than an electron in the
orbital of lower angular momentum.
17. The tests performed on compound X and their (b) For a given value of the principal quantum number,
inferences are: the size of the orbit is inversely proportional to the
Test Inference azimuthal quantum number.
(a) 2, 4-DNP test Coloured precipitate (c) According to wave mechanics, the ground state
h
(b) Iodoform test Yellow precipitate angular momentum is equal to .
2π
(c) Azo-dye test No dye formation (d) The plot of ψ Vs r for various azimuthal quantum
Compound ‘X’ is: numbers, shows peak shifting towards higher r
value.
NH2
(1) (a), (d) (2) (a), (b)
(1) CHO (3) (a), (c) (4) (b), (c)
(3) (4)
NH2 OH
N
(3) CH3
23. Good reducing nature of H3PO2 is attributed to the
presence of:
H3C
N
CH3 (1) Two P – OH bonds (2) One P – H bond
(4) (3) Two P – H bonds (4) One P – OH bond
CHO
24. The correct statement regarding the given Ellingham
diagram is:
O
18. If the standard electrode potential for a cell is 2 V at 2Cu 2
300 K, the equilibrium constant (K) for the reaction 4Cu
+ O2
(3) Coke cannot be used for the extraction of Cu from (1) a more negative value than the first
Cu2O. (2) almost the same as that of the first
(4) At 800°C, Cu can be used for the extraction of Zn (3) negative, but less negative than the first
from ZnO.
(4) a positive value
25. The transition element that has lowest enthalpy of
28. At 100°C, copper (Cu) has FCC unit cell structure
atomization, is:
with cell edge length of x Å. What is the approximate
(1) Fe (2) Cu density of Cu (in g cm−3) at this temperature?
(3) V (4) Zn
[Atomic Mass of Cu = 63.55 u]
26. The increasing basicity order of the following 205 105
compounds is: (1) (2)
x3 x3
211 422
(A) CH3CH2NH2 (3) (4)
x3 x3
(B) CH2CH3
29. A solution containing 62 g ethylene glycol in
CH3CH2NH 250 g water is cooled to −10°C. If Kf for water is
1.86 K kg mol−1, the amount of water (in g) separated
(C) CH3
as ice is:
H3C — N — CH3
(1) 48 (2) 32
(D) CH3 (3) 64 (4) 16
Ph — N — H
30. Homoleptic octahedral complexes of a metal ion
(1) (D) < (C) < (B) < (A) ‘M3+’ with three monodentate ligands L1, L2 and L3
(2) (D) < (C) < (A) < (B) absorb wavelengths in the region of green, blue and
red respectively. The increasing order of the ligand
(3) (A) < (B) < (C) < (D)
strength is:
(4) (A) < (B) < (D) < (C)
(1) L3 < L1 < L2 (2) L3 < L2 < L1
27. When the first electron gain enthalpy (ΔegH) of oxygen (3) L1 < L2 < L3 (4) L2 < L1 < L3
is −141 kJmol–1, its second electron gain enthalpy is:
_
@edubuzznotes
CHEMISTRY
1. The total number of isomers for a square planar 6. Which primitive unit cell has unequal edge lengths
complex [M(F)(Cl)(SCN)(NO2)] is: (a ≠ b ≠ c) and all axial angles different from 90°?
(1) 16 (2) 8 (1) Triclinic (2) Hexagonal
(3) 4 (4) 12 (3) Monoclinic (4) Tetragonal
2. A process has ΔH = 200 J mol−1 and 7. The major product of the following reaction is:
ΔS = 40 JK−1 mol−1. Out of the values given below,
Br
choose the minimum temperature above which the
KOH alc. (excess)
process will be spontaneous:
D
(1) 20 K (2) 12 K Ph
(3) 5 K (4) 4 K Br
(1) (2)
3. The values of Kp/KC for the following reactions at
300 K are, respectively : (At 300 K, RT = 24.62 dm3 Ph
atm mol−1) Ph
COOC2H5
(3) OH
(4) Cl COOC2H5
OH
II
(1) [(Ph3P)3IrCl]
III
(2) [(Et3P)3RhCl]
(3) [(Ph3P)3RhCl] (Et = C2H5) CH3O COOC2H5
(4) [(Et3P)3IrCl]
IV
11. If dichloromethane (DCM) and water (H2O) are used (1) III > II > IV > I (2) III > II > I > IV
for differential extraction, which one of the following
(3) IV > II > III > I (4) II > III > I > IV
statements is correct?
(1) DCM and H2O would stay as lower and upper layer 14. Which of the graphs shown below does not represent
respectively in the S.F. the relationship between incident light and the electron
(2) DCM and H2O will make turbid/colloidal mixture ejected from metal surface?
(3) DCM and H2O would stay as upper and lower layer (1)
respectively in the separating funnel (S.F.) K.E. of
(4) DCM and H2O will be miscible clearly e–s
(2) C
CH2 OH 0
Frequency of
CH2 OH light
C
O
_
@edubuzznotes JEE Main 2019 (January 10, Shift 1) P–11
(3) (1)
K.E. of
CH3O
e–s
(2) OCH3
0
Frequency CH3
of light
(4)
K.E. of (3)
CH3O
e–s
CH3
0
Intensity (4) CH3O
of light
(4) OCOCH3
18. The major product of the following reaction is: O O
H
N
CH3O H3C N OH
CH2Cl
(i) AlCl3 (anhyd.) H O
(ii) H2O
NHCOCH3
O
_
@edubuzznotesJEE Main 2019 (January 10, Shift 1)
20. The type of hybridisation and number of lone pair(s) 26. The major product ‘X’ formed in the following reaction
of electrons of Xe in XeOF4, respectively, are: is:
(1) sp3d2 and 1 (2) sp3d and 2 O
O
(3) sp3d2 and 2 (4) sp3d and 1
CH2 — C — OCH3 NaBH4
X
21. The electronegativity of aluminium is similar to: MeOH
CH2 — C — H
22. Consider the following reduction processes:
Zn2+ + 2e− → Zn(s); E° = −0.76 V
Ca2+ + 2e− → Ca(s); E° = −2.87 V (2) OH
Mg2+ + 2e− → Mg(s); E° = −2.36 V CH2CH2OH
Ni2+ + 2e− → Ni(s); E° = −0.25 V
The reducing power of the metals increases in the
order: (3) OH
(1) Ca < Zn < Mg < Ni CH2CH2OH
(2) Ni < Zn < Mg < Ca
(3) Zn < Mg < Ni < Ca
(4) Ca < Mg < Zn < Ni (4) OH O
CH2 — C — OCH3
23. The chemical nature of hydrogen peroxide is:
(1) Oxidising agent in acidic medium, but not in basic
medium.
(2) Reducing agent in basic medium, but not in acidic 27. The metal used for making X-ray tube window is:
medium. (1) Mg (2) Na
(3) Oxidising and reducing agent in acidic medium, but (3) Be (4) Ca
not in basic medium.
(4) Oxidising and reducing agent in both acidic and 28. The increasing order of the pKa values of the following
compounds is:
basic medium.
OH OH OH OH
24. A mixture of 100 m mol of Ca(OH)2 and 2 g of sodium
sulphate was dissolved in water and the volume was
made up to 100 mL. The mass of calcium sulphate
formed and the concentration of OH− in resulting NO2
solution, respectively, are: (Molar mass of Ca(OH)2, NO2 OMe
Na2SO4 and CaSO4 are 74, 143 and 136 g mol−1, A B C D
respectively; Ksp of Ca(OH)2 is 5.5 × 10−6) (1) C < B < A < D (2) B < C < D < A
(1) 1.9 g, 0.28 mol L−1 (2) 13.6 g, 0.28 mol L−1 (3) D < A < C < B (4) B < C < A < D
(3) 1.9 g, 0.14 mol L−1 (4) 13.6 g, 0.14 mol L−1
29. Hall-Heroult’s process is given by:
25. Liquids A and B form an ideal solution in the entire (1) Cu2+ (aq) + H2(g) →Cu(s) + 2H+ (aq)
composition range. At 350 K, the vapor pressures of
pure A and B are 7 × 103 Pa and 12 × 103 Pa, respectively. (2) Cr2O3 + 2 Al → Al2O3 + 2 Cr
The composition of the vapor in equilibrium with (3) 2 Al2O3 + 3 C → 4 Al + 3 CO2
a solution containing 40 mol percent of A at this Coke, 1673 K
(4) ZnO + C → Zn + CO
temperature is:
(1) xA = 0.37; xB = 0.63 30. Two π and half σ bonds are present in:
(2) xA = 0.28; xB = 0.72 (1) O 2+ (2) N2
(3) xA = 0.4; xB = 0.6 (3) O2 (4) N +2
(4) xA = 0.76; xB = 0.24
_
@edubuzznotes
CHEMISTRY
10. The correct match between item ‘I’ and item ‘II’ is 14. Elevation in the boiling point for 1 molal solution of
Item ‘I’ Item ‘II’ glucose is 2 K. The depression in the freezing point for
2 molal solution of glucose in the same solvent is 2 K.
(compound) (reagent)
The relation between Kb and Kf is:
(A) Lysine (P) 1-naphthol
(1) Kb = 1.5 Kf (2) Kb = Kf
(B) Furfural (Q) ninhydrin
(3) Kb = 0.5 Kf (4) Kb = 2 Kf
(C) Benzyl alcohol (R) KMnO4
(D) Styrene (S) Ceric ammonium nitrate 15. The major product of the following reaction is:
O
(1) (A) → (Q); (B) → (P); (C) → (S); (D) → (R) NaBH4
CH3N
(2) (A) → (Q); (B) → (P); (C) → (R); (D) → (S)
(3) (A) → (R); (B) → (P); (C) → (Q); (D) → (S) (1) OH
(4) (A) → (Q); (B) → (R); (C) → (S); (D) → (P) CH3N
d[A]
the expression for is:
dt
OH
(1) k1[A2] − k−1[A]2 (2) 2k1[A2] − k−1[A]2
12. The process with negative entropy change is: (3) k1[A2] + k−1[A]2 (4) 2k1[A2] − 2k−1[A]2
(1) Dissociation of CaSO4(s) to CaO(s) and SO3(g)
(2) Sublimation of dry ice 18. Which of the following tests cannot be used for
identifying amino acids?
(3) Dissolution of iodine in water
(1) Biuret test (2) Barfoed test
(4) Synthesis of ammonia from N2 and H2
(3) Ninhydrin test (4) Xanthoproteic test
_
@edubuzznotes JEE Main 2019 (January 10, Shift 2) P–15
19. The difference in the number of unpaired electrons of 24. The number of 2-centre-2-electron and 3-centre-2-
a metal ion in its high-spin and low-spin octahedral electron bonds in B2H6, respectively, are:
complexes is two. The metal ion is: (1) 2 and 1 (2) 4 and 2
(1) Ni2+ (2) Fe2+ (3) 2 and 2 (4) 2 and 4
(3) Co2+ (4) Mn2+
25. In the reaction of oxalate with permanganate in
20. The major product obtained in the following reaction acidic medium, the number of electrons involved in
is: producing one molecule of CO2 is:
CO2Et
NaOEt/∆ (1) 1 (2) 10
O (3) 2 (4) 5
O
26. A reaction of cobalt(III) chloride and ethylenediamine
(1) O
in a 1 : 2 mole ratio generates two isomeric products A
(violet coloured) and B (green coloured). A can show
optical activity, but, B is optically inactive. What type
CO2Et
of isomers does A and B represent?
(1) Geometrical isomers (2) Coordination isomers
(2) O
(3) Linkage isomers (4) Ionisation isomers
CO2Et 27. The electrolytes usually used in the electroplating of
gold and silver, respectively, are:
(3) O
(1) [Au(CN)2]− and [Ag(CN)2]−
(2) [Au(CN)2]− and [AgCl2]−
(3) [Au(OH)4]− and [Ag(OH)2]−
CO2Et
(4) [Au(NH3)2]+ and [Ag(CN)2]−
(4) O
28. A compound of formula A2B3 has the hcp lattice.
CO2Et Which atom forms the hcp lattice and what fraction of
tetrahedral voids is occupied by the other atoms:
2
21. The pair that contains two P – H bonds in each of the (1) hcp lattice – A, tetrahedral voids – B
oxoacids is: 3
(1) H4P2O5 and H4P2O6 (2) H3PO2 and H4P2O5 1
(2) hcp lattice – A, tetrahedral voids – B
(3) H3PO3 and H3PO2 (4) H4P2O5 and H3PO3 3
2
22. Which is the most suitable reagent for the following (3) hcp lattice – B, tetrahedral voids – A
3
transformation?
OH 1
(4) hcp lattice – B, tetrahedral voids – A
CH3 CH CH CH2 CH CH3 3
CH3 CH CH CH2CO2H
29. The major product of the following reaction is:
(1) Tollens’ reagent (2) I2/NaOH CH3
(3) CrO2Cl2/CS2 (4) alkaline KMnO4 OH
(i) aq. NaOH
CH3 CH3
(1) CH3
H
OH
H
Br
CH3
CH3
(1) 3-Bromo-1, 2-dimethylbut-1-ene
(2) 3-Bromo-3-methyl-1, 2-dimethylprop-1-ene
(3) 2-Bromo-3-methylpent-3-ene
(4) 4-Bromo-3-methylpent-2-ene
_
@edubuzznotes
JEE Main 2019 (January 10, Shift 2)
N
H
NO2
(3) CH3
OH (2) NO2
O
N
CH3 H
(4) CH3
(3)
OH O
O2N N
H
CH3
(4) O2N
30. What will be the major product in the following O
mononitration reaction? N
H
N HNO3
H
Conc. H2SO4
_
@edubuzznotes
CHEMISTRY
1. The major product of the following reaction is CO2, 4 moles of H2O and 1 mole of nitrogen gas. The
COCH3 formula of the compound is:
(i) KMnO4/KOH, ∆
(ii) H2SO4 (dil)
(1) C12H8N2 (2) C12HgN
CH3 (3) C6H8N2 (4) C6H8N
O
OHC
(1) Cl (2)
(4) COOH
OH
HOOC O
as a fuel are:
(a) It produces less pollutants than petrol.
(b) A cylinder of compressed dihydrogen weighs ~30 O O
times more than a petrol tank producing the same
amount of energy. 6. Heat treatment of muscular pain involves radiation of
(c) Dihydrogen is stored in tanks of metal alloys like wavelength of about 900 nm. Which spectral line of
H-atom is suitable for this purpose ?
NaNi5.
[RH = 1 × 105 cm−1, h = 6.6 × 10−34 Js, c = 3 × 108 ms−1]
(d) On combustion, values of energy released per gram
of liquid dihydrogen and LPG are 50 and 142 kJ, (1) Balmer, ∞ → 2 (2) Paschen, 5 → 3
respectively. (3) Lyman, ∞ → 1 (4) Paschen, ∞ → 3
(1) (a) and (c) only (2) (b) and (d) only
7. The polymer obtained from the following reactions is:
(3) (b), (c) and (d) only (4) (a), (b) and (c) only +
(i) NaNO2/H3O
NH2
HOOC (ii) Polymerisation
3. An organic compound is estimated through Dumus
method and was found to evolve 6 moles of
_
@edubuzznotes 1, Shift 1)
(1) O (3) H
O (CH2)4 C O
n
CHO
(2) O
H
C (CH2)4 N (4) NH
n
(3) O O
H
HNC (CH2)4 C N
n 12. Among the following compounds, which one is found
in RNA?
(4) O
(1) O (2) O
OC (CH2)4O
n
N Me NH
N O N O
9. Consider the reaction
N 2 (g) + 3H 2 (g) 2NH 3 (g) H H
The equilibrium constant of the above reaction is Kp. If
pure ammonia is left to dissociate, the partial pressure 13. Peroxyacetyl nitrate (PAN), an eye irritant is produced
of ammonia at equilibrium is given by (Assume that by:
pNH3 << ptotal at equilibrium) (1) photochemical smog
CN (ii) DIBAL – H
SO3H SO3H
(1)
OH
(3) OH (4) OH
NH2 Br Br
(2) N Br Br
Br Br
(1) y unit (2) y/R unit (1) (A) → (R); (B) → (P); (C) → (S)
(3) –y unit (4) yR unit (2) (A) → (Q); (B) → (R); (C) → (S)
(3) (A) → (S); (B) → (R); (C) → (P)
16. The correct match between item (I) and item (II) is:
(4) (A) → (Q); (B) → (R); (C) → (P)
Item - I Item - II
(A) Norethindrone (P) Anti-biotic 21. The freezing point of a diluted milk sample is found to
(B) Ofloxacin (Q) Anti-fertility be −0.2°C, while it should have been −0.5° C for pure
milk. How much water has been added to pure milk to
(C) Equanil (R) Hypertension make the diluted sample?
(S) Analgesics (1) 1 cup of water to 2 cups of pure milk
(1) (A) → (R); (B) → (P); (C) → (S) (2) 2 cups of water to 3 cups of pure milk
(2) (A) → (Q); (B) → (P); (C) → (R) (3) 3 cups of water to 2cups of pure milk
(3) (A) → (Q); (B) → (R); (C) → (S) (4) 1 cup of water to 3 cups of pure milk
(4) (A) → (R); (B) → (P); (C) → (R)
22. For the cell Zn(s)|Zn2+(aq)||Mx+(aq)|M(s), different
17. For the chemical reaction X Y, the standard half cells and their standard electrode potentials are
reaction Gibbs energy depends on temperature T (in given below:
K) as
Mx+ (aq)/ Au3+ (aq)/ Ag+ (aq)/ Fe3+ (aq)/ Fe2+ (aq)/
3
ΔrG° (in kJ mol−1) = 120 − T . M(s) Au(s) Ag(s) Fe2+ (aq) Fe(s)
8 1.40 0.80 0.77 −0.44
E° M x+/M /(V)
The major component of the reaction mixture at T is:
(1) Y if T = 300 K (2) Y if T = 280 K
If E °Zn 2+ /Zn = −0.76 V, which cathode will give a
(3) X if T = 315 K (4) X if T = 350 K maximum value of E°cell per electron transferred?
18. The element that usually does NOT show variable (1) Ag+/Ag (2) Au3+/Au
oxidation states is: (3) Fe3+/Fe2+ (4) Fe2+/Fe
(1) Sc (2) V
23. A 10 mg effervescent tablet containing sodium
(3) Ti (4) Cu bicarbonate and oxalic acid releases 0.25 mL of CO2 at
T = 298.15 K and p = 1 bar. If molar volume of CO2 is
19. Match the ores (List I) with the metals 25.0 L under such condition, what is the percentage of
(List II): sodium bicarbonate in each tablet?
(List I) (List II) [Molar mass of NaHCO3 = 84 g mol−1]
Ores Metals (1) 33.6 (2) 8.4
(A) Siderite (P) Zinc (3) 16.8 (4) 0.84
(B) Kaolinite (Q) Copper
(C) Malachite (R) Iron 24. Which compound (s) out of the following is/are not
aromatic?
(D) Calamine (S) Aluminium
(1) (A) → (R); (B) → (S); (C) → (P); (D) → (Q)
(2) (A) → (P); (B) → (Q); (C) → (R); (D) → (S) ⊕ ⊕
1
(T1 + T2 ) 2 (T + T ) 2
(1) 2Cp ln (2) Cp ln 1 2
TT
1 2
4T1T2
_
@edubuzznotes
CHEMISTRY
4. The major product obtained in the following reaction (3) Endothermic if A < 0 and B > 0
is: (4) Exothermic if B < 0
O OH
6. The radius of the largest sphere which fits properly at
the centre of the edge of a body centred cubic unit cell
LiAlH4
(excess)
7. The hydride that is NOT electron deficient is: 13. In the following compound,
(1) SiH4 (2) B2H6 NH2
a
10 × 10 , calculate the E
15 °
cell of this reaction at 298 K the favourable site/s for protonation is/are:
RT (1) (a) and (e) (2) (b), (c) and (d)
2.303 F at 298 K = 0.059 V
(3) (a) and (d) (4) (a)
(1) 0.04736 mV (2) 0.4736 mV
14. Taj Mahal is being slowly disfigured and discoloured.
(3) 0.4736 V (4) 0.04736 V
This is primarily due to:
9. The correct option with respect to the Pauling (1) global warming (2) acid rain
electronegativity values of the elements is: (3) water pollution (4) soil pollution
(1) Te > Se (2) Ga < Ge
15. The relative stability of + 1 oxidation state of Group
(3) Si < Al (4) P > S
13 elements follows the order:
10. Which of the following compounds will produce a (1) Al < Ga < Tl < In (2) Tl < In < Ga < Al
precipitate with AgNO3? (3) Ga < Al < In < Tl (4) Al < Ga < In < Tl
(1) Br (2) Br
16. For the equilibrium, 2H 2 O H 3 O + + OH − , the value
of ∆G° at 298 K is approximately:
N
(1) 100 kJ mol−1 (2) −80 kJ mol−1
(3) Br (4) Br
(3) 80 kJ mol−1 (4) −100 kJ mol−1
C(CH2)2C O C(CH2)3 O O O
n n (3) CH3 O (4) CH3 O
Br
21. K2HgI4 is 40% ionised in aqueous solution. The value O O
of its van’t Hoff factor (i) is:
(1) 1.6 (2) 1.8 Br
(3) 2.0 (4) 2.2 O O
22. 25 mL of the given HCl solution requires 30 mL of 26. Major product of the following reaction is:
0.1 M sodium carbonate solution. What is the volume HO
of this HCl solution required to titrate 30 mL of 0.2 M (i) HCl
(1) 25 mL (2) 75 mL
(1) (2) Cl
(3) 50 mL (4) 12.5 mL
Cl
23. The reaction 2X → B is a zeroth order reaction. If
the initial concentration of X is 0.2 M, the half-life is
6 h. When the initial concentration of X is 0.5 M, the
time required to reach its final concentration of 0.2 M (3) (4) HO
will be: HO
(1) 9.0 h (2) 12.0 h
(3) 18.0 h (4) 7.2 h
24. Match the following items in List I with the 27. The higher concentration of which gas in air can cause
corresponding items in List II. stiffness of flower buds?
List I List II (1) NO2 (2) CO2
(A) Na CO .10 H O
2 3 2
(P) Portland cement (3) SO2 (4) CO
ingredient
(B) Mg(HCO3)2 (Q) Castner-Kellner process 28. The correct match between Item I and Item II is:
(C) NaOH (R) Solvay process Item I Item II
(D) Ca3Al2O6 (S) Temporary hardness (A) Ester test (P) Tyr
(1) (A) → (Q); (B) → (R); (C) → (P); (D) → (S) (B) Carbylamine test (Q) Asp
(2) (A) → (R); (B) → (Q); (C) → (S); (D) → (P) (C) Phthalein dye test (R) Ser
(3) (A) → (S); (B) → (P); (C) → (Q); (D) → (R) (S) Lys
(4) (A) → (R); (B) → (S); (C) → (Q); (D) → (P) (1) (A) → (Q); (B) → (S); (C) → (P)
(2) (A) → (R); (B) → (Q); (C) → (P)
25. The major product obtained in the following conversion (3) (A) → (R); (B) → (S); (C) → (Q)
is:
CH3 O (4) (A) → (Q); (B) → (S); (C) → (R)
O Br2 (1 eqv.)
29. The number of bridging CO ligand(s) and Co-Co
MeOH bond(s) in Co2(CO)8, respectively are:
(1) 2 and 1 (2) 2 and 0
O (3) 0 and 2 (4) 4 and 0
_
@edubuzznotes 1, Shift 2)
CHEMISTRY
1. In the Hall-Heroult process, aluminium is formed at 6. The major product of the following reaction is:
the cathode. The cathode is made out of:
CN
(1) Pure aluminium (2) Carbon
(i) DIBAL-H
(3) Copper (4) Platinum (ii) H3O
+
O
3.
In a chemical reaction, A + 2B K
2C + D, the initial
concentration of B was 1.5 times of the concentration OH O
of A, but the equilibrium concentrations of A and B
were found to be equal. The equilibrium constant (K) CHO
for the aforesaid chemical reaction is:
(1) 4 (2) 16 7. A metal on combustion in excess air forms X. X upon
hydrolysis with water yields H2O2 and O2 along with
1 another product. The metal is:
(3) (4) 1
4 (1) Na (2) Rb
4. Given
(3) Mg (4) Li
Gas H2 CH4 CO2 SO2
Critical Temperature/K 33 190 304 630 8. The molecule that has minimum/no role in the
formation of photochemical smog, is:
On the basis of data given above, predict which of the
(1) N2 (2) CH2 = O
following gases shows least adsorption on a definite
amount of charcoal? (3) O3 (4) NO
(1) SO2 (2) CH4
9. The pair of metal ions that can give a spin-only magnetic
(3) CO2 (4) H2 moment of 3.9 BM for the complex [M(H2O)6]Cl2, is:
(1) V2+ and Co2+ (2) V2+ and Fe2+
5. Mn2(CO)10 is an organometallic compound due to the
presence of: (3) Co2+ and Fe2+ (4) Cr2+ and Mn2+
(1) Mn – C bond (2) Mn − Mn bond
10. For a diatomic ideal gas in a dosed system, which of
(3) Mn – O bond (4) C – O bond the following plots does not correctly describe the
relation between various thermodynamic quantities?
_
@edubuzznotes
JEE Main 2019 (January 12, Shift 1)
(3) OH (4)
(3)
14. 50 mL of 0.5 M oxalic acid is needed to neutralize
25 mL of sodium hydroxide solution. The amount
Cv of NaOH in 50 mL of the given sodium hydroxide
solution is:
(1) 40 g (2) 10 g
(3) 20 g (4) 80 g
T
(4) 15. The volume of gas A is twice than that of gas B. The
compressibility factor of gas A is thrice than that of
gas B at same temperature. The pressures of the gases
for equal number of moles are:
Cv
(1) 3pA = 2pB (2) 2pA = 3pB
(3) pA = 3pB (4) pA = 2pB
19. The metal d-orbitals that are directly facing the ligands CH3CHO MeOH
in K3[Co(CN)6] are: The best combination is:
(1) d xy and d x2 − y 2 (2) d x2 − y 2 and d z 2 (1) CH3CHO and tBuOH
(3) d xz , d yz and d z (4) dxy, dxz and dyz (2) HCHO and MeOH
2
(2) O O
Cl
CH3O CH3 CH3
A= CH3 ; B = CH3
HO
(3) Cl (4) CH3O
(3) O
O
OH
Cl C CH3
CH3O H H
H3C
A= ;B=
H3C H3C
CH3 CH3
23. The element with Z = 120 (not yet discovered) will be (4) O O
OH
an/a: H2C
H H
(1) inner-transition metal H3C
A= ;B=
(2) alkaline earth metal H3C H3C
(3) alkali metal CH3 CH3
(4) transition metal
27. What is the work function of the metal if the light
24. In the following reaction of wavelength 4000 Å generates photoelectrons of
velocity 6 × 105 ms−1 from it?
Aldehyde + Alcohol
HCl
→ Acetal (Mass of electron = 9 × 10−31 kg
_
@edubuzznotes
JEE Main 2019 (January 12, Shift 1)
29. Poly-β-hydroxybutyrate-co-β-hydroxyvalerate(PHBV)
is a copolymer of ____________.
(1) 3-hydroxybutanoic acid and 4-hydroxypentanoic
acid
(2) 2-hydroxybutanoic acid and 3-hydroxypentanoic
acid
_
@edubuzznotes
CHEMISTRY
2. The magnetic moment of an octahedral homoleptic 6. The major product of the following reaction is:
Mn(II) complex is 5.9 BM. The suitable ligand for this H3C O
complex is: NH2
O
(1) ethylenediamine (2) CN−
(3) NCS− (4) CO (i) NaNO2/H+
3. The element that does NOT show catenation is: (ii) CrO3/H+
(1) Ge (2) Si (iii) H2SO4(conc.), Δ
(3) Sn (4) Pb (1) HO
(1) ⊕ (2) ⊕
H3N CH COOH H3N CH COO
⊕
NH2 NH
7. Λ °m for NaCl, HCl and NaA are 126.4, 425.9 and
N N⊕ 100.5 S cm2mol−1, respectively. If the conductivity of
H 0.001 M HA is 5 × 10−5 S cm−1, degree of dissociation
of HA is:
(1) 0.50 (2) 0.25
(3) 0.125 (4) 0.75
_
@edubuzznotesJEE Main 2019 (January 12, Shift 2)
8. Molecules of benzoic acid (C6H5COOH) dimerise in (C) (D)
benzene. ‘w’ g of the acid dissolved in 30 g of benzene
shows a depression in freezing point equal to 2 K. If pVm
the percentage association of the acid to form dimer in U
the solution is 80, then w is:
(Given that Kf = 5 K kg mol−1, Molar mass of benzoic
acid = 122 g mol−1) O O Vm
p
(1) 2.4 g (2) 1.0 g
(1) (B) and (D) (2) (A) and (C)
(3) 1.5 g (4) 1.8 g
(3) (B) and (C) (4) (A) and (D)
9. Chlorine on reaction with hot and concentrated sodium
hydroxide gives: 12. The major product in the following conversion is:
(1) Cl− and ClO3− HBr (Excess)
CH3O CH CH CH3 ?
(2) Cl− and ClO− Heat
CH2CH3 (2)
NaOEt HO CH CH2 CH3
H3C C Cl ∆
Br
COOCH2CH3
(3)
(1) CH3CH2C CH2 CH3O CH CH2 CH3
CO2CH2CH3 Br
(4)
(2) CO2CH2CH3 CH3O CH2 CH CH3
CH3C CHCH3 Br
(3) CH2CH3 13. The major product of the following reaction is:
O
H3C C OCH2CH3
NaBH4
COOCH2CH3 EtOH
(4) OCH2CH3
(1) OH (2) OH
H3CH2C C CO2CH2CH3
CH3 OEt
(3) O (4) OH
11. The combination of plots which does not represent
isothermal expansion of an ideal gas is:
(A) (B)
14. The correct order of atomic radii is:
p p
(1) N > Ce > Eu > Ho (2) Ho > N > Eu > Ce
(3) Ce > Eu > Ho > N (4) Eu > Ce > Ho > N
O 1/Vm O Vm
15. The element that shows greater ability to form pπ - pπ
multiple bonds, is:
(1) Sn (2) C
(3) Ge (4) Si
_
@edubuzznotes JEE Main 2019 (January 12, Shift 2) P–31
16. The two monomers for the synthesis of nylon 6, 6 are: (1) A and B only
(1) HOOC(CH2)4COOH, H2N(CH2)6NH2 (2) A and C only
(2) HOOC(CH2)6COOH, H2N(CH2)6NH2 (3) A, B and C
(3) HOOC(CH2)4COOH, H2N(CH2)4NH2 (4) C only
(4) HOOC(CH2)6COOH, H2N(CH2)4NH2
21. The compound that is NOT a common component of
17. The aldehydes which will not form Grignard product photochemical smog is:
with one equivalent Grignard reagents are: (1) O3 (2) H3C C OONO2
(A) CHO O
(3) CH2=CHCHO (4) CF2Cl2
(C) CHO
Slope = –4606 K
In k
H3CO
(D) CHO
1/T
(1) (B), (D) (2) (B), (C) (3) 10−4 s−1 (4) 4 × 10−4 s−1
(3) (B), (C), (D) (4) (C), (D) 23. An open vessel at 27°C is heated until two fifth of the
air (assumed as an ideal gas) in it has escaped from
18. Given: the vessel. Assuming that the volume of the vessel
(i) C (graphite) + O2(g) → CO2(g); ΔrH° = x kJ mol−1 remains constant, the temperature at which the vessel
1 has been heated is:
(ii) C (graphite) + O2(g) → CO2(g); ΔrH° = y kJ mol−1
2 (1) 500 °C (2) 500 K
1
(iii) CO(g) + O2(g) →CO2(g); ΔrH° = z kJ mol−1 (3) 750 °C (4) 750 K
2
Based on the above thermochemical equations, find 24. The major product of the following reaction is:
out which one of the following algebraic relationships
is correct? H3C
CH2
HCl
(1) x = y + z (2) z = x + y
H
(3) y = 2z – x (4) x = y – z
19. The volume strength of 1 M H2O2 is: (Molar mass of (1) CH2 Cl
(C) Along with sodium ions, they are responsible for the
transmission of nerve signals.
_
@edubuzznotesJEE Main 2019 (January 12, Shift 2)
(4) CH3
27. The major product of the following reaction is:
CH3 (i) KOH alc.
Cl CH3CH2CH CH2
(ii) NaNH2
H Br Br in liq NH3
JANUARY 9, SHIFT 1
1. (1) 2. (4) 3. (3) 4. (1) 5. (4) 6. (3) 7. (4) 8. (1) 9. (3) 10. (2)
11. (3) 12. (2) 13. (3) 14. (1) 15. (1) 16. (4) 17. (4) 18. (2) 19. (3) 20. (3)
21. (1) 22. (4) 23. (3) 24. (3) 25. (1) 26. (1) 27. (3) 28. (2) 29. (2) 30. (4)
JANUARY 9, SHIFT 2
1. (4) 2. (3) 3. (3) 4. (3) 5. (3) 6. (4) 7. (3) 8. (2) 9. (2) 10. (2)
11. (4) 12. (1) 13. (3) 14. (1) 15. (2) 16. (3) 17. (2) 18. (4) 19. (3) 20. (1)
21. (3) 22. (1) 23. (3) 24. (1) 25. (4) 26. (2) 27. (4) 28. (4) 29. (3) 30. (1)
1. (4) 2. (3) 3. (2) 4. (1) 5. (1) 6. (1) 7. (1) 8. (2) 9. (N*) 10. (3)
11. (1) 12. (1) 13. (2) 14. (3) 15. (2) 16. (3) 17. (2) 18. (4) 19. (2) 20. (1)
21. (2) 22. (2) 23. (4) 24. (1) 25. (2) 26. (4) 27. (3) 28. (4) 29. (3) 30. (4)
1. (3) 2. (1) 3. (1) 4. (3) 5. (1) 6. (4) 7. (3) 8. (4) 9. (3) 10. (1)
11. (1) 12. (4) 13. (3) 14. (4) 15. (4) 16. (4) 17. (4) 18. (2) 19. (3) 20. (4)
21. (2) 22. (2) 23. (4) 24. (2) 25 (1) 26. (1) 27. (1) 28. (4) 29. (2) 30. (4)
1. (4) 2. (4) 3. (3) 4. (4) 5. (2) 6. (4) 7. (1) 8. (1) 9. (2) 10. (1)
11. (2) 12. (2) 13. (1) 14. (3) 15. (1) 16. (2) 17. (3) 18. (1) 19. (4) 20. (2)
21. (3) 22. (1) 23. (2) 24. (2) 25. (3) 26. (1) 27. (2) 28. (4) 29. (2) 30. (1)
_
@edubuzznotes n 2019 (January)– Answer Key
1. (3) 2. (1) 3. (4) 4. (3) 5. (1) 6. (4) 7. (1) 8. (3) 9. (2) 10. (2)
11. (4) 12. (4) 13. (2) 14. (2) 15. (4) 16. (3) 17. (2) 18. (3) 19. (2) 20. (4)
21. (2) 22. (1) 23. (3) 24. (4) 25 (1) 26. (4) 27. (3) 28. (1) 29. (1) 30. (2)
1. (2) 2. (4) 3. (1) 4. (4) 5. (1) 6. (3) 7. (2) 8. (1) 9. (1) 10. (1)
11. (2) 12. (1) 13. (4) 14. (N*) 15. (2) 16. (4) 17. (4) 18. (1) 19. (2) 20. (1)
21. (1) 22. (4) 23. (2) 24. (2) 25 (2) 26. (1) 27. (3) 28. (1) 29. (4) 30. (3)
1. (3) 2. (3) 3. (4) 4. (4) 5. (3) 6. (1) 7. (3) 8. (1) 9. (1) 10. (2)
11. (1) 12. (2) 13. (2) 14. (4) 15. (2) 16. (1) 17. (1) 18. (1) 19. (3) 20. (3)
21. (4) 22. (3) 23. (2) 24. (4) 25 (3) 26. (1) 27. (4) 28. (3) 29. (1) 30. (4)
Note:
• (N*) indicates question dropped. Candidate awarded full marks.
_
@edubuzznotes
Index
aluminium alums 394 Aufbau principle 6–7, 13, 92–93 B12 icosahedron 389
aluminium carbide (Al4C3) 417 auriferous rock 235 bidentate ligands 175–176
aluminium chloride (AlCl3) Avogadro constant 111 bimolecular nucleophilic
402–403 axial d•orbitals 6 substitution 157–161
aluminium halides 404 azides 458 binary compounds, thermal stability
aluminium hydride 404 azimuthal quantum number 3–5 of 128
aluminium sulphate 393 azurite 219, 246 binary metal carbonyls 419
aluminium trimethyl dimer 408 biotite 431
alums 394 Birkeland–Eyde process 469
alunite 239 bisulphites 493
amalgam 231, 233
B black phosphorus 449
Ag•Hg 233 back bonding 69, 75–79, 178, 454, 462 blast furnace 233
Au•Hg 233 with C as donor atom 78 blast furnace gas 251
Na•Hg 233 in Cl2O 76 bleaching powder 529–530
tin 233 3dp−2p p type of 76 blue baby syndrome 461
ambidentate ligands 177 with F as donor atom 75–76 B•N bond 78
ammonia 450 of halogen on Lewis acidity 78 body•centred cubic structure 64,
ammonium alum 399 with halogens (Cl, Br, I) as donor 134–136
ammonium dithiocarbamate 424 atom 78–79 body•centred cubic type of
ammonium phosphate 478 with N as donor atom 77–78 arrangement 108
ammonium salts 451–452 with O as donor atom 76–77 boiling points 130
amphiboles 430–431 in PF3 75–76 actinoids (5f•series) 589
amphoteric oxides 491 planar boroxine (B3O6) ring 76 boron 389–390
amphoteric substance 45 2pp −2pp 77 d•block elements 565
anglesite 219, 244 banana bond 83 deuterium (H2) 130
anglesite (PbSO4) 221 band gap 139 group 13 389–390
anhydrone 534 Bari centre 183 group 15 448
annealing 253 baryte 219 halogens 519
antibonding MO 88 basic oxides 490 hydrides 454
anti•parallel arrangement 128 basic radicals, tests for intermolecular hydrogen
aqueous ammonia 172 borax bead test 293–294 bonding 332–334
arachno•boranes 404 dry tests 291–294 intramolecular hydrogen
argentite 218, 234 fame test 293 bonding 336
arsenides 454 sodium carbonate bead test 294 transition elements 565
asbestos 237 wet tests 294–296 water 502
atacamite, 219 bauxite 218, 239 [B3O6]3− ion 76
atom 1 benefciation of 240–242 bonding MO 88
attractive and repulsive forces red 240 bond moments 98
experienced by electrons white 240 for diatomic heteroatomic
in 15 Bayer’s process 240 molecules 98
characteristics of fundamental benitoite 430 for polyatomic molecule 98
particles of 2 bentonite 431 bonds
electronic confguration of 3–17 Bent’s rule 70, 72, 74 calcium chloride 62
nucleus 1 benzene 88 covalent 62–63
structure of 1 nitration of 470 double 64
atomic radi/radius order of ortho, meta and para hydrogen 330–339
of an element 35 disubstituted 101 ionic 60–62
of inert gas elements 37 beryl 430 metallic 60, 64
ionic 38–39 beryllium 94 sodium chloride 61
periodic variation of 37–38 metallic molecular orbitals for 139 triple 64
van der Waals radii of two beryllium carbide (Be2C) 417 types of 60–61
atoms 36–37 beryllium fuoride (BeF2) 110 boranes 404
atomic volume 28–29 Bessemer converter 247–248 ammonia, reaction with 406–407
attractive energy 111 B2H6 hydroboration 405–406
attractive intermolecular bond lengths and bond strength reactions of 405–408
forces 128–130 in 83–84 structures of 408
dipole•dipole interaction 128–129 hybridization of the B atoms borates 396–397
dipole•induced dipole in 83 borax 218, 397–398
interaction 129 terminal and bridge•bond cleavage borax bead test 394
instantaneous dipole•induced in 85 borazine 407
dipole interaction 129–130 bicarbonates 422 Born exponent 112
_
@edubuzznotes
Index I3
Born–Haber cycle 111, 113, magnesium carbide (Mg2C3) 417 specifc tests 306–307
118–119, 188 salt•like 417 sulphides 299–301
Born–Landé equation 113, 184, 188 carbon 413 C60 carbon cluster compound 414
Born–Meyer or Kapustinskii allotrope of 414 cement 394
equations 113, 188 atom 62, 94 cerium (Ce) 585
boron bond energies 415 cerium(IV) oxide (CeO2) 588
amorphous, reactions of 392 carbides 417–418 cerium molybdate 588
anomalous behaviour of 403–404 catenation of 415 cerium tungstate 588
atom 94 chemical reactivity 416–417 cerrusite 219, 244
boiling point 389–390 coordination numbers 415 chain silicates 430–431
boranes 404–408 dioxide CO2 421–422 chalcanthite 219
borates 396–397 disulphide CS2 423–424 chalcocite 218, 246
borax 397–398 Ellingham diagram for 231 chalcogens 31
borax bead test 394 monoxide CO 418–420 allotropic form of 484–488
carboranes 408 oxygen compounds of 418–422 bond lengths 489
halides 402 pi bonding of 415 chemical reactivity 488–489
hydrides 404–405 structure in diamond 413 differences between oxygen and
organometallic compounds 408 structure in graphite 414 other elements 489
preparation of 391 suboxide C3O2 422 electronic structure and oxidation
pure crystalline 392 sulphides of 423–424 states 483
qualitative analysis of 398 carbonate ores 219, 223 general properties 483–484
reactions of 392 carbonates 413, 423 halides 507–508
a •rhombohedral 389 carbon dioxide 413 hydrides 501–507
structure of 389 carbon disulphide 413 oxidation states (+II), (+IV) and
tetrahydridoborates 400 carbon halides 440–441 (+VI) 488–489
boron nitride 406 carbonic acid 422–423 oxides 489–491
boron trifuoride (BF3) 401 carbon monoxide 97, 413 oxides of sulphur 491–494
borosilicate glasses 433 Carbon reduction process 223–224 oxohalides 500
bridge bonding for extraction of lead 245 oxygen 484
in BeH2 and BeCl2 84 carbon tetrachloride (CCl4) ozone 484–487
in BH3 molecules 83–84 boiling point order for 130 pp −dp bonding 489
in I2Cl6 84–85 hydrolysis of 158 physical properties 488
molecules which show 85 carbonyl chloride 420 structure 484–488
bromazide (BrN3) 458 carbonyl halides 420 sulphur 484, 487–488
brown•ring test for nitrates 466 carbonyls 89, 420 chalcopyrite 218
buckminster fullerene 414 carboranes 408 C—H bonds 67
butane 442 carborundum 418 chelating ligands 177
butane•2,3•dione 102 carnalite 219, 237 chemical methods of
carnallite 171 separation 219
Caro’s acid 500 chile saltpeter 219
hydrolysis of 162 China clay 240
C
case•hardening 253 chloral hydrate 334
cadmium chloride (CdCl2) 111 casseterite 218 chlorates 534
cadmium iodide (Cdl2) 110 cast iron 251 chlorazide (ClN3) 458
caesium catenated halides 442 chlorine atom 62
electronegativity of 44 cations, tests for chlorine dioxide (ClO2) 530
caesium chloride (CsCl) with dil. CaSO4 solution 304 chlorine perchlorate 530
lattice energy of 114 with dil. HCl 296 chlorites 533
Madelung constant for 114 with dil. H2SO4 solution 304 chlorofuorocarbons (CFCs) 441
structural arrangement for 108 for group V cations 304–305 chlorosulphuric acid 500
calamine 219, 248 for group VI and zero group CH3NCS 77
calcination 219, 222 cations 305 chromate 569–570
calcium•alkali silicate glass 433 with K4 and K3 302–303, 305 chromite ore 218
calcium chloride (CaCl2) 110 with KCN solution 302 chrysotile 431
calcium cyanamide 413, 417 with KI 301 cinnabar 218
calcium fuoride (fuorite), structure with Na2CrO4 301–302, 304 cis•diol forms 396
of 109 with Na2HPO4 303–304 clathrate compounds 544
caprolactam 460 with NaOH 297 clay minerals 431
carbides 417–418 with NH4OH 298–299 Clementi and Raimondi method 17
covalent 418 with NH4 SCN/KSCN 304 close packing arrangements 106–107
interstitial 418 Rinmann’s green test 306 fuorite structure 109
_
@edubuzznotes
I4 Index
gelignite 425 size of atoms and ions 390 oxoacids of phosphorus 474–478
geometrical isomers 204–206 sodium and potassium phosphate fertilizers 461–462
gerade 85–86 metaborates 397 phosphorus 449
germanium 40, 413, 415 sodium peroxoborate 398 radii 449
chemical reactivity 416–417 structures 389–390 reactivity 450
gibbsite 239 tetrahydridoborates 399–400 group 16. see chalcogens
Gillespie 69 valency electrons of 402 group 17. see halogens
Girbotol process 421 water and air, reactions with 393 group 18. see noble gases
glass 433 group 14 Group 1 carbonates 423
glauber salt 219 allotropic forms 413–414 Group 2 carbonates 423
gold (Au) 563, 565 carbides 417–418 group I B elements 31
extraction of 235–236 chemical reactivity 416–417 Group 1 metals 414
impurities present in ore 235 complexes 438–439 group 1 metals
refning of 235–236 covalent radii 415 body•centred cubic structure 134
Graham’s salt 477 differences between carbon, bonding energy of 134
graphite 406, 413–414 silicon and other group 2 metals
a 414 elements 415 bonding energy of 134
b 414 electronic structures and oxidation hexagonal close•packed
density of 414 states 413 structure 134
electrical conductivity of 414 four•covalent compounds 416 gypsum 219
reverse process of 414 glass 433
stability of 414 halides 440–443
gravity separation 220 inert pair effect 417
Grignard reaction 434 internal p bonding using d H
group 13 orbitals 439–440
Haber–Bosch process 452, 460–461
acid and alkalis, reactions with 393 ionization energies 416
haematite 218, 250
aluminates 399 malleability and electrical
hafnium 564
aluminium sulphate 393 conductivity 416
half•flled confguration 13
aluminum oxide (Al2O3) 399 melting points and electronegativity
halide ores 218–219
alums 394 values 415–416
halides
boiling point of 389–390 metallic and non•metallic
boron 402
borates 394–397 character 416
bridges 528
borax 397–398 organic derivatives 443
carbon 440–441
boric acid (H3BO3) 395 organosilicon compounds 434
catenated 442
boron 398 physical properties of 415–416
chalcogens 507–508
boron sesquioxide 394–395 silicates 428–433
dihalides 443
boron trioxide (B2O3 ) 394–395, silicones 434–437
Freons 441
404 structure of 413–414
group 13 401–403
cement 394 group 15
complexes 403 boiling point 448 group 14 440–443
differences between boron and bond type 449–450 group 15 462–465
other elements 403–404 coordination number 450 halogens 527–528
dihalides 403 electronic structures and oxidation hexafuoroethane (C2F6) 440
dioxygen, reactions with 393 states 448 lead 442
electronic structures and oxidation general properties and lead (Pb) 442
states 388 structures 448–450 oxohalides 500
electropositive or metallic nature halides 462–465 pentahalides 463–465
of 390–391 hydrides 451–456 polytetrafuoroethylene 440
fuoboric acid 399 hydrogen azide (HN3) 458 silicon 442
halides 401–403 ionization energies and sulphuryl 500
halogens and sulphate, reactions electronegativity 449 tetrachloromethane (carbon
with 393 liquid ammonia 457–458 tetrachloride) CCl4 441
(+III) oxidation state 388 melting point 448 tetrafuoro•ethylene (C2F4) 440
ionization energies of 391 metallic and non•metallic tetrafuoromethane (carbon
(+I) oxidation state 388–389 character 450 tetrafuoride) CF4 440
melting points of 389–390 nitrogen 448 tetrahalides 440
metals, bonding energy of 134 nitrogen fxation 459–461 tin 442
orthoborates 396–397 NPK fertilizers 461–462 trihalides 462–463
orthoboric acid (H3BO3) 395, 404 oxides of nitrogen 465–468 Hall’s process 241
preparation of boron 391–392 oxides of phosphorus 472–474 halogens 31
reactions of elements of 392–393 oxoacids of nitrogen 468–472 boiling point 519
_
@edubuzznotes
Index I7
of arsenic trichloride (AsCl3) 161 8•hydroxyquinoline 403 interactions between ions and
of beryllium chloride hypobromites 532 covalent molecules
(BeCl2) 160 hypoiodites 532 131–132
bimolecular nucleophilic hypophosphorous acid melting point of 121–123
substitution 157–161 (H3PO2) 478 properties affected by
of bismuth chloride (BiCl3) 161 polarization 120–121
of boron trichloride (BCl3) 160 solubility of 123–126
of boron trifuoride (BF3) 159
I thermal stability of 128
of BX3 or BH3 395 (+III) oxidation state 388 ionic compounds of the type AX,
of calcium cyanamide 452 electronegativity values 388 structural arrangements for
of carbides, nitrides and Fajans’ rules 388 4:4 arrangement 108
phosphides 164 total hydration energy 388 caesium chloride 108
of carbon tetrachloride (+II) oxidation state 417 sodium chloride 108
(CCl4) 158 ilmenite 218 zinc sulphide 108
of Caro’s acid 162 impurity semiconductors 140 ionic compounds of the type AX2,
defnition of 157 Indian saltpeter 219 structural arrangements for
of dinitrogen pentoxide induced dipole 129 calcium fuoride (fuorite) 109
(N2O5) 162 inert elements 34 b•cristobalite (silica) 110
of dinitrogen trioxide (N2O3) 162 inert gases 31 rutile 109–110
of halides 402 electronegativity of 44 ionic halides 527
of interhalogen compounds 161 inert pair effect 388–389 ionic mobility 47–48
of Marshall’s acid 162 group 14 417 ionic peroxides 505
of methyl trichlorosilane 436 inner transition elements 34 ionic potential 127
of nitrogen trichloride inorganic benzene 407 ionic radius 38–39
(NCl3) 160–161 insulators 139–140 ionic structures
of nitrogen trifuoride interhalogen compounds 535–536 close packing arrangements
(NF3) 157–158 inter•ionic distance 112 106–107
partial 159 intermolecuar forces lattice energy 46, 111–114
of pentahalides 464 repulsive 131 layer structures 110–111
of peroxodisulphuric acid 500 intermolecular forces limiting radius ratio values
of phosphorus pentachloride attractive 128–130 105–106
( PCl5) 165 intermolecular hydrogen bonding radius ratio rules 104–106
of phosphorus tetramer (P4) 164 effects on physical and chemical of type AX, structural
of phosphorus trichloride properties 332–334 arrangements for 108
(PCl3) 161 interstitial carbides 418 of type AX2, structural
of P4O10 165, 475 intramolecular hydrogen arrangements for 109
push•pull mechanism 157, bonding 334 ion•induced dipole interaction 131
163–164 acidity 335–336 ionization energy (IE) 39–40, 118
redox reaction 157, 163 effects on physical and chemical applications of 41
of R3Ga 164 properties 335–337 depending factors 40
of silane (SiH4) 163–164 isomeric distribution 337 periodic variations in 40–41
of silicon tetrachloride 435 melting and boiling points 336 relation with electron affnity 42
of silicon tetrachloride solubility 337 ionization isomerism 199
(SiCl4) 158–159 viscosity 337 (+I) oxidation state 388–389
of silicon tetrafuoride (SiF4) 159 intrinsic semiconduction 115 iron
of sulfur hexafuoride (SF6) 160 intrinsic semiconductors 140 extraction of 250–253
of sulfur tetrafuoride (SF4) 160 iodazide (IN3) 458 ores of 250
of sulfur trioxide (SO3) 163 iodine monochloride (ICl) 535–536 refning of 251
of sulfuryl chloride (SO2Cl2) 162 iodine trichloride (I2Cl6) 536 iron compounds 577–578
through mixed mechanism 164–165 ion•dipole interactions 131 iron chloride (FeCl2) 578
of trimethylaluminium ionic azides 458 iron oxide (FeO) 578
(Al2(CH3)6) 164 ionic bonds 60–62 iron sulphate (FeSO4) 577–578
of trimethylmonochlorosilane 435 radius ratio rules 104–106 iron pyrite 218, 250
unimolecular nucleophillic ionic compounds isobars 2
substitution 157–158 acidic nature of oxides 127 isodiaphers 2–3
of xenon difuoride (XeF2) 163 dissolution process of an 124 isoelectronic species 3
of xenon hexafuoride electrical conductivity and isoelectronic species, radius of 39
(XeF6) 163 colour 126–127 isomerism 199–206
hydrophobic end 221 energy•distance function for for complexes with coordination
hydroxylamine 460 different ion•covalent number fve 203–204
hydroxylamine (NH2OH) 456 interactions 132
_
@edubuzznotes
Index I9
interstitial ions and electrons 117 ortho isomer 336 oxohalides 500
metal defciency 117–118 orthophosphoric acid 474–475 oxyacids 45
normal oxides 490 orthophosphorous acid oxygen 484
NPK fertilizers 461–462 (H3PO3) 478 differences between with other
n-type semiconduction 117 orthosilicates (neso•silicates) 429 elements 489
n•type semiconductor 140 Ostwald process 469 oxygen difuoride (OF2) 528
nylon•6 460 overlap of orbitals 80–83, 87 oxy salt ores 219
oxalate complex 403 ozone 484–487
oxalic acid 335 chemical properties 485–487
oxidation number of an element 63 estimation of 487
O
oxide ores 218 oxidation reactions 485–487
o•Chlorophenol 334–335 reduction of 223 physical properties 485
octahedral complexes 183–187 oxides preparation of 485
asymmetrical electronic acidic 491 uses of 487
arrangements 190 amphoteric 491
CFSE and electronic basic 490
arrangements in 186–187 neutral 491
P
CFSE and pairing energy in 187 normal 490
crystal feld splittings for hexa• peroxides 490 palladium 563
aqua complexes 186 suboxides 490 para isomer 336
CSFE energies in 183 superoxides 490 paramagnetic substances 14
directions in 183 oxides of nitrogen 465–468 Parke’s process 234
Jahn–Teller distortion 189–191 dinitrogen pentoxide (N2O5) 468 partial hydrolysis 159
symmetrical electronic dinitrogen tetroxide (N2O4) 467– Pattinson’s process 234
arrangements 190 468 Pauli exclusion principle 15, 90
octahedral holes 106–107 nitric oxide (NO) 465–466 Pauling scale 43–44
octahedral ligand 183 nitrogen dioxide (NO2) 467–468 Pauling’s electronegativity
octet rule 64–66 nitrogen sesquioxide values 438
odd electron molecules 466 (N2O3) 466–467 Pauli’s exclusion principle 8–9
o•Fluorophenol 334 nitrous oxide (N2O) 465 p•block 389
oil foatation 220 oxides of phosphorus 472–474 p•block elements 33–34, 561
o•Nitrophenol 334 pentoxides 473–474 periodic variations in 40
opal glass 433 trioxides 472–473 valence shell electrons for 33–34
orbital, defnition of 3 oxoacids 89 PBP geometry 72
δ orbitals 90 oxoacids of halogens 531–535 p•d combinations of orbitals 89
p orbitals 90 halic acids (HXO3) 533–534 pentaborane 404
ores 217 halous acids (HXO2) 533 pentadentate ligands 176
carbonate 219 hypohalous acids (HOX) 532 pentagonal planar geometry 72
concentration or dressing perhalic acids (HXO4) 534 pentahalides 463–465
of 219–222 strength of 534–535 pentaiodide 537
conversion to oxide 222 oxoacids of nitrogen 468–472 pentathìonate 499
of copper 246 nitric acid (HNO3) 469–472 pentoxides 473–474
halide 218–219 nitrous acid (HNO2) 468–469 percentage ionic character 100
hydrated 222 oxoacids of phosphorus 474–478 periodic table
of iron 250 Graham’s salt 477 atomic radius 35–39
of lead (Pb) 244 hypophosphorous acid defnition of 27
of magnesium 237 (H3PO2) 478 Dobereiner’s triads 27–28
nitrate 219 metaphosphates 477 element’s electronic
oxide 218 orthophosphoric acid 474–475 confguration 33–35
oxy salt ores 219 orthophosphorous acid Lother Meyer’s curve 28–29
recovery of a metal from its 219 (H3PO3) 478 Mendeleev’s 29–32
of silver 234 phosphoric series of acids 474 modern 32–33
sulphate 219 phosphorous acid series 477–478 Moseley’s law 32
sulphide 218 phosphorous series of acids 474 Neil Bohr’s classifcation 34
types of 218–219 polyphosphates 475–477 Newland’s octave law 28
of zinc 248 oxoacids of sulphur 494–500 properties 35–48
organolithium compound 434 peroxoacid series 499–500 permanganate 570–571
organometallic compounds 408 pyrosulphates 499 peroxides 490, 503–504
organosilicon compounds 434 thionic acid series 499 peroxoacid series 499–500
orthoboric acid 395 thiosulphuric acid and peroxodisulphuric acid
ortho•Hydroxy benzaldehyde 336 thiosulphates 498–499 (H2S2O8) 499–500
_
@edubuzznotes
I12 Index
occurence in Earth’s crust 428 solubility of ionic compounds physical properties 496
orthosilicates (neso•silicates) 429 123–126 uses 497
pyrosilicates (soro•silicates, prediction of 124–126 sulphurous acid series 494–496
disilicates) 429 soluble silicates 428–429 sulphur trioxide molecule 82–83
sheet (phyllo•silicates) 431–432 s•orbital 4–5 super heavy elements, naming
soluble 428–429 nodal plane for 15 of 34–35
three•dimensional 432–433 s•p combinations of orbitals 87 superoxides 490
silicon 413 sp3d2 hybridization 71, 79, 84, 450 superphosphate 478
chemical reactivity 416–417 sp3d3 hybridization 72 sylvine 218
dioxide 424 spectrochemical series 185 synergic effect 178
monoxide 424 sphalerite 218
oxides of 424–425 sp hybridization 70
silicon carbide 418 sp2 hybridization 70, 423 T
silicones 434–437 sp3 hybridization 70–71, 450 talc 431
boiling point of 436 s•p hybrid orbitals 75 tempering 253
fuids 437 s • p hybrid orbitals 97 tetrabasic hypophosphoric acid 477
hydrides of 437–438 sp2 hybrid orbitals 388 tetrachloromethane 62
methyl 437 spinel 237, 239 tetrachloromethane (carbon
oils 437 spin only magnetic moment 14 tetrachloride) CCl4 441
rubbers 437 spin quantum number 3, 6, 91 tetradentate ligands 176
viscosity of 436 spodumene 430 tetraethyl lead 443
silicon halides 442 square planar complexes 191–192 tetrafuoro•ethylene (C2F4) 440
silicon tetrachloride (SiCl4) d8 arrangement 191–192 tetrafuoromethane (carbon
boiling point order for 130 s•s combinations of orbitals 86–87 tetrafuoride) CF4 440
silver s•subshell 5 tetragonal distortion 189–191
extraction of 234–235 stability of half•flled and fully•flled tetrahalides 440
ores of 234 confgurations 13 tetrahedral complexes 193–195
refning of 235 stabilization energy 87, 93 CFSE and electronic
silver and its compounds 571–573 stable confguration 60 arrangements in 193–194
reactivity of metallic silver 571 stable particles 1 tetrahedral crystal feld
silver nitrate (AgNO3) 572–573 steel making process 252–253 splitting 193–194
silver glance 218 steric number, calculation of 68–69 tetrahedral holes 106–107
silver sulfde (Ag2S) 222 stibnides 454 tetrahydridoborates 399–400
Si–O bond energy 436 Stock, Alfred 404 tetrahydrofuran 406
slag cement 251 stoichiometric defects 114–116 tetrahydrofuran (THF) 83
Slater, J. C. 15 stromeyerite 234 tetramethyl ammonium
Slater’s rule 15–17 strong feld ligands 185 hydroxide 331
smelting 223 sub•energy levels 4 tetrathionate 499
soda extract 263 suboxides 490 thallium
preparation 264 subshells 4–5 atomic radius 38
soda glass 433 subsidiary quantum numbers 90 inert pair effect in 389
sodamide 458 sulfur dioxide (SO2) pollution 484 theories of bonding
sodium 40 sulfur hexafuoride (SF6) 508 Lewis theory 64–66
sodium azide 458 sulphamic acid 494 Sidgwick•Powell theory 66, 69
sodium bicarbonate 423 sulphate ores 219, 223 valence bond theory 66–69
sodium carbonate 424 sulphide ores 218, 223 valence shell electron pair
sodium chloride sulphites 493, 496 repulsion (VSEPR)
bonds 61 sulphur 217, 484, 487–488 theory 69–79
Born–Haber cycle for the dioxide (SO2) 491–493 theories of bonding in metals
formation of 118 Engel’s 487 free electron theory 137
lattice energy of 113–114 liquid form 488 molecular orbital or band
Madelung constant for 114 g •monoclinic 487 theory 137–139
Schottky defect 115 oxides of 491–494 valence bond theory 137
structural arrangement for 108 oxoacids of 494–500 theories of metal to ligand bonding
sodium ethyl xanthate 221 structure 487 in complexes
sodium lauryl sulphate 221 trioxide (SO3) 493–494 crystal feld theory 181–187
sodium peroxoborate 398 sulphur dioxide molecule 82 molecular orbital theory 181
sodium thiosulphate 498 sulphuric acid series 494–497 valence bond theory 181–182
sodium trithiocarbonate 424 chemical properties 497 thermal decomposition
sodium zeolites 433 dehydrating properties 497 method 225
_
@edubuzznotes
I14 Index
FOURTH EDITION
Visit us at https://www.wileyindia.com/resources/